HOW TO THINK LIKE
BENJAMIN GRAHAM
AND INVEST LIKE
WARREN BUFFETT
Lawrence A. Cunningham
CONTENTS
Acknowledgements ix
Introduction: The Q Culture xi
PARTI:
A TALE OF TWO MARKETS 1
Chapter 1. Mr. Market’s Bipolar Disorder 3
Swings, Bubbles, and Crashes / 5
Be an Anomaly / 11
Barrel of Monkeys? / 12
Chapter 2. Prozac Market 17
Obscurity / 17
Simplicity / 18
The PerfectDream / 22
Tidying Up the Tale / 28
Chapter 3. Chaotic Market 33
New Wave / 33
NextW ave / 36
Complexity / 46
Behavioral Finance / 47
Chapter 4. Amplified Volatility 51
Information Volatility / 51
Transaction Volatility / 59
Trader Volatility / 63
Prognosis / 66
Chapter 5. Take the Fifth 69
Who’s in Charge? / 70
Sticking to Your Knitting / 71
Alchemy / 81
The Long Run / 86
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
vi Contents
PARTII:
SHOW ME THE MONEY 89
Chapter 6. Apple Trees and Experience 91
Fools and Wisdom / 91
Horse Sense / 100
Chapter 7. Your Circle of Competence 105
The Initial Circle / 106
The Nurtured Circle / 109
A Full Circle / 114
Decision Making / 116
Chapter 8. Recognizing Success 119
Business Fuel / 120
Managers under the Microscope / 124
Bang for the Buck / 128
The Full Tool Chest/ 131
Chapter 9. You Make the Call 133
Assets / 134
Earnings / 138
Silver Bullets and the Margin of Safety / 142
Cash / 144
MarketCircularit y / 146
Chapter 10. Making (Up) Numbers 153
Perennials / 153
Satire / 157
Charades / 162
Coda / 167
PARTIII:
IN MANAGERS WE TRUST 169
Chapter 11. Going Global 171
The Two-World Story / 172
Illusions of Duty / 176
One World to Come / 180
Contents vii
Chapter 12. Rules and Trust 193
The Family Manager / 193
Local Governance / 195
General Governance / 200
Your Voice att he Table / 202
Chapter 13. Directors at Work 205
Hail to the Chief / 206
Pay / 207
Deals / 212
Capital / 215
Checking Up / 217
Chapter 14. The Fireside CEO 221
Master Servants / 221
Action / 222
Lights / 230
Trust/ 235
Conclusion: The V Culture 243
Notes 245
Index 257
This page intentionally left blank.
ix
ACKNOWLEDGMENTS
The main ideas in this booktrace their intellectual lineage to
Benjamin Graham, whom I never knew but must thank posthumously,
and Warren Buffett, whom I have the great fortune to
know and from whose writings, talks, and conversations I have
gained knowledge and insight. Neither of these men, of course, has
any responsibility for this book’s content and no doubt would disagree
with some of what it says, though it is written as a narrative
interpretation of principles they developed, to which it tries to be
faithful.
Mr. Buffett deserves my continuing thanks for permitting me to
prepare a collection of his letters to the shareholders of Berkshire
Hathaway, The Essays of Warren Buffett: Lessons for Corporate America,
and for participating along with Berkshire Vice-Chairman
Charles Munger in a symposium I organized to analyze it. Thanks
also to the readers of that collection of wonderful writings for encouraging
me to write the present book, especially the courageous
college and business school professors who use that bookin their
courses and their many students who tell me how valuable it is.
Other fans of that bookwho encouraged me to write this one
include my friends at Morgan Stanley Dean Witter, led by David
Darst and John Snyder; Chris Davis and KimMarie Zamot at Davis
Selected Advisers; the team at Edward D. Jones; and supporters too
numerous to mention at other firms who appreciate the business
analysis way of investing.
By training and professional habit I am a corporate lawyer, and
as my students know, effectiveness as a corporate lawyer requires
mastering not only (or mostly) law but also business, including finance,
accounting, and governance. For tutelage in that philosophy,
I thankmy friends and former colleagues at Cravath, Swaine &
Moore as well as that firm’s clients.
Not all law faculties recognize the intersection of law and business.
My colleagues at Cardozo Law School do and support my re-
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
x Acknowledgments
search and writing in the fields of finance, accounting, and governance
that seem to others a step beyond law as such. Among these
colleagues, special thanks to Monroe Price for introducing me to
Warren Buffett through their mutual friend Bob Denham. For granting
me a sabbatical to devote time to workon this book, I especially
thankDean Paul Verkuil and Dean Michael Herz.
My personal and institutional ability to span these and other
subjects has been greatly aided by Samuel and Ronnie Heyman, both
nonpracticing lawyers and astoundingly talented businesspeople, investors,
and philanthropists. They generously endowed the Samuel
and Ronnie Heyman Center on Corporate Governance at Cardozo,
a multifaceted program I direct that explores this range of disciplines
in teaching, research, and policy review.
My own teachers also deserve my thanks, particularly Elliott
Weiss, now professor at the University of Arizona College of Law,
who long ago drew my attention to Graham and Buffett’s ideas and
who generously shares his wealth of knowledge. For allowing me to
use in modified form some materials from a textbookwe worked on
together. I also thankProfessor Jeffrey D. Bauman of Georgetown
University Law Center, and West Group, that book’s publisher.
Thanks also to West Group for allowing me to use in modified form
some materials from another textbookI wrote, Introductory Accounting
and Finance for Lawyers, which is not for lawyers only.
Many thanks to the whole team at McGraw-Hill for their confidence,
enthusiasm, and guidance, particularly Kelli Christiansen,
Jeffrey Krames and Scott Amerman.
Most of all, thanks to my wife, JoAnna Cunningham, who painstakingly
edited the entire manuscript with precision and grace and
encouraged me every step of the way.
xi
INTRODUCTION:
THE Q CULTURE
Common sense is the heart of investing and business management.
Yet the paradox of common sense is that it is so uncommon.
For example, people often refer to a stockor the market level
as either “overvalued” or “undervalued.” That is an empty statement.
A share of stockor the aggregate of all shares in a market index have
an intrinsic value. It is the sum of all future cash flows the share or
the index will generate in the future, discounted to present value.
Estimating that amount of cash flow and its present value are
difficult. But that defines value, and it is the same without regard
to what people hope or guess it is. The result of the hoping and
guessing game—sometimes the product of analysis, often not—is
the share price or market level. Thus, it is more accurate to refer to
a stockor a market index as overpriced or underpriced than as overvalued
or undervalued.
The insight that prices vary differently from underlying values is
common sense, but it defies prevalent sense. Thinkabout the ticker
symbol for the popular Nasdaq 100: QQQ. The marketing geniuses
at the National Association of Securities Dealers may have chosen
three Qs because Q is a cool and brandable letter (thinkQ-T ips).
In choosing from the letters N, A, S, D, and Q, however, they selected
the one (three times) that stands for Quotation and unwittingly
reflect a quote-driven culture by this quintessentially New
Economy index created in mid-1999.
Quotes of prices command constant attention in the mad, modern
market where buyers and sellers of stocks have no idea of the
businesses behind the paper they swap but precisely what the price
is. Quote obsession trades analysis for attitude, minds for myopic
momentum, intelligence for instinct. Quotations are the quotidian
diet of the day trader, forging a casino culture where quickness of
action fed by irrational impulses displaces both quality and quantity
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
xii Introduction: The Q Culture
of thought. QQQ is an apt symbol for the most volatile index in
stockmark et history.
In the Q culture, common sense is common nonsense, putting
price on a pedestal and all but ignoring business value. The Q trader
sees price as everything. The smart investor knows what value is.
She focuses on value first, and then compares value to price to see
if an investment holds the promise of a good return. That kind
of focus requires the investor to operate as a business analyst, not
as a market analyst or securities analyst and certainly not as a Q
trader.
This bookdevelops a mind-set for business analysis as the antidote
to the Q culture. It discusses the tools of stockpick ing and
highlights critical areas of thinking about markets and prices, and
businesses and managers. It builds a latticeworkof common sense
to fill the vast value void in today’s markets.
The bookfirst shows you why it is a mistake to operate as a
market analyst or to look to the market to reveal value when all it
can do is reveal prices. It then presents the tools to thinkabout
performance and value but also cautions about how financial information
can be distorted in ways that can mislead you. Accordingly,
it argues that an essential element of intelligent investing is a commonsense
ability to assess the trustworthiness of corporate managers,
principally the chief executive officer and board of directors.
The business analysis approach to investing shatters many myths
of investment lore prevalent in the Q culture though not unique to
it throughout history. For example, it rejects a distinction as pervasive
as it is mistaken between growth investing and value investing
(or between growth stocks and value stocks). To be sure, some companies
show greater promise of earnings growth than others, but all
rates of growth are a component of value so this distinction, crystalized
in the early 1970s and a growing fixation ever since, is of no
analytical value.
For another, the business analysis approach underscores a key
distinction between investing on the one hand and speculation or
gambling on the other. All investing involves riskand in that sense
there is a speculative element in all of it. Intelligent investing, however,
calls for a reasonably ascertainable valuation and comparison
to the price.
Leading examples of speculating and gambling include people
buying shares in IPOs or Internet start-ups they know little or nothIntroduction:
The Q Culture xiii
ing about and buying shares in any business without first reading its
annual report or knowing what to look for in it. For every gambling
success story you hear about, there are scores of failures you don’t.
As The Wall Street Journal recently quipped, no brother-in-law has
ever been known to reveal how much money he lost in the stock
market.
The focus on business analysis as opposed to market analysis is
reinforced by the imaginary Mr. Market, created by the twentieth
century’s most astute investment thinker and business school
teacher, Benjamin Graham. Price and value diverge in capital market
trading because the market is best characterized as manic depressive,
mostly either too euphoric or too gloomy. This is contrary to the
popular but mistaken belief that markets are efficient and therefore
accurately price securities.
Once you as a business analyst know how to look, the next question
is where to look. The core idea is your circle of competence,
created by the twentieth century’s most successful investor and business
educator, Warren Buffett. It is defined by your ability to understand
a company’s products and operating context. Circles of
competence are as varied as the investors who must define them. All
investors must grapple with the challenge of using current and past
information to gauge future business performance.
For most people, it is easier to do this with businesses that have
been around a long time, been through lots of business cycles, and
faced economic recessions. Within that group of business are many
whose long trackrecords justify being called classics—wellestablished
companies with powerful global products and market positions
like Procter & Gamble, GE, Coca-Cola, and Disney. Some of
these will endure as stalwarts, while others will be beaten down (as
GE did to Westinghouse or as Wal-Mart did to Sears Roebuck). The
ability to tell which is which will vary among people with different
aptitudes in evaluating these companies, for different sets of skills
are necessary to understand these various sorts of businesses.
So too will abilities vary with respect to assessing the future performance
of newer companies that have been through fewer variations
in their operating climate. These are “vintage businesses”—
those that have been around for a while but which operate in newer
and more dynamic industries that evolve at a rapid pace—companies
like Cisco, Intel, or Microsoft, for example. They have less of a track
record, and may be harder for lots of people to understand. But some
xiv Introduction: The Q Culture
people will have the ability to understand them quite well and be
able to make informed judgments about their future prospects.
As with the classics, some vintage companies will turn out to be
warriors and others wimps. For example, take the personal computer
business. From 1990 to 1999 the erstwhile start-up Dell built a
hugely profitable direct-sales PC business, growing its sales and profits
at astonishing rates, with Compaq following respectably, Tandy
and Apple lagging, and plenty of staggering wimps suffering erosion
during the period, including AST, Digital, Atari, Tulip, Commodore,
and Kaypro.*
A third group of companies are “rookies,” brand-new companies,
perhaps in brand-new industries, whose entire context has virtually
no trackrecord. These are frontier businesses, like steel in its day,
automobiles in theirs, plastics a bit later, and the Internet at the
turn of the twenty-first century. Apart from the first movers in such
groups—say, Yahoo! and America Online (AOL) among the 1990s
Internet companies—these have virtually no economic histories to
speakof.
Even so, there will be investors who have the present-day tools
to make intelligent estimates of where the rookies will be in the
future. By mating with AOL in 2000, senior managers of Time-
Warner expressed just such confidence in their ability to do so.
Whether their judgment will be vindicated remains to be seen. But
certainly although some of these companies will turn out to be flyby-
nights, others are true up-and-comers that will proceed up the
ranks from vintage warriors to stalwart classics. After all, every company
started out as a rookie.
The central feature of the circle of competence, then, is that it
must be tailored to the individual. It is not the case that intelligent
investors avoid businesses that are hard to understand or subject to
rapid change. On the contrary, those investors equipped with the
ability and fortitude to understand what is hard for others to understand
and to gauge better than others how a business and its industry
are evolving have a decided advantage. But it remains important for
each investor to come to grips with what is and what is not within
his circle of competence to make the informed judgments that intelligent
investing requires.
* Kara Scannell, Anatomy of a Bull Run: “New Economy” Stocks Lead Charge:
Blast From the Past—A Lookat Yesterday’s Tech Investments—A Few Thrive,
Others Merely Survive, Some Fail, The Wall Street Journal, January 18, 2000.
Introduction: The Q Culture xv
The next inquiry is what to lookfor , within your circle of competence.
The main question is the certainty with which you can
evaluate the long-term economic characteristics of a business. A
greater degree of confidence may be necessary for rookies, less for
vintage companies, and least for classics; but in all cases, assessing
the long-term characteristics of business performance is crucial.
Obtaining the necessary degree of confidence in valuation entails
just a few quantitative inquiries. You’ll see in the second part of the
bookthat financial statements must enable you to answer three
questions about a business:
• How likely is it the business will be able to pay its debts as they
come due?
• How well is management running the business?
• What is it worth?
These questions can be gauged with a sufficient degree of confidence
by a basic familiarity with key business ratios relating to
working capital and debt, management of inventory and other shortterm
assets, returns on equity, and the future outlookfor earnings.
Just as each investor’s circle of competence will vary, so too will
the assessment of these financial characteristics. Ultimately, the
value of a business is the present value of all the cash it will generate
for its owners over future time. Because no one can know the future
with certitude, coming up with that number requires the right set
of tools and good judgment.
Equipped with these tools and working within your circle of
competence, you can determine how much and what sort of evidence
is required to be comfortable with a valuation estimate. Yet
there is no single reliable tool to pinpoint the value of a business,
so intelligent investors must observe Benjamin Graham and Warren
Buffett’s cardinal rule of prudent investing: getting a margin of safety
between the price you pay and the value you are paying for.
In your pursuit all these inquiries, reported figures must be
treated with a healthy skepticism. Accounting conventions and judgments
can distort business reality. For example, working capital figures
can be distorted by accounting rules relating to inventory and
receivables collection. Some fixed assets that are outmoded or noncompetitive
may have an actual scrap value way less than the reported
figure.
xvi Introduction: The Q Culture
On the other hand, some assets may be understated on a balance
sheet (such as reserves of a natural gas company as well as land
values). Off–balance sheet liabilities relating to environmental problems,
post-retirement health benefits for employees, and stockoptions
for managers also must be included as adjustments to reported
figures. You need not know every detail, but a working understanding
is necessary and can be developed with a modicum of effort as part
of a business analysis mind-set.
Tied to the question of certainty in evaluating the long-term
characteristics of a business is the certainty with which you can rely
upon management to channel rewards to shareholders. It remains
true that mouth-watering economics is the most important variable
in evaluating any business for investment. Poor economics can
rarely, if ever, be cured, even by exceptional management, and inferior
management can harm a good business (though it is harder
for bad management to damage an outstanding business).
This management reality—coupled with the inadequacy of markets
and the potential unreliability of numbers—demands that an
investor also appreciate the qualitative dimensions of business analysis.
The most important of these are those qualities that indicate
that a company has an owner orientation.
Holding an owner orientation is not required of corporate managers
as a matter of law or even by practice or custom. Nor will such
an owner orientation be achieved merely by arranging the corporate
rules in certain ways, such as having large numbers of outside directors
or separating the functions of the CEO and the chairman of
the board. Accordingly, the focus on managers is a focus on trustworthiness.
Assessing the trustworthiness of corporate managers is much like
assessing the trustworthiness of a prospective son-in-law. It is a matter
of common sense—again, a rare but acquirable mind-set. In the
context of corporate managers, sources of insight into managerial
trustworthiness include business records and qualities of communications
to shareholders—the CEO letter in particular. Examples
of this art finish off the book, the final chapter giving an account of
the letters of JackW elch (GE), Mike Eisner (Disney), and the late
Roberto Goizueta (Coca-Cola).
The folkwisdom of “minding your Ps and Qs” does not refer to
prices and quotes but to common sense. In investing, this means
grasping the basics of finance, accounting, and governance to see
that the following occurs:
Introduction: The Q Culture xvii
• The efficient market story is at most four-fifths true and investors
can take advantage of the remaining one-fifth
• Traditional tools of financial analysis remain an investor’s best
friends but that earnings management and accounting manipulation
can be her worst enemies
• Intelligent investors pay special attention to who the managers are
and whether they are trustworthy
Minding these Ps and Qs does not require enormous amounts
of work, although it does require large doses of common sense as
inoculation against Q fever.
This antidote takes you through the golden gates of the safer and
more prosperous V culture world. The consummate teacher of V
culture, Ben Graham, was also a successful practitioner. Warren
Buffett, the consummate student and practitioner, is also a teacher.
All good students take the lessons of their teachers and expand upon
them in application. Buffett is no exception, nor are the many other
Graham disciples who take the core lessons and extend them in a
variety of successful ways.†
Yet the differences are subtle to say the least. Buffett keeps inviolate
Graham’s core ideas that call for a business analysis mindset,
attention to the differences between price and value, and insisting
on a margin of safety when making any investment. Only
minor differences in application come up, including and pretty much
limited to the following: Buffett places somewhat more significance
on the role of managers in investing, is less beholden to bargain
purchases of the type Graham favored, is a bit less committed to
diversification of stockinvestment, and pays more attention to intangible
asset values than did Graham. But these differences are not
only overshadowed by what is common, they also reflect a broader
unifying principle: the importance of independent judgment in investing.
Other Graham disciples choose different ways of applying the
main ideas—some diversifying enormously, others concentrating
enormously, and some paying far more or less attention to the underlying
nature of businesses. With temerity and great humility, this
bookoffers an account of Graham’s ideas and Buffett’s extension
and application of them that reflect the example and tradition. It is
† Warren Buffett, The Superinvestors of Graham and Doddsville, Hermes (Columbia
Business School), Fall 1984.
xviii Introduction: The Q Culture
a broadened and extended narrative related specifically to the contemporary
investing environment that Graham obviously can no
longer address and that Buffett can do only in the relatively structured
frameworkof annual shareholder letters.
At all times, the business analysis mind-set is anchored in the
price-value distinction and the margin-of-safety principle, the deep
moorings of the V culture, the deans of which will always be Graham
and Buffett, though I am delighted to be on the faculty.
p a r t I
A TALE
OF TWO
MARKETS
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
This page intentionally left blank.
3
C h a p t e r 1
MR. MARKET’S
BIPOLAR DISORDER
The patient exhibits classic manic depression—or bipolar disorder—
combining episodes of euphoria with irritation. He goes on
wild spending sprees for months on end, using money he does not
have to buy things he does not need. In the buoyant periods he is
talkative and full of ideas, but only in distracted, zigzaggy ways. He
can charm you into buying the Brooklyn Bridge. Then, suddenly and
swiftly, he shifts moods, falling into a months-long spell of darkdepression,
often provoked by the tiniest annoyances, such as minor
bad news and modestly disappointing results.
Experts observe that the condition might be inherited, caused by
innate chemistry affecting mood, appetite, and the perception of
pain, which in turn could lead to dramatic weight gains followed by
abrupt weight losses. There are safety nets to fall backon, such as
government support, and government-approved treatments, such as
mood stabilizers. But the patient lives in denial and can become
angry and suspicious, sometimes not taking the medicine and precipitating
more intense bouts of ups and downs.
The patient I am describing, of course, is the stockmark et. It
mixes episodes of irrational fear with episodes of irrational greed. It
rises with massive infusions of funds—often borrowed—then falls
after the withdrawal of those funds. It bounces around like a circus
clown on a pogo stick, weaving wild tales of untold riches to be made
without effort. Then it pouts, plummets, and corrects, often on news
that this or that company failed to meet earnings estimates by mere
pennies per share.
Clear thinkers about market behavior rightly believe that this
condition is incurable, with the market being prone to fat gains followed
by fat losses without a nexus to business or economic reality.
Nevertheless, government engines such as the Securities and
Exchange Commission and private ones such as the New YorkStock
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
4 A Tale of Two Markets
Exchange monitor the extremes, imposing “circuit breakers” that
shut the market down when it threatens to slip into a bout of depression
(a sell-off) or raising the requirements for margin accounts,
particularly those of day traders.
Yet no cure is in sight. Mr. Market, in Ben Graham’s terms,
denies its manic depression.1 It does this in numerous studies extolling
how “rational” it is. It does it in countless conversations and
publications referring to its “efficiency.” Reams of “beta books” are
compiled in the belief that its gyrations simply and accurately reflect
precisely the measurable riskthat stocks pose for investors. Abstract
advice to diversify portfolios is sold as the only way to minimize the
rational riskthat this efficient system manageably presents. Denial
prevents cure.
Take Ben Graham’s Mr. Market a diagnostic step deeper. Malicious
microorganisms called rickettsia (named for Dr. Howard T.
Ricketts, 1871–1910) cause diseases such as typhus. From the Greek
word for “stupor,” signifying a state of insensibility and mental confusion,
typhus is characterized by bouts of depression and delirium.
It is transmitted by bloodsucking parasites called ticks. These parasites
transmit a similar disease called Q fever.
To avoid Q fever, those venturing into tick-infested forests prepare
themselves. Hats, gloves, long sleeves, and pants are the dress
code. If bitten, prudent forest denizens remove the parasite with
tweezers, wash the bite, and apply rubbing alcohol, ice, and calamine
lotion. They survive to enjoy the woods.
Fools in the tick-ridden forest go bare, leaving exposed their skin
and, most daringly, their heads. After they find a tick, fear drives
them to irrational action, such as burning the tickinstead of tweezing
it out. The kings and queens of fooldom then venture gleefully
on their forest expedition, giddily unaware that they are infected with
Q fever—until depression and delirium set in.
In the stock market forest, the ticks of price quotes infect the
unprepared fools in the same way and with similar results. Trader
obsession with price quotations spreads the Q fever epidemic, adding
gas to the fire of Mr. Market’s manic depression.
When venturing into the stockmark et, defend yourself just as
you would when hiking in the forest: armed to fight the wealthsucking
parasite of the Q fever price tick. Ben Graham and Warren
Buffett prescribe the same course for dealing with Mr. Market. They
advise that just as it is foolish not to recognize his symptoms or
diagnose his disease, it is equally foolish to play into them or exMr.
Market’s Bipolar Disorder 5
pose oneself to the contagion. Instead, use Mr. Market to your advantage.
Neither Graham’s Mr. Market nor this Q fever metaphor implies
anything about the psychology of market participants. Rational people
acting independently can produce irrational market results.
Many investors simply defer to experts or majority opinion. Following
the herd may seem rational and intelligent—until it stampedes
straight off the cliff.
SWINGS, BUBBLES, AND CRASHES
Price ticks drive the wild volatility that plagues contemporary stock
markets. Momentum traders and sector rotators are both victims and
transmitters of Q fever. The disease reaches epidemic proportions
when the crowd follows the “indelibly indicated trend,” in the sarcastic
words of Fred Schwed from his classic work Where Are the
Customers’ Yachts? referring to the illusion that patterns predictably
persist.2
Average stockprices swing by 50% every year, while underlying
business value is far more stable. Share turnover is enormous. The
number of shares traded compared to the total shares outstanding
spiked from 42% to 78% on the New YorkStockExchange between
1982 and 1999 and from 88% to 221% on the Nasdaq between 1990
and 1999.3 Prices on particular stocks rise sharply and fall furiously
within days and weeks without any link to underlying business values.
Speculation rages, and the speed of price fluctuation has multiplied
dramatically compared to previous decades. Market volatility
has increased roughly in proportion to the dramatic increase in information—
both real and imagined—that is readily available. Getting
in before the rise and out before the fall has become the day
trader’s mantra, one that reveals not only the presence of Mr.Market
but the existence of his coconspirators by the thousands.
Roller coaster rides in stocklevels have been known throughout
the history of organized market exchanges, but these rides took major
indexes either up or down together. A quite different trail was
blazed in the late 1990s and early 2000s as the Dow Jones average
of leading industrial companies went one way and the Nasdaq average
of more technology-oriented or younger companies went another.
6 A Tale of Two Markets
Table 1-1. Dow Busts
Date Close
Point
Change
Percent
Change
October 27, 1997 7,161.15 554.26 7.18
August 4, 1998 8,487.31 299.43 3.41
August 27, 1998 8,165.99 357.36 4.19
August 31, 1998 7,539.07 512.61 6.37
January 4, 2000 10,997.93 359.58 3.17
March 7, 2000 9,796.03 374.47 3.68
Frothy new economy devotees bid up the new stocks and tech
stocks to wild heights compared to their pathetic or negative earnings
while eschewing the stodgy old economy stocks that continued
to generate steady earnings increases. The new giddiness subsided,
and the Dow surged while the Nasdaq slumped. But then one recovered
while the other dropped. Topsy-turvy is the only description
for this wild world.
Anyone seeking to divine some deep logic in these flip-flopping
patterns, however, could stop looking on April 14, 2000, when the
indexes plunged together, the Dow by 6% and the Nasdaq by 10%.
Then both rebounded the next trading day, with the Dow climbing
backnearly 3% and the Nasdaq moving backup 6.6% (and the day
after that experiencing up pumps of nearly 2% and over 7%, respectively).
No deep logic explains these swoons or this pricing divergence,
and all you can really conclude is that Mr. Market was being his
(un)usual self. Staggering as these data are, consider too that in the
first quarter of 2000, the Nasdaq suffered four declines of 10% or
more and then in each case rebounded. In April 2000 alone it recorded
two jumps that were its largest in history and three drops
that were its largest in history. In the late 1990s and early 2000s,
Dow busts were equally commonplace, as other drops exceeding 3%
show (see Table 1–1).
The Dow busts of August 1998 were particularly potent: They
wiped out all the gains the Dow had made during that year. So was
the March 2000 bust: It set the Dow backto where it had been
about a year earlier.
If you prefer to focus on Mr. Market’s euphoria, take the bursts
Mr. Market’s Bipolar Disorder 7
Table 1-2. Dow Bursts
Date Close
Point
Change
Percent
Change
September 2, 1997 7,879.78 257.36 3.38
October 28, 1997 7,498.32 337.17 4.71
September 1, 1998 7,827.43 288.36 3.82
September 8, 1998 8,020.78 380.53 4.98
September 23, 1998 8,154.41 257.21 3.26
October 15, 1998 8,299.36 330.58 4.15
March 15, 2000 10,131.41 320.17 3.26
March 16, 2000 10,630.60 499.19 4.93
in the Dow exceeding 3% that occurred in the late 1990s and early
2000s (see Table 1–2).
Apart from their magnitude, consider the proximity of these Dow
busts and bursts. The charts show two back-to-back reversals: The
October 27, 1997, bust of 7.18% was followed the next day by a
4.71% burst, and the August 31, 1998, bust of 6.37% was followed
the next day by a 3.82% burst. The three busts of August 1998 were
promptly followed by three bursts of September 1998, much the way
the bust of March 7, 2000, was followed by the bursts on March 15
and 16 of that year. It is hard to believe that these successive bursts
and busts are based on changes in fundamental information investors
were rationally and efficiently acting on.
Beyond busts and bursts on the Dow and the Nasdaq in the late
1990s and early 2000s, recall one of the most dramatic single episodes
of Mr. Market’s presence on Wall Street: the 1987 crash. The
Dow vaporized by 22.6% on a single day and nearly 33% in the
course of one month. The 1987 crash was not limited to the 30
common stocks on the Dow but was worldwide. The New York Stock
Exchange, the London StockExchange, and the Tokyo Stock
Exchange all crashed.
If stockmark et prices really obeyed the ever-popular efficient
market theory (EMT) and accurately reflected information about
business values, some major changes in the body of available information
would be required to justify that crash. Many people tried to
explain it as a rational response to a number of changes in and
around mid-October 1987, including the following:
8 A Tale of Two Markets
• On September 4, 1987, the Federal Reserve Board raised the discount
rate.
• On October 13, 1987, the House Ways and Means Committee
voted to approve income tax legislation that would disallow interest
deductions on debt used to finance business acquisitions.
• On October 18, 1987, Treasury Secretary James Baker publicly announced
an intention to reduce the value of the dollar.
• Market prices were already high by historical standards.4
Some experts attributed the 1987 crash to various institutional
factors, including program trading and portfolio insurance that were
set to sell off big chunks of the portfolios of large investors as prices
fell. When prices fell, these program sales pushed them down even
harder. Other experts pointed to derivative securities, often exotic
instruments whose value fluctuates with changes in the value of
benchmarks such as interest and exchange rates. These derivatives
are usually intended to reduce riskand volatility in such benchmarks,
though if poorly designed can exacerbate the volatility in
stockmark et pricing.
But given the international nature of the crash and its depth,
hardly anyone accepts these explanations. Most people also agree
that it is impossible to explain rationally the radical price changes
that have occurred at other times—whether the 1929 crash, the 1989
break, or the general 1990s and 2000s volatility. Market frenzy simply
cannot be explained using EMT but is a product of a complex of
forces in addition to actual changes in information about fundamental
business values.
Market frenzies like these are not isolated and certainly not
unique episodes in financial history. On the contrary, market bubbles—
situations in which prices are way higher than values—happen
all too often. There was a technology stockbubble from 1959 to 1961;
a bubble in the so-called ‘Nifty Fifty’ stocks in the late 1960s and
early 1970s; a gambling stockbubble in 1978; a bubble in oil and
energy stocks in the late 1970s; a home shopping bubble in 1986 and
1987; and a biotechnology bubble in the early 1990s (with a resurgence
in the early 2000s), and all of these resemble the Internet or
dot-com bubble of the late 1990s and early 2000s.
The market capitalization (price times shares outstanding) of the
Internet sector was about $1 trillion at the beginning of 2000, with
sales of $30 billion and losses of $3 billion.5 In 1999, scores of initial
Mr. Market’s Bipolar Disorder 9
public offerings (IPOs) of Internet stocks were launched, many in
the same industry where it is going to be impossible to have more
than a handful of profitable companies. Deals included, for example,
17 health-care related companies, seven business-to-business
e-commerce companies, six music distribution companies, five employee
recruiters, and three travel agencies. It starts to sound like
the “Twelve Days of Christmas.”
Driving this funding is the fascination with technological innovation,
a fascination that characterized previous market bubbles as
well. The 1960s technology bubble arose from innovations such as
color television and commercial jet aviation. It spawned an IPO
boom in electronics and other businesses whose names ended with
“tron” or “onics” not unlike that of 1999’s dot-com boom.6 Takeovers
surged in both periods, fueled by high-priced stockthat built many
corporate empires. All the talkwas of a new history-defying era—
called a “new paradigm” in the 1960s and the “new economy” in the
late 1990s and early 2000s. But as Warren Buffett quotes Herb Stein
as saying, “If something can’t go on forever, it will end.”7
The Internet bubble may not end as abruptly as the 1960s electronics
bubble did. It may instead follow the path of the stockmark et
bubble in Japan in the 1980s, which ended in a gradual and total
erosion of stock prices in the Nikkei average throughout the decade
of the 1990s. One thing the two periods have in common—and one
of the most striking common features of speculative bubbles generally—
is the emergence of “new” ways to defend the high prices.
In 1980s Japan the fuel was stockprices based not on the earnings
or cash that can be generated by a business, but on underlying
asset values the businesses owned, which themselves had been rising
to the stratosphere as a result of aggressive real estate speculation.
We’ll soon see that the same alchemy plagues the turn of the twentyfirst-
century United States.
These examples merely manifest in U.S. stockmark ets the emotional
drives inherent in human market making, exemplified more
generally not only by the 1980s Japanese experience but by classic
episodes of bipolar disorder such as the Dutch tulip bulb mania of
the 1630s and the British South Sea exuberance just prior to 1720.
In each of those cases—as in most others—the initial reason to buy
may have been sound. Rare tulip bulbs in Holland were valuable
because the novelty of that flower in Holland turned it into a status
symbol. Shares of Britain’s South Sea Company were valuable when
it began to exercise its royal grant of monopoly trade with Spain.
10 A Tale of Two Markets
But the excitement of “getting in” on these deals got out of hand,
more and more money was allocated to futures contracts on tulip
bulbs and shares of the South Sea Company, and the more money
that was led there, the more money seemed to follow—until the
music stopped and panic set in. In Holland, the price got so high
that speculators could not afford to pay for the bulbs they had
bought the rights to. In Britain, the company simply did not generate
the great gains from Spanish trade everyone had obviously been expecting.
If EMT were true, the U.S. stockmark ets would be unique
among all markets throughout human history and across the contemporary
globe.8 Consider this selection from the writings of the
market observer Joseph de la Vega from the late 1600s about the
Amsterdam stockexchanges of his day, in the style of a tongue-incheekdialogue
between a merchant and an investor:
Merchant: These stock-exchange people are quite silly, full of instability,
insanity, pride and foolishness. They will sell
without knowing the motive; they will buy without
reason.
Investor: They are very clever in inventing reasons for a rise in the
price of the shares on occasions when there is a declining
tendency, or for a fall in the midst of a boom. It is particularly
worth remarking that in this gambling hell there
are two classes of speculators. The first class consists of
the bulls. The second faction consists of the bears. The
bulls are like the giraffe which is scared by nothing. They
love everything, they praise everything, they exaggerate
everything. They are not impressed by a fire or disturbed
by a debacle. The bears, on the contrary, are completely
ruled by fear, trepidation, and nervousness. Rabbits become
elephants, brawls in a tavern become rebellions,
faint shadows appear to them as signs of chaos. The fall
of prices need not have a limit, and there are also unlimited
possibilities for the rise. Therefore the excessively
high values need not alarm you.9
Sound familiar? Why, apart from hubris and chutzpah, should
we believe the U.S. stockmark ets are so special in the history of the
world?
Mr. Market’s Bipolar Disorder 11
BE AN ANOMALY
EMT also cannot explain many other things about how market prices
operate apart from swings, bubbles, and crashes. Abundant evidence
refuting EMT includes the extraordinary number of unexplained
market phenomena, such as the following:
• The January effect (prices tend to rise in January).
• The insider effect (a stock’s price tends to rise after insiders disclose
purchases to the Securities and Exchange Commission and
fall after insider sales are disclosed).
• The value line effect (stocks rated highly by the Value Line Investment
Survey tend to outperform the market in terms of price).
• The analyst effect (stocks of companies followed by fewer analysts
tend to become pricier compared to those followed by more analysts).
• The month effect (stockprices tend to rise at the end and the
beginning of months).
• The weekend effect (stock prices tend to be lower on Mondays
and higher on Fridays).
Weirder correlations also exist, including the hemline indicator
(prices historically have risen and fallen in tandem with rises and
falls in the average length of skirts in fashion) and the Super Bowl
effect (prices tend to rise in the period after the Super Bowl if the
winning team was a member of the original National Football
League but fall otherwise).
Efficiency buffs call these and dozens of other well-known
exhibits against market efficiency “anomalies.” Some anomalies disappear
over time. The January effect began to do so in the mid-
1980s. When they do, EMT worshipers rejoice, citing the disappearance
as evidence of market efficiency. This is strange evidence,
however, when you note that the vanished anomalies persisted for
decades (seven decades in the case of the January effect).
Even more bizarre, the anomaly label has been applied to the
astonishing investing records of many prominent stockpick ers, a list
that is long and getting longer. It includes Ben Graham; Warren
Buffett; Charlie Munger, vice chairman of Berkshire Hathaway; John
Maynard Keynes; Bernard Baruch; Gerald Loeb; John Neff of the
12 A Tale of Two Markets
Windsor Fund (Vanguard); Mario Gabelli; David Schafer; William
Ruane and Richard Cuniff of the Sequoia Fund; Tom Knapp of
Tweedy Browne; John Templeton; Mason Hawkins of Longleaf Partner
Funds; and untold others.
BARREL OF MONKEYS?
Can it be, as EMT devotees resort to saying, that these are anomalies
too—that these folks are all merely lucky? Is it plausible to believe
that they are just like the imaginary monkey who would produce the
entire script of Hamlet by randomly hitting the typewriter keys? Even
if you agree that this is possible, to complete the argument the imaginary
monkey would also have to be able to punch in the correct
keys to generate the full scripts of Romeo and Juliet, Macbeth, King
Lear, Henry IV, and pretty much the entire Shakespearean canon.
Even if this is theoretically possible, such a prolific monkey (or a
barrel of monkeys) seems incredible.
The monkey view acknowledges that luck plays a role in investing,
as it does in other aspects of life. The leading populist apostle
of this “lucky monkey” viewpoint is the Princeton professor Burton
Malkiel, who explains it in his book A Random Walk Down Wall
Street by using a coin-flipping contest.10
Start with a thousand people flipping a coin, with those flipping
heads being the winners and going to the next round. By the laws
of chance, on average 500 will flip heads and 500 will flip tails. The
500 flipping heads proceed to round two, where, again by the laws
of chance, half will flip heads and half will flip tails. The 250 lucky
heads flippers go to round three, where 125 of them win; 63 of those
win round four; 31 win round five; 16 win round six; and 8 win the
final round and are proclaimed “expert” coin flippers.
Yet resorting to luckas an explanation of investment success
leaves the explanation incomplete. First, investing is simply not like
coin flipping, though speculation and gambling may be. The great
investors do some homeworkand develop a set of investment precepts
to guide them in their selection of investments. They don’t
simply flip a coin in choosing which investments to make. They
certainly do not decide between, say, IBM and Clorox by pasting
their logos onto a coin, with the logo landing face up getting the
capital.
Second, the lucky monkey would have to have been banging on
Mr. Market’s Bipolar Disorder 13
his keys every day for decades, much as a day trader would have to
clickhis mouse every day for decades. But the great investors have
not followed the daily trading strategy. On the contrary.
Buffett, for example, generated most of the billions of wealth
Berkshire Hathaway has accumulated from about ten investments
over about forty years. Many of those billions came from buying big
stakes in large companies at times when their value was woefully
underappreciated by the market.
Berkshire bought its stake in the Washington Post Company, for
example, in mid-1973.11 Not only had the Post’s own stockprice been
battered by the Nixon White House’s excoriation of its investigative
reporting on Watergate, that was one of the few times in postwar
American history that the U.S. stockmark et resembled its dismal
stance during the Depression. Buffett’s purchase price? About a fifth
of intrinsic value, an 80% margin of safety. Luckplays a major role
in a day trader’s portfolio; discipline plays an obvious role in Berkshire’s.
Luckis an inadequate though often partial explanation for any
human endeavor that entails effort. Those who succeed in their endeavors
catch butterflies not by luckalone but with the help of an
expertly cast net. Ben Graham drew a fine linkbetween luck and
work by saying that “one lucky break, or one supremely shrewd decision—
can we tell them apart?—may count for more than a lifetime
of journeyman efforts. But behind the luck, or the crucial decision,
there must usually exist a background of preparation and disciplined
capacity.”12
Whether they are characterized as value investors, growth investors,
fundamental investors, opportunistic investors, or anything
else, commonsense discipline is the unifying trait of all the superinvestors
who make up this barrel of monkeys. It is true that Keynes
and Loeb are associated with the “skittish” school of investing, an
opportunistic strategy that rapidly exploits market gyrations fueled
by alternating bouts of fear and greed. Their short-termism contrasts
with the long-term views of the “value” school associated with Graham
and Buffett, yet both schools recognize the price-value discrepancy
that these alternating bouts of Mr. Market’s bipolar disorder
create.
All these stellar investors—and many others, such as JackBogle,
Phil Carret, Phil Fisher, Peter Lynch, the Prices (Michael and T.
Rowe), and George Soros—succeed by exercising common sense.
The “systems” or “formulas” employed or the labels given to them
14 A Tale of Two Markets
are not important, but the quality of their analysis and the independence
of their thought and judgment are.
The best investors employ a mind-set that takes account of just
a few things, but those things are indispensable. Every extraordinary
investor follows Ben Graham’s first principle: The market does not
perfectly price the business value of a stock. Warren Buffett takes
that insight dead seriously by limiting his purchases to stocks that
are way underpriced by the market. Both of these investment titans
as well as Phil Carret emphasize the importance of avoiding bad
deals, stocks that are way overpriced in the market.
These investors and other greats, such as Buffett’s partner Charlie
Munger, always remember that there are tens of thousands of
investment options available to just about anyone. To opt for one
requires a strong belief that the market is giving the best deal available
compared to all the others. And opportunity does knock. One
way to test opportunity is to take Loeb’s approach: always ask
whether you would be comfortable committing a large portion of
your resources to a single stockyou are considering.
Buffett and other outstanding investors, including Peter Lynch,
know that an intelligent appraisal depends on your ability to understand
a business. This gives you a basis for gauging points all these
top investors consider crucial, such as a company’s competitive
strength, brand power, and ability to develop new products profitably.
The investment giants (not monkeys) don’t worry much about
whether their investments end up concentrated in certain companies.
For example John Neff, the portfolio manager of the Windsor
Fund from 1964 through 1995, generated returns exceeding the average
by a steady 3% annually and did so while sometimes allocating
as much as 40% of the fund into a single business sector. Buffett’s
Berkshire Hathaway is a wonderfully diverse collection of outstanding
businesses, but that diversity was an accidental by-product of the
tremendous growth in the capital it deployed rather than a conscious
effort to participate in lots of different businesses or sectors.
This cast of illustrious investors extends the commonsense understanding
of markets and businesses to the analysis of business
fundamentals. Chief among these factors are economic characteristics
such as strong financial condition, earnings stability and
growth, strong sales and profit margins, and large amounts of internally
generated cash to fund growth as opposed to a continuing
reliance on external financing sources. These investors also pay
attention to the quality and integrity of management, looking for
Mr. Market’s Bipolar Disorder 15
companies which consistently maximize the full potential of a business,
wisely allocate capital, and channel the rewards of this success
to shareholders. They emphasize the importance of exceptionally
competent managers who own substantial amounts of equity in their
own companies and can rapidly adapt to dynamic business conditions.
They also believe that managerial depth and integrity include
assuring good relations with labor and promoting an entrepreneurial
spirit.
The hedge fund master George Soros summed it up well by saying
that “the prevailing wisdom is that markets are always right; I
assume they are always wrong.” The prevailing wisdom of market
efficiency is one way to view markets. In this view, price changes are
due almost exclusively to changes in fundamental values. Therefore,
a diversified selection of stocks with different pricing behaviors compared
to the overall market makes the most sense. The contrary view
says that lots of price changes occur for nonfundamental reasons.
The goal here is to identify those companies whose prices are below
their business value. This perspective calls for thinking about individual
businesses rather than the overall market.
The next two chapters offer the alternative foundations of these
two competing ways to thinkabout markets. Chapter 2 is a history
of how the efficient market idea came into being. Chapter 3 is an
account of evidence that contradicts EMT on its own terms. If you
are already a skeptic of market efficiency, you can skip these two
chapters as a practical matter (though they contain valuable insights
on the merits of the competing views). If you are an efficiency devotee,
you should read them and be prepared to change your mind.
Either way, Chapter 4 assesses the current environment for clues
concerning whether the direction in which we are heading is better
described by the efficient market idea or by what might be called
the “chaotic” market idea. It finds that we are heading toward less
rather than more efficient markets. The rest of the book adopts the
view of the investment masters that stockmark ets are not perfectly
efficient and provides the equipment you need to take advantage of
the inefficiencies.
This page intentionally left blank.
17
C h a p t e r 2
PROZAC MARKET
Along and interesting story lies behind the ever-popular efficient
market theory, a story every investor should know. Knowing the
EMT story will enable you to evaluate advice based on it, including
advice about the value of diversification and ways of measuring risk.
It will also help you decide for yourself whether to believe EMT.
That is important because if you believe in market efficiency, you
will adopt a style and philosophy of investing very different from the
one you will be smart to adopt if you do not.
Investors who have already concluded that EMT is not the best
account of how stockmark ets workcould skip this chapter without
being cheated, but even they may discover ways in which EMT has
unwittingly affected their investing habits. All readers will also discover
that the history of EMT is fascinating. It is a story about research
designed to enlarge knowledge, to explain and understand the
world, research whose results are intermittently neglected and then
overblown. The story tells us that EMT is not the last word on how
stock markets work, even though the power it has had over investors
and teachers for several decades sometimes makes it seem that people
thinkit is the last word.1
OBSCURITY
EMT traces its history to the random walkmodel of stockprices,
the sensible idea that stockprices move in a way that cannot be
predicted with any systematic accuracy. The model dates backto
1900, when it was elaborated in a doctoral dissertation by the French
mathematician Louis Bachelier that though obscure in its time is
now famous. That dissertation investigated linear correlation in the
prices of options and futures traded on the French Bourse and concluded
that such price changes behaved according to a random walk
model.2
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
18 A Tale of Two Markets
Bachelier’s workwas not widely noticed when it was published,
perhaps because the mathematical parts of it preceded by five years
Einstein’s famous workon the random motion of colliding gas molecules.
Einstein “discovered” the equation that describes the phenomenon
of random molecular motion, known as Brownian motion
(after the Scottish botanist Robert Brown, who first observed it),
which was precisely the equation Bachelier developed to describe
price behavior in financial markets.
Although the mathematical properties Bachelier employed were
of direct and immediate interest to physicists and mathematicians
(including Einstein and his intellectual progeny), economists paid
little attention to the subject until the middle of the century. Indeed,
virtually no studies before the early 1950s made any reference to
Bachelier’s workor to the theory of random processes in financial
markets.
Maurice Kendall is frequently credited with bringing the random
walkmodel to the attention of economists in the early 1950s. Bachelier’s
workitself, however, was not “discovered” by economists until
they stumbled across it in the mid-1950s.
While rummaging through a library, Leonard Savage of the University
of Chicago happened upon a small bookby Bachelier published
in 1914. He sent postcards to his economist friends asking if
they had “ever heard of this guy.” Paul Samuelson could not find the
bookin MIT’s library but did locate and then read a copy of Bachelier’s
doctoral thesis. Just after Samuelson’s discovery in 1959, the
random walkmodel became a very popular area of research.
Bachelier’s long obscurity was also due to a widely reported 1937
study by the renowned economist Alfred Cowles concluding that
stockprices did move in a predictable way. This study shut down
research on the random walkmodel for decades until in 1960 the
Stanford professor Holbrook Working discovered a mistake in it.
Cowles then corrected the mistake, and his revised study supported
the random walkmodel.
SIMPLICITY
Once Samuelson and his colleagues rediscovered Bachelier, they also
had the great fortune of being able to harness his insights on a large
scale with the advent of the computer age and the widespread availability
at universities and research foundations of high-speed comProzac
Market 19
puters. Using those new technologies in the early 1960s, stockmar -
ket researchers went to work with a vengeance exploring random
processes in these markets.
Correlation Tests
One aspect of the investigation consisted of correlation tests that
were used to determine whether specified data sequences move together
to any degree. In the case of stockprices, price changes of a
given stockare recorded over a specified time period—say, a number
of days—and a subsequent period of the same length. These sequences
(called time-series data) are then compared to determine
whether they move together to any degree—whether they show any
“correlation.”
The comparison takes the form of a correlation coefficient, a
number that reflects the degree to which the data are linearly related.
In effect, the time series of data is tested for correlation by
fitting a straight line to the data and then calculating that number.
A correlation coefficient equal to zero provides evidence that the
data in the series have the property of statistical independence; correlation
coefficients that are close to zero (but not equal to zero)
indicate that the data are uncorrelated. A time series of data is random
if it is either independent or uncorrelated.
Consider televised lottery drawings in which winning lottery
numbers are determined by selecting numbered balls from a bin
containing numerous balls with different numbers painted on them.
The auditor retrieves a ball, records its number, and replaces that
ball. The auditor does this perhaps three times, each time retrieving,
recording, and replacing. This process has the property of statistical
independence because the number recorded after any retrieval indicates
nothing about the numbers recorded either previously or subsequently.
Outside of a controlled context such as a lottery bin, particularly
in the context of time-series data such as stockprices, it is extremely
difficult to prove statistically that a series of data has the property
of statistical independence. The less restrictive property—that data
are uncorrelated—is susceptible to statistical proof and allows for
conclusions substantially similar to those which follow from the independence
property.
The correlation tests of the 1960s all resulted in correlation coefficients
that did not differ significantly from zero. This meant that
20 A Tale of Two Markets
various series of actual stockmark et data were indistinguishable
from various series of numbers generated by a random number table,
roulette wheel, lottery drawing, or another device of chance.
These findings had an important practical implication: Traders
could not systematically make above-normal gains from trading because
a statistical lackof correlation implies that the best estimate
of the future price of a stockis its present price. In other words, if
prices follow a random walk, the price change from one time to the
next will not affect the probability that a particular price change will
follow that one. Past prices cannot predict future prices.
Runs
A long known weakness of correlation tests is that the results can
be skewed by a small number of extraordinary data in the time series.
An alternative test that avoids this weakness is an analysis of runs
in the data—an investigation of whether there is any persistence to
the direction of successive changes.
A run is defined by an absence of directional change in a statistic
in the series. Thus, a new run begins any time the direction changes
(i.e., from negative to positive, from positive to negative, or from
unchanged to either negative or positive).
Instead of testing the correlation of numerical changes in the
data in the series, one investigates the relationship of the direction
of those changes. If price changes follow the random walkmodel,
the number of sequences and reversals in time-series data of stock
prices will be roughly equal. If the same direction persists for a significantly
longer period, the random walkmodel will be contradicted.
Among the numerous run studies conducted in the early 1960s,
the University of Chicago economist Eugene Fama’s is regarded as
the most careful.3 Fama found that the direction of price changes
tended to persist but nevertheless concluded that no trading rule or
strategy could be derived that outperformed the market consistently.
Accordingly, almost everyone involved in the debate in the late 1960s
agreed that the observed departures from randomness were negligible
and believed that this constituted strong support for the random
walkmodel.
Trading Rules
Despite the widespread agreement, some participants in the debate
remained skeptical. Indeed, prescient commentators of that era ocProzac
Market 21
casionally expressed the fear that the interrelationships of stockprice
changes are so complex that standard tools like these cannot reveal
them. That fear led to efforts to dispute the model by designing
trading rules that could achieve above-normal returns by uncovering
and exploiting these greater complexities.
Among the most primitive though most illustrative trading rules
was Sidney Alexander’s “filter technique.” This is a strategy designed
to discern and exploit assumed trends in stockprices that, in Alexander’s
piquant phrase, may be “masked by the jiggling of the market.”
4
For instance, a “5% filter rule” for a stockwould say to buy it
when the price goes up 5% (and watch it rise to a higher peak); then
sell it when the price goes down 5% from that peak(and watch it
fall to a lower trough); then short the stock(i.e., borrow it and sell
it at the prevailing price, promising to repay with the same stock, to
be purchased for the price prevailing at the time of repayment); then,
when the price rises 5% from that trough, cover the short position.
If this works, you get a gain on the initial sale plus a gain on the
short position. More important, if it works, prices are following a
peak-trough pattern. That means they are not random and the random
walkmodel is contradicted.
Alexander’s initial results indicated that such a technique could
produce above-normal returns. Subsequent refinements of Alexander’s
workby himself and others, including Fama, however, demonstrated
that relaxing or changing certain assumptions eliminated
the abnormal returns, particularly the original filter technique’s failure
to note that dividends are a cost rather than a benefit when
stocks are sold short.
Alexander’s filter technique epitomizes the chartist or technical
approach to stockanalysis and trading, under which a study of past
prices (or other data) is used as a basis for predicting future prices.
Indeed, Alexander’s filter technique is a conceptual cousin of limit
orders and similar techniques prevalent in securities trading today.
These techniques include conventional technical methods that rely
on anomaly effects (the insider, month, weekend, and analyst effects)
as well as the more unconventional methods (the hemline
indicator, the Super Bowl indicator, and so on).
These and related philosophies such as “momentum investing”
and “sector rotation” remain staples of Wall Street futurology. They
are widely and increasingly used by traders and recommended by
investment advisers and brokers. They are nonsense, as many stu22
A Tale of Two Markets
dents of the random walkmodel (and EMT) recognize based on the
foregoing analysis.
They are nonsense not because of EMT but because they fly in
the face of business analysis. As Ben Graham said of proponents of
such technical methods in The Intelligent Investor: “We shall dismiss
these with the observation that their workdoes not concern ‘investors’
as the term is used in this book.”5
On their own terms, the trouble with all these tests of the random
walkis that they are linear. They do not investigate the presence
of nonlinear price dependence, something that in the early 1960s
researchers simply lacked the computer horsepower to do.
The trading rule test, for example, is linear in that it operates in
chronological time (or real time). Neither it nor the other old tests
consider the possibility that market time may be better understood
from a perspective that is nonlinear. We will get to that subject in
the next chapter, but for now note that Einstein demonstrated that
time is not absolute but works in dozens of different ways depending
on the context, including forward (or linear), backward, circular,
slow, and erratic (nonlinear), and can even stand still.
THE PERFECT DREAM
Many people suggest that EMT developed in a peculiar manner in
scientific research. The proof of the hypothesis came first, beginning
with Bachelier in 1900 and proceeding through the wealth of studies
reporting randomness in the early 1960s.
Only then was a theory proposed to explain the randomness,
beginning with the first explication of EMT in 1965 by Paul Samuelson,
a recipient of the Nobel Prize in economics in 1970.6 Economists
welcomed this proof. The conditions necessary to produce it
seemed tantalizingly close to those necessary to sustain every economist’s
dream: a perfect market.
The perfect market is a heuristic invented by making the following
assumptions concerning a market: There are a large number of
participants such that the actions of any individual participant cannot
materially affect the market; participants are fully informed, have
equal access to the market, and act rationally; the commodity is
homogeneous; and there are no transaction costs.
A perfect market would give you exactly what the random walk
Prozac Market 23
model was implying: Prices of shares in stockmark ets should adjust
instantaneously and accurately to new information concerning them.
That prediction was embodied in EMT as it was first propounded.
In its broadest terms, EMT said that the prices of shares traded in
stockmark ets fully reflect all information concerning those shares.
Stockmark ets may or may not have the characteristics assumed
by the perfect market model. As the 1976 Nobel laureate Milton
Friedman reminds us, however, the cardinal rule of economic forecasting
is that a model’s predictive power is the only relevant test of
its validity, not the assumptions underlying it.7 Thus, the fact that
investors are not rational or fully informed, for example, does not
matter as long as these realities do not interfere with the predictive
power of EMT. While many economists are reconsidering assumptions
like these, for now this approach holds sway over accepted
economic theory.
Three Forms of Efficiency
In its general form, EMT explains more than the random walk
model. That model says simply that successive price changes are
independent or uncorrelated, whereas EMT explains that by saying
that stockprices fully reflect all the information (not just price histories)
about a stock. As a result, virtually since the emergence of
EMT as an explanation of the random walkmodel, EMT has been
divided into three forms defined in terms of specified categories of
information.
The three forms were first proposed to classify empirical tests of
price behavior given specified kinds of information. The weak form
tested the random walkmodel itself, using correlation and run tests
like those just described to investigate whether past prices indicate
anything about future prices. Semistrong-form testing investigated
whether publicly available information other than prices was reflected
in prevailing prices, and strong-form testing investigated
whether private information was reflected in prevailing prices.
As the wealth of tests and discussion proceeded in the 1970s,
the three forms of EMT came to be used to refer to the conclusions
those tests suggested. Thus, the forms of EMT have since then been
specified as follows: The weakform says that stock prices fully reflect
all information consisting of past prices, the semistrong form says
that stockprices fully reflect all information that is currently publicly
24 A Tale of Two Markets
available; and the strong form (hold your breath) says that stock
prices fully reflect all existing information, whether publicly available
or not.
There is thus a direct and logical linkbetween the random walk
model and weak-form efficiency but a more attenuated and contingent
linkbetween the random walkmodel and stronger forms of
EMT. Recall that the random walkmodel holds that price changes
are independent of or uncorrelated with prior price changes. That
means that technical analysis of past price changes—sometimes
called chartist analysis—cannot aid the prediction of future price
changes in any systematic way.
Weak-form efficiency explains this independence and its implications
for prediction by hypothesizing that the current price impounds
all information contained in prior prices. Thus, any price
change can only be the result of new information, the production of
which is itself assumed to be random. This process of information
absorption continues and thus explains the absence of substantial
linear dependence in successive price changes discovered in the correlation
and run tests of the 1960s. It also leads to the stronger forms
of the hypothesis.
The semistrong form of EMT posits not only that current stock
prices reflect all information consisting of prior stockprices but also
that they reflect all publicly available information about the stockin
question. Testing this more ambitious claim requires a focus not on
correlation analysis of price changes but on the relative swiftness
with which prices change given new information.
Despite this different testing methodology, semistrong efficiency
depends on the validity of the random walkmodel, which depends
in turn on empirical conclusions concerning the absence of statistical
dependence in stockprice data. In other words, if future price
changes depend on prior price changes, any price change the semistrong
form tests cannot be attributable solely to the new information
the test is evaluating. Thus, both weakefficiency and semistrong
efficiency depend on the proof provided by linear testing
models.
The strong form of EMT extends much farther than the random
walkmodel suggested. Indeed, the strong form is a theological proposition,
holding that public capital markets are infinitely wise: even
nonpublic information is reflected in public stockprices. Abundant
evidence has decimated the strong form by showing that people who
possess nonpublic information can use it to make abnormally high
Prozac Market 25
market returns, with the apotheosis being the insider trading scandals
of the 1980s.
Since the strong form of EMT has been discredited, debate concerning
EMT centers on the semistrong and weakforms. Debate
over the weakform generally is defined by analysis of the random
walkmodel itself, usually in terms of the linear empirical models
used to test the relationship between successive price changes; this
has cut into the random walkmodel.
A widely noted study by MIT’s Andrew Lo and Wharton’s A.
Craig MacKinlay demonstrated strong positive serial correlation in
stockprices for weekly and monthly holding period returns. Using
1,216 weekly stock return observations from 1962 to 1985, they found
a weekly correlation coefficient of 30%, an extremely high level of
correlation. These researchers point out in their book, A Non-
Random Walk Down Wall Street, that this does not mean necessarily
that the stockmark et is inefficient but that the random walk model
cannot be the basis for any theory of efficiency.8
Though not conclusive, evidence like this led even Eugene
Fama—a chief architect of EMT—to conclude that daily and weekly
stockreturns are predictable from past returns, thus rejecting the
random walkmodel on a statistical basis.9 Even so, Fama and the
other fathers of EMT cling to the view that such discrepancies are
merely anomalies that do not impair the basic model’s validity,
though others try to explain these results in a different way called
noise.
Noise
Consider John Maynard Keynes’s well-known beauty contest metaphor
for the stock market. In the contest, each judge picks the candidate
he or she thinks others will pick rather than the candidate he
or she thinks should win on merit. This replaces a fundamental or
substantive sort of analysis (of the kind urged in this book) with a
popular, speculative, and herd-packmentality .
The 1981 Nobel laureate James Tobin of Yale tookKeynes’s
beauty contest a step farther. He suggested that even if a public
capital market is efficient in the sense of swiftly incorporating public
information into stockprices (i.e., the semistrong form of EMT),
that does not necessarily mean that stockprices in that market reflect
fundamental values (i.e., the present value of expected future
flows to stockholders).10
26 A Tale of Two Markets
The quality of information digested by the market may be just
as low as the quality of information that goes into the decisions of
Keynes’s beauty contest judges. Tobin has many followers who think
he’s right, including Nobel Prize winnersWilliam F. Sharpe and Kenneth
Arrow of Stanford.11 If it is true that many traders act as Keynes
described, the semistrong form of EMT has to be further subdivided
between strict informational efficiency and a more refined notion of
fundamental efficiency.
Informational efficiency describes a market in which all public
information about a stockis reflected in the price of that stock without
regard to the quality of that information. Thus, information that
concerns the fundamental value of a stockis reflected, but so is
information wholly unrelated to that fundamental value, such as who
won the Super Bowl. Fundamental efficiency is the more narrow but
more ambitious idea that stockprices are accurate indicators of intrinsic
value because they reflect only information concerning fundamental
business values.12
The issue becomes whether the capital markets can distinguish
among kinds of information so that only information about fundamental
value is impounded and reflected in prices. That revives the
basic question of whether humans behave rationally. EMT says it
does not matter if individual actions are not rational because any
individual irrationality will be corrected by others acting rationally.
In effect, irrationally is “assumed out” of the EMT model.
The informational-fundamental distinction, however, is so intuitively
and empirically potent that it had to be confronted. The result
was the face-saving shelter of euphemism: The economist Fischer
Black, borrowing a term from the field of statistics, renamed irrational
behavior noise, thus enabling self-respecting economists to
discuss the issue and try to model it.13
Noise theory is supported by substantial empirical evidence and
a well-developed intellectual foundation. Noise theory models hold
that stockmark ets are infected by a substantial volume of trading
based on information unrelated to fundamental asset values (noise
trading). These models attempt to explain both why noise trading
occurs and why its effects persist.
The most common noise theory model says, for example, that
noise trading is conducted by ill-informed investors who act on sentiment
rather than rational analysis. Their actions move prices away
from fundamental values. The price-value gap persists despite the
presence of sophisticated arbitrageurs because they are risk-averse
Prozac Market 27
and cannot be sure that investor sentiment will not change adversely
at any time.14
Evidence of the noisy investor approach to the stockmark et includes
following tips or acting on rumors, rapidly turning over one’s
portfolio, selling good performers while retaining bad ones (thus triggering
taxable gains rather than generating tax-deductible losses),
paying huge mutual fund fees for poor managerial performance, and
imitating others in running off market cliffs by using silly technical
trading strategies.
The causes of this behavior remain poorly understood, but psychological
research suggests a number of tendencies. These tendencies
include attitudes toward riskthat lead people to be more averse
to loss than eager for gain; this explains the irrational tendency to
hold losing stocks while selling winning stocks. Another is skewing
the probabilities of uncertain future events by basing forecasts on
past patterns, such as by forecasting that earnings growth over the
next ten years will equal that of the last three.
In theory, smart money arbitrageurs could correct all these errors
and profit from them, keeping EMT intact. But this is a risky business.
If there is mispricing today, there may be mispricing tomorrow.
If stocks are highly priced compared to value, an arbitrageur will sell
short and await the correction. But the correction may not arrive
before she has to cover. If stocks are lowly priced compared to value,
an arb will buy and await the rise. But that correction could take a
long time, during which those funds could be deployed at higher
returns elsewhere.
Another possibility is that individual actions that are rational can
produce aggregate results that are irrational. This happens all the
time in business. After air-conditioning was invented, for example,
retail stores spent substantial sums to install it, but once every store
did this, none of them enjoyed any competitive advantage as a result.
It is why you see a gas station at every corner of a suburban intersection.
Buffett gives the example of what occurs when each person
watching a parade decides he or she can see a little better by standing
on tiptoe.
Despite these profound insights developed at the frontiers of
thought about how markets work, they continue to be treated by
many leading economists as variations on the theme. Maybe there
is some deviation in EMT, its devotees admit, but the deviations are
due to mere chance. Eugene Fama, for example, continues to argue
that apparent overreaction to information is just as common as ap28
A Tale of Two Markets
parent underreaction to information, and the likelihood of abnormal
returns continuing after an event are about as likely as those returns
reversing after that event.
Thus, a whole group of leading economists thinks that the latest
evidence against EMT does not add up to much. They cling to investment
tools that are based on EMT and used to complete the
theoretical picture with practical applications.
TIDYING UP THE TALE
EMT tells us that specified information sets are fully reflected in
the price of public securities. EMT, however, does not provide any
basis for determining what it means for any such information to be
fully reflected in stockprices. Doing this requires a theory of asset
pricing. It is composed of two popular ideas: modern portfolio theory,
which provides the foundation, and the capital asset pricing model,
which is the general paradigm.
Modern Portfolio Theory
While the random walkmodel and EMT were being developed in
the 1950s and 1960s, Harry Markowitz of the City University of New
Yorkand yet another Nobel Prize recipient (in 1990, along with
Sharpe) was developing modern portfolio theory (MPT).15 The basic
idea here is that combining a group of noncorrelated stocks in a
single portfolio results in a portfolio with less volatility than the average
volatility of those individual stocks.
MPT proposes that all investments are reducible to two elements—
riskand return—and assumes that investors are risk-averse
in the sense that they will sacrifice returns to avoid riskand demand
greater returns to assume risk. MPT says that such investors will
best address their riskaversion by investing in a portfolio of investments
in which they receive the greatest expected return for any
given level of risk.
The expected return on an investment is simply the weighted
average of all possible returns on it, and the riskof an investment
is the dispersion of possible returns on that investment around the
expected return. Under MPT, expected return on a portfolio of investments
is simply the weighted sum of the expected returns on the
individual investments; the risk, however, of a portfolio of investProzac
Market 29
ments is not necessarily the weighted sum of the risks (or dispersion
in the returns) of the individual investments.
The central insight of MPT is thus that since variations in returns
on individual investments may reduce the dispersion of returns
on a portfolio of investments, portfolio riskis primarily a function
of the degree of variance of individual investments compared to the
portfolio as a whole. This means that portfolio riskis minimized
through portfolio diversification.
MPT’s understanding of riskhas another important implication.
With respect to any stock, two elements of risk can be distinguished:
systematic riskand unsystematic risk. Systematic risk (also sometimes
called market risk or undiversifiable risk) arises from the tendency
of a stockto vary as the market in which it is traded varies.
Unsystematic risk (also sometimes called unique risk, residual risk,
specific risk, or diversifiable risk) arises from the peculiarities of the
particular stockbeing investigated.
Because under MPT’s diversification directive unsystematic risks
can be diversified away to zero, market returns on a stock in a competitive
market will not include any compensation for such risk.
Thus, market returns will be a function solely of the systematic risk,
or the extent to which a particular stockvaries as the market of
which it is a part varies. Measuring such riskand return is the main
goal of capital asset pricing models.
The Capital Asset Pricing Model
As MPT and EMT were maturing in the late 1960s, capital asset
pricing theory was in its infancy. The capital asset pricing model
(CAPM) that is most widely known today derives from MPT (and
was pretty much invented by Markowitz’s co-Nobelist, Sharpe).16
Like MPT, CAPM assumes that investors are risk-averse in the sense
just described. In addition, CAPM assumes that investors have rational
expectations concerning expected returns. Under this assumption,
CAPM says that the expected return on an investment is equal
to the risk-free rate of return plus compensation for the systematic
riskof the investment in the sense just described.
The systematic riskis measured by the degree of variability of
the individual investment versus the market as a whole. It relates
the riskpremium associated with a particular stock (its return less
the risk-free return) to that associated with the market as a whole.
That association for any stockis expressed by a number called
30 A Tale of Two Markets
the stock’s ß (beta). Under CAPM, stocks with higher ß’s are more
risky than are stocks with lower ß’s because they tend to swing more
widely than does the market—their returns exhibit greater dispersion
versus market returns.
Critique and Common Sense
On their own terms, there are several weaknesses in MPT and
CAPM. First, in evaluating EMT, the need for a pricing model creates
a joint hypothesis problem: No one can ever be sure in testing
a model whether its failure is due to market inefficiency or to an
inadequately specified asset pricing model.
Indeed, many of the anomalies in EMT mentioned earlier are
attributed to deficiencies in the asset pricing model rather than to
the presence of market inefficiency. These deficiencies are most often
associated with imprecision in defining riskor , equivalently, in
specifying ß.
The joint hypothesis problem has an important implication for
EMT skeptics. To disprove EMT requires proof that does not use an
asset pricing model. However, any linear or nonlinear dependence
in stockprice behavior is inconsistent with EMT itself. Thus, a discovery
of linear or nonlinear dependence in successive stockprices
(presented in the next chapter) means EMT is incomplete, period.
It does not admit the alternative explanation of a “misspecified” asset
pricing model.
In addition, CAPM says that expected returns from an investment
are linearly related to expected returns on the portfolio of
which that investment is a part. The linear relationship is given by
ß and is in turn dictated by CAPM’s rational-expectations assumption.
If human behavior is itself inconsistent with the rationalexpectations
assumption, there is no reason to believe in such a
linear relationship. This is another way of saying that the stockmar -
ket is nonlinear rather than linear. In that case, ß will not be an
accurate measure of risk.
Finally, the rational-expectations assumption used in the CAPM
requires that investors have homogeneous return expectations; this
in turn requires that investors evaluate and understand information
in identical ways. Heroic as that sounds, it would also require all
investors to evaluate investment opportunities over identical time
Prozac Market 31
horizons. The patent dubiousness of these requirements recently has
become an important aspect of the literature criticizing CAPM.
The literature demonstrates that demand for particular stocks is
sensitive to price changes, just like demand for most other goods.17
Investors have different appetites for particular stocks as their prices
change. Thus, markets do not depict the right price of a stock because
there is no such thing. Even rational people are not homogeneous
automatons; they interpret information differently, and their
judgment about the present value of a business’s future cash flows
will vary even if they are all rational.
As Francis Fukuyama has pointed out in another context, the
neoclassical economic model of rational self-interested behavior with
which EMT is ultimately linked is right only about 80% of the time.18
Its devotees forget Adam Smith, the father of their thought, who
emphasized that economic life is embedded in social life and that
economic actors make decisions that vary from pure economic calculus
as a result of social habits and contexts. That is why in Smith’s
day his field was called “political economy” rather than, as it is today,
simply “economics.”
If the rest of social science should be returned to economics, it
is even possible to add some physics from the hard sciences. Recall
that the random walkmodel got that name because public capital
markets seemed to obey the principles of Brownian motion, which
specify that molecules in motion behave randomly. Although molecules
lacksentience, prices are strictly creatures of the ultimate sentience,
human behavior.
Common sense thus suggests that the price-molecule parallel
should not hold. More powerfully, current thought in physics concerning
nonlinear dynamics and chaos theory extends well beyond
Brownian motion and suggests further reasons to doubt and reconsider
the validity of the analogy.
The next chapter shows how that analogy has been turned upside
down and inside out. Before going on, though, pause to consider
whether common sense supports ß as a measure of risk. What ß
really measures is the price volatility of a stock. If you insist on
associating the word “risk” with that measure, it at most means that
ß captures the riskof stockprice gyrations. For a market analyst,
that measurement may be of some interest.
But for a business analyst, price gyrations are useless analytic
tools, and so therefore is ß. What matters in business analysis might
be called “business volatility,” the gyrations in earnings or cash flows
32 A Tale of Two Markets
a business has experienced as grounds for gauging its future business
performance. The earnings and cash flows are what give a business
value and what are of interest; market prices do not, and ß is
therefore of no interest to a business analyst.
As the vogue of mathematical investing approaches raged in the
late 1960s, Ben Graham declared that treating volatility in price
changes as the meaning of riskis “more harmful than useful for
sound investment decisions because it places too much emphasis on
market fluctuations.”19 EMT sought to neutralize that objection by
saying that market fluctuations were simply rational price changes
reflecting information changes. Just so. Yet some things are not that
simple. Charlie Munger is fond of quoting Einstein on this point:
Everything should be made as simple as possible, but no more so.20
Graham continues to be right.
33
C h a p t e r 3
CHAOTIC MARKET
Today’s investor can learn something from the elite group of Nobel
Prize winners who brought us the “modern finance” summarized
in the last chapter, but way less than is commonly believed.
Although few informed students of EMT ever had great confidence
in the strong form, the more modest forms—plus modern portfolio
theory and beta (ß)—have held sway over academic and popular
investment thinking for nearly three decades.
Those hypotheses are based exclusively on simple linear analysis
and thought, however, and so their descriptive power and normative
implications are questionable. As in all fields of endeavor, knowledge
continues to advance. Technology has enabled better ways to model
market behavior than were available when EMT and the rest of modern
finance were growing up. The new technology shows quite different
results than did the old, results that confirm the commonsense
intuitions behind Ben Graham’s Mr. Market.1
NEW WAVE
The presence of noise in stockmark et trading shows the inadequacy
of the linear testing models that led to the random walkmodel and
EMT. Noise theory shows that the information-processing properties
of public capital markets are so bluntly powerful that fundamental
information about underlying business values is crowded out by extraneous
information or noise. There is a feedbacksystem in which
individuals overreact to information or withhold action in the face
of information.
Feedbackprocesses are the hallmarks of a nonlinear system.
They indicate a nonproportional relationship between a cause and
its effect (e.g., between news and price changes). This insight of
noise theory has not been recognized for its full power. The distinction
between linear and nonlinear is fundamental to an understand-
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
34 A Tale of Two Markets
ing of stockmark et behavior and how investors and managers should
think about markets and market prices.
Linearity means proportionality: A change in one variable produces
a proportionate change in another specified variable. What
makes the CAPM linear, for example, is its assertion that the expected
riskpremium of a stockvaries in direct proportion to ß.
EMT is linear in two ways. First, the statistical models underlying
the weakform are simple linear regression analyses; correlation
coefficients are statements about how variables are related on a
straight-line basis over time. In other words, the time series of data
is tested for correlation by fitting a straight line to the data and then
calculating the correlation coefficient.
Second, the semistrong form of EMT is linear because it defines
a proportional relationship between information changes and price
changes. In particular, the semistrong form says that information is
swiftly incorporated into prices without bias. In other words, there
is a proportional relationship between information changes about
business values and resulting price changes in the financial asset
(stocks) representing those businesses.
In contrast and a bit simplistically, nonlinearity means the absence
of proportionality: Changes in one variable will produce a
change in another variable, but exponentially rather than proportionally.
To take a prosaic example, the 1-gram straw that breaks the
1-ton camel’s backis nonlinear because the cause is utterly disproportionate
to the effect.
Volatile stockprices and roaring or crashing markets are often
attributable to an incremental bit of information piled on top of
cumulated bits of information. If one company announces that its
earnings aren’t going to be as strong as people had hoped, its stock
price may take a haircut, but the market overall may not blush. But
as the weeks go by and a few more companies in that sector say the
same thing, Wall Street gets rattled. The shares of all the stocks in
that sector can suddenly get punished, and the pounding can spread
across the market as a whole. At some point, the creepy Wall Street
saying that there is never only one cockroach starts to resonate.
The fact that the market may react slowly or may overreact to
bits of new information is of course what noise theory teaches and
explains. The distinction between nonlinear and linear systems goes
well beyond noise theory, however, because noise theory itself is constrained
by the efficiency paradigm. Nonlinear dynamics and chaos
theory breakfrom that context and imply a fundamentally different
Chaotic Market 35
understanding of public capital market phenomena with a broader
perspective on investor and market behavior.
There is no a priori reason to believe that public capital markets
are linear systems rather than nonlinear systems. Therefore, one of
the first questions that must be considered in understanding such
markets is whether they follow linear or nonlinear processes. More
sophisticated techniques than were available when the random walk
model was first developed are now used to investigate precisely that
question.
One reason such techniques were unavailable in the 1960s,
1970s, and even early 1980s was the need for powerful computer
systems that not only could process data more swiftly but also could
go beyond the simplified mathematical models of straight lines and
investigate the curvatures of multidimensional data streams. Armed
with such resources, researchers now start with the consensus view
that empirical research shows that a random walkdescribes stock
prices fairly well, subject to some anomalies. Then they dig deeper.
One tool for the digging actually dates to the early part of the
twentieth century. It was developed by the hydrologist H. E. Hurst
when he was working on the Nile River Dam project.2 Hurst had to
develop reservoir discharge policies to maintain reservoir water levels
in the light of rainfall patterns.
To understand how the reservoir system worked, Hurst would
record its water level each day at noon and calculate the range (essentially
differences between the high and low levels and the average
levels). If the range increased in proportion to the number of observations
recorded, one could conclude that the reservoir system
was a random one. Otherwise, it was nonrandom and exhibited some
pattern, knowing either of which could enable the hydrologist to set
the reservoir’s discharge policies.
Hurst developed a simple tool called the H exponent to determine
whether the range increased as would a random process or
whether it exhibited a more patterned behavior. Skipping the mathematical
details, if a system’s H equals .50, then the system behaves
according to a random walk. The probability that any particular move
will follow any other move is 50-50 and thus completely up to
chance.
If H is less than .50, the system is mean reverting. That means
that if the system has moved up for a number of observations, it is
more likely to move down over the next number of observations, and
vice versa. Conversely, if H is greater than .50, the system is correl36
A Tale of Two Markets
ative or persistent: if the system has moved up for a number of
observations, it is more likely to continue to move up over the next
number of observations, and vice versa. If H is .60, for example, the
probability that a positive move will follow a positive move is 60%.
H may change over time. For example, H may be in the .70s over
some period and then drop to near .50 and subsequently increase
again. The number of observations (or time periods) over which H
is sustained at other than .50 (before returning to near .50) is a
measure of the average cycle length of the system.
In the case where H exceeds .50 for a sustained period, the
length of that period is a measure of the system’s memory—the extent
to which past events influence present and future events. In
the context of investment analysis, it measures the period over which
an investor can use information to his or her advantage.
During the 1990s, some market analysts figured out that the H
exponent can also be applied to markets to determine whether they
are random too. One of them even published his results. Edgar Peters,
a money manager in Boston, applied it to the Standard and
Poor’s 500 Index (the S&P 500) for monthly data over a 38-year
period from January 1950 through July 1988.3
Peters found that H was .78 for average periods of approximately
four years, indicating a strong persistent element in the S&P 500
rather than a random process. Beyond average periods of four years,
however, H was not significantly different from .50 (it was .52/-.02).
So Peters concluded that the S&P 500 begins to lose memory of
events after four years. The S&P 500 thus is not random, and events
today continue to affect price changes for up to an average of four
years.
NEXTW AVE
This dashing of the economist’s dream of a perfect market has been
amplified by studies of the chaotic behavior of markets. Just as
Hurst’s H suggests that markets are not linear as EMT assumes,
EMT’s assumption of market rationality is put into scientific doubt
by principles first developed by physicists in the field of chaos theory.
Chaos theory was popularized by the publication of James
Gleick’s 1987 best-selling book Chaos, primarily an exposition of
chaos in natural science. The potential role of chaos theory in economics
and finance was made prominent by the Santa Fe Institute’s
Chaotic Market 37
publication of a volume in 1988. It has been carried into the realm
of “phynance”—the merger of physics and finance—most spectacularly
by Doyne Farmer and Norman Packard, whose phynance exploits
are chronicled by Thomas Bass in his 1999 book The Predictors.
As a result of these works, chaos theory became an important
and growing field in the study of the nonlinear dynamic behavior of
economic and financial systems.
Through chaos theory, physicists discovered that many phenomena
in the universe previously thought to be random (unpredictable,
exhibiting no pattern) are not random but exhibit a significant pattern.
To oversimplify, chaos theory holds that there is a pattern to
the seeming randomness of physical events occurring in the universe.
Thus, systems that appear to be stochastic (to involve only
random motion or behavior under conventional linear modeling)
may be deterministic, or exhibit more complex internal dependence
than simple linear modeling reveals.
Chaos theory has its roots in the nineteenth-century workof
Henri Poincare´ , a French mathematician and physicist who studied
the famous three-body problem.4 Newton, using his laws of motion
and gravitation, proved that it was possible to calculate accurately
the future positions and velocities of two mutually attractive material
bodies. Neither Newton nor anyone since, however, has been able
to do so for three or more bodies.
This three-body problem reveals itself repeatedly to scientists
sending space probes to Mars and other planets: They chart a course
directed to where the planet will be in its orbit when the probe
arrives (not where the planet is upon sending the probe), but midcourse
corrections are nevertheless necessary because Newtonian
physics can predict accurately only the interaction of two bodies, not
three. (This has led some probes to be lost in space.)
Poincare´ attributed the three-body problem to nonlinearities inherent
in multibody systems as the result of which “small differences
in the initial conditions produce very great ones in the final phenomena.
A small error in the former will produce an enormous error
in the latter.” This insight, now the unifying core of chaos theory, is
known as “sensitive dependence upon initial conditions.”
The classic example of sensitivity to initial conditions is the butterfly
effect in meteorology. Its pioneer in the early 1960s was the
MIT meteorologist Edward Lorenz, who said, “The dynamical equations
governing the weather are so sensitive to the initial data that
whether or not a butterfly flaps its wings in one part of the world
38 A Tale of Two Markets
may make the difference between a tornado occurring or not occurring
in another part of the world.”5
Picture an empty hockey rink. A person places a puck at midice
and then rolls it toward the far end of the rink. He measures the
angle of his hit, the angle of the puck’s impact, and the angle of its
rebound. He keeps measuring the puck’s angles of impact and rebound
as the puckbounces around the rink.
Assuming no friction, a rule of puckmotion in the rinkis that
it will emerge from impacting a side of the rinkat precisely its angle
of approach (a similar thing will be familiar to anyone who has
played billiards). That rule means we have defined a deterministic
system under which the future position of the puckat any time can
be forecast perfectly (assuming its actual or average speed is known).
But now assume that the initial position of the puckis varied by
a few degrees, even an infinitesimally small variation, not observed
by or known to the forecaster. The forecaster’s predictions of the
puck’s location after it hits the first one or two sides may be imprecise—
off by some small amount—but the imprecision will be negligible.
The amount of error will grow exponentially, however, with
each subsequent impact. In a short time the forecast will be wide of
the mark.
Disturbing the measure of the puck’s initial position causes its
movement to appear random and unpredictable, whereas knowing
that measure enables precise prediction. It is this sensitive dependence
on initial conditions that is the signal characteristic of chaotic
systems.6 To detect its presence, Lorenz and his followers developed
a couple of fascinating tools.
Pictures and Attractors
Time-series data are conventionally plotted using simple Cartesian
geometry. For example, to plot a time series of a stock’s price, price
is plotted on the vertical axis and chronological time is plotted on
the horizontal axis.
In physics, the usual Cartesian graphs can be turned into more
powerful pictures called phase portraits plotted in phase space, a
presentation that can depict the full range of possibilities for a system.
The pendulum is the paradigm for illustrating the differences
between Cartesian plots of time-series data and phase portraits of
the same data as well as for introducing the notion of the attractor.
Consider a regularly swinging pendulum driven by mechanical
Chaotic Market 39
FIGURE 3-1 Driven pendulum time series.
force. It will swing backand forth at a steady speed and not come
to rest (unless we withdraw its force). A Cartesian time-series plot
would show such a pendulum’s motion as a wavy up-and-down line
whose height remains the same as time passes, as shown in Figure
3-1.7
The driven pendulum’s portrait in phase space can be envisioned
as a rectangle. At any moment in phase space, the pendulum’s angle
would dictate the location of a point horizontally and the pendulum’s
speed would dictate the location of a point vertically. As such, the
pendulum’s portrait in phase space would form a loop, illustrating
the pendulum’s continual motion through the same sequence of positions
repeatedly, as shown in Figure 3-2. That continual repetition
is described as a limit cycle or a limit cycle attractor because the
pendulum (which can be called a system) is attracted to that one
and only (limit) cycle.
Now consider a pendulum undriven by permanent mechanical
force, having instead been started manually by lifting it to one end
of its orbit and letting it go. Without the permanent mechanical
force, the undriven pendulum will swing backand forth, gradually
reducing speed and coming closer and closer to rest. A Cartesian
time-series plot of this undriven pendulum would begin with the
same wavy up-and-down line depicting the driven pendulum just
40 A Tale of Two Markets
FIGURE 3-2 Driven pendulum phase space: ‘‘limit cycle attractor.’’
described, but this line’s height would fall gradually and continuously
as the pendulum’s speed declined, as shown in Figure 3-3.
This pendulum’s portrait in phase space also would begin as if
it might form a loop, but owing to its declining speed, the plot would
begin to spiral inward continuously as the pendulum slowed down.
Correspondingly, the plot would converge to the origin, as shown in
Figure 3-4. The origin in this case is described as a point attractor
because the pendulum (or system) is attracted to that one and only
point.
Another way to approach the pictures is to conceive of the phase
space as a sideways view of the Cartesian time-series plot. It is in
effect a collapsed side view of the gyrations of the simple time-series
graph.
Keep that picture in mind as you consider a third type of attractor,
which physicists call the strange attractor. The strange attractor
describes a system whose phase portrait will be neither a loop nor a
spiraling circle but instead will show some orbits that appear to be
random: They do not repeat and are not periodic. They are, however,
limited in range. In other words, the portrait will exist in a finite
space but will admit of an infinite number of solutions in that finite
space.
41
FIGURE 3-3 Undriven pendulum time series.
FIGURE 3-4 Undriven pendulum phase space: ‘‘point attractor.’’
42
FIGURE 3-5 Simulated weather system time series.
FIGURE 3-6 Simulated weather system phase space: ‘‘strange
attractor.’’
Chaotic Market 43
Take a look at Figures 3-5 and 3-6. Figure 3-5 depicts the time
series of a simulated weather system, suggesting behavior that is
completely random and resembles typical graphs of stockmark et
prices. Figure 3-6 depicts a phase portrait of the same system, revealing
a strange attractor. Again, lookat Figure 3-6 as a side shot
of the time-series plot in Figure 3-5, condensing that Cartesian figure
into a phase space portrait.
Limit cycle attractors and point cycle attractors do not exhibit
any sensitive dependence on initial conditions: A pendulum without
permanent mechanical force will always end up at the point of origin
(its point attractor) no matter where it started, and a pendulum with
permanent mechanical force will always orbit in its loop (its limit
cycle attractor) no matter where it started.
Systems containing strange attractors do exhibit sensitive dependence
on initial conditions: Where the system is at some future moment
will be determined by where the system started (or by where
it was at any time before).
Stretching
Phase portraits depict all possible states of a system by plotting a
variable’s value against the possible values of all other variables. The
dimension of the phase space is equal to the number of variables
that describe the system. Whether a system exhibits sensitive dependence
on initial conditions can be determined by numbers called
Lyapunov exponents (LEs), named for the Russian mathematician
Aleksandr Lyapunov, who discovered them.8
LEs measure the speed of a variable’s movements in phase space
versus another variable. Positive LEs measure stretching in phase
space—the speed of divergence of one variable with respect to another
variable. Negative LEs measure contracting in phase space—
the speed of system restoration after being perturbed. Thus, LEs for
point attractors and limit cycles never are positive because such systems
are always contracting.
In the case of a point attractor, the dimensions always converge
to a fixed point, the origin; in the case of a limit cycle attractor, all
the dimensions converge into one another except one, whose relative
position creates the loop by not changing (and whose LE is therefore
zero). For a strange attractor—involving a system that does exhibit
sensitive dependence on initial conditions—at least one LE must be
positive such that there is divergence in the nearby orbits.
44 A Tale of Two Markets
LEs were created for use in connection with information theory,
to specify the likelihood that information conveyed in binary computer
language would be understood properly. LEs measured the
increase in uncertainty of a communication as additional bits of information
were added to the system.
The notion of bits of information has been reconceptualized for
application to public capital markets as measures of our knowledge
of current conditions. For example, in a time series of stockprice
data (e.g., daily returns), a positive LE would indicate the amount
of information or predictive power lost each day.
An LE of .05 per day, for example, would mean that information
becomes useless after 20 days (i.e., 1/.05). Thus, the LE is a measure
of the reliability of information in making forecasts for specified periods.
Peters, the Boston money manager, also has calculated the LE
for the S&P 500 (1950–1989), using monthly data. His calculations
resulted in a stable LE equal to .0241 per month. An LE of .0241
per month means that information reliability decays at the rate of
.0241 bit of accuracy each month; thus, the average cycle length of
the system using this measure is approximately three and a half years
(1/.0241 approximately 42 months). Note that this result substantially
matches the result that Peters got in his H analysis.
Peters also calculated the LE of 90-day trading data for the S&P
500 (1928–1990) and found an LE of .09883 per period. That result
substantially matches both the monthly LE and the H analysis: The
average cycle length of the system was approximately four years
(1/.09883 approximately ten 90-trading-day periods). Based on
these calculations, the public capital markets do exhibit sensitive
dependence on initial conditions and chaotic behavior rather than
simple linear efficiency.
Fractals
Another way to test for chaos is to determine whether a system has
a fractal dimension. Systems with fractal dimensions do not follow
Euclidean laws. Euclidean geometry simplifies and organizes nature
dimensionally: There are points, which lackdimension; lines, which
have one dimension; planes, which have two dimensions; and solids,
which have three dimensions. These simplifying images are heuristics:
Natural objects do not conform to these images. Until fractal
Chaotic Market 45
geometry was developed, however, these integral dimensions were all
we had to go on.
Fractal geometry was developed initially by the mathematician
and scientist Benoit Mandelbrot, who won the 1993 Wolf Prize in
physics.9 He observed that natural objects are not as simple as the
descriptions offered by Euclidean geometry: “Clouds are not spheres
[and] mountains are not cones.” For example, how would we classify
a piece of paper crumpled up an infinite number of times in terms
of Euclidean geometry?
It is not three-dimensional because it is not a pure solid form (it
has creases and crevices). (In mathematical terms, it is not completely
differentiable across its entire surface.) It is also not twodimensional
because it has depth. In fact, its dimension is between
two and three. That property makes the crumpled paper a fractal:
Its dimension is a fraction (two point something).
With respect to time-series data, dimensionality depends on
whether the system from which the data are taken is random or
nonrandom. If a system is random, time-series data taken from it
will reflect that randomness and have as large a dimension as can
possibly be. In the case of data being presented on a sheet of paper,
the highest possible dimension is two (the dimension of the paper
itself). In any case, the data will fill a plane.
If a system is nonrandom, time series of data taken from it will
reflect that nonrandomness and show a fractal dimension: The data
will not fill the plane but will clump together. That clumping together
reflects the correlations influencing the data (i.e., causing it
to be nonrandom).
These properties distinguishing random from nonrandom time
series may be conceptualized in a different way. For example, our
conception of a crumpled piece of paper as a three-dimensional object
can be regarded as embedding a fractal in a dimension greater
than itself. That greater dimension is called the embedding dimension.
Fractals retain their fractal dimension when placed in an embedding
dimension; random distributions do not. Thus, unlike nonrandom
distributions, random distributions fill their space the way
gas fills a volume: The gas spreads out because there is nothing to
bind the molecules together. This is, of course, the defining characteristic
of Brownian motion as discussed earlier.
Peters calculated the fractal dimension of the S&P 500 as 2.33
and did the same for other global stockmark ets, all of which also
46 A Tale of Two Markets
turned out to be fractals. Japan’s was 3.05; Germany’s, 2.41; and the
United Kingdom’s, 2.94. That is strong proof indeed that stockmar -
kets are not best described by EMT.
COMPLEXITY
Thinkabout the 1987 crash (and other roller coaster market episodes)
in terms of Einstein’s point that time operates in different
ways in different contexts. An intuitive case that market crashes exhibit
chaotic behavior starts to emerge. The intuitive case begins by
taking a nonlinear perspective of market time, under which market
time expands (speeds up) when trading is heavy and compresses
(slows down) when trading is thin. The speed of market time—called
intrinsic time—evidences itself in pricing persistence and pricing
discontinuity.
Pricing persistence is described in chaos theory as the Joseph
effect, drawn from the familiar biblical story of Joseph interpreting
the pharaoh’s dream to mean seven years of feast followed by seven
years of famine. The presence of this phenomenon in public capital
markets is exhibited by bull markets and bear markets in that identifiable
trends emerge and endure for significant time periods.
Pricing discontinuity is described in chaos theory as the Noah
effect, taken from the biblical story of the Flood. Public capital markets
exhibit the Noah effect in price changes. For example, suppose
IBM opens at 50 and closes at 30. That does not necessarily mean
that during some point in the trading day an investor could have
traded IBM at 40 (or any other price between 50 and 30). Rather,
the price of a stockmoves discontinuously in the sense that at one
moment it may be trading at 45 and at the next it cannot be sold
for more than 35 (something that day traders see a lot of and that
is discussed further in the next chapter).
The alternating presence of price persistence (the Joseph effect)
and price discontinuity (the Noah effect) shows that chronological
time—a linear concept—is not the most precise temporal measure
of public capital market phenomena. When discontinuous pricing—
the Noah effect—dominates a market, wide swings occur and market
pricing is relatively unstable because intrinsic time and trading
activity outpace chronological time and information gathering.
When price persistence—the Joseph effect—dominates a market,
pricing is relatively stable because intrinsic time is approximately
equal to or slower than chronological time.
Chaotic Market 47
The speed of intrinsic time may differ from that of chronological
time. Price changes would then move ahead of information changes.
Investors and other market participants conform perfectly neither to
the linear assumption of homogeneous expectations nor to the ubiquitous
irrationality of noise theory.
Instead, investors have heterogeneous expectations that may or
may not be rational and that may be defined according to a number
of variables. Chief among them are investor time horizons that range
from the very short term (for day traders and minute traders and
market makers, say) to the very long term (for central banks, say).
The range of different time dimensions contributes to the Joseph
and Noah effects, persistence, discontinuity, and premature and delayed
adjustments to information. Short-term traders react more
quickly to new information; long-term investors react more slowly.
Therefore, information changes will not produce proportionate price
changes. Indeed, volatility will increase when there are greater numbers
of short-term traders (day traders) than long-term traders.
Changes that are produced constitute new information, producing
another round of price changes again defined according to a
range of discrete time dimensions. Adding further complexity to this
mix of investor heterogeneity and time dimensions is the increasingly
global nature of financial markets: News itself is dynamic, traveling
around the world, usually in 24-hour cycles, and impacting Tokyo,
then London/Frankfurt, then New York, and around again.
In this reality, it seems implausible to claim instantaneous, unbiased
market adjustment to new information and it is not necessary
to attribute all market preadjustment or readjustment to irrational
noise trading. Incremental information changes in a perfect market
would be expected to produce proportionate price changes.
But informational changes produce disproportionate changes. In
terms of chaotic dynamics, these disproportionate changes may be
seen as a result of initial measurement error that (as in the hockey
puckexample and the butterfly effect generally) leads to exponentially
greater price changes over time.
BEHAVIORAL FINANCE
Not only do these systemic complexities and the stickiness of prices
show new reasons to be skeptical of EMT, they also suggest partial
explanations for the observed nonlinear dependence of stockprices
and the possible presence of chaotic phenomena. They certainly
48 A Tale of Two Markets
show that market behavior is far more complex than EMT allows.
While that is bad news for market efficiency, it is good news for
investors who recognize reality.
EMT may remain valuable to economists in explaining portions
of market processes—the public capital markets alternately may involve
both random and nonrandom components. But this partial validity
must not be misunderstood to suggest that markets are “relatively
efficient,” “reasonably efficient,” “sufficiently efficient,” or
“more efficient than not” at any moment in time, as many devotees
of EMT have been forced to argue since the market crash of 1987
shookconfidence in that theory.
Since 1987, a new generation of economists has arisen in prominent
universities to challenge EMT. Led by Robert Shiller of Yale,
a school of thought called behavioral finance draws on a wide range
of disciplines—including economics, psychology, biology, demography,
sociology, and history—to challenge the essentially mathematical
underpinnings of EMT.
The pioneers of behavioral finance have found substantial evidence
supporting two of Buffett’s long-held and most commonsense
propositions. The first is that while stockprices over short horizons
bounce around a lot, wedging price and value, over long horizons
the price must correspond to value. As Andrei Shleifer of Harvard
puts it, summarizing the studies: “Stocks with very high valuations
relative to their assets or earnings (growth or glamour stocks), which
tend to be stocks of companies with extremely high earnings growth
over the previous several years, earn relatively low riskadjusted returns
in the future, whereas stocks with low valuations (value stocks)
earn relatively high returns.”10
The second is evidence showing that investing in the latter group
of stocks (mislabeled “value stocks,” but the label is useful to simplify
the discussion) offers superior returns over long horizons. However
measured, the evidence Shleifer and his colleagues compiled
shows that “value” stocks outperform “growth” stocks by spreads of
about 8 to 10% annually over long horizons.
As early as 1981, Shiller showed that stockmark et prices are too
volatile to accord with EMT. Shiller’s peers at that time skewered
him for this blasphemy, but his research has held up and attracted
a still small but growing following, including former Harvard professor
Lawrence Summers, who became secretary of the treasury.
Shiller examined the relationship between price changes and subsequent
cash paid to stockholders and found remarkable irregularity
Chaotic Market 49
(bouncing around) in price changes in contrast to remarkable
smoothness in the cash stream.
Shiller and his colleague John Campbell recognize that some of
the price changes are due to changes in fundamental information
and to uncertainty about the future trends of cash flows. But taking
account of these factors, Shiller and Campbell estimated that only
27% of the annual return volatility in U.S. stockmark ets is justified
in terms of fundamental information. Campbell followed up this research
with John Ammer by using more recent data and reduced the
estimate to only 15%.11
Markets may be relatively efficient only on some days but not on
all days or may be relatively efficient for some stocks but not for
others. Even if we are more generous than the 15 to 27% suggested
by these studies and say EMT is 80% correct, it is a grave mistake
to use market efficiency as the basis of a managerial or investor game
plan. Buffett sums it up: “Observing correctly that the market was
frequently efficient,” EMT devotees “went on to conclude incorrectly
that it was always efficient. The difference between these propositions
is night and day.”12 That difference between night and day is
all that Graham and Buffett need to recognize. Neither is enthused
by mathematical accounts of markets, except to agree that EMT does
not explain all of market behavior.
Buffett quotes one of Charlie Munger’s favorite sayings to describe
the modern economist’s penchant for building EMT and related
mathematical models of stockmark ets: “To a man with a hammer,
every problem looks like a nail.”13 Graham quotes Aristotle: “It
is the markof an educated mind to expect that amount of exactness
which the nature of the particular subject admits. It is equally unreasonable
to accept merely probable conclusions from a mathematician
and to demand strict demonstration from an orator.”14
Graham concludes that “the workof a financial analyst falls
somewhere in the middle between that of a mathematician and an
orator.”15 The vanguard theorists of behavioral finance stand a better
chance of finding that middle road than do the devotees of EMT,
but they admit they still have a long way to go in understanding
investors and markets, a task that is likely to get harder rather than
easier, as the next chapter explains.
This page intentionally left blank.
51
C h a p t e r 4
AMPLIFIED
VOLATILITY
The efficient market story and the chaotic market story are neither
exhaustive nor mutually exclusive accounts of market behavior.
Rather, they depict end points on a continuum ranging from perfect
pricing to substantial deviation between price and value. These polar
points at the outer ranges of the continuum are a function of the
amount of price volatility. Price volatility can move prices toward
values (and is efficient) but can also push prices away from values
(and is inefficient).
Measuring how much market behavior is captured by the efficiency
story or the chaos story is hard. But if a generous estimate is
that EMT has explained about 80% of stockmark et behavior in the
past couple of decades, an important question is how much it is
likely to explain in the future. To answer that question, we need to
thinkabout the sources of volatility in pricing and assess whether
those sources are trending toward greater efficiency or greater pricevalue
discrepancies.
The sources of volatility that lead prices to part from fundamental
values are (1) the quality of information used by market participants in
trading, (2) the complexity of the markets in which trades are effected,
and (3) the discipline of market participants. A good prognosis is that
with the rise of on-line and computer-based trading and the spread of
fountains of noisy information all through the Internet, day and minute
traders will drive market mania to an ever more acute state of bipolar
disorder. Chaos rather than efficiency seems ascendant.
INFORMATION VOLATILITY
The first source of stockmark et volatility relates to information
changes. Information volatility has both a positive (efficient) dimension
and a negative (inefficient) dimension.
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
52 A Tale of Two Markets
The efficient dimension of information volatility is simply the
market’s facilitation of price changes in the light of fundamental
information about a company. That information alters the uncertainty
associated with that company’s future business prospects.
When the U.S. Supreme Court announces that the U.S. Food and
Drug Administration (FDA) lacks the authority to regulate tobacco
products, for example, the prices of tobacco stocks change to reflect
greater certainty about the regulatory environment.
This type of volatility is inherent in any market. It reflects the
simple reality that stockmark et prices are gauges of the future value
of cash flows to shareholders. The ineradicable uncertainty in that
gauge means that prices in an efficient market will hover about the
best estimates of value. But as information changes, the degree of
uncertainty about that value changes and prices should change accordingly.
There is little reason to believe that positive information volatility
is any worse or better now than it was a decade or longer ago. On
the one hand, there may be greater uncertainty in business value as
a result of globalization, the pervasiveness of new technology, and
the seeming swiftness of its change. A portion of the substantial
price volatility of the late 1990s and early 2000s may be a function
of such greater business volatility. On the other hand, there are also
superior ways to measure business and financial risk, manage it, and
adapt to these changing landscapes. With these factors offsetting
each other, there seems little basis for saying that positive information
volatility will get better or worse in the future.
Negative information volatility is another story. This inefficient
dimension of information volatility consists of trading on the basis
of information either unrelated to fundamental values or inaccurate
about them. The stuff of negative information volatility includes ageold
accounting trickery (discussed in Chapter 9) and other tactics
designed to prop up stockprices, such as share repurchases (discussed
in Chapter 13). But none of these problems seem more (or
less) severe than they ever did. Wacky trading strategies such as
those based on hemline levels and Super Bowl winners also constitute
negative information volatility, but these strategies are as fashionable
(and foolish) as they ever were.
What’s new is an increase in negative information volatility that
arises from trading that is based on premature information dissemination,
unfounded and untrue rumors, false speculative hunches,
and hopes, dreams, and lies. Changes in the manner and speed of
Amplified Volatility 53
information flows produce fountains of high-quality information
along with a deluge of low-quality junkmasquerading as information.
The result is increased negative information volatility that
drives a wider wedge between price and value.
In the old economy, EMT seemed plausible in part because the
information that markets digested had a superior quality compared
to that in the new economy trading environment. Old economy news
benefited from the major filtering role played by the mainstream
press. You could count on the integrity of The New York Times, USA
Today, The Wall Street Journal, and other great newspapers and magazines
to deliver news and information that was professionally vetted
under constraints imposed by long-nurtured and valuable reputations
for journalistic quality and integrity.
While you still can count on such media for filtered and considered
news reporting, the process of getting there has been littered
with unfiltered information that gets out before its time. The days
of getting vetted news from the morning paper and the evening news
are numbered. Americans get a steady diet of news throughout the
day, with the newspaper and the evening broadcasts sandwiching
nonstop cable news programs, Internet reports, and e-mails forwarding
rumor-based “news” that your friends or colleagues fear you
might otherwise miss.
The deluge of “news by the second” disrupts the old fixture of
the news cycle. Reporters who used to workon a 24-hour news cycle
that entailed gathering, researching, writing, rewriting, and printing
the news now announce their results as they go. Print journalists
broadcast tomorrow’s stories on today’s market wraps, and the reports
flash around every other news outlet—cable, Internet, and traditional
wires.
By the time this new news cycle is finished, the news that actually
gets reported in print is often either stale or discovered to be
less important than first believed. Reporting quality is sacrificed for
speed. In this world you get data earlier, but you get it the way
journalists in the middle of the old news cycle used to get it: unfiltered—
the draft of a story in progress.
These forces were behind the $2 billion price plunge of Emulex,
manufacturer of fiber optic communications equipment, in August
2000. Major news organizations, including Bloomberg, Dow
Jones, and CBS.Marketwatch.com, distributed what turned out to
be a fake press release announcing that Emulex’s CEO had resigned
and that it planned to restate its earnings for the prior two years.
54 A Tale of Two Markets
The hoax was engineered by a former employee of a press service
who knew the ropes of getting releases onto the Internet and reported
by organizations eager to be first to get news out. Apart from
the devastation to the stockof Emulex, the hoax appeared responsible
for dragging down the stockprices of numerous other fiber
optic companies as well as the broader Nasdaq composite.1
Webcasting by brokerage firms can also be a source of negative
information volatility. Supplanting the traditional news media, analysts
of major brokerages increasingly post reports directly on their
own Web sites by video streaming. They opine on market conditions
and call attention to favored stocks. Most firms admit they are not
reporting news but claim instead to be giving information. The difference
is often lost on investors consuming the data, who trade on
its basis without recognizing that it is furnished as a marketing device
for the brokerage rather than as news vetted and constrained
by traditional journalistic ethics of independence.
But the real villains of negative information volatility are the
cobwebs of Web sites that pump out unfiltered information on the
Internet with unbridled abandon, particularly on bulletin boards and
chat rooms. The ease and often anonymous character of information
dissemination over these Internet forums eliminates an important
filter for vast channels of what only passes for news and information.
If it has always been hard to believe that the market is as omniscient
as EMT says it is, the increasing ability of anyone, anywhere—identified
or anonymous—to spread lies, rumors, hunches, and other
disinformation to millions at a time makes that concept downright
fantastic.
On a typical day over thirty thousand messages flood the four
largest boards: Yahoo!, Silicon Investor, Motley Fool, and Raging
Bull. None of these board providers screen the messages for accuracy,
and all leave them up after they are posted. All of them permit
anonymous messages, and all posters can use as many different
names as they want.
For less than it costs to buy a cappuccino, anybody can drop by a
cyber cafe´ , log on, use one of many services that facilitate anonymous
postings that are nearly impossible to trace (cutely called “anonymizers”),
and say anything he or she wants to about any company (or anything
else, for that matter). The SEC has some investigators who regularly
review sites looking for possible fraud and some companies try
to address the rumors they see flying around, but these efforts cannot
assure you that what you are reading is worth anything.
Amplified Volatility 55
The most innocuous form of the riskof negative information
volatility is the rumor mill—Internet postings that stop way short of
fraud—but these rumors can have equally significant effects on
stockprices. Berkshire Hathaway’s stock price was hurt when wholly
unfounded and viscous rumors that Warren Buffett’s health was failing
spread all over the Internet in early 2000. Equally vicious were
the rumors spread in 1996 that executives of Quigley Corporation, a
company that had just introduced a cold remedy called Cold-Eaze,
were really mobsters: Its stockprice dropped from $37 to $10 on the
lies. Worst of all was the day when Michael Hackworth, president
and chief executive officer of Cirrus Logic, clicked on a Yahoo! site
to a message pronouncing him “dead after a long illness.”2
More pernicious than rumors in motive and in their effect on
stockprice accuracy are the deliberate defrauders, those who have
adapted a host of age-old fraud techniques to the Internet at a very
low cost and a very low riskof detection.3 Spamming is one of the
Internet defrauders cheapest mechanisms of deceit. For a few hundred
dollars, a spammer can buy software that enables the harvesting
of thousands of e-mail addresses from Internet files. A whole
e-mailing list can be devised. For higher stakes—say, $10,000—
spammers can buy e-mailing lists numbering tens of millions of addresses.
They blitz them for bogus bucks.
These spammers sometimes get caught. One who did promoted
stocks by spamming to several million e-mailees, touting the stocks
of two companies in exchange for a fee. The spammer did not disclose
his true identify or the fact that he was being paid to do the
hawking. A California court in October 1998 slammed the spammer
with a fine and an injunction against doing it again.4 In a similar
case, a convicted felon just out of jail and on probation for previous
securities fraud spammed 30 million e-mailees with lies about his
company that were intended to prop up its price precisely so that
he could generate enough money to repay the victims of his earlier
fraud!5 What a Ponzi scheme.
A more elaborate spamming technique seeks to disguise the
source of the e-mail and the identify of its sender, making it look as
if the message were misdirected to the recipient and making her feel
she had “overheard” a hot tip being exchanged between friends. In
one case, two men indicted in early 2000 on charges of securities
fraud “made” more than $1 million by sending hundreds of
thousands of e-mail messages about dozens of small companies to
subscribers of America Online (AOL).6 The subject stocks were just
56 A Tale of Two Markets
the kind lots of 2000s maniacs salivate for: no earnings and no revenue,
though most of them also had no continuing operations. In a
number of other cases, spammers disguised the sender of e-mails to
make it look as if the recipient were reading an internal memo at a
major investment banking house containing “inside” information
about various stocks.7
It has always been true that “tips” are suspect—whether from
your neighbor across the backfence, your hairdresser, or your dentist.
The great investor Phil Carret advised avoiding them like the
plague;8 an astute chronicler of trading markets, Edwin LeFe` vre,
stingingly observed that “Wall Street professionals know that acting
on ‘inside’ tips will breaka man more quickly than famine, pestilence,
crop failures, political readjustments, or what might be called
normal accidents”;9 and Ben Graham was terser: “Much bad advice
is given free.”10
What is different about the new tips is that more people create
them, more people hear them, and more people act on them than
ever before. When adapted for the Internet, not only do classic fraud
schemes dramatically enlarge the number of possible victims (and
the dollar receipts of the perpetrator), when peddled on many finance
bulletin boards and chat rooms they can carry special weight.
This is the case because these boards and rooms often create a spirit
of camaraderie among their users that generates trust in other participants
and what they have to say.
The most classic scam being adapted to the Internet is the pumpand-
dump, and it has been going on for many years. As early as
October 1996, for example, a pumper bought shares of Omnigene
Diagnostics for around $1 each and then posted a slew of pretty
much identical lies on AOL boards saying that the company was hot
and sales were growing rapidly. The stocksprinted to nearly $7 in
about six weeks, whereupon the pumper dumped the stock for an
illicit but huge gain. The lies were dispelled when an employee of
Omnigene announced on the company’s own Web site all sorts of
operational and financial problems. The SEC ordered a halt in trading
of the company’s stock. When it later lifted that halt, the stock
traded backbelow the $1 a share it had been resting at before the
pump-and-dump.11
A more recent pump-and-dump example began one Friday afternoon
in late November 1999, when three Beverly Hills twentysomethings
bought fifty thousand shares of a bankrupt commercial
printing company, NEI Webworld, for nickels and dimes a share.
Amplified Volatility 57
They then spent the weekend on computers at UCLA bombarding
three popular finance message boards—Yahoo!, Raging Bull, and
Freerealtime—with some five hundred fabricated messages hyping a
pending buyout of the worthless company. The lies jacked up NEI’s
stockprice to open at $8 Monday morning and move to a high that
day of $15, while the troika cashed in their shares for a net booty of
about $364,000, plunging the price backto the nickels and dimes
they had “invested.”12
The SEC and the U.S. attorney’s office in California jumped on
this scam and in a matter of days identified the looters and charged
them with violating federal securities laws against telling material
lies in connection with the purchase or sale of securities. The SEC
rightly denounced much of the nonsense that is spewed in Internet
bulletin boards and chat rooms as having no more value than graffiti,
and The Wall Street Journal rightly declared that some of them can
be worse than trash.
Of all the known Internet trashers, Yun Soo Oh Park is the most
notorious. Called Tokyo Joe, he was subjected to civil fraud charges
in early 2000 by the SEC for putting misleading investment information
on his Internet site. During 1998 and 1999, the SEC said,
Tokyo Joe made hundreds of thousands of fraudulent dollars through
a scalping strategy that involved buying stocks, saying wonderful
things about them on his Web site, and then selling them after the
buying of the masses pushed their price up.13
It may not even be those looking for fast money who sponsor
this negative information volatility. Early in 1999 an employee of
PairGain Technologies put a message on a Yahoo! site directing users
to a fake Bloomberg News page containing a fabricated story that
PairGain was going to be taken over. Its stock price soared on this
“news,” and while the fabricator apparently did not gain any money
from the ploy, he is spending five years on probation for the crime.14
Hard as it is to identify Internet scammers, you cannot count on
the authorities to punish and deter the new defrauders when they
are traced. When the SEC discovered in early 2000 that four thirdyear
Georgetown University law students (and the mother of one of
them, who happened to be a councilwoman for Colorado Springs!)
had generated nearly $350,000 in illegal profits from a pump-anddump
scam on their Web site, the SEC “settled” with the scoundrels.
No jail time, no fine, not even disgorgement of the dirty money. The
losers simply had to agree not to do it again.15
In a world where it is just as easy for anyone to buy a share of
58 A Tale of Two Markets
stockas to sell it short, the pump-and-dump scheme can be run just
as easily as a bust-and-buy scam. The buster is a short seller who
benefits if a stockprice falls because he buys stock today but promises
to pay for it at a price to be determined later. So he spreads
false rumors that a company’s sales are falling and that it is plagued
with all kinds of problems. The price busts, and the scammer gets
his shares at a low price—and then gets to watch the price rise as
people figure out there was no reason for the bust in the first place.16
That is precisely what the drafter of the fake press release about
Emulex was trying to do.
Outdoing the brazen fraud of the perpetrators of these stories
and the lax enforcement is the galactic stupidity of those who fall
for the schemes. To take just one example, any eighth-grader could
have looked up NEI on the SEC’s Web site or any other reputable
database and found that it had filed for bankruptcy a year earlier
and that it no longer had a listed telephone number for its Dallas
headquarters, let alone any assets or operations. Yet you would be
surprised how many people buy stocks on the basis of such Internet
gibberish and buy them without even knowing anything about their
business climate, let alone management or other basic financial information.
Speaking of eighth-graders, an astonishing number of people
who should have known better lost over a quarter of a million dollars
to a junior high school kid who apparently took Internet securities
fraud up as an after-school hobby. The child, 14 years old when he
began his scam, posted hundreds of manufactured messages concerning
nine different obscure stocks in chat rooms and bulletin
boards and entered automatic orders to sell the stocks once they
reached hype-inflated price levels. Without admitting or denying
guilt, he agreed with the SEC to refrain from doing it again and to
disgorge his profits (though without paying any additional fine or
other penalty).17
These anecdotal accounts and hundreds more untold indicate a
dramatic increase in negative information volatility. Certainly they
do not evidence an efficient market or one that is getting more efficient.
Rather, they help explain the market manias and greed-gloom
gyrations cataloged in Chapter 1. Their limited detectability and policing,
coupled with the public’s evident gullibility, suggest they will
continue to plague the market.
You can be sure not only that there are other crooks and swindlers
looking for and sometimes finding fast and fraudulent dollars
Amplified Volatility 59
but that negative information volatility will result. That bad news for
market efficiency is not entirely bad news for you as an investor,
however, so long as you steer clear of the pump-and-dump set and
take advantage of the widening spread between price and value that
results from their dirty work.
TRANSACTION VOLATILITY
The second source of stockprice volatility is transaction-related.18
This arises from the way prices are formed by market trading. It is
not possible for any party acting alone to set the price of a stock.
Share pricing in stockmark ets arises solely as a result of traders’
orders meeting in the market. How they meet in the market to determine
prices is important to know but often overlooked.
Trades on traditional markets such as the New York Stock
Exchange (NYSE) begin with a customer who instructs a broker to
effect a trade, say, to buy 100 shares of Dell at $50. The broker takes
that order to the trading floor, where a crowd of traders are at work.
If there were another broker who had gotten a customer’s order to
sell 100 shares of Dell at $50, the two could just swap shares for
their customers. No price change would result, and so there would
be no transaction volatility. That perfect matching of buy and sell
orders seldom happens on traditional exchanges (or on the Nasdaq,
where the chief difference is only that matching is done more by
computer routing of orders than through the physical presence of
people on the floor).
Instead, buyers and sellers place orders with their brokers at
different times, want to trade different amounts of shares, and want
to buy or sell at different prices. In these more typical cases, the
customers have to wait until someone else arrives looking for a trade
on the same terms or have someone else in the market make the
trade. That someone else is there, and she is called a market maker
(on the NYSE) or specialist (on the Nasdaq) in that stock.
When a broker can’t find another broker looking for a precise
swap with his customer’s order, these middlemen (market makers
and specialists) do the trade so that the broker’s customers don’t
have to wait until a counterpart comes along. The middlemen do
the waiting for them, making markets in stocks by buying and selling
shares when buyers and sellers arrive.
Middlemen make money for providing this service by buying
60 A Tale of Two Markets
stocks at a lower price (called the bid) and selling them at a higher
price (called the ask). The difference between the bid and the ask
price is called the bid-askspread. It is the price buyers and sellers
pay so that they don’t have to wait.
The bid-ask spread also compensates the market maker for the
risks he is exposed to in taking positions in stocks so that others
don’t have to wait. Making a market in stocks exposes her to the risk
of error in her own valuations and the valuations of others. Market
makers can make a market at a price below or above a stock’s fundamental
value.
If they make a market at a price below value, more buyers should
arrive. But the price goes up when buyers arrive (they pay the ask
price). Therefore, a maker will sell more shares at the ask than it
buys at the bid. It may then have to buy more shares to make a
market, and the price will be pushed up, exposing it to losses if the
bid-askspread is too small.
Market makers respond to that risk by widening the bid-ask
spread—raising the price at which they will sell to buyers and/or
lowering the price at which they will buy from sellers. Transaction
volatility in stockprices arises from such changes in the bid-ask
spread. It is undesirable volatility because it is driven not by changes
in fundamental values but by a market maker’s exposure to loss from
value errors amid orders arriving at different times seeking different
things.
Market makers also create transaction volatility when they respond
to changes in order flow. If more buy orders than sell orders
are coming in, they raise the bid and askquotes. They do this because
they must assume that the order imbalance reflects changes
in fundamental values. When they are right about that, their raise
reflects positive information volatility (i.e., price moving closer to
value). But when they are wrong about that, their prices deviate from
value and the change creates transaction volatility.
The rise of electronic computer networks (ECNs) has put regulatory
and economic pressure on the traditional exchanges to reduce
transaction volatility resulting from market making. ECNs conduct
trading solely on computer screens rather than through brokers,
traders, and market makers. The swiftness and transparency of this
computerized technique allows trades to be handled as in the first
example above, where two brokers swap their respective customers’
mirror trades, and with far less or no waiting time.
Each customer posts his desired trade on the ECN’s screen, say,
Amplified Volatility 61
one seeking to buy 100 shares of Dell at $50 and one seeking to sell
the same. When the price of an offer to buy matches the price of
an offer to sell (as in this case), the trade occurs automatically. The
middleman disappears, and the price is formed directly by two orders
meeting in the market. ECNs can thus reduce transaction volatility
caused by the bid-ask spread required by market makers.
If particular ECN offer prices do not match, however, they still
get posted on the computer along with the bid and askoffers of
specialists and market makers. When the orders don’t match, there
is an “order imbalance” and the screens cannot do anything about
it. A middleman must step in to buy or sell to eliminate the imbalance
and keep the market alive.
Even if it were theoretically possible for ECNs to eliminate transaction
volatility caused by the bid-askspread required by middlemen,
that could not happen without effectively shutting down the market.
Thus, any reduction in transaction volatility you see coming from
ECNs is not going to eliminate it. And there is some reason to believe
it won’t even reduce it—depending on how markets shape up.
ECNs shookup market trading as they proliferated in the late
1990s and early 2000s. The leading players in this market are Island
and Instinet, both of which do a huge business in this kind of computer
trading. Any business they get, however, is business that the
traditional exchanges—and the brokers, traders, and market makers
who participate in them—do not get. At stake for traditional brokerage
firms is the franchise value from their roles as specialists and
market makers in stocks. At stake for the proprietors of the ECNs
and the on-line and discount brokers who get more order flow
through their use is a new franchise value the systems can create.
Not surprisingly, then, the explosion of ECNs as alternative trading
places produced an excited debate among the traditional firms
and the newer firms and at the SEC and in Congress. All factions
recite a variation of the same mantra: The goal is to help investors
get the best price available each time they trade.
Traditional firms say the goal of getting customers the best price
would be best accomplished by having a single source of pricing
information,19 and so they call for a centralized order bookwhere all
orders would be posted and through which all participants could
insure that their customers get the best price. The ECNs and online
and discount firms say you will get better pricing if you have
lots of competition between firms, and so they call for permitting a
62 A Tale of Two Markets
fragmented system with lots of different order books. The pressure
on all sides is revealed by merger talks between the NYSE and Nasdaq
on the one hand and between ECN leaders Instinet and Island
on the other.20
Given this environment, elimination of transaction volatility is
unlikely. Not only that, any reduction in it through enhanced use of
electronic computer systems as opposed to market makers is likely
to be offset by another development in market trading: quoting share
prices down to the penny (“decimal pricing”) rather than in fractional
increments of 1/8 or 1/16.
In theory, decimal pricing would help produce prices that equal
value. Suppose the value of a share is $50.03. In a decimal pricing
system it is quoted at exactly $50.03, whereas in a fractional pricing
system it is quoted either at $50 or at $50.06 (i.e., 50 1/16).
Decimal pricing also has the effect of narrowing the bid-ask
spread for the same reason. But it means the spread is changed more
frequently, itself a cause of transaction volatility. While the move to
decimal pricing may not contribute as much to increasing transaction
volatility as the rise of ECNs subtracts, on balance the reduction
from ECNs makes only a modest case for improved market efficiency.
The case is cloudier yet when you add the move toward 24-hour
trading. Market volatility tends to lighten when trading sessions are
interrupted, as occurs on the Thursday following Ash Wednesday,
for example. However, some of the greatest market plummets have
occurred on Mondays, following two days off. Whether continuous
trading will promote or retard efficiency is thus hard to predict,
though one lesson from history suggests the latter. The Evening
Exchange operated in New Yorkin the 1860s as a place to continue
trading stocks and gold after the NYSE’s regular daytime hours. It
lasted only a few years, apparently creating and suffering from a
staggering speculative and volatile bubble that led to its demise.21
Whatever value ECNs add in terms of reduced transaction volatility
is offset by what they create in a third kind of volatility. The
rise of ECNs has meant a proliferation of places to trade and get
prices. For investors and traders, this means faster and cheaper ways
to trade stocks, at lower commissions, with swifter trade executions
and more after-hours trading. This promotes the democratization of
capital, which sounds nice. But is it?
As anyone who know anything about Warren Buffett knows, the
best investors see themselves as part owners of a business rather
Amplified Volatility 63
than of a piece of tradable paper or cyberspace. But this mind-set is
hard to maintain when price quotes proliferate and distract attention
to value by both existing owners and new shareholders who buy on
spec.
All this action across a broad spectrum of people and places
means more room for psychological influences. That remains true
whether all these trades arise in thousands of different places or
occur in a single place. The resulting prices bear less resemblance
to business values. The irony is that volatility exists no matter what
system emerges, though with the rise of ECNs a greater danger
lurks: trader volatility.
TRADER VOLATILITY
Trader volatility arises when trades are made for purposes unrelated
to the fundamental values of a business. These trades drive prices
to points related more to the motives of the trader than to the business
value of the company.
The wide range of trading decisions that cause price moves unrelated
to business value includes: trading for identifiable economic
reasons of the trader, such as portfolio “rebalancing”; selling shares
to fund personal needs or desires, such as a child’s education or the
remodeling of a kitchen; and, most notoriously of all, day trading for
purposes of speculation and gambling. Let’s start with that one.
Day trading is usually not based on fundamental values but on
momentum, sector rotation, and other technical tactics of the type
ridiculed earlier. When trades are based on these things, they move
prices. Those moves, having nothing to do with values, widen the
gap between price and value. This exacerbates Mr. Market’s peaks
and valleys and feeds irrational exuberance and irrational despair.
Day trading is thus among the worst developments capital markets
have seen in their history for purposes of maintaining an orderly or
sensible market, much less an efficient one.
Many day traders are probably perfectly rational people; many
are not. Aberrations may get headlines, but some of the day trader
stunts captured by the mainstream press warrant attention. The Atlanta
day trader who gunned down nine people and then himself in
the summer of 1999 after suffering staggering day trading losses is a
glaring example. So too is the fun-loving 44-year-old family man who
tookearly retirement with his wife and their $780,000 nest egg only
64 A Tale of Two Markets
to murder the money day trading and then attempt to murder his
wife (he wound up in a South Carolina prison).22
Hardly tales of high rationality, and the woeful tales of these
hapless folks are not isolated examples or aberrations. A Senate committee
held hearings on day trading in early 2000 accompanied by
a blistering report cataloging its numerous plagues. The report focused
on the industry that supports day trading and emphasized the
need for greater industry riskdisclosure, licensing, and minimum
financial requirements for traders. But it is also a brief against the
sagacity of the pernicious practice.23
The most compelling conclusions of the report are that 75% of
day traders lose money and that a typical day trader has to generate
gains of $110,000 a year just to breakeven after costs! That figure is
breathtaking, but the idea is not new. Classic studies have shown
that someone who tries to time the market and move in and out of
it quickly to exploit its gyrations has to be right 70% of the time to
profit. Do you know anybody who can perform that well consistently?
Even the best hitters in baseball—say, Rod Carew, George Brett, and
even Ted Williams—bat at most .400 (the equivalent of “being right”
only 40% of the time).
An equally important—if slightly more benign—source of trader
volatility is the practice of “rebalancing.” Ironically, this practice was
promoted mainly by those who use modern portfolio theory and believe
in market efficiency. Rebalancing goes something like this: If
you start with ten stocks each bought for 10% of the total cost of
your portfolio, some will rise in price and some will fall. The rebalancer
says that after a year or another arbitrary interval, lookat
the new pricing. Suppose five went up and five went down, both in
proportion. Now your portfolio has five stocks constituting 75% of
the holdings and five stocks constituting 25%. The rebalancer says
you should shed some of those in the 75% group to reduce their
role in the overall holdings.
This must rankamong the dumbest things people could do with
investments, yet it is very prevalent. You end up selling the stocks
that seem to be performing relatively well and keeping those which
come up behind. Why would you do that?
It may be rational, but not because your portfolio is somehow out
of balance. It makes sense to sell the good performers only if you examine
the business fundamentals of the companies and decide that
they no longer meet your requirements for holding them: the price exceeds
the value by large amounts, there are clearly superior opportuAmplified
Volatility 65
nities for wider price-value gaps, the economic characteristics have
deteriorated, or management has changed hands for the worse.
The famed investor Gerald Loeb gave the opposite advice, which
is not easy to follow in the best of circumstances, much less when
contemporary advisers are telling you something else: “If you want
to sell some of your stocks and not all, invariably go against your
emotional inclinations and sell first the issues with losses, small profits,
or none at all. Always get rid of the weakest and keep your best
issues for last.”24
Like Loeb, Peter Lynch regards the prevalent practice of rebalancing
as backward, saying it is like gardening by watering the weeds
and pulling the flowers. The beneficiaries of this backward gardening
are not the investors or traders who do the rebalancing but their
advisers—who generate fees from trading—and the U.S. federal and
local treasuries—which get tax payments. Buffett put it best in asking
whether it would have made sense for the Chicago Bulls to trade
Michael Jordan on the grounds that he had become too important
and valuable to the team.25
Apart from the stupidity of trading the best picks, the strategy’s
contribution to trader volatility is significant. When trades are made
to rebalance a portfolio in this way, they are by definition trades unrelated
to business value (other than fortuitously). The sale of stock
that no longer “fits” a portfolio puts price change pressures on that
stock. But that pressure, having nothing to do with actual or even perceived
value in that stock, simply widens the price-value gulf.
Finally, plenty of people have turned to the stockmark et as a
savings account. It is the place where they repose regular sums to
build wealth for planned projects such as buying a home, paying for
a child’s education, and enjoying retirement. It is also the place
where money is stored and drawn on for unplanned funding needs,
such as paying to remodel a kitchen, buying a sports utility vehicle,
and taking trips to exotic vacation spots.
It is hard to quarrel with those who use the stockmark et as a
way to build wealth for planned future needs such as home ownership,
education, and retirement. These tend to be long-term goals
that enable long-term investing, and so the stockmark et is a rational
place to store some of that wealth.
It is far easier to rebuke the use of the stock market for more
short-term-oriented expenditures. For one thing, there is extraordinary
riskin stockmark et investing, especially over short periods of
time. It is simply not a rational place to put resources that may be
66 A Tale of Two Markets
needed to fund ordinary needs such as home repair and ordinary
desires such as recreation.
As to either form of using the stockmark et, however, the net
effect on market efficiency is the same. Trading decisions are based
on needs (or desires) rather than on the fundamental values of the
stockbeing sold. That has the effect, again, of separating the resulting
prices from the actual values.
As more Americans use the stockmark et for these purposes—
as traders rather than as investors—EMT explains less market activity.
And as The New York Times said when day trader mania took
hold, America has gone from a nation of savers, to a nation of investors,
to a nation of traders.26
ECNs and discount on-line brokers facilitate trading, rebalancing,
and savings via stocks. Although this positively reduces the costs
of incremental trading, it has an offsetting negative effect of encouraging
more trades. In the aggregate market, negative information
volatility and a wilder Mr. Market ensue.
It is like Reaganomics for brokers, as people end up spending
more in commissions under this lower pricing per trade because they
trade more often. Charles Schwab, to give a representative example
of this industry, reduced its average revenue per trade from $64.27
in 1997 to $45.55 two years later while increasing daily trading volume
from 106,000 to 208,000 and growing.27 Schwab’s revenues
soared; you know who paid.
Day trading funds on the horizon will make all these matters
worse. Marrying low-cost trading, screen-based clearing, and the insatiable
day trader appetite, a former commissioner of the SEC
launched a company in mid-2000 called Folio(fn) to cater to the
rebalancing and day trading set. It offers a fixed annual fee that is
not only much lower than typical mutual fund fees but also lower
than the average cost per trade Schwab and others charge. It uses
a proprietary trading system to match customer trading orders in
house, going to market twice a day with compiled customer orders
to clear any imbalance. Touted as a way to help investors, this day
trading fund will increase trader volatility.28
PROGNOSIS
The main effect of amplified volatility—from low-quality information,
market fragmentation, and noise traders—is less efficient pricAmplified
Volatility 67
ing of stocks. The spread has widened between Mr. Market’s currency
(prices, what you pay) and corporate management’s currency
(value, what you get).
The symptoms of that inefficiency and the consequences of that
amplification consist of all the phenomena cataloged in Chapter 1,
including bifurcation of markets (for example, between the Dow and
the Nasdaq) and roller coaster rides of crashes and breaks. Episodes
such as the crash of 1987 and the breakof 1989 no longer look like
isolated aberrations; rather, these and the spasmodic bursts and
busts of the late 1990s and early 2000s evidence a disease that is
not only epidemic but chronic.
EMT was never a perfect explanation of the stockmark et, but
whatever purchase it once held is declining further and rapidly in
today’s market climate. It may have had some appeal in an era when
trading enjoyed the benefits of a major filtering role for the financial
press and investment professionals. While these institutions were
never perfect in those roles, their training, knowledge, and professionalism
(and, for advisers, interest in stable markets for underwriting
and merger advisory businesses) tooksome of the edge off
their human infirmities. It didn’t make EMT right, but it did make
it seem plausible.
The rise of the Web, ECNs, day traders, and the individual investor
have produced unfiltered stockmark ets that retard rather than
promote efficiency. SEC Chairman Arthur Levitt testified before
Congress that market fragmentation created by the rise of ECNs
could lead the same stockto trade at substantially different prices
in different trading forums. Maybe that would create new and exciting
arbitrage opportunities, but the chairman’s insight makes the
case against existing stockmark et efficiency airtight.
As the next chapter shows, these trends in market behavior imply
that managers and investors should ignore how the market is behaving
with respect to pricing securities and focus instead on their
own knitting: running businesses with strong economic characteristics
and looking for them, respectively.
This page intentionally left blank.
69
C h a p t e r 5
TAKE THE FIFTH
Knowing that the average cycle length of public capital markets
is approximately four years does not give you any tricks to investing,
for there are none. That, plus knowing that stock market
efficiency is at most about 80% true and getting less so, corroborates
the endurance of Ben Graham’s intuition: Mr. Market is alive and
still not well. The question is what to do with the 20% or more of
market pricing EMT does not capture, and the answer is to take
advantage of it.
Maybe Mr. Market’s manic depression has been better diagnosed
if still not widely understood. Maybe the detection of nonlinear dependence
and the upsetting of EMT are like superior clinical diagnoses
of bipolar disorder in medicine. Maybe increasing recognition
of the disease has reduced the denial and given some hope of treatability.
But these are just maybes.
What is certain is that the market is complex. Also certain, given
the alternative accounts of market phenomena, is that trading rule
tests and other pat formulas for investing remain nonsensical gibberish,
though not because the market is efficient but because it is
plagued by emotional disorder.
It remains to navigate the market’s Scylla of gloom and its Charybdis
of euphoria. It is possible to do so because there are bounds
to the mania. The greater fool theory may be true: Buying stocks for
profitable resale at some future time requires that there be someone
out there who will buy what you want to sell. It may be true that
the entire market operation rests upon confidence that in the long
run the market gets things right without too much static or dislocation
over the shorter run that it takes to get there.
Market traits of irrationality and chaos undermine efficiency
claims, but that is as far as they go. They do not undermine confidence
in the long-run stability of markets. To the contrary, they
mean that opportunities exist for the wise and the cautious, those
armed with the tools of business analysis that enable one to decide
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
70 A Tale of Two Markets
when the time is right to take advantage of Mr. Market’s festering
gloom and when the time is right to steer clear of his maniacal
euphoria.
The debate over how much of market behavior EMT captures is
an endless one. This is the case because its devotees tell us that as
it starts to explain less, opportunities arise for informed people (such
as those who act on the mind-set they develop from reading this
book) to step in and correct things. Thus, EMT gets restored. The
endlessly open empirical question is the degree to which one effect
swamps the other.
On balance, the Internet’s negligible business information quality
and the frolicsome day traders acting on it suggest plenty of incentive
for real investors to get informed and plenty of room left
over after they do. In other words, if the current trading environment
makes it seem that EMT’s descriptive power is going to look more
like 70% in the coming years, people acting on it may be able to
return its power to about 80% after that. Those most able to participate
in taking advantage of that process are investors equipped with
a business analysis mind-set.
WHO’S IN CHARGE?
From a manager’s perspective, an important consequence of market
complexity is that directors and officers cannot control a company’s
stockprice. Hence, shareholders should not expect or require them
to maximize it. Managers can only be expected and required to manage
their own business and its fundamental values, not how the
market understands that performance. Investors and traders make
those determinations, not managers.
It would be a mistake, however, to allow this reality to immunize
managers from reproach for poor stockprice performance over long
periods of time. What this means is only that managers cannot be
held responsible for fluctuations in the company’s stockprice that
result from the passions of the marketplace. It does not mean that
a long-term subpar stockprice is not a reflection of actual managerial
ineptitude.
Good managers will enjoy average stockprices of the company
above the norm; bad ones will suffer average prices below it. Neither
is responsible for, or can claim credit for, the intermittent ups and
downs. As Ben Graham said, “Good managements produce a good
Take the Fifth 71
average market price, and bad managements produce bad market
prices.”1
Managers also undoubtedly attempt to influence the company’s
stockprice all the time in ways ranging from the mundane (casting
unfavorable announcements in the rosiest light subject to antifraud
constraints), to the unlawful (manipulating earnings, a subject considered
in Part II), to something in between (say, extraordinary distributions
to shareholders from the sale of debt or assets).
Those attempts, however, are not motivated primarily by a desire
to produce stockprices equivalent to underlying business value. On
the contrary, most managers want the company’s stockto trade at
the highest possible prices in the market, without regard to business
value. This is a mistake, as Buffett emphasizes repeatedly, for such
delinkage means that business results during one period will not
necessarily benefit the people who owned the company during that
period.2
While investors rather than managers are in the best position to
evaluate and translate into market prices a company’s performance
as measured by its underlying business value, they cannot guarantee
a perfect translation. Information, transaction, and trader volatility
all interfere with the identity between business value and market
price. Even subject to these distortions, however, it is worth an investor’s
time to understand business values and promote their identity
with market prices. The larger investors have greater incentives
to do this and to reap its rewards, which increase in proportion to
shareholding size.
Together, therefore, these insights justify active, informed, large,
and long-term investors focused on business analysis or, in Buffett’s
characterization of Berkshire Hathaway, “major, stable and interested
shareholders” who are “supportive, analytical and objective.”3 Instead
of asking whether such investors will make EMT more than
about 70 to 80% correct, however, this perspective confirms the
prospect that such investing can take advantage of what EMT has
papered over for nearly three decades: the systemic separation of
business value from market price.
STICKING TO YOUR KNITTING
The separation of business value from market price calls for inverting
the usual thinking about investing. Too often tools and people
72 A Tale of Two Markets
use market prices as a metric in valuing a business. That gets the
process backward. Market price is the last thing an investor should
lookat in a valuation exercise. All the market price tells you is what
you can buy (or sell) a share of stockfor .
The market does not at all tell you whether that is a good or bad
deal. Answering that question requires conducting a valuation based
on the fundamental business and economic characteristics of the issuing
company. These are the tools considered in the rest of this book.
In using these tools, all investors—institutional and individual—
also should appreciate a few other implications of market complexity
that follow from the question suggested at the beginning of this
chapter: What does a stockmark et’s four-year cycle length mean? It
certainly means that the most revolutionary investing ideas of the
last 30 years—EMT, MPT, and CAPM—can be misleading.
These are the lessons to relearn:
• It is not a waste of time to study individual investment opportunities
in stocks.
• You are likely to do better by thinking about whether individual
investment opportunities make sense than by randomly selecting
a group of stocks for a portfolio by throwing darts at the stock
tables (as contests sponsored by publications such as The Wall
Street Journal lead many to believe).
• Nor will you do better by using modern portfolio theory’s strategy
of putting your eggs in lots of different baskets based on what ß
tells you the riskof each basket is.
It should also be noted that one of the costliest lessons of modern
finance theory was the proliferation of portfolio insurance—a
computerized technique for readjusting a portfolio in declining markets.
The widespread use of portfolio insurance helped precipitate
the stock market crash of October 1987 as well as the market break
of October 1989, for the models prescribed selling off blocks of stock
as their prices fell.
That massive an error—on the scale of the entire market and its
participants—suggests that similar errors occurred throughout the
investing population, including missed opportunities for gain by
small investors. Accordingly, you should ignore modern finance theory
and other quasi-sophisticated views of the market and stick to
investment knitting.
Take the Fifth 73
Strategies
You might askwhether it is worth your time to do hardheaded analysis
of business or whether you would be better off letting other
people do the workand then free riding on their effort. Economists
illustrate this free rider strategy by positing a country that taxes its
citizens in order to build a good military. Everyone agrees that this
is desirable to defend against foreign enemies. A tax dodger free rides
on the public good of a strong military while not contributing to it.
Is it possible for an investor to let others do the investment research
(pay the taxes) yet participate as a free rider in the market
anyway? Not quite. First, in the classic free rider example, there are
two classes of people: those who pay their taxes and those who free
ride. In stockinvesting, there are three: those who do their homework,
those who speculate, and those who free ride. The addition of
the speculators makes it possible for those who would otherwise be
content with a free ride to exploit the folly of the speculators by
doing their homework.
You might ask, If those doing the homework can gain so much
from the speculators, why doesn’t everyone shift from speculating to
homework? Good question. People should. But they don’t. Ben Graham
and Warren Buffett—the consummate homeworkdevotees —
repeatedly marvel at the inertia of speculators and can only wonder
why so many people choose lemming-like laziness over active analysis.
Yet the speculator is here to stay, as the trends identified earlier
suggest (and not everyone will read or heed this book). Plus c¸a
change, plus c¸a la meˆme chose.
Even the strategies that come closest to resembling the free rider
gambit require some work. The most common version of a free rider
strategy, which may be best for many people, is long-term investment
in an index fund. An index fund is a mutual fund that buys the same
securities that are in a given index, such as the S&P 500. They have
grown to gigantic proportions of total invested capital.4
People are attracted to such funds for lots of reasons. For one
thing, the S&P 500 and similar indexes consistently outperform the
managers of active portfolio funds. Indexes also change relatively
little, and so index funds have low stockturnover and therefore lower
costs and better management of taxable gains.
The chief potential downside of indexing is that it pays no attention
to fundamentals, emphasizing past returns rather than evaluating
future prospects. The trade-off hinges on an investor’s ability
74 A Tale of Two Markets
and inclination to conduct business analysis. While using an index
fund gives a reasonable assurance of obtaining the average market
return with very little effort, the investor should still have some reasonable
basis for believing that the basket of stocks that constitutes
the index—whether the S&P 500 or something else—is cheap relative
to the value it contains. Making such a decision requires some
sense of the business analysis discussed in this bookeven if it does
not require precise or detailed application of it.
Monitoring of fundamentals is plain common sense. Buyers of a
market index need to know what value they are getting, just as buyers
of shares do. Both can fluctuate on the upside and the downside.
There is no assurance that the overall stockmark et will go up any
more than there is any assurance that attendance at major league
baseball games will go up. Both can and do go down.
Patience while holding is not as valuable as research before buying,
for many bear markets extend for long periods of time. Whether
a market is heading up or down is impossible to predict, even over
long periods, whereas there is at least some possibility of predicting,
over long periods, which way a particular stockis likely to go.
Stockmutual funds are managed portfolios consisting of selected
stocks from the broader market. An investment committee regularly
buys and sells stocks for the fund. The fund’s shareholders pay the
costs of these trades, plus other fees, making mutual funds more
expensive than index funds. They are also more expensive from a tax
standpoint. Mutual fund portfolio changes often produce capital
gains, and shareholders pay the taxes.
The tax consequence of mutual fund ownership shows an advantage
to holding individual stocks. When you make a mistake in
purchasing a stock—it declines in both price and value to the point
where it no longer meets your requirements for holding it—selling
it at least gives you the modest breakof a tax deduction for the loss
on the sale.
For individual stocks, regular and periodic investing in dividend
reinvestment plans (DRIPs) using the concept of dollar-cost averaging
is a sensible alternative for many people. All this concept
means is that regular purchases of a particular stockin set dollar
amounts each month (or another interval) lower the average cost of
those shares compared to the average of the prices when the shares
were bought. It insulates an investor from the effects of Mr.Market’s
euphoria by taking advantage of his episodic gloom.
Suppose you invested $200 per month in Procter & Gamble durTake
the Fifth 75
ing three months when its stockprice on the purchase dates was
$80, $120, and $100, respectively. The average price during that period
was $100 (80 120 100 divided by 3), but your average cost
would have been $97 (you would have acquired 2.5 shares at $80,
1.66 shares at $120, and 2 shares at $100, and so you would have
invested $600 and acquired 6.16 shares). This strategy can beat Mr.
Market by substantial margins when used over long periods of time.
Staying the course is prudent only if there is a basis for deciding
that price is less than value. Adopting the mind-set developed in this
book is important in making that kind of judgment. Monitoring the
relationship of the DRIP’s price to its value using this mind-set is
prudent. Beware, however, that dollar-cost averaging works to reduce
your average purchase price only if you participate during Mr. Market’s
gloomy moods. It defeats the goal of defeating Mr. Market to
try to time the market by periodically terminating and later resuming
participation.
For all investors (those in index or mutual funds, DRIPs, or individual
stocks) the key point is to develop a mind-set that attends
to the price-value distinction. You can achieve this without necessarily
doing all the detailed computations or extensive research discussed
in this book, but it is imperative to embrace the mind-set
these tools reflect as a way to understand business analysis and intelligent
investing. There are no free rides any more than there are
free lunches.
Diversification of Stock Investments
Unlike modern finance theory, investment knitting does not prescribe
a particular diversification of a stockportfolio. It may result
in diversification, but not as a requirement. Ending up with a concentrated
portfolio is sometimes perfectly fine. As Gerald Loeb
noted, most of the really great fortunes were made by concentration.
5 If you thinkabout Johnson & Johnson or Papa John’s Pizza
and find that the prices at which they can be bought are very low
compared to your reasonable valuation, buying only those two stocks
may be all you need or prudently should do.
You should certainly avoid starting a portfolio on day one with a
dozen diversified stocks. It is almost certain that you will not be able
to find that number of stocks on a single day that are offered at
prices substantially lower than their values. Over long periods of
time, some degree of diversification will probably occur, and it is not
76 A Tale of Two Markets
imprudent to maintain it as long as it does not impair your ability
to concentrate on selecting new candidates or keeping up with what
you already own.
An excessively diversified portfolio gives you a different version
of the free rider problem. Just as a tax dodger benefits from a strong
national defense without contributing to it, a bad stockenjoys the
price you paid for it without contributing value to your portfolio.
Free riders are less noticeable in larger settings; it is easier to catch
a tax cheat in Canada than in the United States, for example. Likewise,
the more stocks you have in your portfolio, the less likely it is
that you will catch and punish (sell) those which are free riding on
your wealth and devouring it.
These principles of limited diversification hold only for wellchosen
common stocks that carry a margin of safety between the
price paid and the reasonable value estimated. For those, Buffett
believes finding between 5 and 10 stocks would be sensible; Graham
says between 10 and 30. Graham and Buffett both emphasize that
investors taking more aggressive stances, as professional money managers
do, require the same kind of wide diversification casino houses
adopt: The house needs, in Buffett’s words, “lots of action because
it is favored by probabilities, but will refuse to accept a single, huge
bet.”6
Asset Allocation
Excessive stockdiversification (and portfolio rebalancing, as discussed
in the last chapter) should be distinguished from a more
fundamental and important investment principle called asset allocation.
This principle recognizes the many types of assets available
to investors, not just common stocks. Alternatives include bonds,
cash, real estate, real estate investment trusts (REITs), and commodities.
These alternatives often furnish attractive ways to store
and build wealth. Their relative attractiveness is potentially greatest
when stockmark ets do not appear to offer prices lower than values,
a prudent time to consider investing in these asset classes. Alternatives
also include any mix of these asset classes invested in taxadvantaged
vehicles such as individual retirement accounts (IRAs)
and 401(k) plans.
Most investors tend to end up with a diversified mix of these
different asset classes: home ownership, some cash on hand, a retirement
vehicle, and a stockand bond mix. Those who do not
should try to do so. Diversity across asset classes is important as a
Take the Fifth 77
way to preserve wealth. If 100% of wealth were allocated to stocks
and the stockmark et overall dragged for a decade, total wealth would
erode. If a portion of the wealth were stored in bonds and the bond
market performed favorably over that time, much of the wealth
would be preserved.
One problem with investments made through tax-advantaged
plans is a lackof diversification in the asset classes offered. Many
plan menus are weighted disproportionately toward stockfunds.
Many people simply elect an even allocation between the items on the
menu. Many others simply allocate 100% to the stockfunds. Either
way, assets are allocated heavily toward stocks. Heavy stock weighting
may be prudent for very young people and even for older people,
but only so long as other (non-plan) assets are in different classes.
Putting all your eggs in the stock market basket is imprudent
asset allocation. Once you have allocated your assets across different
classes, the portion you allocate to stocks need not be diversified. In
short, asset diversification is far more important than stockportfolio
diversification.
Beyond asset preservation, the ultimate issue in asset allocation—
as in investing in general—is the prior and larger question of
opportunity cost. You want to invest your money in the assets most
likely to produce the greatest return in future periods. The general
principles for evaluating that likelihood are pretty much the same
across asset classes. The form of the asset itself guarantees nothing
about its relative attractiveness, a question that depends on its context.
That said, there are plenty of exotic asset classes that most
people are better off staying far clear of, ranging from innocuoussounding
instruments such as convertible bonds to the more mysterious
zones of private equity and hedge funds (more on this below).
The business analysis mind set is just as important in assessing
these alternative asset types as it is in investing in common stocks.
While each asset type warrants attention to the peculiar issues associated
with it (the price of silver depends on supply and demand
for the metal, for example), a mind-set trained in thinking as a business
analyst about common stocks can easily adapt itself for application
to these other asset classes (that is why this bookconcentrates
on common stocks).
Income Allocation
Asset allocation is less important than income allocation, but most
people get this backward too. People focus on how much they make
78 A Tale of Two Markets
but less on how they allocate income between investment and consumption.
The result is a national savings rate around zero.
But if you save more of what you make, it is easier to meet
investing goals since more assets are at work. Those who save relatively
smaller portions of their income are more easily tempted by
speculative impulses that make intelligent investing more difficult.
Everyone with income faces the question of income allocation.
You have to decide how much of your income to allocate to housing
costs, food and clothing, entertainment, transportation, education,
and so on. Some people also have the unfortunate chore of deciding
how to allocate income to pay for past consumption in the form of
cumulated credit card debt, automobile or personal loans, and mortgages
on real estate.
It should be a no-brainer that the high-interest-expense items in
this category should be paid down to zero before an allocator even
thinks about investing in common stocks. If you are carrying a balance
on your credit card accounts that requires you to pay something
like 10 to 18% interest annually, you are wasting your money. Pay
those debts down to zero and you will automatically earn the rate
you otherwise would be paying—guaranteed (something that is never
possible with stocks). The same holds true even for less expensive
obligations such as automobile loans (with average interest rates of
around 8 to 12%): Paying them down to zero with your extra cash
guarantees you that return. It can even be true for home mortgage
loans in some cases: Paying down 6 to 8% debt locks in that rate in
a way that no common stockcan ever guarantee.
Margin Trading
The growth in the number and size of margin accounts for stocks—
especially among day traders—suggests that many people foolishly
neglect these simple truths. From 1996 to 1999, margin debt rose
nearly fivefold at on-line brokerage firms and doubled among NYSE
member firms. During the decade of the 1990s, margin debt as a
percentage of total consumer debt quadrupled from 4% to 16%. Yet
many people do not understand that margin loans are not like other
consumer loans.7
Margin traders borrow from their brokers at rates ranging around
9 to 11% in order to buy stocks with the borrowed money. They think
they can leverage those loans by using the proceeds to buy stocks
whose price rises plus dividends yield greater returns. In euphoric
Take the Fifth 79
markets those people may win, getting returns higher than the cost
of the money. In gloomy markets they get crushed.
When the balance in your portfolio falls so that your margin
loans are equal to about half or more of that amount, you have to
put cash in to pay down that debt (your broker gives you a “margin
call”). If you don’t have the cash, your broker will sell some of your
shares—with or without your cooperation. Add the interest expense
and the trading costs to a reversal of Mr. Market’s euphoria to count
your losses; then multiply that by the number of overextended margin
traders and you have the acute slope of a downhill market before
you.
The big margin traders might as well be high-rolling in Monaco
on borrowed money. Lookno further than the poster boy of marginized
day trading to see the stupefying riskof this strategy. The most
vocal proponent of this high-stakes game is Barry Hertz, the impresario
of a company called TrackData Corporation. Its marketing
pitch gleefully enthused that investing was easy (“you don’t have to
be a pro to trade like one”), and Hertz advised his customers to day
trade, using borrowed funds.
Hertz at least tookhis own (bad) advice to double speculate. So
on Q day (April 14, 2000, when markets plunged), his own brokers
called him to say they needed over $45 million to shore up his margin
account. To do so, Hertz had to pledge over 50% of his shares
of TrackData. 8 Heed the advice of those like Hertz if you like what
happened to him.
Financial Gambling
You would also do well to remember the tragedy of 28-year-old Nick
Leeson, the so-called rogue trader working for the Singapore branch
of Barings. He funded his trading with millions of dollars of borrowed
money, and when the market turned against him, he brought
down Barings, the oldest bankin England and the one that financed
the Napoleonic wars and the Louisiana Purchase!
Leeson ostensibly was doing arbitrage trading, focusing on differences
in prices of Nikkei 225 futures contracts listed on the
Osaka Securities Exchange (OSE) in Japan and the Singapore Monetary
Exchange (SIMEX). He bought futures on one market and
simultaneously sold them on the other. This was a low-riskstrategy ,
since the two positions offset.
Its success led Leeson to another move, a straddle where he
80 A Tale of Two Markets
simultaneously sold put options and call options on Nikkei 225 futures.
This was a medium-riskstrategy , very effective in stable markets
but dangerous in volatile ones.
An earthquake that rocked Kobe, Japan, in January 1995 plunged
the Nikkei and terrorized Leeson. As the market roiled, Leeson acted
like a heroin addict and adopted the high-risk strategy of buying
more Nikkei futures in the vain hope of propping up the fallen market.
When the dust settled, Barings’s exposure on the futures contracts
ran to a staggering $1 billion, far in excess of Barings’s total
capital. The bankfell to its knees. Investigators discovered that Leeson’s
positions had been covered by Baring’s margin accounts while
he was trading, but after the crash—and after Leeson fled Singapore
for Germany—they were not.
During his trading, Leeson told Barings’s main branch in London
the plausible story that he was hedging his long futures positions
with private contracts and was also making hedged trades on behalf
of a client of the bank. In fact, the client did not exist but was a
fictitious name given to an account that Leeson invented earlier for
his own use.
Leeson allegedly funded that account with proceeds from other
trades and used those funds to maintain the margin account balance.
He apparently used the fictitious client account to convince Barings
in London to provide additional firm capital, which Lesson in turn
used to shore up the margin account. In the end, none of that was
enough.9
The Leeson lesson is admittedly an extreme psychological case
tripped up in a mix of exotic securities, excess margins, and fraud.
But the drama is a memorable warning that margins and exotica can
get you in over your head and that mixing them can get it handed
to you on a platter.
Options
A final warning on exotica takes us back to Ben Graham’s opinion
on options. Even before stockoption awards to managers became
commonplace, Graham disparaged the instruments on more general
grounds.
Options originally were attached to bonds and by the 1920s had
expanded as part of other financial innovations Graham regarded as
abusive. When they reappeared more widely in the 1960s, Graham
Take the Fifth 81
regarded “stockoption warrants” as they were then called, as “a near
fraud, an existing menace, and a potential disaster.” He believed they
created value out of thin air, had no excuse for existing except to
mislead people, and should be prohibited by law or at least capped
at a minor part of a company’s total capital.
The major negative effects of options are dilution of existing
shareholders’ ownership interest in the company—including existing
earnings per share, sharing in future growth, enjoying dividend payments,
voting for managers, and other major corporate changes such
as mergers and (a bit ironically) new option plans. Graham could
see no purpose in options generally other than to “fabricate imaginary
market values.” In short, Graham condemned stock options as
criminal, a monstrous and “wanton creation of huge paper-money.”10
Buffett echoes the point less vociferously by saying that “the
business project in which you would wish to have an option frequently
is a project in which you would reject ownership. (I’ll be
happy to accept a lottery ticket as a gift—but I’ll never buy one.)”11
The lesson for investors is clear. Stay away from options and stay as
far away as possible from companies in which options constitute a
significant portion of total capital.
ALCHEMY
Stockmark et bubbles occur when aggregate capital invested in equity
securities exceeds the amount of profitable deployment opportunities
so that prices exceed values by terrific multiples. They result
from the hope that the stocks people pick will turn out to be the
ones that enjoy the profits. But if, say, $100 billion is allocated to
ventures that can only give returns from profitable investments on
$10 billion, then $90 billion in disappointment is going to come—
90% of the dollars will be left standing without chairs to sit in when
the music stops.
The main difference between the musical chairs of market speculation
and the activity at the typical racetrackis that horse races
take only about two minutes to separate the gambler from her
money. What horse betting and the stockmark et do have in common,
however, is that those who study the horses or businesses and
who bet seldom are more likely to be winners than are those who
bet on every race or stock.12 In the early stages of a boom that may
bubble, if you can find the cinch stockat a low price and load up
82 A Tale of Two Markets
on that stock, it is reasonably likely that you will win; if you bet on
everything that comes down the track, it is most certain that you
will lose.
Those who bet on everything coming down the trackadd hot air
to the bubble. It is a large-scale version of the mania that leads to
around-the-blocklottery lines during hefty jackpots. What creates
most bubbles is the whiff of great riches from something new that
excites people and leads them to irrational behavior or at least herdlike
behavior.
The wildfire of excitement is spread by unchecked rumors of
champagne and caviar dreams come true—stories of riches, reinforced
by greed. The frenzy spirals, but ultimately breaks. In reality,
only one person wins the lottery jackpot and the multitudes experience
the most expensive case of “monkey see, monkey do.”
Edwin LeFe`vre put it nicely: “The appeal in all booms is always
frankly to the gambling instinct aroused by cupidity and spurred by
pervasive prosperity. People who lookfor easy money invariably pay
for the privilege of proving conclusively that it cannot be found on
this sordid earth.”13
Real investors are not the same people who wait in long lottery
ticket lines. They realize that “get rich quick” usually means “get
poor quicker.”
For a bit of de´ ja` vu, consider Graham’s observation from the late
1960s: “The speculative public is incorrigible. In financial terms it
cannot count beyond 3. It will buy anything, at any price, if there
seems to be some ‘action’ in progress. It will fall for any company
identified with ‘franchising,’ computers, electronics, science, technology,
or what have you, when the particular fashion is raging.”14
In Yogi Berra “it’s de´ ja` vu all over again” style, note this similar
vintage Graham lament: “Bright, energetic people—usually quite
young—have promised to perform miracles with ‘other people’s
money’ since time immemorial. They have usually been able to do
it for a while—or at least to appear to have done it—and they have
inevitably brought losses to their public in the end. . . . [I]t is probably
too much to expect that the urge to speculate will ever disappear,
or that the exploitation of that urge can ever be abolished.”15
The urge to speculate endures, with vast numbers of people
seeming to accept the declaration of hyperventilating venture capitalists
and day traders that the new economy of the late 1990s and
early 2000s means that the old rules of the game no longer apply.
An extraordinary statement of these times was uttered by the chief
Take the Fifth 83
economist of a prominent investment research firm who announced
to The New York Times that “we no longer thinkwe know how to
value companies” (to be kind, that confused confessor shall go unnamed
in this book).
Valuation has always been difficult, but how much harder now
can it be than it was before? Cash is the ultimate economic payoff.
If you can’t get to the point of figuring out how long it takes
to get cash and what risks may reduce the amount or value of it,
then it is not that you don’t know how to value companies anymore
but that the things you are trying to value are not worth trying
to value.
Proponents of financial alchemy shrinkfrom the mind-set of
business analysis discussed in this book, presumably deeming its
tools conventional, maybe even boring, dull, and old-fashioned.
When people want to be rich now, they relegate the idea of a nest
egg grown with patient discipline to the dustbin of the older generation’s
history, alien territory to freshly minted paper millionaires
and their envious contemporaries.
Unfortunately, this attitude leads to day gambling on stocks using
credit card debt and a “buy now, pay later” myopia that neglects
the inevitable day of reckoning. It also leads to the popularity of
techniques that enable false positive answers to key questions about
a business when traditional tools give negative answers.
In the biotechnology industry in the early to mid-1990s, for example,
fewer than 10% of companies generated earnings and few
even generated positive cash flows from their operating businesses.
But those companies needed new investment. Since the traditional
measures of business analysis could not tell a convincing story, they
turned to unorthodox measures. The most striking was a measure of
so-called performance known as “cash-burn.” This was the rate at
which a business was “able” to spend cash on new research projects.
The more burn, the better the management and the more desirable
the investment. Crazy?
It is not much crazier than the similar move made in the Internet
and high-technology industries of the late 1990s and early 2000s.
These financial entrepreneurs jettisoned the traditional metrics of
performance and value based on earnings and cash in favor of new
ways to look at these questions. Take market share, for example.
Entrepreneurs say, “Look, we have 60% of the market in selling
flowers (or whatnot) over the Internet, and you should give us credit
for that.” Or, more optimistically yet, “We have 10 million ‘hits’ on
84 A Tale of Two Markets
our Internet site every month. Even though we don’t make money,
that’s 20 million (or so) eyeballs, so we must be good, we must have
value, and you should invest with us.”
People do in droves, following a monkey see, monkey do mentality.
For most—though not all—of those businesses, the flood of
funds is unjustifiable in a business analysis mind-set. (The next
growth industry is likely to be Internet bankruptcy law firms.)
Every frenzy is accompanied by rational-sounding new rules that
attempt to explain the irrationality. In the last century alone, a “New
Era” bull market culminated in the 1929 crash (fueled by the spread
of wonderful new technologies such as cars, electricity, vacuum
cleaners, washing machines, radio, and talking movies), a “Second
New Era” flamed out in 1962’s “New Panic,” and a “New Performance
Phenomenon” preceded the implosion of markets and mutual
funds in the late 1960s. The stockmark et bubble in Japan in the
1980s was fueled by the widespread belief that Japan had created a
“new” economic model that defied the historical principles of economics.
Market share was king, and companies were rewarded if
they had it and rewarded more if they got it at the price of having
no or low profits, much as in 1990s–2000s U.S. markets.16
This is not to say that market share is irrelevant. Market share
is a standard and useful indicator of the relative performance of
Coke compared to Pepsi, for example, and something both these
companies pursue aggressively in their competition in the beverage
marketplace. And it is significant that Cisco has 80% of the router
market and 30 to 40% in network switches and that DuPont dominates
global markets in nylon and Lycra. That kind of market scale
enables a company to lower the cost of sales and general and administrative
expenses, which translates into higher profits.
But Coke, Pepsi, Cisco, and DuPont make money in their markets.
A larger share of a profitable market is certainly desirable and
a good indicator of strong business performance. The same can hardly
be said for a larger share of an unprofitable one. On the contrary,
the greater your share is, the more money you lose.
Aggressive accumulation of market share can be perfectly disastrous
for a business. Lookat what happened to the airline industry
after deregulation. Intense competition for market share drove nearly
all the profits out of that business. The same thing occurs in the
submarkets where Coke and Pepsi compete, driving profits at bottlers
for those brands close to zero in some places.
Nor is this to deny that technological changes from the 1980s to
Take the Fifth 85
the 2000s produced significant shifts in the economy. Rising oil
prices, for example, historically throttled the economy, sponsoring
the recessions of 1973, 1980, and, to a lesser degree, 1990. Yet when
oil prices more than doubled during the late 1990s and early 2000s,
inflation remained quite low and no threat of recession loomed. Part
of the reason was a shift to natural gas and greater use by major oil
consumers (such as airlines) of hedging contracts that reduced their
exposure to such price increases.
But a major part of the reason is econographic shifts from oilconsuming
manufacturing operations to oil-independent service
businesses, including those run on the Internet. Manufacturing operations
as a percentage of the economy shrankfrom 22% in 1977
to 17% twenty years later. The share of gross domestic product (GDP)
allocated to oil purchases fell from 8.5% in 1981 to about 3% in the
late 1990s. The Internet is surely part of this shift, as it enables the
conduct of sales and distribution businesses at far lower cost than
traditional means.17
Even so, oil prices above some level will still trigger such macroeconomic
problems. Indeed, the plunge in the Dow by nearly 4%
in March 2000 was led by a 30% drop in the stockprice of Procter
& Gamble. That company issued a warning that its quarterly earnings
were going to be way lower than those in the same quarter of
the prior year and much lower than analysts expected. The company
cited as one cause of that disappointment the rising cost of oil,
which it uses in many of its products.
Another part of the shift is surely the increasing value attached
to intellectual as opposed to physical capital. Businesses producing
and selling software or on-line services can grow more quickly and
at lower cost than can those producing and selling automobiles or
oil. Far less investment in factories, plants, and equipment is required.
There is no reason to believe, however, that those companies as
a whole can grow any faster than the economy overall is growing. In
the end, the old-fashioned companies (the so-called old economy
companies) are the major customers (and beneficiaries) of the tech
upstarts (the so-called new economy companies), so how much faster
can the latter group grow than the former? Some companies
might, but not forever or just because they have in the past (indeed,
the bigger you get, the harder it is to grow). Even if outsized growth
is possible, it cannot be guaranteed.
Even with these shifts, the new economy does not change the
86 A Tale of Two Markets
basic facts of business life that call for investing based on an understanding
of a company’s business climate; some key ratios must
be in the tool box of all smart investors. Even if some of the new
economy business metrics are used, they should be analyzed critically.
Ignoring losses is foolish, but ignoring signs of endurance is
downright stupid.
If you accept growing market share as an indication of future
value, for example, you also have to recognize that slowdowns in
customer growth are a sign of reduced future value. You must agree
that when revenues per new customer fall while costs per new customer
climb, you go from uncertain to bad. These facts are characteristic
of many Internet companies whose stockprices actually
rise on this kind of news. These companies include some of the best
names in the “space,” giving reason to thinkthat the new economy
may just be a wolf in sheep’s clothing. After all, something that
seems too good to be true usually is.
People talkof the new millennium and the unmatched pace of
technological change, but this impression is mistaken. If you comb
through the annals of economic and investment writing over the
centuries, you will discover repeated periodic references to the rapid
pace of technological change and declarations that nothing like it
has ever been seen (historians dubbed the late 1890s and early 1900s
the Age of Optimism, imbued with technological excitement that
makes centennial turns seem the natural apotheoses of exuberance).
Just pause to consider the printing press, the agricultural and industrial
revolutions, the assembly line, television and radio, and now
computers and the Internet.
Even the sober Ben Graham felt constrained to report on the
sense of his time, writing in the relatively recent period of the early
1970s that: “the rapid and pervasive growth of technology in recent
years is not without major effect on the attitude and the labors of
the security analyst. More so than in the past, the progress or retrogression
of the typical company in the coming decade may depend
on its relation to new products and new processes.”18 To repeat what
Graham was fond of saying, plus c¸a change, plus c¸a la meˆme chose.
THE LONG RUN
The attitude that drives any mania is as shortsighted as it is shortlived.
Investors need to looklong down the road of years rather than
Take the Fifth 87
the path of days when thinking about business and returns. How far
will vary with the person’s age and needs, but a minimum time frame
for anyone serious about investing is four years—and way longer for
most of us.
It is customary to call people with a long-term view “long-term
investors” and to say that such investors adopt a “buy-and-hold”
strategy. Apart from using redundant vocabulary (an investor, by definition,
is always dealing in the long term), these characterizations
are imprecise.
One reason to lookat the long term is to realize that while early
investing is better, no one needs to make an investment every day
or even every year. As Warren Buffett says, using a baseball analogy,
there is no such thing as a called strike in investing—no penalty for
sitting backand waiting for your pitch to come in. If a characterization
of this style of view is necessary, it is more apt to call it the
“wait-and-see” approach than the “buy-and-hold” approach.
Either of these approaches, however, is superior to the promiscuous
practices of speculative traders. It is true, to an extent, that
today’s rookie companies are tomorrow’s classics, but it is false, to
a fault, that day traders and their ilkact on this insight. The average
holding period for the top 50 Nasdaq stocks in late 1999 was less
than 30 days, and for Nasdaq stocks as a whole it was about 150
days (compared to about 730 days in the late 1980s).19 That kind of
turnover means the speculators are neither picking stocks carefully
(a wait-and-see approach) nor buying them for the long term (a buyand-
hold approach).
Keynes famously quipped that in the long run we are all dead.
But he wasn’t talking about stock picking. Keynes made that comment
in the context of persuading policy makers to focus on shortterm
needs that could be met, he believed, only by governmental
rather than market actions. Indeed, the phrase makes no sense in
the stock-picking context, since it is always better to be rich later
than to be poor sooner and most of us will leave family survivors.
Ben Graham expressly referred to stocks when he said that in
the short run the market is a voting machine, while in the long run
it is a weighing machine. This means that the market is risky in the
short run for its wild pricing gyrations but gets relatively stable and
safer over the long run. But what does it mean to say that the market
will eventually price an asset correctly? Doesn’t it mean that the
market is sometimes correct—that it must, as Alice said in Wonderland,
“sometimes come to jam today”? Not exactly.
88 A Tale of Two Markets
Milton Friedman’s rejoinder to Keynes was that the long run is
just a series of short runs linked in succession. Thus the long run
is simultaneously with us (it was the long run four years ago) and
ahead of us (four years from now). Market price today reflects the
value of a business as long ago as four years, and the price today is
a guess about business productivity and returns some four years from
now. If your guess is better than the market’s, then while four years
from now the market may be getting today’s value of that business
right, you will be that much ahead.
That is the sense in which the market may get it right in the
long term: Four years from now the market will get correct what
Starbucks is doing today; if you are able to assess that performance
better than today’s market crowd is doing, you will reap outsized
returns. The hard question, of course, is how to make that determination
with high success rates.
Warren Buffett takes Keynes seriously, adopting the “till death
do us part” standard. He invests only in businesses he would be
happy to hold forever. It is a commitment not unlike the one you
make to your spouse. The consequence is the same: be patient and
picky in your search.
P a r t II
SHOW ME
THE MONEY
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
This page intentionally left blank.
91
C h a p t e r 6
APPLE TREES AND
EXPERIENCE
If market price is the last thing an investor or manager shouldlook
at in determining the value of a business or an ownership interest
in it, the first thing to consider is its fundamental economic characteristics.
There are so many approaches to appraising those fundamentals
that many people use the relatively lazy metric of market
price as a guideline in valuation, but that is a mistake. Of all the
approaches to appraising business value, just a few do virtually all
the hardwork, andthose are the ones you need. A parable will
illustrate the basics, andthe rest of this part will fill in the details.1
FOOLS AND WISDOM
Once there was a wise oldman who ownedan apple tree. It was a
fine tree, andwith little care it produceda crop of apples each year
which he soldfor $100. The man wantedto retire to a new climate,
and he decided to sell the tree. He enjoyed teaching a good lesson,
andhe placedan advertisement in the business opportunities section
of The Wall Street Journal in which he saidhe wantedto sell the
tree for “the best offer.”
Some Red Herrings
The first person to respondto the adoffered to pay $50, which, he
said, was what he could get for selling the apple tree for firewood
after he cut it down. “You don’t know what you are talking about,”
the oldman chastised. “You are offering to pay only the salvage value
of this tree. That might be a goodprice for a pine tree or even this
tree if it hadstoppedbearing fruit or if the price of apple wood had
gotten so high that the tree was more valuable as a source of wood
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
92 Show Me the Money
than as a source of fruit. But you are obviously not competent to
understand these things, so you can’t see that my tree is worth far
more than 50 bucks.”
The next person who visitedthe oldman offeredto pay $100 for
the tree. “For that,” she opined, “is what I would be able to get for
selling this year’s crop of fruit, which is about to mature.” “You are
not as out of your depth as the first one,” responded the old man.
“At least you see that this tree has more value as a producer of apples
than it wouldas a source of firewood. But $100 is not the right price.
You are not considering the value of next year’s crop of apples or
that of the years after. Please take your $100 andgo elsewhere.”
The thirdperson to come along was a young man who had just
dropped out of business school. “I am going to sell apples on the
Internet,” he said. “I figure that the tree should live for at least
another 15 years. If I sell the apples for $100 a year, that will total
$1,500. I offer you $1,500 for your tree.” “Oh, no, dot-commer,” lamentedthe
man, “you’re even more ill informedabout reality than
the others I’ve spoken with.”
“Surely the $100 you wouldearn by selling the apples from the
tree 15 years from now cannot be worth $100 to you today. In fact,
if you placed$41.73 today in a bank account paying 6% interest,
compounded annually, that small sum would grow to $100 at the end
of 15 years. So the present value of $100 worth of apples 15 years
from now, assuming an interest rate of 6%, is only $41.73 not $100.
Pray,” advised the beneficent old man, “take your $1,500 and invest
it safely in high-grade corporate bonds and go back to business
school andlearn something about finance.”
Before long there came a wealthy physician who said, “I don’t
know much about apple trees, but I know what I like. I’ll pay the
market price for it. The last fellow was willing to pay you $1,500 for
the tree, andso it must be worth that.”
“Doctor,” advisedthe oldman, “you should get yourself a knowledgeable
investment adviser. If there were truly a market in which
apple trees were traded with some regularity, the prices at which
they were soldmight tell you something about their value. But not
only is there no such market, even if there were, taking its price as
the value is just mimicking the stupidity of that last knucklehead or
the others before him. Please take your money andbuy a vacation
home.”
The next would-be buyer was an accounting student. When the
old man asked, “What price are you willing to give me?” the student
Apple Trees and Experience 93
first demandedto see the oldman’s books. The oldman had kept
careful records and gladly brought them out.
After examining them, the accounting student said, “Your books
show that you paid$75 for this tree ten years ago. Furthermore, you
have made no deductions for depreciation. I do not know if that
conforms with generally acceptedaccounting principles, but assuming
that it does, the book value of your tree is $75. I will pay that.”
“Ah, you students know so much and yet so little,” chided the
oldman. “It is true that the book value of my tree is $75, but any
fool can see that it is worth far more than that. You hadbest go back
to school andsee if you can finda book that shows you how to use
your numbers to better effect.”
A Dialogue on Earnings
The final prospect to visit the oldman was a young stockbroker who
hadrecently graduatedfrom business school. Eager to test her new
skills, she too askedto examine the books. After several hours she
came back to the oldman andsaidshe was prepared to make an
offer that valuedthe tree on the basis of the capitalization of its
earnings. For the first time the oldman’s interest was piqued, and
he askedher to go on.
The young woman explainedthat while the apples were sold for
$100 last year, that figure did not represent the profits realized from
the tree. There were expenses attendant to the tree, such as the cost
of fertilizer, pruning, tools, picking apples, andcarting them to town
andselling them.
Somebody had to do those things, and a portion of the salaries
paidto those persons ought to be charged against the revenues from
the tree. Moreover, the purchase price, or cost, of the tree was an
expense. A portion of the cost is taken into account each year of the
tree’s useful life. Finally, there were taxes. She concluded that the
profit from the tree was $50 last year.
“Wow!” The old man blushed. “I thought I made $100 off that
tree.”
“That’s because you failedto match expenses with revenues, in
accordance with generally accepted accounting principles,” she explained.
“You don’t actually have to write a check to be charged with
what accountants consider to be your expenses. For example, you
bought a station wagon some time ago andusedit part of the time
to cart apples to market. The wagon will last a while, andeach year
94 Show Me the Money
some of the original cost has to be matchedagainst revenues. A
portion of the amount has to be spreadout over the next several
years even though you expended it all at one time. Accountants call
that depreciation. I’ll bet you never figured that in your calculation
of profits.”
“I’ll bet you’re right,” he replied. “Tell me more.”
“I also went back into the books for a few years andsaw that in
some years the tree produced fewer apples than it did in other years,
the prices varied, and the costs were not exactly the same each year.
Taking an average of only the last three years, I came up with a
figure of $45 as a fair sample of the tree’s earnings. But that is only
half of what we have to do to figure the value.”
“What’s the other half?” he asked.
“The tricky part,” she toldhim. “We now have to figure the value
to me of owning a tree that will produce average annual earnings of
$45 a year. If I believedthat the tree was a ‘one-year wonder,’ I would
say 100% of its value—as a going business—was representedby one
year’s earnings.”
“But if we agree that the tree is more like a corporation in that
it will continue to produce earnings year after year, the key is to
figure out an appropriate rate of return. In other words, I will be
investing my capital in the tree, andI need to compute the value to
me of an investment that will produce $45 a year in income. We can
call that amount the capitalizedvalue of the tree.”
“Do you have something in mind?” he asked.
“I’m getting there. If this tree produced entirely steady and predictable
earnings each year, it would be like a U.S. Treasury bond.
But its earnings are not guaranteed, so we have to take into account
risks anduncertainty . If the risk of its ruin was high, I would insist
that a single year’s earnings represent a higher percentage of the
value of the tree. After all, apples couldbecome a glut on the market
one day andyou wouldhave to cut the price, thus increasing the
costs of selling them.”
“Or,” she continued, “some doctor could discover a link between
eating an apple a day and heart disease. A drought could cut the
yield of the tree. Or the tree could become diseasedandd ie. These
are all risks. Andwe don’t even know whether the costs we are sure
to incur will be worth incurring.”
“You are a gloomy one,” reflectedthe oldman. “There could also
be a shortage of apples on the market, andthe price of apples could
rise. If you think about it, it is even possible that I have been selling
Apple Trees and Experience 95
the apples at prices below what people wouldbe willing to pay and
that you couldraise the price without reducing your sales. Also,
there are treatments, you know, that couldbe appliedto increase
the yieldof the tree. This tree could help spawn a whole orchard.
Any of these wouldincrease earnings.”
“The earnings also couldbe increasedby lowering costs of the
sort you mentioned,” the old man continued. “Costs can be reduced
by speeding the time from fruition to sale, managing extensions of
credit better, and minimizing losses from bad apples. Cutting costs
boosts the relationship between overall sales andnet earnings or, as
the financial types say, the tree’s profit margin. Andthat in turn
wouldboost the return on your investment.”
“I am aware of all that,” she assuredhim. “The fact is, we are
talking about risk. Andinvestment analysis is a coldbusiness. We
don’t know with certainty what’s going to happen. You want your
money now, andI’m supposed to live with the risk.
“That’s fine with me, but then I have to look through a cloudy
crystal ball, andnot with 20/20 hindsight. Andmy resources are
limited. I have to choose between your tree and the strawberry patch
down the road. I cannot buy both, and the purchase of your tree
will deprive me of alternative investments. That means I have to
compare the opportunities andthe risks.
“To determine a proper rate of return,” she continued, “I looked
at investment opportunities comparable to the apple tree, particularly
in the agribusiness industry, where these factors have been
taken into account. I then adjusted my findings based on how the
things we discussedworkedout with your tree. Based on those judgments,
I figure that 20% is an appropriate rate of return for the tree.
“In other words,” she concluded, “assuming that the average
earnings from the tree over the last three years (which seems to be
a representative period) are indicative of the return I will receive, I
am preparedto pay a price for the tree that will give me a 20% return
on my investment. I am not willing to accept any lower rate of return
because I don’t have to; I can always buy the strawberry patch instead.
Now, to figure the price, we simply divide $45 of earnings per
year by the 20% return I am insisting on.”
“Long division was never my strong suit. Is there a simpler way
of doing the figuring?” he asked hopefully.
“There is,” she assuredhim. “We can use an approach we Wall
Street types prefer, calledthe price-earnings (or P/E) ratio. To compute
the ratio, just divide 100 by the rate of return we are seeking.
96 Show Me the Money
If I were willing to settle for an 8% return, that would be 100 divided
by 8, which equals 12.5. So we’duse a P/E ratio of 12.5 to 1. But
since I want to earn 20% on my investment, I divided 100 by 20 and
came up with a P/E ratio of 5:1. In other words, I am willing to pay
five times the tree’s estimatedannual earnings. Multiplying $45 by
5, I get a value of $225. That’s my offer.”
The oldman sat back andsaidhe greatly appreciated the lesson.
He wouldhave to think about her offer, andhe askedif she could
come by the next day.
A Dialogue on Cash
When the young woman returned, she found the old man emerging
from behinda sea of work sheets, small print columns of numbers,
and a calculator. “Delighted to see you,” he said, enthralled. “I think
we can do business.
“It’s easy to see how you Wall Street smarties make so much
money, buying people’s property for less than its true value. I think
I can get you to agree that my tree is worth more than you figured.”
“I’m open-minded,” she assured him.
“The $45 number you came up with yesterday was something
you calledprofits, or earnings that I earnedin the past. I’m not so
sure it tells you anything that important.”
“Of course it does,” she protested. “Profits measure efficiency
andeconomic utility.”
“Fair enough,” he mused, “but it sure doesn’t tell you how much
money you’re getting. I lookedin my safe yesterday after you left
and saw some stock certificates I own that never paid a dividend to
me. AndI kept getting reports each year telling me how great the
earnings were. Now I know that the earnings increasedthe value of
my stocks, but without any dividends I couldn’t spend them. It’s just
the opposite with the tree.
“You figuredthe earnings were lower because of some amounts
I’ll never have to spend, like depreciation on my station wagon,” the
oldman went on. “It seems to me these earnings are an idea worked
up by the accountants.”
Intrigued, she asked, “What is important, then?”
“Cash,” he answered. “I’m talking about dollars you can spend,
save, or give to your children. This tree will go on for years yielding
revenues after costs. Andit is the future, not the past, we need to
reckon with.”
Apple Trees and Experience 97
“Don’t forget the risks,” she reminded him. “And the uncertainties.”
“Quite right,” he observed. “If we can agree on the possible range
of future revenues andcosts andthat earnings averaged around $45
the last few years, we can make some fair estimates of cash flow
over the coming five years: How about that there is a 25% chance
that cash flow will be $40, a 50% chance it will be $50, anda 25%
chance it will be $60?
“That makes $50 our best guess if you average it out,” the old
man figured. “Then let’s just say that for ten years after that the
average will be $40. Andthat’s it. The tree doctor tells me it can’t
produce any longer than that.
“Now all we have to do,” he finished up, “is figure out what you
pay today to get $50 a year from now, two years from now, and so
on for the first five years until we figure what you wouldpay to get
$40 a year for each of the ten years after that. Then, throw in the
20 bucks we can get for firewood.
“Simple,” she confessed. “You want to discount to the present
value of future receipts including salvage value. Of course you need
to determine the rate at which you discount.”
“Precisely,” he concurred. “That’s what my charts and the calculator
are for.” She nodded as he showed her discount tables that
revealed what a dollar received at a later time is worth today under
different assumptions about the discount rate. It showed, for example,
that at an 8% discount rate, a dollar delivered a year from
now is worth $.93 today, simply because $.93 today, invested at 8%,
will produce $1 a year from now.
“You couldput your money in a savings account that is insured
andreceive 5% interest. But you couldalso buy U.S. Treasury obligations
with it and earn, say, 8% interest, depending on prevailing
interest rates. That looks like the risk-free rate of interest to me.
Anywhere else you put your money deprives you of the opportunity
to earn 8% risk-free. Discounting by 8% will only compensate you
for the time value of the money you invest in the tree rather than
in Treasuries. But the cash flow from the apple tree is not riskless,
sadto say, so we needto use a higher discount rate to compensate
you for the risk in your investment.
“Let’s agree to discount the receipt of $50 a year from now by
15%, andso on with the other deferredreceipts. That is about the
rate that is appliedto investments with this magnitude of risk. You
can check that out with my neighbor, who just soldhis strawberry
98 Show Me the Money
patch yesterday. According to my figures, the present value of the
expectedyearly profit is $268.05, andtod ay’s value of the firewood
is $2.44, for a grandtotal of $270.49. I’ll take $270 even. You can
see how much I’m allowing for risk because if I discounted the
stream at 8%, it wouldcome to $388.60.”
After a few minutes of reflection, the young woman saidto the
oldman, “It was a bit foxy of you yesterday to let me appear to be
teaching you something. Where did you learn so much about finance
as an apple grower?”
The old man smiled. “Wisdom comes from experience in many
fields.”
“I enjoyedthis little exercise, but let me tell you something that
some financial whiz kids told me,” she replied. “Whether we figure
value on the basis of the discounted cash flow method you like or
the capitalization of earnings I proposed, so long as we apply both
methods perfectly, we should come out at exactly the same point.”
“Of course!” the old man exclaimed. “The wunderkinds are
catching on. The clever ones are not simply looking at oldearnings
but copying managers by projecting cash flows into the future. The
question is which methodis more likely to be misused.
“I prefer my methodof using cash rather than earnings because
I don’t have to monkey around with costs like depreciation of my
station wagon andother long-term assets. You have to make these
arbitrary assumptions about the useful life of the thing andhow fast
you’re going to depreciate it. That’s where I think you went wrong
in your figuring.”
“Nice try, you crafty old devil,” she rejoined. “You know there is
plenty of room for mistakes in your calculations too. It’s easy to
discount cash flows when they are nice and steady, but that doesn’t
help you when you’ve got some lumpy expenses that do not recur.
For example, several years from now that tree will needserious pruning
andspraying that don’t show up in your flow. The labor and
chemicals for that once-only occasion throw off the evenness of your
calculations.”
“But I’ll tell you what,” she belliedup. “I’ll offer you $250. My
coldanalysis tells me I’m overpaying, but I really like that tree. I
think the delight of sitting in its glorious shade must be worth something.”
“It’s a deal,” agreedthe oldman. “I never said I was looking for
the highest offer but only the best offer.”
Apple Trees and Experience 99
Lessons
The parable of the oldman andthe tree introduced a number of
alternative methods of valuing productive property, whether a single
asset or an entire business enterprise. The original $50 bidwas based
on the tree’s salvage value, also sometimes calledits scrap value.
This valuation methodwill virtually always be inappropriate for valuing
a productive asset, business, or share of stock (though many
bust-up takeover artists of the 1980s popularizedthe opposite claim).
The $100 bidwas basedonly on one year’s earnings and ignores
the earning power over future time. The Internet apple maven’s
$1,500 overvaluation ignoredthe concept of the time value of money
by simply adding together the raw dollar amounts of expected earnings
over future years. Neither of these approaches even qualifies as
an appropriate valuation method.
The doctor’s bid drew on a market-based valuation technique
that considers what other willing buyers had offered. But that technique
will be helpful only if the property under consideration or
similar properties are regularly traded in reasonably well developed
markets. Even then, it is circular because it uses the question
(What’s it worth, according to others?) to get the answer (What it’s
worth, according to others).
The deal was ultimately sealed when the buyer and the old man
agreedthat the two methods they used—capitalizing earnings and
discounting cash flows—made the most sense (noting that these two
techniques, if perfectly applied, give the same answer). The buyer
preferredto use earnings because accounting rules regarding earnings
are intended to reflect economic reality pretty well. The old man
hadless confidence in those rules principally because they call for
deducting from revenues accounting depreciation, which he was not
sure accurately reflectedeconomic reality.
Although reasonable people can differ, both methods show that
valuation is not a fool’s game. The buyer andthe oldman both wisely
and rightly acknowledged the importance of keen judgment in business
analysis. As the type of investment you consider becomes more
uncertain, your judgment must become proportionately more razorsharp.
Picking an index fundor even a mutual fundrequires the least
amount of knowledge or judgment; picking a classic stock a bit more,
a vintage stock much more, anda rookie stock the greatest. In terms
of apples, the apple tree the oldman just soldis much like a classic
100 Show Me the Money
business, a GE, say, or DuPont or UnitedT echnologies. It is mature
andprod uctive andhas an extensive track record.
At the other extreme might be a dot-com start-up business whose
only recordis on paper—a business plan that is the apple tree equivalent
of a bag of seeds. Even if the ingredients are there, the execution
is entirely in front of you. You may still have a basis for gauging
the probable future—the quality of the seeds, soil, fertilizer, and
farmer—but you are leaving more to judgment than in the case of
the mature tree.
A few additional morals of the parable: Methods are useful as
tools, but good judgment comes not from methods alone but from
experience. Andexperience comes from bad judgment. Listen
closely to the experts andhear the things they don’t tell you. Behind
all the sweet sounds of their confident notes there is a great
deal of discordant uncertainty. One wrong assumption can carry
you pretty far from the truth. Finally, you are never too young to
learn.
HORSE SENSE
The oldman andhis ultimate buyer shared a business analysis mindset.
That mind-set focuses on individual businesses but must be
formed against the backdrop of a few general conditions—what
economists call macroeconomic conditions: interest rates, taxes, inflation,
andthe time value of money (or compounding).
Compounding
A powerful andintuitive introduction to the time value of money is
given by this characteristically witty vignette by a 32-year-oldW arren
Buffett:
I have it from unreliable sources that the cost of the voyage
Isabella originally underwrote for Columbus was approximately
$30,000. This has been considered at least a moderately successful
utilization of venture capital.Without attempting to evaluate
the psychic income derived from finding a new hemisphere,
it must be pointedout that . . . the whole deal was not exactly
another IBM. Figuredvery roughly, the $30,000 invested at 4%
compounded annually would have amounted to something like
$2,000,000,000,000. . . .
Apple Trees and Experience 101
That is $2 trillion—basedon a quite modest 4% rate of return.
Not only nothing to sneeze at but something to be joyous over. Buffett
calledthis vignette “The Joys of Compounding.”
It explains the apocryphal story of Buffett riding up a crowded
office building elevator. All heads were staring up at the floor numbers
lighting across the top, while Buffett was scouring the elevator
floor. As he walkedout, Buffett stoopedd own and picked up a penny
lying on the floor. The doors closedbehindhim, smirks crossed some
passengers’ faces, and one rider remarked, “That is the start of the
next billion.”
If you think a penny today does not amount to a hill of beans,
consider how much it will grow to over time! That is the joy of future
values of money—they get higher the more compounding there is.
You get compounding in two ways. You can put money away earlier
rather than later, and you can get returns (interest or dividends) paid
more frequently andreinvest them too. That is why building wealth
calls for saving early andoften, though investing only when the price
is right.
Investors grasp the joys of compounding, for it is a useful tool
to evaluate competing opportunities quickly. A handy reference for
making the comparisons gauges how long it takes a given amount of
money to double at varying compounded rates of return (or interest
rates).
Calledthe rule of 72s, it says that dividing 72 by the rate of
return gives the approximate number of years it takes for an amount
of money to double. For example, an investment yielding a compounded
rate of return of 9% will double in about eight years (72
divided by 9 equals 8) and one yielding 6% will double in about 12
years (72 divided by 6 equals 12).
The rule of 72s can show all sorts of variations on the relationship
between money in handnow andmoney to be gotten in the
future. For example, it can determine what required rate of return
is necessary for a certain sum to grow to a desired sum in the future.
Or if you know what rate of return is available or possible, it can
figure how much money someone needs today in order for it to grow
to a desired level at some future time.
Take an example. If the available average rate of return on money
from now until 40 years from now is 9%, how much money does a
25-year-old person need today in order to retire as a millionaire at
age 65 without saving another cent over that time? Work backward
from ending up with $1,000,000 at age 65. Since money earning a
102 Show Me the Money
compoundrate of return of 9% doubles approximately every 8 years,
at age 57 she’dneedto have $500,000; at age 49 she’d need to have
$250,000; at age 41 she’dneedto have $125,000; at age 33 she’d
needto have $62,500; andtod ay, at age 25, she’dneed to have (only)
$31,250!
If this illustrates the joy in compounding, take another use of
the rule of 72s to illustrate the joy of slightly higher rates of return.
Assume that insteadof being able to earn about a 9% rate of return
over the next 40 years, our 25-year-oldcan only reasonably expect a
6% rate of return. Now her money will double approximately only
every 12 years rather than every 8. So 12 years hence at age 37 she’d
have $62,500; at age 49 she’dhave $125,000; at age 61 she’d have
$250,000; at age 73 she’dhave $500,000; andshe’dhave to reach
the ripe age of 85 to endup with a million!
Interest Rates
A subtle but most important lesson of the apple tree parable is the
pivotal role interest rates play in the value of assets. The oldman
mentionedthat U.S. Treasury instruments provide a risk-free rate of
interest. That benchmark interest rate is a major determinant of the
value of any other asset in the economy, including the value of whole
businesses andshares of stock in them. The risk-free rate sets the
standard of value of assets with risk. The higher the risk-free rate,
the lower the values of riskier assets; the lower the risk-free rate, the
higher the values of riskier assets.
As Warren Buffett reflectedin a rare public commentary preparedfor
Fortune by Carol Loomis, when the risk-free rate was very
high in the late 1960s and1970s, for example, the average price of
stocks was depressed.2 The Dow hardly moved an inch in price from
the early 1960s to the late 1970s because for investors to buy stocks,
they hadto get a return that exceeded the sky-high risk-free interest
rate. When the risk-free rate was very low from the mid-1980s to the
early 2000s, in contrast, average stock prices shot up. The Dow enjoyedthe
greatest bull market in history because the risk-free rate
was so low that it was relatively easy for investors to get a risk premium
(returns above the risk-free rate).
Taxes
The only thing more mind-boggling about amateur day trading than
the outright losses that are rackedup is how many among the trading
Apple Trees and Experience 103
winners neglect how much they are losing to tax payments both
outright andin terms of the time value lost by the payments.
Suppose you buy an investment that pays 15% per year for 30
years andkeep that investment compounding yearly until the end of
that time without being obligatedto pay taxes on it. Suppose also
that you are taxedon your income from that investment at the end
of that thirtieth year at a rate of 35%. This means your after-tax
annual rate of return on that investment was about 13.3%. Hardto
beat.
Suppose insteadthat your 15% per year investment for 30 years
pays you that 15% annually andsubjects you to tax of 35% each year
you get it. Your annual after-tax return suddenly shrinks to about
9.75%. Not a badnet return, you say, but that is over 3.5% less than
the tax-deferred position. And now we are talking about huge sums,
with that 3.5% difference compounding over periods such as 30
years.
The same is true at every level of return differentials and remains
quite substantial even at lower rates of return. A 10% pretax return
with taxes due only at the end of 30 years gives you an after-tax
return of about 8.3%, comparedwith about a 6.5% after-tax return
if you hadpaid taxes on that income each year. Again, that kind of
2% difference compounded over a few decades works out to be lots
of dollars.3
Inflation
Our parable’s business school dropout did not know that the value
of money across time is nonlinear. Inflation often differs from returns,
andreturns differ from each other. Annual inflation of 4%
means that a basket of goods that can be bought for $100 on January
1 costs $104 on December 31. But if during that year you put $100
in a savings account paying 8%, your balance at the endof that year
would be $108. Left uninvested, that $100 would decline in purchasing
power to about $96, whereas the investedamount gives you
a purchasing power of about $104 (the $108 you have less the impact
on its buying power of the 4% inflation).
These macroeconomic factors bear on value. Tax andinflation
in particular determine how much your gross return will give you in
increasedpurchasing power. Changes in interest rates require revising
any valuations made under different interest rate assumptions.
Operating as a business analyst requires knowledge of these things
104 Show Me the Money
but not their prediction. As Buffett says, “We do not have, never
have had, and never will have an opinion about where the stock
market, interest rates, or business activity will be a year from now.”4
Still, you can’t avoideating a little spinach in the enterprise of investing.
Those who dine on the business investor’s rigorous diet
emerge more muscular andfit from the meal. Course two is served
up next.
105
C h a p t e r 7
YOUR CIRCLE OF
COMPETENCE
Investors avoidstocks outside their circle of competence; those
who buy stocks outside their circle of competence are gamblers,
speculators, or fools. If you lack the grounds for understanding a
business—grounds ultimately for estimating a gap between value
andprice —but make a purchase anyway, you may as well be at a
Las Vegas or Atlantic City blackjack table or a local poker party. All
you are really doing is guessing, hoping, maybe even praying that
things work out your way. Yet there is little reason, other than dumb
luck, to think they will.
The first thing you must do before investing in any business is
make sure you have a basic understanding of that business. This
requires some familiarity with its products, customers, selling environment,
andso on—in short, its operating climate.
It is quite a different proposition to understand businesses, such
as Procter & Gamble, that make andsell a wide variety of familiar
consumer products such as peanut butter, soap, and toothpaste than
it is to understand businesses, such as Applied Materials, that make
andsell a wide variety of highly technical materials for the semiconductor
industry such as expitaxial and polysilicon deposition, etch,
ion, implantation, and metrology (understand?).
Getting the information necessary to determine whether a business
is within your circle of competence before making an investment
decision is easy. Check out the SEC-maintained Free-
Edgar.com Web site or contact the SEC at its Washington, D.C., or
various regional offices. Or check out each company’s Web site directly.
You can even search the SEC Edgar database on lots of other
Web sites, including 10kwizard.com, Edgarspace, and Edgaronline.
Findthe section in the company’s annual report called management’s
discussion and analysis of the business. This is a narrative
assessment of the business that shouldhelp andtest your under-
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
106 Show Me the Money
standing of it. Another useful source to consult is the chairman’s or
CEO’s letter, as much for what it says as for what it does not say
about the business. You will learn an enormous amount by reading
just a few of these reports, andthe more you read, the better able
you will be to evaluate them.
THE INITIAL CIRCLE
Circles of competence should be drawn according to your ability and
willingness to understand a business and its operating climate. Your
circle’s boundaries are defined by your knowledge and aptitude; its
contents are companies about which you can make an intelligent
investment decision in light of those boundaries. Omit from your
circle businesses that are too hardfor you to understand or that
change too rapidly for you to keep up with.
To define your circle of competence, start with your own industry.
Retail store managers probably have a head start in understanding
CVS, Walgreen’s, Gap, andHome Depot; restaurant employees,
in understanding McDonald’s. People in the energy business tend
to know that business andwill have a leg up on Exxon-Mobil, Enron,
andT exaco. Engineers andscientists will have a better shot at understanding
Dow Chemical and DuPont, and telecommunications
devotees have a goodshot at MCI, AT&T, andLucent. Doctors
shouldcertainly have an edge in evaluating pharmaceutical concerns
such as Eli Lilly andPfizer . Farmers may be able to evaluate John
Deere better than the average Wall Street banker can.
Think also about the things you buy anduse andhow you do
so. You may know more about companies such as American Home
Products, BMW, Federal Express, and Sony than you think, or at
least you may be able to understand them better than you think. Try
Hershey’s andNestle´ if you are a chocolate lover, Anheuser-Busch
or Heineken if you drink a lot of beer, and Tiffany’s if diamonds are
your best friend.
Do the same with regional companies in your area. Public utilities
such as ConEdin New York andBlack Hills in the Rocky Mountains
(South Dakota, Wyoming, andMontana) andregional banks
such as First Oaks in Chicago, Wilshire in Los Angeles, andAlabama
National in the Southeast (Alabama, Georgia, andFlorid a) should
be easy andinteresting to examine for people living in those areas.
So too are similarly locatedlarger companies, say, Boeing in Seattle,
Your Circle of Competence 107
Coca-Cola in Atlanta, Kimberly-Clark in Dallas, andJohnson Controls
in Milwaukee.
How do the companies which seem a natural fit for your circle
of competence relate to less obvious ones that fit just as well? If you
are in retail, what about apparel companies such as Gucci, Polo
Ralph Lauren, andHe`rmes International? Up-and-comers such as
Kenneth Cole? Sports fans may enjoy learning more about Nike;
musicians, Steinway. The examples pour out if you identify the sector
your business or interests are in andcomb through lists of companies
in that sector publishedby all the major investment banking
firms andavailable on many reputable Web sites.
To sharpen your boundaries after you’ve identified one or a few
companies andind ustries you know something about, evaluate
whether a particular company qualifies for admission by asking yourself
a series of commonsense questions about that business. If you
can answer them, the company probably qualifies; if you can’t, pick
another one that stands a better chance and ask the same questions.
Here are the key questions.
What products does the company sell or services does it provide?
There is a big difference between razors (Gillette) and computer
chips (Intel) and cruises (Carnival). Do you understand these products
andhow they are used?
Does the company make products that people need? Razors and
chips almost certainly, but that’s less true of luxury goods such as
cruise vacations. Will these products probably be needed for the
indefinite future? There are big differences between toothpaste
(Colgate-Palmolive), paper (Mead), and pet rocks (who made
them?). Big differences can arise between today’s needs and tomorrow’s
(razors can become obsolete with an explosion of electrolysis
or laser removal, andcomputer chips may be displaced by chemicaldriven
substitutes now in the research stage).
How distinctive is the company’s product compared to possible
substitutes for it? The difference between Coke and Pepsi may be
slight, but do consumers think it matters? Product differentiation in
the beverage industry, as in many other consumer product businesses,
can be remarkably successful.
Askedanother way, how likely is it that this company can raise
prices on its products without losing unit volume in sales? Carnival
might be able to do that with its cruises more easily than Mead can
with its paper. The ability to raise prices without hurting sales is
called economic goodwill. Some companies get more of it by distin108
Show Me the Money
guishing their products in the consumer’s eye as having distinctive
traits that make them worth buying even at higher prices. Bang &
Olufsen did this successfully in upgrading its image to a maker of
stereos andother soundsystems at the “high end” of audio technology.
Proceedwith similar sorts of questions about the product market.
What is the company’s target customer and/or client base? Is it
teens and preteens (say, electronic music) or retirees (medical devices),
male or female (sporting goods, clothing, cosmetics)?
Does the company depend on one or a few customers for a major
portion of its revenues, as might a manufacturer or wholesaler such
as Procter & Gamble (13% of sales go to Wal-Mart)? Does it have
millions of customers, or does it depend on a handful? (Coca-Cola
has over 14 million customers who sell in turn to the ultimate consumer!)
How much does any dependency matter—how sturdy is a major
customer? Even businesses with well-known andtime-tested products
can suffer enormous economic damage from policy changes by
their major customers. Mattel (with its venerable Barbie line) and
Hasbro (with powerful branded products such as Star Wars and Poke
´mon figures) both took major financial beatings when one of their
largest customers—Toys-“R”-Us—forcedmajor inventory control
changes that shiftedmuch of the cost of carrying inventory from the
store to the manufacturers.
How does the company sell its products? Direct mail (say, Dell)
and storefronts (say, Starbucks) are quite distinct modes of distribution,
andeach differs again from sales over the Internet (say, Amazon.
com) or sales by industrial manufacturers to their industrial
clients (say, Johnson Controls andGeneral Electric).
What is the company’s geographic market? An economic downturn
in Asia can severely impair profits at multinational companies
that do significant parts of their business there, as the crisis in 1998
showedfor venerable companies such as Procter & Gamble and
Coca-Cola. Yet both also hadsuch global reach, they survived with
no long-term damage.
Has the company ledor at least adaptedquickly to changing
economic andbusiness conditions? Companies able to maneuver
quickly to join their oldeconomy businesses with new economy
strategies—such as General Electric—deserve credit for that deftness.
Can you judge which ones can do this?
These commonsense questions can go on andon to include
questions such as the following: What is the company’s supply sitYour
Circle of Competence 109
uation like? Its employee relations? Does it operate in regions subject
to ordinary or extraordinary risks of political or economic instability?
Grappling with these questions shouldbe enough to test whether
a company is within your circle of competence. Again, if you can
answer these questions, the company probably qualifies; if you can’t,
try one you are more familiar with.
Graham advised: “The field of choice is wide; the selection
should depend not only on the individual’s competence and equipment
but perhaps equally well upon his interests andpreferences.” 1
Buffett echoes the point: “You don’t have to be an expert on every
company, or even many. You only have to be able to evaluate companies
within your circle of competence. The size of that circle is
not very important; knowing its boundaries, however, is vital.”2 If
you have to choose between a large circle anda thick boundary,
choose the latter. But a bigger circle will give you more opportunities,
so work on enlarging it.
THE NURTURED CIRCLE
The boundaries of your circle must change over time. If you leave
them the same, some companies will simply disappear. If you are a
master of the fashion industry today—say you work in New York
City’s garment industry or are a buyer for a large retail chain such
as Sak’s Fifth Avenue—you know that to remain a master five years
from now you will need to learn new things over that period. Indeed,
particularly in the fashion industry, you need to keep up daily, since
fashion is (by its very name) a business that swiftly andconstantly
evolves. Colors, hemlines, cuts, andwho’s in andwho’s out change
by the season. To stay on top, you must change.
If you simply took what you knew about an industry you worked
in ten years ago andusedthat knowledge to evaluate a company
in that industry today, you would be at a severe disadvantage. Take
the business of book publishing, which has changedrapid ly in that
period. In the distribution channels, for example, first the rise of
chain booksellers such as Barnes & Noble andBord ers eclipsed
much of the power of the old-fashioned independent booksellers;
then the rise of on-line booksellers such as Amazon.com alteredthe
dynamic again. And the entire book publishing industry has consolidated
substantially and become part of a broader entertainment industry.
Anyone in the publishing industry during that period needed to
110 Show Me the Money
constantly stretch her knowledge of that industry and in doing so
redefine her investment circle of competence. If an editor, publisher,
or other industry member simply stuck with only what she knew in
the beginning, she riskedlosing not only power in her job but investment
insight into her industry as well. If you stop learning now,
you will know less as the worldchanges. Andas the world changes,
you needto know more just to stay in the same place.
Those who can discern trends in their industries are better able
to ascertain which businesses in an industry are likely to remain or
emerge as leaders. Equally important is recognizing that industries
you know can be affectedby other industries about which you know
less. In book publishing, putting 4-pound, 3-inch volumes on tape
or compact disc (CD) created competition for the music industry—
people listen to books in their cars andeven at home instead of
listening to music. Turning multivolume encyclopedia sets into the
single-disc CD-ROM format sucked a huge chunk of the profit out
of the traditional print encyclopedia business.
To maintain your circle of competence in the face of invasions
andforcedchange from other industries thus requires that you know
something about those other industries. That calls not merely for a
commitment to maintain your circle of competence as the things in
it change but for constantly stretching your circle of competence to
include things that might affect it.
Some people were raisedin tech environments andknow more
about computers, digitalization, and the Internet than they know
about fashion andpublishing. Companies in those industries may
dominate their initial circle of competence. However, sticking to
those industries alone is dangerous. A tech company’s value will be
affected by how its products are used by other industries, such as
fashion andpublishing.
Likewise, those who work in industries such as fashion and publishing
may know more about those fields than about anything techrelated,
and their initial circle of competence will be filled with companies
in that cohort. But if they don’t learn something about the
tech businesses that drive changes in fashion and publishing, they
will know less about fashion andpublishing too.
All companies and industries are exposed to change from outside
forces. Among those forces are globalization, computerization, and
the rise of the service sector in the UnitedStates and of e-business
globally. Keeping up with such developments helps gauge their probable
impact. Other external forces are much harder to measure, such
Your Circle of Competence 111
as war, trade disputes, oil price spikes, and earthquakes. This calls
for a delicate balance.
Graham advised that “there are other factors outside the control
of the company that are perhaps equally important in their influence
on the value of its securities. The outlook for the industry, general
business and security-market conditions, periods of inflation or depression,
artificial market influences, the popular favor of the type
of security—these factors cannot be measuredin terms of exact ratios
andmargins of safety. They can only be judgedby a general
knowledge gained by constant contact with financial and business
news.”3
Buffett appreciates this too but emphasizes selecting businesses
that will prosper despite these things, and never indulging the fantasy
of being able to see into the crystal ball:
We will continue to ignore political andeconomic forecasts,
which are an expensive distraction for many investors and businessmen.
Thirty years ago, no one couldhave foreseen the huge
expansion of the Vietnam War, wage andprice controls, two oil
shocks, the resignation of a president, the dissolution of the
Soviet Union, a one-day drop in the Dow of 508 points, or treasury
bill yields fluctuating between 2.8% and 17.4%
But, surprise—none of these blockbuster events made the
slightest dent in Ben Graham’s investment principles. . . . Fear
is the foe of the faddist, but the friend of the fundamentalist.
A different set of major shocks is sure to occur in the next
30 years. We will neither try to predict these nor to profit from
them.4
All companies—whether classic, vintage, or rookie—are subject
to change in character andquality . Classics with rising sales and
earnings can face contractions andreversals from competitors, new
entrants, downturns in important markets, or changes in the way
their customers or suppliers do business in the face of changes.
Rookies with low sales andno earnings can come to dominate an
industry, throttle the competition, and ultimately generate enormous
earnings andvalue. Vintage companies can go either way.
Even if all businesses change, some businesses enjoy one thing
that does not change: the reasons their customers keep coming back.
Companies like that in your circle deserve careful attention; they are
so rare andvaluable that Buffett calls them the Inevitables.5
In maintaining andstretching your circle of competence, note
112 Show Me the Money
how changes that affect industries and companies follow certain
pretty well defined paths. Business change is not unpredictable, only
hardto predict. There are myriadtypes of business changes and
patterns that they follow, but the infinite potential variation can be
organizedpretty simply to enable you to think about those changes
in a profitable way. The chief patterns that matter relate to products
and their degree of brand or commodity characteristics, the sources
andcosts of supply, the chain of distribution, customers’ habits and
tastes, andbusiness andorganizational design.6
Take the brand-commodity pattern. Some businesses are able to
transform a commodity product into a branded product, as Clorox
did with bleach and Frank Perdue did with chicken. Those branded
products can be retransformed back into commodity products, going
the way of the Model T and the Hoover vacuum, or at least have
the franchise value of the brand reduced, as occurred with the Xerox
machine andCampbell’s Soup. Knowledge of a company’s brand
position is important, but more important is knowing its commitment
andability to promote, protect, andexpand that position.
Supply patterns either reduce or enlarge the amount of inventory
a company has to maintain. Companies that reduce their inventory
end up decreasing their costs and boosting profits. Dell developed
close relationships with its suppliers that enabledit to pretty much
eliminate carrying inventory of any of the computer components it
uses. IBM andCompaq have hadless success in doing that.
Distribution patterns are always important andgot a huge
amount of attention during the dawn of the Internet. The direct
seller of products has come and gone over the years. The Fuller
brush salesman, the milkman, andthe Avon lady usedto give a good
profit advantage to their companies, but the shift to suburban living
andthe proliferation of cars, highways, shopping centers, and malls
changedall that. Some of that changedagain as direct sellers reemergedto
bring computers, books, andeven groceries direct to the
home.
Customers’ tastes obviously relate to distribution patterns,
though the causality is not always certain. As they say in marketing,
if you make it, people will come (andif you deliver it, people may
take it). But consumer tastes andhabits are equally obviously an
enormous driver of profits and a determinant of where the profit
centers are. It is useful to distinguish here, however, between fad
patterns andlonger-term patterns.
Silly products that capture the temporary imagination of the
Your Circle of Competence 113
masses may generate some short-term profit (hula hoops, yo-yos),
but the typical pattern is that those tastes evaporate andthe profit
in them moves to the collectors and dealers (Pez candy dispensers).
The patterns of endurance give rise to longer-term profit centers, as
with the trendtowardlow-salt and low-fat foods that companies
such as Nabisco took advantage of.
Business organization andd esign move arounda lot with
changes in the context in which companies operate andcompete:
• Globalization ledmany companies, such as Procter & Gamble and
Xerox, to reorganize their management structures—from having
heads of different parts of the world to having heads of various
product lines throughout the world.
• The rise of the Internet ande-commerce led many to create entire
new dimensions of their businesses to market product on-line or
to redirect major chunks of their businesses to take advantage of
the lower costs andwid er reach of Internet sales—in GE’s case,
the company did both.
• The move towardservice profit centers andthe ability to unleash
greater profits with fewer hardassets ledmany companies to operate
parts of their businesses as managers under contract rather
than through outright ownership, the way Barnes & Noble entered
the college bookstore market.
Companies that adapt organizational structure and business design
to meet changing needs and opportunities are good companies
to keep an eye on. If you notice a company that constantly readapts
itself in this way, try to learn more about it. Even if those companies
don’t make it into your circle of competence, you can enlarge it with
the knowledge you gain from studying them. Coca-Cola and Disney
are goodexamples.
Coca-Cola’s main business is selling beverages globally, principally
gallons of concentrates andsyrups that constitute the Coke
brandbut also Minute Maidandnearly two hundred others. Coca-
Cola devotes most of its resources to marketing its brands to promote
consumer awareness andmaintaining andexpand ing its bottling
operations through a mix of independent bottlers and wholly
or partly ownedbottlers. Coca-Cola reinvented itself in the 1980s to
see its chief customers not as those who actually drink Coke and
the other brands but the distributors around the world who carry
product to those end consumers (this transformation was led by
114 Show Me the Money
Coca-Cola’s late CEO, Roberto Goizueta, who is discussed further
in the final chapter of this book).
Disney’s segments are mainly creative content (films, animation,
books), broadcasting through the American Broadcasting Corporation
(ABC) andESPN, andtheme parks and resorts. A unique thing
about Disney is that going to DisneylandandDisney World(with
children or grandchildren especially) is an incomparable experience.
AndDisney constantly reinvigorates its business by expanding into
television, building blockbuster products that can be sold in multiple
forms (film, record, tape, theme park, apparel, and souvenirs), and
so on, andby exploiting the Internet to broaden both its content and
its distribution channels.
By no means an exhaustive list of patterns, these are the kinds
of important trends that alter and reshape circles of competence and
that must be lookedafter to expandyour circle. To sharpen your
idea of what you should know about companies in order for them
to qualify as members of your circle of competence, let’s take a
closer look at some candidates.
A FULL CIRCLE
Take one company from each of the categories mentionedin the
beginning: the classic General Electric (GE), the vintage Microsoft,
andthe rookie Amazon.com. These are all important companies and
are widely discussed in the financial press, but they differ in age,
products, andfinancial andbusiness characteristics.
GE operates through numerous divisions in a wide range of industries.
The most important divisions are appliances such as refrigerators,
lighting such as lamps andbulbs, the National Broadcasting
Corporation (NBC), aircraft engines, capital services (itself a widely
diversified group of about thirty businesses engaged in various consumer
and commercial financing activities worldwide), plastics used
in a wide range of applications from cars to CD-ROMs, and industrial,
medical, power, and transportation systems (including products
andbusiness solutions such as factory automation, surgical diagnostics,
gas turbines, andlocomotives, respectively).
Understanding all of GE is a tall order that calls for some appreciation
of the basics of finance, broadcasting, consumer, and industrial
businesses. But if you read its annual report for the last few
years andpay special attention to the excellent letters written by
Your Circle of Competence 115
CEO Jack Welch (discussed in Chapter 14), you will gain a good
sense of the company and how it operates. Indeed, Welch argues
that understanding GE is not a tall order at all, and after you read
Chapter 14, you may agree.
One thing that immediately jumps out at you is that GE got to
where it is through Welch’s declaration 20 years ago that the company
wouldremain in any business only if it were the number one
or number two player in that business. Businesses that did not
achieve that rank were fixed, sold, or closed. The company has ended
up the business equivalent of a magnificent art collection, Jack
Welch, curator.
Founded in 1975, Microsoft is a relative newcomer compared to
the century-oldGE. It develops, manufactures, licenses, and supports
a range of software products, including operating systems,
server applications, worker productivity applications, and software
development tools. Microsoft’s success would have been hard to predict
in the middle to late 1980s, when the dynamic of the software
industry was uncertain. As that decade came and went and the 1990s
confirmedthe power andimportance of that industry, the company’s
dominant position became easier to predict.
Yet pervasive andwid espreadInternet use in the late 1990s might
have poseda threat to Microsoft’s business, though a threat it managedto
navigate (excuse the pun, but it is an apt characterization)
through its aggressive entry into andforceful presence in the Internet
browser industry. While it is a somewhat older business than
Amazon.com, its relative youth comparedto GE makes its future
(wholly apart from its legal andregulatory environment) harder to
predict than that of its classic elders.
Still, you can learn from its annual report that Microsoft’s Windows
operating system is installed on more than 300 million Intelbased
personal computers (PCs), making it the world’s leading PC
software company. It is also a leader in PC application tools and has
grown rapidly to rank among the top networks on the Internet. Its
properties receive over 40 million unique monthly visitors to sites
such as Hotmail, MSNBC, Carpoint, andMoneyCentral. If these
computing andInternet operations are up your alley, read about Microsoft’s
stuff in its annual report andCEO Bill Gates’s books or
annual letters to shareholders.
Amazon.com is a business infant begun in 1994, retailing on-line
books, CDs, andvid eos andoffering some 5 million titles. Its business
model, while interesting, is hard to pin down because it con116
Show Me the Money
stantly andrapid ly evolves. Amazon.com started as a bookseller but
quickly expanded into a wide range of product lines such as toys,
electronics, home improvement, andeven a joint venture with Sotheby’s
auction house. It attracts an average of as many as 12 million
unique monthly visitors to its site.
Amazon.com buys inventory from suppliers on a just-in-time basis,
thus minimizing its inventory andwarehousing costs, and takes
orders on its state-of-the-art Web site for shipping by its warehouse
teams. Whatever one thinks of this business model, it depends entirely
on the continuing success andproliferation of the Internet as
an important way of doing consumer shopping.
While so far so good, the Internet’s brief history makes forecasting
the future of Amazon.com andother e-businesses more difficult
for most people than it is to forecast the future of companies
such as GE and even Microsoft. Indeed, it is also difficult because
Amazon.com has never generateda profit. The book business is mature,
slow-growing, andfiercely competitive and has low profit margins;
Amazon.com’s expansion into other businesses poses huge
start-up costs that will deepen those losses further in the short run,
though they may come roaring back in the form of huge profits in
the future.
Amazon.com’s growing diversity of businesses can fragment
managerial attention (much as your diversified portfolio can distract
you). If well managed, though, they could be as successful a group
as GE’s variedlot. Despite the uncertainties, Amazon.com’s business
is intriguing. Those with the ability to learn more about it andan
aptitude for understanding it would be foolish not to look a little
harder.
DECISION MAKING
Assessing information about a business andits industry and related
industries enables you to make rational judgments about the probable
payoffs versus the probable losses. Anything less is simply a toss
of the dice. Conservative decision makers take the position that no
option shouldbe pursuedwithout a high level of positive evidence
andinformation. To put a number on it, they might argue that you
must have a degree of confidence in your judgment of, say, 90% (you
are 90% sure of the outcome and10% unsure).
Less conservative people believe that the level of evidence reYour
Circle of Competence 117
quiredfor a particular decision varies with the probable payoff from
being right comparedto the probable loss from being wrong.7 If the
payoff from being right is very high comparedto the loss from being
wrong (say, gaining $99 versus losing $1), this view says you can
reduce the required confidence level substantially—maybe to as low
as 1%. People who buy lottery tickets reflect this kindof decision
making.
If the gain-loss matrix goes the other way (say, gaining only $1
versus losing $99), then you wouldinsist on a much greater confidence
level—maybe nearly 100%. These are the sure bets in life. And
as even the most steadfast gambler knows, there is no such thing as
a sure bet.
Your risk appetite will determine the sort of decision maker that
best suits your own psychology. Losses are inevitable. If they make
your misery index soar, stick with conservative approaches; if you
can tolerate them, a more aggressive approach is defensible. (Beware:
most people weigh losses more heavily than gains by a factor
of about 2.5.)
Buffett is a conservative decision maker. Explaining Berkshire’s
conservative financial policy of using little debt, Buffett says that if
there were a 99% probability that higher leverage wouldprod uce
something goodanda 1% chance of a surprise that would produce
something between anguish andd efault, he wouldnot bite that bullet:
“We wouldn’t have liked those 99:1 odds—and never will. A small
chance of distress or disgrace cannot, in our view, be offset by a
large chance of extra returns.”8
Graham was also cautious, warning investors to avoidventures
with little to gain andmuch to lose.9 He advised forming judgments
on the basis of knowledge and experience, not on the basis of optimism
(valuable in many settings but not in investing; Buffett calls
optimism the “enemy of the rational buyer”).10
Graham andBuffett’s views reflect contemporary social psychology.
Research in this fieldshows that in any decision-making
process, the cognitive weaknesses sharedby most people produce
subconscious errors of judgment. The main cognitive biases in reasoning
that investors needto worry about are the following:
• Overconfidence and superiority: believing you are certain when
you are only pretty sure (or believing you are pretty sure when you
are uncertain) andbelieving you are better than average (the Lake
Woebegon syndrome).
118 Show Me the Money
• Confirmation and resistance: skewing your interpretation of new
information to support earlier beliefs andbeing slow to update
those beliefs.
• Vividness and pattern seeking: weighing dramatic information too
heavily andoverreacting to a series of similar sorts of news items
in the belief that they show a pattern.11
Of these, the most potentially damaging cognitive biases are
overconfidence and superiority. As Buffett advises: “What counts for
most people in investing is not how much they know, but rather how
realistically they define what they don’t know. An investor needs to
do very few things right as long as he or she avoids big mistakes.”12
There are three simple strategies to help investors avoidthese
reasoning errors. The first is to recognize them. The secondis to
insist on a justification, something you can do by writing a memo to
yourself about why you are making a decision. (Beware of the traps
of this strategy, which Buffett illustrates by quoting Ben Franklin:
“So convenient a thing it is to be a reasonable creature, since it
enables one to findor make a reason for everything one has a mind
to do.”13 Many people do not have articulable reasons for many of
their decisions. In investing decisions, if you don’t have one, don’t
try to make one up.) The third, and related, strategy is to have clear
guidance in your decision making. For investing, this includes the
ideas discussed in this book.
119
C h a p t e r 8
RECOGNIZING
SUCCESS
What makes an investment attractive? A price substantially
lower than value. Estimating value requires making judgments
about probable future performance, but the only available basis for
prognosis is the recordof the past. The historian Daniel Boorstein
likenedplanning for the future without knowing some history to
planting cut flowers.
Investments cannot be made on the basis of such temporary gardens
either but require a look at the history of business. If accounting
is the language of business, numbers are its history. Just as history
is complex, broad, and replete with contradictions, so too are
the numbers of business history. If you focus on a few key numbers,
however, the roadmap to goodinvestment selection becomes clear.
Start with the management’s discussion and analysis of the business.
In addition to a narrative assessment of the business, this summarizes
the most important numbers in the company’s financial
statements. So you don’t have to go to the trouble of doing the
calculations—just look them up. This discussion also interprets the
meaning of those numbers from management’s perspective. So you
also don’t have to become an expert in accounting to make sense of
this stuff.
Beware of using secondhand databases. Lots of Web sites give
you a chance to employ screening tools to search through 12,000 or
more different businesses with dozens of different variables of the
kindd escribedbelow . These tools operate as filters to give you a
limitednumber of businesses to examine more closely. In principle,
this is precisely the kindof technique that is sensible to use.
However, you cannot be sure the search engines are working
with data of integrity. The data do not usually include information
about a company’s accounting policies, footnote information, or
management’s discussion and analysis. The data are not always up-
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
120 Show Me the Money
dated or corrected, may have embedded errors that arise in the transmission
process, andmay be the product of aggregating information
that is dissimilar or noncomparable. This is not to say that these
systems are worthless, only that you shouldexercise care in using
them.1
BUSINESS FUEL
Every business has debts coming due every day which require resources
to meet. The difference between short-term needs and resources
is calledworking capital. It is a bit like fuel in an engine; it
is better to have a full tank, but overfilling can be dangerous. Too
little working capital can pose a threat to the ability of a company
to operate in the ordinary course over the immediate future, but too
much working capital can mean that resources are not being deployedin
optimal ways.
The right level of working capital varies across businesses. One
way to determine how much working capital is needed and assess
its adequacy is to compare the working capital to sales. Typically, a
retailing business that generates substantial sales of low-cost items,
such as a supermarket, needs less working capital per dollar of sales
(perhaps around 10 to 15%) than does an industrial manufacturer of
high-ticket items such as airplanes (perhaps around25 to 35%). A
manufacturer of consumer goods—say, Carnation or Clorox—might
require some level in between.
Other businesses can operate with low or even negative working
capital. Companies in the restaurant business, McDonald’s, for example,
often operate with negative working capital because of the
cash nature of the business. This system provides direct liquidity,
andpayment terms with suppliers usually permit payment after product
is both receivedandusedin the business to generate cash. Companies
in other industries can benefit from the same combination,
as Amazon.com aptly demonstrates by operating sometimes with
negative working capital without apparent impairment of its ability
to meet obligations as they come due.
In the oil andgas industry, a principal source of cash is proved
reserves that are produced in the ensuing year. While they cannot
be reportedas working capital on the balance sheet under generally
acceptedaccounting principles, they are turned into cash. Companies
in other industries sometimes fund new construction by issuing
Recognizing Success 121
short term obligations such as commercial paper that is later refinancedwith
long-term obligations such as bank loans. This can also
produce low or negative working capital while not posing any threat
to the company’s short-term ability to meet its obligations.
Ben Graham put it this way in his marvelous little book publishedin
1937, The Interpretation of Financial Statements:
The proper amount of working capital requiredby a particular
enterprise will depend upon both the amount and the character
of its business. The chief point of comparison is the amount of
working capital per dollar of sales. A company doing business
for cash andenjoying a rapid turnover of inventory—for example,
a chain grocery enterprise—needs a much lower working
capital comparedwith sales than does the manufacturer of
heavy machinery soldon long-term payments.2
Current and Quick Ratios
Evaluating the working capital position is achievedby comparing the
relationship between current assets andcurrent liabilities in relative
terms. Known as the current ratio, this relationship shows how many
dollars in cash or other assets likely to be turned into cash within a
year are available to pay debts that are due within that year. As a
rule of thumb, for most businesses the ideal current ratio is around
1.5, but the range of current ratios across companies andind ustries
is broad.
A current ratio substantially higher—say, 3 or 4 or more—is a
sign of potential problems, not with respect to liquidity but with
respect to efficiency. It implies that there are financial resources that
couldbe freedup andput to better use: Inventory could be reduced,
receivables couldbe collectedmore quickly or sold, or payables
couldbe aged a bit more before being paid.
At the other extreme, a current ratio of 1 or less (i.e., negative
working capital) is often a warning signal that a company may face
difficulties in paying its debts as they come due in the short term.
As the ratio gets close to 1 or below it, therefore, investigate the
liquidity question further.
Recently the average current ratio of the companies in the S&P
500 was about 1.5, about the same as for the conglomerate segment
of that index, of which GE is a part. The current ratio in the computer
industry tends to be higher, closer to 2.75 (with Microsoft right
aroundthat average). Specialty retailers, including Amazon.com, had
122 Show Me the Money
higher current ratios than these, around3.5, with Amazon.com’s
fluctuating from negative to 4.5, depending on its borrowing levels
for investment in new businesses.
This range of ratios reflects different corporate needs as well as
unique funding situations (called the net trade cycle, or the relationship
between desired investment in inventory compared to the
relationship between credit extended and credit taken). Amazon.com
has at times operatedwith negative working capital, which, given
the retail nature of its business with low inventory andlow accounts
receivable, is safe andind eeda goodind icator of value from managing
working capital. Microsoft’s relatively high ratio is due in large
part to the fact that it generates enormous amounts of cash in its
operations. GE andits peers exhibit the usual characteristics of relatively
mature businesses, though GE constantly tries to reduce the
amount of working capital it requires to zero.
You can fine-tune your analysis even more by looking only to
highly liquidassets, excluding assets such as inventory and prepaid
expenses. This leaves cash (liquidity itself) and assets such as accounts
receivable that are due in shorter periods (say, within three
months). This more refinedtest is known as the quick ratio and
sometimes (equivalently) as either the liquidity ratio or the acid test
ratio.
Rules of thumb still apply. A minimum quick ratio of 1 is desirable,
andhigher ratios are generally better—up to a point. This is
useful to know because of what it reveals about the relative level of
the current ratio. For example, a current ratio within a seemingly
satisfactory range (say, between 1.4 and2) couldactually be high
largely as a result of excessive inventory levels. Since a business cannot
pay debts with inventory, there is reason to worry about a company’s
ability to pay its debts as they come due if it has a low quick
ratio even while sporting a high current ratio.
Conglomerates such as GE tendto have a relatively wider gap
than do other businesses between the current ratio and the quick
ratio. As a segment, the conglomerate current ratio of around1.5,
comparedto a quick ratio of about .8, reflects the fact that most of
the current assets are neither cash nor short-term accounts receivable.
The bandis tighter in the more liquid businesses of computers
andon-line retail sales, where there are speedier assets in the current
ratio (2.75 and2.6 in the computer industry and about 3.5 and
2.5 in the specialty retailer segment). These variations reflect the
range of operating environments in these businesses andalso show
Recognizing Success 123
that neither GE, Microsoft, nor Amazon.com is all that different
from its segment in terms of liquidity needs or how they are being
met.
Debt
Check out a company’s ability to attract additional financing; this is
particularly important when a company has negative working capital
from issuing short-term obligations such as commercial paper. This
is done by using the debt-to-equity ratio. In its most general formulation,
the calculation is the ratio between the total debt of a company,
including short-term debt as well as long-term debt, divided
by the amount of owners’ equity.
The ratio measures the relative borrowing capacity andd ebtpaying
ability of the enterprise over the long term. Businesses with
relatively high debt-to-equity ratios are characterized as “highly leveraged,”
meaning that the debt level in relation to the investment
level of the owners in the business (the shareholders) is very high.
What levels of debt-to-equity ratios are normal has varied historically,
in accordance with economic conditions and collective beliefs
about credit.
During the 1980s, for example, debt-to-equity ratios in the range
of 7:1 or higher were common, whereas during the early 1990s the
typical ratios were closer to 4:1. At the turn of the twenty-first century,
the debt-to-equity ratio of the S&P 500 averaged just about 1:
1, reflecting a decade in which most business financing was done
using equity rather than debt.
Conglomerates still are relatively debt-heavy, however, with the
segment average of about 3:1 andGE above that segment average
with a debt-to-equity ratio of around 4:1. That level reflects the relatively
more mature stage of these companies, particularly compared
with the far leaner computer industry. Microsoft, for example, funds
all its operations with internally generatedcash, enabling it to operate
with no debt whatsoever, and the average debt-to-equity ratio
for the computer industry as a whole is a staggeringly low .2:1. Amazon.
com weighs in between these levels, reflecting both its needto
finance its expanding operations and warehouse construction projects
andits relatively lesser ability compared with Microsoft to generate
sufficient cash to satisfy those needs.
Leverage reflectedin a relatively higher debt-to-equity ratio can
be desirable. If a company borrows at rates below what it can earn
124 Show Me the Money
on its capital, borrowing is profitable. Shareholders benefit. There is
a limit to the benefit, however, for even relatively cheap money must
be repaidandtoo great a debt burden couldbe crushing during
periods of depressed returns.
A way to gauge these trade-offs is to examine the coverage ratio—
a comparison of earnings to interest obligations on debt. For
most industrial companies, an interest coverage ratio in the range of
3 to 4 is considered prudent and implies a relatively safe level of
borrowing. In light of the relatively low levels of indebtedness and
relatively high levels of profitability of corporate America at the turn
of the twenty-first century, the average interest coverage ratio among
the S&P 500 soaredto nearly 11.
Conglomerates remainedclosest to historical norms, with GE’s
coverage ratio at about 2.5 andthe segment at about 4.5. At nearly
the other extreme, Microsoft enjoys total coverage because it is simply
debt-free. Amazon.com is an interesting case: Its coverage ratio
is negative because it is losing money (has negative profits), as low
as 4. That kindof situation calls for looking more closely at other
fixedcharges, which in Amazon.com’s case include leases on various
warehouses that also have to be paid. Its fixed charge coverage ratio
is therefore even worse, making its ability to generate additional
funds to cover its increasing expansion all the more important.
MANAGERS UNDER THE MICROSCOPE
Three simple tools clue us into managerial effectiveness. They center
on the efficiency of inventory andreceivables management and the
thickness of profit margins. Some companies report the speedof
inventory andreceivable turns andthe levels of profit margins directly
in their periodic reports, and some even highlight this in the
chairman’s letters—usually signs of goodor at least honest management.
In other cases, you have to dig for it (not a good sign). Putting
managers under the microscope this way helps gauge the prospects
for future business performance—whether the maximal profits are
being squeezedfrom the business or whether there is room for more.
Inventory Turns
While inventory is considered a current asset in that it is expected
to be realizedin cash within one year, you can be more precise about
Recognizing Success 125
its relative liquidity by measuring the speed of its sale. Inventory
speed, or turns, is measured by the relationship between the cost of
goods sold (COGS) during a period and the average level of inventory
during that period:
Current year’s cost of goods sold
(Beginning inventory ending inventory)/2
Inventory turn levels are reliable indicators of the quality of inventory
management. The longer inventory sits aroundwithout being
sold, the less value it adds to the business, since it could be converted
into cash deployed for more productive uses. High inventory
levels also increase the risk of obsolescence or spoilage, require large
amounts of either cash or bank borrowing to finance, andpose the
risk of loss if the market price at which they can be soldd eclines
materially.
GE is well known for its inventory turn management, andits
long-time CEO, Jack Welch, regularly reports this in his annual letters.
GE boasts inventory turns of a robust 8 amida conglomerate
average inventory turn of about 7 though shy of the S&P 500 average
inventory turn of about 10. Microsoft manages inventory well too,
right along with the rest of the computer industry, with turns of
about 15; this is larger than GE in part because of the vastly different
products these businesses sell.
But Amazon.com is superefficient in inventory management, at
a breakneck pace of around20. Amazon.com is a specialist in justin-
time inventory, a key management strategy developed in the last
couple of decades that Amazon.com has taken to new levels. Stock
doesn’t sit idle in Amazon.com’s warehouses, and this swift turnover
lowers costs. That enables the business either to charge lower
prices to its customers (hence Amazon.com’s aggressive pricing discounts)
or to continue to charge the market price but generate more
profit.
Receivable Turns
A company’s credit policies can be its Achilles’ heel or a driver of
efficiency. Too many sales on credit or too many delinquencies or
uncollectible accounts can crush cash flows. Speedy collection enhances
liquidity and can enable a company to get its customers to
finance its business. Receivable turns are measuredby credit sales
126 Show Me the Money
(or total sales if those sales are not broken out separately) during a
period divided by the average accounts receivable outstanding during
the period:
Credit sales
(Beginning accounts receivable ending accounts receivable)/ 2
To gauge the speedof receivables collection, in turn, divide the
number of days in a year by the number of turns. The result gives
the average number of days the receivables are outstanding. Compare
that average to the business’s credit policies to see how well
managers are running the credit part of the business. There is trouble
if the average is greater than the policy (say, collections average
70 days but billing calls for payments to be made within 30 or 60
days).
GE displays considerable skill in receivables management, turning
them about eight times per year, meaning they are collectedon
average within 45 days. That compares dramatically well to a conglomerate
industry average of three turns, or 120 days. Microsoft is
also a speedy collector, turning receivables about 11 times a year, or
just over 30 days—perhaps as a result of its no-paper policy under
which all bills (andinvoices) are completed electronically—routing
a slower computer industry average that looks more like that of GE
(about eight turns, averaging 45 days).
Again, the exceptional case is Amazon.com, a standout in this
category, with about forty turns, or a mere nine days outstanding.
That means Amazon.com’s customers are funding a substantial part
of Amazon.com’s operations! They provide funds well ahead of the
company’s obligations to pay its creditors, particularly its suppliers,
whose trade terms extend up to 60 days.
Profit Margin
The key to business efficiency is the profit per dollar of sales, which
is calledthe profit margin. To calculate it, divide operating income
by the total net sales (i.e., sales after returns, discounts, and so on)
andexpress the result as a percentage. (Two alternatives to this
standard profit margin calculation are also often made: A more
general one called gross profit margin divides gross profit on sales
by total net sales, anda more specific one called net profit margin
Recognizing Success 127
divides net income by total net sales.) The standard way is as
follows:
Operating income
Net sales
There is tremendous variation in profit margins across industries.
Average profit margins in the automotive andbanking industries, for
example, are way lower (often around10%) than they are in the
computer, pharmaceutical, andfoodind ustries (as high as 40% in
the case of Microsoft). The S&P 500 average profit margin is about
17.5%, right aroundwhere GE stands, while other conglomerates
show margins of around13 to 14%. Again, companies without earnings,
such as Amazon.com, have negative profit margins.
Profit margins can be squeezed or expanded, depending in large
measure on whether a business has a special franchise that gives it
market power or competes in a commodity market where branding
and product differentiation are harder. Coke and Pepsi constantly
pursue product differentiation to exploit the possibility of raising
prices without hurting unit volume, with varying degrees of success
in various economic climates.
Amazon.com invests heavily in this kindof product differentiation,
with a state-of-the-art Web site that includes patented features
such as “one-click” andd istinctive formatting. Yet competitors, including
barnesandnoble.com and buy.com, easily mimic much of this
would-be differentiation, quickly eroding profit margins.
The competition results in constant efforts to innovate andad -
vance technology, whether in hamburger stands, on-line booksellers,
or the beverage industry. Such innovation tends to hurt rather than
help commodity businesses but benefits franchise businesses enormously.
That is why Microsoft so jealously guards the code to its
Windows operating system. It is why GE spends so many advertising
dollars on campaigns such as “We bring good things to life,” in which
it highlights all dozen or so of its businesses without pitching particular
products such as a washing machine or x-ray diagnostic
equipment.
When a company develops a superior production system for a
commodity product (such as oil), the bulk of the savings from that
system goes to consumers rather than to the company. In contrast,
a company that improves branded goods—those on which prices can
128 Show Me the Money
remain high or be raised—reaps most of the upside from that innovation.
Profit margins are driven up or down depending on the
degree to which any business—whether GE, Microsoft, Amazon.
com, or any other company—can differentiate its products to
earn brandedpricing andinnovation power or else be left to bear
the cross andcosts of innovation.
A warning on profit margins is in order. Very high profit margins
may seem desirable and often are, but they also invite competition
that couldd estroy them. Very low profit margins are worth their
level. Something in between, toward the high end, is ideal.
BANG FOR THE BUCK
“Returns” are a measure of the bang a business gets for its buck.
The bang is always measuredin terms of earnings. There are three
bases (or bucks) against which to measure the bang: equity, investment,
andassets.
In each measure, it is smart to gauge the return over a relatively
long periodof time—say, five to ten years—rather than over short
periods to get a perspective that tracks a business’s ability to weather
the downsides and reap the upsides.
Return on Equity
Return on equity is the amount a business earns on the capital
owned by its shareholders. Shareholder capital is equal to the total
assets minus the total liabilities. If a business earns $10 million on
shareholder equity of $100 million, its return on equity is 10%.
Returns on equity were relatively high in the late 1990s andearly
2000s. The S&P 500 average return on equity is around22%. Below
that average are specialty retailers (15%, other than Amazon.com,
whose losses rather than profits give it a negative return on equity).
At or somewhat above the average are GE (about 27%) andthe conglomerate
sector (about 25%) as well as the computer industry at
about 25%. Leading the pack is Microsoft (about 34%).
Return on Investment
Return on investment is the amount a business earns on both the
capital owned by its shareholders and the capital supplied by lenders
Recognizing Success 129
on a long-term (over one year) basis. A business may borrow capital
rather than issue equity if it needs capital and believes it will generate
greater returns on the capital than the costs of borrowing it.
Suppose a business with $100 million in shareholder equity borrows
$50 million from long-term lenders and then generates earnings
of $15 million on that total capital. Its return on investment will
be 10% (15/150). But this leveraging boosts the business’s return on
equity—earnings of $15 million on shareholder equity of $100 million
means a return on equity of 15%.
Using debt to boost return on equity is common but by no means
imperative. Some companies generate sufficient cash from their operations
to enable high returns on equity more cheaply than they
couldby borrowing. As was noted earlier, Microsoft is debt-free,
generating returns on equity of nearly 34% andreturns on investment
that are just about the same (a similar near 1:1 ratio holds
across the computer industry).
The norm among the S&P 500 is to use debt, driving the average
return on equity to about 22% while return on investment is about
14%. GE exploits leverage with more spectacular results, with returns
on equity of nearly 27% tripling return on investment of just above
9% (similar results holdacross the conglomerate sector).
Return on Assets
Return on assets is the amount a business earns on all its resources—
not only shareholder equity and long-term borrowing but
short-term resources generatedby effective management of working
capital. A business may seek short-term, low-rate loans or buy goods
on credit that it resells for cash, thus increasing the assets available
for deployment at low or no cost. Those assets contribute to incremental
increases in earnings, boosting both return on equity and
return on assets.
Suppose a business maintains an average amount of short-term
assets of $20 million over a year (by continually repaying the obligations
as they come due and incurring new ones as rollovers). That
couldincrease incremental annual earnings by, say, $2 million. Thus,
a company with shareholder equity of $100 million and long-term
debt of $50 million, carrying that additional $20 million in the short
term andearning $17 million, generates a return on assets of 10%
(17/170). This deployment boosts return on investment to 11.3%
(17/150) andreturn on equity to 17% (17/100).
130 Show Me the Money
Return on assets is thus the toughest measure of performance
basedon returns, as it reveals the results of deploying all the assets
at management’s disposal. Starting with a high return on assets
shouldyielda high return on investment and hence on equity. (Some
analysts calculate a “financial leverage index” equal to the return on
equity divided by the return on assets.)
Higher returns on assets are achievedby squeezing earnings out
of fewer or smaller asset bases. Microsoft starts off with a return on
assets of 25%, suggesting a relatively low level of asset intensity,
freeing it from dependency on debt and enabling it to generate returns
on equity of nearly 10 points more. At the other extreme, GE
starts off with a return on assets of just 3%, meaning it must manage
its capital structure to use debt skillfully and deploy assets efficiently
in order to get the higher returns on equity of about 27% that it
achieves.
Microsoft is asset-nonintensive, whereas GE is quite assetintensive.
The earnings of many companies (Amazon.com maybe)
are driven by brand names and/or inventory and distribution systems
far more than by the plants andother physical resources that make
up their balance sheet assets. Microsoft relies more on fixedand
other assets but also is able to extract prodigious earnings from its
brandname andmarket position. GE’s asset-intensive business requires
heavy investment in plants andequipment even as its products
enjoy enormous brandrecognition (“We bring goodthings to
life”).
It is too soon to tell how Amazon.com will fare in the contest
for high returns on assets. Certainly its business model is designed
to minimize asset intensity. Its brandname and Internet presence
are the key drivers of sales and hence earnings. It minimizes its fixed
asset needs by avoiding the bricks-and-mortar store operations to
which Barnes & Noble and other traditional retailers devote resources.
Amazon.com’s just-in-time inventory management is designed to
reduce the carrying costs of inventory. Its trade terms with customers
andsuppliers drive incremental earnings by superior short-term
working capital management—it receives revenues from customers
as products are ordered but usually need not pay its suppliers for
those goods until some 30 to 60 days later. Internet customers base
purchases on pictures andimages on the Internet screen, moreover,
meaning Amazon.com does not suffer from books damaged by customers
thumbing through them. Bricks-and-mortar bookstores incur
Recognizing Success 131
losses from such damaged books (though they have the right to return
damaged books to publishers, the result is often a lower discount
on purchases from them). These characteristics of low asset
intensity are extremely favorable to Amazon.com, though it remains
a hardbusiness to assess given its relative youth and negative earnings.
THE FULL TOOL CHEST
This tool chest of ideas helps you assess a company’s liquidity, efficiency,
andperformance. The tools can be adapted from the basic
metrics outlined here to deal with special situations and more advancedanalysis.
A few examples of measures that help further gauge various aspects
of a company’s relative andprobable future success are as
follows. Quality of income (cash flows provided by operating activities
divided by operating income) tells you what portion of income
is actually turning into cash to gauge the liquidity position. The
amount of annual depreciation expense can be a goodproxy for future
capital investment needs. Sales per employee helps evaluate
overall productivity.
A company’s key ratios vary with time, andany trends are important
guides to managerial efficiency and performance. Therefore,
you might look at all the expenses on the income statement over
several years. There is no reason to automatically assume that any
particular ratio or trends will continue, but history does help define
probabilities for the future.
Suppose, for example, you see a large reduction in an expense
for research andd evelopment. That would significantly increase income
in a period. But growth in income resulting from the reduction
in such an expense wouldnot mean that the business is being managedmore
efficiently. It couldeven mean that there are reasons to
worry about its prospects for growth in the future.
Or take receivables turns. Suppose the average number of collection
days during a period increases materially in relation to the
credit terms. Maybe part of any sales growth during the period is
due to a relaxation in credit collection policies rather than to business
efficiency. If those accounts are more likely to go uncollected,
the sales growth might look goodtod ay but there’ll be hell to pay
tomorrow.
132 Show Me the Money
We couldgo on andon but don’t needto. 3 Get acquaintedwith
the key ratios mentionedabove andyou’ll instantly be miles ahead
of the crowdin your ability to distinguish strengths and weaknesses
in numerous businesses within your circle of competence. Focus on
the strong ones andkeep looking—they might have the value you
want, especially if they pass the tests in the next chapter.
133
C h a p t e r 9
YOU MAKE THE CALL
Abusiness is worth the present value of the future cash flows it
generates from now until doomsday. Present value is in the eye
of the beholder, for its realization is entirely in the future. People
will disagree at virtually every step of the process of figuring present
value, including the methods used and the different answers they
yield.
Gazing into the cloudy crystal ball of valuation, you can never
be sure of the accuracy of forecasts when you make them. Yet since
your future wealth is at stake, you do not want to fly blindfolded
even if you cannot predict the future. What you can do is minimize
the hazards of your errors.
What drives cash flows are assets and earnings. These factors
andhistorical cash flows are the best gauges for thinking about probable
future cash flows. You couldfigure value based just on assets
(something calledbook value), basedjust on earnings (what the
earnings stream is worth), or from the cash flows (the worth of the
dividends paid out to shareholders).
However, none of these separate valuation tools in itself is usually
sufficient to determine the value of a business. Not only is none
of them definitive, all of them together remain imperfect, for all
share the inevitable andirremovable infirmity in any valuation exercise:
using current andpast information to forecast future cash
flows. You’ll needinformation about all these things to aid your judgment.
Some valuation tools are more useful for certain businesses than
for others. For example, GE generates earnings andpays cash dividends,
Microsoft generates earnings but does not pay cash dividends,
andAmazon.com does neither. Obviously, you can value all three
companies by using asset measures; you can value GE andMicrosoft
basedon earnings, andGE basedon dividends.
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
134 Show Me the Money
Less obviously, you coulduse all these tools—but in different
ways—for all three companies. That is, estimatedfuture earnings
and dividends can be made for all three (relatively easy for GE, less
so for Microsoft, andvery hardfor Amazon.com).
If these companies are within your circle of competence, you
can do it. You can do it even if you are nervous about using the huge
number of valuation techniques that are discussed in innumerable
books or below because none of them will enable you or anyone else
to pinpoint with precision what the value of any business is.
At best, these techniques produce a range of values that depend
on your interpretation of history andprognosis for the future. These
acts expose you andeveryone else to risks of error, andthose risks
are precisely why Ben Graham insistedon getting a thick margin of
safety between the price paidandthe value one could reasonably
expect to get. Every star investor follows that principle.
In the most famous chapter of The Intelligent Investor, Graham
wrote: “In the oldlegendthe wise men finally boiledd own the history
of mortal affairs into the single phrase, ‘This too will pass.’ Confrontedwith
a like challenge to distill the secret of sound investing
into three words, we venture the motto, MARGIN OF SAFETY.”1
Commenting on this passage over 40 years later, Warren Buffett said
he still believes those are the right three words.2
Getting a wide gap between the price you pay and the value you
buy is the cornerstone of intelligent investing because as Buffett
says, while “intrinsic value can be defined simply,” its calculation
“is not so simple.”3 Graham invokedthe margin of safety principle
to avoidthe risk of error in calculating intrinsic value. And while
Charlie Munger—Buffett’s business partner andalter ego—has
quippedthat he has never seen Buffett do an intrinsic value calculation,
the principles that follow are part of the mind-set that enables
him not to.
ASSETS
The book value of a company is the excess of its total assets as
set forth on the balance sheet over its total liabilities andany outstanding
preferred stock, also as set forth on the balance sheet. The
book value per share of a common stock of that business is simply
that amount divided by the number of common shares outstanding.
You Make the Call 135
This use of the word“value” is misleading. Balance sheets list
assets at their cost when acquiredrather than their current value
(or in some cases at current market values if lower). The balance
sheet report of the carrying amount of assets does not reflect increases
in value under current market conditions. And while the
long-term assets are shown less the depreciation on them, that is
only an approximation of what it wouldcost to replace them rather
than an exact figure.
The range of book values per share is as broadas the range of
businesses itself, andall those values reflect historical acquisition
costs rather than current values. The book value per share of our
sample illustrates this. GE’s is about $12; Microsoft’s, about $6; and
Amazon.com’s, about $2.4
These numbers correctly suggest that the usefulness of book
value decays when more productive activity is performed with fewer
rather than more tangible assets (as more production is generated
not by, say, steel mills andother factories but by information technologies
andInternet distribution systems). The fact that GE’s book
value per share is six times Amazon.com’s may reflect more the
greater asset intensity of GE’s business comparedto Amazon.com’s
than the value of those businesses.
For a whole range of businesses, the current accounting system
basedon historical cost is handicappedin appraising present and
future values. For example, GE’s property, plant, andequipment if
soldat current market prices wouldfetch a substantial multiple of
the book value per share; Amazon.com’s might fetch only about what
the book value says, chiefly because all its assets were acquired
within the past few years.
Not only does this cost principle mean that some assets listed
on a balance sheet are worth far more than their listedamount, it
also means that the opposite is true. Even if book value purports to
reflect the amount for which a company couldbe sold(its liquidation
value), it cannot reflect the circumstances under which a sale
is held. A business liquidation conducted under or caused by adverse
conditions may lead to assets such as inventory and equipment and
machinery being soldat a loss comparedto their balance sheet carrying
amounts.
For some companies, losses on major assets such as plants and
warehouses can be enormous. If Disney were liquidated, for example,
there is reason to doubt that its theme park fixed assets—an
important part of its book value—couldbe soldat their book value.
136 Show Me the Money
Perhaps more obviously, if Coke were liquidated, its inventory of
syrup and concentrate would undoubtedly fetch far less in a fire sale
of those goods than the amount at which they are carried as inventory
on its balance sheet.
This does not mean that the balance sheet is useless. It is a
starting point for analysis. All the historical numbers can be adjusted
to reflect prevailing economic conditions. On the upside, inflation
andappreciation in market values can be acknowledged to arrive at
a current measure of the financial value of assets. Guides to this
adjusting of old numbers to new conditions include sales prices of
similar property andincreasing asset amounts based on changes in
the consumer price index.
On the downside, the historical amount of assets recorded on a
balance sheet can be reduced to the amount they could be sold for
in a fire sale upon liquidation of the business. How much to reduce
the amounts for things such as inventory andaccounts receivable
wouldd ependon their respective turnover rates. Amazon.com’s inventory,
for example, turns so quickly (24 times a year) that even in
a fire sale the company wouldprobably be able to get ridof it at
pretty close to cost (the amount listedon its balance sheet). Some
of GE’s inventory, which turns only eight times per year, might have
to be soldat a loss.
Even those adjustments may not serve as an accurate basis for
financial valuation, however, because of another accounting principle:
the principle of economic or monetary exchange. A business
enterprise may have financial value derived from intangible assets
that are not recorded in the financial statements because they were
not attributable to any discrete economic exchange. For example,
only the cost of development of intellectual property (such as patents,
trademarks, and copyrights) is recorded as an asset on the balance
sheet even if the property is worth billions of dollars in the
form of brandrecognition or customer loyalty.
You undoubtedly recognize the GE brand name, for instance,
andcollective consumer recognition is certainly valuable, but you
will not see any line item for GE’s brandnames andassociated intellectual
property on its balance sheet. The same is true for company
know-how, employee capital anded ucation, and similar items
increasingly crucial to many companies in a wide variety of businesses,
particularly but not exclusively companies such as Microsoft
andAmazon.com.
These sources of value are referredto as economic goodwill, a
You Make the Call 137
bundle of intangible assets that enable a business to generate superior
returns on equity, investment, andassets. They can, as was
notedbefore, create a franchise or branding power that enables a
business to increase prices without hurting total sales volume. Disney,
for example, can raise ticket prices to Disneylandwithout hurting
attendance.
Another sort of goodwill is called accounting goodwill. This is a
recordof prices paidfor businesses a company acquired at a premium
to book value. The economic value of accounting goodwill is
even trickier to appraise. If the purchase was a prudent one, the
value of the economic goodwill obtained is usually greater than the
amount of accounting goodwill. That is especially true because another
accounting rule requires that accounting goodwill be amortized—
reduced annually by specified amounts over future decades.
But again, if the businesses were smartly bought, the goodwill value
shouldrise over those years rather than, as the amortization suggests,
fall.
Sidestepping the need for these adjustments to the balance
sheet, an old-fashioned rule of thumb championed by Ben Graham
says that a common stock carries a sufficient margin of safety if it
can be bought at a price equivalent to less than the company’s net
current assets,5 that is, a price equal to per share working capital.
This means that the buyer wouldpay nothing for the business’s fixed
assets. Such companies are so rare today that this tool in its pristine
form is of little use.
But a modest variation retains the old rule’s conservative rigor
while still catching some fish. A business still qualifies if it can be
bought for its net current assets plus, say, half the original cost of its
fixedassets. Thus, the investor pays for net working capital at the
statedvalue andgets a 50% discount for all the other assets. In the
case of most companies today this would still be quite a low figure, but
some companies—particularly smaller ones—endup in your nets.6
The potential trouble with these approaches is that they relegate
you to being a bottom fisher—the person trolling for very low priced
businesses. That is fine, but you needto be careful not to buy a
dying fish. Bargain hunting leads to disaster if all you get is a burst
of economic return but nothing in the long term. Prudent investors
hunt for stocks with fair rather than cheap prices andstrong rather
than modest economic characteristics. As Warren Buffett advises, it
is better to buy a great business at a fair price than a fair business
at a great price.
138 Show Me the Money
A neophyte investor’s mistake, in any event, is to assess business
value solely on the basis of the balance sheet, even after overcoming
the limits imposedby accounting principles. Unless you are indeed
valuing a company for purposes of liquidating it, what you really
want to know is not what its assets couldsell for but what earnings
andcash they spin off.
Graham recognizedthe limits of a balance sheet. Noting that it
is quite useful with respect to working capital position, Graham cautionedthat
it is of less use concerning the carrying amount of fixed
assets, which he said“must not be taken too seriously,” and the
figure at which intangible assets are listed, to which he said “little
if any weight shouldbe given.”7 He advised:
It is true that in many individual cases we find companies with
small asset values earning large profits, while others with large
asset values earn little or nothing. Yet in these cases some attention
must be given to the book value situation, for there is
always a possibility that large earnings on the investedcapital
may attract competition andthus prove temporary; also that
large assets, not now earning profits, may later be made more
productive.8
Accordingly, Graham concluded that “book value is of some importance
in analysis because a very rough relationship tends to exist
between the amount investedin a business and its average earnings,”
where the real money is.9
EARNINGS
Earnings refer to accounting earnings as reportedon the “bottom
line” of an income statement. These figures are separatedinto basic
earnings per share andd ilutedearnings per share. Basic earnings
per share are the total earnings divided by the average number of
common shares outstanding during the period.
Dilutedearnings take account of the possibility that some convertible
securities andstock options couldincrease the number of
common shares outstanding. This reduces the earnings per share by
taking into account the conversion or exercise of those instruments.
Focus on the diluted earnings per share (andbear in mindthat even
that figure does not always reflect full dilution or cost of stock options
issuedto managers, as we will see later).
You Make the Call 139
In assessing what the enterprise can do for you in the future,
you only have present andpast earnings available. How can present
andpast earnings guide an assessment of future earnings? Or which
of various prior year earnings or which combination is the “right”
level of earnings?
In GE’s case, four recent annual diluted earnings per share were
$2.16, $2.46, $2.80, and$3.22; in Amazon.com’s, negative $.06,
.$24, $.84, and$2.18 per share.
Perhaps you shoulduse only the most recent period. But what
if, as with GE andAmazon.com, there is significant change in that
year comparedto the prior years? One issue is, of course, why that
change occurred. Was it due to extraordinary factors that are unlikely
to recur?
If that is the case, using the prior periods might seem appropriate,
though a more precise gauge for companies that periodically
experience such extraordinary occurrences is to lengthen the period
to seven to ten years to iron out those bumps. Alternatively, perhaps
the business is experiencing a steady positive or negative trend in its
earnings. In these cases, averaging the earnings over the last four
years makes sense. In GE’s case, that is about $2.66 (in Amazon.
com’s, negative $.83).
All these issues obviously entail judgment, and on top of that
you must recognize that the estimate is about future earnings. Taking
the average earnings over the past four years andprojecting them
forwardto the next four years requires a further forecast of the earnings
growth in the future period. Despite steadily rising losses, Amazon.
com’s management expects profits within a few years (as
apparently do thousands of its stockholders, who at one point in the
early 2000s drove its market capitalization to over ten times the
combinedtotals of its profit-making archrivals Borders and Barnes
& Noble!).
GE’s earnings growth rate was about 12 to 15% in the late 1990s.
You might cautiously expect similar or slightly slower growth in the
early 2000s. Taking a conservative view of the future couldjustify a
10% growth rate—roughly $3.50, $3.90, $4.30, and$4.75, or an
average of about $4.10.
In estimating earnings, note again the limits of accounting records.
Accounting earnings result from subtracting cash expenses
plus noncash expenses such as depreciation andbadd ebt reserves
from gross revenue. This sounds simple, but the exercise entails
making a number of decisions about how various events are ac140
Show Me the Money
countedfor . Accounting earnings are affected by a host of accounting
conventions, including, for example, the method of computing
the cost of goods sold, the method of depreciating fixed assets, and
policies concerning allowance for badd ebts.
But imperfect accounting rules are still effective. With respect
to earnings (as distinguished from, say, book value), accounting rules
work when properly and consistently applied. Even if depreciation
expense for fixedassets such as computers is not a perfect gauge of
the future costs of replacing them when they wear out, for example,
it does capture a minimum reasonable amount that must be reinvestedin
the business to maintain its sales level and competitive
position in the future.
Once a representative earnings figure is selected, the earnings
must be discounted. Doing this requires a suitable discount rate
(conventionally calledthe capitalization rate or cap rate). It is the
rate of return requiredto compensate for the risk of making the
investment, andso it is equal to the risk-free rate (that available on
U.S. Treasury obligations) plus an additional amount to reflect the
particular risk of the business.
Assume you determine that GE’s expected earnings over the next
four will be about $4.10 per share. The price you are willing to pay
for the right to that $4.10 per share in the future is a function of
the rate of return necessary to compensate for the risk that the $4.10
per year will not materialize. It will equal the risk-free rate—say,
3%—plus a premium to induce you to take the risk of owning GE
stock.
A robust debate centers on what the right cap rates are for different
businesses andtypes of investments. In general, the lower the
risks involvedin a particular type of business, the lower the cap rate.
For example, if there is a high degree of certainty that a business
will continue to perform as it has in the past, a cap rate in the range
of around10% is appropriate. For businesses that present moderate
degrees of risk, a cap rate in the range of 15 to 25% is better. For
particularly risky businesses, those where uncertainty about future
success is great, an appropriate cap rate couldrange from 30 to 40%
up to 100%.
Businesses whose earnings fluctuate widely in the ordinary
course may be seen as subject to a greater risk that estimatedearnings
will vary. For example, banks andinsurance companies whose
assets consist largely of cash or investments are more exposedto
cycles of economic change andmay warrant a discount rate in the
You Make the Call 141
range of 8 to 12%. Consumer products businesses—those selling
foods and detergents, for example—tend to remain more stable during
periods of both boom andbust andthus generally warrant a
lower-risk cap rate in the range of, say, 6 to 8%.
In addition to depending on the risk-free rate of interest, an
appropriate cap rate takes into account the rate of economic growth
in the overall economy. During periods of steady economic growth
andind ustry expansion, risks are relatively lower. During economic
downturns, growth is less likely, even steady earnings are less likely,
andthere is a greater likelihoodof overall earnings contractions. In
such an environment, risk rises, andyou shouldchoose higher cap
rates.
Therefore, the rules of thumb for cap rates have to be set according
to the risk-free rate, the risks of a particular business, and
those of industry in general. Equally important, we must adjust the
cap rate to allow for future variations. If interest rates rise or the
economy slows, for example, the cap rate will have to be increased,
andvice versa.
The difficulties in estimating earnings and selecting a cap rate
relate back to your circle of competence. Just as an appreciation of
economic history is essential, knowledge of the operating context is
indispensable for the forecasting exercise. GE, Microsoft, and Amazon.
com all look exceptionally well managed, with Amazon.com
even scoring some knockout points in the key ratios, though GE and
Microsoft also make money from goodmanagement.
GE is a money machine, particularly in its capital financing division.
It delivered steady earnings increases throughout nearly all
its 100 years and every year during the last 20. Its diverse businesses
andlead ership in virtually all of them suggest a reasonable basis for
forecasting continuedstead y earnings generation in the future,
though that is never free from doubt because of evolving economic
environments. With GE’s distinguished performance, however, a
modest cap rate is perfectly reasonable.
Let’s assume GE warrants a risk premium just above the riskfree
rate—say, 5%—andapply it to our estimate of average future
earnings of about $4.10. An estimate of GE’s value can be made
simply by dividing the earnings estimate by the cap rate, in other
words, $4.10 divided by .05, which equals $82 per share.
If we took a slightly more aggressive guess about GE’s earnings
prospects, our valuation wouldlook different. Suppose, for example,
we forecast the earnings at $5.00. Still using the cap rate of 5%
142 Show Me the Money
wouldgive us a value per GE share of $100 (5.00/.05). If you go
further andd eem a lower cap rate of, say, 4% more appropriate given
GE’s prowess andcurrent business opportunities and conditions, the
value per share shoots up to $125 (5.00/.04).
This play with the numbers gives a valuation for GE with a fairly
wide range of $82 to $125. The range is broader yet if we take a
more pessimistic view. If you use only the average earnings of the
past four years of $2.66 andstick with our original discount rate of
5%, the valuation is about $53. If you believe the roadahead is
riskier than the roadjust traveledso that a cap rate of, say, 6% is
more suitable, the value becomes $44 per share, generating a “Texas
range” from $44 to $125.
The selection of your earnings estimate andd iscount rate is crucial
to this exercise. (A plausible range of values for Amazon.com,
for example, starts from zero and goes to a few hundred dollars!)
But even if you make those selections ruthlessly, your result cannot
be the “answer” to the question of what a share of such stock is
“worth.” After all, there are plenty of steps in the process where your
judgment could turn out to be wrong.
SILVER BULLETS AND THE MARGIN OF SAFETY
Most people agree that discount rates are driven by the risk-free rate
of interest in effect from time to time, usually that available on U.S.
government bonds that are deemed free of any default risk. This
couldrange from the prevailing rate of about 3%, to the historical
average of about 3.5%, to the present rate on inflation-protected
government bonds of about 4%. Some people use bonds of shorter
durations (such as 30 days instead of 30 years), but since equities
are inherently long term (i.e., corporations have perpetual duration),
it is probably better to use the long bond.
After settling on a risk-free rate, you then add a premium for
your stock. The tendency is to look at the average rates of return on
equities overall for long periods of time, which has been roughly 7%.
That gives you an average risk premium of 3 to 3.5%, which must
be tailored to the individual stock you are investigating. The rules
of thumb mentionedabove get you a long way here, though you
shouldknow that many try to be very precise about these matters.
You Make the Call 143
Believers in the modern finance stories discussed earlier, for example,
multiply the market risk premium by a stock’s ß to come up with
an appropriate discount rate.
All this disagreement and the examples we’ve just gone through
show you that there is plenty of play in the valuation enterprise. Tiny
variations in your assumptions take the bottom line in widely different
directions and magnitudes. A 1% change in your guess about the
market premium, for example, throws off an appropriate level for the
S&P Index by about 200 points (and more if you also play around
with your estimate of future earnings growth rates).
Your best approach remains artistic judgment rather than scientific
precision. Phil Carret made it one of his investing commandments
to “ignore mechanical formulas for valuing securities.”10 Sorry
to disappoint you if you expected magical solutions and think you
haven’t gotten them. In a sense, though, magic is what you get.
Graham delivered the silver bullet of investing when he said the
three most important words in investing philosophy are “margin of
safety.” Recognizing that it is essentially impossible to pinpoint the
precise intrinsic value of a business andthat the best you can do is
compute reasonable ranges of value basedon reasonable assumptions,
Graham thought you shouldgive yourself a break by making
sure the price you pay is way lower than the low endof your valuation
estimate.
Graham calledthe margin of safety the central concept of investment
because its essential function is to render an accurate estimate
of the future unnecessary. In using it, you neednot stress or
struggle over the precise way to define the “right” risk premium,
earnings, or discount rate so long as you have a reasonable approximation
of what makes sense. Its secondary function is to absorb the
effect of error in your assumptions—andremember , even tiny errors
cause huge effects—as well as the effect of plain badluck.
Graham observedthat most investing errors are made not so
much by paying too high a price for high-quality stocks as by buying
low-quality stocks during times of economic prosperity (much as in
early 2000s America). Indeed, Graham repudiated a strategy that
overemphasizes what the fashion plates of finance call growth stocks.
If you can get the same margin of safety by carefully estimating the
future of growth stocks, more power to you, but the danger is that
growth stocks tendto be favorites andfavoritism in stocks is measuredby
high prices that steal safety margins.11
144 Show Me the Money
Graham saidthe margin of safety principle ultimately served as
the touchstone in distinguishing between investing and speculation.
Those who deny the difference between price and value or fail to
get a margin of safety take their seats at the roulette wheel. Place
your bets!
CASH
The same judgment can be applied to the cash a company is expectedto
generate andpay to shareholders in the future. The cash
dividend–based approach to valuation was championed by John Burr
Williams, who arguedas follows:
Earnings are only a means to an end, and the means should not
be mistaken for the end. Therefore we must say that a stock
derives its value from its dividends, not its earnings. In short, a
stock is worth only what you can get out of it.
In saying that dividends, not earnings, determine value, we
seem to be reversing the usual rule that is drilled into every
beginner’s headwhen he [or she] starts to trade in the market;
namely, that earnings, not dividends, make prices. The apparent
contradiction is easily explained, however, for we are discussing
permanent investment, not speculative trading, and dividends
for years to come, not income for the moment only.
Of course it is true that low earnings together with a high
dividend for the time being should be looked at askance, but
likewise it is true that these low earnings mean low dividends in
the long run. On analysis, therefore, it will be seen that no contradiction
really exists between our formula using dividends and
the common precept regarding earnings.12
Williams indicates that dividend discounting and earnings capitalization
give the same answer (or range of answers) to the question
of what a share of stock is worth.
This is the case because dividends are a subset of earnings. A
corporation can deploy its earnings either by paying them out to
shareholders as dividends or retaining them for reinvestment in the
business. If the retainedearnings generate a return equal to the cap
rate, the value you get from capitalizing the earnings stream will be
the same as the value you get from discounting the dividend stream.
Indeed, valuation by discounting dividends is analytically idenYou
Make the Call 145
tical to the capitalization of earnings technique. An assumedd ividendpayment
is dividedby an assumedd iscount rate, just as an
assumedearnings level was dividedby an assumed cap rate. In each
case, the questions are (1) What does the expected stream look like
in terms of amount andgrowth? and(2) What is the risk that the
amount andgrowth will not be realized?
The conceptual difference between the two techniques is that in
discounting dividends you assume that the value of a share of stock
is the present value of the expected dividend payments on it from
now until doomsday. This makes sense because the value of the stock
consists of the payment stream it yields while it is ownedandwhen
it is sold.
The only reason there will be a gain on sale is that some other
investor wants to buy the payment stream, andso on. These investors
may or may not be correct or even rational in that determination,
but it is precisely differences in valuation judgments that
leadto such exchanges anyway. As a result, the value of a share of
common stock resides solely in its expected stream of cash dividends.
Discounting dividends is just as difficult as capitalizing earnings
because both require selecting a highly sensitive discount rate. For
dividend discounting, many people try to minimize this difficulty by
using the subject’s weightedaverage cost of capital. But that is not
a uniquely correct number, andcalculating it requires just as much
judgment as they are trying to escape.
Calculating the weighted average cost of a company’s indebtedness
is relatively easy: It is the average interest rate on all long-term
obligations weightedaccord ing to the various amounts of principal
outstanding on each type of debt. Figuring out the cost of a company’s
equity capital is far harder.
The cost of equity is usually defined by what the market expects
the annualizedreturn on the stock to be, combining price appreciation
and dividend payout. But what are we really doing here? In
determining a stock’s value, we are trying to figure out what the
return is going to be. If your key variable in that figuring is what the
market expects, you are begging the question. You are assuming the
answer rather than analyzing the question.
You are better off forming your own value judgment. There is no
formula to tell you the answer, as these examples emphasize. Your
only friendat that point is the Graham-Buffett margin of safety, not
Mr. Market (you may be fallible; we know Mr. Market is).
146 Show Me the Money
MARKET CIRCULARITY
The greatest deficiency in using market metrics for valuation is the
problem of circularity. To say that a share of Exxon-Mobil is “worth”
what the stock last traded for tells you nothing about how that last
trade was valued. Of course we know how it was priced: by the forces
of supply andd emand in the stock market. We also know from Part
I that those forces are far from rational; are infectedby emotion,
psychology, andnoise; andmay even be chaotic.
But that is all we know. None of this tells you whether the price
is a product of analysis or hope or fear, is a product of discounting
expectedfuture earnings or cash flows, or is based on a determined
multiple of book values or on hunches andguesses.
You can try to penetrate the problem of market circularity by remembering
John BurrWilliams’s point that the value of any asset is the
amount of cash flow it will generate in the future, discounted by the
probability that those flows will materialize. You couldargue that a collection
of comparable assets yields a particular return and use that
comparable return as the discounting factor. But not only are you left
with the challenge of defining comparable assets, you still have not determinedthe
basis on which those comparable assets have been valued
(other than, again circularly, by the market’s collective judgment).
Countless books andarticles have been written about how interest
rates andother returns are determined by the market, but no
one knows for sure. Interest rates vary according to people’s collective
inclination to borrow for immediate consumption or invest for
future consumption (say, at retirement). These inclinations are
shaped not only by roughly quantifiable conditions such as productivity
andreturns andthe supply of money but by behavioral and
psychological conditions that are virtually impossible to measure and
in any event are highly unstable.
People undoubtedly have specific expectations about returns
from assets, but those expectations vary widely. Current survey data
show that people who livedd uring or in the aftermath of the Great
Depression now expect average annual returns on stock portfolios
that are in line with their averages in the postwar periodof close to
10% while younger people with only history lessons rather than personal
memories of that periodexpect returns in line with those of
the 1990s of closer to 20%. (A similar gap has existedin other periods,
such as the late 1960s.)13
You Make the Call 147
Neither of these groups is correct, for it is logically impossible
to say that any person is correct about the future. But these sorts of
expectations—founded in the infinitely complex map of human psychology
andexperience —furnish the underpinnings of the returns
the market generates. Great expectations are inherently unreliable,
andthe circularity of market metrics remains impenetrable.
Once you have made the call about value, you have to go to Mr.
Market to see what prices he is offering. While there, compare your estimation
of value to a few price ratios before making a final decision.
There is no guarantee that stocks with low price ratios offer value
higher than their price, but they are a goodplace to look. Nor do
high price ratios automatically mean a stock is unattractive, since
price still may be lower than value.14 Businesses with attractive operating
climates, liquidity and performance measures, and earnings
records deserve a close look, particularly but not exclusively if all
the price ratios are low andthe return on equity is high.
Price/Book Ratio
The relationship between a company’s stock market price andits
book value is calledthe price/book ratio (P/B ratio). It is equal to the
market price per share divided by book value per share.
Comparing the P/B ratio of one business with its peers is a way
to gauge how investors regardthat business compared to others or
the industry average. Higher P/B ratios mean that investors regard
the stock more favorably.
The average P/B ratio for publicly traded stock in the early 2000s
is around 2 to 3.5, with older, industrial companies (such as steel
companies) sometimes trading at P/B ratios near or below 1 and newer,
technology-orientedcompanies (such as computer software manufacturers)
sometimes trading at P/B ratios as high as 20 or more.
In our crop, Amazon.com’s P/B ratio leads the league at above
40, with Microsoft at about 15 andGE at 10. While none of these
fits the bill, if you finda stock trading below a P/B ratio of 1, you
can buy that stock for a price below the company’s net worth. Such
stocks are rare andcertainly warrant further investigation.
Price/Sales Ratio
For most companies, a strong relationship between a company’s
value andits sales levels shouldexist. Sales drive growth. More sales
148 Show Me the Money
mean more earnings. A company cannot grow faster than its sales,
but it can grow more slowly with poor management, which will be
reflectedin poor efficiency and performance ratios.
The sales figure is also less affectedby accounting conventions.
Since it is the top-line number on the income statement, pretty
much the only accounting rules affecting sales relate to the timing
of their recognition. While that can be manipulatedto an extent (this
is discussed further in Chapter 10), it is far purer than the bottomline
earnings number, which can be affectedby scores of accounting
conventions.
Calculate the price/sales ratio (P/S ratio) by dividing the stock
price by the sales per share (this is not commonly reportedin financial
statements but is an easy calculation to make). Alternatively, you
can follow the conventional but equivalent methodof dividing the
total market capitalization (price times shares outstanding) by the
total sales. Either way, if you can buy a stock for a price that is equal
to or less than the company’s sales, you are on your way to getting
a goodmargin of safety.
In our group, Microsoft is richly pricedcomparedto its sales at
a P/S ratio of about 20, with Amazon.com also heftily pricedat about
15, andGE at about 5. No bargains exist on these numbers, but
again, if you can finda company with a low P/S ratio, particularly
one that also has high profit margins, you are getting goodvalue for
money.
Price/Earnings Ratio
Investors commonly use market prices to compare businesses by relating
trading prices to earnings per share. This is called the priceearnings
ratio (P/E ratio), and it is computed by dividing the market
price of a share of common stock by the company’s earnings per
share. The limitations of using the earnings multiple for valuation
andthe ruthlessness requiredto specify a cap rate explain the popularity
of P/E ratios as guides for selection.
In general, higher P/E ratios suggest that investors are more optimistic
about a company’s prospects than they are about comparable
businesses with lower P/E ratios. The historical breakpoint for high
andlow P/E ratios has been 15—above that was high, and below it
was low. Very high P/E ratios (anything above 50) imply loads of
optimistic investors swooning over a company’s prospects. However,
the relative levels of P/E ratios also vary with a company’s growth outYou
Make the Call 149
look, industry, relative maturation (rookie, vintage, or classic), and
accounting policies usedin calculating net income. Don’t count on
P/E ratios being comparable across companies.
The P/E ratios of our group of companies fluctuated wildly during
the 1990s andearly 2000s, along with the volatile overall market.
But suppose the market price of a share of common stock sits between
25 and50 andsuppose its average earnings per share are
around$1.00. The P/E ratio thus has rangedfrom 25 to 50. The
implied cap rate hovers between 2% and4%. Does that mean you
shoulduse such rates? Why would it? But suppose a stock had a P/E
ratio of 5. Now that sounds like a deal with a thick margin of safety.
Economic Value Added
Consider an all-industry metric created (and trademarked!) by a
business consulting firm that apparently has realizedthat the marketplace
is thirsting for new tools to justify all kinds of crazy ideas.15
The tool has been cleverly named “economic value added” (EVA). It
says that a company’s performance can be evaluatedin terms of
whether returns on capital are higher than costs of capital. If they
are, value is being added.
Though the components of the EVA calculation are simple to
state—the company’s return on capital minus its weightedaverage
cost of capital—we already know that pinning down the latter is a
lot harder than it sounds.
For EVA, the weightedaverage cost of capital could be defined
simply as the appropriate discount rate at which to value the company,
but that doesn’t escape the circularity trap. Or it could be the
cost of the company’s indebtedness—the average interest rate paid
on its debt during the measured period. But if that is all it is, then
EVA is just another name for leverage.
If it includes a mixed measure of the cost of debt and the expectedreturn
on equity, the measure not only still has the problem
of circularity but also gets nonparsimonious. All it really tells you is
by how much a company beat expectations. If return on equity last
year was 10% andthe market this year expects the same 10% but the
company actually has delivered 12%, EVA says it increased value by
an additional 2%—but you don’t need a name like EVA to tell you
that.
Worse, part of the motivation to develop tools such as EVA was
to overcome earnings management techniques: managerial manip150
Show Me the Money
ulation of revenue recognition timing, restructuring charges, and
others discussed in the next chapter. These techniques proliferate in
proportion to investor emphasis on (or obsession with) whether a
company meets analysts’ earnings expectations. EVA exacerbates
rather than solves the problem, because it applauds managers only
when they exceedexpectations.
Moreover, if EVA is intended to measure a company’s ability to
generate profits for shareholders on the amount of their invested
capital, it potentially suffers from the same weaknesses of traditional
financial ratios: They all rely on the integrity of the underlying accounting
data used to calculate profit. EVA tends to increase rather
than reduce pressure on managers to manipulate (or make up) numbers.
None of this denies the underlying insight of EVA: assessing
performance basedon how much extra return is generated from a
dollar of investment. Indeed, in evaluating managerial performance,
we shouldd educt from reported results a charge for the capital employed
in producing them (something rarely done, especially in connection
with reports andreward s of stock options tied to returns, a
subject discussed in Part III). For some companies—Coke under
Roberto Goizueta, for example—returns on capital are so impressive
that even with difficulties in pinning down the cost of capital, there
is no question that returns exceedcosts by impressive distances.16
Obsession with EVA puts a false premium on precision, just as
the tools of modern finance discussed earlier do. Though he believes
in the basic idea underlying EVA, Warren Buffett often says he prefers
to be approximately right than precisely wrong. Speaking publicly
at the Berkshire Hathaway 2000 annual shareholders meeting,
Charlie Munger put it more epigrammatically with a characteristically
unglovedd enunciation of EVA: “bullshit.”
Graham’s comments on market price andbusiness value are
worth memorizing:
The acceptedid ea that a common stock should sell at a certain
ratio to its current earnings must be considered more the result
of practical necessity than of logic. The market takes the trend
or future prospects into account by varying this ratio for different
types of companies. Common stocks of enterprises with only
slight possibilities of increasing profits ordinarily sell at a rather
low price-earnings ratio (less than 15 times their current earnings);
andthe common stocks of companies with good prospects
You Make the Call 151
of increasing the earnings usually sell at high price-earnings ratio
(over 15 times the current earnings). . . .
When neither boom nor deep depression is affecting the
market, the judgment of the public on individual issues, as indicated
by market prices, is usually quite good. If the market
price of some [stock] appears out of line with the facts and
figures available, it will often be foundlater that the price is
discounting future developments not then apparent on the surface.
There is, however, a frequent tendency on the part of the
stock market to exaggerate the significance of changes in earnings
both in a favorable andunfavorable direction. This is manifest
in the market as a whole in periods of both boom and
depression, and it is also evidenced in the case of individual
companies at other times.
At bottom the ability to buy [stocks] successfully is the ability
to look aheadaccurately . Looking backward, however carefully,
will not suffice, and may do more harm than good. Common
stock selection is a difficult art—naturally, since it offers
large rewards for success. It requires a skillful mental balance
between the facts of the past andthe possibilities of the future.17
This page intentionally left blank.
153
C h a p t e r 1 0
MAKING (UP)
NUMBERS
Accounting shenanigans have plaguedbookkeeping since it was
inventedby Luca Pacioli in 1494, andthere is no reason to expect
that the next 500 years will stray from the historical pattern.
No amount of rule making—from accounting, auditing, or elsewhere—
can ensure the integrity of financial reporting. Rules cannot
eliminate managerial discretion, and there will always be the possibility
of imaginative, unorthodox, creative, and even fraudulent financial
reporting.
Investors andmanagers shouldexpect it and, instead of wishing
it away, take pains not to be its victims or accomplices. Just think
of the notorious accounting frauds of relatively recent memory—
from Leasco, National Student Marketing, and Penn Central in the
late 1960s andearly 1970s to Cendant, MicroStrategy, and Sunbeam
in the late 1990s andearly 2000s. These frauds sting investors, and
managers who engage in them shouldknow they will be caught,
punished, and made to pay (though investors will not profit in the
process).
The nonfraudulent cases are often the trickier to deal with. They
consist of a variety of smoothing techniques designed to massage the
whole range of financial numbers, from the ratios discussed previously
to income itself. Income smoothing, also known as earnings
management, exploits the flexibility of generally acceptedaccounting
principles to classify transactions or allocate them by time periodto
achieve favorable financial reporting.
PERENNIALS
SEC Chairman Arthur Levitt delivered a series of major speeches in
the late 1990s and early 2000s identifying several long-standing ac-
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
154 Show Me the Money
counting issues that are hallmarks of earnings management. These
techniques are as oldas accounting itself andhave been used to full
advantage (sometimes appropriately, often not) by managers over the
centuries. Yet the contemporary problems are heightened, according
to Levitt, by a managerial obsession with meeting consensus earnings
estimates formulatedby the increasingly influential profession
of investment analysis.
This dizzying obsession with “making numbers” is documented
by the accounting professors DavidBurgstahler of the University of
Washington andIlia Dichev of the University of Michigan.1 They
show that about one in ten managers facing small declines in earnings
manage to show earnings increases, andthat about four in ten
facing negative earnings manage to report positive earnings! The obsession
with “making numbers” leads managers to make them up.
Levitt singledout five issues of particular concern, giving each
a catchy phrase intended, one supposes, for both poetic and mnemonic
value.
• Big bath. Big bath accounting is a particularly aggressive version
of earnings management that is sort of a financial face-lift. It
lumps major events adversely affecting income in current periods
to facilitate improved financial appearances in succeeding periods.
It is particularly common in, but by no means limitedto, costs
occasionedby acquisitions, divestitures, reorganizations, and other
extraordinary organic business changes. These transactions call for
numerous accounting judgments in regard to both timing and classification.
Managers often expense as much of the potential cost
of a transaction at the time it is consummatedas possible. It’s also
tempting to give current earnings a “big bath” in one year to create
a brighter-looking future when the year is so dismal anyway that
investors have written it off (this happens all the time, even at
otherwise reputable companies).
• Merger magic. This describes a subset of creative accounting in
acquisitions. If a business buys another business for a price higher
than the seller’s book value, the buyer in most cases must record
an asset called accounting goodwill (discussed in the last chapter)
and amortize that account as an expense over future decades. That
reduces earnings over that period. To minimize the reduction, a
buyer’s manager can allocate some or a lot of that excess to other
things, most notoriously to in-progress research-and-development
Making (Up) Numbers 155
(R&D) costs. Accounting rules require such R&D costs to be expensedwhen
incurred(rather than amortized), and so many buyers
allocate that excess as a one-time expense at the merger time even
when that allocation defies business reality.
• Cookie jar reserves. This entails the overestimation or underestimation
of things such as sales returns by publishers, probable loan
losses of lending institutions, and warranty obligations for manufacturers.
The incorrect estimation enables managers to adjust and
smooth out earnings as actual earnings vary from expectedearnings
periodto period.
• It’s not material. The materiality principle requires the reporting
of items that are material andallows the nonreporting of items
that are not. Materiality is not an absolute concept but entails
making judgments. A standard legal formulation for public corporations
under federal securities laws is whether an item would
be important to an investor in making an investment decision
about a security (the accounting rule similarly asks whether it
would influence a reasonable person’s judgment). Judgments concerning
materiality are often guided by rough rules of thumb. One
rule of thumb accountants and auditors often use in determining
materiality is whether a particular item entails more than, say, a
5% impact on a company’s earnings. But applying such a simple
rule couldleadto excluding things that are meaningful to a user
of the financial statements in a qualitative sense.
• Wine before its time. This image of popping open a bottle of wine
before it matures reflects the premature recognition of revenue.
For instance, a toy manufacturer may tag goods in a warehouse as
“sold” even though they are not and may never be sold, or a distributor
of cell phones may recordrevenue for merchandise that
it shippedandreceivedpayment for but that is subject to free
return by the buyer for a periodof, say, 90 days.
To address these manipulations, the SEC called for immediate
andcoord inatedaction, seeking nothing less than a fundamental
change in American corporate culture. Levitt articulateda multifacetedprogram,
beginning with instructing the SEC staff to scrutinize
financials for abuses of restructuring accounting andaccruals for
losses andreserves. He askedthe American Institute of Certified
Public Accountants (AICPA) to clarify auditing rules concerning
purchasedR&D, large acquisition write-offs, and revenue recogni156
Show Me the Money
tion. He also instructedthe SEC staff to focus on materiality not
solely in quantitative terms but also in qualitative terms, reject the
notion that materiality can excuse minor errors, andpromulgate new
standards on revenue recognition.
Levitt also called on private standard-setting organizations to join
the cause, particularly asking the Financial Accounting Standards
Board (FASB) to reconsider the definition of liabilities under generally
acceptedaccounting principles. He encouraged the Public
Oversight Boardto review andintensify its focus on the audit
committees of boards and recruit more members with financial backgrounds
(as opposed to legal, marketing and public service backgrounds).
He envisioned audit committees meeting more often and
asking tougher questions—what he calleda “private sector response.”
He impaneleda blue ribbon commission to report on ways
to enhance the audit committee’s role and ultimately called upon
management itself andW all Street to revitalize integrity in financial
reporting by cooperating andsupporting these initiatives.
This program emboldened the SEC to prosecute scores of enforcement
actions against companies engagedin earnings management
of the sort Levitt highlighted. The SEC adopted tougher rules
governing audits, including a requirement that quarterly financial
statements be reviewedby auditors, andmateriality rules that expressly
deal with qualitative and quantitative dimensions.2
Audit committees must now review and vouch for the accuracy
of financial statements, provide a report in proxy statements concerning
whether they signedoff on the financial statements, state
whether a written charter spells out the committee’s duties, and submit
any such charter to the SEC every three years. The stock exchanges
adopted rules requiring listed companies to disclose
whether members of the audit committee are independent of management
andrequiring audit committee members to have a financial
background.3
Levitt’s ambitious crusade is ongoing, and investors should support
those who carry it out. No amount of effort, however, can eliminate
the inevitable flexibility that generally acceptedaccounting
principles provide or the temptations or capitulations to which they
lead. It remains for the intelligent investor to monitor financial reporting
with measuredskepticism andstay alert to the possibility of
distortion. While the past is no guarantee of the future, it certainly
is prologue, andas early as 1936 Ben Graham lampooned corporate
Making (Up) Numbers 157
America for its abuses of financial reporting, as have many since,
most notably City University of New York accounting professor Abraham
Briloff.4
SATIRE
Graham satirically hypothesizeda phantom US Steel Corporation
adopting “advanced bookkeeping methods” to report “phenomenally
enhanced” earnings without any cash outlays or changes in operating
conditions or sales. To update that illustration of accounting
chicanery, consider how a phantom company might today achieve
the same results by using techniques like those Levitt denounces.
Its press release andaccompanying financial reports might look like
this:
E-America Dot.Com Announces Positive Earnings
E-America Dot.Com today announced positive earnings, stunning
Wall Street analysts whose consensus view estimatedcontinued negative
earnings for the start-up that went public last year. Its stock
price shot up 40% on the news. Though this response is usually reservedfor
companies that report negative earnings, we believe it is
justifiedfor the same sort of reasons—none.
Rather than taking any action to increase sales or improve its
products, marketing strategy, distribution channels, or customer service,
the earnings increase was due to improvements in the manner
in which the company’s economic activity is recorded in its books.
These new bookkeeping methods report profits of $50 per share insteadof
the $25 loss per share that otherwise would be reported. The
accounting improvements consist of the following steps:
• Modifying revenue recognition policies
• Adjusting reserves and treatment of returns
• Recording the value of market share as an asset
• Recording the amount of cash we “burn” as an asset
• Reporting in a different currency
• Refining the concept of materiality
The Boardof Directors of E-America Dot.Com, in collusion with
their auditors, reached the following conclusions in adopting this pro158
Show Me the Money
gram in a resolution unanimously approvedat its boardmeeting this
week:
The Board of Directors and its Independent Outside Auditors,
after careful study and review, determined that the accounting policies
andpractices the company usedsince its recent initial public offering
ten months ago are outdated and do not reflect the kind of performance
managers of the company expect or predict.
The Boardandits Auditors, aidedandabettedby a special audit
committee, determined that many other companies obtain a competitive
advantage in the capital markets by reporting accounting results
in terms of innovative, cutting-edge techniques and that the company
was penalizedfor failing to follow these best practices, referred to as
the “New Accounting.”
Adopting the New Accounting will neutralize this disadvantage
andenable the company to increase its market capitalization without
the needfor disbursing cash or changing any of its operating activities.
The changes adopted by the Board, with the attestation of its Auditors,
are as follows:
m o d i f y i n g r e v e n u e
r e c o g n i t i o n p o l i c i e s
Competitive conditions in our industry lead us to give generous credit
terms to our customers. These include giving them the right to return
goods to us for a full refund if they cannot resell them to the ultimate
consumer within 180 days. We formerly deferred recognizing the
revenue in connection with such transactions until after that 180-
day periodpassedon the grounds that no sale was complete until
then.
But this oldeconomy policy substantially reduced the amount of
reported sales reflected on our income statement. The Board decided
to treat those transactions as sales right away, on the grounds that
our sales team put tireless effort into generating them andshould get
credit. (We can make adjustments for returns later, but for now we
wouldrather report the goodnews in the short term andd efer the
badnews for the long term.)
In particular, we will occasionally “park” inventory with our customers,
to whom we give unconditional return rights either orally or
in “side letters” kept separate from the sales documents. As a result
of this scheme, we will report much higher sales revenue andd ramatic
increases in earnings. If adjustments must be made to smooth those
earnings, we will restate past earnings in subsequent quarterly reports
Making (Up) Numbers 159
andd isclose that these resultedfrom a problem with the “collectibility”
of our accounts receivable.
a d j u s t i n g r e s e r v e s a n d
t r e a t m e n t o f r e t u r n s
In the financing arm of our business, we intendto reduce the amount
of reserves we recordfor delinquent anduncollectible accounts by
reporting them as current. To do so, we will in some cases simply
extend the due dates of our customers’ obligations. In others, we will
assume that we can repossess the items securedby these delinquent
loans whether or not that is feasible. This enables us to recordfar
lower reserves in our allowance for credit losses, thus increasing our
net income.
Similarly, in all of our businesses, we will recordcustomers’ returns
of merchandise as purchases of goods rather than charging
them against our reserves for returns. Another benefit of this new
policy is to increase our receivable turns, making our operations look
speedier and more efficient.
r e c o r d i n g t h e v a l u e o f
m a r k e t s h a r e a s a n a s s e t
A hot trendin the marketplace for traders andspeculators is to assign
a value to Internet companies basedon the percentage of their product
market their sales levels represent. This is necessary to justify the
stratospheric prices being paidfor stocks of these companies in initial
public offerings andin exchange trading. After all, most of these
companies do not generate any earnings or even positive cash flows.
Staying aheadof the stampede, we are moving one logical step further
by listing the value of this market share on our balance sheet as an
asset.
Every quarter we will gauge the amount of value the market is
giving us basedon our market share andrecordthat in an asset account
calledmarket share. This may seem like a “belts-andsuspenders”
policy given that our other New Accounting changes will
enable us to report actual earnings andactual cash flows which otherwise
wouldbe negative. Nevertheless, we believe that this is what
shareholders andmarket players want, andwe are just trying to cooperate.
160 Show Me the Money
r e c o r d i n g t h e a m o u n t o f
c a s h w e “ b u r n ” a s a n a s s e t
Companies with negative cash flows sometimes get credit for the
amount of cash they raise andspendon researching new products.
This is especially true in the biotechnology industry, but we see no
reason why the logic of that approach shouldnot extendto our businesses
as well. Speculators andtrad ers give substantial valuation
credit for this cash burn.
Beginning today, we will treat the amount of our cash burn as an
asset on the balance sheet rather than as an expense on the income
statement. On the other hand, because of the significant impact that
the treatment of disbursed cash as an expense or an asset has on our
earnings, we reserve the right from time to time to alternate between
these treatments, depending on the trend in reported earnings from
quarter to quarter.
r e p o r t i n g i n a d i f f e r e n t
c u r r e n c y
We sell many of our products and conduct a clearinghouse operation
for other businesses in a barter exchange Web site on the Internet.
In lieu of trading (or bartering) such goods and services directly, however,
exchange members use our trademarked “dot-com dollars,” issued
to them by us for the purpose of bartering. These dot-com dollars
have a face value far greater than the U.S. dollar and we propose to
record certain of our assets and sales transactions in dot-com dollars
rather than U.S. dollars, thereby substantially increasing the amounts
of reportedassets andincome (we are not fools, however, so expenses
andliabilities, of course, will continue to be reported in U.S. dollars).
r e f i n i n g t h e c o n c e p t o f
m a t e r i a l i t y
Lawyers andaud itors often place great weight on whether some economic
event is material to our company or not. They define materiality
in terms of what a reasonable investor thinks about its impact on the
business or financial condition of the company. In the past, this led
us to report in our financial statements details that don’t really seem
Making (Up) Numbers 161
to matter very much to the managers at our company or to other
owners of options on our stock.
To reconcile managerial needs with the requirements of financial
reporting, the board adopted a new rule of materiality. Under it, no
economic activity is material to the company unless it impacts our
earnings by at least 5%. This rule is more definitive and reliable than
the oldrule andwill result in greater certainty in our bookkeeping
department. By applying this approach to materiality, we can ignore
a variety of burdensome reporting questions, thus saving (material)
basketfuls of money.
As satire, the report from E-America Dot.Com reveals how atrocious
andd istorted aggressive accounting and earnings management
can be. (Most of the examples are basedon actual cases.) However,
you will never see the kindof candor expressedin this news release
coming out of corporations. That kindof honesty is inconsistent with
the goals underlying the shenanigans.
Accordingly, you will not recognize financial disingenuousness,
recklessness, aggressiveness, deception, or fraud when you see it unless
you know how to look. You will findthe following examples of
recent financial chicanery helpful andwill benefit from constant perusal
of the reports of financial deception chronicled virtually daily
in newspapers, newsletters, andreputable Web sites.
In thinking about such charades, note that many frequently criticizedtechniques
are not always unlawful and do not necessarily
violate generally acceptedaccounting principles. Often, however,
they impair the integrity of financial reporting. Worse, a corporate
or financial reporting culture that condones aggressive practices creates
the risk of degradation of financial reporting: What starts as
merely aggressive can create pressure that leads reporting over the
line andinto the fraudulent.
There is always pressure to engage in accounting shenanigans.
Many scandals suggest that irregular accounting is especially acute
at businesses with poor economic characteristics andthose facing
tough competitive conditions. A company’s contractual profile may
increase pressure for aggressive or irregular accounting. Many loan
agreements, for example, contain promises by the borrower to maintain
certain financial ratios, including debt-to-equity ratios and the
others discussedearlier , andcan leadmanagers to meet those promises
by finessing.
Incentive compensation agreements triggeredby meeting sales
or earnings targets may encourage accounting games. Similar pres162
Show Me the Money
sures emerge from settlement agreements, consent decrees, and the
other legal obligations a company faces. Planning for additional financing
can produce pretty pictures despite dismal performance.
More generally, in an investment climate obsessedwith short-term
results, as Levitt cautioned, there is invariably pressure to sustain
steady increases in earnings growth.
CHARADES
There are lots of aggressive accounting techniques andopportunities
for difficult judgment calls, and so it would be surprising for any
two scandals to be identical.5 However, most accounting scandals
have a simple common denominator: Earnings are inflated. One of
the most common ways to inflate earnings is to treat as an expense
something that shouldbe treatedas an asset or a liability. This deception
hides the costs of doing business on the balance sheet so
that they never burden the income statement.
Dissecting most accounting scams requires only a rudimentary
understanding of simple bookkeeping rules and their relationship to
financial statements. Double-entry bookkeeping requires a debit and
a credit in equal amounts for every transaction. The double entries
keep a balance sheet equalized(assets always equal liabilities plus
net worth) andreflect the direct relationship between income (revenue
minus expenses) andnet worth.
More particularly, increases in asset or expense accounts require
debits, and decreases in them require credits; increases in liability
or revenue accounts require credits, and decreases in them require
debits. These bookkeeping rules are invariant, and so short of making
up or not recording transactions, the trickery involves classifying
transactions as assets or expenses or as liabilities or revenues.
Pearson/Penguin
Consider how the Pearson conglomerate accounted for book sales
through its Penguin publishing division. Sales made on credit require
two entries in equal amounts: a debit to Accounts Receivable,
the asset account, anda credit to Sales, the revenue account. Subsequent
receipt of the cash payment requires a debit to Cash and a
credit to Accounts Receivable.
Penguin began granting 10% discounts off its list price to selected
Making (Up) Numbers 163
buyers who paidtheir accounts early. Following bookkeeping rules,
receipt of those early cash payments calledfor a credit to Accounts
Receivable equal to 100% of the list price. Since the buyer received
a 10% discount on the price, the debits should have been made to
Cash for 90% of the list price, with the other 10% going to an expense
account. Adding it up, those 10% discount expenses would have reduced
reported earnings.
Insteadof following these standard bookkeeping rules, Pearson
apparently recorded receipts of early payments as a debit to Cash
for 90% of the list price anda credit to Accounts Receivables for
90% of the list price, andso the 10% discount never showed up as
an expense. It simply remainedpart of the asset account—Accounts
Receivable—andartificially inflated reported earnings.
While Penguin’s 10% individual discounts given on a per customer
basis may at first seem like small change, they aggregatedover
six years to $163 million. Pearson’s management eventually discoveredthe
buriedd iscounts when integrating Penguin and Pearson’s
newly acquiredPutnam Berkley publishing house. Dirty bookkeeping
then turnedinto housecleaning.
Mercury Finance
In January 1997 Mercury Finance announcedthat it hadoverstated
earnings for the first three quarters of 1996 andfor the whole of
1995 by a total of more than 100%. All corporate hell broke loose at
Mercury Finance, a company in the business of lending to consumers
with weak credit ratings. Its CEO and controller both left, a
turnaround specialist was recruited, and pending deals with the
Bank of Boston andSalomon Brothers were terminated. It lacked
cash to meet its maturing commercial paper obligations andteetered
on the edge of bankruptcy.
The company and the consumer finance industry made headlines
every other day. Some commentators correctly noted that many companies
in high-risk businesses like Mercury Finance’s use “aggressive
accounting techniques”; other so-calledexperts incorrectly stated
that accounting in finance companies is “extraordinary complex.” It
is not all that complex.
To lenders, loans are assets even though some loans are unlikely
to be repaid. Bad loans are an expense—a cost of doing business.
Expenses reduce net income. Estimating the amount of bad loans
may involve complex judgments, but the accounting is simple. The
164 Show Me the Money
portion of loans deemed uncollectible is recorded as an expense (a
debit). The credit is to an account called Allowance for Doubtful
Receivables.
Insteadof treating all badloans as expenses, Mercury Finance
apparently decided that even if a borrower was not going to pay,
somehow the company wouldrecover the money (by repossessing
the borrower’s car, for example). In the bookkeeping, a debit was
made to an asset account called Other Assets to reflect the right to
repossess rather than to an expense account to reflect that the loan
probably was never going to be paid. With fewer reported expenses,
Mercury Finance reportedfar higher earnings.
A bright redflag flew over Mercury Finance’s financial statements.
The Other Assets account on its balance sheet rocketedfrom
$24.6 million at the endof 1994 to $121 million a year later. Even if
the account included other assets besides repossession rights, the
striking increase shouldhave seemedpeculiar to anyone with a little
accounting sense (or even common sense).
America Online
America Online’s asset- andexpense-flipping imbroglio resulted from
treating disbursements for developing a subscriber base not as a cost
of doing business (an expense) but as an investment in the business
(an asset). While this is exactly what was done in the National Student
Marketing scandal of the late 1960s and early 1970s, there was
a judgment to make here.
One couldliken on-line services to newspapers and follow that
industry’s practice of expensing these costs, or one could analogize
to direct mail order companies and follow that industry’s practice of
capitalizing them—treating them as assets whose cost is allocated
over future accounting periods.
In choosing between these treatments, the accounting issue is
whether the disbursements will contribute reliably to revenue generation
in future periods. As it turned out, America Online could
not gauge for how long its new subscribers wouldremain customers,
andso there was no basis for saying the disbursements would increase
future revenue.
Maybe it was reasonable for AOL’s managers andaud itors to
make the judgment they made. After the horrible press coverage and
class action shareholder lawsuit that resulted, however, you can be
sure they regret it.
Making (Up) Numbers 165
As with Mercury Finance, a telltale redflag flew high: AOL’s
balance sheet showedan unusual asset called Deferred Subscriber
Acquisition Costs. Mushrooming to $385 million between August
1995 andOctober 1996, it became the largest asset on AOL’s balance
sheet. Angry shareholder agitation forced AOL to abandon the practice
in the fall of 1996 andrestate its earnings, wiping out about 80%
of owners’ equity.
Fabri-Centers
Judgment plays a critical role in corporate accounting decisions, enabling
managers to persuade auditors and directors to accept their
position when choosing to expense or capitalize a transaction or
make other accounting decisions. Even when the managerial decision
is accepted, full disclosure about the judgment should be included
in the company’s financial statements but isn’t always.
If you have any doubt about the need for disclosing these difficult
judgment calls, consider the enlightening story behind the settlement
of SEC charges against Fabri-Centers, an operator of over
900 retail stores, including the JoAnn Fabrics chain. Fabri-Centers
knew the daily sales figures at its stores but could not determine the
cost of goods sold or the profit margin until it conducted an annual
inventory, andso it estimatedthem, using the so-called gross profit
methodof applying the prior year’s actual profit margin to calculate
quarterly profits for the succeeding year.
During several quarters, however, heavy price competition substantially
eroded the margin. Before the erosion was reported or publicly
disclosed, the company effected a public debt offering. The SEC
charged Fabri-Centers with inadequate disclosure about price competition
andits estimation practice in that offering.
Under Fabri-Centers’ inventory system (it has since been modernized),
a judgment about quarterly profit margins was necessary.
But those involvedin the debt offering—aware that the quarterly
financial statements were unauditedandprepared in anticipation of
the offering—shouldhave paidgreater attention to the role that accounting
estimates played.
Sunbeam
Sunbeam committeda distinct but all too common type of accounting
fraud. Its widely publicized accounting machinations boiled down to
166 Show Me the Money
a series of so-calledbill-and -holdtransactions. During the winter
months, it recorded charcoal grill sales even though the grills were
not to be shippeduntil the spring. This manipulative maneuver enabledit
to report higher sales in the winter.
The accounting shenanigan took place near the endof the reign
of the self-proclaimedturnaround king Al Dunlap. Upon taking the
helm at Sunbeam—which was floundering from a substantial business
downturn—Dunlap fired half its workers and closed or consolidated
more than half its facilities. Boasting that he aimed to “attack”
his company, Dunlap declared that his plan was as carefully plotted
as the invasion of Normandy. (Alas, Dunlap is no Churchill, and all
his plans for Sunbeam failedmiserably .) With that kindof siege
mentality driving the company, accounting irregularities might not
have been inevitable, but they were certainly made more likely.
MicroStrategy
Sunbeam’s travails of revenue recognition have spreadthrough other
businesses, especially the computer software companies that Levitt
singledout for special illustration. One of the most dramatic examples
of the potential fallout occurredat the software company
MicroStrategy.
MicroStrategy enteredinto several unusual contracts under
which it bought andsoldsomething from the other party. The dual
deal enabledMicroStrategy to recordrevenue much earlier than accounting
rules permit andto obscure that accounting from the auditors
reviewing its books.
Pressure from journalists compelledthe company andits auditors
to scrutinize those contracts, and they ultimately decided the
earlier accounting hadbeen incorrect. Shazam! When the company
finally came clean, its stock price plungedfrom $245 to $87 per
share (over a 60% wipeout). Who lost? Popeyedsharehold ers.
Cendant
Obfuscatory language in corporate disclosure signifies brewing trouble.
This is only one of the scores of lessons learnedfrom the
notorious accounting scandal that unfolded in the late 1990s at Cendant
Corporation, a company formed by the merger in late 1997 of
CUC International andHFS Inc.
CUC operateda members-only discount shopping service that
Making (Up) Numbers 167
generatedrevenue through membership dues. On average, membership
clubs like these earn greater profits from long-term members
than from short-term members. Indeed, the tendency is to make zero
profit from members enrolledless than a year because they are typically
entitledto a cancellation refundof dues.
As early as 1989, CUC met with some accounting embarrassment
for its practice of recognizing as revenue the total amount of each
membership payment in the periodit was received while expensing
amounts allocable to each membership over a three-year period. In
bookkeeping terms, it debited revenue while crediting both an expense
account andsome liability account, a mismatching that
boostedreportedearnings.
Although CUC retreatedfrom that position after harsh criticism
by financial analysts andothers, it continued practicing aggressive
accounting in other areas. Chief among these practices was its reporting
technique for membership flow andannual renewal rates—
important information for gauging company prospects given that
newer members contribute little or nothing to the bottom line while
the real value is in long-term members.
Among new members enrolledat the endof a given year, 70%
renewed, but the way CUC reported this in its disclosure made it
seem as if 70% of all members who joined during the year renewed.
Thus, if 100 members were in andout during the year but 10 remainedmembers
at year end, the 70% figure meant that 7 renewed
even though it lookedlike 70 renewed—a tenfold difference in the
company’s prospects.
This misleading disclosure represents only one egregious example
of numerous irregularities at the company, as a subsequent $2.8
billion settlement of an investor lawsuit anda forensic accounting
report later made clear. The report emphasized that these practices
manifestedan overall culture of pernicious accounting practices.
Others included manipulating books relating to the percentage of
refundable membership dues, cash management, and even how the
merger between CUC andHFS that created Cendant was accounted
for.
CODA
Aggressive or irregular accounting is not a sign of business promise.
The trouble is, it is often hard to detect. Buffett quipped: “It has
168 Show Me the Money
been far safer to steal large sums with a pen than small sums with
a gun.”6 Steering clear of such robbery requires attention to managers,
who shape corporate culture. Some corporate cultures encourage
laudable accounting practices, while others—as these chicaneries
illustrate—encourage what Ben Graham called
“prestidigitation” or magical numbers.7 From National Student Marketing
to Cendant, the question is the tone of trust at the top, which
raises the subject of the next part of this book.
P a r t I I I
IN MANAGERS
WE TRUST
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
This page intentionally left blank.
171
C h a p t e r 1 1
GOING GLOBAL
Warren Buffett repeatedly emphasized the importance of investing
only with people you “like, trust, and admire” (the phrase
appears over a dozen times in The Essays of Warren Buffett: Lessons
for Corporate America). Ben Graham deemphasized this managerial
factor in investment selection, but not because he did not thinkit
was important.
Graham’s trouble was the difficulty in measuring the management
factor. He believed that until “objective, quantitative, and reasonably
reliable tests of managerial competence are devised and applied,
this factor will continue to be looked at through a fog.”1 The
best Graham thought an investor could do to gauge the management
factor was to lookat historical financial performance as it is reported
in financial statements.
At the same time, one of Graham’s key principles of investing as
business analysis focused squarely on integrity. Graham implored
investors not to entrust wealth to someone else unless either (1) the
investor could supervise that person or (2) the investor had “unusually
strong reasons for placing implicit confidence in his integrity
and ability.”2 Graham was expressly talking about investment advisers,
but the point applies equally to managers. After all, whether
an investor uses an intermediary or not, her wealth is in the hands
of business managers.
A fog still clouds the view of managerial ability and trustworthiness,
but consider two important points. First, the corporate governance
field has blossomed since Graham wrote, and many people
argue that it now contributes clearer ways of thinking about and
measuring managerial integrity and effectiveness. Second, Graham
implicitly noted the importance of managerial trustworthiness when
he deferred to the financial record as a gauge of managerial ability.
As we just saw, the reliability of historical financial statements depends
on managerial trustworthiness.
While managerial ability and trustworthiness may not warrant an
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
172 In Managers We Trust
increase in your estimate of a company’s value, the weakness or
absence of these qualities certainly justifies the opposite. As Buffett
says: “Investors should pay more for a business that is lodged in the
hands of a manager with demonstrated pro-shareholder leanings
than for one in the hands of a self-interested manager marching to
a different drummer.”3
To set the stage for examining managerial integrity and ability, it
is first useful to consider the standards of behavior managers are
held to both in the United States and around the industrialized
world. Much rhetoric characterizes discussion of these conventions,
but the reality is often at odds with it. Let’s take a brief tour of the
world stage of corporate governance before zeroing in on specific
indicators of pro-shareholder management.4
THE TWO-WORLD STORY
Customarily, it is believed that corporations in the United States and
the United Kingdom (U.K.) operate primarily for the benefit of
shareholders. This contrasts with corporations in Japan, Germany,
and other Continental European countries, where managers
are thought to operate for the common good—for the benefit of
shareholders, workers, creditors, and communities. At an abstract
level both generalizations are correct, but on closer inspection neither
is.
This comparison describes the U.S./U.K. approach as a shareholder
market model. In it, two internal groups constitute and regulate
a corporation: managers and shareholders. Shareholders own
the corporation’s equity, the value of which fluctuates with the fortunes
of the corporation. Managers consist of both the daily operators
of the corporation (the officers) and those who oversee and
supervise those operations (the directors).
The key problem in U.S. and U.K. corporate governance is the
separation of ownership from control that results from the
shareholder-manager dichotomy. Two broad sets of mechanisms address
the issues raised by this problem. Monitoring mechanisms either
impose duties on managers or empower shareholders to take
action against them. Exit mechanisms include, most importantly, the
free transferability of ownership interests, which enables shareholders
to sell their stockand thus exit the corporation at will; this often
is called the Wall Street rule.
Monitoring and exit mechanisms reinforce the financial and laGoing
Global 173
bor markets, and vice versa. Shareholders can oust inferior managements
because a market for managing and controlling corporations
exists. The free transferability of ownership interests—an exit mechanism—
has contributed to the development of deep, liquid, and active
(if not efficient) capital markets. Disclosure laws in the United
States, which promote the transparency of corporations’ performance,
have substantially aided these market forces.
Corporate transparency, coupled with the U.S./U.K. tradition of
at-will employment, also facilitates reasonably well-functioning labor
markets. For example, if managers perform poorly, corporate transparency
makes it more likely that shareholders will vote to oust them
and other corporations will not hire them readily.
At the same time, however, managers can contract and expand
the employee base to enhance performance. Of course, labor unions
often gain substantial power through collective bargaining agreements
which contract and federal labor laws protect. That power
does not derive, however, from externally imposed regulation but
instead is the product of voluntary arrangements.
Consumer product markets also contribute to the discipline of
corporate managerial performance by registering preferences which
eventually lead to corporate profits. Nonetheless, in the end, labor
markets are far from perfect, and it is not uncommon to see senior
executives earn staggering compensation despite mediocre or subpar
performance.
The great American pastime of litigation reinforces these monitoring
mechanisms. Shareholders are equipped with a vast arsenal
of legal claims, procedural devices, and legal and equitable remedies
to protect their interests. They benefit from a specialized group of
lawyers who not only bring direct, derivative, and class action suits
under both state and federal law but also identify and communicate
the bases for such actions and even finance them.
The rights of other constituencies in a U.S. corporation differ
from those of shareholders. Contracts set employee, supplier, creditor,
and customer rights. The primary rationale for this treatment
is that in bankruptcy, shareholders are last in line after the claims
of all the other groups are paid off. This means that when managers
act for the shareholders they indirectly protect the interests of all
those claimants.
The central finance characteristic of this market model is fragmented
ownership of equity securities in corporations. An underlying
cultural aspect of the fragmented ownership structure generates
an entrepreneurial spirit which encourages widespread participation
174 In Managers We Trust
in equity investment in terms of both those who demand it (startups
and expanding enterprises) and those who supply it (venture
capitalists and investors generally).
This ownership structure also rests on a cultural aversion to concentrations
of power. The best examples are the Sherman and Clayton
antitrust acts that shut down trusts such as Standard Oil in the
climate of Theodore Roosevelt’s trust-busting populism. Another is
the Glass-Steagall Act, the Depression-era law that segregated the
industry of investment banking from that of commercial banking.
The repeal of that act in 1999 may reflect a degree of change in U.S.
attitudes, though it at least equally likely reflects the globalization
of the world economy, in which power is greatly diffused already;
the governmental efforts waged against Microsoft under the antitrust
laws suggest that such concerns remain prevalent.
Contrast all this with the so-called bank/labor model used to describe
Japanese, German, and other Continental European corporate
systems. Instead of the shareholder market model’s fragmentation of
ownership, the central finance features of the bank/labor model are
ownership concentration and substantial investment intermediation.
Banks act as financial intermediaries by accepting individual deposits
and compiling them for investment in corporations. Only a
relatively small number of these investing entities exist. This concentration
of ownership and debt holdings reduces the pressure for
the development of actively functioning, deep, and liquid capital
markets. Moreover, nothing like the Glass-Steagall Act has prevented
the commercial and investment bankunity that mitigates this concentration
of investment ownership.
This centralization results in a small and powerful body of shareholders
and debt holders whose dual position requires few regulatory
governance mechanisms compared to the array of tools used to define
the rights of various interests in U.S./U.K. corporations. Because
a single bankacts as both primary shareholder and debt
holder, there is less pressure to choose between models that favor
either shareholders or other constituencies of the corporation.
Also, less need exists for regulating governance mechanisms because
of traditions that have put labor at the center of the governance
structure rather than as a participant with contractually defined
interests. European nations are deeply committed to worker
protection, as evidenced by wage-setting policies and laws that make
firing workers difficult (in contrast to U.S./U.K. at-will employment).
These sorts of forces also explain why the disparity in compensation
Going Global 175
levels between senior executives and ordinary laborers is relatively
narrower under the bank/labor model than it is under the market
model.
In terms of formal governance, the German and Dutch version
of this model formally elevates labor as a third key participant in the
leadership of a corporation. These corporations operate with worker
councils which management must consult on a variety of matters
concerning corporate policy. German corporations generally have a
two-tiered board system which consists of a management board and
a supervisory board.
The management board (Vorstand) manages the corporation, represents
it in third-party dealings, and submits regular reports to the
supervisory board. The supervisory board (Aufsichtsrat) appoints and
removes the members of the management board and oversees the
management of the corporation. Under German law, employeeelected
and shareholder-elected representatives are represented on
the supervisory board in equal shares. While it cannot make management
decisions, the supervisory board may determine that certain
actions or business measures contemplated by the management
board require its prior approval.
The German dual-board structure is based on the concept of
codetermination (Mitbestimmung). According to this view, because
labor and capital codetermine a corporation’s future, labor should
protect its interests from within the corporate governance system
through formal representation on the supervisory board rather than
through contract or governmental regulation. Banks, which occupy
the unique positions of debt holder and shareholder, constitute the
other half of the supervisory board. Consequently, the separation of
ownership from control, a defining characteristic of the shareholder
market model, is expressly absent in the bank/labor model.
In the bank/labor model, even sole shareholders may lack the
power to remove or replace management. This lackof power is especially
pronounced under the two-tiered board structure prevalent
in Germany and the Netherlands, in large part as a result of the
workcouncil regulations that have been adopted across Europe. The
European Union (EU) mandates that all members except the United
Kingdom require most of their corporations to establish procedures
for employee consultation and worker council formation.
Many Continental European countries have gone beyond the EU
mandates to require that virtually all corporations establish and
maintain worker councils. Management must consult with these
176 In Managers We Trust
councils on major corporate policies affecting labor interests, including
layoff proposals and in many cases potential changes of control.
Galvanizing this labor element in the corporate governance
model, the EU also requires that employment contracts follow business
assets when sold as a going concern so that a buyer of such
assets remains subject to those agreements by operation of law.
Compared to the European model, the Japanese variation deepens
the roles of both labor and lender banks in the governance structure.
As in Europe, banks tend to own the vast bulk of the debt and
equity of industrial companies. The distinguishing factual characteristic
is the Japanese production model that is called horizontal
coordination. Workers are generalists when it comes to the production
process and engage in a substantial amount of information sharing
and training throughout production. Limited specialization, however,
requires high corporate investment in labor markets to develop
the necessary human capital.
Japanese corporations thus face a higher riskof loss on investment
from worker defection than do European and American corporations.
However, workers face the risk of acquiring nontransportable,
firm-specific skills. Corporations and workers have
addressed these risks by developing a system of lifetime employment.
This policy provides workers with permanent job security and affords
corporations a concomitantly restricted labor market.
No binding contract guaranteed this mutual security system, and
so the Japanese model turned to corporate cross-ownership to provide
the necessary structural protections. Industrial corporations in
Japan own substantial percentages of the securities of other industrial
corporations. The resulting ownership concentration is even
more centralized than it is in the European model, and it causes a
commensurate dilution of capital market disciplining power.
ILLUSIONS OF DUTY
So much for these polar stories. Reality suggests far more overlap
and universal looseness across advanced economies in regard to the
real beneficiaries of managerial duties—an important point for investors
to understand.
Corporate social responsibility remains an important dimension
of U.S. corporate governance. Direct efforts to improve the lot of
nonshareholder constituencies supplement the simple argument that
Going Global 177
shareholder-based profit maximization helps all the other participants.
Scores of organizations promote this direct approach in response
to the needs of corporate constituencies on a variety of issues, including
affirmative action, child labor, downsizing, the environment,
fair wages, privacy, sexual harassment, and the balance between work
life and family life. These organizations operate through employee
training and assistance programs, mission statements, and social responsibility
audits.
Social responsibility has reached the large organizational level.
For example, Business for Social Responsibility, an organization
founded in 1992, currently has over 1,400 corporate members with
aggregate annual revenues exceeding $1 trillion and total employees
of nearly 5 million. It features household corporate names such as
AT&T, Coke, DuPont, Federal Express, Home Depot, Motorola, and
Polaroid. Significant numbers of mutual funds and other institutional
investors also have committed to investing only in socially
responsible enterprises. Some investors claim that investing this way
maximizes shareholder wealth.
Many corporations have followed suit and now emphasize their
social responsibility. There are well-known exemplars of the traditional
left such as Body Shop and Ben & Jerry’s (taken over by Unilever
in early 2000 with promises to expand the social responsibility
commitments of the global consumer products giant). There are also
some surprising followers, such as Philips-Van Heusen Corporation,
which is headed by CEO Bruce Klatsky, an adviser on U.S. trade policy
to the Bush and Reagan administrations. Hasbro, Reebok, and
Wal-Mart also are following this trend. This social emphasis is entirely
consistent with state laws, which mandate that directors act in the
best interests of the shareholders and the corporation as a whole.
German law takes more seriously the idea that the beneficiaries
of directors’ duties include corporate constituents other than shareholders,
yet Germany also forbids directors from acting contrary to
shareholder interests and indeed often requires them to act in the
“aggregated shareholder interest.” German corporate law—which is
fairly representative of European countries on these points—and
U.S. law therefore contemplate the protection of all corporate constituencies.
Both prescribe this protection by imposing on management
the fiduciary duties care and loyalty.
The duty of care requires the exercise of an informed business
judgment, which is taken to mean that directors must gather all the
178 In Managers We Trust
material information that is reasonably available to them. Informed
directors then must act prudently and reasonably in the discharge
of their duties. The liability of directors for breach of the duty of
care in most circumstances requires a finding by a court that the
directors were grossly negligent—quite a high standard that is akin
to driving while intoxicated. The duty of loyalty requires directors to
subordinate their personal interests to those of the corporation if a
conflict exists. Specific applications of this general duty vary among
economically-developed countries, but the variation is not much
more pronounced than are the nuanced differences between states
within the United States.
The differences are thus more subtle between U.S./U.K. and
Continental Europe director duties than is often recognized. The
varying prescriptions address the content of those duties rather than
their discrete beneficiaries. They are “vertical,” intended to preserve
and expand the size of the corporate pie rather than address how it
is sliced or allocated.
When the question is pie size, the interests of managers are pitted
against the interests of all the other constituencies, and so it is
not surprising that these vertical mechanisms differ little across the
borders of economically advanced countries. What is surprising is
that they also extend to situations where allocation is at stake, a
“horizontal” question that manifests itself most acutely when threats
to corporate control arise.
Most U.S. state laws impose either a heightened standard of duty
on directors facing hostile takeovers or a heightened standard of
judicial review of director conduct. The issue in either instance is
whether the directors have acted in the best interest of shareholders.
While these heightened standards do not exist in German law, which
only requires directors not to act contrary to the stockholders’ interest
and to show regard for the common interest, this does not
mean that the heightened U.S. standard separates the American
model from the Continental model.
Many states empower directors to consider the interests of nonshareholder
constituencies in numerous circumstances. For example,
although U.S. judges often remarkthat “shareholders come
first,” they simultaneously let directors consider the impact of corporate
decisions on constituencies other than shareholders, including
creditors, customers, employees, and sometimes as broad a group
as the general community.
Judges sometimes mesh mandatory rhetoric with discretionary
Going Global 179
reality even in extreme circumstances such as where managers fight
against a hostile takeover—one of the devices on the horizon in the
late 1960s that Ben Graham thought might operate as a disciplining
force on underperforming managers.5 For example, in the mid-1990s
the Delaware Supreme Court accepted the arguments of Time Inc.’s
directors, who resisted an unwanted takeover by Paramount, in part
on the ground that doing so was necessary to preserve the company’s
culture of journalistic integrity. Thus, despite even the most rigorous
judicial review of board actions, in takeover contexts, directors have
a great deal of latitude.
Takeover laws do not require any particular action, such as an
auction, or impose on directors any duty to ensure that shareholders
get the highest price. The unifying inquiry in virtually all these cases
is whether a threat to the corporation exists, not solely or even necessarily
whether the shareholders’ interests are in jeopardy.
For a dramatic example of what occurs under laws that look
beyond shareholder interests, consider the fight for corporate control
between AlliedSignal and AMP.6 AlliedSignal offered a 55% premium
over the market price of AMP, a company whose profitability
had seriously dropped. AMP shareholders overwhelmingly supported
AlliedSignal, and within a month of the offer 72% of AMP’s outstanding
shares were tendered into it. Shareholder supporters included
the family of the company’s founder, Robert Hixon, and many
institutional shareholders, which owned approximately 80% of the
stock, including the Teachers Insurance and Annuity Association–
College Retirement Equities Fund (TIAA-CREF).
Indeed, TIAA-CREF joined a shareholder group that sued AMP’s
board. That group tookthe extraordinary step of separately filing a
“friend-of-the-court” brief supporting AlliedSignal in direct litigation
between AlliedSignal and AMP. TIAA-CREF argued that AMP had
trampled on basic “principles of shareholder democracy.”
Despite this overwhelming shareholder support for AlliedSignal,
AMP’s management successfully erected a series of defensive barriers
to the bid. Management tookadvantage of Pennsylvania laws
requiring directors to act in the best interests not of the shareholders,
but of the corporation and permitting boards to act in what they
perceive to be the best interests of employees, lenders, communities,
and others. One extraordinary barrier AMP’s management raised
changed the terms of its “poison pill” so that it could not be eliminated
even by directors who held office before any of AlliedSignal’s
directors had joined.
180 In Managers We Trust
AMP sought and won an injunction prohibiting AlliedSignal’s
consent solicitation unless and until each proposed directorcandidate
affirmed that if elected, he or she was duty-bound under
Pennsylvania law to act in the best interests of the corporation as a
whole, not merely in the shareholders’ interest.
The court upheld AMP’s extraordinary actions against Allied-
Signal’s claim that AMP’s board had breached its fiduciary duties in
response to the AlliedSignal bid. In its opinion, the court repeatedly
emphasized a “stakeholder” standard, which appears to be at the
heart of Pennsylvania law, and used the following unequivocal terms:
“Directors may weigh the interests of the shareholders against the
interests of other constituencies.” They “may consider the effects
upon all groups affected, including shareholders, employees, suppliers,
customers and creditors.” They “shall not be required to regard
any corporate interest or group as dominant or controlling.”
These statements do not suggest a shareholder-primacy norm. A
less obvious point but one that is equally true is that these Pennsylvania
standards are not all that different in practice from those
of other U.S. states. They are also not all that different from German
law and may even capture the German sense of the common interest.
Consider both German-based Mannesmann’s battle against the
United Kingdom’s Vodaphone and the merger of Germany’s Daimler
Benz with the United States’s Chrysler. Although German law permits
directors to evaluate the interests of workers and lenders and
the so-called common interest, the law also required that the board
not act contrary to the best interests of shareholders—and both
boards did so, Mannesmann’s with a vengeance.
That kind of deference to shareholders may not illustrate shareholder
primacy, nor it it consistent with the usual rhetoric of the
bank/labor model. Accordingly, U.S. practice more closely resembles
European practice than it does U.S. rhetoric, and European practice
more closely resembles U.S. practice than it does European rhetoric;
managers in neither place are obligated to hold a thoroughgoing
owner orientation.
ONE WORLD TO COME
Trends in corporate practice worldwide suggest further harmonization,
and it is a mistake for investors to overlook them. These trends
spell the continued erasure of differences and a tendency to make
Going Global 181
owner orientation even less compulsory. If this is the case, the already
small population of true owner-orientated U.S. managers will
shrinkfurther . On the other hand, the number abroad may grow
larger.
Financial markets increasingly compete internationally, just as
product markets have done for decades. Investors (suppliers of capital)
now lookacross borders for additional investment opportunities,
while corporations and other organizations seekthe lowest-cost capital
from any market in the world. The isolation of capital markets
is disappearing, and head-to-head competition among financial markets
has ensued.
The EU integrates corporate finance and governance in many
respects. Most significantly, the adoption of a single currency will
harmonize competition through the sharing of productivity differentials—
the fruits of technological advancement and higher investment.
Business expense differentials, particularly wages, should
evaporate. The process is just beginning as countries adopt the euro
and ultimately abandon their local currencies.
Nearly as profound, new EU innovations are greatly diminishing
barriers to cross-border capital flows. A series of EU directives
compeled the abolition of foreign investment controls. Member
states enthusiastically responded to this call by relaxing their controls.
The remaining restrictions generally are limited to notification
requirements or to specified sectors that pose national security or
public health, safety, and welfare concerns. Many European countries
simply retained the authority to implement such controls if
necessary.
Accounting
A series of fundamental principles has harmonized accounting rules
within Europe. These principles include (1) a requirement of uniform
formats for financial statements, (2) common valuation principles,
including historical cost, accrual accounting, and the principle of
conservatism called prudence, (3) a general mandate that financial
statements show true and fair value, (4) an annual audit, (5) public
filings, and (6) consolidation principles. A trend toward unified accounting
reinforces the harmonization trends in finance and governance.
Similar moves have occurred in Japan. Japanese accounting rules
now require consolidation of all the accounts of a company’s controlled
affiliates. In the past, the absence of such a rule enabled
182 In Managers We Trust
companies to allocate the bad accounting news to affiliates, making
the parent company’s books look much better. New Japanese rules
also require listing real estate held for sale at its current market value
if that value has fallen more than 50% from the original cost. The
absence of this new rule fueled the Japanese speculative bubble of
the 1980s that cratered gradually throughout the 1990s (described in
Chapter 5).
Around the world, increasing numbers of non-U.S. and non-
English-language corporations are ahead of schedule in adopting international
accounting principles and reporting their results in the
English language. Nissan, for example, adopted consolidation accounting
principles in late 1999, six months ahead of schedule, and
issued related press releases about that period’s results in English,
an unimaginable act for a Japanese corporation just a decade ago
(even one that is partly French-owned).
When Nissan reported its annual financial results in mid-2000,
using international accounting principles, they showed staggering
losses of $6.3 billion. Contributing to those losses were recognition
of pension liabilities and the costs of plant closings and the assignment
of more realistic values to real estate and securities holdings.
Although a number of other substantive factors contributed to these
results, investors considering investment in non-U.S. companies
must understand that accounting principles elsewhere are not always
what they seem.
The United States is harmonizing its accounting principles with
those prevalent worldwide. In October 1996, Congress passed the
National Securities Markets Improvement Act of 1996, which requires
the SEC to report to Congress on progress in developing international
accounting standards. The SEC has worked with the International
Accounting Standards Committee (IASC) for nearly a
decade to promulgate a core set of accounting pronouncements. In
October 1997 the SEC published a report to Congress on the progress
of the IASC, and it joined organizations throughout the world
in supporting the IASC’s initiatives.
The finance ministers and central bankgovernors of the G7
countries proclaimed support for the IASC and encouraged it to
complete a proposed set of core principles promptly. Additionally,
the World Bankrequested the world’s “Big Five” international auditing
firms to insist that companies prepare their financial statements
in accordance with international accounting standards. Leading
voices from around the world, including Tony Blair, the United
Going Global 183
Kingdom’s prime minister, and Robert E. Rubin, then U.S. treasury
secretary, intoned that developing and implementing international
accounting standards is a key part of the emerging global financial
system.
The SEC argues that international accounting standards must
be comprehensive, produce comparability and transparency, provide
for full disclosure, and be amenable to rigorous interpretation and
application. Indeed, many view SEC Chairman Levitt’s broad-based
initiative to crackdown on earnings abuses by management in U.S.
corporations as a response to the increasing attractiveness of international
harmonization of accounting standards, which the SEC
wants the United States to lead rather than follow.
The future state of accounting is crucial to investors. As pliable
as accounting rules are in the United States, they remain a functional
way to measure business reality. Coupled with an auditing
culture that insists on the integrity of financial reporting, this system
adds unparalleled value to the investing enterprise. Investors looking
abroad should be aware of the differences and monitor improvements
worldwide as they pose both pitfalls and opportunities.
Governance
In Europe, periodic resistance flares up against unification efforts.
For example, 13 EU directives dealing with European company law,
as well as a proposal to create a European Corporation (Societas
Europaea) that would supplement but not substitute for the national
corporate form in individual states, were intended to promote regional
(if not global) harmonization. However, none of these measures
is currently among the EU’s highest priorities.
On a few occasions, particularly during early EU convergence
efforts, proposals for employee board representation derailed the
adoption of some integrated governance proposals. Much of this resistance
originated in the United Kingdom, which has for decades
debated whether its future will be served better by a U.S./U.K. alliance
or a Continental European EU alliance. Despite the obstacles
this uncertainty poses for EU harmony, the United Kingdom produced
domestic convergence by drawing on both models.
U.S. corporate governance originally drew upon and refined U.K.
traditions. Now the United Kingdom has in turn imported those
principles as refined. Its 1992 Cadbury Report on corporate governance
(renamed the Hampel Report in the final 1998 version) seeks
184 In Managers We Trust
to identify the “best practices” of global corporations. They tend to
borrow on U.S. technical innovations in corporate governance, including
some discussed in the next chapter.
The United Kingdom’s substantial role in Europe, coupled with
its linkto U.S. corporate governance, moved the Continental models
closer to the market model. The French experience provides a provocative
example. The stakeholder model and financial intermediation
historically characterized French corporate governance. At the
same time, a state-dominated industrial policy defined French capitalism,
producing firms of a smaller average size than those in other
capitalist countries and an industrial elite recruited not from within
industry but from outside it. This environment limits capital market
depth and monitoring capabilities.
Now the French model is following the trend toward globalization
and liberalism. The revisions make the French model more closely resemble
a market model, beginning with a loosening of the state’s grip
on industry through privatization efforts. Additionally, the number of
small shareholders is rapidly growing, and, following the United Kingdom,
technical governance reforms based on U.S. models have been
instituted widely. Moreover, audit and compensation committees are
forming in French corporate boards, minority shareholders are taking
on increasingly important roles, and information superior in both
quantity and quality is enhancing economic transparency.
Japan is similarly racing toward a shareholder-market model and
away from long-term employment commitments and horizontal coordination.
Increasingly, Japan has recognized that profit-maximizing
strategies actually are consistent with the protections its traditional
devices provide. More and more Japanese workers—particularly
younger workers—indicate that they do not intend to stay with one
employer for more than a few years at a time, let alone maintain
lifetime employment with a single firm.
U.S. corporate governance remains imperfect, as we’ll see in the
next few chapters. The principles on which it is based are sound,
but a lot can be learned from studying governance in other countries,
particularly as investors increasingly set their sites on companies
organized abroad and competing worldwide.
Mergers and Acquisitions
The Vodafone-Mannesmann fight rode a wave of American-style European
merger activity that erupted in early 1999 with major hostile
Going Global 185
takeover battles. In France, Banque Nationale de Paris launched a
$38 billion hostile bid to take over its two major French banking
rivals, Socie´ te´ Ge´ne´ rale and Paribas, after they had recently announced
their own plan to merge with each other. In Italy, Olivetti
launched a $60 billion hostile bid to acquire its major rival, Telecom
Italia, which in turn erected a series of substantial defensive tactics
designed to thwart the overture, including a white-knight alliance
with Germany’s Deutsche-Telecom.
In another cross-border battle, France’s LVMH Moe¨ t Hennessy
Louis Vuitton waged a protracted and intense battle to obtain control
of Gucci, an Italy-based but Netherlands-incorporated company
which also strenuously resisted the unwelcome overture. TOTALFINA
made a hostile bid for Elf Aquitaine in mid-1999, shaking up
the French industrial and governmental establishment. These kinds
of deals—in both their offensive and defensive modes—are reminiscent
of U.S.-style merger activity, which had been unprecedented in
Europe.
Scores of friendly global alliances have reinforced the spread of
market model behavior in Europe and Japan. Led by the merger of
Daimler and Chrysler, the worldwide auto industry consolidated
through cross-border deals once considered too intractable to
achieve. Industry capacity ranges up to approximately 70 million vehicles
annually while average annual demand generally peaks at 50
million, and only about 10 of the world’s 40 auto manufacturers are
profitable. Some results: Ford bought control of Mazda, Volkswagen
acquired the United Kingdom’s Rolls Royce, Renault bought Samsung
(Korea) and a third of Nissan, and Daimler-Chrysler bought a
third of Mitsubishi.
Many other industries stand on the brinkof similar global consolidation.
In the publishing industry, Germany’s Bertelsmann pursued
an acquiring and joint-venturing spree with other European and U.S.
counterparts; in apparel, after surviving its own battle to resist a takeover
by LVMH, Gucci tookover France’s Yves Saint Laurent; in finance,
Deutsche Bankbought Bankers Trust, UBS bought Paine
Webber, Credit Suisse bought Donaldson Lufkin Jenrette, Dresdner
bought Wasserstein Parella; British Petroleum bought Amoco; and
Nabisco and a U.S. buyout firm sought to buy Britain’s United Biscuits
only to be outflanked by a consortium of French, German, and
British buyers. These and scores of other proposals on the docket of
the EU merger panel have created unmatched uniformity of practices
and expectations in the corporate world.
186 In Managers We Trust
There are few ways in which a corporate board can destroy shareholder
value as dramatically as through mergers and acquisitions. As
globalization advances, more opportunities for deals arise. Some will
be desirable; many will not. Paying close attention to the activity in
this field is of great importance to investors and is addressed again
later in this part.
Capital Markets
The aggregate stockmark et capitalization of Europe is larger than
that of Nasdaq and over half that of the New YorkStock Exchange.
(Given Mr. Market, the aggregate market capitalizations can change
dramatically in short time periods, but as of early 2000, the amounts
were about $7 trillion, $4 trillion, and $11 trillion, respectively.)
The Frankfurt and London stock exchanges announced in July
1998 a plan to integrate their facilities and permit the trading of each
other’s listed securities on both exchanges. France, unhappy with its
exclusion, quickly gained admission to the Frankfurt-London alliance
(although as a 20% player, compared with 40% for each of the
founding exchanges). Soon after France announced its inclusion in
the emerging pan-European exchange, exchange officials in Milan,
Madrid, Amsterdam, and Brussels echoed a similar eagerness to participate
in the venture.
Although the European alliance had difficulty agreeing on a
common trading system, the group quickly elected to permit stock
trading between the various exchanges. While negotiators struggled,
the once-snubbed French Bourse tookadvantage of the delays by
signing itself up with exchange partners from Amsterdam and Brussels.
This troika’s single market—a full integration of these three
exchanges called Euronext—boasts listings with a combined market
capitalization equal to over a quarter of that of Europe as a whole.
As the Euronext group forged this deal, the London and Frankfurt
exchanges agreed on a merger. The two formed iX, standing for
International Exchanges, a market poised to integrate blue chips and
tech stocks from the two dominant European capitals and boasting
a total capitalization of over half of that of Europe as a whole. That
deal was interrupted when OM Gruppen, operator of the Stockholm
(Sweden) stockexchange, made a hostile bid to buy the London
Exchange. However the dust settles on this array of parties, these
historical deals will not end capital market integration in Europe,
Going Global 187
the pace of which races on despite the presence of a dozen or more
unintegrated exchanges on the continent.
The U.S. National Association of Securities Dealers (NASD)
launched its own Nasdaq Europe stockmark et, one that will have
strong links to the emerging continental hybrids. This signifies a
major step toward creating a 24-hour-a-day global stockmark et that
began with the NASD’s similar venture in creating Nasdaq Japan, a
joint effort with the SoftbankCorporation of Japan that is linked to
the Osaka Securities Exchange. All this will compel the convergence
of these markets in awesome ways, impacting finance, accounting,
disclosure, takeovers, governance, and ultimately what investors expect
and what managers deliver.
Evidence of integration is pervasive in securities listing and trading.
Foreign firms for years have pushed for global listing, most famously
achieved by Daimler-Benz’s listing on the NYSE beginning
in 1993. These crusades continue, with rising success. After the repeal
of Glass-Steagall, the Swiss bankUBS filed with the SEC to
seekan NYSE listing, chiefly to give it a U.S.-listed stock to pay for
new acquisitions of U.S. financial services firms. This started with
its acquisition, a couple of months later, of PaineWebber.
SAP, a 25-year-old German software firm, was listed on the
NYSE in early August 1998, ten years to the day after its initial public
offering on the Frankfurt stock exchange. SAP is famous for generating
“U.S.-style growth” and “U.S.-style rewards.” SAP executives
characterized its listing on the NYSE as evidence that SAP had “outgrown”
the Frankfurt stock market and evolved into a transnational
company combining features of a variety of governance models.
Clear-cut signs of the conglomeration of international securities
trading include the creation of the International Securities Exchange
(ISE) for options trading. An on-line brokerage firm, E*Trade, and
a group of broker-dealers led by Adirondack Trading Partners invested
nearly $80 million to establish this all-electronic options
exchange. The founders touted their ability to slash transaction costs
while simultaneously conducting staggering sums of electronic
trades which transcend geographic boundaries.
Investors should not ignore the shape of capital markets. How
trades are made, by whom, at what cost, and over what time periods
significantly affect price volatility and have an impact on market
efficiency. Equally important, exchange rules often dictate accounting
requirements, and so the ease of international listings can impair
the integrity of financial reporting.
188 In Managers We Trust
The Last Frontier: Information
A practical barrier to cross-border deals has been yielding. It concerns
the nature and amount of available information regarding a
counterparty. In market model countries such as the United States
and the United Kingdom, a wealth of information is available concerning
the targets organized therein. These countries tend to operate
systems of public recordation for real as well as intellectual
property. Well-developed securities and mergers and acquisitions
(M&A) industries strengthen such an information culture.
Buyers and sellers in M&A transactions understand the need for
information to allow proper valuations and the need for contractual
protection to preserve confidentiality. Sellers customarily meet these
needs by executing confidentiality agreements early in the exploration
process and providing the buyer with substantial proprietary
data before discussing agreements any further.
The culture in European and Asian countries contrasts remarkably
with that of the U.S./U.K. market model. Access to property
records is limited, and information is more jealously guarded. Sellers
are reluctant to share information with a potential buyer who can
walkaway from a deal if she doesn’t like what she sees; confidentiality
agreements that protect such a seller in the United States and
the United Kingdom simply don’t do the trick. That may be sensible,
since a less well-developed system of legal enforcement for such
agreements justifies a seller’s apprehension about a buyer’s confidentiality.
Cultural disparities became acute in the Vodafone-Mannesmann
battle. Mannesmann sued Vodaphone’s adviser, Goldman Sachs, in
a U.K. court, trying to prevent it from advising Vodaphone on the
grounds that Goldman had previously represented Mannesmann and
possessed confidential information about it. The British court dismissed
the lawsuit after a brief hearing and in a short time, basically
telling Mannesmann that its claim was frivolous.
Substantively, the type of information understood as relevant also
varies between the models. In the market model and especially in
the United States, disclosing potential environmental or retiree liabilities
is a time-honored practice. Other countries have only recently
developed environmental regulation. Also, other countries traditionally
rely more heavily on public social security systems,
removing private plans from center stage (even in countries such as
Germany, where such liabilities are often substantial and unfunded).
Going Global 189
For investors, U.S. corporations disclose far more than do those
in Europe or Japan. U.S. federal and state law, as well as stock
exchange rules and general market pressures and expectations in the
United States, result in corporations disclosing extraordinary
amounts and types of information. Other countries impose more
limited and far less effective disclosure requirements.
As global corporations as diverse as DaimlerChrysler and SAP
increasingly list shares on U.S. stockexchanges and stock exchanges
around the world, they will find themselves subject to U.S.-style disclosure
requirements as a matter of both regulatory mandate and
market expectations and demand. As the same group consummates
cross-border transactions requiring the disclosure and evaluation of
information, pressures toward uniform disclosure requirements will
emerge in a wide variety of settings. In fact, participants find that
U.S./U.K.-style information disclosure is consistent with existing
corporate traditions in most countries, most notably Germany. Accordingly,
broadening global corporate laws to require such disclosure
seems quite possible.
Public regulators have undertaken just such an effort. The SEC
is working with the International Organization of Securities Commissions
(IOSCO) to develop a set of international standards for
nonfinancial statement disclosure. These efforts are intended to facilitate
cross-border financing and listing by transnational companies
while holding them to a single global standard of disclosure. The
IOSCO issued new rules about certain kinds of cash transactions
and offerings and listings of common equity securities and is working
to extend them to tender and exchange offers, business combinations,
privatizations, and other affiliated deals.
High-quality information is essential for intelligent investing in
the modern global marketplace. Ignoring the garbage and disinformation
piling up on the Internet is becoming increasingly difficult
as more countries develop information-based corporate and investing
cultures and as more citizens of those countries learn the ropes of
the systems.
Two-Way Street
Not all these trends run one way, for the idea of shareholder primacy
in the United States was gradually but substantially eroded by the
dramatic reallocation of corporate value from shareholders to work190
In Managers We Trust
ers throughout the latter half of the twentieth century. In the past,
workers had no interest in a corporation other than a paycheck and
the right to quit (and be fired). Today corporations whose workers
have no interest except a paycheckare rare.
Workers have claims against their corporate employers ranging
from vacation and sickpay to paternity or maternity leave, safety and
antidiscrimination rights, health plans, severance claims, and retiree
benefits and pensions. All these claims cost substantial amounts of
money, value that in the old days was owned by the shareholders.
On top of all that, somewhat paradoxically, employees have become
shareholders of these corporations and, counter to the Japanese
trend, are actually staying with the same employer for longer periods
and expressing greater loyalty to their employers than they did in the
past.
U.S. regulators are taking pages from abroad in a bolder way. A
major example is the elimination of boundaries between investment
and commercial banking. These boundaries were relaxed in December
1996, when the Federal Reserve Board increased the amount of
investment banking income a commercial bank can earn from investment
banking subsidiaries from 10% to 25%. The so-called Section
20 subs ushered in this regulatory change, which contributed
substantially to the ensuing wave of commercial and investment
bankmergers and reversed a historical cause of ownership fragmentation.
The repeal of the Glass-Steagall Act in November 1999 has
further fueled such financial reunions.
The U.S. litigation system is not the envy of the world, and it
encourages large volumes of shareholder class action and derivative
lawsuits against management. In contrast, most legal systems put
substantial restrictions on such suits. Although it does not appear
that litigation will decline substantially in the United States, it is
clear that lawmakers want to curb litigation abuse. For example, the
Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995 substantially revised
the securities laws in an effort to distinguish frivolous claims from
meritorious ones.
This analysis forecasts the hybridization of corporate governance
models in terms of both constituency and finance characteristics.
No owner orientation is required by these models. Forces appear to
be pushing for convergence, and the emerging model will not require
an owner orientation either. Indeed, to the extent that there is anything
real to the European corporate governance rhetoric, converGoing
Global 191
gence will dilute rather than enhance any managerial mandate to
run U.S. corporations mainly for the benefit of shareholders. Detecting
an owner orientation in this global marketplace thus becomes
more important than ever.
Buffett tells us that the most valuable lesson he learned in investing
was realizing the importance of owner-oriented managers.
The value of this timeless lesson will increase geometrically in a
globalized world. Of course, Buffett emphasizes that while management
quality can dramatically affect returns on equity, it is never a
substitute for a good business within one’s circle of competence,
saying that “a good managerial record (measured by economic returns)
is far more a function of what business boat you get into than
it is of how effectively you row (though intelligence and effort help
considerably, of course, in any business, good or bad).”7 The remaining
chapters focus on identifying winning managers.
This page intentionally left blank.
193
C h a p t e r 1 2
RULES AND TRUST
An investor is going to entrust her wealth to someone else.
Shouldn’t the investor have a high degree of confidence in that
person’s ability and integrity? Of course. It is simple common sense,
but how to assess ability and integrity is a bit trickier.
Graham used the quantitative analysis of the sort described in
Part II as a proxy. If the numbers lookgood year after year and
provide a basis for thinking that they will continue to do so, that
may suggest that management is able.
Many other investors, including Warren Buffett in his early days,
learned hard lessons from paying too little attention to management
integrity. True, if a company’s numbers lookgood and are accurate,
its managers are probably able and trustworthy. If the numbers look
good but are misleading, management may be neither. As Buffett
reminds us, “In the long run, managements stressing accounting
appearances over economic substance usually achieve little of either.”
1
Therefore, integrity is an additional independent factor in investment
selection. Is there a sensible way to thinkabout managerial
integrity? Buffett says the key is to invest with managers you “like,
trust, and admire.” His test for whether an investment meets this
requirement is whether the managers are “men you would be pleased
to see your daughter marry.”2
Does this “son-in-law” standard help? It may only suggest avoiding
managers you would not be pleased to invite over for a Super
Bowl party, but this is a great deal more meaningful than it sounds.
THE FAMILY MANAGER
All business transactions depend on trust and always have. Contracts
help define and protect rights, but entering into one calls for some
expectation that the other party will do what he says he will do.
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
194 In Managers We Trust
Contracts also reduce the costs of doing business and investing by
enabling people to trade off future risks, but that works only if the
other person can be expected to live up to the deal.
Trust in business is deeply rooted in kinship, and so it is no
wonder that the son-in-law test makes sense. The link between the
son-in-law test for managers and business itself comports with the
broad history of business development. Most businesses start out as
family enterprises and then grow in size over decades or generations,
adding relatives to the management ranks (often even including
sons-in-law, as at Anheuser-Busch, the Washington Post Company,
and Mead, for example). In many cases, such growth leads families
to give up control and the business evolves into a modern corporation,
as occurred at Brown-Forman, DuPont, Eli Lilly, McGraw-Hill,
Nordstroms, and countless others.
The erstwhile family business as modern corporation no longer
has Dad or Granddad or Daughter at the helm but instead has a
cadre of professional managers, a diffusion of control, an institutionalized
organizational structure, and lines of reporting authority.
The upshot is a corporation characterized by a separation of ownership
from control—shareholders watching managers run the business.
Trust in the modern corporation should resonate with norms
and values associated with that family business.
It is rarely feasible for an individual investor to sit down and get
acquainted with the chief executive officers of most major corporations,
but all these chiefs write annual letters to shareholders and
author other addresses periodically as well. These communications
contain remarkable clues about trustworthiness. The manager’s own
words often reveal her character. (Chapter 14 pursues this point.)
What is it that you trust a manager to do? The answer to that
question comes from thinking of him as your manager, something
that is hardly ever done. People always speakof their broker, their
accountant, their lawyer, but they hardly ever speakof their manager.
Yet a corporate manager does just as much for your wealth as these
sidekicks do, or more.
What should your manager do? Run the business for your benefit,
as a shareholder, against the numerous and often conflicting
interests of other constituencies of the business. Here is another key
point that is often overlooked: The perspectives of investors and
managers often diverge. When they do, investor interests can be
disserved.
Rules and Trust 195
Managers raise funds for corporate enterprise from the investing
public in the form of equity capital or stocks. Investors are regarded
by managers either as partners in the enterprise or merely as consumers.
When seen as consumers, investors are deemed to have tastes
and preferences that are reflected in the prices at which managers
can sell them stocks and other securities. Most of these investors
have little or no say in how a business is operated or even who the
managers will be (other than through annual elections of directors).
Instead they are strangers to the corporation, strangers whose
interests are subordinated to those of the corporation as a whole. In
this type of corporation, for example, managers tend to consider the
tax effects of declaring a dividend or structuring an acquisition deal
on the corporation as a whole but not on the individual shareholders.
In contrast, the voices of individual investors matter more to
owner-oriented managers. Seeing them as partners in the business,
these managers treat investors as members of the enterprise rather
than as strangers to it. Electing directors remains the formal vehicle
for this voice, but a more solicitous view of owner interests is taken.
For example, these managers consider the tax effects of corporate
decisions such as dividends and deals on the investor rather than
on, or at least separately from, the corporation.
It is far easier for managers of family and other small and privately
held corporations to adopt this owner orientation. It is far
easier for managers of large publicly held corporations to adopt the
opposite view. The managers with whom intelligent investors should
entrust their wealth are those who adopt the investor’s perspective
no matter how large the corporation or how many shareholders it
has.
LOCAL GOVERNANCE
The reality of global corporate management means that boards and
managers can run a business for the benefit of many constituencies,
not solely shareholders. Laws permit managers to operate pretty
much wherever they want along the spectrum from a shareholder
orientation to a constituency orientation. One part of business analysis
is evaluating the degree to which management has an owner
orientation.
196 In Managers We Trust
Sources for determining that orientation abound, probably more
so in the United States but increasingly throughout the developed
world. In the United States, corporations disclose volumes of information
to shareholders and other interested people. Many corporations
go beyond legal requirements, producing substantial information
on their Web sites and Webcasting archives and you can get
plenty of high-quality and reliable information from publications by
reputable industry analysts such as Standard & Poor’s, Dun & Bradstreet,
and Robert Morris Associates as well as government agencies
such as the Federal Trade Commission. Use your imagination.
Sift through these materials in looking for managers who act like
stewards of shareholder capital. Use it to find the best managers,
those who think like owners in making business decisions and who
adopt an attitude of partnership, embracing shareholders as members
of the enterprise rather than as strangers to it, those you would
be happy to invite over for a Super Bowl party.
However, even owner-oriented managers sometimes have interests
that conflict with those of shareholders. Workto identify and
invest with those who make a habit of easing those conflicts and
nurturing managerial stewardship of owner funds, those who exhibit
Aristotelian ethical virtue.
It is not easy to detect governance indicators of an owner orientation
in place at a corporation any more than it is to detect the
financial or managerial performance or even value of a corporation
from its financial statements. However, as with that effort, it is worth
the work.
The difficulty and the possibility exist because the law requires
very little of corporate governance. Yes, federal securities laws impose
extensive disclosure obligations, though most of what they call
for probably would be produced voluntarily by good companies participating
in a vibrant market economy anyway. Yes, state laws impose
duties on directors and managers, but those duties are loose
and general. Some statutory rules or limits are imposed, but they
are either highly formal and therefore malleable or pretty meaningless
as a practical matter and can be altered in corporate by-laws or
charter documents.
Corporate governance as such is not necessary. Many advocates
of corporate governance argue for reforms directed toward compelling
an owner orientation, usually described as aligning management
and shareholder interests or enhancing board oversight of CEO performance.
If a company needs these mechanisms to create an owner
Rules and Trust 197
orientation, however, its valuation should be discounted proportionally.
Most corporate governance reforms fail to solve governance
problems, and some exacerbate them. Nevertheless, institutional investors
and other shareholder advocates have promulgated a variety
of policies about corporate governance, most of which are designed
to promote an owner orientation. But just as fads infect finance,
they gum up governance too.
Perhaps the most popular governance idea in the past couple of
decades has been the call for independent boards of directors. The
National Association of Corporate Directors (NACD) and many institutional
investors including CalPers and TIAA-CREF, urged that
corporate boards be composed of at least a majority of outside directors,
those without employment or other affiliation with the corporation.
The idea was that this would strengthen directorial spines
to keep management in check. Nearly all major companies fell into
line, with 90% of Fortune 1000 companies having a majority of independent
directors.
These arguments were made on the basis of intuition, however,
rather than analysis. It was as if there were little or no doubt that
managers needed to be kept in line and that director watchdogs
could do the trick. This premise has been exploded by several studies
showing that far from independent boards enhancing economic performance,
there is actually a negative correlation between the degree
of independence and financial results.3
This is not to say that having some or many independent directors
is never desirable (Buffett, for example, believes that most directors
should be outsiders),4 but there is no reason to give credit
ipso facto to a company just because it does this. The unanswered
commonsense questions are: (1) Who are these independent directors?
and (2) What value do they add to the boardroom? Independent
directors famous for international diplomacy or senatorial jobbery
may be far worse to have at the table than a chief financial officer
with extensive industry and managerial experience. A template that
calls for independence is not a virtue but a mirage.
The key is to choose directors for their business savvy, interest
in the job, and owner orientation. To be avoided are celebrity directors
and others who are chosen for nonfundamental reasons, such
as adding diversity or prominence to a board.
Another popular move some companies fell for was the push to
split the functions of the company’s CEO from those of its board
198 In Managers We Trust
chairman. This manifested the same rationale of independence prescriptions,
a need to checkthe boardroom power of the CEO. Only
about 5% of Fortune 1000 companies succumbed to this formula,
probably with good reason.
As an empirical matter, as with board independence, most evidence
shows that companies that split these functions do not perform
better than those which do not.5 As an abstract matter, it is
hard to justify giving a company governance credit for this separation
of function, for putting a watchdog on the CEO suggests as many reasons
to be suspicious of the CEO as reasons to trust him. For a company
whose CEO is not to be trusted, this may be a good step, but
it sounds more like probation than probity and is a strong warning
signal for investors to run from rather than embrace the business.
Only a fool, after all, thinks trust can be purchased or structured.
One aspect of this reform makes sense, however, and many companies
adopted a version of it by providing for a nonexecutive board
chair for critical functions such as CEO, board, and director evaluations.
After all, letting the CEO grade herself and her board does
pose a riskof self-delusion. An independent grader is in a better
position to evaluate performance objectively, and so some governance
credit is justified for a company that takes this step.
Director independence is frequently encouraged for some committees
and often required for audit committees. Audit committee
independence is consistent with the structure of U.S. audit practice
that requires an auditing firm to be independent of the company and
its management. Independence on compensation committees reflects
the logic of a nonexecutive overseer for key functions such as
CEO and board performance review.
However, the argument for requiring independence on other
committees, such as nominating, ethics, and governance, is the same
as that for independence overall. If a corporation needs those kinds
of things, it has problems anyway. The mere fact that a corporation
has various independent board committees does not guarantee that
problems arising from collusion or delusion will be absent or disappear.
Periodic and formal evaluations of the CEO and other directors
are often recommended and do seem sensible and worthy of praise.
To deserve credit, however, the CEO reviews should be conducted
outside the presence of the CEO, something that is not easily or
commonly done. A more general way to implement this practice is
to supplement such periodic reviews with regular director meetings
Rules and Trust 199
outside the CEO’s presence, a practice Buffett in particular champions.
This is creditworthy not so much under the logic of suspicion
of the CEO but as an independent checkon the CEO’s judgment.
Some gobbledygookabout improved board processes is commonly
bandied about. This is usually sheer nonsense or gloss. Requirements
such as swift flows of quality information, statements of
governance principles, and procedures for full and effective participation
of all directors seem like mere bafflegab. These practices
should simply be part of the normal operation of a well-governed
corporation. Giving credit for the articulation of these practices is
superfluous—like giving umpires extra credit for knowing the rules
of baseball.
Other common and strange prescriptions take pages from the
equally silly playbookof American politics. Term limits for directors?
Why should a good director be forbidden from continuing in his job
just because he’s done it for a specified period of time? Age limits?
Nearly 40% of Fortune 1000 companies adopted age limits in response
to urgings from governance poobahs such as CalPers.
But a company that forbids persons older than, say, 65 or 70 is
ordaining the exclusion of talent from its reach. One can applaud
JackBogle for stepping down as Vanguard’s chairman at the fund’s
mandated retirement age of 70, but is Vanguard really better off
without Jackor any other (old!) sagacious person with integrity? And
what should it matter—on its own terms—that 5 of the 18 members
of Disney’s board are in their seventies, if those people are savvy
business leaders who seekto promote the interests of Disney’s owners?
At the other end of the politically correct scale of corporate governance
is the goal of trying to add diversity of gender or race to the
board. Diversity itself is not a laudable business goal and is nothing
for which credit should be given to the leaders of a business organization.
It is just as out of place, silly, and off the markas deliberately
creating and maintaining a diversified portfolio of stocks. It
may turn out to be fine and dandy, but if so, that is a consequence
and not a cause of a more prudent disposition that focuses on fundamentals
rather than frames. It does not matter one way or the
other that GE’s board has two women and one blackperson on it
though it does matter that those people and GE’s other directors are
outstanding business thinkers with a strong owner orientation.
The problem with all these sorts of proposals is their universality.
What is good for GM may not be good for GE, and what is good for
200 In Managers We Trust
either of them may not be good for Procter & Gamble or eBay, Wrigley,
or Hershey. Each corporate situation justifies and calls for its
own governance structure and analysis. Broad credit can be given
only for governance moves that have some inherently defensible
logic, such as having the board review the CEO’s performance without
her being present and having independence on the audit committee.
Beyond that, these general principles are of little use. Indeed,
too much emphasis on them can be affirmatively misleading. You
can put all the governance bells and whistles you want on a board,
but if its CEO or other strong leaders lackintegrity , you can be sure
they will neither ring nor blow.
GENERAL GOVERNANCE
While one-size-fits-all recipes of corporate governance are inapt, a
few areas justify generalizations. The most important is that active
boards engaged with the companies they serve boost corporate performance.
That is plain common sense, though empirical studies
confirm the intuition.6
A key problem in all governance structures is the size of the
board. You do need a minimum number of directors to generate the
kind of thoughtful deliberateness that characterizes any effective
group of people. But above that number—which is probably as low
as six—the larger the board is, the less manageable it is. Lean is
mean in business, and there is no question that ideas and energy
move more quickly through leaner managerial structures, as Wal-
Mart proved to Sears and GE proved to Westinghouse. Smaller
boards often translate into leaner management teams down the
ranks.
A similar problem is the number of other boards on which individual
directors serve. The more duties a given director undertakes
in various companies, the less effective she is likely to be on each
one. A director’s concurrent experience on two boards may add value
to both. Former U.S. Senator Sam Nunn serves on the boards of a
half dozen public companies (including GE, Coke, and Texaco), for
example, and his workon one may benefit the needs of the others.
But how effective is a director who serves on a dozen boards at once?
Vernon Jordan serves on nearly that many and has been criticized
for doing so. It would be a rare person whose prominence and trustRules
and Trust 201
worthiness, not to mention access to the corridors of power, could
remain valuable to a company that shares her service with so many
others.
A final point all corporations should worry about is who is next
in line for the top spot. It may not be necessary for a company to
have a formal succession plan for its CEO, but it is important for
the board to give it some thought. The trouble is that even the best
laid plan can go awry and sometimes the most surprising and unplanned
succession can have terrific benefits. Succession is a matter
of judgment, and just because a board has thought hard about it,
that doesn’t mean its plan will work(more on this in the next chapter).
All these details of corporate governance provide clues about
managerial trustworthiness. A board filled with close personal
friends of the CEO who lacksolid business backgrounds is a red
flag of caution. A board that fails to review the chief’s performance
regularly may not be trustworthy either. Take another area of corporate
life: charitable giving. If most of the corporation’s charitable
contributions go to pet causes of the CEO, maybe you should wonder
whether he treats the corporation more as his than as yours.
Unique among major American corporations, Berkshire Hathaway
rejects managerial direction of discretionary charitable giving, putting
this power directly in the hands of shareholders.7
If these factors indicate high trustworthiness, lower your discount
rate on a good business; if they suggest moderate trustworthiness,
raise it upward. (If they suggest an antiowner orientation,
simply stay away.)
Amid the intense interest in corporate governance there generally
emerges the subtopic of corporate governance for Internet companies.
Some argue that the traditional templates of corporate governance
simply do not apply to new economy companies. It is hard
to see exactly why, but the argument seems to be that the speed of
industry change, the intensity of competition, the shortage of
technology-savvy managers, and the importance of stockoptions in
compensation packages mean that the new economy cannot abide
the old rules and ways.8
These arguments are silly. On their face, they state very little
difference in the problems of governing a new economy company
versus an old economy company. Change, competition, managerial
savvy, and incentive compensation matter in all businesses. A better
202 In Managers We Trust
argument would relate these different sorts of companies to their
respective average sizes. Smaller companies may need or warrant less
in the way of formal governance (such as board review of director
performance) than do larger companies. But that argument relates
to the dot-com governance debate only to the extent that dot-coms
are on average smaller than non-dot-coms, something that may or
may not be true and so is ultimately irrelevant.
The key issue for any kind of business also remains the same,
whether new economy, old economy, future economy, or whatever.
It is what constitutes good governance, and the answer varies with
company specifics, including potentially to which category a company
belongs. Just as a one-size-fits-all governance template is inappropriate
for the run of non-dot-com companies, it is inappropriate
for dot-coms.
In fairness to the advocates of new governance rules for new
economy companies, they were forced into this strange stance (that
dot-coms as a group were both alike and special) because governance
gurus had so whipsawed old economy companies into governance
uniformity that prevailing governance practices did not make sense
for many dot-coms (for the same reasons they never made sense for
many old economy companies).
It is therefore a colossal waste of time even to discuss whether
governance principles should be different. Of course they should,
but not because of anything special about dot-coms as such but
instead because every business organization is special.
YOUR VOICE ATT HE TABLE
Persuading boards to listen to shareholders is an ideal corporate governance
method, but legal and practical limits frustrate this simple
vehicle. Apathy and collective action problems limit the shareholders’
voice, but this explains only part of the problem.
Most state laws authorize corporations to establish procedures
governing shareholder proposals at annual or special meetings. The
SEC imposes additional rules.9 As a matter of practice, management
on average strongly prefers rules that enable it to omit shareholder
proposals from proxy statements.
Using the “shareholder proposal rule” has led to substantial policy
changes at many major corporations. For example, beginning in
Rules and Trust 203
the 1930s, this rule was used to enhance shareholder rights in areas
such as cumulative voting and dissemination of postmeeting reports.
Virtually anyone can satisfy the eligibility requirements for compelling
a corporation to include a shareholder proposal in the corporation’s
annual proxy statement. By law it is enough to own 1% or
$1,000 in market value of the corporation’s equity for one year, and
the costs of making proposals are borne by the company.
Shareholder proposals are often made by only nominal shareholders,
spearheaded by nonshareholder constituencies that harness
the shareholder proposal rule to effect social change. (This use exploded
in the 1970s, with the famous Campaign GM that led to the
integration of GM’s board of directors.) Social policy advocates use
it to promote things such as reporting requirements concerning the
environmental impact of corporate actions, race and sex discrimination,
and human rights activities. Sometimes these are in the interests
of shareholders, and sometimes they are not.
In the last few decades shareholders and other constituencies
have employed this device innumerable times. Although most campaigns
do not carry a majority vote, increasing numbers of proposals
win. But because everyone knows nominal shareholders can make
proposals, management can take lightly even proposals that win the
support of a majority of shareholders. Thus management often opts
not to implement a winning proposal. After all, if management believes
in the proposal, it will adopt it without waiting for a constituency
initiative or vote.
More important than the shareholder proposal rule is the possibility
of a corporate takeover. This can be effected either by proxy
contest or by tender offer. In a proxy contest, the more traditional
method of corporate takeover, a shareholder or group of shareholders
appeals to other shareholders to change control of the company by
electing new directors to the board. They argue their case in a proxy
statement delivered to all shareholders, and the incumbent group
presents its case in its own proxy statement. The shareholders vote,
and their voice is heard.
Before the late 1960s and early 1970s, Ben Graham lamented the
difficulty shareholders faced in changing poor management in this
way. (Graham knew firsthand about those difficulties, for he waged
a proxy contest to wrest control of a company earlier in his career.)10
But proxy contests became far easier to wage and more effective in
that time, signaling the dawn of the corporate governance movement
that tookfirm hold in the 1980s. As a consequence of the rise in
204 In Managers We Trust
proxy contests in the late 1960s and early 1970s, Graham said that
“boards of directors have probably become more alive than previously
to their fundamental duty to see that their company has a
satisfactory top management.”
The 1980s brought more sophisticated and better-funded takeover
tactics to corporate America, chiefly the tender offer, by which
shareholders simply exit a company with unsatisfactory management
and performance. The result has been the creation of a market for
control of corporations, a way to give real meaning to the shareholders’
voice. Thus, Graham’s plea made at the dawn of the corporate
governance era assumes greater value now: “that stockholders
consider with an open mind and with careful attention any proxy
material sent them by fellow stockholders who want to remedy an
obviously unsatisfactory management situation in the company.”11
205
C h a p t e r 1 3
DIRECTORS AT
WORK
An increasingly common lament sung across corporate America
is that directors are overworked. They are asked to do too much,
must satisfy too many competing interests, and so on. There is a
simple and sufficient solution to this condition. Directors should be
asked to do a short list of five things and do them well. The key jobs
entrusted to any board of directors are as follows:
• Selecting an effective chief executive
• Setting executive compensation
• Evaluating takeovers
• Allocating capital
• Promoting integrity in financial reporting
Effective performance of these jobs ultimately depends not so
much on governance mechanisms as on board trustworthiness. An
investor should pay attention to how well directors perform these
tasks as a way to gauge where along the continuum from owner
orientation to manager orientation they sit. A management-oriented
position is suggested by fat executive paychecks for a dismal performance.
A stakeholder-oriented position reveals itself in poor returns
on invested capital that keep unproductive plants operating in a bow
to labor pressure. An owner orientation is reflected by good performance,
reasonable executive pay, and the cultivation of productive
workers in productive jobs.
As a management orientation example, askyourself whose interests
were really going to be served by AMP’s resistance to Allied-
Signal’s bid discussed in Chapter 11? AMP’s shareholders objected,
and so they obviously thought their interests were being disserved,
and AMP’s plan to boost the company’s profitability included cutting
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
206 In Managers We Trust
the workforce by about 9%, or 4200 jobs, and closing ten factories.1
AMP’s board ultimately may have served the corporation’s interests
in concluding a deal with a friendly partner, but AMP’s CEO and
management undoubtedly pressured the board to resist what by all
accounts looked good for shareholders in favor of something that
looked bad for the workers.
The best way to tell where a company sits is to investigate the
way its directors tackle their key jobs. Focus on those jobs and decide
which boards do them well.
HAIL TO THE CHIEF
The CEO sets the tone at the top. The CEO’s historical performance
on matters such as compensation, acquisitions, and capital allocation
generally is the key question an investor should ask when judging
a CEO and deciding whether to entrust wealth to his or her
management. Special attention must be paid to selecting a CEO
because of his or her unique role in the organization.
Warren Buffett notes that standards for measuring a CEO’s performance
are either inadequate or easy to manipulate, and so a
CEO’s performance is harder to measure than that of most workers.
The CEO has no senior other than in theory the company’s board
of directors. That board is often handicapped in its performance
review, however, because of a lackof measurement standards and
because as meetings come and go, the relationship between the CEO
and the directors increasingly becomes congenial rather than supervisory.
Maintaining that supervisory attitude is critical. The board’s role
in reviewing the CEO’s performance is most acute precisely where
it can be most easily impaired: dealing with a mediocre manager. It
is easy for a board to get rid of a terrible manager; the hard case is
a so-so one. Recruiting the top talent and a roster of succession
candidates is a critical board function. Too often the importance of
this role is overlooked, as occurs when a board simply replaces an
outgoing CEO with the number two fellow at the company (which
happens about two-thirds of the time). This means that many boards
fail to evaluate changing organizational needs and variations in the
personal talents of the two at the top.2
Abdication of a board’s responsibility for CEO selection is most
clear when a board simply allows an incumbent CEO to handpick
Directors at Work 207
the successor. There is little reason to believe that even the most
outstanding CEO is as good as a top board at picking a new CEO.
The result is too often the need to oust the new CEO pretty early
in his or her tenure.
Still, boards must evaluate a CEO’s performance regularly and
out of the CEO’s presence, and evaluating that performance is harder
than it seems. Both short-term results and potential long-term
results must be assessed. If only short-term results mattered, many
managerial decisions would be much easier, particularly those relating
to businesses whose economic characteristics have eroded.
Recall again Al Dunlap’s aggressive and doomed plan to turn
around the ailing Sunbeam. The huge accounting scandal that followed
in its wake also suggests its inherent stupidity. Once it was
clear that Dunlap was a terrible manager, it was easy for the Sunbeam
board to throw him out, but before the fallout he looked at
worst mediocre and therefore harder to disagree with.
PAY
Plenty of evidence shows that the total level of executive compensation
in the United States is positively correlated with the level of
corporate performance. Some evidence even shows a positive correlation
between performance and the portion of total compensation
paid in stock.3
Even so, it is also obvious that some executives are paid substantially
more than they should be in light of their performance.
Accordingly, investors should pay close attention to potentially piratical
executive compensation.
Compensation Levels
This is not to say that it is desirable to have governance rules that
limit top executive compensation to some ratio of the pay of the
least compensated employee at a company. Indeed, Ben & Jerry’s
tried this during its early years of business life, capping its founder’s
and chief’s compensation at seven times that of the lowest-paid
worker. But once the company outgrew its founder’s managerial
skills, it was forced to go on the market to recruit top talent, and
that required a pay package way higher than that cap.4
208 In Managers We Trust
If the early Ben & Jerry’s policy showed bad judgment, some of
the pay packages seen lately show something far worse. The CEO
of NetworkAssociates (owner of the McAfee computer antivirus programs),
for example, got about $7 million in shares of McAfee.com
just ahead of its IPO even though the business of NetworkAssociates
performed poorly and McAfee itself was losing money.5
A key issue in the merger between Chrysler and Daimler-Benz
was the enormous difference between the two companies both in
the level of executive compensation and in the compensation ratios
of the highest-paid and lowest-paid employees. In 1997, for example,
Robert Eaton, Chrysler’s chairman of the board, received total compensation
of about $10 million, over 200 times the average worker’s
pay and nearly as much as the total compensation paid to all ten
members of Daimler-Benz’s management board combined. Daimler-
Benz’s chairman, Jurgen Schrempp, was paid about one-tenth as
much as Eaton, making his compensation approximately twenty
times that of the average Daimler-Benz worker.
Thus, a major question in the merger was the form that the
combined entity’s compensation structure should take. Schrempp
pointed out that the existing pay differences reflected cultural differences,
particularly the somewhat more egalitarian corporate culture
in Germany, as demonstrated by labor representation on supervisory
boards. He also predicted that the U.S. model would prove to
be the proper form for DaimlerChrysler and other transnational
companies, except that “the only way to make big pay packets socially
acceptable is by linking them closely to performance.”6
Schrempp’s statement mirrors the rhetoric of corporate America.
Given that the other differences in corporate governance between
Germany and the United States are more nuanced and subtle than
is generally understood, you have to wonder if this was Schrempp’s
main point when he said that DaimlerChrysler created “the first
German company with a North American culture.” Any doubt was
cleared up when Schrempp subsequently proselytized for Americanstyle
executive options at DaimlerChrysler’s April 2000 shareholder
meeting, something his German shareholders sensibly resisted.
Stock Options
A decade ago corporate governance mavens urged boards to pay
managers more in stockthan in cash to promote an alignment of
interests between managers and shareholders. The response was treDirectors
at Work 209
mendous, a bit like the apocryphal story of Lady Astor’s famous quip
on the Titanic: “I asked for ice, but this is ridiculous.”
What the governance gurus got was a proliferation of payment
not in stockthat was the functional equivalent of the forgone cash
but instead stockoptions with a value vastly exceeding what the cash
payment could reasonably have been. The explosion of option-based
compensation remains one of the most controversial subjects in corporate
governance history.
Some say that the widespread use of stockoptions in the United
States simply reflects the priority given to this alignment goal in the
United States and that its relative infrequency in Europe and elsewhere
reflects the absence or irrelevance of this goal. However, the
talkof alignment is more myth than truth and too often represents
an attempt to sanitize management compensation packages that conflict
with shareholder interests (not to mention labor interests).
Stock Option Myths
No evidence indicates that the prevailing structure of executive compensation
in the United States comes anywhere close to aligning
manager and shareholder interests. On the contrary, a great deal of
evidence demonstrates that the compensation structure is random.
Many corporations give their managers stockoptions which increase
in value simply through earnings retention, rather than because
of improved performance resulting from superior deployment
of capital. By retaining and reinvesting net income, managers can
report annual earnings increases without doing anything to improve
real returns on capital.
Buffett makes the point: “You can get the same result personally
while operating from your rocking chair. Just quadruple the capital
you commit to a savings account and you will quadruple your earnings.
You would hardly expect hosannas for that particular accomplishment.”
7
When that happens, stockoptions rob the corporation and its
shareholders of wealth and allocate the booty to the optionees. Indeed,
once granted, stockoptions are often irrevocable and unconditional
and benefit the grantees without regard to individual performance—
a form of instant robbery.
Even if stockoptions encourage optionees to thinkas shareholders
would, optionees are not exposed to the same downside risks
as shareholders are. If economic performance improves and the
210 In Managers We Trust
stockprice rises above the exercise price, the optionees will exercise
the option and share in the increase with shareholders. But if economic
performance is unfavorable and the stockprice remains below
the exercise price, optionees simply will not exercise the option.
Shareholders suffer from the corporation’s unfavorable performance,
but an option holder does not.
These awards also exacerbate the misalignment of interests between
corporate option holders (usually senior executives) and other
workers. The awards dramatically increase the compensation differential
between highly paid executives and ordinary laborers, a ratio
which is significantly higher in the United States than it is in Europe
and elsewhere. Accordingly, when stockoptions are used, they
should be spread throughout the employee base—as GE has done—
rather than limited to the top dogs.
Stock Option Costs
The direct cost to shareholders of stockoption compensation is the
dilution of their ownership interest. A common managerial response
to the dilution is to buy backoutstanding shares. The trouble with
that solution is that it devours corporate funds that might be more
profitably deployed.
Shocking indirect costs are accounting rules that fail to require
employee stockoptions to be recorded as an expense on the income
statement.8 This translates into earnings per share figures that overstate
actual earnings for companies with executive stockoptions outstanding.
Even the diluted earnings per share figure does not reflect
these costs.
Accordingly, you must adjust earnings figures for the cost of options.
Doing this is not easy, however, for not all information is necessarily
found in the financial statements. You need to examine the
footnotes for something called overhang, which is the percentage of
the company that outstanding stockoptions would represent if they
were exercised. The average percentage has mushroomed from under
10% a few years ago to nearly 15% now.
Still, the actual cost of options is not presented directly, though
there is some footnote disclosure about this. The real cost equals
the price at the time of exercise minus the amount the executive
pays (the exercise price). This is the truest measure of cost because
the company could have generated that much by selling the optioned
shares to others at the prevalent price instead of at the option price.
The cost of executive stockoptions is substantial, averaging
Directors at Work 211
about 5% of annual earnings among S&P 500 companies and in
some cases amounting to half of reported earnings, including at Yahoo!,
Polaroid, and Palm.9 In less dramatic but still striking examples,
if stockoptions were recorded as a cost, the 1999 earnings of
some major companies would be slashed: Cisco, 24%; Microsoft,
12%; IBM, 8%; and Oracle, 16%.10
These cost effects extend for many years, depending on the life
of the options. At many companies, options have a life of five years.
Increasingly, companies extend their lives to as long as 10 and 15
years.
Accountability
Legal rules are ill equipped to police executive compensation. The
general stance of U.S. courts is to evaluate compensation issues, if
at all, under a waste standard. This standard rarely upsets corporate
decisions. Waste requires pretty much the irrational trashing of corporate
assets in ways akin to dumping truckloads of cash into the
Hudson River. In the case of executive compensation, U.S. courts
are quite deferential to management indeed.
As for securities disclosure laws, the SEC requires substantial
and focused disclosure of top executive compensation in comparative
performance charts. Nevertheless, corporations continue to
structure executive compensation packages so that they don’t show
up in the bottom-line numbers. For example, after accounting standard
setters ruled that a reduction in the exercise price of a previously
issued option had to be recorded as an expense on the income
statement, many companies chose instead to extend the life of the
option.
Without effective legal or accounting regulations, the chief job
of policing executive compensation lies with the corporate board.
Board members must insist that executive compensation peg individual
contributions to corporate performance. Measuring executive
performance by business profitability is the most definitive yardstick
with regard to shareholder as well as labor interests. When measuring
performance, companies should reduce earnings by the capital
employed in the relevant business or by the earnings the firm retains.
Caveat
While Warren Buffett tends to share these criticisms of stockoption
compensation packages, he is careful to record the following caveat:
212 In Managers We Trust
Some managers whom I admire enormously—and whose operating
records are far better than mine—disagree with me regarding
fixed-price options. They have built corporate cultures
that work, and fixed-price options have been a tool that helped
them. By their leadership and example, and by the use of options
as incentives, these managers have taught their colleagues to
thinklik e owners. Such a culture is rare and when it exists
should perhaps be left intact—despite inefficiencies and inequities
that may infest the option program.11
Investors should lookfor boards that take the lead in policing
stockoption compensation, but beware—they are scarce.
DEALS
Just as the disease of random executive compensation must be
avoided by intelligent investors and trustworthy boards, so must the
costs of imprudent acquisition policies and defensive tactics.
Offensive
Offensive acquisition strategies require careful board attention because
of the strong possibility that even outstanding senior managers
possess individual interests that conflict with owner interests. Acquisitions
give CEOs enormous psychological benefits by expanding
their dominion and generating more action. Acquisitions driven by
these sorts of impulses come at shareholder expense.
Most acquisitions do not achieve gains in business value. A 1999
study by the global accounting firm KPMG concluded that “83% of
mergers [during the period 1996–1998, when trillions had been paid
in merger deals] failed to produce any benefits for shareholders and,
even more alarming, over half actually destroyed value.” That study
also found, based on interviews with managers involved in mergers,
that less than half did any postdeal review to test whether value was
added or subtracted!12
A governance problem exists because most acquisition attempts
do not come to the board for discussion until the process is substantially
under way and until after the CEO has invested substantial
personal capital in them. Rejecting an acquisition proposal after the
CEO invests substantial personal capital is often considered a rejection
of the CEO who presented the proposal to the board. This problem
is especially acute among CEOs who resent hearing bad news.
Directors at Work 213
Cascades of stupid acquisitions come pouring in, often drowning the
board’s better judgment.
These timing problems make it difficult to design a governance
mechanism that would alleviate this pressure on the board. The ego
problems are just as intractable, as another Buffettism suggests:
“While deals often fail in practice, they never fail in projections—if
the CEO is visibly panting over a prospective acquisition, subordinates
and consultants will supply the requisite projections to rationalize
any price.”13
Mattel, for example, is a worldwide leader in the design, manufacture,
and distribution of toys. In May 1999 it bought the Learning
Company, a producer of educational software for personal computers.
Mattel paid for the $3.8 billion purchase by using Mattel
stockat a time when the stockwas trading at about $26 a share
(down already from an average trading price over the prior year of
around $40). Mattel’s chair, Jill Barad, announced in July 1999 that
the Learning Company was contributing to Mattel’s overall operations
with “exceptionally strong growth” in revenues and margins and
said this “was one of the reasons this merger made so much sense
for Mattel.”14
Barad did not say how the computer software business related
to Mattel’s traditional products, such as Barbie dolls, Fisher-Price
toys, and Hot Wheels. But just three months later, in October
1999, Mattel announced that the Learning Company division’s revenues
had declined and it had lost money because of, among other
things, higher than expected product returns from customers and
write-offs of bad debts.15 Instead of earning $50 million that quarter
as Barad estimated, it lost over $100 million, and Mattel’s stock
plummeted to about $11 a share. Many analysts, at least in hindsight,
reported that these problems at the Learning Company were
not new and should have been uncovered and discounted before
Mattel bought it.
These analysts also thought that Mattel fit the description of a
company about to make a bad acquisition. If sales growth in your
core business is declining and you can’t seem to do anything about
it through product, marketing, or distribution improvements, one
impulse is to buy yourself some growth through an acquisition. Mattel’s
sales growth, incidentally, was declining in its core products
right before the Learning Company acquisition. So too, for that matter,
was the Learning Company’s. (Mattel’s board ousted Barad in
early 2000, awarding her an exorbitant severance package, and replaced
her with Kraft Foods CEO Robert Eckert.)
214 In Managers We Trust
Contrast Mattel’s story with the policies of Disney. Disney’s
philosophy is to make only acquisitions that are in a related or
complementary field that current management understands fully,
and at a fair price. In its most important acquisition, Capital Cities
ABC fit the bill. Disney’s long-time chairman, Michael Eisner, had
worked at ABC from 1966 through 1976 and had seen it grow from
a networkcritics called the “fourth of three” to first place in every
category.
After Capital Cities bought ABC in 1986, Tom Murphy and Dan
Burke catapulted it to yet new heights, and the combination with
Disney made sense. Walt Disney himself liked ABC as well. After
all, ABC helped finance Disneyland in 1955, and Walt brought ABC
to Hollywood when he began what is now The Wonderful World of
Disney. Disney’s Internet business benefited enormously from the
addition of ABC.com, ESPN.com, and a host of cable assets that
enable important growth opportunities.
Defensive
Takeover defenses are the flip side of offensive acquisition strategies.
Antitakeover devices such as the poison pill protect management’s
decision making by discouraging attempts to acquire the corporation
or remove incumbent directors (as AMP’s defense against Allied-
Signal attests). If some or a majority of stockholders deem a takeover
attempt to be in the corporation’s and their best interest and the
potential acquirer is willing to pay a premium over the prevailing
market price or intrinsic value of the corporation’s common stock,
antitakeover devices work against shareholders.
Disney’s acquisition philosophy is also illustrative on this side of
the table. Corporate raiders of the early 1980s sought to acquire
Disney and bust it up but Roy Disney would not let that happen.
He preserved Disney as a great American institution and facilitated
a recommitment to the fundamental businesses that had made it
great. Disney animation, for example, with Roy at the helm, reinvented
itself and surged with a long series of critically and popularly
acclaimed films. In doing so, Disney adopted the best takeover defense
strategy there is: an extraordinary business. (More on Disney
in the next chapter.)
To be sure, situations exist in which hostile offers are inadequate
and not in the interests of the corporation or any of its constituents.
Yet incumbent managers facing unwanted takeover talks naturally
Directors at Work 215
will resist the efforts of the acquiring firm whether or not their resistance
best serves the corporation. After all, in most cases their
jobs are at risk.
Within U.S. corporations—and probably increasingly within corporations
organized elsewhere—takeovers put unmatured stock options
at risk. Faced with this prospect, managers may employ mechanisms
designed to resist inferior bids in an effort to resist superior
bids. They thus may use a poison pill against a bid that is great for
shareholders when it should be used only to deter bids that are bad
for shareholders.
In these situations, boards must recognize that CEOs and their
troops are under fire, just as they are when a board challenges one
of their proposed offensive acquisitions.
In both situations boards should expect managers to adopt a
siege mentality which obscures honest thinking about what is in the
owners’ interests. In both offensive and defensive situations there is
no clear mechanism that can assure that boards will respond properly,
but boards must at least recognize what is happening psychologically
in these situations if they hope to respond effectively at all.
For investors, identifying directors with that capacity is key.
CAPITAL
A company generating substantial amounts of excess cash can deploy
it in one of four ways. It can reinvest in the business, repurchase its
own shares, distribute the cash in dividends to shareholders, and, as
was just noted, make acquisitions.
Aside from a few formal and manipulable limits, U.S. law gives
boards of directors unbridled discretion in the choice of these uses,
including declaring and paying dividends and making or not making
repurchases. Corporate charters rarely restrict dividend policies, although
a corporation’s loan and credit agreements sometimes do.
The policy of most U.S. boards is to pay regular quarterly cash
dividends at a stable or steadily increasing dollar amount. This pattern
is inconsistent with the reality that underlying business performance
is hardly ever that smooth. Earnings are almost always bumpy
(even if less bumpy than average stockprices).
Dividends tend to be way higher than they should be. Given the
importance of dividend policy in capital allocation decisions, certain
common reasons that boards use to justify their policies, such as
216 In Managers We Trust
signaling confidence and giving the appearance of reliability, are either
strange or disingenuous.
We should give credit to boards that use a more rigorous approach
for setting dividend policy, an ideal set forth by Warren Buffett.
The test distinguishes between restricted earnings, those which
must be reinvested in a business just to maintain its competitive
position, and unrestricted earnings, which should be retained only
when there is a reasonable prospect that for every dollar retained,
at least one dollar of market value will be created for shareholders;
otherwise, the dollar of earnings should be paid out.16 Microsoft follows
this policy pretty well, never having paid a dividend and generating
great returns on the reinvested capital.
Boards can justify retaining earnings under this test only if the
capital retained produces incremental earnings at least equal to the
return generally available to the shareholders. For companies that
can reinvest earnings in this manner, dividends should not be paid
and boards should ignore any negative signals this policy sends, such
as lackof confidence or unreliability (though they should pay attention
to the resulting tax advantages to shareholders).
The smartest thing a company can do with undervalued stockis
to buy it back. Obviously, if a stock is selling in the market at half
its intrinsic value, the company can buy $2 in value by paying $1 in
cash. You rarely find better uses of capital than that. Stockrepur -
chases usually give a stockholder a slight tax advantage. Dividends
on common stockare taxed as ordinary income at rates as high as
39.6%, whereas income generated by the repurchase of stockheld
longer than a year is treated as capital gains at rates no higher than
20%.
Stockbuyback s are not always what they seem. They reduce the
number of a company’s shares outstanding, thus increasing earnings
per share. The typical result is that investors buy more of that stock
and thus bid the price up, mistakenly believing that the repurchases
are a managerial signal that the company’s stockis underpriced. Often,
however, the repurchase program is a cognate of a stockissuance
program to offset shares issued upon the exercise of stockoptions.
The increased stockprice, after all, means increasing the value
of stockoptions on that stock. When a repurchase program and an
issuance program are run simultaneously, you should be more discriminating
in your judgment of what management is doing.
It is possible that this effect could lead management (with many
stockoptions at its feet) to prefer buybacks even if that were not
Directors at Work 217
the smartest way to allocate the company’s capital. Indeed, options
create incentives to borrow money for stockrepurchases that boost
earnings per share and return on equity. That poses a major risk, as
a smaller equity base in a crisis can push a company closer to bankruptcy,
severely damaging shareholder interests (as well as the interests
of others).
In contrast to the occasional wisdom of stockrepurchases is the
universal folly of stocksplits. Stocksplits have three consequences,
none of them beneficial to the stockholders. They increase transaction
costs by promoting high share turnover; they attract shareholders
with short-term, market-oriented views who unduly focus on
stockmark et prices; and, as a result of both of those effects, they
lead to prices that depart materially from intrinsic business value.
With no offsetting benefits, splitting a stockis nonsense. Nevertheless,
most companies do it, including GE, Microsoft, and Amazon.
com. Berkshire Hathaway is one of the handful that don’t. After
going public in mid-1997, Amazon.com split its stockthree times
from June 1998 to September 1999! GE split its stockonly nine times
in its hundred-plus-year history, though three of those splits occurred
in the last six years of the 1990s.
The only meritorious argument favoring stocksplits is that they
reduce the per share price of stockand thus enable a wider investor
group to participate. If no U.S. company in history had ever split its
stock, the per share price of some of the best companies would be
in the tens of thousands of dollars (as is the case at Berkshire Hathaway,
for example). That price level is prohibitive for many investors.
This argument does not justify the high frequency of stocksplits,
however, which are used to keep prices below a couple of hundred
dollars—an amount that is affordable by all investors.
CHECKING UP
As Chapter 10 showed, for accounting information to be valuable,
users must have justifiable confidence in its integrity. Forces that
jeopardize integrity are often intractable: Business innovation, evolution,
and complexity, coupled with the formal nature of accounting
rules inevitably create a substantial zone of managerial discretion in
financial reporting.
Integrity in financial reporting is promoted through internal control
systems and by external auditor certifications, both of which can
218 In Managers We Trust
constrain managerial discretion somewhat. For these mechanisms to
be effective, however, the board of directors must assure that both
internal controls and external audits do this.
Internal financial reporting controls are designed to assure that
transactions are executed in accordance with management policy
and are recorded properly in the accounting records (and to assure
that assets are deployed only in accordance with management policy).
They range from daily journal entries that are reviewed regularly
by others, to periodic taking of inventory, to procedures for review
of judgments concerning depreciation, to the articulation and review
of riskmanagement policies. Some of these tools are required by
federal securities laws.
Within a corporation, both the board of directors and the managers
play a role in defining, implementing, and evaluating internal
controls. In principle, however, the chief and ultimate responsibility
for internal controls rests with the board of directors, both as a matter
of common sense and as a matter of policy. Boards have a comparative
informational advantage and greater motivation to police
managerial opportunism than managers do. This obligation entails
supervising the design of internal control systems and supporting
their administration.
The critical importance of internal controls to the integrity of
financial reporting is evidenced by the requirement that outside auditors
review them in connection with annual audits of a company’s
financial statements. This audit is intended to obtain objective assurance
that the financial statements are relevant and reliable, based
on a general review of the financial statements and the underlying
day-to-day records and periodic summaries on which they are based.
The audit is a monitoring mechanism that lends credibility to
the financial statements. For that credibility to be meaningful, however,
the auditor must workclosely with members of the board of
directors, and both the auditor and those directors must act with
diligence, independence, and awareness. Several challenges are
posed for a board and its audit committee.
First, an audit conducted by an independent firm does not
change the fact that a company’s management prepares the financial
statements and is responsible for them. The audit is a review of those
statements. The audit does not entail a review of every financial
transaction in which the company engaged during the period covered
by the financial statements. That is a practical impossibility for any
auditor and even more so for any audit committee. Businesses enDirectors
at Work 219
gage in huge numbers of financial transactions during the course of
the typical financial period, usually one year. Instead, audits are conducted
on a “test basis” by reviewing a sample of the hundreds or
thousands of transactions of a variety of kinds engaged in by the firm
over time.
Second, with respect to the detection of fraud, neither the auditor
nor the audit committee is always in a position to root it out.
This is the case principally because it is impossible for the audit to
include an examination of every single transaction in which a company
engaged or in which management says it engaged.
Third, the auditor must be independent of the company, a requirement
imposed by the canons of professional responsibility of
the auditing profession; so too must the members of the audit committee,
a requirement of stockexchange rules endorsed by the SEC.
Audits lacking impartial and objective professional judgment fail to
promote financial reporting integrity. At best, they end up functioning
as merely another type of internal control.
Audits are harmful if they carry a false appearance of independent
certification that induces undue reliance. Also, since effective
independent audits include testing internal controls, the integrity of
those systems is undermined by a nonobjective and potentially biased
audit that diminishes rather than enhances overall integrity.
Audit firm independence is a hot topic. The big global auditing
firms have expanded their businesses beyond the traditional audit
function to include consulting and other practices that could in
some circumstances compromise their ability to contribute integrity
to financial reporting. These firms have merged, restructured, or
been acquired by other corporations. Their clients and business are
evolving into more sophisticated, technologically advanced, and
transnational operations.
The SEC established the Independence Standards Board (ISB)
to address auditor independence issues,17 but it remains a principal
responsibility of the board of directors and its audit committee to
assure an independent financial review. Those in charge are accountable
for adopting a diligent and alert mind-set that lets them rigorously
assess the company’s internal controls, the testing of its
reported accounts, and the likelihood that what they see accountingwise
is what really happened businesswise.
The audit committee is the one place where independent directors
are called for, but independence is not as essential as expertise
in accounting and/or auditing, as the new stockexchange rules now
220 In Managers We Trust
require. That is a crucial step (though by no means a sufficient one)
in giving assurance that, in the words of the traditional SEC standard,
“a reasonable investor, knowing all relevant facts and circumstances,
would perceive an auditor as having neither mutual nor
conflicting interests with its audit client and as exercising objective
and impartial judgment on all issues brought to the auditor’s attention.”
Only then are financial statements worth analyzing. Auditing is
an area over which the board of directors must take control and
provide leadership. Boards that consistently do this deserve credit.
Those which do not should be penalized—and they should be penalized
long before the outside auditor gets around to blowing the
whistle, as shareholders of Rite-Aid discovered to their chagrin and
loss in late 1999, when its outside auditors resigned from their audit
engagement on the grounds that they could no longer trust management
to tell them the truth!
Important as the auditor, audit committee, and board are in their
key jobs, there remains one person holding the torch for investors—
the CEO. Buffett says:
The term “earnings” has a precise ring to it. And when an earnings
figure is accompanied by an unqualified auditor’s certificate,
a naive reader might thinkit comparable in certitude to p,
calculated to dozens of decimal places.
In reality, however, earnings can be as pliable as putty when
a charlatan heads the company reporting them. Eventually truth
will surface, but in the meantime a lot of money can change
hands. Indeed, some important American fortunes have been
created by the monetization of accounting mirages.18
Avoiding charlatans is even more important than identifying excellent
boards, so let’s move on to the corner suite.
221
C h a p t e r 1 4
THE FIRESIDE CEO
The legendary investor Phil Fisher described his scuttlebutt approach
to investing as requiring diligent investigation of management.
He boldly interviewed a company’s customers, suppliers,
and employees about the managers and also spoke to management
directly. The Fisher method is followed today by venture capitalists
but is prohibitive for most average investors, who cannot get out and
visit those folks or even talk to them.
Some reasonable substitutes are available, though. You can listen
in on the investor conference calls held by most companies on a
quarterly basis and chaired by the CEO (the dial-in numbers for
these calls are available from the company and from most brokerage
firms). You can also attend the periodic “road shows” that companies
take through your locality; they are particularly worthwhile when the
CEO is in tow (which isn’t always the case) and you can attend
annual meetings to get a bird’s-eye view of the chief. These and other
events are often available on the Internet as Webcasts.
You can also read the voluminous material written about the
CEOs of most companies and by the CEOs themselves. At the top
of the reading list for insight into the character and business orientation
of a CEO is his annual letters to shareholders. Most of
these are public relations documents, ghostwritten, stylized, and full
of puffery. No one is fooled by messages written in the promotions
department, but among the glossy, photograph-laden, chart-strewn
marketing materials are a handful of letters actually written by the
CEO. Those are the letters worth reading.
MASTER SERVANTS
The seven basic characteristics most widely cited by venture capitalists
as important to lookfor in managers are integrity, achieve-
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
222 In Managers We Trust
ment, energy, intelligence, knowledge, leadership, and creativity.1
Which of these is the most important?
Obviously, you want to avoid entrusting your wealth to a brilliant
crookor a trustworthy idiot. An above-average IQ and these other
traits are certainly assets, but your CEO need not be in the top 10%
in the world on all these scales (who is?).
You might be tempted to follow the line of Fred Schwed in Where
Are the Customers’ Yachts? who joked that he’d prefer a smart criminal
to an honest bonehead because at least with a writ and a cop
he’d collect from the thief whereas all he’d get from the bonehead
was a pathetic apology. Don’t do this.
Buffett repeatedly emphasizes that the one characteristic that
belongs on a pedestal is integrity. This means a CEO who thinks of
your interests first, one who has what Buffett calls an owner orientation.
CEOs reveal the degree of their owner orientation in their letters,
as described by the rules Warren Buffett sets for himself when
he writes his annual letter to Berkshire Hathaway shareholders: “to
tell you the business facts that we would want to know if our positions
were reversed. We owe you no less. . . . TheCEOwhomisleads
others in public may eventually mislead himself in private.”2 Apply
that standard in evaluating whether a CEO deserves your trust.
Everyone knows that Warren Buffett is an enormously successful
investor, but not everyone is aware that he is also an enormously
successful and owner-oriented manager. On this score, Buffett is to
business management what Ted Williams was to baseball. Both are
in classes by themselves, Ted constantly hitting near .400 and Warren
constantly writing lucid and candid reports of his successes and
failures at Berkshire Hathaway (compiled into the book The Essays
of Warren Buffett: Lessons for Corporate America).
While Buffett is in a class by himself, there are many runnersup,
and searching for them by reading CEO letters is a valuable and
often entertaining investing exercise. This chapter looks at what is
revealed by the letters of three leaders who display not only honesty,
the key characteristic you should seek in a CEO, but also in various
degrees achievement, energy, intelligence, knowledge, leadership,
and creativity.
ACTION
Few CEOs have affected corporate America as GE’s JackWelch has.3
By word and action since taking the helm at General Electric in
The Fireside CEO 223
1979, Welch has redefined major aspects of business management.
In his widely followed annual letters to GE shareholders, Welch articulates
a creative set of core operating elements and explains how
their practical applications produce a new kind of company that exploits
the vast resources of a large organization with the passion and
hunger usually associated with smaller companies, all within a corporate
culture committed to cultivating the best practices.
GE is one of the largest companies in the world. Welch transformed
it from a widely diverse set of 350 businesses and major
product lines into what he calls an “integrated, diversified company.”
Welch determined that GE’s strength from diversity could be real
only if each business was number one or two in its particular market.
Through a policy of “fixing, selling, or closing” businesses that
weren’t, Welch led GE to occupy a leadership position in the dozen
businesses it now operates. Those businesses are integrated as an
overall company through a boundaryless culture united by a shared
thirst for better ideas to workfaster and reach higher.
GE shareholders benefited enormously from this culture of
boundaryless and integrated diversity, enjoying average annual returns
on equity exceeding 24% during Welch’s stewardship. Hundreds
of thousands of GE employees also benefited through an enhanced
system of internal rewards and recognition that encourages
involvement. A large number of GE alumni moved on to lead other
businesses, including Larry Bossidy, former CEO of AlliedSignal and
coauthor with Welch of a number of his letters.
Ideas generated or adapted at GE were celebrated among other
businesses and leaders, for the concept of boundarylessness is taken
so literally at GE that it shares its ideas the world over. As Welch
notes, a key GE value is to treat resource allocation as a dynamic
process: “Sometimes a business benefits as a net importer of dollars,
ideas and talent while at other times the same business will be
called upon to be a net exporter for the benefit of the Company as
a whole.”
Accolades for GE flowed during Welch’s stewardship. Fortune
magazine named GE its “Most Admired Company in America” in
1998 and 1999, and The Financial Times named it “the World’s Most
Respected Company” in those two years. Time magazine upped the
ante, calling GE “the Company of the Century,” and a 1999 Business
Week survey said that GE boasted the best board of directors. As
Welch said in his 1999 letter, Thomas Edison would be pleased with
the company he founded over a century ago.
Welch’s letters not only contain a firsthand account of the de224
In Managers We Trust
velopment of GE’s unique culture but also reflect Welch’s imagination,
energy, and vision. They are a concrete exposition of the
values that pervade GE’s culture, how those values are implemented,
their fruits, and the qualities of leadership that make it all possible—
a great resource for the sophisticated investor as well as the intelligent
manager.
The Core Operating Elements
Welch envisions an organization without boundaries. Artificial walls
dividing parts of the inside of an organization are to be destroyed.
The entire enterprise is a team, and responsibility is shared. A culture
without boundaries renders impossible excuses such as “not
invented here,” a common way to evade responsibility. In this culture,
Welch created “a vast laboratory whose principal product is new
ideas.” Ideas generated in one place are transported to others.
External boundaries are also exploded in this corporate culture.
Employees engage with broader communities through volunteer
work, and the company participates in outreach programs. GE engages
its various constituents as part of its daily life, learning how
better to serve customers as well as coventurers, distributors, and
others. GE is happy to learn from its own but equally happy to adapt
ideas created by others, including suppliers and competitors.
Boundaries retard development, stifle creativity, and complicate
operations. Destroying boundaries enabled GE to flourish amid
Welch’s three other core operating elements: speed, stretch, and simplification.
Speed thrives on change. Teamworkenhances speed, enabling
substantial increases in measures of performance straight across a
business. For example, by diminishing the cycle from order to remittance,
speed enhances inventory turnover. For a company GE’s
size, every single-digit improvement in its inventory turnover produces
over a billion dollars in free cash for investment.
Speed’s “fun and excitement” facilitates stretch, the idea of always
setting outsized goals. The stretch philosophy says that if you
thinkyou can increase inventory turnover by one point in the next
cycle, set your goal at increasing it by two points. A boundaryless
culture is the key to a successful stretch philosophy because it emphasizes
that “the quality of effort toward achieving the ‘impossible’
is the ultimate measure” of performance.
Stretch reverses much of conventional practice and incentive
The Fireside CEO 225
structures in business. At many businesses, managers set targets and
are evaluated on the basis of whether they meet them. The incentive
is to set modest targets. In a stretch setting managers are encouraged
to set extraordinarily ambitious goals and are then evaluated according
to how they did in one period compared to how they did in the
prior period. In short, “performance is measured against how the
world turned out to be—how well a business anticipated change and
dealt with it—rather than against some ‘plan’ or internal number
negotiated a year earlier.”
Speed and stretch are complemented by the final core operating
element of a boundaryless environment: simplification. Complexity,
whether in business organization charts, communications, or goal
setting, impairs speed and stretch and is foreign to a boundaryless
culture. Simplicity breeds self-confidence, which is conveyed
through direct plans and straightforward speech, setting “big, clear
targets.” The clarity arising from simplicity has another big virtue:
It enhances speed. As Welch says, “simple messages travel faster,
simpler designs reach the market faster, and the elimination of clutter
allows faster decision making.”
The Implementing Practices
GE implements its core operating elements of speed, stretch, and
simplification to realize the fruits of these elements. The key to producing
those fruits is the concept of integrated diversity. It is the
strength a company generates from being number one or number
two in all its businesses and drawing on the resources of each business
to sustain or enhance its position in others.
Two steps were necessary to achieve integrated diversity at GE.
The first was to keep only the businesses that were number one or
two in their particular markets. Each business needs to be strong in
its own right. Then the collection of businesses produces “a critical
mass of competitive advantage.” To exploit that competitive advantage
in turn requires delayering the management structure, which
Welch achieved by dismantling the multiple layers of management
that had clogged the company in the earlier era. Delayering enhanced
productivity, making the aggregate of the parts far more powerful
than their mere sum.
Through a strategy called “Work-Out,” Welch sought and got
input from everyone in the company (and some people outside it).
Long before Perot and Clinton repopularized the town meeting con226
In Managers We Trust
cept in American politics, GE practiced it, getting ideas from those
closest to the particular problem. This technique not only is most
likely to generate the best solutions, it also builds self-confidence
through participation and counters insecurity by discouraging turf
battles, parochialism, and other impediments to speed and stretch.
Apart from these practices within the boundaryless culture,
Welch instilled a sense of the right sorts of managers for a thriving
enterprise. Four types of managers are defined. The first two are
easy: Type I believes in GE’s values and delivers (and sticks around),
whereas type II does neither (and doesn’t last long). Type III is a
believer but an erratic deliverer and usually gets another chance.
Type IV is the trickiest: He or she delivers short-term results but
does not believe in GE’s values. Instead of living and breathing boundaryless
values and energizing and exciting people to new heights of
creativity and productivity, this manager controls, oppresses, intimidates,
and squeezes people. Welch solved the type IV case by elevating
shared values above short-term results, and so these types
don’t last long at GE either.
GE’s system of rewards and recognition glues these managerial
qualities to GE’s values by reinforcing its boundaryless and speed/
stretch culture. Under Welch’s stewardship at GE, the number of
employees eligible for stockoptions soared from 400 to nearly
30,000. Speakers at big company meetings are selected not by their
title or rankbut on the basis of “what people know that can be
shared, borrowed, and expanded on.”
Finally, GE’s “360 degree” management appraisal calls for managers
to be evaluated not only by their superiors but also by
the people who workunder and alongside them. This evaluation
focuses GE’s leaders “on finding and rewarding people who demonstrated
an ability to get every mind in the organization into the
relentless search for ideas.”
Fruits of the Culture
Concrete results of the core operating elements implemented
through a strategy of integrated diversity and Work-Out include
those generated at GE’s Crotonville Institute management school
and those originating on shop floors throughout the company. Best
practices has become a model emulated throughout the world and
is a hallmarkof Welch’s GE. Crotonville is a wellspring of thought
on management and business, producing great ideas for decades and
The Fireside CEO 227
sharing them not only with GE businesses but with businesspeople
the world over.
Welch notes that “the intellectual underpinning of Work-Out
consists of ideas like worker involvement, trust and empowerment—
shopworn and even platitudinous concepts.” Yet he goes on to say
that at GE, “the difference is that our whole organization is, in fact,
living them, every day.” GE wields these “soft concepts” as real competitive
weapons in victorious battles, not merely “inscribing them
on coffee mugs and T-shirts.”
Crotonville, as Welch describes it, combines the “thirst for learning
of academia with an action environment usually seen only in
small, hungry companies.” Animating GE’s culture of ideas is a mode
of thought linked to the core operating elements of speed and stretch
called bullet-train thinking. Originated by the CEO of Yokogawa, this
metaphor signifies that if you want to increase a train’s speed by 10
mph, tinker with its horsepower; if you want to double it, break out
of conventional thinking and goal setting.
The fruits of the learning culture reinforce the core operating
elements by producing additional mechanisms. Consider two big
ideas embraced at GE that also exhibit the speed and stretch philosophy.
Co-location, Welch says, is the “ultimate boundaryless behavior.”
As “unsophisticated as can be,” it means conducting all the
functions for a product in one room without walls. All project participants
are simultaneously involved, including at the design stages
people from manufacturing and marketing as well as suppliers and
customers. Quick response is a cycle-time reduction technique that
similarly erases barriers between functions for a product. With colocation,
it vastly reduces average inventory and proportionately bolsters
inventory turnover.
Other fruits of this learning culture taken from outside GE help
implement the core operating elements. Demand Flow Technology
was borrowed from the GE customer American Standard to multiply
inventory turnover and move toward GE’s goal noted in an earlier
chapter of zero working capital. Quick Market Intelligence (QMI), a
strategy adapted from Wal-Mart to get direct customer feedback
weekly, “employs out-of-the-box thinking and cross-functional teams
dedicated to removing obstacles to cost reduction.” The Toshibaoriginated
idea of Half Movement, another variation on the speedstretch
operating elements, envisions each product being produced
with half the parts and half the weight in half the time.
Six Sigma quality is perhaps the most famous concept Welch
228 In Managers We Trust
pioneered at GE. It means “the virtual elimination of defects from
every product, process and transaction [GE] engages in every day
around the globe.” It is not just a slogan but a measurement: It
means “fewer than 3.4 defects per million operations in a manufacturing
or service process.” That is nearly perfect quality when you
consider that average sigma quality in corporate America is around
3 or 4, at a cost of about 10 to 15% of corporate revenues, Welch
reports.
Led by experts on quality who, depending on their skill level in
Six Sigma thinking, are creatively called Master Black Belts, Black
Belts or Green Belts, the activity dissects every process to improve
key business concerns such as enhancing customer productivity and
reducing customer capital outlays while increasing the “quality,
speed and efficiency” of all GE operations.
Launched in 1995, Six Sigma quality spread “like wildfire”
throughout GE to generate substantial returns on the billion-plus
dollars invested in it. For example, Six Sigma contributed over $300
million to GE’s operating income in 1997, $750 million in 1998, and
about $2 billion in 1999, and the impact continues. Profit margins
at GE historically ran around 10%, but with Six Sigma they were
boosted to 15% to 17% and higher.
All this leads to what Welch hoped for all along: a new kind of
company that is a hybrid of typical large companies with vast resources
and typical small companies with insatiable appetites.Welch
denies that GE is a conglomerate in the usual sense of the word.
Welch’s model is very different. It calls for GE to reign only over
businesses where it is number one or number two, generate ideas
from those businesses, and spread them to the others, all in a culture
of energy, excitement, and creativity.
The learning culture created by Work-Out and boundarylessness
that fueled Six Sigma gains enabled GE to get into e-business far
more rapidly and with greater depth and breadth than pretty much
any company close to its size. GE generates billions in revenue from
its e-business, but Welch notes that the transformation it has
brought is more pervasive.
Tackling the question of why the Internet revolution began at
small start-ups rather than big resourceful companies such as GE,
Welch speculated that it was a mystery of the unknown. At GE,
however, it did not take long for people to overcome that e-fear
and digitize the entire company, a taskW elch says was way easier
than anyone at the company had ever imagined. E-business was
The Fireside CEO 229
made for GE, he says, telling us that the “E” in GE assumes a
whole new meaning in this learning culture that rides out all great
new ideas.
Leadership
Creating, implementing, and harvesting best practices from a boundaryless
culture built on speed, stretch, and simplification require
leadership. The cornerstone of successful leadership is recognizing
that people matter most in any organization. Welch repeatedly emphasizes
this characteristic, which is the essence of Work-Out, the
bedrockof best practices, and the sine qua non of superior management
teams.
Leaders must constantly be on guard. They must take reality
checks and face the results. They must avoid the pervasive temptation
to wish, hope, and temporize. Equally important, leaders must
encourage their troops to do the same. To ignite a mammoth company
like GE with the energy of a small company requires “passion,
hunger, appetite for change, customer focus, and, above all, the
speed to see reality more clearly and to act on it faster.” Doing all
this, Welch concludes, requires leaders to foster a culture in which
everything “comes backto people—their ideas, their motivation,
their passion to win.”
Effective leaders share the same values as their troops. GE’s
enormous size and diversity are bound together through common
values. These valves include excellence measured in terms of customer
satisfaction, acceptance of change as a constant force, candid
communication in all directions, and acceptance of the paradox of
managing such an organization, which is simultaneously a single
entity and a collection of many different businesses.
Driving all GE’s initiatives are what Welch calls a “a unique
brand of 21st century business leader—the GE ‘A’ player.” These are
leaders with “a vision and the ability to articulate that vision to the
team, so vividly and powerfully that it also becomes their vision.”
They embody GE’s “4Es” of leadership—Energy, Energize-ability,
Edge, and Execution. In other words they embody enormous personal
energy, the ability to energize others, “the instinct and the
courage to make tough calls decisively but with fairness and absolute
integrity,” and “the consistent ability to turn vision into results.” The
best A leaders, Welch concludes, are like the best coaches: They
insist on having only A players on the field.
230 In Managers We Trust
Welch developed a culture of creativity—one without the barnacles
of bureaucracy that retard progress—where it is possible to
blend the virtues of both large and small organizations. Boundarylessness
is a “behavior definer” that gets people together as teams
with speed and drive. Work-Out epitomizes a process designed to
generate and capture good ideas whatever their origin. This culture
and these processes characterize the type of company GE has become:
a company of action, just like its leader.
LIGHTS
The Walt Disney Company is no Mickey Mouse operation, and CEO
Mike Eisner knows it.4 Eisner has one of the most enviable jobs in
the world, but he makes it look easier than it is. Since 1984 he has
run Disney as if he himself were Walt Disney—the ultimate owner
orientation. The animation, the characters, the films, the broadcast
TV, and now publishing and bigger theme parks keep Eisner on his
toes at this multi-billion-dollar entertainment company.
In his letters to shareholders, Eisner summarizes his views on
management and strategies for growth through times of change and
economic adversity. Direct commentary on specific aspects of Disney’s
entertainment business—animation, characters, television,
Euro Disney, and the Internet—evinces qualities of trust as well as
creativity and leadership. Eisner discusses some of the special problems
a large, exquisitely public company such as Disney confronts
as a business operated in the limelight of public opinion.
The More Things Change . . .
Eisner sums up his whole philosophy of business as follows: “call
meetings about subjects that really matter—and show up.” Paralleling
the situation at Welch’s GE, the big meetings at Disney are the
“synergy meetings” that bring together the heads and top managers
of each division to share ideas so that the best of one division can
be transplanted to the others. Motivated by Disney’s general devotion
to synergy and all the participants’ desire to impress their colleagues
“with the breadth and creativity of their synergistic initiatives,”
participants prepare hard for these gatherings, with
tremendous results.
The synergy meetings reflect an overall strategy at Disney anThe
Fireside CEO 231
chored on four guiding lights. First and foremost is the goal of increasing
shareholder wealth while simultaneously discharging responsibility
to Disney’s employees and its communities in an ethical
manner. The second goal is “to increase productivity through superior
work,” emphasizing that setting “the highest standards drives the
highest results.” The third goal is to “concentrate on continuing to
lead creatively,” and the fourth is a “strategic direction of quality and
innovation.”
These anchoring qualities are necessary to exploit the opportunities
and confront the challenges posed by constant change.
“Change is the engine of growth and the muse of creativity,” Eisner
says. It’s what makes things happen in life and at Disney. Eisner
addresses technological change with special lucidity. Soothsayers
regularly announce the edge of technology as spelling doom for certain
industries, such as entertainment, in the face of advances such
as 500-channel television capability.
Eisner loves it, likening such predictions to those Walt faced
when TV first emerged and forecasters foretold the death of film.
Far from shutting down any aspects of Disney’s business, TV gave
Disney a new outlet for its products. For those who are creative and
driven, such technological and other changes mean opportunity, not
obsolescence.
Tough times must be dealt with when they come, of course, but
it is far better to deal with them before they come—in robust economic
times. Eisner thinks that way, and Disney’s business is organized
that way. Although Eisner no longer likes the term “recessionresistant”
as a description of Disney, the account he gives of its
ability and strategy to make headway in tough economic times makes
the label apt.
The roaring economic climate of the 1980s led many companies
(and individuals) down shortsighted and treacherous paths, but not
Disney. It stayed clear of overpaying for businesses; didn’t acquire
what it didn’t need; kept its balance sheet clean, strong, and financially
conservative; grew internally; preserved its franchise by nurturing
its core values; and avoided teaming up with others who could
detract from the Disney brand.
Opportunities present themselves, of course, and even a conservative
company must be ready to exploit them. The fall of communism
opened enormous new markets. Disney penetrated them
through Euro Disney and through television programming in former
Soviet bloc countries.
232 In Managers We Trust
Through adversity and opportunity, Eisner recounts how the
challenges he faces are not all that different from those Walt Disney
faced 50 or 60 years ago. The challenges listed in Disney’s annual
report of 1940 were eerily similar to its list in 1990: external world
crises such as war, studio expansion, film production expansion, foreign
currency fluctuations, and control over the cost of creative talent.
All these things remain, including, the pundits notwithstanding,
the riskof war, which is hardly expected far in advance by the investing
public.
Disney’s recession resistance comes from a combination of a
strong brand, financial conservatism, and a disciplined emphasis on
growth that concentrates mainly on internal expansion supplemented
with selective expansion through prudent acquisition. External
expansion is prudent when it is necessary to preserve access
to the means of entertainment delivery, especially to the home entertainment
environment. That often entails expansion through technological
advances, but Eisner cautions that he will not let Disney
invest in technology for its own sake.
Disney’s commitment must be to the content of the entertainment,
Eisner says, not its delivery mechanisms. He regards Marshall
McLuhan’s claim that “the medium is the message” as anachronistic,
maybe true when written but no longer the case in a world of proliferating
delivery systems—numerous broadcast networks, independent
television stations, and the advent and multiplication of home
video, satellite, and the Internet. “What has counted from the time
of Homer, Chaucer and Shakespeare to the present is the story and
the skill with which it is told, whatever the medium,” he observes.
Even so, Eisner aggressively led Disney to embrace the Internet.
Among Disney’s major assets are some of the most visited Web sites:
Disney.com for entertainment, ESPN.com for sports, and ABC.com
for news. By partnering first with Starwave, a leading technology
company, and then with Infoseek, one of the most popular Web
search engines, Disney also created the Go Network, an Internet
space that collects and offers content from all Disney units.
Magic and Mice
Eisner explains that many people in the early 1980s thought animation
was dead, a lost art. Roy Disney disagreed and proved that
when done properly, animation was magic. And as Eisner says,
“magic is the essence of Disney.” Disney’s success in renewing aniThe
Fireside CEO 233
mation was the product of a two-part strategy. First, it successfully
rereleased the great classics in old and new venues—in theaters and
then on the Disney Channel and on home video. Second, Disney
bolstered its motion picture animation organization. That effort was
a splash, producing such phenomenal productions as Who Framed
Roger Rabbit?, The Little Mermaid, Beauty and the Beast, Aladdin,
The Lion King, and Pocahantas. These efforts continued through the
1990s with Tarzan, a smash hit which weighs in as the second most
successful animated film Disney ever released.
These blockbusters tower alongside such brand-name Disney
characters as Mickey Mouse and help define Disney as a familyoriented
company. That enables it to avoid dependency on the hitor-
miss business orientation shackling many other studios. Filmmaking
is a high-risk industry: Millions can be invested in a film
with no assurance of any return. That is why most major movie
studios release a dozen or more films per year, betting that the hits
will offset the misses (a practice not unlike that of dot-com speculators
in the late 1990s and early 2000s).
Disney’s strategy for overcoming these industry conditions is to
concentrate on cost control and selectivity. Two applications follow.
First, Disney emphasizes its family-oriented brand identification.
This creates a special niche that largely liberates Disney from the
hit-or-miss strategy. Second, that emphasis also gives Disney an operating
edge in the live-action film (and television) business, allowing
successes such as Father of the Bride, The Hand That Rocks the
Cradle, and Sister Act (plus scores of others too numerous to mention,
but thinkof Toy Story, Armageddon, The Horse Whisperer, and
Good Will Hunting).
The television business is even tougher than the motion picture
business, but again, Disney leverages its animation strengths to overcome
industry challenges. The Disney Channel is a major vehicle
for animation and a major competitive advantage for Disney in the
television business, with subscriber increases generally outpacing
those at competitor channels. Even before it acquired ABC in 1995,
Disney placed numerous successful shows with the networks, including
Home Improvement, Golden Girls, and Empty Nest. It later
scored knockout points with the ABC hit Who Wants to Be a Millionaire?,
which Eisner says “transcended being a mere television
show and has entered into the culture.”
If magic is the essence of Disney, Mickey Mouse is its manifestation.
Mickey’s prominence leads Eisner to explore the intriguing
234 In Managers We Trust
question, “Which came first, Mickey Mouse or the Disney company?”
The answer is not easy. Of course the company came first as
a logical and chronological matter, but Mickey was the company’s
real launching pad. Eisner quotes Walt Disney as fondly repeating:
“Remember, this all started with a mouse.” And it continues with
that mouse, as Eisner describes how Disney pulled out all the stops
to stage a worldwide celebration of Mickey’s sixty-fifth birthday in
1992.
Among the toughest business challenges Eisner and Disney
faced in recent years was the development of Euro Disney. This ambitious
theme-park undertaking was years in the making. During
many of them, Eisner expressed high hopes and great optimism.
Then struggles ensued, delays slowed progress, and hopes were lowered.
But with tenacity bolstered by a long-term vision, Eisner and
Disney pulled through and Euro Disney opened with success. Eisner’s
candor in admitting trouble and accounting for his own errors
is a sign of trustworthiness that no investor should ignore.
Managing in the Spotlight
Euro Disney got a lot of press, but so do most activities of a company
that is a piece of American cultural history. This unyielding spotlight
poses special management problems that Eisner describes with great
understatement and felicity. Disney takes the lumps for its mistakes
but gets praise when it deserves to. Under Eisner’s stewardship Disney
regularly ranks among the best entertainment companies in the
world, one of the best-managed companies overall, and one of the
most profitable and financially stable entertainment companies. In
1991 Disney also joined the Dow, the only representative of the entertainment
industry in that barometer of American (and world) financial
health.
Eisner attributes these successes to his entire management team
as well as all Disney employees, whom he affectionately refers to as
the “cast of Disney.” The spirit Eisner conveys to the cast of this
family entertainment company resonates with civic virtue and
public-spiritedness. From generating research funding for AIDS at
the 20th Anniversary Celebration of Walt Disney World in 1991, to
furnishing financial sustenance to a downtown theater in Los Angeles
in 1997, to practicing sound environmental policies companywide,
Disney is long on public values. Disney is a major supporter
of education through an effort that dramatizes the importance of
The Fireside CEO 235
teachers in society and responded generously to the upheaval reflected
in the Los Angeles riots of 1992.
Eisner’s exorbitant stockoptions remain controversial and a
sticky issue (as was his decision to hire talent tsar Mike Ovitz, who
lasted at Disney for 14 months but cost the company several hundred
million dollars in severance payments). These options warrant careful
scrutiny in his case, as with all managers. Eisner makes no bones
about his pay level, arguing that his performance at Disney justifies
it. Whether you agree is a judgment call. Some investors could reasonably
adjust their valuation of Disney on the basis of both the
awards and Eisner’s defense of them; the question is what his account
tells you about whether you want to entrust your wealth to
him.
TRUST
The Coca-Cola Company remains one of the world’s premier corporations.
5 Three priorities guided Coke’s actions under its late
CEO, Roberto C. Goizueta: creating value, strengthening the company’s
trademarks, and focusing on the long term. These priorities
pervade and define Coke, a $150 billion operation when Goizueta
died in 1997, up from a $4 billion operation when he became CEO
a little more than a decade earlier. The lively pages of Goizueta’s
passionate and clear writings, some cowritten with his former righthand
man, Donald Keough, explain why.
Consider first a few of the benchmarks. In 1995 and 1996 Coca-
Cola led Fortune’s ranking of wealth creators. As of year end 1995
its market cap was $93 billion, an increase in shareowner wealth of
$38 billion over the prior year. As of year end 1996 that figure had
increased to $131 billion, adding another $38 billion. While in 1976
Coca-Cola was the twentieth best wealth creator among publicly
traded U.S.-based companies, by 1995 it was fourth and in 1996 it
was first.
In 1995 and 1996 the total return on Coca-Cola stockexceeded
40%, and during the preceding 15 years it produced an average compound
annual total return rate of 30% (counting reinvested dividends).
From 1980 through 1995 Coca-Cola’s share price grew at an
average annual compound rate of 24%, creating nearly $89 billion
in shareowner wealth, compared with increases of 12% in the Dow
and 11% in the S&P 500. The annualized total return from 1981
236 In Managers We Trust
through 1990, assuming reinvestment of dividends, was 37%, and
from 1986 through 1990, it was 34%.
Driving these spectacular results, Goizueta repeatedly emphasized,
was growth in unit case volume. From 1985 through 1995, unit
case volume outside North America grew at an average annual compound
rate of 8.2%, while within the United States it grew at an
average annual compound rate of 4.2% (compared with 2.7% industrywide).
In 1996 Coca-Cola set another record, with worldwide unit
case volume up 8% and selling 13.7 billion unit cases. Sales of the
Coca-Cola brand itself grew by nearly 450 million unit cases (a 6%
increase over 1995), while Sprite grew by more than 138 million unit
cases (up 13%, its third consecutive year of double-digit growth).
Owner Orientation and Long-Term Thinking
Adding fuel to this unstoppable engine was Goizueta’s business philosophy.
Goizueta saw himself as the steward of shareholder capital,
always tying Coke’s activities to shareholder values. He said that
“solid unit case volume growth is the foundation for generating economic
profit, which, experience teaches us, is the key to increasing
the value of [our shareowners’ investment].”
Under Goizueta, Coke focused on its core businesses and
adopted a long-term time horizon. Through disciplined and patient
attention to building the Coke brand for the long term, Goizueta
also created another trademarkat Coke: a company with an unquenchable
thirst for selling more product to more customers all
over the world.
Goizueta believed that “the best way to generate consistently
strong short-term results is to keep our attention riveted on the longterm.”
That long-term focus during the 1980s and 1990s meant building
step by step a “global business machine capable of sustaining
strong, profitable growth” over the decades to come.
Branding
At the foundation of that global business is the Coke brand. It “not
only has universal appeal and accessibility, but also meets the fundamental,
frequently recurring human need for refreshment.” To get
people to choose Coke to meet their daily liquid needs, building
The Fireside CEO 237
brand strength was the key. Brand strength was for Goizueta not
solely about delivering value to the marketplace, marketing research
results, or balance sheet impacts. Goizueta defined brand strength
in terms of its “ability to command a premium price in exchange for
the very real and obvious value it delivers in return.”
Managing brand strength need not be tricky, although enough
businesses have squeezed brand strength to the point where its
price-value relationship led to its rejection by the market. Coke did
not make that mistake under Goizueta’s leadership. Instead, it continually
sought to find ways to add brand strength by differentiating
the products, “making them unique and distinctive.” For many years
Coke used the AAA approach to its brand strength: availability, affordability,
and acceptability of its products. That strategy worked
well, but Goizueta moved to the next level in 1995, to the PPP approach:
pervasive penetration (rather than mere availability), priceto-
value ratios for customers (rather than mere affordability), and
preferred (to merely acceptable).
Financial Prudence
Another foundation of Coke’s enormous success was Goizueta’s
commitment to financial prudence, epitomized by his decision in
1994 to effect at Coke a “financial reformation.” Noting that Coke’s
historical financial prudence had ossified by the early 1980s—“effectively
trapping a live organism within the hard constrictions of its
own fossil shell”—and rejuvenated in the latter 1980s, Goizueta restated
that commitment.
Goizueta announced a new way of measuring Coke’s performance.
Economic profits (a version of what would later be called
economic value added), not just growth in revenues or earnings,
became the yardstick. Economic profit is “net operating profit after
taxes, less a charge for the average cost of capital employed to produce
that profit.”
Evaluating businesses with this measure led Coke to divest some
poorly performing operations and renewed the focus on the core
business of soft drinkconcentrate (with some holdings in bottlers
complemented by an economically profitable foods business).
Coke used debt sparingly to enhance shareholder returns and
effected share repurchases to enhance earnings per share. It lowered
its dividend payout ratio while increasing the annual dividend to free
238 In Managers We Trust
up cash for reinvestment at low cost. It reinvested those and other
funds to expand its global bottling networkto erect an extensive and
efficient business system. All this Goizueta explained with great clarity
to his fellow shareholders.
Infrastructure Fortification
Part of that investment helped finance improvements in its bottlers’
processing and distribution systems. Not only did those investments
bolster current and future product sales (and strengthen the Cokebottler
partnership), Coke could subsequently sell its interest in the
investment at an additional profit for its shareholders.
Goizueta called Coke’s investment in and development of an extensive
and efficient bottling and distribution system “infrastructure
fortification.” It entailed continued and deeper investments in the
system that bottles and distributes Coca-Cola products. A variety of
means were used to fortify the system, from encouraging bottlers to
reinvest to investing equity directly and supplying managerial expertise.
Through these practices, Coke expanded around the globe to
nearly two-hundred countries to create billions of new potential customers.
Between 1980 and 1994 the number of potential Coke customers
more than doubled. With sales volume growth as the key to
sustaining value growth, this shows why Coke’s average return on
capital was over triple the approximate cost of that capital.
Adding strength to Coke’s focus on the core brands in its global
business system was geographic diversification. Coke enjoys a
strong—maybe dominant—position in blue chip markets such as the
United States, Germany, and Japan. It is committed to dominating
new worlds of opportunity such as eastern Europe and Indonesia.
Add to that the “start-up” markets of China and India and you have
overall diversity through which to “use existing strengths to create
future strengths.” (That fortification is one of the reasons Coke prevailed
against the adversity of the Asian financial crisis of 1998.)
Resource Allocation
In Coke’s global business environment, Goizueta said, his primary
challenge was to optimally allocate resources generated in developed
markets to invest in less developed ones. The greatest growth potential
for Coke in the world, Goizueta told a group of students in 1995,
The Fireside CEO 239
was in southern California! Coke sold more cans and bottles of Coke
per capita in Hungary than in southern California, making the latter
the more “emerging” of the two markets.
Financial reformation, infrastructure fortification, and geographic
expansion were meant to create the “best machine possible.”
A complementary initiative would “equip that machine with a
uniquely powerful growth engine.” This was the consumer marketing
effort designed to drive world demand for the brand. It called for
Coke to market its products as distinctive—“different, better and
special”—relentlessly deepening brand power.
Goizueta ignored the varied views from the sidelines that ranged
from those who said Coke already was a premier consumer marketing
outfit and could do no more to those who said there were plenty
of other great companies that hold that title. Noting that the average
human body needs at least 64 ounces of liquid daily to survive, Goizueta
saw Coke as having a huge window of opportunity.
Goizueta sought to promote the brand everywhere in the world,
driving dramatic growth in already developed markets such as the
United States, Japan, and Europe. To deepen brand strength vertically—
that is, in existing strong markets as compared to horizontal
building in new ones—required exploiting Goizueta’s commitment
to product differentiation. Goizueta said that if the keys to selling
real estate are location, location, location, the “keys to selling consumer
products are differentiation, differentiation, differentiation.”
Many were astonished in 1996 when Coke did what they thought
was impossible: It surpassed the combined consumption of the two
leading teas in the United Kingdom and that of the leading bottled
water in France!
Learning Culture
These insights guided Coke instinctively for years. Goizueta set them
out in writing as part of an effort to create throughout the company
a “learning culture” in which these principles were institutionalized.
Like GE’s Welch, he sought to learn from every participant in Coke’s
business: consumers, customers, partners, competitors, and even unrelated
organizations. For example, another reality at Goizueta’s
Coke was his team’s ability to find opportunities others could not
see. His people search the world not to see where Coke already is
but to see where it is not.
Goizueta helped create another extraordinary reality: Coca-Cola
240 In Managers We Trust
adds value “to everyone who touches it.” Shareholders, bottlers,
Coke’s customers, and end consumers all benefit from Coke. Goizueta
emphasized particularly Coke’s relationships with its bottlers.
Throughout the world, a once-fragmented group of bottlers increasingly
consolidated on a country-by-country basis—in Japan, Germany,
and elsewhere—to gain substantial competitive advantages. As
for the customers, many restaurants must sell three hamburgers to
make the same profit they make from selling a large Coke. Coke
went out of its way to let its customers know this.
Conquering Economic Adversity
Concentrating on the long term by emphasizing short-term prudence
is how Coke and Goizueta conquered the economic adversity of the
early 1990s. Coke deployed its resources amid global economic malaise
to cope with the slowdown through strategic pricing and cost
controls. It deployed those resources to capitalize on those conditions
by making flexible marketing investments. In this two-front
campaign Goizueta never wavered from his conviction, shared by
Keough and Coke’s other top managers, that a hybrid perspective is
optimal: What distinguished Coke was its simultaneous “constancy
of purpose” and its “continuous discontentment with the immediate
present.”
That hybrid perspective was doubly valuable in facing adversity
and proved the adage that tough times make the strong stronger.
The aggressive investment in the long-term growth and value of the
business, in good times as well as in bad, is what’s behind Fortune
magazine’s regular ranking of Coke as one of the most admired companies
in America, especially for its long-term investment value.
Goizueta’s long-term orientation gave succor in bad times, as did
his unwillingness to waste energy on forecasting the economic future.
It is not possible to control external events such as “global
economic trends, currency fluctuations and devaluations, natural
disasters, political upheavals, social unrest, bad weather or schizophrenic
stockmark ets,” but Goizueta notes that he and every other
manager has complete control over his or her own behavior.
Managers cannot allow themselves to be distracted by the external
environment. What they can and should do is focus the management
team on what it can control: resource deployment to build
a foundation for future growth, whatever the current economic climate.
The future, in those terms, is in no way preordained but inThe
Fireside CEO 241
stead is “an infinite series of openings, of possibilities.” He emphasized
that what uncertainty calls for, especially in difficult economic
environments, is what the Greeks called practical intelligence. This
world view “forces adaptability and teaches constant preparedness.”
Pragmatism
Practical intelligence also “acknowledges that nothing quite succeeds
as planned” and that what is crucial is “pragmatic adaptability”
to what is new. And new always comes—change is inevitable. The
sharp business focus at Coke is what best prepared the company to
meet change. Indeed, as Goizueta suggested, few large companies
are as focused as Coke or as “tightly riveted” to a particular business
as Coke is to soft drinks.
Animating Goizueta’s letters was an overarching dominant
theme: The company’s shareholders own it. All other themes—building
brand strength through the AAAs or PPPs, differentiating the
brand as special and better, fiscal prudence, and focus—serve the
ultimate principle that the investors are the owners.
Success at Coke, Goizueta emphasized to all the troops, was
“creating value for the people who have entrusted their assets to us.”
That is the reason why the company (and any other business) exists.
All the other social benefits Coke or any other company generates
by “serving customers and consumers, creating jobs, positively impacting
society, supporting communities—happen only as long as we
fulfill our mission of creating value for [shareholders],” Goizueta
said.
Shortly before his death Goizueta quoted for his management
team the words of the German poet and playwright Goethe: “Whatever
you can do or dream you can, begin it. Boldness has genius,
power and magic in it. Begin it now.”
Goizueta believed that boldness sustains growth. He expressed
gratitude to all the participants in the Coke venture—associates,
customers, bottling partners, board members, and most of all, he
said, his fellow shareowners—for their trust and confidence in his
team’s ability to create value.
Well-earned trust indeed, and indispensable when markets, numbers,
and governance tell only part of the story in business analysis.
This page intentionally left blank.
243
CONCLUSION:
THE V CULTURE
Readers with an arbitrage orientation may regret that the exemplars
of great modern CEOs covered in the last chapter, apart
from Warren Buffett, consist of one who is dead, one who has announced
his retirement, and only one who is likely to reign for the
foreseeable future. Who’s next, and why not name them?
If I knew, I would not say. Not so much because I want to gain
a competitive edge. No, my reticence is precisely because of an insight
in this book: Judgment is the key, and my judgment will invariably
differ from yours. Our circles of competence are necessarily
different. Our interpretation of the past differs, and our prognosis
for the future must as well. It contradicts the whole point of this
bookfor me to tell you who I believe are the up-and-coming star
CEOs. My picks are irrelevant to your judgments.
Go backto the masters mentioned in Chapter 1 and you’ll see
that it was precisely their independence of thought, their utter and
profound common sense, which led to their remarkable success. I
condense these ideas and insights in the spirit of a teacher and professor,
not an investment adviser. I hope you’ll use these pages as a
foundation for picking stocks as a savvy, sophisticated investor (or,
failing that, picking advisers who share respect for the basic philosophy
of outstanding investors such as Graham and Buffett).
The basic philosophy of business analysis investing integrates
three branches: finance, accounting, and governance. Finance is
commonly defined as “the science of management of money and
other assets.” So much for this definition, if you agree that finance
is one part science and the other part art. Behavioral economics, a
field that draws on numerous disciplines, including psychology, statistics,
history, and sociology, may deserve to be called a social sci-
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
244 In Managers We Trust
ence. Its approach to finance is the most promising, for it recognizes
the first branch of intelligent investing: Graham’s foundational insight
that price and value are different things.
The meaning and measure of value are the second branch, pursuits
requiring a grasp of basic ideas from the world of accounting.
Accounting has long been known as the language of business, and
the discretion managers have in applying accounting principles requires
intelligent investors to become translators of that language.
When that discretion is abused, it is safer to side with those who
declare accounting a state of mind rather than an art or science.
Fluency in accounting gives you a huge investment edge, and even
conversational accounting will put you at the top of the investing
class.
Since market prices and accounting numbers are both fragile
grounds for firm and final investment decisions, the third branch is
managerial trustworthiness. Formal and overly general governance
principles don’t help very much here. What you need are people you
are happy to entrust your wealth with. Identifying them is all art.
In the stockmark et forest, lookfor these three branches. They
enable you to steer away from the Q culture and thrive in the V
culture, a value-oriented investing culture nurtured by Graham and
Buffett.
245
NOTES
Chapter 1
1. Benjamin Graham, The Intelligent Investor (1st ed. 1949; 4th rev. ed. Harper &
Row, 1973), 108.
2. Fred Schwed, Jr., Where Are the Customers’ Yachts? (1st ed. 1940; rev. ed. John
Wiley & Sons, 1995), 6–7.
3. The New York Stock Exchange Fact Book (New York, 1999), http://
www.nyse.com; Gretchen Morgenson, “Investing’s Longtime Best Bet Is Being
Trampled by the Bulls,” The New York Times, January 15, 2000.
4. Report of the Presidential TaskF orce on Market Mechanisms (the Brady Report),
1988.
5. Greg Ip, “Market on a High Wire,” The Wall Street Journal, January 18, 2000.
6. Burton G. Malkiel, A Random Walk Down Wall Street (1st ed. 1973; 7th rev.
ed. W. W. Norton, 1999), 57–61.
7. Warren E. Buffett and Lawrence A. Cunningham, The Essays of Warren Buffett:
Lessons for Corporate America (The Cunningham Group, 1997), 72.
8. Robert J. Shiller, Irrational Exuberance (Princeton University Press, 2000), 118–
132, catalogs and evaluates the 25 top bursts and busts on global stockexchanges
during one- and five-year periods from the 1960s through the 1990s.
9. Joseph de la Vega, Confusio´n de Confusiones (1st ed. 1688; rev. ed. John Wiley
& Sons, 1996), 159–165 (the selected quotation condenses original material
without indicating omissions).
10. Malkiel, Random Walk, 185.
11. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 63, 84. The price per share was $5.63, aggregating
$100 million, compared to a value of $400 to $500 million.
12. Graham, Intelligent Investor, 289 (footnote omitted).
Chapter 2
1. For additional analysis and sources, consult Lawrence A. Cunningham, “From
Random Walks to Chaotic Crashes: The Linear Genealogy of the Efficient
Capital Market Hypothesis,” The George Washington University Law Review,
vol. 62 (1994), on which this chapter is based.
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
246 Notes
2. Louis Bachelier, “Theory of Speculation,” reprinted in The Random Character
of Stock Market Prices, Paul H. Cootner, ed. (rev. ed. MIT Press, 1964).
3. Eugene F. Fama, “The Behavior of StockMark et Prices,” Journal of Business,
vol. 38 (1965).
4. Sidney S. Alexander, “Price Movements in Speculative Markets: Trends or Random
Walks?” Industry Management Review, May 1961.
5. Benjamin Graham, The Intelligent Investor (1st ed. 1949; 4th rev. ed. Harper &
Row, 1973), 133.
6. Paul A. Samuelson, “Proof That Properly Anticipated Prices Fluctuate Randomly,”
Industry Management Review, Spring 1965.
7. Milton Friedman, “The Methodology of Positive Economics,” in Essays in Positive
Economics (University of Chicago Press, 1953).
8. Andrew Lo and A. Craig MacKinlay, A Non-Random Walk Down Wall Street
(Princeton University Press, 1999).
9. Eugene A. Fama, “Efficient Capital Markets: II,” Journal of Finance, vol. 46
(1991).
10. James Tobin, “On the Efficiency of the Financial System,” Lloyds Bank Review,
July 1984.
11. William F. Sharpe, Portfolio Theory and Capital Markets (McGraw-Hill, 1970);
Kenneth J. Arrow, “RiskP erception in Psychology and Economics,” Economic
Inquiry, vol. 20 (1982).
12. Lawrence H. Summers, “Does the StockMark et Rationally Reflect Fundamental
Values?” Journal of Finance, vol. 41 (1986).
13. Fischer Black, “Noise,” Journal of Finance, vol. 41 (1986).
14. Andrei Shleifer, Inefficient Markets: An Introduction to Behavioral Finance (Oxford
University Press, 2000).
15. Harry M. Markowitz, Portfolio Diversification: Efficient Diversification of Investments
(John Wiley & Sons, 1959).
16. Sharpe, Portfolio Theory and Capital Markets.
17. Andrei Shleifer, “Do Demand Curves for Stocks Slope Down?” Journal of Finance,
vol. 41 (1986).
18. Francis Fukuyama, Trust: The Social Virtues and the Creation of Prosperity (Free
Press, 1995).
19. Graham, Intelligent Investor, 61, n. 2.
20. Lawrence A. Cunningham, ed., “Conversations from the Buffett Symposium,”
Cardozo Law Review, vol. 19 (Sept.–Nov. 1997), 812.
Chapter 3
1. For additional analysis and sources, consult Lawrence A. Cunningham, “From
Random Walks to Chaotic Crashes: The Linear Genealogy of the Efficient
Capital Market Hypothesis,” The George Washington University Law Review,
vol. 62 (1994), on which this chapter is based.
Notes 247
2. H. E. Hurst, “Long-Term Storage Capacities of Reservoirs,” Transactions of the
American Society of Civil Engineers, vol. 116 (1951).
3. Edgar E. Peters, Chaos and Order in the Capital Markets (John Wiley & Sons,
1991); Edgar E. Peters, Fractal Market Analysis: Applying Chaos Theory to Investment
and Economics (John Wiley & Sons, 1994).
4. Henri Poincare´ , Science and Method (1st ed. 1908; rev. ed. Dover Press, 1952).
5. Edward Lorenz, “Deterministic Nonperiodic Flow,” Journal of Atmospheric Sciences,
vol. 20 (1963); Edward Lorenz, Nonlinear Dynamical Economics and
Chaotic Motion (Springer-Verlag, 1989).
6. Alan Wolf, “Chaos in the Stadium,” Algorithm, April 1992.
7. These figures were prepared by Alan Wolf.
8. Alan Wolf, et al., “Determining Lyapunov Exponents from Time Series,” Physica,
vol. 16D (1985).
9. Benoit B. Mandelbrot, The Fractal Geometry of Nature (W. H. Freeman, 1988);
Benoit B. Mandelbrot, ed., Fractals and Scaling in Finance: Discontinuity, Concentration,
Risk (Springer-Verlag, 1997).
10. Andrei Shleifer, Inefficient Markets: An Introduction to Behavioral Finance (Oxford
University Press, 2000), 121–22.
11. John Y. Campbell and Robert J. Shiller, “The Dividend-Price Ratio and Expectations
of Future Dividends and Discount Factors,” Review of Financial Studies,
vol. 1 (1998); John Y. Campbell and John Ammer, “What Moves Stockand Bond
Markets: A Variance Decomposition for Long-Term Asset Returns,” Journal of
Finance, vol. 48 (1993).
12. Warren E. Buffett and Lawrence A. Cunningham, The Essays of Warren Buffett:
Lessons for Corporate America (The Cunningham Group, 1997), 72.
13. Warren E. Buffett, “The Superinvestors of Graham and Doddsville,” Hermes
(Columbia Business School), Fall 1984.
14. Benjamin Graham, The Intelligent Investor (1st. ed. 1949; rev. ed Harper & Row,
1973), 36–37.
15. Ibid.
Chapter 4
1. Alex Berenson, “On Hair-Trigger Wall Street, A StockPlunges on Fake News,”
The New York Times, August 26, 2000.
2. Susan E. Hurd and Jonathan M.Winer, “On-Line Securities Fraud Under Scrutiny,”
The New York Law Journal, February 22, 2000.
3. Professor Howard M. Friedman of the University of Toledo Law School furnished
testimony providing some of these examples before the Permanent Investigations
Subcommittee of the Senate Governmental Affairs Committee on
March 22, 1999.
4. SEC v. Francis Tribble &Sloane Fitzgerald, SEC Litigation Release No. 15959,
October 27, 1998.
248 Notes
5. SEC v. Remington-Hall Capital Corp. &Douglas T. Fonteno, SEC Litigation
Release No. 15943, October 22, 1998.
6. Alex Berenson, “Two Accused of Using E-Mail to Commit StockF raud,” The
New York Times, February 25, 2000.
7. Jeffrey Keegan, “Regulators Step Up Fight against Internet Fraud,” Investment
Dealers Digest, August 7, 1998.
8. Philip L. Carret, The Art of Speculation (1st ed. 1930; rev. ed. Fraser, 1984).
9. Edwin LeFe`vre, Reminiscences of a Stock Operator (1st ed. 1923; rev. ed. John
Wiley & Sons, 1994).
10. Benjamin Graham, The Intelligent Investor (1st ed. 1949; 4th rev. ed. Harper &
Row, 1973), 142.
11. Leslie Eaton, “Internet Investing: Spotlight on Risk,” International Herald Tribune,
December 6, 1996.
12. SEC v. Aziz-Golshani, No. 99–13139 (CBM) (Federal Central District of California,
December 15, 1999); Rebecca Buckman and Michael Schroeder, “Web
Postings Draw Charges of StockF raud,” The Wall Street Journal, December 16,
1999; Gretchen Morgenson, “Internet’s Role Is Implicated in StockF raud,” The
New York Times, December 16, 1999.
13. SEC Litigation Release No. 16399 (January 5, 2000) (reporting on SEC v. Yun
Soo Oh Park, Federal Northern District of Illinois, Case No. 00C 0049); Jennifer
Friedlin, “The SEC Files Civil Fraud Charges against Tokyo Joe,” The-
Street.com & NYTimes.com, January 2000; John C. Coffee, Jr., “Tokyo Joe and
the First Amendment,” The New York Law Journal, January 20, 2000.
14. “Net Damage: PairGain Hoax Revealed,” Investor Relations Business, April 26,
1999; Associated Press, “PairGain Worker Sentenced in Fraud Case,” The New
York Times, August 31, 1999.
15. Alex Berenson, “S.E.C. Reaches Settlement in Web-Based ‘Pump and Dump’
Case,” The New York Times, March 3, 2000; Michael Schroeder, “Georgetown
Students Draw Web Investors—and an SEC Bust,” The Wall Street Journal,
March 3, 2000.
16. William M. Bulkeley, “Presstek Suit Alleges Short Sellers Posted False Statements
On-Line,” The Wall Street Journal, September 18, 1997.
17. Gretchen Morgenson, “S.E.C. Says Teenager Had After-School Hobby: Online
StockF raud,” The New York Times, September 21, 2000.
18. Lawrence Harris, “Volatility, Portfolio Insurance, and the Role of Specialists
and Market Makers,” Cornell Law Review, vol. 74 (1989), provided part of the
foundation for the following discussion.
19. Michael Schroeder and Randall Smith, “Sweeping Changes in Market Structure
Sought: Major Firms Propose Central Order System and Single Regulator,”
The Wall Street Journal, February 29, 2000; Alex Berenson, “Top Wall St. Executives
Urge Trading Overhaul,” The New York Times, March 1, 2000.
20. Michael Schroeder, “NASD, NYSE Discussed Merging to Keep Up With Market
Changes,” The Wall Street Journal, March 3, 2000; Greg Ip and Randall
Notes 249
Smith, “Instinet, DatekRecently Held Merger Talks,” The Wall Street Journal,
March 3, 2000.
21. Thomas Kalinke, “Sleepless in New York: Evening Hours at the Exchange,”
Financial History, vol. 69 (Spring 2000).
22. Rebecca Buckman, “Heavy Losses: The Rise and Collapse of a Day Trader,”
The Wall Street Journal, February 28, 2000.
23. Senate Governmental Affairs Committee, Permanent Subcommittee on Investigations,
February 25, 2000; Bloomberg News, “Day Trading’s Risks and Pressures
Are Described to a Senate Panel,” The New York Times, February 25,
2000.
24. Gerald M. Loeb, The Battle for Investment Survival (1st ed. 1935; rev. ed. John
Wiley & Sons, 1996).
25. Warren E. Buffett and Lawrence A. Cunningham, The Essays of Warren Buffet:
Lessons for Corporate America (The Cunningham Group, 1997), 90.
26. Edward Wyatt, “Day Traders Are Formidable Market Force,” The New York
Times, April 14, 1999.
27. The Charles Schwab Corporation, 1999 Annual Report, 41–42; PatrickMc-
Geehan, “Profit Up at Citigroup, Merrill and Schwab,” The New York Times,
April 18, 2000.
28. PatrickMcGeehan, “The Unmutual Fund,” The New York Times, May 18, 2000.
Chapter 5
1. Benjamin Graham, The Intelligent Investor (1st ed. 1949; 4th rev. ed. Harper &
Row, 1973), 110.
2. Warren E. Buffett and Lawrence A. Cunningham, The Essays of Warren Buffett:
Lessons for Corporate America (The Cunningham Group, 1997), 120, 122, 134.
3. Ibid., 110.
4. John C. Bogle, Common Sense on Mutual Funds (John Wiley & Sons, 1999).
5. Gerald M. Loeb, The Battle for Investment Survival (1st ed. 1935; rev. ed. John
Wiley & Sons, 1996).
6. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 79; Graham, Intelligent Investor, 54, 282–
283.
7. Gretchen Morgenson, “Buying on Margin Becomes a Habit,” The New York
Times, March 24, 2000.
8. Gretchen Morgenson, “Stock-Trading Cheerleader Now Faces $45 Million
Debt,” The New York Times, April 19, 2000.
9. NickLeeson, Rogue Trader (Warner, 1997).
10. Graham, Intelligent Investor, 228–231.
11. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 57.
12. Charles T. Munger, “A Lesson on Elementary, Worldly Wisdom As It Relates
to Investment Management and Business,” Outstanding Investor Digest, vol. X
(May 5, 1995).
250 Notes
13. Edwin LeFe`vre, Reminiscences of a Stock Operator (1st ed. 1923; rev. ed. John
Wiley & Sons, 1994).
14. Graham, Intelligent Investor, 245.
15. Ibid., 124–125
16. Bill Spindle, “Been There? Euphoric ’80s in Japan Ended in Long Slide,” The
Wall Street Journal, January 18, 2000.
17. Steve Liesman and Jacob M. Schlesinger, “Blunted Spike: The Price of Oil Has
Doubled This Year; So, Where’s the Recession?” The Wall Street Journal, December
15, 1999; Joseph Kahn, “Surge in Oil Prices Is Raising Specter of Inflation
Spike,” The New York Times, February 21, 2000.
18. Graham, Intelligent Investor, 162.
19. Gretchen Morgenson, “Investing’s Longtime Best Bet Is Being Trampled by the
Bulls,” The New York Times, January 15, 2000.
Chapter 6
1. Donald Schwartz, late professor at the Georgetown University Law Center,
prepared the original version of this parable, rewritten for publication here and
previously appearing in others forms in Lawrence A. Cunningham, Introductory
Accounting and Finance for Lawyers (West Group 2d ed., 1999) and Lewis D.
Solomon, et al., Corporations Law and Policy (West Group 4th ed., 1998).
2. Carol Loomis, “Mr. Buffett on the StockMark et,” Fortune, November 22, 1999.
3. Charles T. Munger, author of “A Lesson on Elementary, Worldly Wisdom As It
Relates to Investment Management and Business,” Outstanding Investor Digest,
vol. X (May 5, 1995), furnished this example.
4. Warren E. Buffett and Lawrence A. Cunningham, The Essays of Warren Buffett:
Lessons for Corporate America (The Cunningham Group, 1997), 71.
Chapter 7
1. Benjamin Graham, The Intelligent Investor (1st ed. 1949; 4th rev. ed. Harper &
Row, 1973), 63.
2. Warren E. Buffett and Lawrence A. Cunningham, The Essays of Warren Buffett:
Lessons for Corporate America (The Cunningham Group, 1997), 92–93.
3. Benjamin Graham, The Interpretation of Financial Statements (1st ed. 1937; rev.
ed. Harper Business, 1998), 77.
4. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 208.
5. Ibid., 91–92.
6. Adrian J. Slywotzky and David J. Morrison, authors of Profit Patterns (Times
Business, 1999), identify and discuss the patterns described in the accompanying
text.
7. Bill Miller, “Amazon.com’s Allure,” Barron’s, November 15, 1999.
8. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 96–97.
Notes 251
9. Graham, Intelligent Investor, 286.
10. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 99.
11. The psychology literature calls the resistance bias a “principle of conservatism”
and the pattern-seeking bias a “representativeness heuristic.” Both labels seem
not only unwieldy but imprecise when adapted for thinking about investor behavior.
Nevertheless, investment theorists cling to these terms in arguing that
these cognitive biases play a role in explaining market inefficiencies. For an
example, consider Andrei Shleifer, Inefficient Markets: An Introduction to Behavioral
Finance (Oxford University Press, 2000).
12. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 87.
13. Ibid., 53.
Chapter 8
1. Leopold A. Bernstein and John J. Wild, Analysis of Financial Statements (5th
ed. McGraw-Hill, 2000), 102–03.
2. Benjamin Graham, The Interpretation of Financial Statements (1st ed. 1937; rev.
ed. Harper Business, 1998), 32.
3. For more, consult ibid. or Lawrence A. Cunningham, Introductory Accounting
and Finance for Lawyers (2nd ed. West Group, 1999), on which this and the
next chapter draw (the title is intended to show that it is for the nonaccountant;
it is not exclusively for lawyers).
Chapter 9
1. Benjamin Graham, The Intelligent Investor (1st ed. 1949; 4th rev. ed. Harper &
Row, 1973), 277.
2. Warren E. Buffett and Lawrence A. Cunningham, The Essays of Warren Buffett:
Lessons for Corporate America (The Cunningham Group, 1997), 101. Note also
Subrata N. Chakravarty, “Three Little Words,” Forbes, April 6, 1998.
3. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 187.
4. The per share figures throughout this chapter do not take into account any
stocksplits occurring in 2000 or beyond.
5. Graham, Intelligent Investor, 14–15.
6. Michael Metz and David Kerdell, “Graham and Dodd Revisited,” Portfolio Strategy
(CIBC Oppenheimer, December 11, 1998).
7. Benjamin Graham, The Interpretation of Financial Statements (1st ed. 1937; rev.
ed. Harper Business, 1998), 15, 23.
8. Ibid., 49.
9. Ibid., 48–49.
10. Philip L. Carret, The Art of Speculation (1st ed. 1930; rev. ed. Fraser, 1984).
11. Graham, Intelligent Investor, 277–282.
252 Notes
12. John Burr Williams, The Theory of Investment Value (1st ed. 1938; rev. ed. Fraser,
1997).
13. Robert Shiller, Irrational Exuberance (Princeton University Press, 2000) (noting
the studies referred to and reporting on others done directly that show
slightly lower expected returns), 52–55; Graham, Intelligent Investor, 122.
14. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 85.
15. Stern Stewart, the firm that trademarked the term “economic value added,”
publishes volumes of material on the concept, including G. Bennett Stewart
III, “EVA : Fact and Fantasy,” Journal of Applied Corporate Finance, vol. 7
(1994).
16. The Coca-Cola Company defines “economic value added” in a glossary in its
annual report as year-to-year growth in after-tax operating income in excess of
a varying estimated charge for average operating capital employed.
17. Graham, Interpretation, 75–76.
Chapter 10
1. David Burgstahler and Ilia Dichev, “Earnings Management to Avoid Earnings
Decreases and Losses,” Journal of Accounting and Economics, vol. 24 (1997).
2. Michael Schroeder, “SEC to Adopt Disclosure Rules for Companies,” The Wall
Street Journal, December 16, 1999.
3. New York Stock Exchange Listed Company Manual, Section 303.01, Audit Committees
(available from http://www.nyse.com/listed). Big accounting firms used
these rules and recommendations to formulate statements of audit committee
standards. For example, see PriceWaterhouseCoopers, Audit Committees: Best
Practices for Protecting Shareholder Interests (1999); KMPG, Shaping the Audit
Committee Agenda (1999).
4. Graham’s lampooning appears in Warren E. Buffett and Lawrence A. Cunningham,
The Essays of Warren Buffett: Lessons For Corporate America (The
Cunningham Group, 1997), 159–65. Briloff’s workincludes More Debits Than
Credits (Harper & Row, 1976) and Unaccountable Accounting (Harper & Row,
1972).
5. Some of these charade discussions are adapted from Lawrence A. Cunningham,
Introductory Accounting and Finance for Lawyers (2nd ed. West Group, 1999).
6. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 193.
7. Benjamin Graham, The Intelligent Investor (1st ed. 1949; 4th rev. ed. Harper &
Row, 1973), 167.
Chapter 11
1. Benjamin Graham, The Intelligent Investor (1st ed. 1949; 4th rev. ed. Harper &
Row, 1973), 155.
2. Ibid., 286.
3. Warren E. Buffett and Lawrence A. Cunningham, The Essays of Warren Buffett:
Notes 253
Lessons for Corporate America (The Cunningham Group, 1997), 147.
4. For additional analysis and sources, consult Lawrence A. Cunningham, “Commonalities
and Prescriptions in the Vertical Dimension of Global Corporate
Governance,” Cornell Law Review, vol. 84 (1999), on which this and the following
chapters draw.
5. Graham, Intelligent Investor, 270.
6. AMP, Inc. v. Allied-Signal, Inc., 1998 US District LEXIS 15617 (Federal Eastern
District of Pennsylvania, October 8, 1998), reversed on other grounds by the
Federal Third Circuit Court of Appeals, 168 Federal Reporter 3d 649 (January
20, 1999).
7. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 47.
Chapter 12
1. Warren E. Buffett and Lawrence A. Cunningham, The Essays of Warren Buffett:
Lessons for Corporate America (The Cunningham Group, 1997), 138.
2. Ibid., 86–87, 96.
3. Roberta Romano, “Corporate Law and Corporate Governance,” Industrial and
Corporate Change, vol. 5 (1996); Sanjai Bhagat and Bernard Black, “The Uncertain
Relationship between Board Composition and Firm Performance,” Business
Lawyer, vol. 54 (1999).
4. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 40.
5. James A. Brickley, Jeffrey L. Coles, and Gregg Jarrell, “Leadership Structure:
Separating the CEO and Chairman of the Board,” Journal of Corporate Finance,
vol. 3 (1997).
6. Ira M. Millstein and Paul W. MacAvoy, “The Active Board of Directors and
Performance of the Large Publicly Traded Corporation,” Columbia University
Law Review, vol. 98 (1998).
7. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 47–54.
8. Investors Responsibility Research Center (press release), “Investors, CEOs,
Split on Best Governance Practices for Dot-Com Companies,” January 26,
2000.
9. SEC Rule 14a-8 under the Federal Securities Exchange Act of 1934.
10. Benjamin Graham, The Memoirs of the Dean ofWall Street (McGraw-Hill, 1996;
posthumous publication, Seymour Chatman, ed.), 201–212. The company was
Northern Pipeline, and the year was 1928 (Graham was 34 years old). Ibid.,
320.
11. Benjamin Graham, The Intelligent Investor (1st ed. 1949; 4th rev. ed. Harper
and Row, 1973), 270.
Chapter 13
1. Joseph Kahn, “AMP Rejects Allied Signal’s Takeover Bid of $10 Billion,” The
New York Times, August 22, 1998.
254 Notes
2. John A. Byrnes, “The Blame When the Boss Fails,” Business Week, December
27, 1999.
3. Consult Kevin Murphy, “Corporate Performance and Managerial Remuneration:
An Empirical Analysis,” Journal of Accounting and Economics, vol. 7
(1985), and Hamid Mehran, “Executive Compensation Structure, Ownership,
and Firm Performance,” Journal of Financial Economics, vol. 38 (1995).
4. Ben & Jerry’s Homemade, Inc., 1992 Annual Report (5:1 ratio raised in 1990 to
7:1); Ben & Jerry’s Homemade, Inc., 1998 Annual Report (16:1 ratio at its “historical
high” and would be higher if “the present value of unexercised stock
options were included”).
5. Lee Gomes, “McAfee.com to Make Long-Awaited IPO,” The Wall Street Journal,
December 2, 1999.
6. Haig Simonian and Nikki Tait, “U.S. Executives Earn Much More,” The Financial
Times (London), August 3, 1998.
7. Warren E. Buffett and Lawrence A. Cunningham, The Essays of Warren Buffett:
Lessons for Corporate America (The Cunningham Group, 1997), 54–55.
8. “Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation,” Statement of Financial Accounting
Standards No. 123 (Financial Accounting Standards Board, 1995).
9. Gretchen Morgenson, “Investors May Now Eye Costs of StockOptions,” The
New York Times, August 29, 2000 (reporting studies performed by Pat Mc-
Connell of Bear Stearns); Manitou Investment Management Ltd., The Long
View: The Amazing Stock Option Bubble (October 1999) (reporting studies performed
by the British research firm Smithers and the U.S. investment banking
firm Sanford Bernstein).
10. David Leonhardt, “In the Options Age, Rising Pay (and Risk): Will Today’s
Huge Rewards Devour Tomorrow’s Earnings?” The New York Times, April 2,
2000.
11. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 58.
12. Reuters, “Study Says Mergers Often Don’t Aid Investors,” The New York Times,
December 1, 1999.
13. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 143.
14. Mattell, Inc., SEC Form 8-K (filed July 22, 1999).
15. Mattell, Inc., SEC Form 8-K (filed October 22, 1999).
16. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 123–127.
17. Beginning in 1999, the author helped direct a project on firm structures for the
Independence Standards Board, and his views expressed here do not necessarily
represent those of that project or of the board.
18. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 168.
Chapter 14
1. David Gladstone, Venture Capital Handbook (Prentice-Hall, 1988), 101–104.
2. Warren E. Buffett and Lawrence A. Cunningham, The Essays of Warren
Buffett: Lessons for Corporate America (The Cunningham Group, 1997), 36
Notes 255
(this is one of Berkshire Hathaway’s famous “Owner Related Business Principles”).
3. This discussion draws on the annual letters of John F. (Jack) Welch to General
Electric Co. shareholders from 1985 through 2000. Some of them were coauthored
with other GE executives.
4. This discussion draws on the annual letters of Michael D. (Mike) Eisner to
Walt Disney Co. shareholders from 1988 through 2000.
5. This discussion draws on the annual letters of Roberto C. Goizueta to Coca-
Cola Co. shareholders from 1985 through 1996, plus an article enclosed with
one of them by Mr. Goizveta called “The Emerging Post-Conglomerate Era:
Changing the Shape of Corporate America,” Leaders, April–June 1989.
This page intentionally left blank.
257
COMPANY INDEX
AdirondackT rading Partners, 187
Alabama National, 106
AlliedSignal, 179–180, 205–206, 214, 223
Amazon.com, 115–116, 120–122, 124–128, 130–
131, 133–136, 139, 141–142, 147–148, 217
America Online (AOL), 55–56, 164
American Broadcasting Corporation (ABC),
114, 214, 232, 233
American Home Products, 106
American Institute of Certified Public Accountants
(AICPA), 155–156
American Standard, 227
Amoco, 185
AMP, 179–180, 205–206, 214
Anheuser-Busch, 106, 194
Applied Materials, 105
AT&T, 106, 177
Bang & Olufsen, 108
Bankof Boston, 163
Bankers Trust, 185
Banque Nationale de Paris, 185
Barings, 79–80
Barnes & Noble, 109, 113, 130
Ben & Jerry’s, 177, 207–208
Berkshire Hathaway, 11, 12–13, 14, 55, 71, 117,
150, 201, 217, 222
Bertelsmann, 185
BlackHills, 106
Bloomberg News, 53, 57
BMW, 106
Body Shop, 177
Boeing, 106, 108
Border’s, 109
British Petroleum, 185
Brown-Forman, 194
Business for Social Responsibility, 177
CalPers, 197, 199
Campbell’s Soup, 112
Capital Cities, 214
Carnival, 107
Cendant Corporation, 153, 166–167
Central Broadcasting System (CBS), 53
Charles Schwab, 66
Chicago Bulls, 65
Chrysler, 180, 185, 189, 208
Cirrus Logic, 55
Cisco, 84, 211
Clorox, 112
Coca-Cola Company, 84, 106–107, 108, 113–
114, 127, 136, 150, 177, 200, 235–241
Colgate-Palmolive, 107
Compaq, 112
ConEd, 106
Credit Suisse, 185
CUC International, 166
CVS, 106
Daimler Benz, 180, 185, 187, 189, 208
Dell Computer, 59, 60–61, 108, 112
Deutsche Bank, 185
Deutsche-Telecom, 185
Disney, 113–114, 135, 137, 199, 214, 230–235
Donaldson Lufkin Jenrette, 185
Dow Chemical, 106
Dow Jones, 53
Dresdner, 185
Dun & Bradstreet, 196
DuPont, 84, 99, 106, 177, 194
E-America Dot.com (satire), 157–160
eBay, 200
Elf Aquitaine, 185
Eli Lilly, 106, 194
Emulex, 53–54, 58
Enron, 106
ESPN, 114, 214, 232
E*Trade, 187
Euronext, 186
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
258 Company Index
Evening Exchange, 62
Exxon-Mobil, 106, 146
Fabri-Centers, 164–165
Federal Express, 106, 177
Federal Reserve Board, 8, 190
Financial Accounting Standards Board
(FASB), 156
First Oaks, 106
Folio, 66
Food and Drug Administration, U.S. (FDA),
52
Ford, 112, 185
Freerealtime, 57
French Bourse, 17, 186
Gap, 106
General Electric (GE), 99, 108, 113, 114–116,
121–130, 133–136, 139–142, 147–148, 199–
200, 210, 217, 222–230, 239
General Motors (GM), 199–200, 203
Gillette, 107
Goldman Sachs, 188
Gucci, 107, 185
Hasbro, 108, 177
Heineken, 106
He`rmes International, 106
Hershey’s, 106, 200
HFS Inc., 166
Home Depot, 106, 177
Honeywell, 108
Hoover, 112
IBM, 112, 211
Instinet, 62
Intel, 107
International Accounting Standards Committee
(IASC), 182
International Organization of Securities
Commissions (IOSCO), 189
International Securities Exchange, 187
Island, 62
iX (International Exchanges), 186–187
JoAnn Fabrics, 165
John Deere, 106
Johnson & Johnson, 75
Johnson Controls, 107, 108
Kenneth Cole, 107
Kimberly-Clark, 107
KPMG, 212
Kraft Foods, 213
Learning Company, 213
Leasco, 153
London StockExchange, 7
Longleaf Partner Funds, 11
Lucent, 106
LVMH Moe¨ t Hennessy Louis Vuitton, 185
McDonald’s, 106, 120
McGraw-Hill, 194
Mannesmann, 180, 184–185, 188
Marketwatch.com, 53
Mattel, 108, 213–214
Mazda, 185
MCI, 106
Mead, 107, 194
Mercury Finance, 163–164
Microsoft, 114–116, 121–130, 133–136, 141, 147–
148, 174, 211, 216, 217
MicroStrategy, 153, 166
Mitsubishi, 185
Motley Fool, 54
Motorola, 177
Nabisco, 113, 185
Nasdaq, 5–7, 54, 59, 62, 67, 87, 186, 187
National Association of Corporate Directors
(NACD), 197
National Association of Securities Dealers
(NASD), 187
National Broadcasting Corporation (NBC),
114
National Student Marketing, 153, 164
NEI Webworld, 56–58
Nestle´ , 106
NetworkAssociates, 208
New YorkStockExchange (NYSE), 3–4, 5,
7, 59, 62, 78, 186, 187
Nike, 107
Nissan, 182, 185
Nordstroms, 194
Olivetti, 185
Om Gruppen, 186
Omnigene Diagnostics, 56
Company Index 259
Oracle, 211
Osaka Securities Exchange, 187
PaineWebber, 185, 187
PairGain Technologies, 57
Palm, 211
Papa John’s Pizza, 75
Paramount, 179
Paribas, 185
Pearson, 162–163
Penguin, 162–163
Penn Central, 153
Pepsi, 84, 107, 127
Perdue, 112
Pfizer, 106
Philips-Van Heusen Corporation, 177
Polaroid, 177, 211
Polo Ralph Lauren, 107
Procter & Gamble, 74–75, 85, 105, 108, 113,
200
Putnam Berkley, 163
Quigley Corporation, 55
Raging Bull, 54, 57
Ralph Lauren, 107
Reebok, 177
Renault, 185
Rite-Aid, 220
Robert Morris Associates, 196
Rolls Royce, 185
Saks Fifth Avenue, 109
Salomon Brothers, 163
Samsung, 185
Santa Fe Institute, 36–37
SAP, 187, 189
Sears, 200
Securities and Exchange Commission
(SEC), 3–4, 11, 54, 56–59, 61, 67, 105,
155–156, 165, 182–183, 187, 189, 202,
211, 219–220
Sequoia Fund, 11
Silicon Investor, 54
Socie´te´ Ge´nerale, 185
SoftbankCorporation, 187
Sony, 106
Sotheby’s, 116
South Sea Company, 9–10
Standard & Poor’s, 196
Standard Oil, 174
Starbucks, 108
Steinway, 107
Sunbeam, 153, 165, 166, 207
Supreme Court, U.S., 52
Teacher’s Insurance Annuity Associate-
College Retirement Equities Fund
(TIAA-CREF), 179, 197
Telecom Italia, 185
Texaco, 106, 200
Tiffany’s, 106
Time Inc., 179
Tokyo Stock Exchange, 7
Toshiba, 227
TOTAL-FINA, 185
Toys-‘‘R’’-Us, 108
TrackData Corporation, 79
Tweedy Browne, 11
UBS, 185
Unilever, 177
United Biscuits, 185
United Technologies, 99
U.S. Steel Corporation, 157
Value Line Investment Survey, 11
Vanguard, 11, 199
Vodafone, 180, 184–185, 188
Volkswagen, 185
Wal-Mart, 108, 177, 200, 227
Walgreen’s, 106
Walt Disney Company, 113–114, 135, 137, 199,
214, 230–235
Washington Post Company, 13, 194
Wasserstein Parella, 185
Westinghouse, 200
Wilshire, 106
Windsor Fund, 11, 14
Wrigley, 200
Xerox, 113
Yahoo!, 54, 55, 57, 211
Yokogawa, 227
Yves Saint Laurent, 185
260
NAME INDEX
Alexander, Sidney, 21
Ammer, John, 49
Aristotle, 49
Arrow, Kenneth, 26
Astor, Lady, 208–209
Bachelier, Louis, 17–18, 22
Baker, James, 8
Barad, Jill, 213
Baruch, Bernard, 11
Bass, Thomas, 37
Berra, Yogi, 82
Black, Fischer, 26
Blair, Tony, 182–183
Bogle, Jack, 13, 199
Boorstein, Daniel, 119
Bossidy, Larry, 223
Brett, George, 64
Briloff, Abraham, 156–157
Brown, Robert, 18
Buffett, Warren, 4, 9, 11, 12–14, 27, 48, 49,
55, 65, 71, 73, 76, 81, 87, 88, 100, 102,
103, 109, 111, 117, 118, 134, 137, 145, 150,
167, 171, 172, 191, 193, 197, 198–199,
206, 209, 211–212, 216, 220, 222, 243
Burgstahler, David, 154
Burke, Dan, 214
Campbell, John, 49
Carew, Rod, 64
Carret, Phil, 13, 14, 56, 143
Clinton, Bill, 225–226
Cowles, Alfred, 18
Cuniff, Richard, 11
de la Vega, Joseph, 10
Dichev, Ilia, 154
Disney, Roy, 214, 232
Disney, Walt, 214, 230, 231, 232, 234
Dunlap, Al, 165, 207
Eaton, Robert, 208
Eckert, Robert, 213
Edison, Thomas, 223
Einstein, Albert, 18, 22, 32, 46
Eisner, Michael, 214, 230–235
Fama, Eugene, 20, 21, 25, 27–28
Farmer, Doyne, 37
Fisher, Phil, 13, 221
Franklin, Ben, 118
Friedman, Milton, 23, 87–88
Fukuyama, Francis, 31
Gabelli, Mario, 11
Gates, Bill, 115
Gleick, James, 36–37
Goethe, G. W. F., 241
Goizueta, Roberto, 113–114, 150, 235–241
Graham, Benjamin, 4–5, 11, 13–14, 22, 32,
33, 49, 56, 69, 70–71, 73, 76, 80–82,
86, 87, 109, 111, 117, 121, 134, 137, 143–
144, 145, 150–151, 156–157, 167, 171, 179,
193, 203–204, 243–244
Hackworth, Michael, 55
Hawkins, Mason, 11
Hertz, Barry, 79
Hixon, Robert, 179
Hurst, H. E., 35–36
Jordan, Michael, 65
Jordan, Vernon, 200
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
Name Index 261
Kendall, Maurice, 18
Keough, Donald, 235
Keynes, John Maynard, 11, 13, 25, 26, 87–88
Klatsky, Bruce, 177
Knapp, Tom, 11
Leeson, Nick, 79–80
Lefe`vre, Edwin, 56, 82
Levitt, Arthur, 67, 153–154, 155–157, 161,
166, 183
Lo, Andrew, 25
Loeb, Gerald, 11, 13, 14, 65, 75
Loomis, Carol, 102
Lorenz, Edward, 37–38
Lyapunov, Aleksandr, 43–44
Lynch, Peter, 13, 14, 65
MacKinley, A. Craig, 25
McLuhan, Marshall, 232
Malkiel, Burton, 12
Mandelbrot, Benoit, 45
Markowitz, Harry, 28, 29
Munger, Charlie, 11, 14, 32, 49, 134, 150
Murphy, Tom, 214
Neff, John, 11, 14
Newton, Isaac, 37
Nixon, Richard, 13
Nunn, Sam, 200
Ovitz, Mike, 235
Pacioli, Luca, 153
Packard, Norman, 37
Park, Yun Soo Oh (Toyko Joe), 57–58
Perdue, Frank, 112
Perot, Ross, 225–226
Peters, Edgar, 36, 44–46
Poincare´ , Henri, 37
Price, Michael, 13
Price, T. Rowe, 13
Ricketts, Howard T., 4
Roosevelt, Theodore, 174
Ruane, William, 11
Rubin, Robert E., 182–183
Samuelson, Paul, 18, 22
Savage, Leonard, 18
Schafer, David, 11
Schrempp, Jurgen, 208
Schwed, Fred, 5, 222
Shakespeare, William, 12
Sharpe, William F., 26, 28, 29
Shiller, Robert, 48–49
Shleifer, Andrei, 48
Smith, Adam, 31
Soros, George, 13, 15
Stein, Herb, 9
Summers, Lawrence, 48
Templeton, John, 11
Tobin, James, 25–26
Tokyo Joe, 57–58
Welch, Jack, 114–115, 125, 222–230, 239
Williams, John Burr, 144, 146
Williams, Ted, 64, 222
Working, Holbrook, 18
262
SUBJECT INDEX
AAA approach, at Coca-Cola, 237, 241
Accountability, 211
Accounting:
auditing and, 217–220
globalization and, 181–183, 219
internal financial controls, 218
for mergers and acquisitions, 154–155
Accounting goodwill, 137, 154
Accounting trickery, 52, 153–167
examples of aggressive accounting, 161–
167
perennial techniques, 153–157
satire of, 157–161
Accounts receivable turnover, 125–126
Acid test ratio, 122–123
Analyst effect, 11
Annual reports, 105–106
Anomaly effects, 10–11, 21
Arbitrage, 27, 79–80
Ask, 59–60
Asset allocation, 76–77
At-will employment, 173
Auditing, 217–220
Balance sheet, 134–138
Bargain hunting, 137
Behavioral finance, 47–49
Beta, 29–32
Bid, 59–60
Bid-askspread, 60, 61
Big bath accounting, 154
Board of directors (see Corporate governance)
Bookvalue, 92–93, 134–138, 147
Boundarylessness, at General Electric, 223,
224, 226, 228, 229, 230
Branded products, 112, 136, 236–237
British South Sea bubble, 9–10
Brownian motion, 18
Bullet-train thinking, 227
Bulletin boards, 54, 56–57
Business climate, 85–86
Business value, 70–75
(See also Valuation)
Business volatility, 31–32
Butterfly effect, 37–38, 47
Capital allocation, 215–217
Capital asset pricing model (CAPM), 29–32,
34, 72
Capital markets, globalization and, 186–
187
Capitalization of earnings method of valuation,
95–96, 98, 99, 133, 138–142
Capitalization rate, 140
Care, duty of, 177–178
Cash-burn, 83, 159–160
Cash flow, in discounted cash flow method
of valuation, 96–98, 99, 133, 144–
145
Chaos (Gleick), 36–37
Chaos theory, 31, 36–46
butterfly effect and, 37–38, 47
fractals and, 44–46
hockey puck problem and, 38, 47
Lyapunov exponents and, 43–44
origins of, 37–38
phase portraits and, 38–43
pricing discontinuity and, 46–47
pricing persistency in, 46–47
time-series data and, 38–43, 45
Chartists, 24
Chat rooms, 54, 56–57
Chief executive officers (CEOs):
Michael Eisner, 230–235
Roberto Goizueta, 235–241
JackW elch, 222–230
key characteristics of, 221–222
selection of, 206–207
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
Subject Index 263
Circle of competence, 105–118
decision making and, 116–118
full circle, 114–116
initial, 106–109
nurtured, 109–114
Circuit breakers, 3–4
Co-location, at General Electric, 227
Commercial banking, 174, 187, 190
Commodities, 112
Compensation:
determining levels of, 207–208
stockoptions in, 208–212, 216–217
Compounding, 100–102
Confirmation bias, 118
Corporate governance, 172–176, 183–184
board independence, 198–199
capital allocation, 215–217
CEO selection, 206–207
compensation and, 207–212
globalization and, 172–176, 183–184
integrity of financial reporting, 217–
220
involvement in other boards, 200–201
orientation of board, 195–200
reforms in, 197
shareholder primacy and, 180, 189–190,
194
shareholder proposals and, 202–204
size of board, 200
son-in-law standard, 193–195
succession and, 201, 206–207
takeover evaluation, 212–215
(See also Chief executive officers; Managerial
integrity and ability)
Corporate social responsibility, 176–179
Correlation tests, 19–20
Cost of debt, 145
Cost of equity, 145
Cost of goods sold (COGS), 125
Crash of 1929, 8, 84
Crash of 1987, 7–8, 46, 48, 67, 72
Credit sales, 126
Currency reporting, 160
Current ratio, 121–122
Day trading, 4, 47, 70
margin trading and, 79
trader volatility and, 63–64, 66
Debt-to-equity ratio, 123–124
Decimal pricing, 62
Decision making, 116–118
Delinkage, 71
Demand Flow Technology, at General Electric,
227
Depreciation, 93, 96, 98, 99, 131
Derivative securities, 8
(See also Stockoptions)
Diluted earnings, 138
Directors (see Corporate governance)
Discount brokers, 61
Discounted cash flow method of valuation,
96–98, 99, 133, 144–145
Discounting, 97–98
Diversification, 15, 75–76
asset allocation and, 76–77
income allocation and, 77–78
and modern portfolio theory, 29
Dividend discount method of valuation, 144–
145
Dividend policy, 215–216
Dividend reinvestment plans (DRIPs), 74–
75
Dutch tulip bulb mania, 9, 10
Duty of care, 177–178
Duty of loyalty, 178
E-commerce (see Internet)
Economic goodwill, 136–137
Economic value added, 149–151
Efficient market theory (EMT), 4, 7–49
anomaly effects and, 10–11, 21
behavioral finance and, 47–49
capital asset pricing model and, 29–32,
34, 72
challenges to, 47–49
chaos theory and, 36–46
‘‘lucky monkey’’ viewpoint and, 12–13
market bubbles and, 8–10
as misleading, 72
modern portfolio theory and, 28–29, 64,
72
noise theory and, 25–28, 33–34
perfect market and, 22–23
professional investors and, 11, 12–15
random walkmodel and, 12–13, 17–
22
three forms of efficiency, 23–25, 26
volatility and, 51–67
Electronic computer networks (ECNs), 60–
63
EMT (see Efficient market theory)
Essays of Warren Buffett, The (Buffett), 171,
222
Euclidean geometry, 44–46
264 Subject Index
European Union (EU):
corporate governance and, 175–176, 183
integration of finance and governance,
181
(See also names of specific countries)
Expenses, matching revenues with, 93–94
Filter technique, 21
Financial alchemy, 81–86
Financial leverage index, 130
401(k) accounts, 76, 77
Fractals, 44–46
France, mergers and acquisitions, 185
Fraud detection, 219
Free rider strategy, 73, 76
Fundamental analysis, 70–75
Fundamental efficiency, 26
Germany:
corporate governance and, 175
globalization and, 187
information and, 188, 189
mergers and acquisitions and, 180, 185
social responsibility and, 177
Glass-Steagall Act, 174, 187, 190
Globalization, 52, 113, 171–191
accounting and, 181–183, 219
capital markets and, 186–187
corporate governance and, 172–176, 183–
184
information and, 188–189
mergers and acquisitions, 178–180, 184–
186
orientation of board, 195–200
shareholder primacy and, 172–176, 180,
189–190
social responsibility and, 176–179
Goodwill, 136–137, 154
Greater fool theory, 69
H exponent, 35–36
Half Movement, at General Electric, 227
Hedge funds, 15
Hoaxes, 53–58
Hockey puck problem, 38, 47
Holding period, 87
Hostile takeovers, 178–180, 184–186, 214–215
Implied cap rate, 149
Income allocation, 77–78
Index funds, 73–74, 99
Individual retirement accounts (IRAs), 76,
77
Inflation, in valuation process, 103, 136
Information volatility, 51–59
negative, 52–59
positive, 52
Informational efficiency, 26
Infrastructure fortification, at Coca-Cola,
238
Initial public offerings (IPOs), 8–9
Inside tips, 56
Insider effect, 11
Integrated diversity, at General Electric,
223, 225, 226
Intelligent Investor, The (Graham), 22, 134
Interest rates:
risk-free, 102, 141, 142
in valuation process, 102
Internet, 8–9
and Disney, 232
and General Electric, 228–229
rise of, 113
Webcasting, 54
Interpretation of Financial Statements, The
(Graham), 121
Intrinsic time, 46–47
Inventory turnover, 124–125
Investment banking, 174, 187, 190
Italy, mergers and acquisitions, 185
January effect, 11
Japan:
accounting and, 181–182
corporate governance and, 176, 184
globalization and, 185, 187
information and, 189
stockmark et bubble, 9, 84
Joseph effect, 46–47
Lake Woebegon syndrome, 117
Learning culture:
at Coca-Cola, 239–240
at General Electric, 227, 228
Leverage, 123–124, 129, 130
Limit cycle attractors, 43
Linear testing, 33–36
Liquidation value, 135–136
Liquidity ratio, 122–123
Long-term approach, 86–88
Loyalty, duty of, 178
Lyapunov exponents (LEs), 43–44
Subject Index 265
Macroeconomic factors, 100, 103
Management discussion and analysis, 105–
106, 119
Managerial integrity and ability, 171–191
accounting and, 181–183
capital markets and, 186–187
corporate governance and, 172–176, 183–
184
information and, 188–189
key components of, 221–222
mergers and acquisitions and, 178–180,
184–186, 214–216
shareholder primacy and, 172–176, 180,
189–190
social responsibility and, 176–179
(See also Chief executive officers)
Margin trading, 78–79, 80
Market bubbles, 8–10, 81–86
Market capitalization, 8–9
Market cycle, 69, 72
Market efficiency, 64
Market makers, transaction volatility and,
59–63
Market share, 83–84, 159
Market volatility, 5–8, 34
Matching expenses and revenues, 93–94
Materiality principle, 155, 160
Mergers and acquisitions:
accounting for, 154–155
defensive tactics in, 214–215
hostile takeovers, 178–180, 184–186, 214–
215
offensive tactics in, 212–214
Modern portfolio theory (MPT), 28–29, 64,
72
Momentum traders, 5, 21–22
Month effect, 11
Mutual funds, 99, 177
National Securities Markets Improvements
Act of 1996, 182
Negative information volatility, 52–59
accounting trickery and, 52, 153–167
pump-and-dump schemes, 56–58
rumor-based ‘‘news’’ and, 53–58
share repurchases and, 52, 216–217
Neoclassical economic model, 31
Net current assets, 137
Netherlands:
corporate governance and, 175
mergers and acquisitions, 185
News cycle, 53
Nile River Dam project, 35
Noah effect, 46–47
Noise theory, 25–28, 33–34
Non-Random Walk Down Wall Street, A (Lo
and MacKinlay), 25
Nonlinear systems, 31, 33–36
On-line brokers, 61
Opportunity cost, 77
Options, 79–81, 208–212, 216–217
Order flow, 60
Overconfidence, 117, 118
Owner orientation (see Shareholder primacy)
Pattern seeking, 118
Perfect markets, 22–23
Phase portraits, 38–43
Phynance, 36–46
Point cycle attractors, 43
Ponzi schemes, 55
PPP approach, at Coca-Cola, 237, 241
Practical intelligence, at Coca-Cola, 241
Predictors, The (Bass), 37
Present value, 97–98
Price/bookratio, 147
Price/earnings (P/E) ratio, 95–96, 148–149
Price/sales ratio, 147–148
Pricing discontinuity, 46–47
Pricing persistency, 46–47
Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of
1995, 190
Privatization, 184
Profit margin, 95, 126–128
Proxy contests, 203–204
Pump-and-dump schemes, 56–58
Q fever, 4–5
Quality of income, 131
QuickMark et Intelligence (QMI), at General
Electric, 227
Quickratio, 122–123
Random Walk Down Wall Street, A (Malkiel),
12
Random walkmodel, 17–22, 31
correlation tests and, 19–20
described, 12–13
H exponent and, 35–36
perfect market and, 22–23
runs and, 20
266 Subject Index
Random walkmodel (Cont.):
trading rules and, 20–22
validity of, 24, 35
weakform efficiency and, 23–25
Rate of return, 95
Ratio analysis, 119–132
current ratio, 121–122
debt-to-equity ratio, 123–124
inventory turns, 124–125
price/bookratio, 147
price/earnings ratio, 95–96, 148–149
price/sales ratio, 147–148
profit margin, 95, 126–128
quickratio, 122–123
receivable turns, 125–126
return on assets, 129–131
return on equity, 128
return on investment, 128–129
working capital, 120–121
Rebalancing, trader volatility and, 63, 64–
65, 66
Receivables turnover, 125–126
Research-and-development (R&D) expenditures,
154–155
Reserve adjustments, 155, 158–159
Resistance, 118
Resource allocation, at Coca-Cola, 238–
239
Return:
capital asset pricing model and, 29–32
and modern portfolio theory, 28–29
Return on assets, 129–131
Return on equity, 128
Return on investment (ROI), 128–129
Revenue recognition, 155, 158
Revenues, matching expenses with, 93–94
Risk:
appetite for, 117
and modern portfolio theory, 28–29
riskaversion, 27
risk-free rate of interest, 102, 141, 142
Rule of 72s, 101–102
Rumors, 27, 53–58, 82
Runs, 20
Sales per employee, 131
Salvage value, 99
Saving via stocks, 65–66
Scalping, 57
Scrap value, 99
Sector rotation, 5, 21–22
Sell-offs, 4
Semistrong-form efficiency, 23–25, 26
Shareholder primacy:
at Coca-Cola, 236
corporate governance and, 172–176, 180,
189–190, 194
Shareholder proposal rule, 202–204
Simplification philosophy, at General Electric,
225, 229
Six Sigma quality, at General Electric, 227–
228
Smoothing techniques, 153
Social responsibility, 176–179
Son-in-law standard, 193–195
Spamming, 55–56
Specialists, transaction volatility and, 59–63
Speculation, 5, 73, 79–80
market bubbles and, 8–10, 81–86
(See also Day trading)
Speed philosophy, at General Electric, 224,
227, 229
Stochastic systems, 37
Stockmutual funds, 74, 77
Stockoptions, 208–212, 216–217
Stockrepurchases, 52, 216–217
Stocksplits, 217
Stretch philosophy, at General Electric, 224–
225, 227, 229
Strong-form efficiency, 23–25
Succession, 201, 206–207
Superiority, 117, 118
Synergy meetings, at Disney, 230–231
Systematic risk, 29
Takeovers, 178–180, 184–186, 214–215
Taxes:
impact on investments, 102–103
interest deductions on debt, 8
on mutual funds versus individual
stocks, 74
Three-body problem, 37
360 degree management appraisal, 226
Ticks:
market price, 5
Q fever and, 4–5
Time-series data, 19–20, 38–43, 45
Time value of money, 99, 100–102
Tips, 27
Trader volatility, 63–66
day trading and, 63–64, 66
rebalancing and, 63, 64–65, 66
saving via stocks and, 65–66
Trading rules, 20–22
Subject Index 267
Transaction volatility, 59–63
Tulip bulb mania, 9, 10
24-hour trading, 62
Typhus, 4
United Kingdom:
accounting and, 182–183
corporate governance and, 172–176, 183–
184
information and, 188–189
Unsystematic risk, 29
Valuation, 70–75, 83, 91–103
assets in, 134–138
bookvalue in, 134–138
capitalization of earnings method, 95–
96, 98, 99, 133, 138–142
circle of competence and, 105–118
compounding in, 100–102
discounted cash flow method, 96–98,
99, 133, 144–145
inflation in, 103, 136
interest rates in, 102
Valuation (Cont.):
margin of safety and, 134, 142–144
market circularity and, 146–149
ratio analysis in, 119–132, 147–149
taxes and, 102–103
Value Line effect, 11
Vividness bias, 118
Volatility, 51–67
business, 31–32
information, 51–59
market, 5–8, 34
prognosis for market and, 66–67
trader, 63–66
transaction, 59–63
Wall Street rule, 172
Watergate, 13
Weakform efficiency, 23–25
Webcasting, 54
Weekend effect, 11
Where Are the Customers’ Yachts? (Schwed),
5, 222
Work-Out, at General Electric, 225–227,
228, 229, 230
Working capital, 120–121
ABOUT THE AUTHOR
Lawrence A. Cunningham is professor of law at the Benjamin N.
Cardozo Law School of Yeshiva University in New YorkCity and
director of The Samuel and Ronnie Heyman Center on Corporate
Governance at Cardozo, where he has taught since 1992. From 1988
to 1992, he was an associate with Cravath, Swaine & Moore, where
he practiced corporate and securities law. Professor Cunningham
has written numerous books and dozens of articles on accounting,
business, finance, investing, and related policy matters, including an
internationally acclaimed collection of Warren Buffett’s letters to
Berkshire Hathaway shareholders, The Essays of Warren Buffet: Lessons
for Corporate America, and the widely used textbook Introductory
Accounting and Finance for Lawyers. Professor Cunningham has
taught and lectured widely, in the United States and abroad, at
schools and business organizations of all kinds. He has served as a
consultant to corporate boards of directors, law and accounting
firms, and regulatory and standard-setting bodies. He has been featured
in Forbes and Money, and on CNN and The Motley Fool Radio
Show, and has appeared on or been quoted in scores of other broadcast
and print media. Professor Cunningham is a magna cum laude
graduate of Cardozo and earned his B.A. in economics from the
University of Delaware. He was born and raised in Wilmington, Delaware,
and now resides in New YorkCity with his wife, JoAnna Cunningham.
Professor Cunningham is an investor and may hold securities
of some of the companies discussed in this book
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
‘‘This timely bookchallenges investors to move away from the recentlypopular
‘Q Culture’ of speculation to the ‘V Culture’ of value investing,
based on business analysis that focuses on the basics of finance, accounting,
and governance. The author reminds us that, ‘earnings and cash
flows are what give a business value’—the eternal message of long-run
success in equity investing. It is the critical linkin the investment chain,
and Larry Cunningham’s bookforges it with heat, power, and persuasiveness.’’
JackBogle, Founder and Former Chairman,
The Vanguard Group
‘‘Larry Cunningham masterfully tackles critical subjects at the heart of
today’s markets. A much-needed work on a unique style of investing, this
bookputs the ABCs of common sense valuation back into the business of
investing. This is the place to lookfor insight and guidance in the age of
volatile markets and colliding ideas.’’
Alan C. (‘‘Ace’’) Greenberg, Chairman, Bear Stearns
‘‘Anyone desiring to be a successful investor should read this excellent
bookpresenting the important investing principles of Graham, Buffett,
Fisher, and others in a most insightful and understandable manner.’’
David J. (‘‘Sandy’’) Gottesman, Chairman, First Manhattan
‘‘Remarkably timely. For stock players who realize they played the greatest
fool in the Internet stockgame, Cunningham offers a tool for rehabilitation:
a guide to thoughtful investing. For earnest investors, he shows how
to live profitably with the moodiness of Mr. Market.’’
David Henry, Associate Editor, Finance, Business Week
‘‘While the stockmark et does not always behave rationally, Larry Cunningham’s
well-articulated and insightful views as to value investing are a
refreshing reminder that, just as night follows day, a return to the principles
at the core of Cunningham’s commonsense approach to investing is
inevitable.’’
Samuel J. Heyman, Chairman of the Board and CEO,
GAF Corporation
‘‘Puzzled by acronyms, buzz words, the pop investing concepts? Cunningham
explains then debunks them. He gets down to the fundamentals that
investors must know about companies in order to choose reliable winners
in the stockmark et.’’
Janet Lowe, Author, Benjamin Graham on
Value Investing and Warren Buffett Speaks
BENJAMIN GRAHAM
AND INVEST LIKE
WARREN BUFFETT
Lawrence A. Cunningham
CONTENTS
Acknowledgements ix
Introduction: The Q Culture xi
PARTI:
A TALE OF TWO MARKETS 1
Chapter 1. Mr. Market’s Bipolar Disorder 3
Swings, Bubbles, and Crashes / 5
Be an Anomaly / 11
Barrel of Monkeys? / 12
Chapter 2. Prozac Market 17
Obscurity / 17
Simplicity / 18
The PerfectDream / 22
Tidying Up the Tale / 28
Chapter 3. Chaotic Market 33
New Wave / 33
NextW ave / 36
Complexity / 46
Behavioral Finance / 47
Chapter 4. Amplified Volatility 51
Information Volatility / 51
Transaction Volatility / 59
Trader Volatility / 63
Prognosis / 66
Chapter 5. Take the Fifth 69
Who’s in Charge? / 70
Sticking to Your Knitting / 71
Alchemy / 81
The Long Run / 86
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
vi Contents
PARTII:
SHOW ME THE MONEY 89
Chapter 6. Apple Trees and Experience 91
Fools and Wisdom / 91
Horse Sense / 100
Chapter 7. Your Circle of Competence 105
The Initial Circle / 106
The Nurtured Circle / 109
A Full Circle / 114
Decision Making / 116
Chapter 8. Recognizing Success 119
Business Fuel / 120
Managers under the Microscope / 124
Bang for the Buck / 128
The Full Tool Chest/ 131
Chapter 9. You Make the Call 133
Assets / 134
Earnings / 138
Silver Bullets and the Margin of Safety / 142
Cash / 144
MarketCircularit y / 146
Chapter 10. Making (Up) Numbers 153
Perennials / 153
Satire / 157
Charades / 162
Coda / 167
PARTIII:
IN MANAGERS WE TRUST 169
Chapter 11. Going Global 171
The Two-World Story / 172
Illusions of Duty / 176
One World to Come / 180
Contents vii
Chapter 12. Rules and Trust 193
The Family Manager / 193
Local Governance / 195
General Governance / 200
Your Voice att he Table / 202
Chapter 13. Directors at Work 205
Hail to the Chief / 206
Pay / 207
Deals / 212
Capital / 215
Checking Up / 217
Chapter 14. The Fireside CEO 221
Master Servants / 221
Action / 222
Lights / 230
Trust/ 235
Conclusion: The V Culture 243
Notes 245
Index 257
This page intentionally left blank.
ix
ACKNOWLEDGMENTS
The main ideas in this booktrace their intellectual lineage to
Benjamin Graham, whom I never knew but must thank posthumously,
and Warren Buffett, whom I have the great fortune to
know and from whose writings, talks, and conversations I have
gained knowledge and insight. Neither of these men, of course, has
any responsibility for this book’s content and no doubt would disagree
with some of what it says, though it is written as a narrative
interpretation of principles they developed, to which it tries to be
faithful.
Mr. Buffett deserves my continuing thanks for permitting me to
prepare a collection of his letters to the shareholders of Berkshire
Hathaway, The Essays of Warren Buffett: Lessons for Corporate America,
and for participating along with Berkshire Vice-Chairman
Charles Munger in a symposium I organized to analyze it. Thanks
also to the readers of that collection of wonderful writings for encouraging
me to write the present book, especially the courageous
college and business school professors who use that bookin their
courses and their many students who tell me how valuable it is.
Other fans of that bookwho encouraged me to write this one
include my friends at Morgan Stanley Dean Witter, led by David
Darst and John Snyder; Chris Davis and KimMarie Zamot at Davis
Selected Advisers; the team at Edward D. Jones; and supporters too
numerous to mention at other firms who appreciate the business
analysis way of investing.
By training and professional habit I am a corporate lawyer, and
as my students know, effectiveness as a corporate lawyer requires
mastering not only (or mostly) law but also business, including finance,
accounting, and governance. For tutelage in that philosophy,
I thankmy friends and former colleagues at Cravath, Swaine &
Moore as well as that firm’s clients.
Not all law faculties recognize the intersection of law and business.
My colleagues at Cardozo Law School do and support my re-
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
x Acknowledgments
search and writing in the fields of finance, accounting, and governance
that seem to others a step beyond law as such. Among these
colleagues, special thanks to Monroe Price for introducing me to
Warren Buffett through their mutual friend Bob Denham. For granting
me a sabbatical to devote time to workon this book, I especially
thankDean Paul Verkuil and Dean Michael Herz.
My personal and institutional ability to span these and other
subjects has been greatly aided by Samuel and Ronnie Heyman, both
nonpracticing lawyers and astoundingly talented businesspeople, investors,
and philanthropists. They generously endowed the Samuel
and Ronnie Heyman Center on Corporate Governance at Cardozo,
a multifaceted program I direct that explores this range of disciplines
in teaching, research, and policy review.
My own teachers also deserve my thanks, particularly Elliott
Weiss, now professor at the University of Arizona College of Law,
who long ago drew my attention to Graham and Buffett’s ideas and
who generously shares his wealth of knowledge. For allowing me to
use in modified form some materials from a textbookwe worked on
together. I also thankProfessor Jeffrey D. Bauman of Georgetown
University Law Center, and West Group, that book’s publisher.
Thanks also to West Group for allowing me to use in modified form
some materials from another textbookI wrote, Introductory Accounting
and Finance for Lawyers, which is not for lawyers only.
Many thanks to the whole team at McGraw-Hill for their confidence,
enthusiasm, and guidance, particularly Kelli Christiansen,
Jeffrey Krames and Scott Amerman.
Most of all, thanks to my wife, JoAnna Cunningham, who painstakingly
edited the entire manuscript with precision and grace and
encouraged me every step of the way.
xi
INTRODUCTION:
THE Q CULTURE
Common sense is the heart of investing and business management.
Yet the paradox of common sense is that it is so uncommon.
For example, people often refer to a stockor the market level
as either “overvalued” or “undervalued.” That is an empty statement.
A share of stockor the aggregate of all shares in a market index have
an intrinsic value. It is the sum of all future cash flows the share or
the index will generate in the future, discounted to present value.
Estimating that amount of cash flow and its present value are
difficult. But that defines value, and it is the same without regard
to what people hope or guess it is. The result of the hoping and
guessing game—sometimes the product of analysis, often not—is
the share price or market level. Thus, it is more accurate to refer to
a stockor a market index as overpriced or underpriced than as overvalued
or undervalued.
The insight that prices vary differently from underlying values is
common sense, but it defies prevalent sense. Thinkabout the ticker
symbol for the popular Nasdaq 100: QQQ. The marketing geniuses
at the National Association of Securities Dealers may have chosen
three Qs because Q is a cool and brandable letter (thinkQ-T ips).
In choosing from the letters N, A, S, D, and Q, however, they selected
the one (three times) that stands for Quotation and unwittingly
reflect a quote-driven culture by this quintessentially New
Economy index created in mid-1999.
Quotes of prices command constant attention in the mad, modern
market where buyers and sellers of stocks have no idea of the
businesses behind the paper they swap but precisely what the price
is. Quote obsession trades analysis for attitude, minds for myopic
momentum, intelligence for instinct. Quotations are the quotidian
diet of the day trader, forging a casino culture where quickness of
action fed by irrational impulses displaces both quality and quantity
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
xii Introduction: The Q Culture
of thought. QQQ is an apt symbol for the most volatile index in
stockmark et history.
In the Q culture, common sense is common nonsense, putting
price on a pedestal and all but ignoring business value. The Q trader
sees price as everything. The smart investor knows what value is.
She focuses on value first, and then compares value to price to see
if an investment holds the promise of a good return. That kind
of focus requires the investor to operate as a business analyst, not
as a market analyst or securities analyst and certainly not as a Q
trader.
This bookdevelops a mind-set for business analysis as the antidote
to the Q culture. It discusses the tools of stockpick ing and
highlights critical areas of thinking about markets and prices, and
businesses and managers. It builds a latticeworkof common sense
to fill the vast value void in today’s markets.
The bookfirst shows you why it is a mistake to operate as a
market analyst or to look to the market to reveal value when all it
can do is reveal prices. It then presents the tools to thinkabout
performance and value but also cautions about how financial information
can be distorted in ways that can mislead you. Accordingly,
it argues that an essential element of intelligent investing is a commonsense
ability to assess the trustworthiness of corporate managers,
principally the chief executive officer and board of directors.
The business analysis approach to investing shatters many myths
of investment lore prevalent in the Q culture though not unique to
it throughout history. For example, it rejects a distinction as pervasive
as it is mistaken between growth investing and value investing
(or between growth stocks and value stocks). To be sure, some companies
show greater promise of earnings growth than others, but all
rates of growth are a component of value so this distinction, crystalized
in the early 1970s and a growing fixation ever since, is of no
analytical value.
For another, the business analysis approach underscores a key
distinction between investing on the one hand and speculation or
gambling on the other. All investing involves riskand in that sense
there is a speculative element in all of it. Intelligent investing, however,
calls for a reasonably ascertainable valuation and comparison
to the price.
Leading examples of speculating and gambling include people
buying shares in IPOs or Internet start-ups they know little or nothIntroduction:
The Q Culture xiii
ing about and buying shares in any business without first reading its
annual report or knowing what to look for in it. For every gambling
success story you hear about, there are scores of failures you don’t.
As The Wall Street Journal recently quipped, no brother-in-law has
ever been known to reveal how much money he lost in the stock
market.
The focus on business analysis as opposed to market analysis is
reinforced by the imaginary Mr. Market, created by the twentieth
century’s most astute investment thinker and business school
teacher, Benjamin Graham. Price and value diverge in capital market
trading because the market is best characterized as manic depressive,
mostly either too euphoric or too gloomy. This is contrary to the
popular but mistaken belief that markets are efficient and therefore
accurately price securities.
Once you as a business analyst know how to look, the next question
is where to look. The core idea is your circle of competence,
created by the twentieth century’s most successful investor and business
educator, Warren Buffett. It is defined by your ability to understand
a company’s products and operating context. Circles of
competence are as varied as the investors who must define them. All
investors must grapple with the challenge of using current and past
information to gauge future business performance.
For most people, it is easier to do this with businesses that have
been around a long time, been through lots of business cycles, and
faced economic recessions. Within that group of business are many
whose long trackrecords justify being called classics—wellestablished
companies with powerful global products and market positions
like Procter & Gamble, GE, Coca-Cola, and Disney. Some of
these will endure as stalwarts, while others will be beaten down (as
GE did to Westinghouse or as Wal-Mart did to Sears Roebuck). The
ability to tell which is which will vary among people with different
aptitudes in evaluating these companies, for different sets of skills
are necessary to understand these various sorts of businesses.
So too will abilities vary with respect to assessing the future performance
of newer companies that have been through fewer variations
in their operating climate. These are “vintage businesses”—
those that have been around for a while but which operate in newer
and more dynamic industries that evolve at a rapid pace—companies
like Cisco, Intel, or Microsoft, for example. They have less of a track
record, and may be harder for lots of people to understand. But some
xiv Introduction: The Q Culture
people will have the ability to understand them quite well and be
able to make informed judgments about their future prospects.
As with the classics, some vintage companies will turn out to be
warriors and others wimps. For example, take the personal computer
business. From 1990 to 1999 the erstwhile start-up Dell built a
hugely profitable direct-sales PC business, growing its sales and profits
at astonishing rates, with Compaq following respectably, Tandy
and Apple lagging, and plenty of staggering wimps suffering erosion
during the period, including AST, Digital, Atari, Tulip, Commodore,
and Kaypro.*
A third group of companies are “rookies,” brand-new companies,
perhaps in brand-new industries, whose entire context has virtually
no trackrecord. These are frontier businesses, like steel in its day,
automobiles in theirs, plastics a bit later, and the Internet at the
turn of the twenty-first century. Apart from the first movers in such
groups—say, Yahoo! and America Online (AOL) among the 1990s
Internet companies—these have virtually no economic histories to
speakof.
Even so, there will be investors who have the present-day tools
to make intelligent estimates of where the rookies will be in the
future. By mating with AOL in 2000, senior managers of Time-
Warner expressed just such confidence in their ability to do so.
Whether their judgment will be vindicated remains to be seen. But
certainly although some of these companies will turn out to be flyby-
nights, others are true up-and-comers that will proceed up the
ranks from vintage warriors to stalwart classics. After all, every company
started out as a rookie.
The central feature of the circle of competence, then, is that it
must be tailored to the individual. It is not the case that intelligent
investors avoid businesses that are hard to understand or subject to
rapid change. On the contrary, those investors equipped with the
ability and fortitude to understand what is hard for others to understand
and to gauge better than others how a business and its industry
are evolving have a decided advantage. But it remains important for
each investor to come to grips with what is and what is not within
his circle of competence to make the informed judgments that intelligent
investing requires.
* Kara Scannell, Anatomy of a Bull Run: “New Economy” Stocks Lead Charge:
Blast From the Past—A Lookat Yesterday’s Tech Investments—A Few Thrive,
Others Merely Survive, Some Fail, The Wall Street Journal, January 18, 2000.
Introduction: The Q Culture xv
The next inquiry is what to lookfor , within your circle of competence.
The main question is the certainty with which you can
evaluate the long-term economic characteristics of a business. A
greater degree of confidence may be necessary for rookies, less for
vintage companies, and least for classics; but in all cases, assessing
the long-term characteristics of business performance is crucial.
Obtaining the necessary degree of confidence in valuation entails
just a few quantitative inquiries. You’ll see in the second part of the
bookthat financial statements must enable you to answer three
questions about a business:
• How likely is it the business will be able to pay its debts as they
come due?
• How well is management running the business?
• What is it worth?
These questions can be gauged with a sufficient degree of confidence
by a basic familiarity with key business ratios relating to
working capital and debt, management of inventory and other shortterm
assets, returns on equity, and the future outlookfor earnings.
Just as each investor’s circle of competence will vary, so too will
the assessment of these financial characteristics. Ultimately, the
value of a business is the present value of all the cash it will generate
for its owners over future time. Because no one can know the future
with certitude, coming up with that number requires the right set
of tools and good judgment.
Equipped with these tools and working within your circle of
competence, you can determine how much and what sort of evidence
is required to be comfortable with a valuation estimate. Yet
there is no single reliable tool to pinpoint the value of a business,
so intelligent investors must observe Benjamin Graham and Warren
Buffett’s cardinal rule of prudent investing: getting a margin of safety
between the price you pay and the value you are paying for.
In your pursuit all these inquiries, reported figures must be
treated with a healthy skepticism. Accounting conventions and judgments
can distort business reality. For example, working capital figures
can be distorted by accounting rules relating to inventory and
receivables collection. Some fixed assets that are outmoded or noncompetitive
may have an actual scrap value way less than the reported
figure.
xvi Introduction: The Q Culture
On the other hand, some assets may be understated on a balance
sheet (such as reserves of a natural gas company as well as land
values). Off–balance sheet liabilities relating to environmental problems,
post-retirement health benefits for employees, and stockoptions
for managers also must be included as adjustments to reported
figures. You need not know every detail, but a working understanding
is necessary and can be developed with a modicum of effort as part
of a business analysis mind-set.
Tied to the question of certainty in evaluating the long-term
characteristics of a business is the certainty with which you can rely
upon management to channel rewards to shareholders. It remains
true that mouth-watering economics is the most important variable
in evaluating any business for investment. Poor economics can
rarely, if ever, be cured, even by exceptional management, and inferior
management can harm a good business (though it is harder
for bad management to damage an outstanding business).
This management reality—coupled with the inadequacy of markets
and the potential unreliability of numbers—demands that an
investor also appreciate the qualitative dimensions of business analysis.
The most important of these are those qualities that indicate
that a company has an owner orientation.
Holding an owner orientation is not required of corporate managers
as a matter of law or even by practice or custom. Nor will such
an owner orientation be achieved merely by arranging the corporate
rules in certain ways, such as having large numbers of outside directors
or separating the functions of the CEO and the chairman of
the board. Accordingly, the focus on managers is a focus on trustworthiness.
Assessing the trustworthiness of corporate managers is much like
assessing the trustworthiness of a prospective son-in-law. It is a matter
of common sense—again, a rare but acquirable mind-set. In the
context of corporate managers, sources of insight into managerial
trustworthiness include business records and qualities of communications
to shareholders—the CEO letter in particular. Examples
of this art finish off the book, the final chapter giving an account of
the letters of JackW elch (GE), Mike Eisner (Disney), and the late
Roberto Goizueta (Coca-Cola).
The folkwisdom of “minding your Ps and Qs” does not refer to
prices and quotes but to common sense. In investing, this means
grasping the basics of finance, accounting, and governance to see
that the following occurs:
Introduction: The Q Culture xvii
• The efficient market story is at most four-fifths true and investors
can take advantage of the remaining one-fifth
• Traditional tools of financial analysis remain an investor’s best
friends but that earnings management and accounting manipulation
can be her worst enemies
• Intelligent investors pay special attention to who the managers are
and whether they are trustworthy
Minding these Ps and Qs does not require enormous amounts
of work, although it does require large doses of common sense as
inoculation against Q fever.
This antidote takes you through the golden gates of the safer and
more prosperous V culture world. The consummate teacher of V
culture, Ben Graham, was also a successful practitioner. Warren
Buffett, the consummate student and practitioner, is also a teacher.
All good students take the lessons of their teachers and expand upon
them in application. Buffett is no exception, nor are the many other
Graham disciples who take the core lessons and extend them in a
variety of successful ways.†
Yet the differences are subtle to say the least. Buffett keeps inviolate
Graham’s core ideas that call for a business analysis mindset,
attention to the differences between price and value, and insisting
on a margin of safety when making any investment. Only
minor differences in application come up, including and pretty much
limited to the following: Buffett places somewhat more significance
on the role of managers in investing, is less beholden to bargain
purchases of the type Graham favored, is a bit less committed to
diversification of stockinvestment, and pays more attention to intangible
asset values than did Graham. But these differences are not
only overshadowed by what is common, they also reflect a broader
unifying principle: the importance of independent judgment in investing.
Other Graham disciples choose different ways of applying the
main ideas—some diversifying enormously, others concentrating
enormously, and some paying far more or less attention to the underlying
nature of businesses. With temerity and great humility, this
bookoffers an account of Graham’s ideas and Buffett’s extension
and application of them that reflect the example and tradition. It is
† Warren Buffett, The Superinvestors of Graham and Doddsville, Hermes (Columbia
Business School), Fall 1984.
xviii Introduction: The Q Culture
a broadened and extended narrative related specifically to the contemporary
investing environment that Graham obviously can no
longer address and that Buffett can do only in the relatively structured
frameworkof annual shareholder letters.
At all times, the business analysis mind-set is anchored in the
price-value distinction and the margin-of-safety principle, the deep
moorings of the V culture, the deans of which will always be Graham
and Buffett, though I am delighted to be on the faculty.
p a r t I
A TALE
OF TWO
MARKETS
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
This page intentionally left blank.
3
C h a p t e r 1
MR. MARKET’S
BIPOLAR DISORDER
The patient exhibits classic manic depression—or bipolar disorder—
combining episodes of euphoria with irritation. He goes on
wild spending sprees for months on end, using money he does not
have to buy things he does not need. In the buoyant periods he is
talkative and full of ideas, but only in distracted, zigzaggy ways. He
can charm you into buying the Brooklyn Bridge. Then, suddenly and
swiftly, he shifts moods, falling into a months-long spell of darkdepression,
often provoked by the tiniest annoyances, such as minor
bad news and modestly disappointing results.
Experts observe that the condition might be inherited, caused by
innate chemistry affecting mood, appetite, and the perception of
pain, which in turn could lead to dramatic weight gains followed by
abrupt weight losses. There are safety nets to fall backon, such as
government support, and government-approved treatments, such as
mood stabilizers. But the patient lives in denial and can become
angry and suspicious, sometimes not taking the medicine and precipitating
more intense bouts of ups and downs.
The patient I am describing, of course, is the stockmark et. It
mixes episodes of irrational fear with episodes of irrational greed. It
rises with massive infusions of funds—often borrowed—then falls
after the withdrawal of those funds. It bounces around like a circus
clown on a pogo stick, weaving wild tales of untold riches to be made
without effort. Then it pouts, plummets, and corrects, often on news
that this or that company failed to meet earnings estimates by mere
pennies per share.
Clear thinkers about market behavior rightly believe that this
condition is incurable, with the market being prone to fat gains followed
by fat losses without a nexus to business or economic reality.
Nevertheless, government engines such as the Securities and
Exchange Commission and private ones such as the New YorkStock
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
4 A Tale of Two Markets
Exchange monitor the extremes, imposing “circuit breakers” that
shut the market down when it threatens to slip into a bout of depression
(a sell-off) or raising the requirements for margin accounts,
particularly those of day traders.
Yet no cure is in sight. Mr. Market, in Ben Graham’s terms,
denies its manic depression.1 It does this in numerous studies extolling
how “rational” it is. It does it in countless conversations and
publications referring to its “efficiency.” Reams of “beta books” are
compiled in the belief that its gyrations simply and accurately reflect
precisely the measurable riskthat stocks pose for investors. Abstract
advice to diversify portfolios is sold as the only way to minimize the
rational riskthat this efficient system manageably presents. Denial
prevents cure.
Take Ben Graham’s Mr. Market a diagnostic step deeper. Malicious
microorganisms called rickettsia (named for Dr. Howard T.
Ricketts, 1871–1910) cause diseases such as typhus. From the Greek
word for “stupor,” signifying a state of insensibility and mental confusion,
typhus is characterized by bouts of depression and delirium.
It is transmitted by bloodsucking parasites called ticks. These parasites
transmit a similar disease called Q fever.
To avoid Q fever, those venturing into tick-infested forests prepare
themselves. Hats, gloves, long sleeves, and pants are the dress
code. If bitten, prudent forest denizens remove the parasite with
tweezers, wash the bite, and apply rubbing alcohol, ice, and calamine
lotion. They survive to enjoy the woods.
Fools in the tick-ridden forest go bare, leaving exposed their skin
and, most daringly, their heads. After they find a tick, fear drives
them to irrational action, such as burning the tickinstead of tweezing
it out. The kings and queens of fooldom then venture gleefully
on their forest expedition, giddily unaware that they are infected with
Q fever—until depression and delirium set in.
In the stock market forest, the ticks of price quotes infect the
unprepared fools in the same way and with similar results. Trader
obsession with price quotations spreads the Q fever epidemic, adding
gas to the fire of Mr. Market’s manic depression.
When venturing into the stockmark et, defend yourself just as
you would when hiking in the forest: armed to fight the wealthsucking
parasite of the Q fever price tick. Ben Graham and Warren
Buffett prescribe the same course for dealing with Mr. Market. They
advise that just as it is foolish not to recognize his symptoms or
diagnose his disease, it is equally foolish to play into them or exMr.
Market’s Bipolar Disorder 5
pose oneself to the contagion. Instead, use Mr. Market to your advantage.
Neither Graham’s Mr. Market nor this Q fever metaphor implies
anything about the psychology of market participants. Rational people
acting independently can produce irrational market results.
Many investors simply defer to experts or majority opinion. Following
the herd may seem rational and intelligent—until it stampedes
straight off the cliff.
SWINGS, BUBBLES, AND CRASHES
Price ticks drive the wild volatility that plagues contemporary stock
markets. Momentum traders and sector rotators are both victims and
transmitters of Q fever. The disease reaches epidemic proportions
when the crowd follows the “indelibly indicated trend,” in the sarcastic
words of Fred Schwed from his classic work Where Are the
Customers’ Yachts? referring to the illusion that patterns predictably
persist.2
Average stockprices swing by 50% every year, while underlying
business value is far more stable. Share turnover is enormous. The
number of shares traded compared to the total shares outstanding
spiked from 42% to 78% on the New YorkStockExchange between
1982 and 1999 and from 88% to 221% on the Nasdaq between 1990
and 1999.3 Prices on particular stocks rise sharply and fall furiously
within days and weeks without any link to underlying business values.
Speculation rages, and the speed of price fluctuation has multiplied
dramatically compared to previous decades. Market volatility
has increased roughly in proportion to the dramatic increase in information—
both real and imagined—that is readily available. Getting
in before the rise and out before the fall has become the day
trader’s mantra, one that reveals not only the presence of Mr.Market
but the existence of his coconspirators by the thousands.
Roller coaster rides in stocklevels have been known throughout
the history of organized market exchanges, but these rides took major
indexes either up or down together. A quite different trail was
blazed in the late 1990s and early 2000s as the Dow Jones average
of leading industrial companies went one way and the Nasdaq average
of more technology-oriented or younger companies went another.
6 A Tale of Two Markets
Table 1-1. Dow Busts
Date Close
Point
Change
Percent
Change
October 27, 1997 7,161.15 554.26 7.18
August 4, 1998 8,487.31 299.43 3.41
August 27, 1998 8,165.99 357.36 4.19
August 31, 1998 7,539.07 512.61 6.37
January 4, 2000 10,997.93 359.58 3.17
March 7, 2000 9,796.03 374.47 3.68
Frothy new economy devotees bid up the new stocks and tech
stocks to wild heights compared to their pathetic or negative earnings
while eschewing the stodgy old economy stocks that continued
to generate steady earnings increases. The new giddiness subsided,
and the Dow surged while the Nasdaq slumped. But then one recovered
while the other dropped. Topsy-turvy is the only description
for this wild world.
Anyone seeking to divine some deep logic in these flip-flopping
patterns, however, could stop looking on April 14, 2000, when the
indexes plunged together, the Dow by 6% and the Nasdaq by 10%.
Then both rebounded the next trading day, with the Dow climbing
backnearly 3% and the Nasdaq moving backup 6.6% (and the day
after that experiencing up pumps of nearly 2% and over 7%, respectively).
No deep logic explains these swoons or this pricing divergence,
and all you can really conclude is that Mr. Market was being his
(un)usual self. Staggering as these data are, consider too that in the
first quarter of 2000, the Nasdaq suffered four declines of 10% or
more and then in each case rebounded. In April 2000 alone it recorded
two jumps that were its largest in history and three drops
that were its largest in history. In the late 1990s and early 2000s,
Dow busts were equally commonplace, as other drops exceeding 3%
show (see Table 1–1).
The Dow busts of August 1998 were particularly potent: They
wiped out all the gains the Dow had made during that year. So was
the March 2000 bust: It set the Dow backto where it had been
about a year earlier.
If you prefer to focus on Mr. Market’s euphoria, take the bursts
Mr. Market’s Bipolar Disorder 7
Table 1-2. Dow Bursts
Date Close
Point
Change
Percent
Change
September 2, 1997 7,879.78 257.36 3.38
October 28, 1997 7,498.32 337.17 4.71
September 1, 1998 7,827.43 288.36 3.82
September 8, 1998 8,020.78 380.53 4.98
September 23, 1998 8,154.41 257.21 3.26
October 15, 1998 8,299.36 330.58 4.15
March 15, 2000 10,131.41 320.17 3.26
March 16, 2000 10,630.60 499.19 4.93
in the Dow exceeding 3% that occurred in the late 1990s and early
2000s (see Table 1–2).
Apart from their magnitude, consider the proximity of these Dow
busts and bursts. The charts show two back-to-back reversals: The
October 27, 1997, bust of 7.18% was followed the next day by a
4.71% burst, and the August 31, 1998, bust of 6.37% was followed
the next day by a 3.82% burst. The three busts of August 1998 were
promptly followed by three bursts of September 1998, much the way
the bust of March 7, 2000, was followed by the bursts on March 15
and 16 of that year. It is hard to believe that these successive bursts
and busts are based on changes in fundamental information investors
were rationally and efficiently acting on.
Beyond busts and bursts on the Dow and the Nasdaq in the late
1990s and early 2000s, recall one of the most dramatic single episodes
of Mr. Market’s presence on Wall Street: the 1987 crash. The
Dow vaporized by 22.6% on a single day and nearly 33% in the
course of one month. The 1987 crash was not limited to the 30
common stocks on the Dow but was worldwide. The New York Stock
Exchange, the London StockExchange, and the Tokyo Stock
Exchange all crashed.
If stockmark et prices really obeyed the ever-popular efficient
market theory (EMT) and accurately reflected information about
business values, some major changes in the body of available information
would be required to justify that crash. Many people tried to
explain it as a rational response to a number of changes in and
around mid-October 1987, including the following:
8 A Tale of Two Markets
• On September 4, 1987, the Federal Reserve Board raised the discount
rate.
• On October 13, 1987, the House Ways and Means Committee
voted to approve income tax legislation that would disallow interest
deductions on debt used to finance business acquisitions.
• On October 18, 1987, Treasury Secretary James Baker publicly announced
an intention to reduce the value of the dollar.
• Market prices were already high by historical standards.4
Some experts attributed the 1987 crash to various institutional
factors, including program trading and portfolio insurance that were
set to sell off big chunks of the portfolios of large investors as prices
fell. When prices fell, these program sales pushed them down even
harder. Other experts pointed to derivative securities, often exotic
instruments whose value fluctuates with changes in the value of
benchmarks such as interest and exchange rates. These derivatives
are usually intended to reduce riskand volatility in such benchmarks,
though if poorly designed can exacerbate the volatility in
stockmark et pricing.
But given the international nature of the crash and its depth,
hardly anyone accepts these explanations. Most people also agree
that it is impossible to explain rationally the radical price changes
that have occurred at other times—whether the 1929 crash, the 1989
break, or the general 1990s and 2000s volatility. Market frenzy simply
cannot be explained using EMT but is a product of a complex of
forces in addition to actual changes in information about fundamental
business values.
Market frenzies like these are not isolated and certainly not
unique episodes in financial history. On the contrary, market bubbles—
situations in which prices are way higher than values—happen
all too often. There was a technology stockbubble from 1959 to 1961;
a bubble in the so-called ‘Nifty Fifty’ stocks in the late 1960s and
early 1970s; a gambling stockbubble in 1978; a bubble in oil and
energy stocks in the late 1970s; a home shopping bubble in 1986 and
1987; and a biotechnology bubble in the early 1990s (with a resurgence
in the early 2000s), and all of these resemble the Internet or
dot-com bubble of the late 1990s and early 2000s.
The market capitalization (price times shares outstanding) of the
Internet sector was about $1 trillion at the beginning of 2000, with
sales of $30 billion and losses of $3 billion.5 In 1999, scores of initial
Mr. Market’s Bipolar Disorder 9
public offerings (IPOs) of Internet stocks were launched, many in
the same industry where it is going to be impossible to have more
than a handful of profitable companies. Deals included, for example,
17 health-care related companies, seven business-to-business
e-commerce companies, six music distribution companies, five employee
recruiters, and three travel agencies. It starts to sound like
the “Twelve Days of Christmas.”
Driving this funding is the fascination with technological innovation,
a fascination that characterized previous market bubbles as
well. The 1960s technology bubble arose from innovations such as
color television and commercial jet aviation. It spawned an IPO
boom in electronics and other businesses whose names ended with
“tron” or “onics” not unlike that of 1999’s dot-com boom.6 Takeovers
surged in both periods, fueled by high-priced stockthat built many
corporate empires. All the talkwas of a new history-defying era—
called a “new paradigm” in the 1960s and the “new economy” in the
late 1990s and early 2000s. But as Warren Buffett quotes Herb Stein
as saying, “If something can’t go on forever, it will end.”7
The Internet bubble may not end as abruptly as the 1960s electronics
bubble did. It may instead follow the path of the stockmark et
bubble in Japan in the 1980s, which ended in a gradual and total
erosion of stock prices in the Nikkei average throughout the decade
of the 1990s. One thing the two periods have in common—and one
of the most striking common features of speculative bubbles generally—
is the emergence of “new” ways to defend the high prices.
In 1980s Japan the fuel was stockprices based not on the earnings
or cash that can be generated by a business, but on underlying
asset values the businesses owned, which themselves had been rising
to the stratosphere as a result of aggressive real estate speculation.
We’ll soon see that the same alchemy plagues the turn of the twentyfirst-
century United States.
These examples merely manifest in U.S. stockmark ets the emotional
drives inherent in human market making, exemplified more
generally not only by the 1980s Japanese experience but by classic
episodes of bipolar disorder such as the Dutch tulip bulb mania of
the 1630s and the British South Sea exuberance just prior to 1720.
In each of those cases—as in most others—the initial reason to buy
may have been sound. Rare tulip bulbs in Holland were valuable
because the novelty of that flower in Holland turned it into a status
symbol. Shares of Britain’s South Sea Company were valuable when
it began to exercise its royal grant of monopoly trade with Spain.
10 A Tale of Two Markets
But the excitement of “getting in” on these deals got out of hand,
more and more money was allocated to futures contracts on tulip
bulbs and shares of the South Sea Company, and the more money
that was led there, the more money seemed to follow—until the
music stopped and panic set in. In Holland, the price got so high
that speculators could not afford to pay for the bulbs they had
bought the rights to. In Britain, the company simply did not generate
the great gains from Spanish trade everyone had obviously been expecting.
If EMT were true, the U.S. stockmark ets would be unique
among all markets throughout human history and across the contemporary
globe.8 Consider this selection from the writings of the
market observer Joseph de la Vega from the late 1600s about the
Amsterdam stockexchanges of his day, in the style of a tongue-incheekdialogue
between a merchant and an investor:
Merchant: These stock-exchange people are quite silly, full of instability,
insanity, pride and foolishness. They will sell
without knowing the motive; they will buy without
reason.
Investor: They are very clever in inventing reasons for a rise in the
price of the shares on occasions when there is a declining
tendency, or for a fall in the midst of a boom. It is particularly
worth remarking that in this gambling hell there
are two classes of speculators. The first class consists of
the bulls. The second faction consists of the bears. The
bulls are like the giraffe which is scared by nothing. They
love everything, they praise everything, they exaggerate
everything. They are not impressed by a fire or disturbed
by a debacle. The bears, on the contrary, are completely
ruled by fear, trepidation, and nervousness. Rabbits become
elephants, brawls in a tavern become rebellions,
faint shadows appear to them as signs of chaos. The fall
of prices need not have a limit, and there are also unlimited
possibilities for the rise. Therefore the excessively
high values need not alarm you.9
Sound familiar? Why, apart from hubris and chutzpah, should
we believe the U.S. stockmark ets are so special in the history of the
world?
Mr. Market’s Bipolar Disorder 11
BE AN ANOMALY
EMT also cannot explain many other things about how market prices
operate apart from swings, bubbles, and crashes. Abundant evidence
refuting EMT includes the extraordinary number of unexplained
market phenomena, such as the following:
• The January effect (prices tend to rise in January).
• The insider effect (a stock’s price tends to rise after insiders disclose
purchases to the Securities and Exchange Commission and
fall after insider sales are disclosed).
• The value line effect (stocks rated highly by the Value Line Investment
Survey tend to outperform the market in terms of price).
• The analyst effect (stocks of companies followed by fewer analysts
tend to become pricier compared to those followed by more analysts).
• The month effect (stockprices tend to rise at the end and the
beginning of months).
• The weekend effect (stock prices tend to be lower on Mondays
and higher on Fridays).
Weirder correlations also exist, including the hemline indicator
(prices historically have risen and fallen in tandem with rises and
falls in the average length of skirts in fashion) and the Super Bowl
effect (prices tend to rise in the period after the Super Bowl if the
winning team was a member of the original National Football
League but fall otherwise).
Efficiency buffs call these and dozens of other well-known
exhibits against market efficiency “anomalies.” Some anomalies disappear
over time. The January effect began to do so in the mid-
1980s. When they do, EMT worshipers rejoice, citing the disappearance
as evidence of market efficiency. This is strange evidence,
however, when you note that the vanished anomalies persisted for
decades (seven decades in the case of the January effect).
Even more bizarre, the anomaly label has been applied to the
astonishing investing records of many prominent stockpick ers, a list
that is long and getting longer. It includes Ben Graham; Warren
Buffett; Charlie Munger, vice chairman of Berkshire Hathaway; John
Maynard Keynes; Bernard Baruch; Gerald Loeb; John Neff of the
12 A Tale of Two Markets
Windsor Fund (Vanguard); Mario Gabelli; David Schafer; William
Ruane and Richard Cuniff of the Sequoia Fund; Tom Knapp of
Tweedy Browne; John Templeton; Mason Hawkins of Longleaf Partner
Funds; and untold others.
BARREL OF MONKEYS?
Can it be, as EMT devotees resort to saying, that these are anomalies
too—that these folks are all merely lucky? Is it plausible to believe
that they are just like the imaginary monkey who would produce the
entire script of Hamlet by randomly hitting the typewriter keys? Even
if you agree that this is possible, to complete the argument the imaginary
monkey would also have to be able to punch in the correct
keys to generate the full scripts of Romeo and Juliet, Macbeth, King
Lear, Henry IV, and pretty much the entire Shakespearean canon.
Even if this is theoretically possible, such a prolific monkey (or a
barrel of monkeys) seems incredible.
The monkey view acknowledges that luck plays a role in investing,
as it does in other aspects of life. The leading populist apostle
of this “lucky monkey” viewpoint is the Princeton professor Burton
Malkiel, who explains it in his book A Random Walk Down Wall
Street by using a coin-flipping contest.10
Start with a thousand people flipping a coin, with those flipping
heads being the winners and going to the next round. By the laws
of chance, on average 500 will flip heads and 500 will flip tails. The
500 flipping heads proceed to round two, where, again by the laws
of chance, half will flip heads and half will flip tails. The 250 lucky
heads flippers go to round three, where 125 of them win; 63 of those
win round four; 31 win round five; 16 win round six; and 8 win the
final round and are proclaimed “expert” coin flippers.
Yet resorting to luckas an explanation of investment success
leaves the explanation incomplete. First, investing is simply not like
coin flipping, though speculation and gambling may be. The great
investors do some homeworkand develop a set of investment precepts
to guide them in their selection of investments. They don’t
simply flip a coin in choosing which investments to make. They
certainly do not decide between, say, IBM and Clorox by pasting
their logos onto a coin, with the logo landing face up getting the
capital.
Second, the lucky monkey would have to have been banging on
Mr. Market’s Bipolar Disorder 13
his keys every day for decades, much as a day trader would have to
clickhis mouse every day for decades. But the great investors have
not followed the daily trading strategy. On the contrary.
Buffett, for example, generated most of the billions of wealth
Berkshire Hathaway has accumulated from about ten investments
over about forty years. Many of those billions came from buying big
stakes in large companies at times when their value was woefully
underappreciated by the market.
Berkshire bought its stake in the Washington Post Company, for
example, in mid-1973.11 Not only had the Post’s own stockprice been
battered by the Nixon White House’s excoriation of its investigative
reporting on Watergate, that was one of the few times in postwar
American history that the U.S. stockmark et resembled its dismal
stance during the Depression. Buffett’s purchase price? About a fifth
of intrinsic value, an 80% margin of safety. Luckplays a major role
in a day trader’s portfolio; discipline plays an obvious role in Berkshire’s.
Luckis an inadequate though often partial explanation for any
human endeavor that entails effort. Those who succeed in their endeavors
catch butterflies not by luckalone but with the help of an
expertly cast net. Ben Graham drew a fine linkbetween luck and
work by saying that “one lucky break, or one supremely shrewd decision—
can we tell them apart?—may count for more than a lifetime
of journeyman efforts. But behind the luck, or the crucial decision,
there must usually exist a background of preparation and disciplined
capacity.”12
Whether they are characterized as value investors, growth investors,
fundamental investors, opportunistic investors, or anything
else, commonsense discipline is the unifying trait of all the superinvestors
who make up this barrel of monkeys. It is true that Keynes
and Loeb are associated with the “skittish” school of investing, an
opportunistic strategy that rapidly exploits market gyrations fueled
by alternating bouts of fear and greed. Their short-termism contrasts
with the long-term views of the “value” school associated with Graham
and Buffett, yet both schools recognize the price-value discrepancy
that these alternating bouts of Mr. Market’s bipolar disorder
create.
All these stellar investors—and many others, such as JackBogle,
Phil Carret, Phil Fisher, Peter Lynch, the Prices (Michael and T.
Rowe), and George Soros—succeed by exercising common sense.
The “systems” or “formulas” employed or the labels given to them
14 A Tale of Two Markets
are not important, but the quality of their analysis and the independence
of their thought and judgment are.
The best investors employ a mind-set that takes account of just
a few things, but those things are indispensable. Every extraordinary
investor follows Ben Graham’s first principle: The market does not
perfectly price the business value of a stock. Warren Buffett takes
that insight dead seriously by limiting his purchases to stocks that
are way underpriced by the market. Both of these investment titans
as well as Phil Carret emphasize the importance of avoiding bad
deals, stocks that are way overpriced in the market.
These investors and other greats, such as Buffett’s partner Charlie
Munger, always remember that there are tens of thousands of
investment options available to just about anyone. To opt for one
requires a strong belief that the market is giving the best deal available
compared to all the others. And opportunity does knock. One
way to test opportunity is to take Loeb’s approach: always ask
whether you would be comfortable committing a large portion of
your resources to a single stockyou are considering.
Buffett and other outstanding investors, including Peter Lynch,
know that an intelligent appraisal depends on your ability to understand
a business. This gives you a basis for gauging points all these
top investors consider crucial, such as a company’s competitive
strength, brand power, and ability to develop new products profitably.
The investment giants (not monkeys) don’t worry much about
whether their investments end up concentrated in certain companies.
For example John Neff, the portfolio manager of the Windsor
Fund from 1964 through 1995, generated returns exceeding the average
by a steady 3% annually and did so while sometimes allocating
as much as 40% of the fund into a single business sector. Buffett’s
Berkshire Hathaway is a wonderfully diverse collection of outstanding
businesses, but that diversity was an accidental by-product of the
tremendous growth in the capital it deployed rather than a conscious
effort to participate in lots of different businesses or sectors.
This cast of illustrious investors extends the commonsense understanding
of markets and businesses to the analysis of business
fundamentals. Chief among these factors are economic characteristics
such as strong financial condition, earnings stability and
growth, strong sales and profit margins, and large amounts of internally
generated cash to fund growth as opposed to a continuing
reliance on external financing sources. These investors also pay
attention to the quality and integrity of management, looking for
Mr. Market’s Bipolar Disorder 15
companies which consistently maximize the full potential of a business,
wisely allocate capital, and channel the rewards of this success
to shareholders. They emphasize the importance of exceptionally
competent managers who own substantial amounts of equity in their
own companies and can rapidly adapt to dynamic business conditions.
They also believe that managerial depth and integrity include
assuring good relations with labor and promoting an entrepreneurial
spirit.
The hedge fund master George Soros summed it up well by saying
that “the prevailing wisdom is that markets are always right; I
assume they are always wrong.” The prevailing wisdom of market
efficiency is one way to view markets. In this view, price changes are
due almost exclusively to changes in fundamental values. Therefore,
a diversified selection of stocks with different pricing behaviors compared
to the overall market makes the most sense. The contrary view
says that lots of price changes occur for nonfundamental reasons.
The goal here is to identify those companies whose prices are below
their business value. This perspective calls for thinking about individual
businesses rather than the overall market.
The next two chapters offer the alternative foundations of these
two competing ways to thinkabout markets. Chapter 2 is a history
of how the efficient market idea came into being. Chapter 3 is an
account of evidence that contradicts EMT on its own terms. If you
are already a skeptic of market efficiency, you can skip these two
chapters as a practical matter (though they contain valuable insights
on the merits of the competing views). If you are an efficiency devotee,
you should read them and be prepared to change your mind.
Either way, Chapter 4 assesses the current environment for clues
concerning whether the direction in which we are heading is better
described by the efficient market idea or by what might be called
the “chaotic” market idea. It finds that we are heading toward less
rather than more efficient markets. The rest of the book adopts the
view of the investment masters that stockmark ets are not perfectly
efficient and provides the equipment you need to take advantage of
the inefficiencies.
This page intentionally left blank.
17
C h a p t e r 2
PROZAC MARKET
Along and interesting story lies behind the ever-popular efficient
market theory, a story every investor should know. Knowing the
EMT story will enable you to evaluate advice based on it, including
advice about the value of diversification and ways of measuring risk.
It will also help you decide for yourself whether to believe EMT.
That is important because if you believe in market efficiency, you
will adopt a style and philosophy of investing very different from the
one you will be smart to adopt if you do not.
Investors who have already concluded that EMT is not the best
account of how stockmark ets workcould skip this chapter without
being cheated, but even they may discover ways in which EMT has
unwittingly affected their investing habits. All readers will also discover
that the history of EMT is fascinating. It is a story about research
designed to enlarge knowledge, to explain and understand the
world, research whose results are intermittently neglected and then
overblown. The story tells us that EMT is not the last word on how
stock markets work, even though the power it has had over investors
and teachers for several decades sometimes makes it seem that people
thinkit is the last word.1
OBSCURITY
EMT traces its history to the random walkmodel of stockprices,
the sensible idea that stockprices move in a way that cannot be
predicted with any systematic accuracy. The model dates backto
1900, when it was elaborated in a doctoral dissertation by the French
mathematician Louis Bachelier that though obscure in its time is
now famous. That dissertation investigated linear correlation in the
prices of options and futures traded on the French Bourse and concluded
that such price changes behaved according to a random walk
model.2
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
18 A Tale of Two Markets
Bachelier’s workwas not widely noticed when it was published,
perhaps because the mathematical parts of it preceded by five years
Einstein’s famous workon the random motion of colliding gas molecules.
Einstein “discovered” the equation that describes the phenomenon
of random molecular motion, known as Brownian motion
(after the Scottish botanist Robert Brown, who first observed it),
which was precisely the equation Bachelier developed to describe
price behavior in financial markets.
Although the mathematical properties Bachelier employed were
of direct and immediate interest to physicists and mathematicians
(including Einstein and his intellectual progeny), economists paid
little attention to the subject until the middle of the century. Indeed,
virtually no studies before the early 1950s made any reference to
Bachelier’s workor to the theory of random processes in financial
markets.
Maurice Kendall is frequently credited with bringing the random
walkmodel to the attention of economists in the early 1950s. Bachelier’s
workitself, however, was not “discovered” by economists until
they stumbled across it in the mid-1950s.
While rummaging through a library, Leonard Savage of the University
of Chicago happened upon a small bookby Bachelier published
in 1914. He sent postcards to his economist friends asking if
they had “ever heard of this guy.” Paul Samuelson could not find the
bookin MIT’s library but did locate and then read a copy of Bachelier’s
doctoral thesis. Just after Samuelson’s discovery in 1959, the
random walkmodel became a very popular area of research.
Bachelier’s long obscurity was also due to a widely reported 1937
study by the renowned economist Alfred Cowles concluding that
stockprices did move in a predictable way. This study shut down
research on the random walkmodel for decades until in 1960 the
Stanford professor Holbrook Working discovered a mistake in it.
Cowles then corrected the mistake, and his revised study supported
the random walkmodel.
SIMPLICITY
Once Samuelson and his colleagues rediscovered Bachelier, they also
had the great fortune of being able to harness his insights on a large
scale with the advent of the computer age and the widespread availability
at universities and research foundations of high-speed comProzac
Market 19
puters. Using those new technologies in the early 1960s, stockmar -
ket researchers went to work with a vengeance exploring random
processes in these markets.
Correlation Tests
One aspect of the investigation consisted of correlation tests that
were used to determine whether specified data sequences move together
to any degree. In the case of stockprices, price changes of a
given stockare recorded over a specified time period—say, a number
of days—and a subsequent period of the same length. These sequences
(called time-series data) are then compared to determine
whether they move together to any degree—whether they show any
“correlation.”
The comparison takes the form of a correlation coefficient, a
number that reflects the degree to which the data are linearly related.
In effect, the time series of data is tested for correlation by
fitting a straight line to the data and then calculating that number.
A correlation coefficient equal to zero provides evidence that the
data in the series have the property of statistical independence; correlation
coefficients that are close to zero (but not equal to zero)
indicate that the data are uncorrelated. A time series of data is random
if it is either independent or uncorrelated.
Consider televised lottery drawings in which winning lottery
numbers are determined by selecting numbered balls from a bin
containing numerous balls with different numbers painted on them.
The auditor retrieves a ball, records its number, and replaces that
ball. The auditor does this perhaps three times, each time retrieving,
recording, and replacing. This process has the property of statistical
independence because the number recorded after any retrieval indicates
nothing about the numbers recorded either previously or subsequently.
Outside of a controlled context such as a lottery bin, particularly
in the context of time-series data such as stockprices, it is extremely
difficult to prove statistically that a series of data has the property
of statistical independence. The less restrictive property—that data
are uncorrelated—is susceptible to statistical proof and allows for
conclusions substantially similar to those which follow from the independence
property.
The correlation tests of the 1960s all resulted in correlation coefficients
that did not differ significantly from zero. This meant that
20 A Tale of Two Markets
various series of actual stockmark et data were indistinguishable
from various series of numbers generated by a random number table,
roulette wheel, lottery drawing, or another device of chance.
These findings had an important practical implication: Traders
could not systematically make above-normal gains from trading because
a statistical lackof correlation implies that the best estimate
of the future price of a stockis its present price. In other words, if
prices follow a random walk, the price change from one time to the
next will not affect the probability that a particular price change will
follow that one. Past prices cannot predict future prices.
Runs
A long known weakness of correlation tests is that the results can
be skewed by a small number of extraordinary data in the time series.
An alternative test that avoids this weakness is an analysis of runs
in the data—an investigation of whether there is any persistence to
the direction of successive changes.
A run is defined by an absence of directional change in a statistic
in the series. Thus, a new run begins any time the direction changes
(i.e., from negative to positive, from positive to negative, or from
unchanged to either negative or positive).
Instead of testing the correlation of numerical changes in the
data in the series, one investigates the relationship of the direction
of those changes. If price changes follow the random walkmodel,
the number of sequences and reversals in time-series data of stock
prices will be roughly equal. If the same direction persists for a significantly
longer period, the random walkmodel will be contradicted.
Among the numerous run studies conducted in the early 1960s,
the University of Chicago economist Eugene Fama’s is regarded as
the most careful.3 Fama found that the direction of price changes
tended to persist but nevertheless concluded that no trading rule or
strategy could be derived that outperformed the market consistently.
Accordingly, almost everyone involved in the debate in the late 1960s
agreed that the observed departures from randomness were negligible
and believed that this constituted strong support for the random
walkmodel.
Trading Rules
Despite the widespread agreement, some participants in the debate
remained skeptical. Indeed, prescient commentators of that era ocProzac
Market 21
casionally expressed the fear that the interrelationships of stockprice
changes are so complex that standard tools like these cannot reveal
them. That fear led to efforts to dispute the model by designing
trading rules that could achieve above-normal returns by uncovering
and exploiting these greater complexities.
Among the most primitive though most illustrative trading rules
was Sidney Alexander’s “filter technique.” This is a strategy designed
to discern and exploit assumed trends in stockprices that, in Alexander’s
piquant phrase, may be “masked by the jiggling of the market.”
4
For instance, a “5% filter rule” for a stockwould say to buy it
when the price goes up 5% (and watch it rise to a higher peak); then
sell it when the price goes down 5% from that peak(and watch it
fall to a lower trough); then short the stock(i.e., borrow it and sell
it at the prevailing price, promising to repay with the same stock, to
be purchased for the price prevailing at the time of repayment); then,
when the price rises 5% from that trough, cover the short position.
If this works, you get a gain on the initial sale plus a gain on the
short position. More important, if it works, prices are following a
peak-trough pattern. That means they are not random and the random
walkmodel is contradicted.
Alexander’s initial results indicated that such a technique could
produce above-normal returns. Subsequent refinements of Alexander’s
workby himself and others, including Fama, however, demonstrated
that relaxing or changing certain assumptions eliminated
the abnormal returns, particularly the original filter technique’s failure
to note that dividends are a cost rather than a benefit when
stocks are sold short.
Alexander’s filter technique epitomizes the chartist or technical
approach to stockanalysis and trading, under which a study of past
prices (or other data) is used as a basis for predicting future prices.
Indeed, Alexander’s filter technique is a conceptual cousin of limit
orders and similar techniques prevalent in securities trading today.
These techniques include conventional technical methods that rely
on anomaly effects (the insider, month, weekend, and analyst effects)
as well as the more unconventional methods (the hemline
indicator, the Super Bowl indicator, and so on).
These and related philosophies such as “momentum investing”
and “sector rotation” remain staples of Wall Street futurology. They
are widely and increasingly used by traders and recommended by
investment advisers and brokers. They are nonsense, as many stu22
A Tale of Two Markets
dents of the random walkmodel (and EMT) recognize based on the
foregoing analysis.
They are nonsense not because of EMT but because they fly in
the face of business analysis. As Ben Graham said of proponents of
such technical methods in The Intelligent Investor: “We shall dismiss
these with the observation that their workdoes not concern ‘investors’
as the term is used in this book.”5
On their own terms, the trouble with all these tests of the random
walkis that they are linear. They do not investigate the presence
of nonlinear price dependence, something that in the early 1960s
researchers simply lacked the computer horsepower to do.
The trading rule test, for example, is linear in that it operates in
chronological time (or real time). Neither it nor the other old tests
consider the possibility that market time may be better understood
from a perspective that is nonlinear. We will get to that subject in
the next chapter, but for now note that Einstein demonstrated that
time is not absolute but works in dozens of different ways depending
on the context, including forward (or linear), backward, circular,
slow, and erratic (nonlinear), and can even stand still.
THE PERFECT DREAM
Many people suggest that EMT developed in a peculiar manner in
scientific research. The proof of the hypothesis came first, beginning
with Bachelier in 1900 and proceeding through the wealth of studies
reporting randomness in the early 1960s.
Only then was a theory proposed to explain the randomness,
beginning with the first explication of EMT in 1965 by Paul Samuelson,
a recipient of the Nobel Prize in economics in 1970.6 Economists
welcomed this proof. The conditions necessary to produce it
seemed tantalizingly close to those necessary to sustain every economist’s
dream: a perfect market.
The perfect market is a heuristic invented by making the following
assumptions concerning a market: There are a large number of
participants such that the actions of any individual participant cannot
materially affect the market; participants are fully informed, have
equal access to the market, and act rationally; the commodity is
homogeneous; and there are no transaction costs.
A perfect market would give you exactly what the random walk
Prozac Market 23
model was implying: Prices of shares in stockmark ets should adjust
instantaneously and accurately to new information concerning them.
That prediction was embodied in EMT as it was first propounded.
In its broadest terms, EMT said that the prices of shares traded in
stockmark ets fully reflect all information concerning those shares.
Stockmark ets may or may not have the characteristics assumed
by the perfect market model. As the 1976 Nobel laureate Milton
Friedman reminds us, however, the cardinal rule of economic forecasting
is that a model’s predictive power is the only relevant test of
its validity, not the assumptions underlying it.7 Thus, the fact that
investors are not rational or fully informed, for example, does not
matter as long as these realities do not interfere with the predictive
power of EMT. While many economists are reconsidering assumptions
like these, for now this approach holds sway over accepted
economic theory.
Three Forms of Efficiency
In its general form, EMT explains more than the random walk
model. That model says simply that successive price changes are
independent or uncorrelated, whereas EMT explains that by saying
that stockprices fully reflect all the information (not just price histories)
about a stock. As a result, virtually since the emergence of
EMT as an explanation of the random walkmodel, EMT has been
divided into three forms defined in terms of specified categories of
information.
The three forms were first proposed to classify empirical tests of
price behavior given specified kinds of information. The weak form
tested the random walkmodel itself, using correlation and run tests
like those just described to investigate whether past prices indicate
anything about future prices. Semistrong-form testing investigated
whether publicly available information other than prices was reflected
in prevailing prices, and strong-form testing investigated
whether private information was reflected in prevailing prices.
As the wealth of tests and discussion proceeded in the 1970s,
the three forms of EMT came to be used to refer to the conclusions
those tests suggested. Thus, the forms of EMT have since then been
specified as follows: The weakform says that stock prices fully reflect
all information consisting of past prices, the semistrong form says
that stockprices fully reflect all information that is currently publicly
24 A Tale of Two Markets
available; and the strong form (hold your breath) says that stock
prices fully reflect all existing information, whether publicly available
or not.
There is thus a direct and logical linkbetween the random walk
model and weak-form efficiency but a more attenuated and contingent
linkbetween the random walkmodel and stronger forms of
EMT. Recall that the random walkmodel holds that price changes
are independent of or uncorrelated with prior price changes. That
means that technical analysis of past price changes—sometimes
called chartist analysis—cannot aid the prediction of future price
changes in any systematic way.
Weak-form efficiency explains this independence and its implications
for prediction by hypothesizing that the current price impounds
all information contained in prior prices. Thus, any price
change can only be the result of new information, the production of
which is itself assumed to be random. This process of information
absorption continues and thus explains the absence of substantial
linear dependence in successive price changes discovered in the correlation
and run tests of the 1960s. It also leads to the stronger forms
of the hypothesis.
The semistrong form of EMT posits not only that current stock
prices reflect all information consisting of prior stockprices but also
that they reflect all publicly available information about the stockin
question. Testing this more ambitious claim requires a focus not on
correlation analysis of price changes but on the relative swiftness
with which prices change given new information.
Despite this different testing methodology, semistrong efficiency
depends on the validity of the random walkmodel, which depends
in turn on empirical conclusions concerning the absence of statistical
dependence in stockprice data. In other words, if future price
changes depend on prior price changes, any price change the semistrong
form tests cannot be attributable solely to the new information
the test is evaluating. Thus, both weakefficiency and semistrong
efficiency depend on the proof provided by linear testing
models.
The strong form of EMT extends much farther than the random
walkmodel suggested. Indeed, the strong form is a theological proposition,
holding that public capital markets are infinitely wise: even
nonpublic information is reflected in public stockprices. Abundant
evidence has decimated the strong form by showing that people who
possess nonpublic information can use it to make abnormally high
Prozac Market 25
market returns, with the apotheosis being the insider trading scandals
of the 1980s.
Since the strong form of EMT has been discredited, debate concerning
EMT centers on the semistrong and weakforms. Debate
over the weakform generally is defined by analysis of the random
walkmodel itself, usually in terms of the linear empirical models
used to test the relationship between successive price changes; this
has cut into the random walkmodel.
A widely noted study by MIT’s Andrew Lo and Wharton’s A.
Craig MacKinlay demonstrated strong positive serial correlation in
stockprices for weekly and monthly holding period returns. Using
1,216 weekly stock return observations from 1962 to 1985, they found
a weekly correlation coefficient of 30%, an extremely high level of
correlation. These researchers point out in their book, A Non-
Random Walk Down Wall Street, that this does not mean necessarily
that the stockmark et is inefficient but that the random walk model
cannot be the basis for any theory of efficiency.8
Though not conclusive, evidence like this led even Eugene
Fama—a chief architect of EMT—to conclude that daily and weekly
stockreturns are predictable from past returns, thus rejecting the
random walkmodel on a statistical basis.9 Even so, Fama and the
other fathers of EMT cling to the view that such discrepancies are
merely anomalies that do not impair the basic model’s validity,
though others try to explain these results in a different way called
noise.
Noise
Consider John Maynard Keynes’s well-known beauty contest metaphor
for the stock market. In the contest, each judge picks the candidate
he or she thinks others will pick rather than the candidate he
or she thinks should win on merit. This replaces a fundamental or
substantive sort of analysis (of the kind urged in this book) with a
popular, speculative, and herd-packmentality .
The 1981 Nobel laureate James Tobin of Yale tookKeynes’s
beauty contest a step farther. He suggested that even if a public
capital market is efficient in the sense of swiftly incorporating public
information into stockprices (i.e., the semistrong form of EMT),
that does not necessarily mean that stockprices in that market reflect
fundamental values (i.e., the present value of expected future
flows to stockholders).10
26 A Tale of Two Markets
The quality of information digested by the market may be just
as low as the quality of information that goes into the decisions of
Keynes’s beauty contest judges. Tobin has many followers who think
he’s right, including Nobel Prize winnersWilliam F. Sharpe and Kenneth
Arrow of Stanford.11 If it is true that many traders act as Keynes
described, the semistrong form of EMT has to be further subdivided
between strict informational efficiency and a more refined notion of
fundamental efficiency.
Informational efficiency describes a market in which all public
information about a stockis reflected in the price of that stock without
regard to the quality of that information. Thus, information that
concerns the fundamental value of a stockis reflected, but so is
information wholly unrelated to that fundamental value, such as who
won the Super Bowl. Fundamental efficiency is the more narrow but
more ambitious idea that stockprices are accurate indicators of intrinsic
value because they reflect only information concerning fundamental
business values.12
The issue becomes whether the capital markets can distinguish
among kinds of information so that only information about fundamental
value is impounded and reflected in prices. That revives the
basic question of whether humans behave rationally. EMT says it
does not matter if individual actions are not rational because any
individual irrationality will be corrected by others acting rationally.
In effect, irrationally is “assumed out” of the EMT model.
The informational-fundamental distinction, however, is so intuitively
and empirically potent that it had to be confronted. The result
was the face-saving shelter of euphemism: The economist Fischer
Black, borrowing a term from the field of statistics, renamed irrational
behavior noise, thus enabling self-respecting economists to
discuss the issue and try to model it.13
Noise theory is supported by substantial empirical evidence and
a well-developed intellectual foundation. Noise theory models hold
that stockmark ets are infected by a substantial volume of trading
based on information unrelated to fundamental asset values (noise
trading). These models attempt to explain both why noise trading
occurs and why its effects persist.
The most common noise theory model says, for example, that
noise trading is conducted by ill-informed investors who act on sentiment
rather than rational analysis. Their actions move prices away
from fundamental values. The price-value gap persists despite the
presence of sophisticated arbitrageurs because they are risk-averse
Prozac Market 27
and cannot be sure that investor sentiment will not change adversely
at any time.14
Evidence of the noisy investor approach to the stockmark et includes
following tips or acting on rumors, rapidly turning over one’s
portfolio, selling good performers while retaining bad ones (thus triggering
taxable gains rather than generating tax-deductible losses),
paying huge mutual fund fees for poor managerial performance, and
imitating others in running off market cliffs by using silly technical
trading strategies.
The causes of this behavior remain poorly understood, but psychological
research suggests a number of tendencies. These tendencies
include attitudes toward riskthat lead people to be more averse
to loss than eager for gain; this explains the irrational tendency to
hold losing stocks while selling winning stocks. Another is skewing
the probabilities of uncertain future events by basing forecasts on
past patterns, such as by forecasting that earnings growth over the
next ten years will equal that of the last three.
In theory, smart money arbitrageurs could correct all these errors
and profit from them, keeping EMT intact. But this is a risky business.
If there is mispricing today, there may be mispricing tomorrow.
If stocks are highly priced compared to value, an arbitrageur will sell
short and await the correction. But the correction may not arrive
before she has to cover. If stocks are lowly priced compared to value,
an arb will buy and await the rise. But that correction could take a
long time, during which those funds could be deployed at higher
returns elsewhere.
Another possibility is that individual actions that are rational can
produce aggregate results that are irrational. This happens all the
time in business. After air-conditioning was invented, for example,
retail stores spent substantial sums to install it, but once every store
did this, none of them enjoyed any competitive advantage as a result.
It is why you see a gas station at every corner of a suburban intersection.
Buffett gives the example of what occurs when each person
watching a parade decides he or she can see a little better by standing
on tiptoe.
Despite these profound insights developed at the frontiers of
thought about how markets work, they continue to be treated by
many leading economists as variations on the theme. Maybe there
is some deviation in EMT, its devotees admit, but the deviations are
due to mere chance. Eugene Fama, for example, continues to argue
that apparent overreaction to information is just as common as ap28
A Tale of Two Markets
parent underreaction to information, and the likelihood of abnormal
returns continuing after an event are about as likely as those returns
reversing after that event.
Thus, a whole group of leading economists thinks that the latest
evidence against EMT does not add up to much. They cling to investment
tools that are based on EMT and used to complete the
theoretical picture with practical applications.
TIDYING UP THE TALE
EMT tells us that specified information sets are fully reflected in
the price of public securities. EMT, however, does not provide any
basis for determining what it means for any such information to be
fully reflected in stockprices. Doing this requires a theory of asset
pricing. It is composed of two popular ideas: modern portfolio theory,
which provides the foundation, and the capital asset pricing model,
which is the general paradigm.
Modern Portfolio Theory
While the random walkmodel and EMT were being developed in
the 1950s and 1960s, Harry Markowitz of the City University of New
Yorkand yet another Nobel Prize recipient (in 1990, along with
Sharpe) was developing modern portfolio theory (MPT).15 The basic
idea here is that combining a group of noncorrelated stocks in a
single portfolio results in a portfolio with less volatility than the average
volatility of those individual stocks.
MPT proposes that all investments are reducible to two elements—
riskand return—and assumes that investors are risk-averse
in the sense that they will sacrifice returns to avoid riskand demand
greater returns to assume risk. MPT says that such investors will
best address their riskaversion by investing in a portfolio of investments
in which they receive the greatest expected return for any
given level of risk.
The expected return on an investment is simply the weighted
average of all possible returns on it, and the riskof an investment
is the dispersion of possible returns on that investment around the
expected return. Under MPT, expected return on a portfolio of investments
is simply the weighted sum of the expected returns on the
individual investments; the risk, however, of a portfolio of investProzac
Market 29
ments is not necessarily the weighted sum of the risks (or dispersion
in the returns) of the individual investments.
The central insight of MPT is thus that since variations in returns
on individual investments may reduce the dispersion of returns
on a portfolio of investments, portfolio riskis primarily a function
of the degree of variance of individual investments compared to the
portfolio as a whole. This means that portfolio riskis minimized
through portfolio diversification.
MPT’s understanding of riskhas another important implication.
With respect to any stock, two elements of risk can be distinguished:
systematic riskand unsystematic risk. Systematic risk (also sometimes
called market risk or undiversifiable risk) arises from the tendency
of a stockto vary as the market in which it is traded varies.
Unsystematic risk (also sometimes called unique risk, residual risk,
specific risk, or diversifiable risk) arises from the peculiarities of the
particular stockbeing investigated.
Because under MPT’s diversification directive unsystematic risks
can be diversified away to zero, market returns on a stock in a competitive
market will not include any compensation for such risk.
Thus, market returns will be a function solely of the systematic risk,
or the extent to which a particular stockvaries as the market of
which it is a part varies. Measuring such riskand return is the main
goal of capital asset pricing models.
The Capital Asset Pricing Model
As MPT and EMT were maturing in the late 1960s, capital asset
pricing theory was in its infancy. The capital asset pricing model
(CAPM) that is most widely known today derives from MPT (and
was pretty much invented by Markowitz’s co-Nobelist, Sharpe).16
Like MPT, CAPM assumes that investors are risk-averse in the sense
just described. In addition, CAPM assumes that investors have rational
expectations concerning expected returns. Under this assumption,
CAPM says that the expected return on an investment is equal
to the risk-free rate of return plus compensation for the systematic
riskof the investment in the sense just described.
The systematic riskis measured by the degree of variability of
the individual investment versus the market as a whole. It relates
the riskpremium associated with a particular stock (its return less
the risk-free return) to that associated with the market as a whole.
That association for any stockis expressed by a number called
30 A Tale of Two Markets
the stock’s ß (beta). Under CAPM, stocks with higher ß’s are more
risky than are stocks with lower ß’s because they tend to swing more
widely than does the market—their returns exhibit greater dispersion
versus market returns.
Critique and Common Sense
On their own terms, there are several weaknesses in MPT and
CAPM. First, in evaluating EMT, the need for a pricing model creates
a joint hypothesis problem: No one can ever be sure in testing
a model whether its failure is due to market inefficiency or to an
inadequately specified asset pricing model.
Indeed, many of the anomalies in EMT mentioned earlier are
attributed to deficiencies in the asset pricing model rather than to
the presence of market inefficiency. These deficiencies are most often
associated with imprecision in defining riskor , equivalently, in
specifying ß.
The joint hypothesis problem has an important implication for
EMT skeptics. To disprove EMT requires proof that does not use an
asset pricing model. However, any linear or nonlinear dependence
in stockprice behavior is inconsistent with EMT itself. Thus, a discovery
of linear or nonlinear dependence in successive stockprices
(presented in the next chapter) means EMT is incomplete, period.
It does not admit the alternative explanation of a “misspecified” asset
pricing model.
In addition, CAPM says that expected returns from an investment
are linearly related to expected returns on the portfolio of
which that investment is a part. The linear relationship is given by
ß and is in turn dictated by CAPM’s rational-expectations assumption.
If human behavior is itself inconsistent with the rationalexpectations
assumption, there is no reason to believe in such a
linear relationship. This is another way of saying that the stockmar -
ket is nonlinear rather than linear. In that case, ß will not be an
accurate measure of risk.
Finally, the rational-expectations assumption used in the CAPM
requires that investors have homogeneous return expectations; this
in turn requires that investors evaluate and understand information
in identical ways. Heroic as that sounds, it would also require all
investors to evaluate investment opportunities over identical time
Prozac Market 31
horizons. The patent dubiousness of these requirements recently has
become an important aspect of the literature criticizing CAPM.
The literature demonstrates that demand for particular stocks is
sensitive to price changes, just like demand for most other goods.17
Investors have different appetites for particular stocks as their prices
change. Thus, markets do not depict the right price of a stock because
there is no such thing. Even rational people are not homogeneous
automatons; they interpret information differently, and their
judgment about the present value of a business’s future cash flows
will vary even if they are all rational.
As Francis Fukuyama has pointed out in another context, the
neoclassical economic model of rational self-interested behavior with
which EMT is ultimately linked is right only about 80% of the time.18
Its devotees forget Adam Smith, the father of their thought, who
emphasized that economic life is embedded in social life and that
economic actors make decisions that vary from pure economic calculus
as a result of social habits and contexts. That is why in Smith’s
day his field was called “political economy” rather than, as it is today,
simply “economics.”
If the rest of social science should be returned to economics, it
is even possible to add some physics from the hard sciences. Recall
that the random walkmodel got that name because public capital
markets seemed to obey the principles of Brownian motion, which
specify that molecules in motion behave randomly. Although molecules
lacksentience, prices are strictly creatures of the ultimate sentience,
human behavior.
Common sense thus suggests that the price-molecule parallel
should not hold. More powerfully, current thought in physics concerning
nonlinear dynamics and chaos theory extends well beyond
Brownian motion and suggests further reasons to doubt and reconsider
the validity of the analogy.
The next chapter shows how that analogy has been turned upside
down and inside out. Before going on, though, pause to consider
whether common sense supports ß as a measure of risk. What ß
really measures is the price volatility of a stock. If you insist on
associating the word “risk” with that measure, it at most means that
ß captures the riskof stockprice gyrations. For a market analyst,
that measurement may be of some interest.
But for a business analyst, price gyrations are useless analytic
tools, and so therefore is ß. What matters in business analysis might
be called “business volatility,” the gyrations in earnings or cash flows
32 A Tale of Two Markets
a business has experienced as grounds for gauging its future business
performance. The earnings and cash flows are what give a business
value and what are of interest; market prices do not, and ß is
therefore of no interest to a business analyst.
As the vogue of mathematical investing approaches raged in the
late 1960s, Ben Graham declared that treating volatility in price
changes as the meaning of riskis “more harmful than useful for
sound investment decisions because it places too much emphasis on
market fluctuations.”19 EMT sought to neutralize that objection by
saying that market fluctuations were simply rational price changes
reflecting information changes. Just so. Yet some things are not that
simple. Charlie Munger is fond of quoting Einstein on this point:
Everything should be made as simple as possible, but no more so.20
Graham continues to be right.
33
C h a p t e r 3
CHAOTIC MARKET
Today’s investor can learn something from the elite group of Nobel
Prize winners who brought us the “modern finance” summarized
in the last chapter, but way less than is commonly believed.
Although few informed students of EMT ever had great confidence
in the strong form, the more modest forms—plus modern portfolio
theory and beta (ß)—have held sway over academic and popular
investment thinking for nearly three decades.
Those hypotheses are based exclusively on simple linear analysis
and thought, however, and so their descriptive power and normative
implications are questionable. As in all fields of endeavor, knowledge
continues to advance. Technology has enabled better ways to model
market behavior than were available when EMT and the rest of modern
finance were growing up. The new technology shows quite different
results than did the old, results that confirm the commonsense
intuitions behind Ben Graham’s Mr. Market.1
NEW WAVE
The presence of noise in stockmark et trading shows the inadequacy
of the linear testing models that led to the random walkmodel and
EMT. Noise theory shows that the information-processing properties
of public capital markets are so bluntly powerful that fundamental
information about underlying business values is crowded out by extraneous
information or noise. There is a feedbacksystem in which
individuals overreact to information or withhold action in the face
of information.
Feedbackprocesses are the hallmarks of a nonlinear system.
They indicate a nonproportional relationship between a cause and
its effect (e.g., between news and price changes). This insight of
noise theory has not been recognized for its full power. The distinction
between linear and nonlinear is fundamental to an understand-
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
34 A Tale of Two Markets
ing of stockmark et behavior and how investors and managers should
think about markets and market prices.
Linearity means proportionality: A change in one variable produces
a proportionate change in another specified variable. What
makes the CAPM linear, for example, is its assertion that the expected
riskpremium of a stockvaries in direct proportion to ß.
EMT is linear in two ways. First, the statistical models underlying
the weakform are simple linear regression analyses; correlation
coefficients are statements about how variables are related on a
straight-line basis over time. In other words, the time series of data
is tested for correlation by fitting a straight line to the data and then
calculating the correlation coefficient.
Second, the semistrong form of EMT is linear because it defines
a proportional relationship between information changes and price
changes. In particular, the semistrong form says that information is
swiftly incorporated into prices without bias. In other words, there
is a proportional relationship between information changes about
business values and resulting price changes in the financial asset
(stocks) representing those businesses.
In contrast and a bit simplistically, nonlinearity means the absence
of proportionality: Changes in one variable will produce a
change in another variable, but exponentially rather than proportionally.
To take a prosaic example, the 1-gram straw that breaks the
1-ton camel’s backis nonlinear because the cause is utterly disproportionate
to the effect.
Volatile stockprices and roaring or crashing markets are often
attributable to an incremental bit of information piled on top of
cumulated bits of information. If one company announces that its
earnings aren’t going to be as strong as people had hoped, its stock
price may take a haircut, but the market overall may not blush. But
as the weeks go by and a few more companies in that sector say the
same thing, Wall Street gets rattled. The shares of all the stocks in
that sector can suddenly get punished, and the pounding can spread
across the market as a whole. At some point, the creepy Wall Street
saying that there is never only one cockroach starts to resonate.
The fact that the market may react slowly or may overreact to
bits of new information is of course what noise theory teaches and
explains. The distinction between nonlinear and linear systems goes
well beyond noise theory, however, because noise theory itself is constrained
by the efficiency paradigm. Nonlinear dynamics and chaos
theory breakfrom that context and imply a fundamentally different
Chaotic Market 35
understanding of public capital market phenomena with a broader
perspective on investor and market behavior.
There is no a priori reason to believe that public capital markets
are linear systems rather than nonlinear systems. Therefore, one of
the first questions that must be considered in understanding such
markets is whether they follow linear or nonlinear processes. More
sophisticated techniques than were available when the random walk
model was first developed are now used to investigate precisely that
question.
One reason such techniques were unavailable in the 1960s,
1970s, and even early 1980s was the need for powerful computer
systems that not only could process data more swiftly but also could
go beyond the simplified mathematical models of straight lines and
investigate the curvatures of multidimensional data streams. Armed
with such resources, researchers now start with the consensus view
that empirical research shows that a random walkdescribes stock
prices fairly well, subject to some anomalies. Then they dig deeper.
One tool for the digging actually dates to the early part of the
twentieth century. It was developed by the hydrologist H. E. Hurst
when he was working on the Nile River Dam project.2 Hurst had to
develop reservoir discharge policies to maintain reservoir water levels
in the light of rainfall patterns.
To understand how the reservoir system worked, Hurst would
record its water level each day at noon and calculate the range (essentially
differences between the high and low levels and the average
levels). If the range increased in proportion to the number of observations
recorded, one could conclude that the reservoir system
was a random one. Otherwise, it was nonrandom and exhibited some
pattern, knowing either of which could enable the hydrologist to set
the reservoir’s discharge policies.
Hurst developed a simple tool called the H exponent to determine
whether the range increased as would a random process or
whether it exhibited a more patterned behavior. Skipping the mathematical
details, if a system’s H equals .50, then the system behaves
according to a random walk. The probability that any particular move
will follow any other move is 50-50 and thus completely up to
chance.
If H is less than .50, the system is mean reverting. That means
that if the system has moved up for a number of observations, it is
more likely to move down over the next number of observations, and
vice versa. Conversely, if H is greater than .50, the system is correl36
A Tale of Two Markets
ative or persistent: if the system has moved up for a number of
observations, it is more likely to continue to move up over the next
number of observations, and vice versa. If H is .60, for example, the
probability that a positive move will follow a positive move is 60%.
H may change over time. For example, H may be in the .70s over
some period and then drop to near .50 and subsequently increase
again. The number of observations (or time periods) over which H
is sustained at other than .50 (before returning to near .50) is a
measure of the average cycle length of the system.
In the case where H exceeds .50 for a sustained period, the
length of that period is a measure of the system’s memory—the extent
to which past events influence present and future events. In
the context of investment analysis, it measures the period over which
an investor can use information to his or her advantage.
During the 1990s, some market analysts figured out that the H
exponent can also be applied to markets to determine whether they
are random too. One of them even published his results. Edgar Peters,
a money manager in Boston, applied it to the Standard and
Poor’s 500 Index (the S&P 500) for monthly data over a 38-year
period from January 1950 through July 1988.3
Peters found that H was .78 for average periods of approximately
four years, indicating a strong persistent element in the S&P 500
rather than a random process. Beyond average periods of four years,
however, H was not significantly different from .50 (it was .52/-.02).
So Peters concluded that the S&P 500 begins to lose memory of
events after four years. The S&P 500 thus is not random, and events
today continue to affect price changes for up to an average of four
years.
NEXTW AVE
This dashing of the economist’s dream of a perfect market has been
amplified by studies of the chaotic behavior of markets. Just as
Hurst’s H suggests that markets are not linear as EMT assumes,
EMT’s assumption of market rationality is put into scientific doubt
by principles first developed by physicists in the field of chaos theory.
Chaos theory was popularized by the publication of James
Gleick’s 1987 best-selling book Chaos, primarily an exposition of
chaos in natural science. The potential role of chaos theory in economics
and finance was made prominent by the Santa Fe Institute’s
Chaotic Market 37
publication of a volume in 1988. It has been carried into the realm
of “phynance”—the merger of physics and finance—most spectacularly
by Doyne Farmer and Norman Packard, whose phynance exploits
are chronicled by Thomas Bass in his 1999 book The Predictors.
As a result of these works, chaos theory became an important
and growing field in the study of the nonlinear dynamic behavior of
economic and financial systems.
Through chaos theory, physicists discovered that many phenomena
in the universe previously thought to be random (unpredictable,
exhibiting no pattern) are not random but exhibit a significant pattern.
To oversimplify, chaos theory holds that there is a pattern to
the seeming randomness of physical events occurring in the universe.
Thus, systems that appear to be stochastic (to involve only
random motion or behavior under conventional linear modeling)
may be deterministic, or exhibit more complex internal dependence
than simple linear modeling reveals.
Chaos theory has its roots in the nineteenth-century workof
Henri Poincare´ , a French mathematician and physicist who studied
the famous three-body problem.4 Newton, using his laws of motion
and gravitation, proved that it was possible to calculate accurately
the future positions and velocities of two mutually attractive material
bodies. Neither Newton nor anyone since, however, has been able
to do so for three or more bodies.
This three-body problem reveals itself repeatedly to scientists
sending space probes to Mars and other planets: They chart a course
directed to where the planet will be in its orbit when the probe
arrives (not where the planet is upon sending the probe), but midcourse
corrections are nevertheless necessary because Newtonian
physics can predict accurately only the interaction of two bodies, not
three. (This has led some probes to be lost in space.)
Poincare´ attributed the three-body problem to nonlinearities inherent
in multibody systems as the result of which “small differences
in the initial conditions produce very great ones in the final phenomena.
A small error in the former will produce an enormous error
in the latter.” This insight, now the unifying core of chaos theory, is
known as “sensitive dependence upon initial conditions.”
The classic example of sensitivity to initial conditions is the butterfly
effect in meteorology. Its pioneer in the early 1960s was the
MIT meteorologist Edward Lorenz, who said, “The dynamical equations
governing the weather are so sensitive to the initial data that
whether or not a butterfly flaps its wings in one part of the world
38 A Tale of Two Markets
may make the difference between a tornado occurring or not occurring
in another part of the world.”5
Picture an empty hockey rink. A person places a puck at midice
and then rolls it toward the far end of the rink. He measures the
angle of his hit, the angle of the puck’s impact, and the angle of its
rebound. He keeps measuring the puck’s angles of impact and rebound
as the puckbounces around the rink.
Assuming no friction, a rule of puckmotion in the rinkis that
it will emerge from impacting a side of the rinkat precisely its angle
of approach (a similar thing will be familiar to anyone who has
played billiards). That rule means we have defined a deterministic
system under which the future position of the puckat any time can
be forecast perfectly (assuming its actual or average speed is known).
But now assume that the initial position of the puckis varied by
a few degrees, even an infinitesimally small variation, not observed
by or known to the forecaster. The forecaster’s predictions of the
puck’s location after it hits the first one or two sides may be imprecise—
off by some small amount—but the imprecision will be negligible.
The amount of error will grow exponentially, however, with
each subsequent impact. In a short time the forecast will be wide of
the mark.
Disturbing the measure of the puck’s initial position causes its
movement to appear random and unpredictable, whereas knowing
that measure enables precise prediction. It is this sensitive dependence
on initial conditions that is the signal characteristic of chaotic
systems.6 To detect its presence, Lorenz and his followers developed
a couple of fascinating tools.
Pictures and Attractors
Time-series data are conventionally plotted using simple Cartesian
geometry. For example, to plot a time series of a stock’s price, price
is plotted on the vertical axis and chronological time is plotted on
the horizontal axis.
In physics, the usual Cartesian graphs can be turned into more
powerful pictures called phase portraits plotted in phase space, a
presentation that can depict the full range of possibilities for a system.
The pendulum is the paradigm for illustrating the differences
between Cartesian plots of time-series data and phase portraits of
the same data as well as for introducing the notion of the attractor.
Consider a regularly swinging pendulum driven by mechanical
Chaotic Market 39
FIGURE 3-1 Driven pendulum time series.
force. It will swing backand forth at a steady speed and not come
to rest (unless we withdraw its force). A Cartesian time-series plot
would show such a pendulum’s motion as a wavy up-and-down line
whose height remains the same as time passes, as shown in Figure
3-1.7
The driven pendulum’s portrait in phase space can be envisioned
as a rectangle. At any moment in phase space, the pendulum’s angle
would dictate the location of a point horizontally and the pendulum’s
speed would dictate the location of a point vertically. As such, the
pendulum’s portrait in phase space would form a loop, illustrating
the pendulum’s continual motion through the same sequence of positions
repeatedly, as shown in Figure 3-2. That continual repetition
is described as a limit cycle or a limit cycle attractor because the
pendulum (which can be called a system) is attracted to that one
and only (limit) cycle.
Now consider a pendulum undriven by permanent mechanical
force, having instead been started manually by lifting it to one end
of its orbit and letting it go. Without the permanent mechanical
force, the undriven pendulum will swing backand forth, gradually
reducing speed and coming closer and closer to rest. A Cartesian
time-series plot of this undriven pendulum would begin with the
same wavy up-and-down line depicting the driven pendulum just
40 A Tale of Two Markets
FIGURE 3-2 Driven pendulum phase space: ‘‘limit cycle attractor.’’
described, but this line’s height would fall gradually and continuously
as the pendulum’s speed declined, as shown in Figure 3-3.
This pendulum’s portrait in phase space also would begin as if
it might form a loop, but owing to its declining speed, the plot would
begin to spiral inward continuously as the pendulum slowed down.
Correspondingly, the plot would converge to the origin, as shown in
Figure 3-4. The origin in this case is described as a point attractor
because the pendulum (or system) is attracted to that one and only
point.
Another way to approach the pictures is to conceive of the phase
space as a sideways view of the Cartesian time-series plot. It is in
effect a collapsed side view of the gyrations of the simple time-series
graph.
Keep that picture in mind as you consider a third type of attractor,
which physicists call the strange attractor. The strange attractor
describes a system whose phase portrait will be neither a loop nor a
spiraling circle but instead will show some orbits that appear to be
random: They do not repeat and are not periodic. They are, however,
limited in range. In other words, the portrait will exist in a finite
space but will admit of an infinite number of solutions in that finite
space.
41
FIGURE 3-3 Undriven pendulum time series.
FIGURE 3-4 Undriven pendulum phase space: ‘‘point attractor.’’
42
FIGURE 3-5 Simulated weather system time series.
FIGURE 3-6 Simulated weather system phase space: ‘‘strange
attractor.’’
Chaotic Market 43
Take a look at Figures 3-5 and 3-6. Figure 3-5 depicts the time
series of a simulated weather system, suggesting behavior that is
completely random and resembles typical graphs of stockmark et
prices. Figure 3-6 depicts a phase portrait of the same system, revealing
a strange attractor. Again, lookat Figure 3-6 as a side shot
of the time-series plot in Figure 3-5, condensing that Cartesian figure
into a phase space portrait.
Limit cycle attractors and point cycle attractors do not exhibit
any sensitive dependence on initial conditions: A pendulum without
permanent mechanical force will always end up at the point of origin
(its point attractor) no matter where it started, and a pendulum with
permanent mechanical force will always orbit in its loop (its limit
cycle attractor) no matter where it started.
Systems containing strange attractors do exhibit sensitive dependence
on initial conditions: Where the system is at some future moment
will be determined by where the system started (or by where
it was at any time before).
Stretching
Phase portraits depict all possible states of a system by plotting a
variable’s value against the possible values of all other variables. The
dimension of the phase space is equal to the number of variables
that describe the system. Whether a system exhibits sensitive dependence
on initial conditions can be determined by numbers called
Lyapunov exponents (LEs), named for the Russian mathematician
Aleksandr Lyapunov, who discovered them.8
LEs measure the speed of a variable’s movements in phase space
versus another variable. Positive LEs measure stretching in phase
space—the speed of divergence of one variable with respect to another
variable. Negative LEs measure contracting in phase space—
the speed of system restoration after being perturbed. Thus, LEs for
point attractors and limit cycles never are positive because such systems
are always contracting.
In the case of a point attractor, the dimensions always converge
to a fixed point, the origin; in the case of a limit cycle attractor, all
the dimensions converge into one another except one, whose relative
position creates the loop by not changing (and whose LE is therefore
zero). For a strange attractor—involving a system that does exhibit
sensitive dependence on initial conditions—at least one LE must be
positive such that there is divergence in the nearby orbits.
44 A Tale of Two Markets
LEs were created for use in connection with information theory,
to specify the likelihood that information conveyed in binary computer
language would be understood properly. LEs measured the
increase in uncertainty of a communication as additional bits of information
were added to the system.
The notion of bits of information has been reconceptualized for
application to public capital markets as measures of our knowledge
of current conditions. For example, in a time series of stockprice
data (e.g., daily returns), a positive LE would indicate the amount
of information or predictive power lost each day.
An LE of .05 per day, for example, would mean that information
becomes useless after 20 days (i.e., 1/.05). Thus, the LE is a measure
of the reliability of information in making forecasts for specified periods.
Peters, the Boston money manager, also has calculated the LE
for the S&P 500 (1950–1989), using monthly data. His calculations
resulted in a stable LE equal to .0241 per month. An LE of .0241
per month means that information reliability decays at the rate of
.0241 bit of accuracy each month; thus, the average cycle length of
the system using this measure is approximately three and a half years
(1/.0241 approximately 42 months). Note that this result substantially
matches the result that Peters got in his H analysis.
Peters also calculated the LE of 90-day trading data for the S&P
500 (1928–1990) and found an LE of .09883 per period. That result
substantially matches both the monthly LE and the H analysis: The
average cycle length of the system was approximately four years
(1/.09883 approximately ten 90-trading-day periods). Based on
these calculations, the public capital markets do exhibit sensitive
dependence on initial conditions and chaotic behavior rather than
simple linear efficiency.
Fractals
Another way to test for chaos is to determine whether a system has
a fractal dimension. Systems with fractal dimensions do not follow
Euclidean laws. Euclidean geometry simplifies and organizes nature
dimensionally: There are points, which lackdimension; lines, which
have one dimension; planes, which have two dimensions; and solids,
which have three dimensions. These simplifying images are heuristics:
Natural objects do not conform to these images. Until fractal
Chaotic Market 45
geometry was developed, however, these integral dimensions were all
we had to go on.
Fractal geometry was developed initially by the mathematician
and scientist Benoit Mandelbrot, who won the 1993 Wolf Prize in
physics.9 He observed that natural objects are not as simple as the
descriptions offered by Euclidean geometry: “Clouds are not spheres
[and] mountains are not cones.” For example, how would we classify
a piece of paper crumpled up an infinite number of times in terms
of Euclidean geometry?
It is not three-dimensional because it is not a pure solid form (it
has creases and crevices). (In mathematical terms, it is not completely
differentiable across its entire surface.) It is also not twodimensional
because it has depth. In fact, its dimension is between
two and three. That property makes the crumpled paper a fractal:
Its dimension is a fraction (two point something).
With respect to time-series data, dimensionality depends on
whether the system from which the data are taken is random or
nonrandom. If a system is random, time-series data taken from it
will reflect that randomness and have as large a dimension as can
possibly be. In the case of data being presented on a sheet of paper,
the highest possible dimension is two (the dimension of the paper
itself). In any case, the data will fill a plane.
If a system is nonrandom, time series of data taken from it will
reflect that nonrandomness and show a fractal dimension: The data
will not fill the plane but will clump together. That clumping together
reflects the correlations influencing the data (i.e., causing it
to be nonrandom).
These properties distinguishing random from nonrandom time
series may be conceptualized in a different way. For example, our
conception of a crumpled piece of paper as a three-dimensional object
can be regarded as embedding a fractal in a dimension greater
than itself. That greater dimension is called the embedding dimension.
Fractals retain their fractal dimension when placed in an embedding
dimension; random distributions do not. Thus, unlike nonrandom
distributions, random distributions fill their space the way
gas fills a volume: The gas spreads out because there is nothing to
bind the molecules together. This is, of course, the defining characteristic
of Brownian motion as discussed earlier.
Peters calculated the fractal dimension of the S&P 500 as 2.33
and did the same for other global stockmark ets, all of which also
46 A Tale of Two Markets
turned out to be fractals. Japan’s was 3.05; Germany’s, 2.41; and the
United Kingdom’s, 2.94. That is strong proof indeed that stockmar -
kets are not best described by EMT.
COMPLEXITY
Thinkabout the 1987 crash (and other roller coaster market episodes)
in terms of Einstein’s point that time operates in different
ways in different contexts. An intuitive case that market crashes exhibit
chaotic behavior starts to emerge. The intuitive case begins by
taking a nonlinear perspective of market time, under which market
time expands (speeds up) when trading is heavy and compresses
(slows down) when trading is thin. The speed of market time—called
intrinsic time—evidences itself in pricing persistence and pricing
discontinuity.
Pricing persistence is described in chaos theory as the Joseph
effect, drawn from the familiar biblical story of Joseph interpreting
the pharaoh’s dream to mean seven years of feast followed by seven
years of famine. The presence of this phenomenon in public capital
markets is exhibited by bull markets and bear markets in that identifiable
trends emerge and endure for significant time periods.
Pricing discontinuity is described in chaos theory as the Noah
effect, taken from the biblical story of the Flood. Public capital markets
exhibit the Noah effect in price changes. For example, suppose
IBM opens at 50 and closes at 30. That does not necessarily mean
that during some point in the trading day an investor could have
traded IBM at 40 (or any other price between 50 and 30). Rather,
the price of a stockmoves discontinuously in the sense that at one
moment it may be trading at 45 and at the next it cannot be sold
for more than 35 (something that day traders see a lot of and that
is discussed further in the next chapter).
The alternating presence of price persistence (the Joseph effect)
and price discontinuity (the Noah effect) shows that chronological
time—a linear concept—is not the most precise temporal measure
of public capital market phenomena. When discontinuous pricing—
the Noah effect—dominates a market, wide swings occur and market
pricing is relatively unstable because intrinsic time and trading
activity outpace chronological time and information gathering.
When price persistence—the Joseph effect—dominates a market,
pricing is relatively stable because intrinsic time is approximately
equal to or slower than chronological time.
Chaotic Market 47
The speed of intrinsic time may differ from that of chronological
time. Price changes would then move ahead of information changes.
Investors and other market participants conform perfectly neither to
the linear assumption of homogeneous expectations nor to the ubiquitous
irrationality of noise theory.
Instead, investors have heterogeneous expectations that may or
may not be rational and that may be defined according to a number
of variables. Chief among them are investor time horizons that range
from the very short term (for day traders and minute traders and
market makers, say) to the very long term (for central banks, say).
The range of different time dimensions contributes to the Joseph
and Noah effects, persistence, discontinuity, and premature and delayed
adjustments to information. Short-term traders react more
quickly to new information; long-term investors react more slowly.
Therefore, information changes will not produce proportionate price
changes. Indeed, volatility will increase when there are greater numbers
of short-term traders (day traders) than long-term traders.
Changes that are produced constitute new information, producing
another round of price changes again defined according to a
range of discrete time dimensions. Adding further complexity to this
mix of investor heterogeneity and time dimensions is the increasingly
global nature of financial markets: News itself is dynamic, traveling
around the world, usually in 24-hour cycles, and impacting Tokyo,
then London/Frankfurt, then New York, and around again.
In this reality, it seems implausible to claim instantaneous, unbiased
market adjustment to new information and it is not necessary
to attribute all market preadjustment or readjustment to irrational
noise trading. Incremental information changes in a perfect market
would be expected to produce proportionate price changes.
But informational changes produce disproportionate changes. In
terms of chaotic dynamics, these disproportionate changes may be
seen as a result of initial measurement error that (as in the hockey
puckexample and the butterfly effect generally) leads to exponentially
greater price changes over time.
BEHAVIORAL FINANCE
Not only do these systemic complexities and the stickiness of prices
show new reasons to be skeptical of EMT, they also suggest partial
explanations for the observed nonlinear dependence of stockprices
and the possible presence of chaotic phenomena. They certainly
48 A Tale of Two Markets
show that market behavior is far more complex than EMT allows.
While that is bad news for market efficiency, it is good news for
investors who recognize reality.
EMT may remain valuable to economists in explaining portions
of market processes—the public capital markets alternately may involve
both random and nonrandom components. But this partial validity
must not be misunderstood to suggest that markets are “relatively
efficient,” “reasonably efficient,” “sufficiently efficient,” or
“more efficient than not” at any moment in time, as many devotees
of EMT have been forced to argue since the market crash of 1987
shookconfidence in that theory.
Since 1987, a new generation of economists has arisen in prominent
universities to challenge EMT. Led by Robert Shiller of Yale,
a school of thought called behavioral finance draws on a wide range
of disciplines—including economics, psychology, biology, demography,
sociology, and history—to challenge the essentially mathematical
underpinnings of EMT.
The pioneers of behavioral finance have found substantial evidence
supporting two of Buffett’s long-held and most commonsense
propositions. The first is that while stockprices over short horizons
bounce around a lot, wedging price and value, over long horizons
the price must correspond to value. As Andrei Shleifer of Harvard
puts it, summarizing the studies: “Stocks with very high valuations
relative to their assets or earnings (growth or glamour stocks), which
tend to be stocks of companies with extremely high earnings growth
over the previous several years, earn relatively low riskadjusted returns
in the future, whereas stocks with low valuations (value stocks)
earn relatively high returns.”10
The second is evidence showing that investing in the latter group
of stocks (mislabeled “value stocks,” but the label is useful to simplify
the discussion) offers superior returns over long horizons. However
measured, the evidence Shleifer and his colleagues compiled
shows that “value” stocks outperform “growth” stocks by spreads of
about 8 to 10% annually over long horizons.
As early as 1981, Shiller showed that stockmark et prices are too
volatile to accord with EMT. Shiller’s peers at that time skewered
him for this blasphemy, but his research has held up and attracted
a still small but growing following, including former Harvard professor
Lawrence Summers, who became secretary of the treasury.
Shiller examined the relationship between price changes and subsequent
cash paid to stockholders and found remarkable irregularity
Chaotic Market 49
(bouncing around) in price changes in contrast to remarkable
smoothness in the cash stream.
Shiller and his colleague John Campbell recognize that some of
the price changes are due to changes in fundamental information
and to uncertainty about the future trends of cash flows. But taking
account of these factors, Shiller and Campbell estimated that only
27% of the annual return volatility in U.S. stockmark ets is justified
in terms of fundamental information. Campbell followed up this research
with John Ammer by using more recent data and reduced the
estimate to only 15%.11
Markets may be relatively efficient only on some days but not on
all days or may be relatively efficient for some stocks but not for
others. Even if we are more generous than the 15 to 27% suggested
by these studies and say EMT is 80% correct, it is a grave mistake
to use market efficiency as the basis of a managerial or investor game
plan. Buffett sums it up: “Observing correctly that the market was
frequently efficient,” EMT devotees “went on to conclude incorrectly
that it was always efficient. The difference between these propositions
is night and day.”12 That difference between night and day is
all that Graham and Buffett need to recognize. Neither is enthused
by mathematical accounts of markets, except to agree that EMT does
not explain all of market behavior.
Buffett quotes one of Charlie Munger’s favorite sayings to describe
the modern economist’s penchant for building EMT and related
mathematical models of stockmark ets: “To a man with a hammer,
every problem looks like a nail.”13 Graham quotes Aristotle: “It
is the markof an educated mind to expect that amount of exactness
which the nature of the particular subject admits. It is equally unreasonable
to accept merely probable conclusions from a mathematician
and to demand strict demonstration from an orator.”14
Graham concludes that “the workof a financial analyst falls
somewhere in the middle between that of a mathematician and an
orator.”15 The vanguard theorists of behavioral finance stand a better
chance of finding that middle road than do the devotees of EMT,
but they admit they still have a long way to go in understanding
investors and markets, a task that is likely to get harder rather than
easier, as the next chapter explains.
This page intentionally left blank.
51
C h a p t e r 4
AMPLIFIED
VOLATILITY
The efficient market story and the chaotic market story are neither
exhaustive nor mutually exclusive accounts of market behavior.
Rather, they depict end points on a continuum ranging from perfect
pricing to substantial deviation between price and value. These polar
points at the outer ranges of the continuum are a function of the
amount of price volatility. Price volatility can move prices toward
values (and is efficient) but can also push prices away from values
(and is inefficient).
Measuring how much market behavior is captured by the efficiency
story or the chaos story is hard. But if a generous estimate is
that EMT has explained about 80% of stockmark et behavior in the
past couple of decades, an important question is how much it is
likely to explain in the future. To answer that question, we need to
thinkabout the sources of volatility in pricing and assess whether
those sources are trending toward greater efficiency or greater pricevalue
discrepancies.
The sources of volatility that lead prices to part from fundamental
values are (1) the quality of information used by market participants in
trading, (2) the complexity of the markets in which trades are effected,
and (3) the discipline of market participants. A good prognosis is that
with the rise of on-line and computer-based trading and the spread of
fountains of noisy information all through the Internet, day and minute
traders will drive market mania to an ever more acute state of bipolar
disorder. Chaos rather than efficiency seems ascendant.
INFORMATION VOLATILITY
The first source of stockmark et volatility relates to information
changes. Information volatility has both a positive (efficient) dimension
and a negative (inefficient) dimension.
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
52 A Tale of Two Markets
The efficient dimension of information volatility is simply the
market’s facilitation of price changes in the light of fundamental
information about a company. That information alters the uncertainty
associated with that company’s future business prospects.
When the U.S. Supreme Court announces that the U.S. Food and
Drug Administration (FDA) lacks the authority to regulate tobacco
products, for example, the prices of tobacco stocks change to reflect
greater certainty about the regulatory environment.
This type of volatility is inherent in any market. It reflects the
simple reality that stockmark et prices are gauges of the future value
of cash flows to shareholders. The ineradicable uncertainty in that
gauge means that prices in an efficient market will hover about the
best estimates of value. But as information changes, the degree of
uncertainty about that value changes and prices should change accordingly.
There is little reason to believe that positive information volatility
is any worse or better now than it was a decade or longer ago. On
the one hand, there may be greater uncertainty in business value as
a result of globalization, the pervasiveness of new technology, and
the seeming swiftness of its change. A portion of the substantial
price volatility of the late 1990s and early 2000s may be a function
of such greater business volatility. On the other hand, there are also
superior ways to measure business and financial risk, manage it, and
adapt to these changing landscapes. With these factors offsetting
each other, there seems little basis for saying that positive information
volatility will get better or worse in the future.
Negative information volatility is another story. This inefficient
dimension of information volatility consists of trading on the basis
of information either unrelated to fundamental values or inaccurate
about them. The stuff of negative information volatility includes ageold
accounting trickery (discussed in Chapter 9) and other tactics
designed to prop up stockprices, such as share repurchases (discussed
in Chapter 13). But none of these problems seem more (or
less) severe than they ever did. Wacky trading strategies such as
those based on hemline levels and Super Bowl winners also constitute
negative information volatility, but these strategies are as fashionable
(and foolish) as they ever were.
What’s new is an increase in negative information volatility that
arises from trading that is based on premature information dissemination,
unfounded and untrue rumors, false speculative hunches,
and hopes, dreams, and lies. Changes in the manner and speed of
Amplified Volatility 53
information flows produce fountains of high-quality information
along with a deluge of low-quality junkmasquerading as information.
The result is increased negative information volatility that
drives a wider wedge between price and value.
In the old economy, EMT seemed plausible in part because the
information that markets digested had a superior quality compared
to that in the new economy trading environment. Old economy news
benefited from the major filtering role played by the mainstream
press. You could count on the integrity of The New York Times, USA
Today, The Wall Street Journal, and other great newspapers and magazines
to deliver news and information that was professionally vetted
under constraints imposed by long-nurtured and valuable reputations
for journalistic quality and integrity.
While you still can count on such media for filtered and considered
news reporting, the process of getting there has been littered
with unfiltered information that gets out before its time. The days
of getting vetted news from the morning paper and the evening news
are numbered. Americans get a steady diet of news throughout the
day, with the newspaper and the evening broadcasts sandwiching
nonstop cable news programs, Internet reports, and e-mails forwarding
rumor-based “news” that your friends or colleagues fear you
might otherwise miss.
The deluge of “news by the second” disrupts the old fixture of
the news cycle. Reporters who used to workon a 24-hour news cycle
that entailed gathering, researching, writing, rewriting, and printing
the news now announce their results as they go. Print journalists
broadcast tomorrow’s stories on today’s market wraps, and the reports
flash around every other news outlet—cable, Internet, and traditional
wires.
By the time this new news cycle is finished, the news that actually
gets reported in print is often either stale or discovered to be
less important than first believed. Reporting quality is sacrificed for
speed. In this world you get data earlier, but you get it the way
journalists in the middle of the old news cycle used to get it: unfiltered—
the draft of a story in progress.
These forces were behind the $2 billion price plunge of Emulex,
manufacturer of fiber optic communications equipment, in August
2000. Major news organizations, including Bloomberg, Dow
Jones, and CBS.Marketwatch.com, distributed what turned out to
be a fake press release announcing that Emulex’s CEO had resigned
and that it planned to restate its earnings for the prior two years.
54 A Tale of Two Markets
The hoax was engineered by a former employee of a press service
who knew the ropes of getting releases onto the Internet and reported
by organizations eager to be first to get news out. Apart from
the devastation to the stockof Emulex, the hoax appeared responsible
for dragging down the stockprices of numerous other fiber
optic companies as well as the broader Nasdaq composite.1
Webcasting by brokerage firms can also be a source of negative
information volatility. Supplanting the traditional news media, analysts
of major brokerages increasingly post reports directly on their
own Web sites by video streaming. They opine on market conditions
and call attention to favored stocks. Most firms admit they are not
reporting news but claim instead to be giving information. The difference
is often lost on investors consuming the data, who trade on
its basis without recognizing that it is furnished as a marketing device
for the brokerage rather than as news vetted and constrained
by traditional journalistic ethics of independence.
But the real villains of negative information volatility are the
cobwebs of Web sites that pump out unfiltered information on the
Internet with unbridled abandon, particularly on bulletin boards and
chat rooms. The ease and often anonymous character of information
dissemination over these Internet forums eliminates an important
filter for vast channels of what only passes for news and information.
If it has always been hard to believe that the market is as omniscient
as EMT says it is, the increasing ability of anyone, anywhere—identified
or anonymous—to spread lies, rumors, hunches, and other
disinformation to millions at a time makes that concept downright
fantastic.
On a typical day over thirty thousand messages flood the four
largest boards: Yahoo!, Silicon Investor, Motley Fool, and Raging
Bull. None of these board providers screen the messages for accuracy,
and all leave them up after they are posted. All of them permit
anonymous messages, and all posters can use as many different
names as they want.
For less than it costs to buy a cappuccino, anybody can drop by a
cyber cafe´ , log on, use one of many services that facilitate anonymous
postings that are nearly impossible to trace (cutely called “anonymizers”),
and say anything he or she wants to about any company (or anything
else, for that matter). The SEC has some investigators who regularly
review sites looking for possible fraud and some companies try
to address the rumors they see flying around, but these efforts cannot
assure you that what you are reading is worth anything.
Amplified Volatility 55
The most innocuous form of the riskof negative information
volatility is the rumor mill—Internet postings that stop way short of
fraud—but these rumors can have equally significant effects on
stockprices. Berkshire Hathaway’s stock price was hurt when wholly
unfounded and viscous rumors that Warren Buffett’s health was failing
spread all over the Internet in early 2000. Equally vicious were
the rumors spread in 1996 that executives of Quigley Corporation, a
company that had just introduced a cold remedy called Cold-Eaze,
were really mobsters: Its stockprice dropped from $37 to $10 on the
lies. Worst of all was the day when Michael Hackworth, president
and chief executive officer of Cirrus Logic, clicked on a Yahoo! site
to a message pronouncing him “dead after a long illness.”2
More pernicious than rumors in motive and in their effect on
stockprice accuracy are the deliberate defrauders, those who have
adapted a host of age-old fraud techniques to the Internet at a very
low cost and a very low riskof detection.3 Spamming is one of the
Internet defrauders cheapest mechanisms of deceit. For a few hundred
dollars, a spammer can buy software that enables the harvesting
of thousands of e-mail addresses from Internet files. A whole
e-mailing list can be devised. For higher stakes—say, $10,000—
spammers can buy e-mailing lists numbering tens of millions of addresses.
They blitz them for bogus bucks.
These spammers sometimes get caught. One who did promoted
stocks by spamming to several million e-mailees, touting the stocks
of two companies in exchange for a fee. The spammer did not disclose
his true identify or the fact that he was being paid to do the
hawking. A California court in October 1998 slammed the spammer
with a fine and an injunction against doing it again.4 In a similar
case, a convicted felon just out of jail and on probation for previous
securities fraud spammed 30 million e-mailees with lies about his
company that were intended to prop up its price precisely so that
he could generate enough money to repay the victims of his earlier
fraud!5 What a Ponzi scheme.
A more elaborate spamming technique seeks to disguise the
source of the e-mail and the identify of its sender, making it look as
if the message were misdirected to the recipient and making her feel
she had “overheard” a hot tip being exchanged between friends. In
one case, two men indicted in early 2000 on charges of securities
fraud “made” more than $1 million by sending hundreds of
thousands of e-mail messages about dozens of small companies to
subscribers of America Online (AOL).6 The subject stocks were just
56 A Tale of Two Markets
the kind lots of 2000s maniacs salivate for: no earnings and no revenue,
though most of them also had no continuing operations. In a
number of other cases, spammers disguised the sender of e-mails to
make it look as if the recipient were reading an internal memo at a
major investment banking house containing “inside” information
about various stocks.7
It has always been true that “tips” are suspect—whether from
your neighbor across the backfence, your hairdresser, or your dentist.
The great investor Phil Carret advised avoiding them like the
plague;8 an astute chronicler of trading markets, Edwin LeFe` vre,
stingingly observed that “Wall Street professionals know that acting
on ‘inside’ tips will breaka man more quickly than famine, pestilence,
crop failures, political readjustments, or what might be called
normal accidents”;9 and Ben Graham was terser: “Much bad advice
is given free.”10
What is different about the new tips is that more people create
them, more people hear them, and more people act on them than
ever before. When adapted for the Internet, not only do classic fraud
schemes dramatically enlarge the number of possible victims (and
the dollar receipts of the perpetrator), when peddled on many finance
bulletin boards and chat rooms they can carry special weight.
This is the case because these boards and rooms often create a spirit
of camaraderie among their users that generates trust in other participants
and what they have to say.
The most classic scam being adapted to the Internet is the pumpand-
dump, and it has been going on for many years. As early as
October 1996, for example, a pumper bought shares of Omnigene
Diagnostics for around $1 each and then posted a slew of pretty
much identical lies on AOL boards saying that the company was hot
and sales were growing rapidly. The stocksprinted to nearly $7 in
about six weeks, whereupon the pumper dumped the stock for an
illicit but huge gain. The lies were dispelled when an employee of
Omnigene announced on the company’s own Web site all sorts of
operational and financial problems. The SEC ordered a halt in trading
of the company’s stock. When it later lifted that halt, the stock
traded backbelow the $1 a share it had been resting at before the
pump-and-dump.11
A more recent pump-and-dump example began one Friday afternoon
in late November 1999, when three Beverly Hills twentysomethings
bought fifty thousand shares of a bankrupt commercial
printing company, NEI Webworld, for nickels and dimes a share.
Amplified Volatility 57
They then spent the weekend on computers at UCLA bombarding
three popular finance message boards—Yahoo!, Raging Bull, and
Freerealtime—with some five hundred fabricated messages hyping a
pending buyout of the worthless company. The lies jacked up NEI’s
stockprice to open at $8 Monday morning and move to a high that
day of $15, while the troika cashed in their shares for a net booty of
about $364,000, plunging the price backto the nickels and dimes
they had “invested.”12
The SEC and the U.S. attorney’s office in California jumped on
this scam and in a matter of days identified the looters and charged
them with violating federal securities laws against telling material
lies in connection with the purchase or sale of securities. The SEC
rightly denounced much of the nonsense that is spewed in Internet
bulletin boards and chat rooms as having no more value than graffiti,
and The Wall Street Journal rightly declared that some of them can
be worse than trash.
Of all the known Internet trashers, Yun Soo Oh Park is the most
notorious. Called Tokyo Joe, he was subjected to civil fraud charges
in early 2000 by the SEC for putting misleading investment information
on his Internet site. During 1998 and 1999, the SEC said,
Tokyo Joe made hundreds of thousands of fraudulent dollars through
a scalping strategy that involved buying stocks, saying wonderful
things about them on his Web site, and then selling them after the
buying of the masses pushed their price up.13
It may not even be those looking for fast money who sponsor
this negative information volatility. Early in 1999 an employee of
PairGain Technologies put a message on a Yahoo! site directing users
to a fake Bloomberg News page containing a fabricated story that
PairGain was going to be taken over. Its stock price soared on this
“news,” and while the fabricator apparently did not gain any money
from the ploy, he is spending five years on probation for the crime.14
Hard as it is to identify Internet scammers, you cannot count on
the authorities to punish and deter the new defrauders when they
are traced. When the SEC discovered in early 2000 that four thirdyear
Georgetown University law students (and the mother of one of
them, who happened to be a councilwoman for Colorado Springs!)
had generated nearly $350,000 in illegal profits from a pump-anddump
scam on their Web site, the SEC “settled” with the scoundrels.
No jail time, no fine, not even disgorgement of the dirty money. The
losers simply had to agree not to do it again.15
In a world where it is just as easy for anyone to buy a share of
58 A Tale of Two Markets
stockas to sell it short, the pump-and-dump scheme can be run just
as easily as a bust-and-buy scam. The buster is a short seller who
benefits if a stockprice falls because he buys stock today but promises
to pay for it at a price to be determined later. So he spreads
false rumors that a company’s sales are falling and that it is plagued
with all kinds of problems. The price busts, and the scammer gets
his shares at a low price—and then gets to watch the price rise as
people figure out there was no reason for the bust in the first place.16
That is precisely what the drafter of the fake press release about
Emulex was trying to do.
Outdoing the brazen fraud of the perpetrators of these stories
and the lax enforcement is the galactic stupidity of those who fall
for the schemes. To take just one example, any eighth-grader could
have looked up NEI on the SEC’s Web site or any other reputable
database and found that it had filed for bankruptcy a year earlier
and that it no longer had a listed telephone number for its Dallas
headquarters, let alone any assets or operations. Yet you would be
surprised how many people buy stocks on the basis of such Internet
gibberish and buy them without even knowing anything about their
business climate, let alone management or other basic financial information.
Speaking of eighth-graders, an astonishing number of people
who should have known better lost over a quarter of a million dollars
to a junior high school kid who apparently took Internet securities
fraud up as an after-school hobby. The child, 14 years old when he
began his scam, posted hundreds of manufactured messages concerning
nine different obscure stocks in chat rooms and bulletin
boards and entered automatic orders to sell the stocks once they
reached hype-inflated price levels. Without admitting or denying
guilt, he agreed with the SEC to refrain from doing it again and to
disgorge his profits (though without paying any additional fine or
other penalty).17
These anecdotal accounts and hundreds more untold indicate a
dramatic increase in negative information volatility. Certainly they
do not evidence an efficient market or one that is getting more efficient.
Rather, they help explain the market manias and greed-gloom
gyrations cataloged in Chapter 1. Their limited detectability and policing,
coupled with the public’s evident gullibility, suggest they will
continue to plague the market.
You can be sure not only that there are other crooks and swindlers
looking for and sometimes finding fast and fraudulent dollars
Amplified Volatility 59
but that negative information volatility will result. That bad news for
market efficiency is not entirely bad news for you as an investor,
however, so long as you steer clear of the pump-and-dump set and
take advantage of the widening spread between price and value that
results from their dirty work.
TRANSACTION VOLATILITY
The second source of stockprice volatility is transaction-related.18
This arises from the way prices are formed by market trading. It is
not possible for any party acting alone to set the price of a stock.
Share pricing in stockmark ets arises solely as a result of traders’
orders meeting in the market. How they meet in the market to determine
prices is important to know but often overlooked.
Trades on traditional markets such as the New York Stock
Exchange (NYSE) begin with a customer who instructs a broker to
effect a trade, say, to buy 100 shares of Dell at $50. The broker takes
that order to the trading floor, where a crowd of traders are at work.
If there were another broker who had gotten a customer’s order to
sell 100 shares of Dell at $50, the two could just swap shares for
their customers. No price change would result, and so there would
be no transaction volatility. That perfect matching of buy and sell
orders seldom happens on traditional exchanges (or on the Nasdaq,
where the chief difference is only that matching is done more by
computer routing of orders than through the physical presence of
people on the floor).
Instead, buyers and sellers place orders with their brokers at
different times, want to trade different amounts of shares, and want
to buy or sell at different prices. In these more typical cases, the
customers have to wait until someone else arrives looking for a trade
on the same terms or have someone else in the market make the
trade. That someone else is there, and she is called a market maker
(on the NYSE) or specialist (on the Nasdaq) in that stock.
When a broker can’t find another broker looking for a precise
swap with his customer’s order, these middlemen (market makers
and specialists) do the trade so that the broker’s customers don’t
have to wait until a counterpart comes along. The middlemen do
the waiting for them, making markets in stocks by buying and selling
shares when buyers and sellers arrive.
Middlemen make money for providing this service by buying
60 A Tale of Two Markets
stocks at a lower price (called the bid) and selling them at a higher
price (called the ask). The difference between the bid and the ask
price is called the bid-askspread. It is the price buyers and sellers
pay so that they don’t have to wait.
The bid-ask spread also compensates the market maker for the
risks he is exposed to in taking positions in stocks so that others
don’t have to wait. Making a market in stocks exposes her to the risk
of error in her own valuations and the valuations of others. Market
makers can make a market at a price below or above a stock’s fundamental
value.
If they make a market at a price below value, more buyers should
arrive. But the price goes up when buyers arrive (they pay the ask
price). Therefore, a maker will sell more shares at the ask than it
buys at the bid. It may then have to buy more shares to make a
market, and the price will be pushed up, exposing it to losses if the
bid-askspread is too small.
Market makers respond to that risk by widening the bid-ask
spread—raising the price at which they will sell to buyers and/or
lowering the price at which they will buy from sellers. Transaction
volatility in stockprices arises from such changes in the bid-ask
spread. It is undesirable volatility because it is driven not by changes
in fundamental values but by a market maker’s exposure to loss from
value errors amid orders arriving at different times seeking different
things.
Market makers also create transaction volatility when they respond
to changes in order flow. If more buy orders than sell orders
are coming in, they raise the bid and askquotes. They do this because
they must assume that the order imbalance reflects changes
in fundamental values. When they are right about that, their raise
reflects positive information volatility (i.e., price moving closer to
value). But when they are wrong about that, their prices deviate from
value and the change creates transaction volatility.
The rise of electronic computer networks (ECNs) has put regulatory
and economic pressure on the traditional exchanges to reduce
transaction volatility resulting from market making. ECNs conduct
trading solely on computer screens rather than through brokers,
traders, and market makers. The swiftness and transparency of this
computerized technique allows trades to be handled as in the first
example above, where two brokers swap their respective customers’
mirror trades, and with far less or no waiting time.
Each customer posts his desired trade on the ECN’s screen, say,
Amplified Volatility 61
one seeking to buy 100 shares of Dell at $50 and one seeking to sell
the same. When the price of an offer to buy matches the price of
an offer to sell (as in this case), the trade occurs automatically. The
middleman disappears, and the price is formed directly by two orders
meeting in the market. ECNs can thus reduce transaction volatility
caused by the bid-ask spread required by market makers.
If particular ECN offer prices do not match, however, they still
get posted on the computer along with the bid and askoffers of
specialists and market makers. When the orders don’t match, there
is an “order imbalance” and the screens cannot do anything about
it. A middleman must step in to buy or sell to eliminate the imbalance
and keep the market alive.
Even if it were theoretically possible for ECNs to eliminate transaction
volatility caused by the bid-askspread required by middlemen,
that could not happen without effectively shutting down the market.
Thus, any reduction in transaction volatility you see coming from
ECNs is not going to eliminate it. And there is some reason to believe
it won’t even reduce it—depending on how markets shape up.
ECNs shookup market trading as they proliferated in the late
1990s and early 2000s. The leading players in this market are Island
and Instinet, both of which do a huge business in this kind of computer
trading. Any business they get, however, is business that the
traditional exchanges—and the brokers, traders, and market makers
who participate in them—do not get. At stake for traditional brokerage
firms is the franchise value from their roles as specialists and
market makers in stocks. At stake for the proprietors of the ECNs
and the on-line and discount brokers who get more order flow
through their use is a new franchise value the systems can create.
Not surprisingly, then, the explosion of ECNs as alternative trading
places produced an excited debate among the traditional firms
and the newer firms and at the SEC and in Congress. All factions
recite a variation of the same mantra: The goal is to help investors
get the best price available each time they trade.
Traditional firms say the goal of getting customers the best price
would be best accomplished by having a single source of pricing
information,19 and so they call for a centralized order bookwhere all
orders would be posted and through which all participants could
insure that their customers get the best price. The ECNs and online
and discount firms say you will get better pricing if you have
lots of competition between firms, and so they call for permitting a
62 A Tale of Two Markets
fragmented system with lots of different order books. The pressure
on all sides is revealed by merger talks between the NYSE and Nasdaq
on the one hand and between ECN leaders Instinet and Island
on the other.20
Given this environment, elimination of transaction volatility is
unlikely. Not only that, any reduction in it through enhanced use of
electronic computer systems as opposed to market makers is likely
to be offset by another development in market trading: quoting share
prices down to the penny (“decimal pricing”) rather than in fractional
increments of 1/8 or 1/16.
In theory, decimal pricing would help produce prices that equal
value. Suppose the value of a share is $50.03. In a decimal pricing
system it is quoted at exactly $50.03, whereas in a fractional pricing
system it is quoted either at $50 or at $50.06 (i.e., 50 1/16).
Decimal pricing also has the effect of narrowing the bid-ask
spread for the same reason. But it means the spread is changed more
frequently, itself a cause of transaction volatility. While the move to
decimal pricing may not contribute as much to increasing transaction
volatility as the rise of ECNs subtracts, on balance the reduction
from ECNs makes only a modest case for improved market efficiency.
The case is cloudier yet when you add the move toward 24-hour
trading. Market volatility tends to lighten when trading sessions are
interrupted, as occurs on the Thursday following Ash Wednesday,
for example. However, some of the greatest market plummets have
occurred on Mondays, following two days off. Whether continuous
trading will promote or retard efficiency is thus hard to predict,
though one lesson from history suggests the latter. The Evening
Exchange operated in New Yorkin the 1860s as a place to continue
trading stocks and gold after the NYSE’s regular daytime hours. It
lasted only a few years, apparently creating and suffering from a
staggering speculative and volatile bubble that led to its demise.21
Whatever value ECNs add in terms of reduced transaction volatility
is offset by what they create in a third kind of volatility. The
rise of ECNs has meant a proliferation of places to trade and get
prices. For investors and traders, this means faster and cheaper ways
to trade stocks, at lower commissions, with swifter trade executions
and more after-hours trading. This promotes the democratization of
capital, which sounds nice. But is it?
As anyone who know anything about Warren Buffett knows, the
best investors see themselves as part owners of a business rather
Amplified Volatility 63
than of a piece of tradable paper or cyberspace. But this mind-set is
hard to maintain when price quotes proliferate and distract attention
to value by both existing owners and new shareholders who buy on
spec.
All this action across a broad spectrum of people and places
means more room for psychological influences. That remains true
whether all these trades arise in thousands of different places or
occur in a single place. The resulting prices bear less resemblance
to business values. The irony is that volatility exists no matter what
system emerges, though with the rise of ECNs a greater danger
lurks: trader volatility.
TRADER VOLATILITY
Trader volatility arises when trades are made for purposes unrelated
to the fundamental values of a business. These trades drive prices
to points related more to the motives of the trader than to the business
value of the company.
The wide range of trading decisions that cause price moves unrelated
to business value includes: trading for identifiable economic
reasons of the trader, such as portfolio “rebalancing”; selling shares
to fund personal needs or desires, such as a child’s education or the
remodeling of a kitchen; and, most notoriously of all, day trading for
purposes of speculation and gambling. Let’s start with that one.
Day trading is usually not based on fundamental values but on
momentum, sector rotation, and other technical tactics of the type
ridiculed earlier. When trades are based on these things, they move
prices. Those moves, having nothing to do with values, widen the
gap between price and value. This exacerbates Mr. Market’s peaks
and valleys and feeds irrational exuberance and irrational despair.
Day trading is thus among the worst developments capital markets
have seen in their history for purposes of maintaining an orderly or
sensible market, much less an efficient one.
Many day traders are probably perfectly rational people; many
are not. Aberrations may get headlines, but some of the day trader
stunts captured by the mainstream press warrant attention. The Atlanta
day trader who gunned down nine people and then himself in
the summer of 1999 after suffering staggering day trading losses is a
glaring example. So too is the fun-loving 44-year-old family man who
tookearly retirement with his wife and their $780,000 nest egg only
64 A Tale of Two Markets
to murder the money day trading and then attempt to murder his
wife (he wound up in a South Carolina prison).22
Hardly tales of high rationality, and the woeful tales of these
hapless folks are not isolated examples or aberrations. A Senate committee
held hearings on day trading in early 2000 accompanied by
a blistering report cataloging its numerous plagues. The report focused
on the industry that supports day trading and emphasized the
need for greater industry riskdisclosure, licensing, and minimum
financial requirements for traders. But it is also a brief against the
sagacity of the pernicious practice.23
The most compelling conclusions of the report are that 75% of
day traders lose money and that a typical day trader has to generate
gains of $110,000 a year just to breakeven after costs! That figure is
breathtaking, but the idea is not new. Classic studies have shown
that someone who tries to time the market and move in and out of
it quickly to exploit its gyrations has to be right 70% of the time to
profit. Do you know anybody who can perform that well consistently?
Even the best hitters in baseball—say, Rod Carew, George Brett, and
even Ted Williams—bat at most .400 (the equivalent of “being right”
only 40% of the time).
An equally important—if slightly more benign—source of trader
volatility is the practice of “rebalancing.” Ironically, this practice was
promoted mainly by those who use modern portfolio theory and believe
in market efficiency. Rebalancing goes something like this: If
you start with ten stocks each bought for 10% of the total cost of
your portfolio, some will rise in price and some will fall. The rebalancer
says that after a year or another arbitrary interval, lookat
the new pricing. Suppose five went up and five went down, both in
proportion. Now your portfolio has five stocks constituting 75% of
the holdings and five stocks constituting 25%. The rebalancer says
you should shed some of those in the 75% group to reduce their
role in the overall holdings.
This must rankamong the dumbest things people could do with
investments, yet it is very prevalent. You end up selling the stocks
that seem to be performing relatively well and keeping those which
come up behind. Why would you do that?
It may be rational, but not because your portfolio is somehow out
of balance. It makes sense to sell the good performers only if you examine
the business fundamentals of the companies and decide that
they no longer meet your requirements for holding them: the price exceeds
the value by large amounts, there are clearly superior opportuAmplified
Volatility 65
nities for wider price-value gaps, the economic characteristics have
deteriorated, or management has changed hands for the worse.
The famed investor Gerald Loeb gave the opposite advice, which
is not easy to follow in the best of circumstances, much less when
contemporary advisers are telling you something else: “If you want
to sell some of your stocks and not all, invariably go against your
emotional inclinations and sell first the issues with losses, small profits,
or none at all. Always get rid of the weakest and keep your best
issues for last.”24
Like Loeb, Peter Lynch regards the prevalent practice of rebalancing
as backward, saying it is like gardening by watering the weeds
and pulling the flowers. The beneficiaries of this backward gardening
are not the investors or traders who do the rebalancing but their
advisers—who generate fees from trading—and the U.S. federal and
local treasuries—which get tax payments. Buffett put it best in asking
whether it would have made sense for the Chicago Bulls to trade
Michael Jordan on the grounds that he had become too important
and valuable to the team.25
Apart from the stupidity of trading the best picks, the strategy’s
contribution to trader volatility is significant. When trades are made
to rebalance a portfolio in this way, they are by definition trades unrelated
to business value (other than fortuitously). The sale of stock
that no longer “fits” a portfolio puts price change pressures on that
stock. But that pressure, having nothing to do with actual or even perceived
value in that stock, simply widens the price-value gulf.
Finally, plenty of people have turned to the stockmark et as a
savings account. It is the place where they repose regular sums to
build wealth for planned projects such as buying a home, paying for
a child’s education, and enjoying retirement. It is also the place
where money is stored and drawn on for unplanned funding needs,
such as paying to remodel a kitchen, buying a sports utility vehicle,
and taking trips to exotic vacation spots.
It is hard to quarrel with those who use the stockmark et as a
way to build wealth for planned future needs such as home ownership,
education, and retirement. These tend to be long-term goals
that enable long-term investing, and so the stockmark et is a rational
place to store some of that wealth.
It is far easier to rebuke the use of the stock market for more
short-term-oriented expenditures. For one thing, there is extraordinary
riskin stockmark et investing, especially over short periods of
time. It is simply not a rational place to put resources that may be
66 A Tale of Two Markets
needed to fund ordinary needs such as home repair and ordinary
desires such as recreation.
As to either form of using the stockmark et, however, the net
effect on market efficiency is the same. Trading decisions are based
on needs (or desires) rather than on the fundamental values of the
stockbeing sold. That has the effect, again, of separating the resulting
prices from the actual values.
As more Americans use the stockmark et for these purposes—
as traders rather than as investors—EMT explains less market activity.
And as The New York Times said when day trader mania took
hold, America has gone from a nation of savers, to a nation of investors,
to a nation of traders.26
ECNs and discount on-line brokers facilitate trading, rebalancing,
and savings via stocks. Although this positively reduces the costs
of incremental trading, it has an offsetting negative effect of encouraging
more trades. In the aggregate market, negative information
volatility and a wilder Mr. Market ensue.
It is like Reaganomics for brokers, as people end up spending
more in commissions under this lower pricing per trade because they
trade more often. Charles Schwab, to give a representative example
of this industry, reduced its average revenue per trade from $64.27
in 1997 to $45.55 two years later while increasing daily trading volume
from 106,000 to 208,000 and growing.27 Schwab’s revenues
soared; you know who paid.
Day trading funds on the horizon will make all these matters
worse. Marrying low-cost trading, screen-based clearing, and the insatiable
day trader appetite, a former commissioner of the SEC
launched a company in mid-2000 called Folio(fn) to cater to the
rebalancing and day trading set. It offers a fixed annual fee that is
not only much lower than typical mutual fund fees but also lower
than the average cost per trade Schwab and others charge. It uses
a proprietary trading system to match customer trading orders in
house, going to market twice a day with compiled customer orders
to clear any imbalance. Touted as a way to help investors, this day
trading fund will increase trader volatility.28
PROGNOSIS
The main effect of amplified volatility—from low-quality information,
market fragmentation, and noise traders—is less efficient pricAmplified
Volatility 67
ing of stocks. The spread has widened between Mr. Market’s currency
(prices, what you pay) and corporate management’s currency
(value, what you get).
The symptoms of that inefficiency and the consequences of that
amplification consist of all the phenomena cataloged in Chapter 1,
including bifurcation of markets (for example, between the Dow and
the Nasdaq) and roller coaster rides of crashes and breaks. Episodes
such as the crash of 1987 and the breakof 1989 no longer look like
isolated aberrations; rather, these and the spasmodic bursts and
busts of the late 1990s and early 2000s evidence a disease that is
not only epidemic but chronic.
EMT was never a perfect explanation of the stockmark et, but
whatever purchase it once held is declining further and rapidly in
today’s market climate. It may have had some appeal in an era when
trading enjoyed the benefits of a major filtering role for the financial
press and investment professionals. While these institutions were
never perfect in those roles, their training, knowledge, and professionalism
(and, for advisers, interest in stable markets for underwriting
and merger advisory businesses) tooksome of the edge off
their human infirmities. It didn’t make EMT right, but it did make
it seem plausible.
The rise of the Web, ECNs, day traders, and the individual investor
have produced unfiltered stockmark ets that retard rather than
promote efficiency. SEC Chairman Arthur Levitt testified before
Congress that market fragmentation created by the rise of ECNs
could lead the same stockto trade at substantially different prices
in different trading forums. Maybe that would create new and exciting
arbitrage opportunities, but the chairman’s insight makes the
case against existing stockmark et efficiency airtight.
As the next chapter shows, these trends in market behavior imply
that managers and investors should ignore how the market is behaving
with respect to pricing securities and focus instead on their
own knitting: running businesses with strong economic characteristics
and looking for them, respectively.
This page intentionally left blank.
69
C h a p t e r 5
TAKE THE FIFTH
Knowing that the average cycle length of public capital markets
is approximately four years does not give you any tricks to investing,
for there are none. That, plus knowing that stock market
efficiency is at most about 80% true and getting less so, corroborates
the endurance of Ben Graham’s intuition: Mr. Market is alive and
still not well. The question is what to do with the 20% or more of
market pricing EMT does not capture, and the answer is to take
advantage of it.
Maybe Mr. Market’s manic depression has been better diagnosed
if still not widely understood. Maybe the detection of nonlinear dependence
and the upsetting of EMT are like superior clinical diagnoses
of bipolar disorder in medicine. Maybe increasing recognition
of the disease has reduced the denial and given some hope of treatability.
But these are just maybes.
What is certain is that the market is complex. Also certain, given
the alternative accounts of market phenomena, is that trading rule
tests and other pat formulas for investing remain nonsensical gibberish,
though not because the market is efficient but because it is
plagued by emotional disorder.
It remains to navigate the market’s Scylla of gloom and its Charybdis
of euphoria. It is possible to do so because there are bounds
to the mania. The greater fool theory may be true: Buying stocks for
profitable resale at some future time requires that there be someone
out there who will buy what you want to sell. It may be true that
the entire market operation rests upon confidence that in the long
run the market gets things right without too much static or dislocation
over the shorter run that it takes to get there.
Market traits of irrationality and chaos undermine efficiency
claims, but that is as far as they go. They do not undermine confidence
in the long-run stability of markets. To the contrary, they
mean that opportunities exist for the wise and the cautious, those
armed with the tools of business analysis that enable one to decide
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
70 A Tale of Two Markets
when the time is right to take advantage of Mr. Market’s festering
gloom and when the time is right to steer clear of his maniacal
euphoria.
The debate over how much of market behavior EMT captures is
an endless one. This is the case because its devotees tell us that as
it starts to explain less, opportunities arise for informed people (such
as those who act on the mind-set they develop from reading this
book) to step in and correct things. Thus, EMT gets restored. The
endlessly open empirical question is the degree to which one effect
swamps the other.
On balance, the Internet’s negligible business information quality
and the frolicsome day traders acting on it suggest plenty of incentive
for real investors to get informed and plenty of room left
over after they do. In other words, if the current trading environment
makes it seem that EMT’s descriptive power is going to look more
like 70% in the coming years, people acting on it may be able to
return its power to about 80% after that. Those most able to participate
in taking advantage of that process are investors equipped with
a business analysis mind-set.
WHO’S IN CHARGE?
From a manager’s perspective, an important consequence of market
complexity is that directors and officers cannot control a company’s
stockprice. Hence, shareholders should not expect or require them
to maximize it. Managers can only be expected and required to manage
their own business and its fundamental values, not how the
market understands that performance. Investors and traders make
those determinations, not managers.
It would be a mistake, however, to allow this reality to immunize
managers from reproach for poor stockprice performance over long
periods of time. What this means is only that managers cannot be
held responsible for fluctuations in the company’s stockprice that
result from the passions of the marketplace. It does not mean that
a long-term subpar stockprice is not a reflection of actual managerial
ineptitude.
Good managers will enjoy average stockprices of the company
above the norm; bad ones will suffer average prices below it. Neither
is responsible for, or can claim credit for, the intermittent ups and
downs. As Ben Graham said, “Good managements produce a good
Take the Fifth 71
average market price, and bad managements produce bad market
prices.”1
Managers also undoubtedly attempt to influence the company’s
stockprice all the time in ways ranging from the mundane (casting
unfavorable announcements in the rosiest light subject to antifraud
constraints), to the unlawful (manipulating earnings, a subject considered
in Part II), to something in between (say, extraordinary distributions
to shareholders from the sale of debt or assets).
Those attempts, however, are not motivated primarily by a desire
to produce stockprices equivalent to underlying business value. On
the contrary, most managers want the company’s stockto trade at
the highest possible prices in the market, without regard to business
value. This is a mistake, as Buffett emphasizes repeatedly, for such
delinkage means that business results during one period will not
necessarily benefit the people who owned the company during that
period.2
While investors rather than managers are in the best position to
evaluate and translate into market prices a company’s performance
as measured by its underlying business value, they cannot guarantee
a perfect translation. Information, transaction, and trader volatility
all interfere with the identity between business value and market
price. Even subject to these distortions, however, it is worth an investor’s
time to understand business values and promote their identity
with market prices. The larger investors have greater incentives
to do this and to reap its rewards, which increase in proportion to
shareholding size.
Together, therefore, these insights justify active, informed, large,
and long-term investors focused on business analysis or, in Buffett’s
characterization of Berkshire Hathaway, “major, stable and interested
shareholders” who are “supportive, analytical and objective.”3 Instead
of asking whether such investors will make EMT more than
about 70 to 80% correct, however, this perspective confirms the
prospect that such investing can take advantage of what EMT has
papered over for nearly three decades: the systemic separation of
business value from market price.
STICKING TO YOUR KNITTING
The separation of business value from market price calls for inverting
the usual thinking about investing. Too often tools and people
72 A Tale of Two Markets
use market prices as a metric in valuing a business. That gets the
process backward. Market price is the last thing an investor should
lookat in a valuation exercise. All the market price tells you is what
you can buy (or sell) a share of stockfor .
The market does not at all tell you whether that is a good or bad
deal. Answering that question requires conducting a valuation based
on the fundamental business and economic characteristics of the issuing
company. These are the tools considered in the rest of this book.
In using these tools, all investors—institutional and individual—
also should appreciate a few other implications of market complexity
that follow from the question suggested at the beginning of this
chapter: What does a stockmark et’s four-year cycle length mean? It
certainly means that the most revolutionary investing ideas of the
last 30 years—EMT, MPT, and CAPM—can be misleading.
These are the lessons to relearn:
• It is not a waste of time to study individual investment opportunities
in stocks.
• You are likely to do better by thinking about whether individual
investment opportunities make sense than by randomly selecting
a group of stocks for a portfolio by throwing darts at the stock
tables (as contests sponsored by publications such as The Wall
Street Journal lead many to believe).
• Nor will you do better by using modern portfolio theory’s strategy
of putting your eggs in lots of different baskets based on what ß
tells you the riskof each basket is.
It should also be noted that one of the costliest lessons of modern
finance theory was the proliferation of portfolio insurance—a
computerized technique for readjusting a portfolio in declining markets.
The widespread use of portfolio insurance helped precipitate
the stock market crash of October 1987 as well as the market break
of October 1989, for the models prescribed selling off blocks of stock
as their prices fell.
That massive an error—on the scale of the entire market and its
participants—suggests that similar errors occurred throughout the
investing population, including missed opportunities for gain by
small investors. Accordingly, you should ignore modern finance theory
and other quasi-sophisticated views of the market and stick to
investment knitting.
Take the Fifth 73
Strategies
You might askwhether it is worth your time to do hardheaded analysis
of business or whether you would be better off letting other
people do the workand then free riding on their effort. Economists
illustrate this free rider strategy by positing a country that taxes its
citizens in order to build a good military. Everyone agrees that this
is desirable to defend against foreign enemies. A tax dodger free rides
on the public good of a strong military while not contributing to it.
Is it possible for an investor to let others do the investment research
(pay the taxes) yet participate as a free rider in the market
anyway? Not quite. First, in the classic free rider example, there are
two classes of people: those who pay their taxes and those who free
ride. In stockinvesting, there are three: those who do their homework,
those who speculate, and those who free ride. The addition of
the speculators makes it possible for those who would otherwise be
content with a free ride to exploit the folly of the speculators by
doing their homework.
You might ask, If those doing the homework can gain so much
from the speculators, why doesn’t everyone shift from speculating to
homework? Good question. People should. But they don’t. Ben Graham
and Warren Buffett—the consummate homeworkdevotees —
repeatedly marvel at the inertia of speculators and can only wonder
why so many people choose lemming-like laziness over active analysis.
Yet the speculator is here to stay, as the trends identified earlier
suggest (and not everyone will read or heed this book). Plus c¸a
change, plus c¸a la meˆme chose.
Even the strategies that come closest to resembling the free rider
gambit require some work. The most common version of a free rider
strategy, which may be best for many people, is long-term investment
in an index fund. An index fund is a mutual fund that buys the same
securities that are in a given index, such as the S&P 500. They have
grown to gigantic proportions of total invested capital.4
People are attracted to such funds for lots of reasons. For one
thing, the S&P 500 and similar indexes consistently outperform the
managers of active portfolio funds. Indexes also change relatively
little, and so index funds have low stockturnover and therefore lower
costs and better management of taxable gains.
The chief potential downside of indexing is that it pays no attention
to fundamentals, emphasizing past returns rather than evaluating
future prospects. The trade-off hinges on an investor’s ability
74 A Tale of Two Markets
and inclination to conduct business analysis. While using an index
fund gives a reasonable assurance of obtaining the average market
return with very little effort, the investor should still have some reasonable
basis for believing that the basket of stocks that constitutes
the index—whether the S&P 500 or something else—is cheap relative
to the value it contains. Making such a decision requires some
sense of the business analysis discussed in this bookeven if it does
not require precise or detailed application of it.
Monitoring of fundamentals is plain common sense. Buyers of a
market index need to know what value they are getting, just as buyers
of shares do. Both can fluctuate on the upside and the downside.
There is no assurance that the overall stockmark et will go up any
more than there is any assurance that attendance at major league
baseball games will go up. Both can and do go down.
Patience while holding is not as valuable as research before buying,
for many bear markets extend for long periods of time. Whether
a market is heading up or down is impossible to predict, even over
long periods, whereas there is at least some possibility of predicting,
over long periods, which way a particular stockis likely to go.
Stockmutual funds are managed portfolios consisting of selected
stocks from the broader market. An investment committee regularly
buys and sells stocks for the fund. The fund’s shareholders pay the
costs of these trades, plus other fees, making mutual funds more
expensive than index funds. They are also more expensive from a tax
standpoint. Mutual fund portfolio changes often produce capital
gains, and shareholders pay the taxes.
The tax consequence of mutual fund ownership shows an advantage
to holding individual stocks. When you make a mistake in
purchasing a stock—it declines in both price and value to the point
where it no longer meets your requirements for holding it—selling
it at least gives you the modest breakof a tax deduction for the loss
on the sale.
For individual stocks, regular and periodic investing in dividend
reinvestment plans (DRIPs) using the concept of dollar-cost averaging
is a sensible alternative for many people. All this concept
means is that regular purchases of a particular stockin set dollar
amounts each month (or another interval) lower the average cost of
those shares compared to the average of the prices when the shares
were bought. It insulates an investor from the effects of Mr.Market’s
euphoria by taking advantage of his episodic gloom.
Suppose you invested $200 per month in Procter & Gamble durTake
the Fifth 75
ing three months when its stockprice on the purchase dates was
$80, $120, and $100, respectively. The average price during that period
was $100 (80 120 100 divided by 3), but your average cost
would have been $97 (you would have acquired 2.5 shares at $80,
1.66 shares at $120, and 2 shares at $100, and so you would have
invested $600 and acquired 6.16 shares). This strategy can beat Mr.
Market by substantial margins when used over long periods of time.
Staying the course is prudent only if there is a basis for deciding
that price is less than value. Adopting the mind-set developed in this
book is important in making that kind of judgment. Monitoring the
relationship of the DRIP’s price to its value using this mind-set is
prudent. Beware, however, that dollar-cost averaging works to reduce
your average purchase price only if you participate during Mr. Market’s
gloomy moods. It defeats the goal of defeating Mr. Market to
try to time the market by periodically terminating and later resuming
participation.
For all investors (those in index or mutual funds, DRIPs, or individual
stocks) the key point is to develop a mind-set that attends
to the price-value distinction. You can achieve this without necessarily
doing all the detailed computations or extensive research discussed
in this book, but it is imperative to embrace the mind-set
these tools reflect as a way to understand business analysis and intelligent
investing. There are no free rides any more than there are
free lunches.
Diversification of Stock Investments
Unlike modern finance theory, investment knitting does not prescribe
a particular diversification of a stockportfolio. It may result
in diversification, but not as a requirement. Ending up with a concentrated
portfolio is sometimes perfectly fine. As Gerald Loeb
noted, most of the really great fortunes were made by concentration.
5 If you thinkabout Johnson & Johnson or Papa John’s Pizza
and find that the prices at which they can be bought are very low
compared to your reasonable valuation, buying only those two stocks
may be all you need or prudently should do.
You should certainly avoid starting a portfolio on day one with a
dozen diversified stocks. It is almost certain that you will not be able
to find that number of stocks on a single day that are offered at
prices substantially lower than their values. Over long periods of
time, some degree of diversification will probably occur, and it is not
76 A Tale of Two Markets
imprudent to maintain it as long as it does not impair your ability
to concentrate on selecting new candidates or keeping up with what
you already own.
An excessively diversified portfolio gives you a different version
of the free rider problem. Just as a tax dodger benefits from a strong
national defense without contributing to it, a bad stockenjoys the
price you paid for it without contributing value to your portfolio.
Free riders are less noticeable in larger settings; it is easier to catch
a tax cheat in Canada than in the United States, for example. Likewise,
the more stocks you have in your portfolio, the less likely it is
that you will catch and punish (sell) those which are free riding on
your wealth and devouring it.
These principles of limited diversification hold only for wellchosen
common stocks that carry a margin of safety between the
price paid and the reasonable value estimated. For those, Buffett
believes finding between 5 and 10 stocks would be sensible; Graham
says between 10 and 30. Graham and Buffett both emphasize that
investors taking more aggressive stances, as professional money managers
do, require the same kind of wide diversification casino houses
adopt: The house needs, in Buffett’s words, “lots of action because
it is favored by probabilities, but will refuse to accept a single, huge
bet.”6
Asset Allocation
Excessive stockdiversification (and portfolio rebalancing, as discussed
in the last chapter) should be distinguished from a more
fundamental and important investment principle called asset allocation.
This principle recognizes the many types of assets available
to investors, not just common stocks. Alternatives include bonds,
cash, real estate, real estate investment trusts (REITs), and commodities.
These alternatives often furnish attractive ways to store
and build wealth. Their relative attractiveness is potentially greatest
when stockmark ets do not appear to offer prices lower than values,
a prudent time to consider investing in these asset classes. Alternatives
also include any mix of these asset classes invested in taxadvantaged
vehicles such as individual retirement accounts (IRAs)
and 401(k) plans.
Most investors tend to end up with a diversified mix of these
different asset classes: home ownership, some cash on hand, a retirement
vehicle, and a stockand bond mix. Those who do not
should try to do so. Diversity across asset classes is important as a
Take the Fifth 77
way to preserve wealth. If 100% of wealth were allocated to stocks
and the stockmark et overall dragged for a decade, total wealth would
erode. If a portion of the wealth were stored in bonds and the bond
market performed favorably over that time, much of the wealth
would be preserved.
One problem with investments made through tax-advantaged
plans is a lackof diversification in the asset classes offered. Many
plan menus are weighted disproportionately toward stockfunds.
Many people simply elect an even allocation between the items on the
menu. Many others simply allocate 100% to the stockfunds. Either
way, assets are allocated heavily toward stocks. Heavy stock weighting
may be prudent for very young people and even for older people,
but only so long as other (non-plan) assets are in different classes.
Putting all your eggs in the stock market basket is imprudent
asset allocation. Once you have allocated your assets across different
classes, the portion you allocate to stocks need not be diversified. In
short, asset diversification is far more important than stockportfolio
diversification.
Beyond asset preservation, the ultimate issue in asset allocation—
as in investing in general—is the prior and larger question of
opportunity cost. You want to invest your money in the assets most
likely to produce the greatest return in future periods. The general
principles for evaluating that likelihood are pretty much the same
across asset classes. The form of the asset itself guarantees nothing
about its relative attractiveness, a question that depends on its context.
That said, there are plenty of exotic asset classes that most
people are better off staying far clear of, ranging from innocuoussounding
instruments such as convertible bonds to the more mysterious
zones of private equity and hedge funds (more on this below).
The business analysis mind set is just as important in assessing
these alternative asset types as it is in investing in common stocks.
While each asset type warrants attention to the peculiar issues associated
with it (the price of silver depends on supply and demand
for the metal, for example), a mind-set trained in thinking as a business
analyst about common stocks can easily adapt itself for application
to these other asset classes (that is why this bookconcentrates
on common stocks).
Income Allocation
Asset allocation is less important than income allocation, but most
people get this backward too. People focus on how much they make
78 A Tale of Two Markets
but less on how they allocate income between investment and consumption.
The result is a national savings rate around zero.
But if you save more of what you make, it is easier to meet
investing goals since more assets are at work. Those who save relatively
smaller portions of their income are more easily tempted by
speculative impulses that make intelligent investing more difficult.
Everyone with income faces the question of income allocation.
You have to decide how much of your income to allocate to housing
costs, food and clothing, entertainment, transportation, education,
and so on. Some people also have the unfortunate chore of deciding
how to allocate income to pay for past consumption in the form of
cumulated credit card debt, automobile or personal loans, and mortgages
on real estate.
It should be a no-brainer that the high-interest-expense items in
this category should be paid down to zero before an allocator even
thinks about investing in common stocks. If you are carrying a balance
on your credit card accounts that requires you to pay something
like 10 to 18% interest annually, you are wasting your money. Pay
those debts down to zero and you will automatically earn the rate
you otherwise would be paying—guaranteed (something that is never
possible with stocks). The same holds true even for less expensive
obligations such as automobile loans (with average interest rates of
around 8 to 12%): Paying them down to zero with your extra cash
guarantees you that return. It can even be true for home mortgage
loans in some cases: Paying down 6 to 8% debt locks in that rate in
a way that no common stockcan ever guarantee.
Margin Trading
The growth in the number and size of margin accounts for stocks—
especially among day traders—suggests that many people foolishly
neglect these simple truths. From 1996 to 1999, margin debt rose
nearly fivefold at on-line brokerage firms and doubled among NYSE
member firms. During the decade of the 1990s, margin debt as a
percentage of total consumer debt quadrupled from 4% to 16%. Yet
many people do not understand that margin loans are not like other
consumer loans.7
Margin traders borrow from their brokers at rates ranging around
9 to 11% in order to buy stocks with the borrowed money. They think
they can leverage those loans by using the proceeds to buy stocks
whose price rises plus dividends yield greater returns. In euphoric
Take the Fifth 79
markets those people may win, getting returns higher than the cost
of the money. In gloomy markets they get crushed.
When the balance in your portfolio falls so that your margin
loans are equal to about half or more of that amount, you have to
put cash in to pay down that debt (your broker gives you a “margin
call”). If you don’t have the cash, your broker will sell some of your
shares—with or without your cooperation. Add the interest expense
and the trading costs to a reversal of Mr. Market’s euphoria to count
your losses; then multiply that by the number of overextended margin
traders and you have the acute slope of a downhill market before
you.
The big margin traders might as well be high-rolling in Monaco
on borrowed money. Lookno further than the poster boy of marginized
day trading to see the stupefying riskof this strategy. The most
vocal proponent of this high-stakes game is Barry Hertz, the impresario
of a company called TrackData Corporation. Its marketing
pitch gleefully enthused that investing was easy (“you don’t have to
be a pro to trade like one”), and Hertz advised his customers to day
trade, using borrowed funds.
Hertz at least tookhis own (bad) advice to double speculate. So
on Q day (April 14, 2000, when markets plunged), his own brokers
called him to say they needed over $45 million to shore up his margin
account. To do so, Hertz had to pledge over 50% of his shares
of TrackData. 8 Heed the advice of those like Hertz if you like what
happened to him.
Financial Gambling
You would also do well to remember the tragedy of 28-year-old Nick
Leeson, the so-called rogue trader working for the Singapore branch
of Barings. He funded his trading with millions of dollars of borrowed
money, and when the market turned against him, he brought
down Barings, the oldest bankin England and the one that financed
the Napoleonic wars and the Louisiana Purchase!
Leeson ostensibly was doing arbitrage trading, focusing on differences
in prices of Nikkei 225 futures contracts listed on the
Osaka Securities Exchange (OSE) in Japan and the Singapore Monetary
Exchange (SIMEX). He bought futures on one market and
simultaneously sold them on the other. This was a low-riskstrategy ,
since the two positions offset.
Its success led Leeson to another move, a straddle where he
80 A Tale of Two Markets
simultaneously sold put options and call options on Nikkei 225 futures.
This was a medium-riskstrategy , very effective in stable markets
but dangerous in volatile ones.
An earthquake that rocked Kobe, Japan, in January 1995 plunged
the Nikkei and terrorized Leeson. As the market roiled, Leeson acted
like a heroin addict and adopted the high-risk strategy of buying
more Nikkei futures in the vain hope of propping up the fallen market.
When the dust settled, Barings’s exposure on the futures contracts
ran to a staggering $1 billion, far in excess of Barings’s total
capital. The bankfell to its knees. Investigators discovered that Leeson’s
positions had been covered by Baring’s margin accounts while
he was trading, but after the crash—and after Leeson fled Singapore
for Germany—they were not.
During his trading, Leeson told Barings’s main branch in London
the plausible story that he was hedging his long futures positions
with private contracts and was also making hedged trades on behalf
of a client of the bank. In fact, the client did not exist but was a
fictitious name given to an account that Leeson invented earlier for
his own use.
Leeson allegedly funded that account with proceeds from other
trades and used those funds to maintain the margin account balance.
He apparently used the fictitious client account to convince Barings
in London to provide additional firm capital, which Lesson in turn
used to shore up the margin account. In the end, none of that was
enough.9
The Leeson lesson is admittedly an extreme psychological case
tripped up in a mix of exotic securities, excess margins, and fraud.
But the drama is a memorable warning that margins and exotica can
get you in over your head and that mixing them can get it handed
to you on a platter.
Options
A final warning on exotica takes us back to Ben Graham’s opinion
on options. Even before stockoption awards to managers became
commonplace, Graham disparaged the instruments on more general
grounds.
Options originally were attached to bonds and by the 1920s had
expanded as part of other financial innovations Graham regarded as
abusive. When they reappeared more widely in the 1960s, Graham
Take the Fifth 81
regarded “stockoption warrants” as they were then called, as “a near
fraud, an existing menace, and a potential disaster.” He believed they
created value out of thin air, had no excuse for existing except to
mislead people, and should be prohibited by law or at least capped
at a minor part of a company’s total capital.
The major negative effects of options are dilution of existing
shareholders’ ownership interest in the company—including existing
earnings per share, sharing in future growth, enjoying dividend payments,
voting for managers, and other major corporate changes such
as mergers and (a bit ironically) new option plans. Graham could
see no purpose in options generally other than to “fabricate imaginary
market values.” In short, Graham condemned stock options as
criminal, a monstrous and “wanton creation of huge paper-money.”10
Buffett echoes the point less vociferously by saying that “the
business project in which you would wish to have an option frequently
is a project in which you would reject ownership. (I’ll be
happy to accept a lottery ticket as a gift—but I’ll never buy one.)”11
The lesson for investors is clear. Stay away from options and stay as
far away as possible from companies in which options constitute a
significant portion of total capital.
ALCHEMY
Stockmark et bubbles occur when aggregate capital invested in equity
securities exceeds the amount of profitable deployment opportunities
so that prices exceed values by terrific multiples. They result
from the hope that the stocks people pick will turn out to be the
ones that enjoy the profits. But if, say, $100 billion is allocated to
ventures that can only give returns from profitable investments on
$10 billion, then $90 billion in disappointment is going to come—
90% of the dollars will be left standing without chairs to sit in when
the music stops.
The main difference between the musical chairs of market speculation
and the activity at the typical racetrackis that horse races
take only about two minutes to separate the gambler from her
money. What horse betting and the stockmark et do have in common,
however, is that those who study the horses or businesses and
who bet seldom are more likely to be winners than are those who
bet on every race or stock.12 In the early stages of a boom that may
bubble, if you can find the cinch stockat a low price and load up
82 A Tale of Two Markets
on that stock, it is reasonably likely that you will win; if you bet on
everything that comes down the track, it is most certain that you
will lose.
Those who bet on everything coming down the trackadd hot air
to the bubble. It is a large-scale version of the mania that leads to
around-the-blocklottery lines during hefty jackpots. What creates
most bubbles is the whiff of great riches from something new that
excites people and leads them to irrational behavior or at least herdlike
behavior.
The wildfire of excitement is spread by unchecked rumors of
champagne and caviar dreams come true—stories of riches, reinforced
by greed. The frenzy spirals, but ultimately breaks. In reality,
only one person wins the lottery jackpot and the multitudes experience
the most expensive case of “monkey see, monkey do.”
Edwin LeFe`vre put it nicely: “The appeal in all booms is always
frankly to the gambling instinct aroused by cupidity and spurred by
pervasive prosperity. People who lookfor easy money invariably pay
for the privilege of proving conclusively that it cannot be found on
this sordid earth.”13
Real investors are not the same people who wait in long lottery
ticket lines. They realize that “get rich quick” usually means “get
poor quicker.”
For a bit of de´ ja` vu, consider Graham’s observation from the late
1960s: “The speculative public is incorrigible. In financial terms it
cannot count beyond 3. It will buy anything, at any price, if there
seems to be some ‘action’ in progress. It will fall for any company
identified with ‘franchising,’ computers, electronics, science, technology,
or what have you, when the particular fashion is raging.”14
In Yogi Berra “it’s de´ ja` vu all over again” style, note this similar
vintage Graham lament: “Bright, energetic people—usually quite
young—have promised to perform miracles with ‘other people’s
money’ since time immemorial. They have usually been able to do
it for a while—or at least to appear to have done it—and they have
inevitably brought losses to their public in the end. . . . [I]t is probably
too much to expect that the urge to speculate will ever disappear,
or that the exploitation of that urge can ever be abolished.”15
The urge to speculate endures, with vast numbers of people
seeming to accept the declaration of hyperventilating venture capitalists
and day traders that the new economy of the late 1990s and
early 2000s means that the old rules of the game no longer apply.
An extraordinary statement of these times was uttered by the chief
Take the Fifth 83
economist of a prominent investment research firm who announced
to The New York Times that “we no longer thinkwe know how to
value companies” (to be kind, that confused confessor shall go unnamed
in this book).
Valuation has always been difficult, but how much harder now
can it be than it was before? Cash is the ultimate economic payoff.
If you can’t get to the point of figuring out how long it takes
to get cash and what risks may reduce the amount or value of it,
then it is not that you don’t know how to value companies anymore
but that the things you are trying to value are not worth trying
to value.
Proponents of financial alchemy shrinkfrom the mind-set of
business analysis discussed in this book, presumably deeming its
tools conventional, maybe even boring, dull, and old-fashioned.
When people want to be rich now, they relegate the idea of a nest
egg grown with patient discipline to the dustbin of the older generation’s
history, alien territory to freshly minted paper millionaires
and their envious contemporaries.
Unfortunately, this attitude leads to day gambling on stocks using
credit card debt and a “buy now, pay later” myopia that neglects
the inevitable day of reckoning. It also leads to the popularity of
techniques that enable false positive answers to key questions about
a business when traditional tools give negative answers.
In the biotechnology industry in the early to mid-1990s, for example,
fewer than 10% of companies generated earnings and few
even generated positive cash flows from their operating businesses.
But those companies needed new investment. Since the traditional
measures of business analysis could not tell a convincing story, they
turned to unorthodox measures. The most striking was a measure of
so-called performance known as “cash-burn.” This was the rate at
which a business was “able” to spend cash on new research projects.
The more burn, the better the management and the more desirable
the investment. Crazy?
It is not much crazier than the similar move made in the Internet
and high-technology industries of the late 1990s and early 2000s.
These financial entrepreneurs jettisoned the traditional metrics of
performance and value based on earnings and cash in favor of new
ways to look at these questions. Take market share, for example.
Entrepreneurs say, “Look, we have 60% of the market in selling
flowers (or whatnot) over the Internet, and you should give us credit
for that.” Or, more optimistically yet, “We have 10 million ‘hits’ on
84 A Tale of Two Markets
our Internet site every month. Even though we don’t make money,
that’s 20 million (or so) eyeballs, so we must be good, we must have
value, and you should invest with us.”
People do in droves, following a monkey see, monkey do mentality.
For most—though not all—of those businesses, the flood of
funds is unjustifiable in a business analysis mind-set. (The next
growth industry is likely to be Internet bankruptcy law firms.)
Every frenzy is accompanied by rational-sounding new rules that
attempt to explain the irrationality. In the last century alone, a “New
Era” bull market culminated in the 1929 crash (fueled by the spread
of wonderful new technologies such as cars, electricity, vacuum
cleaners, washing machines, radio, and talking movies), a “Second
New Era” flamed out in 1962’s “New Panic,” and a “New Performance
Phenomenon” preceded the implosion of markets and mutual
funds in the late 1960s. The stockmark et bubble in Japan in the
1980s was fueled by the widespread belief that Japan had created a
“new” economic model that defied the historical principles of economics.
Market share was king, and companies were rewarded if
they had it and rewarded more if they got it at the price of having
no or low profits, much as in 1990s–2000s U.S. markets.16
This is not to say that market share is irrelevant. Market share
is a standard and useful indicator of the relative performance of
Coke compared to Pepsi, for example, and something both these
companies pursue aggressively in their competition in the beverage
marketplace. And it is significant that Cisco has 80% of the router
market and 30 to 40% in network switches and that DuPont dominates
global markets in nylon and Lycra. That kind of market scale
enables a company to lower the cost of sales and general and administrative
expenses, which translates into higher profits.
But Coke, Pepsi, Cisco, and DuPont make money in their markets.
A larger share of a profitable market is certainly desirable and
a good indicator of strong business performance. The same can hardly
be said for a larger share of an unprofitable one. On the contrary,
the greater your share is, the more money you lose.
Aggressive accumulation of market share can be perfectly disastrous
for a business. Lookat what happened to the airline industry
after deregulation. Intense competition for market share drove nearly
all the profits out of that business. The same thing occurs in the
submarkets where Coke and Pepsi compete, driving profits at bottlers
for those brands close to zero in some places.
Nor is this to deny that technological changes from the 1980s to
Take the Fifth 85
the 2000s produced significant shifts in the economy. Rising oil
prices, for example, historically throttled the economy, sponsoring
the recessions of 1973, 1980, and, to a lesser degree, 1990. Yet when
oil prices more than doubled during the late 1990s and early 2000s,
inflation remained quite low and no threat of recession loomed. Part
of the reason was a shift to natural gas and greater use by major oil
consumers (such as airlines) of hedging contracts that reduced their
exposure to such price increases.
But a major part of the reason is econographic shifts from oilconsuming
manufacturing operations to oil-independent service
businesses, including those run on the Internet. Manufacturing operations
as a percentage of the economy shrankfrom 22% in 1977
to 17% twenty years later. The share of gross domestic product (GDP)
allocated to oil purchases fell from 8.5% in 1981 to about 3% in the
late 1990s. The Internet is surely part of this shift, as it enables the
conduct of sales and distribution businesses at far lower cost than
traditional means.17
Even so, oil prices above some level will still trigger such macroeconomic
problems. Indeed, the plunge in the Dow by nearly 4%
in March 2000 was led by a 30% drop in the stockprice of Procter
& Gamble. That company issued a warning that its quarterly earnings
were going to be way lower than those in the same quarter of
the prior year and much lower than analysts expected. The company
cited as one cause of that disappointment the rising cost of oil,
which it uses in many of its products.
Another part of the shift is surely the increasing value attached
to intellectual as opposed to physical capital. Businesses producing
and selling software or on-line services can grow more quickly and
at lower cost than can those producing and selling automobiles or
oil. Far less investment in factories, plants, and equipment is required.
There is no reason to believe, however, that those companies as
a whole can grow any faster than the economy overall is growing. In
the end, the old-fashioned companies (the so-called old economy
companies) are the major customers (and beneficiaries) of the tech
upstarts (the so-called new economy companies), so how much faster
can the latter group grow than the former? Some companies
might, but not forever or just because they have in the past (indeed,
the bigger you get, the harder it is to grow). Even if outsized growth
is possible, it cannot be guaranteed.
Even with these shifts, the new economy does not change the
86 A Tale of Two Markets
basic facts of business life that call for investing based on an understanding
of a company’s business climate; some key ratios must
be in the tool box of all smart investors. Even if some of the new
economy business metrics are used, they should be analyzed critically.
Ignoring losses is foolish, but ignoring signs of endurance is
downright stupid.
If you accept growing market share as an indication of future
value, for example, you also have to recognize that slowdowns in
customer growth are a sign of reduced future value. You must agree
that when revenues per new customer fall while costs per new customer
climb, you go from uncertain to bad. These facts are characteristic
of many Internet companies whose stockprices actually
rise on this kind of news. These companies include some of the best
names in the “space,” giving reason to thinkthat the new economy
may just be a wolf in sheep’s clothing. After all, something that
seems too good to be true usually is.
People talkof the new millennium and the unmatched pace of
technological change, but this impression is mistaken. If you comb
through the annals of economic and investment writing over the
centuries, you will discover repeated periodic references to the rapid
pace of technological change and declarations that nothing like it
has ever been seen (historians dubbed the late 1890s and early 1900s
the Age of Optimism, imbued with technological excitement that
makes centennial turns seem the natural apotheoses of exuberance).
Just pause to consider the printing press, the agricultural and industrial
revolutions, the assembly line, television and radio, and now
computers and the Internet.
Even the sober Ben Graham felt constrained to report on the
sense of his time, writing in the relatively recent period of the early
1970s that: “the rapid and pervasive growth of technology in recent
years is not without major effect on the attitude and the labors of
the security analyst. More so than in the past, the progress or retrogression
of the typical company in the coming decade may depend
on its relation to new products and new processes.”18 To repeat what
Graham was fond of saying, plus c¸a change, plus c¸a la meˆme chose.
THE LONG RUN
The attitude that drives any mania is as shortsighted as it is shortlived.
Investors need to looklong down the road of years rather than
Take the Fifth 87
the path of days when thinking about business and returns. How far
will vary with the person’s age and needs, but a minimum time frame
for anyone serious about investing is four years—and way longer for
most of us.
It is customary to call people with a long-term view “long-term
investors” and to say that such investors adopt a “buy-and-hold”
strategy. Apart from using redundant vocabulary (an investor, by definition,
is always dealing in the long term), these characterizations
are imprecise.
One reason to lookat the long term is to realize that while early
investing is better, no one needs to make an investment every day
or even every year. As Warren Buffett says, using a baseball analogy,
there is no such thing as a called strike in investing—no penalty for
sitting backand waiting for your pitch to come in. If a characterization
of this style of view is necessary, it is more apt to call it the
“wait-and-see” approach than the “buy-and-hold” approach.
Either of these approaches, however, is superior to the promiscuous
practices of speculative traders. It is true, to an extent, that
today’s rookie companies are tomorrow’s classics, but it is false, to
a fault, that day traders and their ilkact on this insight. The average
holding period for the top 50 Nasdaq stocks in late 1999 was less
than 30 days, and for Nasdaq stocks as a whole it was about 150
days (compared to about 730 days in the late 1980s).19 That kind of
turnover means the speculators are neither picking stocks carefully
(a wait-and-see approach) nor buying them for the long term (a buyand-
hold approach).
Keynes famously quipped that in the long run we are all dead.
But he wasn’t talking about stock picking. Keynes made that comment
in the context of persuading policy makers to focus on shortterm
needs that could be met, he believed, only by governmental
rather than market actions. Indeed, the phrase makes no sense in
the stock-picking context, since it is always better to be rich later
than to be poor sooner and most of us will leave family survivors.
Ben Graham expressly referred to stocks when he said that in
the short run the market is a voting machine, while in the long run
it is a weighing machine. This means that the market is risky in the
short run for its wild pricing gyrations but gets relatively stable and
safer over the long run. But what does it mean to say that the market
will eventually price an asset correctly? Doesn’t it mean that the
market is sometimes correct—that it must, as Alice said in Wonderland,
“sometimes come to jam today”? Not exactly.
88 A Tale of Two Markets
Milton Friedman’s rejoinder to Keynes was that the long run is
just a series of short runs linked in succession. Thus the long run
is simultaneously with us (it was the long run four years ago) and
ahead of us (four years from now). Market price today reflects the
value of a business as long ago as four years, and the price today is
a guess about business productivity and returns some four years from
now. If your guess is better than the market’s, then while four years
from now the market may be getting today’s value of that business
right, you will be that much ahead.
That is the sense in which the market may get it right in the
long term: Four years from now the market will get correct what
Starbucks is doing today; if you are able to assess that performance
better than today’s market crowd is doing, you will reap outsized
returns. The hard question, of course, is how to make that determination
with high success rates.
Warren Buffett takes Keynes seriously, adopting the “till death
do us part” standard. He invests only in businesses he would be
happy to hold forever. It is a commitment not unlike the one you
make to your spouse. The consequence is the same: be patient and
picky in your search.
P a r t II
SHOW ME
THE MONEY
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
This page intentionally left blank.
91
C h a p t e r 6
APPLE TREES AND
EXPERIENCE
If market price is the last thing an investor or manager shouldlook
at in determining the value of a business or an ownership interest
in it, the first thing to consider is its fundamental economic characteristics.
There are so many approaches to appraising those fundamentals
that many people use the relatively lazy metric of market
price as a guideline in valuation, but that is a mistake. Of all the
approaches to appraising business value, just a few do virtually all
the hardwork, andthose are the ones you need. A parable will
illustrate the basics, andthe rest of this part will fill in the details.1
FOOLS AND WISDOM
Once there was a wise oldman who ownedan apple tree. It was a
fine tree, andwith little care it produceda crop of apples each year
which he soldfor $100. The man wantedto retire to a new climate,
and he decided to sell the tree. He enjoyed teaching a good lesson,
andhe placedan advertisement in the business opportunities section
of The Wall Street Journal in which he saidhe wantedto sell the
tree for “the best offer.”
Some Red Herrings
The first person to respondto the adoffered to pay $50, which, he
said, was what he could get for selling the apple tree for firewood
after he cut it down. “You don’t know what you are talking about,”
the oldman chastised. “You are offering to pay only the salvage value
of this tree. That might be a goodprice for a pine tree or even this
tree if it hadstoppedbearing fruit or if the price of apple wood had
gotten so high that the tree was more valuable as a source of wood
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
92 Show Me the Money
than as a source of fruit. But you are obviously not competent to
understand these things, so you can’t see that my tree is worth far
more than 50 bucks.”
The next person who visitedthe oldman offeredto pay $100 for
the tree. “For that,” she opined, “is what I would be able to get for
selling this year’s crop of fruit, which is about to mature.” “You are
not as out of your depth as the first one,” responded the old man.
“At least you see that this tree has more value as a producer of apples
than it wouldas a source of firewood. But $100 is not the right price.
You are not considering the value of next year’s crop of apples or
that of the years after. Please take your $100 andgo elsewhere.”
The thirdperson to come along was a young man who had just
dropped out of business school. “I am going to sell apples on the
Internet,” he said. “I figure that the tree should live for at least
another 15 years. If I sell the apples for $100 a year, that will total
$1,500. I offer you $1,500 for your tree.” “Oh, no, dot-commer,” lamentedthe
man, “you’re even more ill informedabout reality than
the others I’ve spoken with.”
“Surely the $100 you wouldearn by selling the apples from the
tree 15 years from now cannot be worth $100 to you today. In fact,
if you placed$41.73 today in a bank account paying 6% interest,
compounded annually, that small sum would grow to $100 at the end
of 15 years. So the present value of $100 worth of apples 15 years
from now, assuming an interest rate of 6%, is only $41.73 not $100.
Pray,” advised the beneficent old man, “take your $1,500 and invest
it safely in high-grade corporate bonds and go back to business
school andlearn something about finance.”
Before long there came a wealthy physician who said, “I don’t
know much about apple trees, but I know what I like. I’ll pay the
market price for it. The last fellow was willing to pay you $1,500 for
the tree, andso it must be worth that.”
“Doctor,” advisedthe oldman, “you should get yourself a knowledgeable
investment adviser. If there were truly a market in which
apple trees were traded with some regularity, the prices at which
they were soldmight tell you something about their value. But not
only is there no such market, even if there were, taking its price as
the value is just mimicking the stupidity of that last knucklehead or
the others before him. Please take your money andbuy a vacation
home.”
The next would-be buyer was an accounting student. When the
old man asked, “What price are you willing to give me?” the student
Apple Trees and Experience 93
first demandedto see the oldman’s books. The oldman had kept
careful records and gladly brought them out.
After examining them, the accounting student said, “Your books
show that you paid$75 for this tree ten years ago. Furthermore, you
have made no deductions for depreciation. I do not know if that
conforms with generally acceptedaccounting principles, but assuming
that it does, the book value of your tree is $75. I will pay that.”
“Ah, you students know so much and yet so little,” chided the
oldman. “It is true that the book value of my tree is $75, but any
fool can see that it is worth far more than that. You hadbest go back
to school andsee if you can finda book that shows you how to use
your numbers to better effect.”
A Dialogue on Earnings
The final prospect to visit the oldman was a young stockbroker who
hadrecently graduatedfrom business school. Eager to test her new
skills, she too askedto examine the books. After several hours she
came back to the oldman andsaidshe was prepared to make an
offer that valuedthe tree on the basis of the capitalization of its
earnings. For the first time the oldman’s interest was piqued, and
he askedher to go on.
The young woman explainedthat while the apples were sold for
$100 last year, that figure did not represent the profits realized from
the tree. There were expenses attendant to the tree, such as the cost
of fertilizer, pruning, tools, picking apples, andcarting them to town
andselling them.
Somebody had to do those things, and a portion of the salaries
paidto those persons ought to be charged against the revenues from
the tree. Moreover, the purchase price, or cost, of the tree was an
expense. A portion of the cost is taken into account each year of the
tree’s useful life. Finally, there were taxes. She concluded that the
profit from the tree was $50 last year.
“Wow!” The old man blushed. “I thought I made $100 off that
tree.”
“That’s because you failedto match expenses with revenues, in
accordance with generally accepted accounting principles,” she explained.
“You don’t actually have to write a check to be charged with
what accountants consider to be your expenses. For example, you
bought a station wagon some time ago andusedit part of the time
to cart apples to market. The wagon will last a while, andeach year
94 Show Me the Money
some of the original cost has to be matchedagainst revenues. A
portion of the amount has to be spreadout over the next several
years even though you expended it all at one time. Accountants call
that depreciation. I’ll bet you never figured that in your calculation
of profits.”
“I’ll bet you’re right,” he replied. “Tell me more.”
“I also went back into the books for a few years andsaw that in
some years the tree produced fewer apples than it did in other years,
the prices varied, and the costs were not exactly the same each year.
Taking an average of only the last three years, I came up with a
figure of $45 as a fair sample of the tree’s earnings. But that is only
half of what we have to do to figure the value.”
“What’s the other half?” he asked.
“The tricky part,” she toldhim. “We now have to figure the value
to me of owning a tree that will produce average annual earnings of
$45 a year. If I believedthat the tree was a ‘one-year wonder,’ I would
say 100% of its value—as a going business—was representedby one
year’s earnings.”
“But if we agree that the tree is more like a corporation in that
it will continue to produce earnings year after year, the key is to
figure out an appropriate rate of return. In other words, I will be
investing my capital in the tree, andI need to compute the value to
me of an investment that will produce $45 a year in income. We can
call that amount the capitalizedvalue of the tree.”
“Do you have something in mind?” he asked.
“I’m getting there. If this tree produced entirely steady and predictable
earnings each year, it would be like a U.S. Treasury bond.
But its earnings are not guaranteed, so we have to take into account
risks anduncertainty . If the risk of its ruin was high, I would insist
that a single year’s earnings represent a higher percentage of the
value of the tree. After all, apples couldbecome a glut on the market
one day andyou wouldhave to cut the price, thus increasing the
costs of selling them.”
“Or,” she continued, “some doctor could discover a link between
eating an apple a day and heart disease. A drought could cut the
yield of the tree. Or the tree could become diseasedandd ie. These
are all risks. Andwe don’t even know whether the costs we are sure
to incur will be worth incurring.”
“You are a gloomy one,” reflectedthe oldman. “There could also
be a shortage of apples on the market, andthe price of apples could
rise. If you think about it, it is even possible that I have been selling
Apple Trees and Experience 95
the apples at prices below what people wouldbe willing to pay and
that you couldraise the price without reducing your sales. Also,
there are treatments, you know, that couldbe appliedto increase
the yieldof the tree. This tree could help spawn a whole orchard.
Any of these wouldincrease earnings.”
“The earnings also couldbe increasedby lowering costs of the
sort you mentioned,” the old man continued. “Costs can be reduced
by speeding the time from fruition to sale, managing extensions of
credit better, and minimizing losses from bad apples. Cutting costs
boosts the relationship between overall sales andnet earnings or, as
the financial types say, the tree’s profit margin. Andthat in turn
wouldboost the return on your investment.”
“I am aware of all that,” she assuredhim. “The fact is, we are
talking about risk. Andinvestment analysis is a coldbusiness. We
don’t know with certainty what’s going to happen. You want your
money now, andI’m supposed to live with the risk.
“That’s fine with me, but then I have to look through a cloudy
crystal ball, andnot with 20/20 hindsight. Andmy resources are
limited. I have to choose between your tree and the strawberry patch
down the road. I cannot buy both, and the purchase of your tree
will deprive me of alternative investments. That means I have to
compare the opportunities andthe risks.
“To determine a proper rate of return,” she continued, “I looked
at investment opportunities comparable to the apple tree, particularly
in the agribusiness industry, where these factors have been
taken into account. I then adjusted my findings based on how the
things we discussedworkedout with your tree. Based on those judgments,
I figure that 20% is an appropriate rate of return for the tree.
“In other words,” she concluded, “assuming that the average
earnings from the tree over the last three years (which seems to be
a representative period) are indicative of the return I will receive, I
am preparedto pay a price for the tree that will give me a 20% return
on my investment. I am not willing to accept any lower rate of return
because I don’t have to; I can always buy the strawberry patch instead.
Now, to figure the price, we simply divide $45 of earnings per
year by the 20% return I am insisting on.”
“Long division was never my strong suit. Is there a simpler way
of doing the figuring?” he asked hopefully.
“There is,” she assuredhim. “We can use an approach we Wall
Street types prefer, calledthe price-earnings (or P/E) ratio. To compute
the ratio, just divide 100 by the rate of return we are seeking.
96 Show Me the Money
If I were willing to settle for an 8% return, that would be 100 divided
by 8, which equals 12.5. So we’duse a P/E ratio of 12.5 to 1. But
since I want to earn 20% on my investment, I divided 100 by 20 and
came up with a P/E ratio of 5:1. In other words, I am willing to pay
five times the tree’s estimatedannual earnings. Multiplying $45 by
5, I get a value of $225. That’s my offer.”
The oldman sat back andsaidhe greatly appreciated the lesson.
He wouldhave to think about her offer, andhe askedif she could
come by the next day.
A Dialogue on Cash
When the young woman returned, she found the old man emerging
from behinda sea of work sheets, small print columns of numbers,
and a calculator. “Delighted to see you,” he said, enthralled. “I think
we can do business.
“It’s easy to see how you Wall Street smarties make so much
money, buying people’s property for less than its true value. I think
I can get you to agree that my tree is worth more than you figured.”
“I’m open-minded,” she assured him.
“The $45 number you came up with yesterday was something
you calledprofits, or earnings that I earnedin the past. I’m not so
sure it tells you anything that important.”
“Of course it does,” she protested. “Profits measure efficiency
andeconomic utility.”
“Fair enough,” he mused, “but it sure doesn’t tell you how much
money you’re getting. I lookedin my safe yesterday after you left
and saw some stock certificates I own that never paid a dividend to
me. AndI kept getting reports each year telling me how great the
earnings were. Now I know that the earnings increasedthe value of
my stocks, but without any dividends I couldn’t spend them. It’s just
the opposite with the tree.
“You figuredthe earnings were lower because of some amounts
I’ll never have to spend, like depreciation on my station wagon,” the
oldman went on. “It seems to me these earnings are an idea worked
up by the accountants.”
Intrigued, she asked, “What is important, then?”
“Cash,” he answered. “I’m talking about dollars you can spend,
save, or give to your children. This tree will go on for years yielding
revenues after costs. Andit is the future, not the past, we need to
reckon with.”
Apple Trees and Experience 97
“Don’t forget the risks,” she reminded him. “And the uncertainties.”
“Quite right,” he observed. “If we can agree on the possible range
of future revenues andcosts andthat earnings averaged around $45
the last few years, we can make some fair estimates of cash flow
over the coming five years: How about that there is a 25% chance
that cash flow will be $40, a 50% chance it will be $50, anda 25%
chance it will be $60?
“That makes $50 our best guess if you average it out,” the old
man figured. “Then let’s just say that for ten years after that the
average will be $40. Andthat’s it. The tree doctor tells me it can’t
produce any longer than that.
“Now all we have to do,” he finished up, “is figure out what you
pay today to get $50 a year from now, two years from now, and so
on for the first five years until we figure what you wouldpay to get
$40 a year for each of the ten years after that. Then, throw in the
20 bucks we can get for firewood.
“Simple,” she confessed. “You want to discount to the present
value of future receipts including salvage value. Of course you need
to determine the rate at which you discount.”
“Precisely,” he concurred. “That’s what my charts and the calculator
are for.” She nodded as he showed her discount tables that
revealed what a dollar received at a later time is worth today under
different assumptions about the discount rate. It showed, for example,
that at an 8% discount rate, a dollar delivered a year from
now is worth $.93 today, simply because $.93 today, invested at 8%,
will produce $1 a year from now.
“You couldput your money in a savings account that is insured
andreceive 5% interest. But you couldalso buy U.S. Treasury obligations
with it and earn, say, 8% interest, depending on prevailing
interest rates. That looks like the risk-free rate of interest to me.
Anywhere else you put your money deprives you of the opportunity
to earn 8% risk-free. Discounting by 8% will only compensate you
for the time value of the money you invest in the tree rather than
in Treasuries. But the cash flow from the apple tree is not riskless,
sadto say, so we needto use a higher discount rate to compensate
you for the risk in your investment.
“Let’s agree to discount the receipt of $50 a year from now by
15%, andso on with the other deferredreceipts. That is about the
rate that is appliedto investments with this magnitude of risk. You
can check that out with my neighbor, who just soldhis strawberry
98 Show Me the Money
patch yesterday. According to my figures, the present value of the
expectedyearly profit is $268.05, andtod ay’s value of the firewood
is $2.44, for a grandtotal of $270.49. I’ll take $270 even. You can
see how much I’m allowing for risk because if I discounted the
stream at 8%, it wouldcome to $388.60.”
After a few minutes of reflection, the young woman saidto the
oldman, “It was a bit foxy of you yesterday to let me appear to be
teaching you something. Where did you learn so much about finance
as an apple grower?”
The old man smiled. “Wisdom comes from experience in many
fields.”
“I enjoyedthis little exercise, but let me tell you something that
some financial whiz kids told me,” she replied. “Whether we figure
value on the basis of the discounted cash flow method you like or
the capitalization of earnings I proposed, so long as we apply both
methods perfectly, we should come out at exactly the same point.”
“Of course!” the old man exclaimed. “The wunderkinds are
catching on. The clever ones are not simply looking at oldearnings
but copying managers by projecting cash flows into the future. The
question is which methodis more likely to be misused.
“I prefer my methodof using cash rather than earnings because
I don’t have to monkey around with costs like depreciation of my
station wagon andother long-term assets. You have to make these
arbitrary assumptions about the useful life of the thing andhow fast
you’re going to depreciate it. That’s where I think you went wrong
in your figuring.”
“Nice try, you crafty old devil,” she rejoined. “You know there is
plenty of room for mistakes in your calculations too. It’s easy to
discount cash flows when they are nice and steady, but that doesn’t
help you when you’ve got some lumpy expenses that do not recur.
For example, several years from now that tree will needserious pruning
andspraying that don’t show up in your flow. The labor and
chemicals for that once-only occasion throw off the evenness of your
calculations.”
“But I’ll tell you what,” she belliedup. “I’ll offer you $250. My
coldanalysis tells me I’m overpaying, but I really like that tree. I
think the delight of sitting in its glorious shade must be worth something.”
“It’s a deal,” agreedthe oldman. “I never said I was looking for
the highest offer but only the best offer.”
Apple Trees and Experience 99
Lessons
The parable of the oldman andthe tree introduced a number of
alternative methods of valuing productive property, whether a single
asset or an entire business enterprise. The original $50 bidwas based
on the tree’s salvage value, also sometimes calledits scrap value.
This valuation methodwill virtually always be inappropriate for valuing
a productive asset, business, or share of stock (though many
bust-up takeover artists of the 1980s popularizedthe opposite claim).
The $100 bidwas basedonly on one year’s earnings and ignores
the earning power over future time. The Internet apple maven’s
$1,500 overvaluation ignoredthe concept of the time value of money
by simply adding together the raw dollar amounts of expected earnings
over future years. Neither of these approaches even qualifies as
an appropriate valuation method.
The doctor’s bid drew on a market-based valuation technique
that considers what other willing buyers had offered. But that technique
will be helpful only if the property under consideration or
similar properties are regularly traded in reasonably well developed
markets. Even then, it is circular because it uses the question
(What’s it worth, according to others?) to get the answer (What it’s
worth, according to others).
The deal was ultimately sealed when the buyer and the old man
agreedthat the two methods they used—capitalizing earnings and
discounting cash flows—made the most sense (noting that these two
techniques, if perfectly applied, give the same answer). The buyer
preferredto use earnings because accounting rules regarding earnings
are intended to reflect economic reality pretty well. The old man
hadless confidence in those rules principally because they call for
deducting from revenues accounting depreciation, which he was not
sure accurately reflectedeconomic reality.
Although reasonable people can differ, both methods show that
valuation is not a fool’s game. The buyer andthe oldman both wisely
and rightly acknowledged the importance of keen judgment in business
analysis. As the type of investment you consider becomes more
uncertain, your judgment must become proportionately more razorsharp.
Picking an index fundor even a mutual fundrequires the least
amount of knowledge or judgment; picking a classic stock a bit more,
a vintage stock much more, anda rookie stock the greatest. In terms
of apples, the apple tree the oldman just soldis much like a classic
100 Show Me the Money
business, a GE, say, or DuPont or UnitedT echnologies. It is mature
andprod uctive andhas an extensive track record.
At the other extreme might be a dot-com start-up business whose
only recordis on paper—a business plan that is the apple tree equivalent
of a bag of seeds. Even if the ingredients are there, the execution
is entirely in front of you. You may still have a basis for gauging
the probable future—the quality of the seeds, soil, fertilizer, and
farmer—but you are leaving more to judgment than in the case of
the mature tree.
A few additional morals of the parable: Methods are useful as
tools, but good judgment comes not from methods alone but from
experience. Andexperience comes from bad judgment. Listen
closely to the experts andhear the things they don’t tell you. Behind
all the sweet sounds of their confident notes there is a great
deal of discordant uncertainty. One wrong assumption can carry
you pretty far from the truth. Finally, you are never too young to
learn.
HORSE SENSE
The oldman andhis ultimate buyer shared a business analysis mindset.
That mind-set focuses on individual businesses but must be
formed against the backdrop of a few general conditions—what
economists call macroeconomic conditions: interest rates, taxes, inflation,
andthe time value of money (or compounding).
Compounding
A powerful andintuitive introduction to the time value of money is
given by this characteristically witty vignette by a 32-year-oldW arren
Buffett:
I have it from unreliable sources that the cost of the voyage
Isabella originally underwrote for Columbus was approximately
$30,000. This has been considered at least a moderately successful
utilization of venture capital.Without attempting to evaluate
the psychic income derived from finding a new hemisphere,
it must be pointedout that . . . the whole deal was not exactly
another IBM. Figuredvery roughly, the $30,000 invested at 4%
compounded annually would have amounted to something like
$2,000,000,000,000. . . .
Apple Trees and Experience 101
That is $2 trillion—basedon a quite modest 4% rate of return.
Not only nothing to sneeze at but something to be joyous over. Buffett
calledthis vignette “The Joys of Compounding.”
It explains the apocryphal story of Buffett riding up a crowded
office building elevator. All heads were staring up at the floor numbers
lighting across the top, while Buffett was scouring the elevator
floor. As he walkedout, Buffett stoopedd own and picked up a penny
lying on the floor. The doors closedbehindhim, smirks crossed some
passengers’ faces, and one rider remarked, “That is the start of the
next billion.”
If you think a penny today does not amount to a hill of beans,
consider how much it will grow to over time! That is the joy of future
values of money—they get higher the more compounding there is.
You get compounding in two ways. You can put money away earlier
rather than later, and you can get returns (interest or dividends) paid
more frequently andreinvest them too. That is why building wealth
calls for saving early andoften, though investing only when the price
is right.
Investors grasp the joys of compounding, for it is a useful tool
to evaluate competing opportunities quickly. A handy reference for
making the comparisons gauges how long it takes a given amount of
money to double at varying compounded rates of return (or interest
rates).
Calledthe rule of 72s, it says that dividing 72 by the rate of
return gives the approximate number of years it takes for an amount
of money to double. For example, an investment yielding a compounded
rate of return of 9% will double in about eight years (72
divided by 9 equals 8) and one yielding 6% will double in about 12
years (72 divided by 6 equals 12).
The rule of 72s can show all sorts of variations on the relationship
between money in handnow andmoney to be gotten in the
future. For example, it can determine what required rate of return
is necessary for a certain sum to grow to a desired sum in the future.
Or if you know what rate of return is available or possible, it can
figure how much money someone needs today in order for it to grow
to a desired level at some future time.
Take an example. If the available average rate of return on money
from now until 40 years from now is 9%, how much money does a
25-year-old person need today in order to retire as a millionaire at
age 65 without saving another cent over that time? Work backward
from ending up with $1,000,000 at age 65. Since money earning a
102 Show Me the Money
compoundrate of return of 9% doubles approximately every 8 years,
at age 57 she’dneedto have $500,000; at age 49 she’d need to have
$250,000; at age 41 she’dneedto have $125,000; at age 33 she’d
needto have $62,500; andtod ay, at age 25, she’dneed to have (only)
$31,250!
If this illustrates the joy in compounding, take another use of
the rule of 72s to illustrate the joy of slightly higher rates of return.
Assume that insteadof being able to earn about a 9% rate of return
over the next 40 years, our 25-year-oldcan only reasonably expect a
6% rate of return. Now her money will double approximately only
every 12 years rather than every 8. So 12 years hence at age 37 she’d
have $62,500; at age 49 she’dhave $125,000; at age 61 she’d have
$250,000; at age 73 she’dhave $500,000; andshe’dhave to reach
the ripe age of 85 to endup with a million!
Interest Rates
A subtle but most important lesson of the apple tree parable is the
pivotal role interest rates play in the value of assets. The oldman
mentionedthat U.S. Treasury instruments provide a risk-free rate of
interest. That benchmark interest rate is a major determinant of the
value of any other asset in the economy, including the value of whole
businesses andshares of stock in them. The risk-free rate sets the
standard of value of assets with risk. The higher the risk-free rate,
the lower the values of riskier assets; the lower the risk-free rate, the
higher the values of riskier assets.
As Warren Buffett reflectedin a rare public commentary preparedfor
Fortune by Carol Loomis, when the risk-free rate was very
high in the late 1960s and1970s, for example, the average price of
stocks was depressed.2 The Dow hardly moved an inch in price from
the early 1960s to the late 1970s because for investors to buy stocks,
they hadto get a return that exceeded the sky-high risk-free interest
rate. When the risk-free rate was very low from the mid-1980s to the
early 2000s, in contrast, average stock prices shot up. The Dow enjoyedthe
greatest bull market in history because the risk-free rate
was so low that it was relatively easy for investors to get a risk premium
(returns above the risk-free rate).
Taxes
The only thing more mind-boggling about amateur day trading than
the outright losses that are rackedup is how many among the trading
Apple Trees and Experience 103
winners neglect how much they are losing to tax payments both
outright andin terms of the time value lost by the payments.
Suppose you buy an investment that pays 15% per year for 30
years andkeep that investment compounding yearly until the end of
that time without being obligatedto pay taxes on it. Suppose also
that you are taxedon your income from that investment at the end
of that thirtieth year at a rate of 35%. This means your after-tax
annual rate of return on that investment was about 13.3%. Hardto
beat.
Suppose insteadthat your 15% per year investment for 30 years
pays you that 15% annually andsubjects you to tax of 35% each year
you get it. Your annual after-tax return suddenly shrinks to about
9.75%. Not a badnet return, you say, but that is over 3.5% less than
the tax-deferred position. And now we are talking about huge sums,
with that 3.5% difference compounding over periods such as 30
years.
The same is true at every level of return differentials and remains
quite substantial even at lower rates of return. A 10% pretax return
with taxes due only at the end of 30 years gives you an after-tax
return of about 8.3%, comparedwith about a 6.5% after-tax return
if you hadpaid taxes on that income each year. Again, that kind of
2% difference compounded over a few decades works out to be lots
of dollars.3
Inflation
Our parable’s business school dropout did not know that the value
of money across time is nonlinear. Inflation often differs from returns,
andreturns differ from each other. Annual inflation of 4%
means that a basket of goods that can be bought for $100 on January
1 costs $104 on December 31. But if during that year you put $100
in a savings account paying 8%, your balance at the endof that year
would be $108. Left uninvested, that $100 would decline in purchasing
power to about $96, whereas the investedamount gives you
a purchasing power of about $104 (the $108 you have less the impact
on its buying power of the 4% inflation).
These macroeconomic factors bear on value. Tax andinflation
in particular determine how much your gross return will give you in
increasedpurchasing power. Changes in interest rates require revising
any valuations made under different interest rate assumptions.
Operating as a business analyst requires knowledge of these things
104 Show Me the Money
but not their prediction. As Buffett says, “We do not have, never
have had, and never will have an opinion about where the stock
market, interest rates, or business activity will be a year from now.”4
Still, you can’t avoideating a little spinach in the enterprise of investing.
Those who dine on the business investor’s rigorous diet
emerge more muscular andfit from the meal. Course two is served
up next.
105
C h a p t e r 7
YOUR CIRCLE OF
COMPETENCE
Investors avoidstocks outside their circle of competence; those
who buy stocks outside their circle of competence are gamblers,
speculators, or fools. If you lack the grounds for understanding a
business—grounds ultimately for estimating a gap between value
andprice —but make a purchase anyway, you may as well be at a
Las Vegas or Atlantic City blackjack table or a local poker party. All
you are really doing is guessing, hoping, maybe even praying that
things work out your way. Yet there is little reason, other than dumb
luck, to think they will.
The first thing you must do before investing in any business is
make sure you have a basic understanding of that business. This
requires some familiarity with its products, customers, selling environment,
andso on—in short, its operating climate.
It is quite a different proposition to understand businesses, such
as Procter & Gamble, that make andsell a wide variety of familiar
consumer products such as peanut butter, soap, and toothpaste than
it is to understand businesses, such as Applied Materials, that make
andsell a wide variety of highly technical materials for the semiconductor
industry such as expitaxial and polysilicon deposition, etch,
ion, implantation, and metrology (understand?).
Getting the information necessary to determine whether a business
is within your circle of competence before making an investment
decision is easy. Check out the SEC-maintained Free-
Edgar.com Web site or contact the SEC at its Washington, D.C., or
various regional offices. Or check out each company’s Web site directly.
You can even search the SEC Edgar database on lots of other
Web sites, including 10kwizard.com, Edgarspace, and Edgaronline.
Findthe section in the company’s annual report called management’s
discussion and analysis of the business. This is a narrative
assessment of the business that shouldhelp andtest your under-
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
106 Show Me the Money
standing of it. Another useful source to consult is the chairman’s or
CEO’s letter, as much for what it says as for what it does not say
about the business. You will learn an enormous amount by reading
just a few of these reports, andthe more you read, the better able
you will be to evaluate them.
THE INITIAL CIRCLE
Circles of competence should be drawn according to your ability and
willingness to understand a business and its operating climate. Your
circle’s boundaries are defined by your knowledge and aptitude; its
contents are companies about which you can make an intelligent
investment decision in light of those boundaries. Omit from your
circle businesses that are too hardfor you to understand or that
change too rapidly for you to keep up with.
To define your circle of competence, start with your own industry.
Retail store managers probably have a head start in understanding
CVS, Walgreen’s, Gap, andHome Depot; restaurant employees,
in understanding McDonald’s. People in the energy business tend
to know that business andwill have a leg up on Exxon-Mobil, Enron,
andT exaco. Engineers andscientists will have a better shot at understanding
Dow Chemical and DuPont, and telecommunications
devotees have a goodshot at MCI, AT&T, andLucent. Doctors
shouldcertainly have an edge in evaluating pharmaceutical concerns
such as Eli Lilly andPfizer . Farmers may be able to evaluate John
Deere better than the average Wall Street banker can.
Think also about the things you buy anduse andhow you do
so. You may know more about companies such as American Home
Products, BMW, Federal Express, and Sony than you think, or at
least you may be able to understand them better than you think. Try
Hershey’s andNestle´ if you are a chocolate lover, Anheuser-Busch
or Heineken if you drink a lot of beer, and Tiffany’s if diamonds are
your best friend.
Do the same with regional companies in your area. Public utilities
such as ConEdin New York andBlack Hills in the Rocky Mountains
(South Dakota, Wyoming, andMontana) andregional banks
such as First Oaks in Chicago, Wilshire in Los Angeles, andAlabama
National in the Southeast (Alabama, Georgia, andFlorid a) should
be easy andinteresting to examine for people living in those areas.
So too are similarly locatedlarger companies, say, Boeing in Seattle,
Your Circle of Competence 107
Coca-Cola in Atlanta, Kimberly-Clark in Dallas, andJohnson Controls
in Milwaukee.
How do the companies which seem a natural fit for your circle
of competence relate to less obvious ones that fit just as well? If you
are in retail, what about apparel companies such as Gucci, Polo
Ralph Lauren, andHe`rmes International? Up-and-comers such as
Kenneth Cole? Sports fans may enjoy learning more about Nike;
musicians, Steinway. The examples pour out if you identify the sector
your business or interests are in andcomb through lists of companies
in that sector publishedby all the major investment banking
firms andavailable on many reputable Web sites.
To sharpen your boundaries after you’ve identified one or a few
companies andind ustries you know something about, evaluate
whether a particular company qualifies for admission by asking yourself
a series of commonsense questions about that business. If you
can answer them, the company probably qualifies; if you can’t, pick
another one that stands a better chance and ask the same questions.
Here are the key questions.
What products does the company sell or services does it provide?
There is a big difference between razors (Gillette) and computer
chips (Intel) and cruises (Carnival). Do you understand these products
andhow they are used?
Does the company make products that people need? Razors and
chips almost certainly, but that’s less true of luxury goods such as
cruise vacations. Will these products probably be needed for the
indefinite future? There are big differences between toothpaste
(Colgate-Palmolive), paper (Mead), and pet rocks (who made
them?). Big differences can arise between today’s needs and tomorrow’s
(razors can become obsolete with an explosion of electrolysis
or laser removal, andcomputer chips may be displaced by chemicaldriven
substitutes now in the research stage).
How distinctive is the company’s product compared to possible
substitutes for it? The difference between Coke and Pepsi may be
slight, but do consumers think it matters? Product differentiation in
the beverage industry, as in many other consumer product businesses,
can be remarkably successful.
Askedanother way, how likely is it that this company can raise
prices on its products without losing unit volume in sales? Carnival
might be able to do that with its cruises more easily than Mead can
with its paper. The ability to raise prices without hurting sales is
called economic goodwill. Some companies get more of it by distin108
Show Me the Money
guishing their products in the consumer’s eye as having distinctive
traits that make them worth buying even at higher prices. Bang &
Olufsen did this successfully in upgrading its image to a maker of
stereos andother soundsystems at the “high end” of audio technology.
Proceedwith similar sorts of questions about the product market.
What is the company’s target customer and/or client base? Is it
teens and preteens (say, electronic music) or retirees (medical devices),
male or female (sporting goods, clothing, cosmetics)?
Does the company depend on one or a few customers for a major
portion of its revenues, as might a manufacturer or wholesaler such
as Procter & Gamble (13% of sales go to Wal-Mart)? Does it have
millions of customers, or does it depend on a handful? (Coca-Cola
has over 14 million customers who sell in turn to the ultimate consumer!)
How much does any dependency matter—how sturdy is a major
customer? Even businesses with well-known andtime-tested products
can suffer enormous economic damage from policy changes by
their major customers. Mattel (with its venerable Barbie line) and
Hasbro (with powerful branded products such as Star Wars and Poke
´mon figures) both took major financial beatings when one of their
largest customers—Toys-“R”-Us—forcedmajor inventory control
changes that shiftedmuch of the cost of carrying inventory from the
store to the manufacturers.
How does the company sell its products? Direct mail (say, Dell)
and storefronts (say, Starbucks) are quite distinct modes of distribution,
andeach differs again from sales over the Internet (say, Amazon.
com) or sales by industrial manufacturers to their industrial
clients (say, Johnson Controls andGeneral Electric).
What is the company’s geographic market? An economic downturn
in Asia can severely impair profits at multinational companies
that do significant parts of their business there, as the crisis in 1998
showedfor venerable companies such as Procter & Gamble and
Coca-Cola. Yet both also hadsuch global reach, they survived with
no long-term damage.
Has the company ledor at least adaptedquickly to changing
economic andbusiness conditions? Companies able to maneuver
quickly to join their oldeconomy businesses with new economy
strategies—such as General Electric—deserve credit for that deftness.
Can you judge which ones can do this?
These commonsense questions can go on andon to include
questions such as the following: What is the company’s supply sitYour
Circle of Competence 109
uation like? Its employee relations? Does it operate in regions subject
to ordinary or extraordinary risks of political or economic instability?
Grappling with these questions shouldbe enough to test whether
a company is within your circle of competence. Again, if you can
answer these questions, the company probably qualifies; if you can’t,
try one you are more familiar with.
Graham advised: “The field of choice is wide; the selection
should depend not only on the individual’s competence and equipment
but perhaps equally well upon his interests andpreferences.” 1
Buffett echoes the point: “You don’t have to be an expert on every
company, or even many. You only have to be able to evaluate companies
within your circle of competence. The size of that circle is
not very important; knowing its boundaries, however, is vital.”2 If
you have to choose between a large circle anda thick boundary,
choose the latter. But a bigger circle will give you more opportunities,
so work on enlarging it.
THE NURTURED CIRCLE
The boundaries of your circle must change over time. If you leave
them the same, some companies will simply disappear. If you are a
master of the fashion industry today—say you work in New York
City’s garment industry or are a buyer for a large retail chain such
as Sak’s Fifth Avenue—you know that to remain a master five years
from now you will need to learn new things over that period. Indeed,
particularly in the fashion industry, you need to keep up daily, since
fashion is (by its very name) a business that swiftly andconstantly
evolves. Colors, hemlines, cuts, andwho’s in andwho’s out change
by the season. To stay on top, you must change.
If you simply took what you knew about an industry you worked
in ten years ago andusedthat knowledge to evaluate a company
in that industry today, you would be at a severe disadvantage. Take
the business of book publishing, which has changedrapid ly in that
period. In the distribution channels, for example, first the rise of
chain booksellers such as Barnes & Noble andBord ers eclipsed
much of the power of the old-fashioned independent booksellers;
then the rise of on-line booksellers such as Amazon.com alteredthe
dynamic again. And the entire book publishing industry has consolidated
substantially and become part of a broader entertainment industry.
Anyone in the publishing industry during that period needed to
110 Show Me the Money
constantly stretch her knowledge of that industry and in doing so
redefine her investment circle of competence. If an editor, publisher,
or other industry member simply stuck with only what she knew in
the beginning, she riskedlosing not only power in her job but investment
insight into her industry as well. If you stop learning now,
you will know less as the worldchanges. Andas the world changes,
you needto know more just to stay in the same place.
Those who can discern trends in their industries are better able
to ascertain which businesses in an industry are likely to remain or
emerge as leaders. Equally important is recognizing that industries
you know can be affectedby other industries about which you know
less. In book publishing, putting 4-pound, 3-inch volumes on tape
or compact disc (CD) created competition for the music industry—
people listen to books in their cars andeven at home instead of
listening to music. Turning multivolume encyclopedia sets into the
single-disc CD-ROM format sucked a huge chunk of the profit out
of the traditional print encyclopedia business.
To maintain your circle of competence in the face of invasions
andforcedchange from other industries thus requires that you know
something about those other industries. That calls not merely for a
commitment to maintain your circle of competence as the things in
it change but for constantly stretching your circle of competence to
include things that might affect it.
Some people were raisedin tech environments andknow more
about computers, digitalization, and the Internet than they know
about fashion andpublishing. Companies in those industries may
dominate their initial circle of competence. However, sticking to
those industries alone is dangerous. A tech company’s value will be
affected by how its products are used by other industries, such as
fashion andpublishing.
Likewise, those who work in industries such as fashion and publishing
may know more about those fields than about anything techrelated,
and their initial circle of competence will be filled with companies
in that cohort. But if they don’t learn something about the
tech businesses that drive changes in fashion and publishing, they
will know less about fashion andpublishing too.
All companies and industries are exposed to change from outside
forces. Among those forces are globalization, computerization, and
the rise of the service sector in the UnitedStates and of e-business
globally. Keeping up with such developments helps gauge their probable
impact. Other external forces are much harder to measure, such
Your Circle of Competence 111
as war, trade disputes, oil price spikes, and earthquakes. This calls
for a delicate balance.
Graham advised that “there are other factors outside the control
of the company that are perhaps equally important in their influence
on the value of its securities. The outlook for the industry, general
business and security-market conditions, periods of inflation or depression,
artificial market influences, the popular favor of the type
of security—these factors cannot be measuredin terms of exact ratios
andmargins of safety. They can only be judgedby a general
knowledge gained by constant contact with financial and business
news.”3
Buffett appreciates this too but emphasizes selecting businesses
that will prosper despite these things, and never indulging the fantasy
of being able to see into the crystal ball:
We will continue to ignore political andeconomic forecasts,
which are an expensive distraction for many investors and businessmen.
Thirty years ago, no one couldhave foreseen the huge
expansion of the Vietnam War, wage andprice controls, two oil
shocks, the resignation of a president, the dissolution of the
Soviet Union, a one-day drop in the Dow of 508 points, or treasury
bill yields fluctuating between 2.8% and 17.4%
But, surprise—none of these blockbuster events made the
slightest dent in Ben Graham’s investment principles. . . . Fear
is the foe of the faddist, but the friend of the fundamentalist.
A different set of major shocks is sure to occur in the next
30 years. We will neither try to predict these nor to profit from
them.4
All companies—whether classic, vintage, or rookie—are subject
to change in character andquality . Classics with rising sales and
earnings can face contractions andreversals from competitors, new
entrants, downturns in important markets, or changes in the way
their customers or suppliers do business in the face of changes.
Rookies with low sales andno earnings can come to dominate an
industry, throttle the competition, and ultimately generate enormous
earnings andvalue. Vintage companies can go either way.
Even if all businesses change, some businesses enjoy one thing
that does not change: the reasons their customers keep coming back.
Companies like that in your circle deserve careful attention; they are
so rare andvaluable that Buffett calls them the Inevitables.5
In maintaining andstretching your circle of competence, note
112 Show Me the Money
how changes that affect industries and companies follow certain
pretty well defined paths. Business change is not unpredictable, only
hardto predict. There are myriadtypes of business changes and
patterns that they follow, but the infinite potential variation can be
organizedpretty simply to enable you to think about those changes
in a profitable way. The chief patterns that matter relate to products
and their degree of brand or commodity characteristics, the sources
andcosts of supply, the chain of distribution, customers’ habits and
tastes, andbusiness andorganizational design.6
Take the brand-commodity pattern. Some businesses are able to
transform a commodity product into a branded product, as Clorox
did with bleach and Frank Perdue did with chicken. Those branded
products can be retransformed back into commodity products, going
the way of the Model T and the Hoover vacuum, or at least have
the franchise value of the brand reduced, as occurred with the Xerox
machine andCampbell’s Soup. Knowledge of a company’s brand
position is important, but more important is knowing its commitment
andability to promote, protect, andexpand that position.
Supply patterns either reduce or enlarge the amount of inventory
a company has to maintain. Companies that reduce their inventory
end up decreasing their costs and boosting profits. Dell developed
close relationships with its suppliers that enabledit to pretty much
eliminate carrying inventory of any of the computer components it
uses. IBM andCompaq have hadless success in doing that.
Distribution patterns are always important andgot a huge
amount of attention during the dawn of the Internet. The direct
seller of products has come and gone over the years. The Fuller
brush salesman, the milkman, andthe Avon lady usedto give a good
profit advantage to their companies, but the shift to suburban living
andthe proliferation of cars, highways, shopping centers, and malls
changedall that. Some of that changedagain as direct sellers reemergedto
bring computers, books, andeven groceries direct to the
home.
Customers’ tastes obviously relate to distribution patterns,
though the causality is not always certain. As they say in marketing,
if you make it, people will come (andif you deliver it, people may
take it). But consumer tastes andhabits are equally obviously an
enormous driver of profits and a determinant of where the profit
centers are. It is useful to distinguish here, however, between fad
patterns andlonger-term patterns.
Silly products that capture the temporary imagination of the
Your Circle of Competence 113
masses may generate some short-term profit (hula hoops, yo-yos),
but the typical pattern is that those tastes evaporate andthe profit
in them moves to the collectors and dealers (Pez candy dispensers).
The patterns of endurance give rise to longer-term profit centers, as
with the trendtowardlow-salt and low-fat foods that companies
such as Nabisco took advantage of.
Business organization andd esign move arounda lot with
changes in the context in which companies operate andcompete:
• Globalization ledmany companies, such as Procter & Gamble and
Xerox, to reorganize their management structures—from having
heads of different parts of the world to having heads of various
product lines throughout the world.
• The rise of the Internet ande-commerce led many to create entire
new dimensions of their businesses to market product on-line or
to redirect major chunks of their businesses to take advantage of
the lower costs andwid er reach of Internet sales—in GE’s case,
the company did both.
• The move towardservice profit centers andthe ability to unleash
greater profits with fewer hardassets ledmany companies to operate
parts of their businesses as managers under contract rather
than through outright ownership, the way Barnes & Noble entered
the college bookstore market.
Companies that adapt organizational structure and business design
to meet changing needs and opportunities are good companies
to keep an eye on. If you notice a company that constantly readapts
itself in this way, try to learn more about it. Even if those companies
don’t make it into your circle of competence, you can enlarge it with
the knowledge you gain from studying them. Coca-Cola and Disney
are goodexamples.
Coca-Cola’s main business is selling beverages globally, principally
gallons of concentrates andsyrups that constitute the Coke
brandbut also Minute Maidandnearly two hundred others. Coca-
Cola devotes most of its resources to marketing its brands to promote
consumer awareness andmaintaining andexpand ing its bottling
operations through a mix of independent bottlers and wholly
or partly ownedbottlers. Coca-Cola reinvented itself in the 1980s to
see its chief customers not as those who actually drink Coke and
the other brands but the distributors around the world who carry
product to those end consumers (this transformation was led by
114 Show Me the Money
Coca-Cola’s late CEO, Roberto Goizueta, who is discussed further
in the final chapter of this book).
Disney’s segments are mainly creative content (films, animation,
books), broadcasting through the American Broadcasting Corporation
(ABC) andESPN, andtheme parks and resorts. A unique thing
about Disney is that going to DisneylandandDisney World(with
children or grandchildren especially) is an incomparable experience.
AndDisney constantly reinvigorates its business by expanding into
television, building blockbuster products that can be sold in multiple
forms (film, record, tape, theme park, apparel, and souvenirs), and
so on, andby exploiting the Internet to broaden both its content and
its distribution channels.
By no means an exhaustive list of patterns, these are the kinds
of important trends that alter and reshape circles of competence and
that must be lookedafter to expandyour circle. To sharpen your
idea of what you should know about companies in order for them
to qualify as members of your circle of competence, let’s take a
closer look at some candidates.
A FULL CIRCLE
Take one company from each of the categories mentionedin the
beginning: the classic General Electric (GE), the vintage Microsoft,
andthe rookie Amazon.com. These are all important companies and
are widely discussed in the financial press, but they differ in age,
products, andfinancial andbusiness characteristics.
GE operates through numerous divisions in a wide range of industries.
The most important divisions are appliances such as refrigerators,
lighting such as lamps andbulbs, the National Broadcasting
Corporation (NBC), aircraft engines, capital services (itself a widely
diversified group of about thirty businesses engaged in various consumer
and commercial financing activities worldwide), plastics used
in a wide range of applications from cars to CD-ROMs, and industrial,
medical, power, and transportation systems (including products
andbusiness solutions such as factory automation, surgical diagnostics,
gas turbines, andlocomotives, respectively).
Understanding all of GE is a tall order that calls for some appreciation
of the basics of finance, broadcasting, consumer, and industrial
businesses. But if you read its annual report for the last few
years andpay special attention to the excellent letters written by
Your Circle of Competence 115
CEO Jack Welch (discussed in Chapter 14), you will gain a good
sense of the company and how it operates. Indeed, Welch argues
that understanding GE is not a tall order at all, and after you read
Chapter 14, you may agree.
One thing that immediately jumps out at you is that GE got to
where it is through Welch’s declaration 20 years ago that the company
wouldremain in any business only if it were the number one
or number two player in that business. Businesses that did not
achieve that rank were fixed, sold, or closed. The company has ended
up the business equivalent of a magnificent art collection, Jack
Welch, curator.
Founded in 1975, Microsoft is a relative newcomer compared to
the century-oldGE. It develops, manufactures, licenses, and supports
a range of software products, including operating systems,
server applications, worker productivity applications, and software
development tools. Microsoft’s success would have been hard to predict
in the middle to late 1980s, when the dynamic of the software
industry was uncertain. As that decade came and went and the 1990s
confirmedthe power andimportance of that industry, the company’s
dominant position became easier to predict.
Yet pervasive andwid espreadInternet use in the late 1990s might
have poseda threat to Microsoft’s business, though a threat it managedto
navigate (excuse the pun, but it is an apt characterization)
through its aggressive entry into andforceful presence in the Internet
browser industry. While it is a somewhat older business than
Amazon.com, its relative youth comparedto GE makes its future
(wholly apart from its legal andregulatory environment) harder to
predict than that of its classic elders.
Still, you can learn from its annual report that Microsoft’s Windows
operating system is installed on more than 300 million Intelbased
personal computers (PCs), making it the world’s leading PC
software company. It is also a leader in PC application tools and has
grown rapidly to rank among the top networks on the Internet. Its
properties receive over 40 million unique monthly visitors to sites
such as Hotmail, MSNBC, Carpoint, andMoneyCentral. If these
computing andInternet operations are up your alley, read about Microsoft’s
stuff in its annual report andCEO Bill Gates’s books or
annual letters to shareholders.
Amazon.com is a business infant begun in 1994, retailing on-line
books, CDs, andvid eos andoffering some 5 million titles. Its business
model, while interesting, is hard to pin down because it con116
Show Me the Money
stantly andrapid ly evolves. Amazon.com started as a bookseller but
quickly expanded into a wide range of product lines such as toys,
electronics, home improvement, andeven a joint venture with Sotheby’s
auction house. It attracts an average of as many as 12 million
unique monthly visitors to its site.
Amazon.com buys inventory from suppliers on a just-in-time basis,
thus minimizing its inventory andwarehousing costs, and takes
orders on its state-of-the-art Web site for shipping by its warehouse
teams. Whatever one thinks of this business model, it depends entirely
on the continuing success andproliferation of the Internet as
an important way of doing consumer shopping.
While so far so good, the Internet’s brief history makes forecasting
the future of Amazon.com andother e-businesses more difficult
for most people than it is to forecast the future of companies
such as GE and even Microsoft. Indeed, it is also difficult because
Amazon.com has never generateda profit. The book business is mature,
slow-growing, andfiercely competitive and has low profit margins;
Amazon.com’s expansion into other businesses poses huge
start-up costs that will deepen those losses further in the short run,
though they may come roaring back in the form of huge profits in
the future.
Amazon.com’s growing diversity of businesses can fragment
managerial attention (much as your diversified portfolio can distract
you). If well managed, though, they could be as successful a group
as GE’s variedlot. Despite the uncertainties, Amazon.com’s business
is intriguing. Those with the ability to learn more about it andan
aptitude for understanding it would be foolish not to look a little
harder.
DECISION MAKING
Assessing information about a business andits industry and related
industries enables you to make rational judgments about the probable
payoffs versus the probable losses. Anything less is simply a toss
of the dice. Conservative decision makers take the position that no
option shouldbe pursuedwithout a high level of positive evidence
andinformation. To put a number on it, they might argue that you
must have a degree of confidence in your judgment of, say, 90% (you
are 90% sure of the outcome and10% unsure).
Less conservative people believe that the level of evidence reYour
Circle of Competence 117
quiredfor a particular decision varies with the probable payoff from
being right comparedto the probable loss from being wrong.7 If the
payoff from being right is very high comparedto the loss from being
wrong (say, gaining $99 versus losing $1), this view says you can
reduce the required confidence level substantially—maybe to as low
as 1%. People who buy lottery tickets reflect this kindof decision
making.
If the gain-loss matrix goes the other way (say, gaining only $1
versus losing $99), then you wouldinsist on a much greater confidence
level—maybe nearly 100%. These are the sure bets in life. And
as even the most steadfast gambler knows, there is no such thing as
a sure bet.
Your risk appetite will determine the sort of decision maker that
best suits your own psychology. Losses are inevitable. If they make
your misery index soar, stick with conservative approaches; if you
can tolerate them, a more aggressive approach is defensible. (Beware:
most people weigh losses more heavily than gains by a factor
of about 2.5.)
Buffett is a conservative decision maker. Explaining Berkshire’s
conservative financial policy of using little debt, Buffett says that if
there were a 99% probability that higher leverage wouldprod uce
something goodanda 1% chance of a surprise that would produce
something between anguish andd efault, he wouldnot bite that bullet:
“We wouldn’t have liked those 99:1 odds—and never will. A small
chance of distress or disgrace cannot, in our view, be offset by a
large chance of extra returns.”8
Graham was also cautious, warning investors to avoidventures
with little to gain andmuch to lose.9 He advised forming judgments
on the basis of knowledge and experience, not on the basis of optimism
(valuable in many settings but not in investing; Buffett calls
optimism the “enemy of the rational buyer”).10
Graham andBuffett’s views reflect contemporary social psychology.
Research in this fieldshows that in any decision-making
process, the cognitive weaknesses sharedby most people produce
subconscious errors of judgment. The main cognitive biases in reasoning
that investors needto worry about are the following:
• Overconfidence and superiority: believing you are certain when
you are only pretty sure (or believing you are pretty sure when you
are uncertain) andbelieving you are better than average (the Lake
Woebegon syndrome).
118 Show Me the Money
• Confirmation and resistance: skewing your interpretation of new
information to support earlier beliefs andbeing slow to update
those beliefs.
• Vividness and pattern seeking: weighing dramatic information too
heavily andoverreacting to a series of similar sorts of news items
in the belief that they show a pattern.11
Of these, the most potentially damaging cognitive biases are
overconfidence and superiority. As Buffett advises: “What counts for
most people in investing is not how much they know, but rather how
realistically they define what they don’t know. An investor needs to
do very few things right as long as he or she avoids big mistakes.”12
There are three simple strategies to help investors avoidthese
reasoning errors. The first is to recognize them. The secondis to
insist on a justification, something you can do by writing a memo to
yourself about why you are making a decision. (Beware of the traps
of this strategy, which Buffett illustrates by quoting Ben Franklin:
“So convenient a thing it is to be a reasonable creature, since it
enables one to findor make a reason for everything one has a mind
to do.”13 Many people do not have articulable reasons for many of
their decisions. In investing decisions, if you don’t have one, don’t
try to make one up.) The third, and related, strategy is to have clear
guidance in your decision making. For investing, this includes the
ideas discussed in this book.
119
C h a p t e r 8
RECOGNIZING
SUCCESS
What makes an investment attractive? A price substantially
lower than value. Estimating value requires making judgments
about probable future performance, but the only available basis for
prognosis is the recordof the past. The historian Daniel Boorstein
likenedplanning for the future without knowing some history to
planting cut flowers.
Investments cannot be made on the basis of such temporary gardens
either but require a look at the history of business. If accounting
is the language of business, numbers are its history. Just as history
is complex, broad, and replete with contradictions, so too are
the numbers of business history. If you focus on a few key numbers,
however, the roadmap to goodinvestment selection becomes clear.
Start with the management’s discussion and analysis of the business.
In addition to a narrative assessment of the business, this summarizes
the most important numbers in the company’s financial
statements. So you don’t have to go to the trouble of doing the
calculations—just look them up. This discussion also interprets the
meaning of those numbers from management’s perspective. So you
also don’t have to become an expert in accounting to make sense of
this stuff.
Beware of using secondhand databases. Lots of Web sites give
you a chance to employ screening tools to search through 12,000 or
more different businesses with dozens of different variables of the
kindd escribedbelow . These tools operate as filters to give you a
limitednumber of businesses to examine more closely. In principle,
this is precisely the kindof technique that is sensible to use.
However, you cannot be sure the search engines are working
with data of integrity. The data do not usually include information
about a company’s accounting policies, footnote information, or
management’s discussion and analysis. The data are not always up-
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
120 Show Me the Money
dated or corrected, may have embedded errors that arise in the transmission
process, andmay be the product of aggregating information
that is dissimilar or noncomparable. This is not to say that these
systems are worthless, only that you shouldexercise care in using
them.1
BUSINESS FUEL
Every business has debts coming due every day which require resources
to meet. The difference between short-term needs and resources
is calledworking capital. It is a bit like fuel in an engine; it
is better to have a full tank, but overfilling can be dangerous. Too
little working capital can pose a threat to the ability of a company
to operate in the ordinary course over the immediate future, but too
much working capital can mean that resources are not being deployedin
optimal ways.
The right level of working capital varies across businesses. One
way to determine how much working capital is needed and assess
its adequacy is to compare the working capital to sales. Typically, a
retailing business that generates substantial sales of low-cost items,
such as a supermarket, needs less working capital per dollar of sales
(perhaps around 10 to 15%) than does an industrial manufacturer of
high-ticket items such as airplanes (perhaps around25 to 35%). A
manufacturer of consumer goods—say, Carnation or Clorox—might
require some level in between.
Other businesses can operate with low or even negative working
capital. Companies in the restaurant business, McDonald’s, for example,
often operate with negative working capital because of the
cash nature of the business. This system provides direct liquidity,
andpayment terms with suppliers usually permit payment after product
is both receivedandusedin the business to generate cash. Companies
in other industries can benefit from the same combination,
as Amazon.com aptly demonstrates by operating sometimes with
negative working capital without apparent impairment of its ability
to meet obligations as they come due.
In the oil andgas industry, a principal source of cash is proved
reserves that are produced in the ensuing year. While they cannot
be reportedas working capital on the balance sheet under generally
acceptedaccounting principles, they are turned into cash. Companies
in other industries sometimes fund new construction by issuing
Recognizing Success 121
short term obligations such as commercial paper that is later refinancedwith
long-term obligations such as bank loans. This can also
produce low or negative working capital while not posing any threat
to the company’s short-term ability to meet its obligations.
Ben Graham put it this way in his marvelous little book publishedin
1937, The Interpretation of Financial Statements:
The proper amount of working capital requiredby a particular
enterprise will depend upon both the amount and the character
of its business. The chief point of comparison is the amount of
working capital per dollar of sales. A company doing business
for cash andenjoying a rapid turnover of inventory—for example,
a chain grocery enterprise—needs a much lower working
capital comparedwith sales than does the manufacturer of
heavy machinery soldon long-term payments.2
Current and Quick Ratios
Evaluating the working capital position is achievedby comparing the
relationship between current assets andcurrent liabilities in relative
terms. Known as the current ratio, this relationship shows how many
dollars in cash or other assets likely to be turned into cash within a
year are available to pay debts that are due within that year. As a
rule of thumb, for most businesses the ideal current ratio is around
1.5, but the range of current ratios across companies andind ustries
is broad.
A current ratio substantially higher—say, 3 or 4 or more—is a
sign of potential problems, not with respect to liquidity but with
respect to efficiency. It implies that there are financial resources that
couldbe freedup andput to better use: Inventory could be reduced,
receivables couldbe collectedmore quickly or sold, or payables
couldbe aged a bit more before being paid.
At the other extreme, a current ratio of 1 or less (i.e., negative
working capital) is often a warning signal that a company may face
difficulties in paying its debts as they come due in the short term.
As the ratio gets close to 1 or below it, therefore, investigate the
liquidity question further.
Recently the average current ratio of the companies in the S&P
500 was about 1.5, about the same as for the conglomerate segment
of that index, of which GE is a part. The current ratio in the computer
industry tends to be higher, closer to 2.75 (with Microsoft right
aroundthat average). Specialty retailers, including Amazon.com, had
122 Show Me the Money
higher current ratios than these, around3.5, with Amazon.com’s
fluctuating from negative to 4.5, depending on its borrowing levels
for investment in new businesses.
This range of ratios reflects different corporate needs as well as
unique funding situations (called the net trade cycle, or the relationship
between desired investment in inventory compared to the
relationship between credit extended and credit taken). Amazon.com
has at times operatedwith negative working capital, which, given
the retail nature of its business with low inventory andlow accounts
receivable, is safe andind eeda goodind icator of value from managing
working capital. Microsoft’s relatively high ratio is due in large
part to the fact that it generates enormous amounts of cash in its
operations. GE andits peers exhibit the usual characteristics of relatively
mature businesses, though GE constantly tries to reduce the
amount of working capital it requires to zero.
You can fine-tune your analysis even more by looking only to
highly liquidassets, excluding assets such as inventory and prepaid
expenses. This leaves cash (liquidity itself) and assets such as accounts
receivable that are due in shorter periods (say, within three
months). This more refinedtest is known as the quick ratio and
sometimes (equivalently) as either the liquidity ratio or the acid test
ratio.
Rules of thumb still apply. A minimum quick ratio of 1 is desirable,
andhigher ratios are generally better—up to a point. This is
useful to know because of what it reveals about the relative level of
the current ratio. For example, a current ratio within a seemingly
satisfactory range (say, between 1.4 and2) couldactually be high
largely as a result of excessive inventory levels. Since a business cannot
pay debts with inventory, there is reason to worry about a company’s
ability to pay its debts as they come due if it has a low quick
ratio even while sporting a high current ratio.
Conglomerates such as GE tendto have a relatively wider gap
than do other businesses between the current ratio and the quick
ratio. As a segment, the conglomerate current ratio of around1.5,
comparedto a quick ratio of about .8, reflects the fact that most of
the current assets are neither cash nor short-term accounts receivable.
The bandis tighter in the more liquid businesses of computers
andon-line retail sales, where there are speedier assets in the current
ratio (2.75 and2.6 in the computer industry and about 3.5 and
2.5 in the specialty retailer segment). These variations reflect the
range of operating environments in these businesses andalso show
Recognizing Success 123
that neither GE, Microsoft, nor Amazon.com is all that different
from its segment in terms of liquidity needs or how they are being
met.
Debt
Check out a company’s ability to attract additional financing; this is
particularly important when a company has negative working capital
from issuing short-term obligations such as commercial paper. This
is done by using the debt-to-equity ratio. In its most general formulation,
the calculation is the ratio between the total debt of a company,
including short-term debt as well as long-term debt, divided
by the amount of owners’ equity.
The ratio measures the relative borrowing capacity andd ebtpaying
ability of the enterprise over the long term. Businesses with
relatively high debt-to-equity ratios are characterized as “highly leveraged,”
meaning that the debt level in relation to the investment
level of the owners in the business (the shareholders) is very high.
What levels of debt-to-equity ratios are normal has varied historically,
in accordance with economic conditions and collective beliefs
about credit.
During the 1980s, for example, debt-to-equity ratios in the range
of 7:1 or higher were common, whereas during the early 1990s the
typical ratios were closer to 4:1. At the turn of the twenty-first century,
the debt-to-equity ratio of the S&P 500 averaged just about 1:
1, reflecting a decade in which most business financing was done
using equity rather than debt.
Conglomerates still are relatively debt-heavy, however, with the
segment average of about 3:1 andGE above that segment average
with a debt-to-equity ratio of around 4:1. That level reflects the relatively
more mature stage of these companies, particularly compared
with the far leaner computer industry. Microsoft, for example, funds
all its operations with internally generatedcash, enabling it to operate
with no debt whatsoever, and the average debt-to-equity ratio
for the computer industry as a whole is a staggeringly low .2:1. Amazon.
com weighs in between these levels, reflecting both its needto
finance its expanding operations and warehouse construction projects
andits relatively lesser ability compared with Microsoft to generate
sufficient cash to satisfy those needs.
Leverage reflectedin a relatively higher debt-to-equity ratio can
be desirable. If a company borrows at rates below what it can earn
124 Show Me the Money
on its capital, borrowing is profitable. Shareholders benefit. There is
a limit to the benefit, however, for even relatively cheap money must
be repaidandtoo great a debt burden couldbe crushing during
periods of depressed returns.
A way to gauge these trade-offs is to examine the coverage ratio—
a comparison of earnings to interest obligations on debt. For
most industrial companies, an interest coverage ratio in the range of
3 to 4 is considered prudent and implies a relatively safe level of
borrowing. In light of the relatively low levels of indebtedness and
relatively high levels of profitability of corporate America at the turn
of the twenty-first century, the average interest coverage ratio among
the S&P 500 soaredto nearly 11.
Conglomerates remainedclosest to historical norms, with GE’s
coverage ratio at about 2.5 andthe segment at about 4.5. At nearly
the other extreme, Microsoft enjoys total coverage because it is simply
debt-free. Amazon.com is an interesting case: Its coverage ratio
is negative because it is losing money (has negative profits), as low
as 4. That kindof situation calls for looking more closely at other
fixedcharges, which in Amazon.com’s case include leases on various
warehouses that also have to be paid. Its fixed charge coverage ratio
is therefore even worse, making its ability to generate additional
funds to cover its increasing expansion all the more important.
MANAGERS UNDER THE MICROSCOPE
Three simple tools clue us into managerial effectiveness. They center
on the efficiency of inventory andreceivables management and the
thickness of profit margins. Some companies report the speedof
inventory andreceivable turns andthe levels of profit margins directly
in their periodic reports, and some even highlight this in the
chairman’s letters—usually signs of goodor at least honest management.
In other cases, you have to dig for it (not a good sign). Putting
managers under the microscope this way helps gauge the prospects
for future business performance—whether the maximal profits are
being squeezedfrom the business or whether there is room for more.
Inventory Turns
While inventory is considered a current asset in that it is expected
to be realizedin cash within one year, you can be more precise about
Recognizing Success 125
its relative liquidity by measuring the speed of its sale. Inventory
speed, or turns, is measured by the relationship between the cost of
goods sold (COGS) during a period and the average level of inventory
during that period:
Current year’s cost of goods sold
(Beginning inventory ending inventory)/2
Inventory turn levels are reliable indicators of the quality of inventory
management. The longer inventory sits aroundwithout being
sold, the less value it adds to the business, since it could be converted
into cash deployed for more productive uses. High inventory
levels also increase the risk of obsolescence or spoilage, require large
amounts of either cash or bank borrowing to finance, andpose the
risk of loss if the market price at which they can be soldd eclines
materially.
GE is well known for its inventory turn management, andits
long-time CEO, Jack Welch, regularly reports this in his annual letters.
GE boasts inventory turns of a robust 8 amida conglomerate
average inventory turn of about 7 though shy of the S&P 500 average
inventory turn of about 10. Microsoft manages inventory well too,
right along with the rest of the computer industry, with turns of
about 15; this is larger than GE in part because of the vastly different
products these businesses sell.
But Amazon.com is superefficient in inventory management, at
a breakneck pace of around20. Amazon.com is a specialist in justin-
time inventory, a key management strategy developed in the last
couple of decades that Amazon.com has taken to new levels. Stock
doesn’t sit idle in Amazon.com’s warehouses, and this swift turnover
lowers costs. That enables the business either to charge lower
prices to its customers (hence Amazon.com’s aggressive pricing discounts)
or to continue to charge the market price but generate more
profit.
Receivable Turns
A company’s credit policies can be its Achilles’ heel or a driver of
efficiency. Too many sales on credit or too many delinquencies or
uncollectible accounts can crush cash flows. Speedy collection enhances
liquidity and can enable a company to get its customers to
finance its business. Receivable turns are measuredby credit sales
126 Show Me the Money
(or total sales if those sales are not broken out separately) during a
period divided by the average accounts receivable outstanding during
the period:
Credit sales
(Beginning accounts receivable ending accounts receivable)/ 2
To gauge the speedof receivables collection, in turn, divide the
number of days in a year by the number of turns. The result gives
the average number of days the receivables are outstanding. Compare
that average to the business’s credit policies to see how well
managers are running the credit part of the business. There is trouble
if the average is greater than the policy (say, collections average
70 days but billing calls for payments to be made within 30 or 60
days).
GE displays considerable skill in receivables management, turning
them about eight times per year, meaning they are collectedon
average within 45 days. That compares dramatically well to a conglomerate
industry average of three turns, or 120 days. Microsoft is
also a speedy collector, turning receivables about 11 times a year, or
just over 30 days—perhaps as a result of its no-paper policy under
which all bills (andinvoices) are completed electronically—routing
a slower computer industry average that looks more like that of GE
(about eight turns, averaging 45 days).
Again, the exceptional case is Amazon.com, a standout in this
category, with about forty turns, or a mere nine days outstanding.
That means Amazon.com’s customers are funding a substantial part
of Amazon.com’s operations! They provide funds well ahead of the
company’s obligations to pay its creditors, particularly its suppliers,
whose trade terms extend up to 60 days.
Profit Margin
The key to business efficiency is the profit per dollar of sales, which
is calledthe profit margin. To calculate it, divide operating income
by the total net sales (i.e., sales after returns, discounts, and so on)
andexpress the result as a percentage. (Two alternatives to this
standard profit margin calculation are also often made: A more
general one called gross profit margin divides gross profit on sales
by total net sales, anda more specific one called net profit margin
Recognizing Success 127
divides net income by total net sales.) The standard way is as
follows:
Operating income
Net sales
There is tremendous variation in profit margins across industries.
Average profit margins in the automotive andbanking industries, for
example, are way lower (often around10%) than they are in the
computer, pharmaceutical, andfoodind ustries (as high as 40% in
the case of Microsoft). The S&P 500 average profit margin is about
17.5%, right aroundwhere GE stands, while other conglomerates
show margins of around13 to 14%. Again, companies without earnings,
such as Amazon.com, have negative profit margins.
Profit margins can be squeezed or expanded, depending in large
measure on whether a business has a special franchise that gives it
market power or competes in a commodity market where branding
and product differentiation are harder. Coke and Pepsi constantly
pursue product differentiation to exploit the possibility of raising
prices without hurting unit volume, with varying degrees of success
in various economic climates.
Amazon.com invests heavily in this kindof product differentiation,
with a state-of-the-art Web site that includes patented features
such as “one-click” andd istinctive formatting. Yet competitors, including
barnesandnoble.com and buy.com, easily mimic much of this
would-be differentiation, quickly eroding profit margins.
The competition results in constant efforts to innovate andad -
vance technology, whether in hamburger stands, on-line booksellers,
or the beverage industry. Such innovation tends to hurt rather than
help commodity businesses but benefits franchise businesses enormously.
That is why Microsoft so jealously guards the code to its
Windows operating system. It is why GE spends so many advertising
dollars on campaigns such as “We bring good things to life,” in which
it highlights all dozen or so of its businesses without pitching particular
products such as a washing machine or x-ray diagnostic
equipment.
When a company develops a superior production system for a
commodity product (such as oil), the bulk of the savings from that
system goes to consumers rather than to the company. In contrast,
a company that improves branded goods—those on which prices can
128 Show Me the Money
remain high or be raised—reaps most of the upside from that innovation.
Profit margins are driven up or down depending on the
degree to which any business—whether GE, Microsoft, Amazon.
com, or any other company—can differentiate its products to
earn brandedpricing andinnovation power or else be left to bear
the cross andcosts of innovation.
A warning on profit margins is in order. Very high profit margins
may seem desirable and often are, but they also invite competition
that couldd estroy them. Very low profit margins are worth their
level. Something in between, toward the high end, is ideal.
BANG FOR THE BUCK
“Returns” are a measure of the bang a business gets for its buck.
The bang is always measuredin terms of earnings. There are three
bases (or bucks) against which to measure the bang: equity, investment,
andassets.
In each measure, it is smart to gauge the return over a relatively
long periodof time—say, five to ten years—rather than over short
periods to get a perspective that tracks a business’s ability to weather
the downsides and reap the upsides.
Return on Equity
Return on equity is the amount a business earns on the capital
owned by its shareholders. Shareholder capital is equal to the total
assets minus the total liabilities. If a business earns $10 million on
shareholder equity of $100 million, its return on equity is 10%.
Returns on equity were relatively high in the late 1990s andearly
2000s. The S&P 500 average return on equity is around22%. Below
that average are specialty retailers (15%, other than Amazon.com,
whose losses rather than profits give it a negative return on equity).
At or somewhat above the average are GE (about 27%) andthe conglomerate
sector (about 25%) as well as the computer industry at
about 25%. Leading the pack is Microsoft (about 34%).
Return on Investment
Return on investment is the amount a business earns on both the
capital owned by its shareholders and the capital supplied by lenders
Recognizing Success 129
on a long-term (over one year) basis. A business may borrow capital
rather than issue equity if it needs capital and believes it will generate
greater returns on the capital than the costs of borrowing it.
Suppose a business with $100 million in shareholder equity borrows
$50 million from long-term lenders and then generates earnings
of $15 million on that total capital. Its return on investment will
be 10% (15/150). But this leveraging boosts the business’s return on
equity—earnings of $15 million on shareholder equity of $100 million
means a return on equity of 15%.
Using debt to boost return on equity is common but by no means
imperative. Some companies generate sufficient cash from their operations
to enable high returns on equity more cheaply than they
couldby borrowing. As was noted earlier, Microsoft is debt-free,
generating returns on equity of nearly 34% andreturns on investment
that are just about the same (a similar near 1:1 ratio holds
across the computer industry).
The norm among the S&P 500 is to use debt, driving the average
return on equity to about 22% while return on investment is about
14%. GE exploits leverage with more spectacular results, with returns
on equity of nearly 27% tripling return on investment of just above
9% (similar results holdacross the conglomerate sector).
Return on Assets
Return on assets is the amount a business earns on all its resources—
not only shareholder equity and long-term borrowing but
short-term resources generatedby effective management of working
capital. A business may seek short-term, low-rate loans or buy goods
on credit that it resells for cash, thus increasing the assets available
for deployment at low or no cost. Those assets contribute to incremental
increases in earnings, boosting both return on equity and
return on assets.
Suppose a business maintains an average amount of short-term
assets of $20 million over a year (by continually repaying the obligations
as they come due and incurring new ones as rollovers). That
couldincrease incremental annual earnings by, say, $2 million. Thus,
a company with shareholder equity of $100 million and long-term
debt of $50 million, carrying that additional $20 million in the short
term andearning $17 million, generates a return on assets of 10%
(17/170). This deployment boosts return on investment to 11.3%
(17/150) andreturn on equity to 17% (17/100).
130 Show Me the Money
Return on assets is thus the toughest measure of performance
basedon returns, as it reveals the results of deploying all the assets
at management’s disposal. Starting with a high return on assets
shouldyielda high return on investment and hence on equity. (Some
analysts calculate a “financial leverage index” equal to the return on
equity divided by the return on assets.)
Higher returns on assets are achievedby squeezing earnings out
of fewer or smaller asset bases. Microsoft starts off with a return on
assets of 25%, suggesting a relatively low level of asset intensity,
freeing it from dependency on debt and enabling it to generate returns
on equity of nearly 10 points more. At the other extreme, GE
starts off with a return on assets of just 3%, meaning it must manage
its capital structure to use debt skillfully and deploy assets efficiently
in order to get the higher returns on equity of about 27% that it
achieves.
Microsoft is asset-nonintensive, whereas GE is quite assetintensive.
The earnings of many companies (Amazon.com maybe)
are driven by brand names and/or inventory and distribution systems
far more than by the plants andother physical resources that make
up their balance sheet assets. Microsoft relies more on fixedand
other assets but also is able to extract prodigious earnings from its
brandname andmarket position. GE’s asset-intensive business requires
heavy investment in plants andequipment even as its products
enjoy enormous brandrecognition (“We bring goodthings to
life”).
It is too soon to tell how Amazon.com will fare in the contest
for high returns on assets. Certainly its business model is designed
to minimize asset intensity. Its brandname and Internet presence
are the key drivers of sales and hence earnings. It minimizes its fixed
asset needs by avoiding the bricks-and-mortar store operations to
which Barnes & Noble and other traditional retailers devote resources.
Amazon.com’s just-in-time inventory management is designed to
reduce the carrying costs of inventory. Its trade terms with customers
andsuppliers drive incremental earnings by superior short-term
working capital management—it receives revenues from customers
as products are ordered but usually need not pay its suppliers for
those goods until some 30 to 60 days later. Internet customers base
purchases on pictures andimages on the Internet screen, moreover,
meaning Amazon.com does not suffer from books damaged by customers
thumbing through them. Bricks-and-mortar bookstores incur
Recognizing Success 131
losses from such damaged books (though they have the right to return
damaged books to publishers, the result is often a lower discount
on purchases from them). These characteristics of low asset
intensity are extremely favorable to Amazon.com, though it remains
a hardbusiness to assess given its relative youth and negative earnings.
THE FULL TOOL CHEST
This tool chest of ideas helps you assess a company’s liquidity, efficiency,
andperformance. The tools can be adapted from the basic
metrics outlined here to deal with special situations and more advancedanalysis.
A few examples of measures that help further gauge various aspects
of a company’s relative andprobable future success are as
follows. Quality of income (cash flows provided by operating activities
divided by operating income) tells you what portion of income
is actually turning into cash to gauge the liquidity position. The
amount of annual depreciation expense can be a goodproxy for future
capital investment needs. Sales per employee helps evaluate
overall productivity.
A company’s key ratios vary with time, andany trends are important
guides to managerial efficiency and performance. Therefore,
you might look at all the expenses on the income statement over
several years. There is no reason to automatically assume that any
particular ratio or trends will continue, but history does help define
probabilities for the future.
Suppose, for example, you see a large reduction in an expense
for research andd evelopment. That would significantly increase income
in a period. But growth in income resulting from the reduction
in such an expense wouldnot mean that the business is being managedmore
efficiently. It couldeven mean that there are reasons to
worry about its prospects for growth in the future.
Or take receivables turns. Suppose the average number of collection
days during a period increases materially in relation to the
credit terms. Maybe part of any sales growth during the period is
due to a relaxation in credit collection policies rather than to business
efficiency. If those accounts are more likely to go uncollected,
the sales growth might look goodtod ay but there’ll be hell to pay
tomorrow.
132 Show Me the Money
We couldgo on andon but don’t needto. 3 Get acquaintedwith
the key ratios mentionedabove andyou’ll instantly be miles ahead
of the crowdin your ability to distinguish strengths and weaknesses
in numerous businesses within your circle of competence. Focus on
the strong ones andkeep looking—they might have the value you
want, especially if they pass the tests in the next chapter.
133
C h a p t e r 9
YOU MAKE THE CALL
Abusiness is worth the present value of the future cash flows it
generates from now until doomsday. Present value is in the eye
of the beholder, for its realization is entirely in the future. People
will disagree at virtually every step of the process of figuring present
value, including the methods used and the different answers they
yield.
Gazing into the cloudy crystal ball of valuation, you can never
be sure of the accuracy of forecasts when you make them. Yet since
your future wealth is at stake, you do not want to fly blindfolded
even if you cannot predict the future. What you can do is minimize
the hazards of your errors.
What drives cash flows are assets and earnings. These factors
andhistorical cash flows are the best gauges for thinking about probable
future cash flows. You couldfigure value based just on assets
(something calledbook value), basedjust on earnings (what the
earnings stream is worth), or from the cash flows (the worth of the
dividends paid out to shareholders).
However, none of these separate valuation tools in itself is usually
sufficient to determine the value of a business. Not only is none
of them definitive, all of them together remain imperfect, for all
share the inevitable andirremovable infirmity in any valuation exercise:
using current andpast information to forecast future cash
flows. You’ll needinformation about all these things to aid your judgment.
Some valuation tools are more useful for certain businesses than
for others. For example, GE generates earnings andpays cash dividends,
Microsoft generates earnings but does not pay cash dividends,
andAmazon.com does neither. Obviously, you can value all three
companies by using asset measures; you can value GE andMicrosoft
basedon earnings, andGE basedon dividends.
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
134 Show Me the Money
Less obviously, you coulduse all these tools—but in different
ways—for all three companies. That is, estimatedfuture earnings
and dividends can be made for all three (relatively easy for GE, less
so for Microsoft, andvery hardfor Amazon.com).
If these companies are within your circle of competence, you
can do it. You can do it even if you are nervous about using the huge
number of valuation techniques that are discussed in innumerable
books or below because none of them will enable you or anyone else
to pinpoint with precision what the value of any business is.
At best, these techniques produce a range of values that depend
on your interpretation of history andprognosis for the future. These
acts expose you andeveryone else to risks of error, andthose risks
are precisely why Ben Graham insistedon getting a thick margin of
safety between the price paidandthe value one could reasonably
expect to get. Every star investor follows that principle.
In the most famous chapter of The Intelligent Investor, Graham
wrote: “In the oldlegendthe wise men finally boiledd own the history
of mortal affairs into the single phrase, ‘This too will pass.’ Confrontedwith
a like challenge to distill the secret of sound investing
into three words, we venture the motto, MARGIN OF SAFETY.”1
Commenting on this passage over 40 years later, Warren Buffett said
he still believes those are the right three words.2
Getting a wide gap between the price you pay and the value you
buy is the cornerstone of intelligent investing because as Buffett
says, while “intrinsic value can be defined simply,” its calculation
“is not so simple.”3 Graham invokedthe margin of safety principle
to avoidthe risk of error in calculating intrinsic value. And while
Charlie Munger—Buffett’s business partner andalter ego—has
quippedthat he has never seen Buffett do an intrinsic value calculation,
the principles that follow are part of the mind-set that enables
him not to.
ASSETS
The book value of a company is the excess of its total assets as
set forth on the balance sheet over its total liabilities andany outstanding
preferred stock, also as set forth on the balance sheet. The
book value per share of a common stock of that business is simply
that amount divided by the number of common shares outstanding.
You Make the Call 135
This use of the word“value” is misleading. Balance sheets list
assets at their cost when acquiredrather than their current value
(or in some cases at current market values if lower). The balance
sheet report of the carrying amount of assets does not reflect increases
in value under current market conditions. And while the
long-term assets are shown less the depreciation on them, that is
only an approximation of what it wouldcost to replace them rather
than an exact figure.
The range of book values per share is as broadas the range of
businesses itself, andall those values reflect historical acquisition
costs rather than current values. The book value per share of our
sample illustrates this. GE’s is about $12; Microsoft’s, about $6; and
Amazon.com’s, about $2.4
These numbers correctly suggest that the usefulness of book
value decays when more productive activity is performed with fewer
rather than more tangible assets (as more production is generated
not by, say, steel mills andother factories but by information technologies
andInternet distribution systems). The fact that GE’s book
value per share is six times Amazon.com’s may reflect more the
greater asset intensity of GE’s business comparedto Amazon.com’s
than the value of those businesses.
For a whole range of businesses, the current accounting system
basedon historical cost is handicappedin appraising present and
future values. For example, GE’s property, plant, andequipment if
soldat current market prices wouldfetch a substantial multiple of
the book value per share; Amazon.com’s might fetch only about what
the book value says, chiefly because all its assets were acquired
within the past few years.
Not only does this cost principle mean that some assets listed
on a balance sheet are worth far more than their listedamount, it
also means that the opposite is true. Even if book value purports to
reflect the amount for which a company couldbe sold(its liquidation
value), it cannot reflect the circumstances under which a sale
is held. A business liquidation conducted under or caused by adverse
conditions may lead to assets such as inventory and equipment and
machinery being soldat a loss comparedto their balance sheet carrying
amounts.
For some companies, losses on major assets such as plants and
warehouses can be enormous. If Disney were liquidated, for example,
there is reason to doubt that its theme park fixed assets—an
important part of its book value—couldbe soldat their book value.
136 Show Me the Money
Perhaps more obviously, if Coke were liquidated, its inventory of
syrup and concentrate would undoubtedly fetch far less in a fire sale
of those goods than the amount at which they are carried as inventory
on its balance sheet.
This does not mean that the balance sheet is useless. It is a
starting point for analysis. All the historical numbers can be adjusted
to reflect prevailing economic conditions. On the upside, inflation
andappreciation in market values can be acknowledged to arrive at
a current measure of the financial value of assets. Guides to this
adjusting of old numbers to new conditions include sales prices of
similar property andincreasing asset amounts based on changes in
the consumer price index.
On the downside, the historical amount of assets recorded on a
balance sheet can be reduced to the amount they could be sold for
in a fire sale upon liquidation of the business. How much to reduce
the amounts for things such as inventory andaccounts receivable
wouldd ependon their respective turnover rates. Amazon.com’s inventory,
for example, turns so quickly (24 times a year) that even in
a fire sale the company wouldprobably be able to get ridof it at
pretty close to cost (the amount listedon its balance sheet). Some
of GE’s inventory, which turns only eight times per year, might have
to be soldat a loss.
Even those adjustments may not serve as an accurate basis for
financial valuation, however, because of another accounting principle:
the principle of economic or monetary exchange. A business
enterprise may have financial value derived from intangible assets
that are not recorded in the financial statements because they were
not attributable to any discrete economic exchange. For example,
only the cost of development of intellectual property (such as patents,
trademarks, and copyrights) is recorded as an asset on the balance
sheet even if the property is worth billions of dollars in the
form of brandrecognition or customer loyalty.
You undoubtedly recognize the GE brand name, for instance,
andcollective consumer recognition is certainly valuable, but you
will not see any line item for GE’s brandnames andassociated intellectual
property on its balance sheet. The same is true for company
know-how, employee capital anded ucation, and similar items
increasingly crucial to many companies in a wide variety of businesses,
particularly but not exclusively companies such as Microsoft
andAmazon.com.
These sources of value are referredto as economic goodwill, a
You Make the Call 137
bundle of intangible assets that enable a business to generate superior
returns on equity, investment, andassets. They can, as was
notedbefore, create a franchise or branding power that enables a
business to increase prices without hurting total sales volume. Disney,
for example, can raise ticket prices to Disneylandwithout hurting
attendance.
Another sort of goodwill is called accounting goodwill. This is a
recordof prices paidfor businesses a company acquired at a premium
to book value. The economic value of accounting goodwill is
even trickier to appraise. If the purchase was a prudent one, the
value of the economic goodwill obtained is usually greater than the
amount of accounting goodwill. That is especially true because another
accounting rule requires that accounting goodwill be amortized—
reduced annually by specified amounts over future decades.
But again, if the businesses were smartly bought, the goodwill value
shouldrise over those years rather than, as the amortization suggests,
fall.
Sidestepping the need for these adjustments to the balance
sheet, an old-fashioned rule of thumb championed by Ben Graham
says that a common stock carries a sufficient margin of safety if it
can be bought at a price equivalent to less than the company’s net
current assets,5 that is, a price equal to per share working capital.
This means that the buyer wouldpay nothing for the business’s fixed
assets. Such companies are so rare today that this tool in its pristine
form is of little use.
But a modest variation retains the old rule’s conservative rigor
while still catching some fish. A business still qualifies if it can be
bought for its net current assets plus, say, half the original cost of its
fixedassets. Thus, the investor pays for net working capital at the
statedvalue andgets a 50% discount for all the other assets. In the
case of most companies today this would still be quite a low figure, but
some companies—particularly smaller ones—endup in your nets.6
The potential trouble with these approaches is that they relegate
you to being a bottom fisher—the person trolling for very low priced
businesses. That is fine, but you needto be careful not to buy a
dying fish. Bargain hunting leads to disaster if all you get is a burst
of economic return but nothing in the long term. Prudent investors
hunt for stocks with fair rather than cheap prices andstrong rather
than modest economic characteristics. As Warren Buffett advises, it
is better to buy a great business at a fair price than a fair business
at a great price.
138 Show Me the Money
A neophyte investor’s mistake, in any event, is to assess business
value solely on the basis of the balance sheet, even after overcoming
the limits imposedby accounting principles. Unless you are indeed
valuing a company for purposes of liquidating it, what you really
want to know is not what its assets couldsell for but what earnings
andcash they spin off.
Graham recognizedthe limits of a balance sheet. Noting that it
is quite useful with respect to working capital position, Graham cautionedthat
it is of less use concerning the carrying amount of fixed
assets, which he said“must not be taken too seriously,” and the
figure at which intangible assets are listed, to which he said “little
if any weight shouldbe given.”7 He advised:
It is true that in many individual cases we find companies with
small asset values earning large profits, while others with large
asset values earn little or nothing. Yet in these cases some attention
must be given to the book value situation, for there is
always a possibility that large earnings on the investedcapital
may attract competition andthus prove temporary; also that
large assets, not now earning profits, may later be made more
productive.8
Accordingly, Graham concluded that “book value is of some importance
in analysis because a very rough relationship tends to exist
between the amount investedin a business and its average earnings,”
where the real money is.9
EARNINGS
Earnings refer to accounting earnings as reportedon the “bottom
line” of an income statement. These figures are separatedinto basic
earnings per share andd ilutedearnings per share. Basic earnings
per share are the total earnings divided by the average number of
common shares outstanding during the period.
Dilutedearnings take account of the possibility that some convertible
securities andstock options couldincrease the number of
common shares outstanding. This reduces the earnings per share by
taking into account the conversion or exercise of those instruments.
Focus on the diluted earnings per share (andbear in mindthat even
that figure does not always reflect full dilution or cost of stock options
issuedto managers, as we will see later).
You Make the Call 139
In assessing what the enterprise can do for you in the future,
you only have present andpast earnings available. How can present
andpast earnings guide an assessment of future earnings? Or which
of various prior year earnings or which combination is the “right”
level of earnings?
In GE’s case, four recent annual diluted earnings per share were
$2.16, $2.46, $2.80, and$3.22; in Amazon.com’s, negative $.06,
.$24, $.84, and$2.18 per share.
Perhaps you shoulduse only the most recent period. But what
if, as with GE andAmazon.com, there is significant change in that
year comparedto the prior years? One issue is, of course, why that
change occurred. Was it due to extraordinary factors that are unlikely
to recur?
If that is the case, using the prior periods might seem appropriate,
though a more precise gauge for companies that periodically
experience such extraordinary occurrences is to lengthen the period
to seven to ten years to iron out those bumps. Alternatively, perhaps
the business is experiencing a steady positive or negative trend in its
earnings. In these cases, averaging the earnings over the last four
years makes sense. In GE’s case, that is about $2.66 (in Amazon.
com’s, negative $.83).
All these issues obviously entail judgment, and on top of that
you must recognize that the estimate is about future earnings. Taking
the average earnings over the past four years andprojecting them
forwardto the next four years requires a further forecast of the earnings
growth in the future period. Despite steadily rising losses, Amazon.
com’s management expects profits within a few years (as
apparently do thousands of its stockholders, who at one point in the
early 2000s drove its market capitalization to over ten times the
combinedtotals of its profit-making archrivals Borders and Barnes
& Noble!).
GE’s earnings growth rate was about 12 to 15% in the late 1990s.
You might cautiously expect similar or slightly slower growth in the
early 2000s. Taking a conservative view of the future couldjustify a
10% growth rate—roughly $3.50, $3.90, $4.30, and$4.75, or an
average of about $4.10.
In estimating earnings, note again the limits of accounting records.
Accounting earnings result from subtracting cash expenses
plus noncash expenses such as depreciation andbadd ebt reserves
from gross revenue. This sounds simple, but the exercise entails
making a number of decisions about how various events are ac140
Show Me the Money
countedfor . Accounting earnings are affected by a host of accounting
conventions, including, for example, the method of computing
the cost of goods sold, the method of depreciating fixed assets, and
policies concerning allowance for badd ebts.
But imperfect accounting rules are still effective. With respect
to earnings (as distinguished from, say, book value), accounting rules
work when properly and consistently applied. Even if depreciation
expense for fixedassets such as computers is not a perfect gauge of
the future costs of replacing them when they wear out, for example,
it does capture a minimum reasonable amount that must be reinvestedin
the business to maintain its sales level and competitive
position in the future.
Once a representative earnings figure is selected, the earnings
must be discounted. Doing this requires a suitable discount rate
(conventionally calledthe capitalization rate or cap rate). It is the
rate of return requiredto compensate for the risk of making the
investment, andso it is equal to the risk-free rate (that available on
U.S. Treasury obligations) plus an additional amount to reflect the
particular risk of the business.
Assume you determine that GE’s expected earnings over the next
four will be about $4.10 per share. The price you are willing to pay
for the right to that $4.10 per share in the future is a function of
the rate of return necessary to compensate for the risk that the $4.10
per year will not materialize. It will equal the risk-free rate—say,
3%—plus a premium to induce you to take the risk of owning GE
stock.
A robust debate centers on what the right cap rates are for different
businesses andtypes of investments. In general, the lower the
risks involvedin a particular type of business, the lower the cap rate.
For example, if there is a high degree of certainty that a business
will continue to perform as it has in the past, a cap rate in the range
of around10% is appropriate. For businesses that present moderate
degrees of risk, a cap rate in the range of 15 to 25% is better. For
particularly risky businesses, those where uncertainty about future
success is great, an appropriate cap rate couldrange from 30 to 40%
up to 100%.
Businesses whose earnings fluctuate widely in the ordinary
course may be seen as subject to a greater risk that estimatedearnings
will vary. For example, banks andinsurance companies whose
assets consist largely of cash or investments are more exposedto
cycles of economic change andmay warrant a discount rate in the
You Make the Call 141
range of 8 to 12%. Consumer products businesses—those selling
foods and detergents, for example—tend to remain more stable during
periods of both boom andbust andthus generally warrant a
lower-risk cap rate in the range of, say, 6 to 8%.
In addition to depending on the risk-free rate of interest, an
appropriate cap rate takes into account the rate of economic growth
in the overall economy. During periods of steady economic growth
andind ustry expansion, risks are relatively lower. During economic
downturns, growth is less likely, even steady earnings are less likely,
andthere is a greater likelihoodof overall earnings contractions. In
such an environment, risk rises, andyou shouldchoose higher cap
rates.
Therefore, the rules of thumb for cap rates have to be set according
to the risk-free rate, the risks of a particular business, and
those of industry in general. Equally important, we must adjust the
cap rate to allow for future variations. If interest rates rise or the
economy slows, for example, the cap rate will have to be increased,
andvice versa.
The difficulties in estimating earnings and selecting a cap rate
relate back to your circle of competence. Just as an appreciation of
economic history is essential, knowledge of the operating context is
indispensable for the forecasting exercise. GE, Microsoft, and Amazon.
com all look exceptionally well managed, with Amazon.com
even scoring some knockout points in the key ratios, though GE and
Microsoft also make money from goodmanagement.
GE is a money machine, particularly in its capital financing division.
It delivered steady earnings increases throughout nearly all
its 100 years and every year during the last 20. Its diverse businesses
andlead ership in virtually all of them suggest a reasonable basis for
forecasting continuedstead y earnings generation in the future,
though that is never free from doubt because of evolving economic
environments. With GE’s distinguished performance, however, a
modest cap rate is perfectly reasonable.
Let’s assume GE warrants a risk premium just above the riskfree
rate—say, 5%—andapply it to our estimate of average future
earnings of about $4.10. An estimate of GE’s value can be made
simply by dividing the earnings estimate by the cap rate, in other
words, $4.10 divided by .05, which equals $82 per share.
If we took a slightly more aggressive guess about GE’s earnings
prospects, our valuation wouldlook different. Suppose, for example,
we forecast the earnings at $5.00. Still using the cap rate of 5%
142 Show Me the Money
wouldgive us a value per GE share of $100 (5.00/.05). If you go
further andd eem a lower cap rate of, say, 4% more appropriate given
GE’s prowess andcurrent business opportunities and conditions, the
value per share shoots up to $125 (5.00/.04).
This play with the numbers gives a valuation for GE with a fairly
wide range of $82 to $125. The range is broader yet if we take a
more pessimistic view. If you use only the average earnings of the
past four years of $2.66 andstick with our original discount rate of
5%, the valuation is about $53. If you believe the roadahead is
riskier than the roadjust traveledso that a cap rate of, say, 6% is
more suitable, the value becomes $44 per share, generating a “Texas
range” from $44 to $125.
The selection of your earnings estimate andd iscount rate is crucial
to this exercise. (A plausible range of values for Amazon.com,
for example, starts from zero and goes to a few hundred dollars!)
But even if you make those selections ruthlessly, your result cannot
be the “answer” to the question of what a share of such stock is
“worth.” After all, there are plenty of steps in the process where your
judgment could turn out to be wrong.
SILVER BULLETS AND THE MARGIN OF SAFETY
Most people agree that discount rates are driven by the risk-free rate
of interest in effect from time to time, usually that available on U.S.
government bonds that are deemed free of any default risk. This
couldrange from the prevailing rate of about 3%, to the historical
average of about 3.5%, to the present rate on inflation-protected
government bonds of about 4%. Some people use bonds of shorter
durations (such as 30 days instead of 30 years), but since equities
are inherently long term (i.e., corporations have perpetual duration),
it is probably better to use the long bond.
After settling on a risk-free rate, you then add a premium for
your stock. The tendency is to look at the average rates of return on
equities overall for long periods of time, which has been roughly 7%.
That gives you an average risk premium of 3 to 3.5%, which must
be tailored to the individual stock you are investigating. The rules
of thumb mentionedabove get you a long way here, though you
shouldknow that many try to be very precise about these matters.
You Make the Call 143
Believers in the modern finance stories discussed earlier, for example,
multiply the market risk premium by a stock’s ß to come up with
an appropriate discount rate.
All this disagreement and the examples we’ve just gone through
show you that there is plenty of play in the valuation enterprise. Tiny
variations in your assumptions take the bottom line in widely different
directions and magnitudes. A 1% change in your guess about the
market premium, for example, throws off an appropriate level for the
S&P Index by about 200 points (and more if you also play around
with your estimate of future earnings growth rates).
Your best approach remains artistic judgment rather than scientific
precision. Phil Carret made it one of his investing commandments
to “ignore mechanical formulas for valuing securities.”10 Sorry
to disappoint you if you expected magical solutions and think you
haven’t gotten them. In a sense, though, magic is what you get.
Graham delivered the silver bullet of investing when he said the
three most important words in investing philosophy are “margin of
safety.” Recognizing that it is essentially impossible to pinpoint the
precise intrinsic value of a business andthat the best you can do is
compute reasonable ranges of value basedon reasonable assumptions,
Graham thought you shouldgive yourself a break by making
sure the price you pay is way lower than the low endof your valuation
estimate.
Graham calledthe margin of safety the central concept of investment
because its essential function is to render an accurate estimate
of the future unnecessary. In using it, you neednot stress or
struggle over the precise way to define the “right” risk premium,
earnings, or discount rate so long as you have a reasonable approximation
of what makes sense. Its secondary function is to absorb the
effect of error in your assumptions—andremember , even tiny errors
cause huge effects—as well as the effect of plain badluck.
Graham observedthat most investing errors are made not so
much by paying too high a price for high-quality stocks as by buying
low-quality stocks during times of economic prosperity (much as in
early 2000s America). Indeed, Graham repudiated a strategy that
overemphasizes what the fashion plates of finance call growth stocks.
If you can get the same margin of safety by carefully estimating the
future of growth stocks, more power to you, but the danger is that
growth stocks tendto be favorites andfavoritism in stocks is measuredby
high prices that steal safety margins.11
144 Show Me the Money
Graham saidthe margin of safety principle ultimately served as
the touchstone in distinguishing between investing and speculation.
Those who deny the difference between price and value or fail to
get a margin of safety take their seats at the roulette wheel. Place
your bets!
CASH
The same judgment can be applied to the cash a company is expectedto
generate andpay to shareholders in the future. The cash
dividend–based approach to valuation was championed by John Burr
Williams, who arguedas follows:
Earnings are only a means to an end, and the means should not
be mistaken for the end. Therefore we must say that a stock
derives its value from its dividends, not its earnings. In short, a
stock is worth only what you can get out of it.
In saying that dividends, not earnings, determine value, we
seem to be reversing the usual rule that is drilled into every
beginner’s headwhen he [or she] starts to trade in the market;
namely, that earnings, not dividends, make prices. The apparent
contradiction is easily explained, however, for we are discussing
permanent investment, not speculative trading, and dividends
for years to come, not income for the moment only.
Of course it is true that low earnings together with a high
dividend for the time being should be looked at askance, but
likewise it is true that these low earnings mean low dividends in
the long run. On analysis, therefore, it will be seen that no contradiction
really exists between our formula using dividends and
the common precept regarding earnings.12
Williams indicates that dividend discounting and earnings capitalization
give the same answer (or range of answers) to the question
of what a share of stock is worth.
This is the case because dividends are a subset of earnings. A
corporation can deploy its earnings either by paying them out to
shareholders as dividends or retaining them for reinvestment in the
business. If the retainedearnings generate a return equal to the cap
rate, the value you get from capitalizing the earnings stream will be
the same as the value you get from discounting the dividend stream.
Indeed, valuation by discounting dividends is analytically idenYou
Make the Call 145
tical to the capitalization of earnings technique. An assumedd ividendpayment
is dividedby an assumedd iscount rate, just as an
assumedearnings level was dividedby an assumed cap rate. In each
case, the questions are (1) What does the expected stream look like
in terms of amount andgrowth? and(2) What is the risk that the
amount andgrowth will not be realized?
The conceptual difference between the two techniques is that in
discounting dividends you assume that the value of a share of stock
is the present value of the expected dividend payments on it from
now until doomsday. This makes sense because the value of the stock
consists of the payment stream it yields while it is ownedandwhen
it is sold.
The only reason there will be a gain on sale is that some other
investor wants to buy the payment stream, andso on. These investors
may or may not be correct or even rational in that determination,
but it is precisely differences in valuation judgments that
leadto such exchanges anyway. As a result, the value of a share of
common stock resides solely in its expected stream of cash dividends.
Discounting dividends is just as difficult as capitalizing earnings
because both require selecting a highly sensitive discount rate. For
dividend discounting, many people try to minimize this difficulty by
using the subject’s weightedaverage cost of capital. But that is not
a uniquely correct number, andcalculating it requires just as much
judgment as they are trying to escape.
Calculating the weighted average cost of a company’s indebtedness
is relatively easy: It is the average interest rate on all long-term
obligations weightedaccord ing to the various amounts of principal
outstanding on each type of debt. Figuring out the cost of a company’s
equity capital is far harder.
The cost of equity is usually defined by what the market expects
the annualizedreturn on the stock to be, combining price appreciation
and dividend payout. But what are we really doing here? In
determining a stock’s value, we are trying to figure out what the
return is going to be. If your key variable in that figuring is what the
market expects, you are begging the question. You are assuming the
answer rather than analyzing the question.
You are better off forming your own value judgment. There is no
formula to tell you the answer, as these examples emphasize. Your
only friendat that point is the Graham-Buffett margin of safety, not
Mr. Market (you may be fallible; we know Mr. Market is).
146 Show Me the Money
MARKET CIRCULARITY
The greatest deficiency in using market metrics for valuation is the
problem of circularity. To say that a share of Exxon-Mobil is “worth”
what the stock last traded for tells you nothing about how that last
trade was valued. Of course we know how it was priced: by the forces
of supply andd emand in the stock market. We also know from Part
I that those forces are far from rational; are infectedby emotion,
psychology, andnoise; andmay even be chaotic.
But that is all we know. None of this tells you whether the price
is a product of analysis or hope or fear, is a product of discounting
expectedfuture earnings or cash flows, or is based on a determined
multiple of book values or on hunches andguesses.
You can try to penetrate the problem of market circularity by remembering
John BurrWilliams’s point that the value of any asset is the
amount of cash flow it will generate in the future, discounted by the
probability that those flows will materialize. You couldargue that a collection
of comparable assets yields a particular return and use that
comparable return as the discounting factor. But not only are you left
with the challenge of defining comparable assets, you still have not determinedthe
basis on which those comparable assets have been valued
(other than, again circularly, by the market’s collective judgment).
Countless books andarticles have been written about how interest
rates andother returns are determined by the market, but no
one knows for sure. Interest rates vary according to people’s collective
inclination to borrow for immediate consumption or invest for
future consumption (say, at retirement). These inclinations are
shaped not only by roughly quantifiable conditions such as productivity
andreturns andthe supply of money but by behavioral and
psychological conditions that are virtually impossible to measure and
in any event are highly unstable.
People undoubtedly have specific expectations about returns
from assets, but those expectations vary widely. Current survey data
show that people who livedd uring or in the aftermath of the Great
Depression now expect average annual returns on stock portfolios
that are in line with their averages in the postwar periodof close to
10% while younger people with only history lessons rather than personal
memories of that periodexpect returns in line with those of
the 1990s of closer to 20%. (A similar gap has existedin other periods,
such as the late 1960s.)13
You Make the Call 147
Neither of these groups is correct, for it is logically impossible
to say that any person is correct about the future. But these sorts of
expectations—founded in the infinitely complex map of human psychology
andexperience —furnish the underpinnings of the returns
the market generates. Great expectations are inherently unreliable,
andthe circularity of market metrics remains impenetrable.
Once you have made the call about value, you have to go to Mr.
Market to see what prices he is offering. While there, compare your estimation
of value to a few price ratios before making a final decision.
There is no guarantee that stocks with low price ratios offer value
higher than their price, but they are a goodplace to look. Nor do
high price ratios automatically mean a stock is unattractive, since
price still may be lower than value.14 Businesses with attractive operating
climates, liquidity and performance measures, and earnings
records deserve a close look, particularly but not exclusively if all
the price ratios are low andthe return on equity is high.
Price/Book Ratio
The relationship between a company’s stock market price andits
book value is calledthe price/book ratio (P/B ratio). It is equal to the
market price per share divided by book value per share.
Comparing the P/B ratio of one business with its peers is a way
to gauge how investors regardthat business compared to others or
the industry average. Higher P/B ratios mean that investors regard
the stock more favorably.
The average P/B ratio for publicly traded stock in the early 2000s
is around 2 to 3.5, with older, industrial companies (such as steel
companies) sometimes trading at P/B ratios near or below 1 and newer,
technology-orientedcompanies (such as computer software manufacturers)
sometimes trading at P/B ratios as high as 20 or more.
In our crop, Amazon.com’s P/B ratio leads the league at above
40, with Microsoft at about 15 andGE at 10. While none of these
fits the bill, if you finda stock trading below a P/B ratio of 1, you
can buy that stock for a price below the company’s net worth. Such
stocks are rare andcertainly warrant further investigation.
Price/Sales Ratio
For most companies, a strong relationship between a company’s
value andits sales levels shouldexist. Sales drive growth. More sales
148 Show Me the Money
mean more earnings. A company cannot grow faster than its sales,
but it can grow more slowly with poor management, which will be
reflectedin poor efficiency and performance ratios.
The sales figure is also less affectedby accounting conventions.
Since it is the top-line number on the income statement, pretty
much the only accounting rules affecting sales relate to the timing
of their recognition. While that can be manipulatedto an extent (this
is discussed further in Chapter 10), it is far purer than the bottomline
earnings number, which can be affectedby scores of accounting
conventions.
Calculate the price/sales ratio (P/S ratio) by dividing the stock
price by the sales per share (this is not commonly reportedin financial
statements but is an easy calculation to make). Alternatively, you
can follow the conventional but equivalent methodof dividing the
total market capitalization (price times shares outstanding) by the
total sales. Either way, if you can buy a stock for a price that is equal
to or less than the company’s sales, you are on your way to getting
a goodmargin of safety.
In our group, Microsoft is richly pricedcomparedto its sales at
a P/S ratio of about 20, with Amazon.com also heftily pricedat about
15, andGE at about 5. No bargains exist on these numbers, but
again, if you can finda company with a low P/S ratio, particularly
one that also has high profit margins, you are getting goodvalue for
money.
Price/Earnings Ratio
Investors commonly use market prices to compare businesses by relating
trading prices to earnings per share. This is called the priceearnings
ratio (P/E ratio), and it is computed by dividing the market
price of a share of common stock by the company’s earnings per
share. The limitations of using the earnings multiple for valuation
andthe ruthlessness requiredto specify a cap rate explain the popularity
of P/E ratios as guides for selection.
In general, higher P/E ratios suggest that investors are more optimistic
about a company’s prospects than they are about comparable
businesses with lower P/E ratios. The historical breakpoint for high
andlow P/E ratios has been 15—above that was high, and below it
was low. Very high P/E ratios (anything above 50) imply loads of
optimistic investors swooning over a company’s prospects. However,
the relative levels of P/E ratios also vary with a company’s growth outYou
Make the Call 149
look, industry, relative maturation (rookie, vintage, or classic), and
accounting policies usedin calculating net income. Don’t count on
P/E ratios being comparable across companies.
The P/E ratios of our group of companies fluctuated wildly during
the 1990s andearly 2000s, along with the volatile overall market.
But suppose the market price of a share of common stock sits between
25 and50 andsuppose its average earnings per share are
around$1.00. The P/E ratio thus has rangedfrom 25 to 50. The
implied cap rate hovers between 2% and4%. Does that mean you
shoulduse such rates? Why would it? But suppose a stock had a P/E
ratio of 5. Now that sounds like a deal with a thick margin of safety.
Economic Value Added
Consider an all-industry metric created (and trademarked!) by a
business consulting firm that apparently has realizedthat the marketplace
is thirsting for new tools to justify all kinds of crazy ideas.15
The tool has been cleverly named “economic value added” (EVA). It
says that a company’s performance can be evaluatedin terms of
whether returns on capital are higher than costs of capital. If they
are, value is being added.
Though the components of the EVA calculation are simple to
state—the company’s return on capital minus its weightedaverage
cost of capital—we already know that pinning down the latter is a
lot harder than it sounds.
For EVA, the weightedaverage cost of capital could be defined
simply as the appropriate discount rate at which to value the company,
but that doesn’t escape the circularity trap. Or it could be the
cost of the company’s indebtedness—the average interest rate paid
on its debt during the measured period. But if that is all it is, then
EVA is just another name for leverage.
If it includes a mixed measure of the cost of debt and the expectedreturn
on equity, the measure not only still has the problem
of circularity but also gets nonparsimonious. All it really tells you is
by how much a company beat expectations. If return on equity last
year was 10% andthe market this year expects the same 10% but the
company actually has delivered 12%, EVA says it increased value by
an additional 2%—but you don’t need a name like EVA to tell you
that.
Worse, part of the motivation to develop tools such as EVA was
to overcome earnings management techniques: managerial manip150
Show Me the Money
ulation of revenue recognition timing, restructuring charges, and
others discussed in the next chapter. These techniques proliferate in
proportion to investor emphasis on (or obsession with) whether a
company meets analysts’ earnings expectations. EVA exacerbates
rather than solves the problem, because it applauds managers only
when they exceedexpectations.
Moreover, if EVA is intended to measure a company’s ability to
generate profits for shareholders on the amount of their invested
capital, it potentially suffers from the same weaknesses of traditional
financial ratios: They all rely on the integrity of the underlying accounting
data used to calculate profit. EVA tends to increase rather
than reduce pressure on managers to manipulate (or make up) numbers.
None of this denies the underlying insight of EVA: assessing
performance basedon how much extra return is generated from a
dollar of investment. Indeed, in evaluating managerial performance,
we shouldd educt from reported results a charge for the capital employed
in producing them (something rarely done, especially in connection
with reports andreward s of stock options tied to returns, a
subject discussed in Part III). For some companies—Coke under
Roberto Goizueta, for example—returns on capital are so impressive
that even with difficulties in pinning down the cost of capital, there
is no question that returns exceedcosts by impressive distances.16
Obsession with EVA puts a false premium on precision, just as
the tools of modern finance discussed earlier do. Though he believes
in the basic idea underlying EVA, Warren Buffett often says he prefers
to be approximately right than precisely wrong. Speaking publicly
at the Berkshire Hathaway 2000 annual shareholders meeting,
Charlie Munger put it more epigrammatically with a characteristically
unglovedd enunciation of EVA: “bullshit.”
Graham’s comments on market price andbusiness value are
worth memorizing:
The acceptedid ea that a common stock should sell at a certain
ratio to its current earnings must be considered more the result
of practical necessity than of logic. The market takes the trend
or future prospects into account by varying this ratio for different
types of companies. Common stocks of enterprises with only
slight possibilities of increasing profits ordinarily sell at a rather
low price-earnings ratio (less than 15 times their current earnings);
andthe common stocks of companies with good prospects
You Make the Call 151
of increasing the earnings usually sell at high price-earnings ratio
(over 15 times the current earnings). . . .
When neither boom nor deep depression is affecting the
market, the judgment of the public on individual issues, as indicated
by market prices, is usually quite good. If the market
price of some [stock] appears out of line with the facts and
figures available, it will often be foundlater that the price is
discounting future developments not then apparent on the surface.
There is, however, a frequent tendency on the part of the
stock market to exaggerate the significance of changes in earnings
both in a favorable andunfavorable direction. This is manifest
in the market as a whole in periods of both boom and
depression, and it is also evidenced in the case of individual
companies at other times.
At bottom the ability to buy [stocks] successfully is the ability
to look aheadaccurately . Looking backward, however carefully,
will not suffice, and may do more harm than good. Common
stock selection is a difficult art—naturally, since it offers
large rewards for success. It requires a skillful mental balance
between the facts of the past andthe possibilities of the future.17
This page intentionally left blank.
153
C h a p t e r 1 0
MAKING (UP)
NUMBERS
Accounting shenanigans have plaguedbookkeeping since it was
inventedby Luca Pacioli in 1494, andthere is no reason to expect
that the next 500 years will stray from the historical pattern.
No amount of rule making—from accounting, auditing, or elsewhere—
can ensure the integrity of financial reporting. Rules cannot
eliminate managerial discretion, and there will always be the possibility
of imaginative, unorthodox, creative, and even fraudulent financial
reporting.
Investors andmanagers shouldexpect it and, instead of wishing
it away, take pains not to be its victims or accomplices. Just think
of the notorious accounting frauds of relatively recent memory—
from Leasco, National Student Marketing, and Penn Central in the
late 1960s andearly 1970s to Cendant, MicroStrategy, and Sunbeam
in the late 1990s andearly 2000s. These frauds sting investors, and
managers who engage in them shouldknow they will be caught,
punished, and made to pay (though investors will not profit in the
process).
The nonfraudulent cases are often the trickier to deal with. They
consist of a variety of smoothing techniques designed to massage the
whole range of financial numbers, from the ratios discussed previously
to income itself. Income smoothing, also known as earnings
management, exploits the flexibility of generally acceptedaccounting
principles to classify transactions or allocate them by time periodto
achieve favorable financial reporting.
PERENNIALS
SEC Chairman Arthur Levitt delivered a series of major speeches in
the late 1990s and early 2000s identifying several long-standing ac-
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
154 Show Me the Money
counting issues that are hallmarks of earnings management. These
techniques are as oldas accounting itself andhave been used to full
advantage (sometimes appropriately, often not) by managers over the
centuries. Yet the contemporary problems are heightened, according
to Levitt, by a managerial obsession with meeting consensus earnings
estimates formulatedby the increasingly influential profession
of investment analysis.
This dizzying obsession with “making numbers” is documented
by the accounting professors DavidBurgstahler of the University of
Washington andIlia Dichev of the University of Michigan.1 They
show that about one in ten managers facing small declines in earnings
manage to show earnings increases, andthat about four in ten
facing negative earnings manage to report positive earnings! The obsession
with “making numbers” leads managers to make them up.
Levitt singledout five issues of particular concern, giving each
a catchy phrase intended, one supposes, for both poetic and mnemonic
value.
• Big bath. Big bath accounting is a particularly aggressive version
of earnings management that is sort of a financial face-lift. It
lumps major events adversely affecting income in current periods
to facilitate improved financial appearances in succeeding periods.
It is particularly common in, but by no means limitedto, costs
occasionedby acquisitions, divestitures, reorganizations, and other
extraordinary organic business changes. These transactions call for
numerous accounting judgments in regard to both timing and classification.
Managers often expense as much of the potential cost
of a transaction at the time it is consummatedas possible. It’s also
tempting to give current earnings a “big bath” in one year to create
a brighter-looking future when the year is so dismal anyway that
investors have written it off (this happens all the time, even at
otherwise reputable companies).
• Merger magic. This describes a subset of creative accounting in
acquisitions. If a business buys another business for a price higher
than the seller’s book value, the buyer in most cases must record
an asset called accounting goodwill (discussed in the last chapter)
and amortize that account as an expense over future decades. That
reduces earnings over that period. To minimize the reduction, a
buyer’s manager can allocate some or a lot of that excess to other
things, most notoriously to in-progress research-and-development
Making (Up) Numbers 155
(R&D) costs. Accounting rules require such R&D costs to be expensedwhen
incurred(rather than amortized), and so many buyers
allocate that excess as a one-time expense at the merger time even
when that allocation defies business reality.
• Cookie jar reserves. This entails the overestimation or underestimation
of things such as sales returns by publishers, probable loan
losses of lending institutions, and warranty obligations for manufacturers.
The incorrect estimation enables managers to adjust and
smooth out earnings as actual earnings vary from expectedearnings
periodto period.
• It’s not material. The materiality principle requires the reporting
of items that are material andallows the nonreporting of items
that are not. Materiality is not an absolute concept but entails
making judgments. A standard legal formulation for public corporations
under federal securities laws is whether an item would
be important to an investor in making an investment decision
about a security (the accounting rule similarly asks whether it
would influence a reasonable person’s judgment). Judgments concerning
materiality are often guided by rough rules of thumb. One
rule of thumb accountants and auditors often use in determining
materiality is whether a particular item entails more than, say, a
5% impact on a company’s earnings. But applying such a simple
rule couldleadto excluding things that are meaningful to a user
of the financial statements in a qualitative sense.
• Wine before its time. This image of popping open a bottle of wine
before it matures reflects the premature recognition of revenue.
For instance, a toy manufacturer may tag goods in a warehouse as
“sold” even though they are not and may never be sold, or a distributor
of cell phones may recordrevenue for merchandise that
it shippedandreceivedpayment for but that is subject to free
return by the buyer for a periodof, say, 90 days.
To address these manipulations, the SEC called for immediate
andcoord inatedaction, seeking nothing less than a fundamental
change in American corporate culture. Levitt articulateda multifacetedprogram,
beginning with instructing the SEC staff to scrutinize
financials for abuses of restructuring accounting andaccruals for
losses andreserves. He askedthe American Institute of Certified
Public Accountants (AICPA) to clarify auditing rules concerning
purchasedR&D, large acquisition write-offs, and revenue recogni156
Show Me the Money
tion. He also instructedthe SEC staff to focus on materiality not
solely in quantitative terms but also in qualitative terms, reject the
notion that materiality can excuse minor errors, andpromulgate new
standards on revenue recognition.
Levitt also called on private standard-setting organizations to join
the cause, particularly asking the Financial Accounting Standards
Board (FASB) to reconsider the definition of liabilities under generally
acceptedaccounting principles. He encouraged the Public
Oversight Boardto review andintensify its focus on the audit
committees of boards and recruit more members with financial backgrounds
(as opposed to legal, marketing and public service backgrounds).
He envisioned audit committees meeting more often and
asking tougher questions—what he calleda “private sector response.”
He impaneleda blue ribbon commission to report on ways
to enhance the audit committee’s role and ultimately called upon
management itself andW all Street to revitalize integrity in financial
reporting by cooperating andsupporting these initiatives.
This program emboldened the SEC to prosecute scores of enforcement
actions against companies engagedin earnings management
of the sort Levitt highlighted. The SEC adopted tougher rules
governing audits, including a requirement that quarterly financial
statements be reviewedby auditors, andmateriality rules that expressly
deal with qualitative and quantitative dimensions.2
Audit committees must now review and vouch for the accuracy
of financial statements, provide a report in proxy statements concerning
whether they signedoff on the financial statements, state
whether a written charter spells out the committee’s duties, and submit
any such charter to the SEC every three years. The stock exchanges
adopted rules requiring listed companies to disclose
whether members of the audit committee are independent of management
andrequiring audit committee members to have a financial
background.3
Levitt’s ambitious crusade is ongoing, and investors should support
those who carry it out. No amount of effort, however, can eliminate
the inevitable flexibility that generally acceptedaccounting
principles provide or the temptations or capitulations to which they
lead. It remains for the intelligent investor to monitor financial reporting
with measuredskepticism andstay alert to the possibility of
distortion. While the past is no guarantee of the future, it certainly
is prologue, andas early as 1936 Ben Graham lampooned corporate
Making (Up) Numbers 157
America for its abuses of financial reporting, as have many since,
most notably City University of New York accounting professor Abraham
Briloff.4
SATIRE
Graham satirically hypothesizeda phantom US Steel Corporation
adopting “advanced bookkeeping methods” to report “phenomenally
enhanced” earnings without any cash outlays or changes in operating
conditions or sales. To update that illustration of accounting
chicanery, consider how a phantom company might today achieve
the same results by using techniques like those Levitt denounces.
Its press release andaccompanying financial reports might look like
this:
E-America Dot.Com Announces Positive Earnings
E-America Dot.Com today announced positive earnings, stunning
Wall Street analysts whose consensus view estimatedcontinued negative
earnings for the start-up that went public last year. Its stock
price shot up 40% on the news. Though this response is usually reservedfor
companies that report negative earnings, we believe it is
justifiedfor the same sort of reasons—none.
Rather than taking any action to increase sales or improve its
products, marketing strategy, distribution channels, or customer service,
the earnings increase was due to improvements in the manner
in which the company’s economic activity is recorded in its books.
These new bookkeeping methods report profits of $50 per share insteadof
the $25 loss per share that otherwise would be reported. The
accounting improvements consist of the following steps:
• Modifying revenue recognition policies
• Adjusting reserves and treatment of returns
• Recording the value of market share as an asset
• Recording the amount of cash we “burn” as an asset
• Reporting in a different currency
• Refining the concept of materiality
The Boardof Directors of E-America Dot.Com, in collusion with
their auditors, reached the following conclusions in adopting this pro158
Show Me the Money
gram in a resolution unanimously approvedat its boardmeeting this
week:
The Board of Directors and its Independent Outside Auditors,
after careful study and review, determined that the accounting policies
andpractices the company usedsince its recent initial public offering
ten months ago are outdated and do not reflect the kind of performance
managers of the company expect or predict.
The Boardandits Auditors, aidedandabettedby a special audit
committee, determined that many other companies obtain a competitive
advantage in the capital markets by reporting accounting results
in terms of innovative, cutting-edge techniques and that the company
was penalizedfor failing to follow these best practices, referred to as
the “New Accounting.”
Adopting the New Accounting will neutralize this disadvantage
andenable the company to increase its market capitalization without
the needfor disbursing cash or changing any of its operating activities.
The changes adopted by the Board, with the attestation of its Auditors,
are as follows:
m o d i f y i n g r e v e n u e
r e c o g n i t i o n p o l i c i e s
Competitive conditions in our industry lead us to give generous credit
terms to our customers. These include giving them the right to return
goods to us for a full refund if they cannot resell them to the ultimate
consumer within 180 days. We formerly deferred recognizing the
revenue in connection with such transactions until after that 180-
day periodpassedon the grounds that no sale was complete until
then.
But this oldeconomy policy substantially reduced the amount of
reported sales reflected on our income statement. The Board decided
to treat those transactions as sales right away, on the grounds that
our sales team put tireless effort into generating them andshould get
credit. (We can make adjustments for returns later, but for now we
wouldrather report the goodnews in the short term andd efer the
badnews for the long term.)
In particular, we will occasionally “park” inventory with our customers,
to whom we give unconditional return rights either orally or
in “side letters” kept separate from the sales documents. As a result
of this scheme, we will report much higher sales revenue andd ramatic
increases in earnings. If adjustments must be made to smooth those
earnings, we will restate past earnings in subsequent quarterly reports
Making (Up) Numbers 159
andd isclose that these resultedfrom a problem with the “collectibility”
of our accounts receivable.
a d j u s t i n g r e s e r v e s a n d
t r e a t m e n t o f r e t u r n s
In the financing arm of our business, we intendto reduce the amount
of reserves we recordfor delinquent anduncollectible accounts by
reporting them as current. To do so, we will in some cases simply
extend the due dates of our customers’ obligations. In others, we will
assume that we can repossess the items securedby these delinquent
loans whether or not that is feasible. This enables us to recordfar
lower reserves in our allowance for credit losses, thus increasing our
net income.
Similarly, in all of our businesses, we will recordcustomers’ returns
of merchandise as purchases of goods rather than charging
them against our reserves for returns. Another benefit of this new
policy is to increase our receivable turns, making our operations look
speedier and more efficient.
r e c o r d i n g t h e v a l u e o f
m a r k e t s h a r e a s a n a s s e t
A hot trendin the marketplace for traders andspeculators is to assign
a value to Internet companies basedon the percentage of their product
market their sales levels represent. This is necessary to justify the
stratospheric prices being paidfor stocks of these companies in initial
public offerings andin exchange trading. After all, most of these
companies do not generate any earnings or even positive cash flows.
Staying aheadof the stampede, we are moving one logical step further
by listing the value of this market share on our balance sheet as an
asset.
Every quarter we will gauge the amount of value the market is
giving us basedon our market share andrecordthat in an asset account
calledmarket share. This may seem like a “belts-andsuspenders”
policy given that our other New Accounting changes will
enable us to report actual earnings andactual cash flows which otherwise
wouldbe negative. Nevertheless, we believe that this is what
shareholders andmarket players want, andwe are just trying to cooperate.
160 Show Me the Money
r e c o r d i n g t h e a m o u n t o f
c a s h w e “ b u r n ” a s a n a s s e t
Companies with negative cash flows sometimes get credit for the
amount of cash they raise andspendon researching new products.
This is especially true in the biotechnology industry, but we see no
reason why the logic of that approach shouldnot extendto our businesses
as well. Speculators andtrad ers give substantial valuation
credit for this cash burn.
Beginning today, we will treat the amount of our cash burn as an
asset on the balance sheet rather than as an expense on the income
statement. On the other hand, because of the significant impact that
the treatment of disbursed cash as an expense or an asset has on our
earnings, we reserve the right from time to time to alternate between
these treatments, depending on the trend in reported earnings from
quarter to quarter.
r e p o r t i n g i n a d i f f e r e n t
c u r r e n c y
We sell many of our products and conduct a clearinghouse operation
for other businesses in a barter exchange Web site on the Internet.
In lieu of trading (or bartering) such goods and services directly, however,
exchange members use our trademarked “dot-com dollars,” issued
to them by us for the purpose of bartering. These dot-com dollars
have a face value far greater than the U.S. dollar and we propose to
record certain of our assets and sales transactions in dot-com dollars
rather than U.S. dollars, thereby substantially increasing the amounts
of reportedassets andincome (we are not fools, however, so expenses
andliabilities, of course, will continue to be reported in U.S. dollars).
r e f i n i n g t h e c o n c e p t o f
m a t e r i a l i t y
Lawyers andaud itors often place great weight on whether some economic
event is material to our company or not. They define materiality
in terms of what a reasonable investor thinks about its impact on the
business or financial condition of the company. In the past, this led
us to report in our financial statements details that don’t really seem
Making (Up) Numbers 161
to matter very much to the managers at our company or to other
owners of options on our stock.
To reconcile managerial needs with the requirements of financial
reporting, the board adopted a new rule of materiality. Under it, no
economic activity is material to the company unless it impacts our
earnings by at least 5%. This rule is more definitive and reliable than
the oldrule andwill result in greater certainty in our bookkeeping
department. By applying this approach to materiality, we can ignore
a variety of burdensome reporting questions, thus saving (material)
basketfuls of money.
As satire, the report from E-America Dot.Com reveals how atrocious
andd istorted aggressive accounting and earnings management
can be. (Most of the examples are basedon actual cases.) However,
you will never see the kindof candor expressedin this news release
coming out of corporations. That kindof honesty is inconsistent with
the goals underlying the shenanigans.
Accordingly, you will not recognize financial disingenuousness,
recklessness, aggressiveness, deception, or fraud when you see it unless
you know how to look. You will findthe following examples of
recent financial chicanery helpful andwill benefit from constant perusal
of the reports of financial deception chronicled virtually daily
in newspapers, newsletters, andreputable Web sites.
In thinking about such charades, note that many frequently criticizedtechniques
are not always unlawful and do not necessarily
violate generally acceptedaccounting principles. Often, however,
they impair the integrity of financial reporting. Worse, a corporate
or financial reporting culture that condones aggressive practices creates
the risk of degradation of financial reporting: What starts as
merely aggressive can create pressure that leads reporting over the
line andinto the fraudulent.
There is always pressure to engage in accounting shenanigans.
Many scandals suggest that irregular accounting is especially acute
at businesses with poor economic characteristics andthose facing
tough competitive conditions. A company’s contractual profile may
increase pressure for aggressive or irregular accounting. Many loan
agreements, for example, contain promises by the borrower to maintain
certain financial ratios, including debt-to-equity ratios and the
others discussedearlier , andcan leadmanagers to meet those promises
by finessing.
Incentive compensation agreements triggeredby meeting sales
or earnings targets may encourage accounting games. Similar pres162
Show Me the Money
sures emerge from settlement agreements, consent decrees, and the
other legal obligations a company faces. Planning for additional financing
can produce pretty pictures despite dismal performance.
More generally, in an investment climate obsessedwith short-term
results, as Levitt cautioned, there is invariably pressure to sustain
steady increases in earnings growth.
CHARADES
There are lots of aggressive accounting techniques andopportunities
for difficult judgment calls, and so it would be surprising for any
two scandals to be identical.5 However, most accounting scandals
have a simple common denominator: Earnings are inflated. One of
the most common ways to inflate earnings is to treat as an expense
something that shouldbe treatedas an asset or a liability. This deception
hides the costs of doing business on the balance sheet so
that they never burden the income statement.
Dissecting most accounting scams requires only a rudimentary
understanding of simple bookkeeping rules and their relationship to
financial statements. Double-entry bookkeeping requires a debit and
a credit in equal amounts for every transaction. The double entries
keep a balance sheet equalized(assets always equal liabilities plus
net worth) andreflect the direct relationship between income (revenue
minus expenses) andnet worth.
More particularly, increases in asset or expense accounts require
debits, and decreases in them require credits; increases in liability
or revenue accounts require credits, and decreases in them require
debits. These bookkeeping rules are invariant, and so short of making
up or not recording transactions, the trickery involves classifying
transactions as assets or expenses or as liabilities or revenues.
Pearson/Penguin
Consider how the Pearson conglomerate accounted for book sales
through its Penguin publishing division. Sales made on credit require
two entries in equal amounts: a debit to Accounts Receivable,
the asset account, anda credit to Sales, the revenue account. Subsequent
receipt of the cash payment requires a debit to Cash and a
credit to Accounts Receivable.
Penguin began granting 10% discounts off its list price to selected
Making (Up) Numbers 163
buyers who paidtheir accounts early. Following bookkeeping rules,
receipt of those early cash payments calledfor a credit to Accounts
Receivable equal to 100% of the list price. Since the buyer received
a 10% discount on the price, the debits should have been made to
Cash for 90% of the list price, with the other 10% going to an expense
account. Adding it up, those 10% discount expenses would have reduced
reported earnings.
Insteadof following these standard bookkeeping rules, Pearson
apparently recorded receipts of early payments as a debit to Cash
for 90% of the list price anda credit to Accounts Receivables for
90% of the list price, andso the 10% discount never showed up as
an expense. It simply remainedpart of the asset account—Accounts
Receivable—andartificially inflated reported earnings.
While Penguin’s 10% individual discounts given on a per customer
basis may at first seem like small change, they aggregatedover
six years to $163 million. Pearson’s management eventually discoveredthe
buriedd iscounts when integrating Penguin and Pearson’s
newly acquiredPutnam Berkley publishing house. Dirty bookkeeping
then turnedinto housecleaning.
Mercury Finance
In January 1997 Mercury Finance announcedthat it hadoverstated
earnings for the first three quarters of 1996 andfor the whole of
1995 by a total of more than 100%. All corporate hell broke loose at
Mercury Finance, a company in the business of lending to consumers
with weak credit ratings. Its CEO and controller both left, a
turnaround specialist was recruited, and pending deals with the
Bank of Boston andSalomon Brothers were terminated. It lacked
cash to meet its maturing commercial paper obligations andteetered
on the edge of bankruptcy.
The company and the consumer finance industry made headlines
every other day. Some commentators correctly noted that many companies
in high-risk businesses like Mercury Finance’s use “aggressive
accounting techniques”; other so-calledexperts incorrectly stated
that accounting in finance companies is “extraordinary complex.” It
is not all that complex.
To lenders, loans are assets even though some loans are unlikely
to be repaid. Bad loans are an expense—a cost of doing business.
Expenses reduce net income. Estimating the amount of bad loans
may involve complex judgments, but the accounting is simple. The
164 Show Me the Money
portion of loans deemed uncollectible is recorded as an expense (a
debit). The credit is to an account called Allowance for Doubtful
Receivables.
Insteadof treating all badloans as expenses, Mercury Finance
apparently decided that even if a borrower was not going to pay,
somehow the company wouldrecover the money (by repossessing
the borrower’s car, for example). In the bookkeeping, a debit was
made to an asset account called Other Assets to reflect the right to
repossess rather than to an expense account to reflect that the loan
probably was never going to be paid. With fewer reported expenses,
Mercury Finance reportedfar higher earnings.
A bright redflag flew over Mercury Finance’s financial statements.
The Other Assets account on its balance sheet rocketedfrom
$24.6 million at the endof 1994 to $121 million a year later. Even if
the account included other assets besides repossession rights, the
striking increase shouldhave seemedpeculiar to anyone with a little
accounting sense (or even common sense).
America Online
America Online’s asset- andexpense-flipping imbroglio resulted from
treating disbursements for developing a subscriber base not as a cost
of doing business (an expense) but as an investment in the business
(an asset). While this is exactly what was done in the National Student
Marketing scandal of the late 1960s and early 1970s, there was
a judgment to make here.
One couldliken on-line services to newspapers and follow that
industry’s practice of expensing these costs, or one could analogize
to direct mail order companies and follow that industry’s practice of
capitalizing them—treating them as assets whose cost is allocated
over future accounting periods.
In choosing between these treatments, the accounting issue is
whether the disbursements will contribute reliably to revenue generation
in future periods. As it turned out, America Online could
not gauge for how long its new subscribers wouldremain customers,
andso there was no basis for saying the disbursements would increase
future revenue.
Maybe it was reasonable for AOL’s managers andaud itors to
make the judgment they made. After the horrible press coverage and
class action shareholder lawsuit that resulted, however, you can be
sure they regret it.
Making (Up) Numbers 165
As with Mercury Finance, a telltale redflag flew high: AOL’s
balance sheet showedan unusual asset called Deferred Subscriber
Acquisition Costs. Mushrooming to $385 million between August
1995 andOctober 1996, it became the largest asset on AOL’s balance
sheet. Angry shareholder agitation forced AOL to abandon the practice
in the fall of 1996 andrestate its earnings, wiping out about 80%
of owners’ equity.
Fabri-Centers
Judgment plays a critical role in corporate accounting decisions, enabling
managers to persuade auditors and directors to accept their
position when choosing to expense or capitalize a transaction or
make other accounting decisions. Even when the managerial decision
is accepted, full disclosure about the judgment should be included
in the company’s financial statements but isn’t always.
If you have any doubt about the need for disclosing these difficult
judgment calls, consider the enlightening story behind the settlement
of SEC charges against Fabri-Centers, an operator of over
900 retail stores, including the JoAnn Fabrics chain. Fabri-Centers
knew the daily sales figures at its stores but could not determine the
cost of goods sold or the profit margin until it conducted an annual
inventory, andso it estimatedthem, using the so-called gross profit
methodof applying the prior year’s actual profit margin to calculate
quarterly profits for the succeeding year.
During several quarters, however, heavy price competition substantially
eroded the margin. Before the erosion was reported or publicly
disclosed, the company effected a public debt offering. The SEC
charged Fabri-Centers with inadequate disclosure about price competition
andits estimation practice in that offering.
Under Fabri-Centers’ inventory system (it has since been modernized),
a judgment about quarterly profit margins was necessary.
But those involvedin the debt offering—aware that the quarterly
financial statements were unauditedandprepared in anticipation of
the offering—shouldhave paidgreater attention to the role that accounting
estimates played.
Sunbeam
Sunbeam committeda distinct but all too common type of accounting
fraud. Its widely publicized accounting machinations boiled down to
166 Show Me the Money
a series of so-calledbill-and -holdtransactions. During the winter
months, it recorded charcoal grill sales even though the grills were
not to be shippeduntil the spring. This manipulative maneuver enabledit
to report higher sales in the winter.
The accounting shenanigan took place near the endof the reign
of the self-proclaimedturnaround king Al Dunlap. Upon taking the
helm at Sunbeam—which was floundering from a substantial business
downturn—Dunlap fired half its workers and closed or consolidated
more than half its facilities. Boasting that he aimed to “attack”
his company, Dunlap declared that his plan was as carefully plotted
as the invasion of Normandy. (Alas, Dunlap is no Churchill, and all
his plans for Sunbeam failedmiserably .) With that kindof siege
mentality driving the company, accounting irregularities might not
have been inevitable, but they were certainly made more likely.
MicroStrategy
Sunbeam’s travails of revenue recognition have spreadthrough other
businesses, especially the computer software companies that Levitt
singledout for special illustration. One of the most dramatic examples
of the potential fallout occurredat the software company
MicroStrategy.
MicroStrategy enteredinto several unusual contracts under
which it bought andsoldsomething from the other party. The dual
deal enabledMicroStrategy to recordrevenue much earlier than accounting
rules permit andto obscure that accounting from the auditors
reviewing its books.
Pressure from journalists compelledthe company andits auditors
to scrutinize those contracts, and they ultimately decided the
earlier accounting hadbeen incorrect. Shazam! When the company
finally came clean, its stock price plungedfrom $245 to $87 per
share (over a 60% wipeout). Who lost? Popeyedsharehold ers.
Cendant
Obfuscatory language in corporate disclosure signifies brewing trouble.
This is only one of the scores of lessons learnedfrom the
notorious accounting scandal that unfolded in the late 1990s at Cendant
Corporation, a company formed by the merger in late 1997 of
CUC International andHFS Inc.
CUC operateda members-only discount shopping service that
Making (Up) Numbers 167
generatedrevenue through membership dues. On average, membership
clubs like these earn greater profits from long-term members
than from short-term members. Indeed, the tendency is to make zero
profit from members enrolledless than a year because they are typically
entitledto a cancellation refundof dues.
As early as 1989, CUC met with some accounting embarrassment
for its practice of recognizing as revenue the total amount of each
membership payment in the periodit was received while expensing
amounts allocable to each membership over a three-year period. In
bookkeeping terms, it debited revenue while crediting both an expense
account andsome liability account, a mismatching that
boostedreportedearnings.
Although CUC retreatedfrom that position after harsh criticism
by financial analysts andothers, it continued practicing aggressive
accounting in other areas. Chief among these practices was its reporting
technique for membership flow andannual renewal rates—
important information for gauging company prospects given that
newer members contribute little or nothing to the bottom line while
the real value is in long-term members.
Among new members enrolledat the endof a given year, 70%
renewed, but the way CUC reported this in its disclosure made it
seem as if 70% of all members who joined during the year renewed.
Thus, if 100 members were in andout during the year but 10 remainedmembers
at year end, the 70% figure meant that 7 renewed
even though it lookedlike 70 renewed—a tenfold difference in the
company’s prospects.
This misleading disclosure represents only one egregious example
of numerous irregularities at the company, as a subsequent $2.8
billion settlement of an investor lawsuit anda forensic accounting
report later made clear. The report emphasized that these practices
manifestedan overall culture of pernicious accounting practices.
Others included manipulating books relating to the percentage of
refundable membership dues, cash management, and even how the
merger between CUC andHFS that created Cendant was accounted
for.
CODA
Aggressive or irregular accounting is not a sign of business promise.
The trouble is, it is often hard to detect. Buffett quipped: “It has
168 Show Me the Money
been far safer to steal large sums with a pen than small sums with
a gun.”6 Steering clear of such robbery requires attention to managers,
who shape corporate culture. Some corporate cultures encourage
laudable accounting practices, while others—as these chicaneries
illustrate—encourage what Ben Graham called
“prestidigitation” or magical numbers.7 From National Student Marketing
to Cendant, the question is the tone of trust at the top, which
raises the subject of the next part of this book.
P a r t I I I
IN MANAGERS
WE TRUST
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
This page intentionally left blank.
171
C h a p t e r 1 1
GOING GLOBAL
Warren Buffett repeatedly emphasized the importance of investing
only with people you “like, trust, and admire” (the phrase
appears over a dozen times in The Essays of Warren Buffett: Lessons
for Corporate America). Ben Graham deemphasized this managerial
factor in investment selection, but not because he did not thinkit
was important.
Graham’s trouble was the difficulty in measuring the management
factor. He believed that until “objective, quantitative, and reasonably
reliable tests of managerial competence are devised and applied,
this factor will continue to be looked at through a fog.”1 The
best Graham thought an investor could do to gauge the management
factor was to lookat historical financial performance as it is reported
in financial statements.
At the same time, one of Graham’s key principles of investing as
business analysis focused squarely on integrity. Graham implored
investors not to entrust wealth to someone else unless either (1) the
investor could supervise that person or (2) the investor had “unusually
strong reasons for placing implicit confidence in his integrity
and ability.”2 Graham was expressly talking about investment advisers,
but the point applies equally to managers. After all, whether
an investor uses an intermediary or not, her wealth is in the hands
of business managers.
A fog still clouds the view of managerial ability and trustworthiness,
but consider two important points. First, the corporate governance
field has blossomed since Graham wrote, and many people
argue that it now contributes clearer ways of thinking about and
measuring managerial integrity and effectiveness. Second, Graham
implicitly noted the importance of managerial trustworthiness when
he deferred to the financial record as a gauge of managerial ability.
As we just saw, the reliability of historical financial statements depends
on managerial trustworthiness.
While managerial ability and trustworthiness may not warrant an
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
172 In Managers We Trust
increase in your estimate of a company’s value, the weakness or
absence of these qualities certainly justifies the opposite. As Buffett
says: “Investors should pay more for a business that is lodged in the
hands of a manager with demonstrated pro-shareholder leanings
than for one in the hands of a self-interested manager marching to
a different drummer.”3
To set the stage for examining managerial integrity and ability, it
is first useful to consider the standards of behavior managers are
held to both in the United States and around the industrialized
world. Much rhetoric characterizes discussion of these conventions,
but the reality is often at odds with it. Let’s take a brief tour of the
world stage of corporate governance before zeroing in on specific
indicators of pro-shareholder management.4
THE TWO-WORLD STORY
Customarily, it is believed that corporations in the United States and
the United Kingdom (U.K.) operate primarily for the benefit of
shareholders. This contrasts with corporations in Japan, Germany,
and other Continental European countries, where managers
are thought to operate for the common good—for the benefit of
shareholders, workers, creditors, and communities. At an abstract
level both generalizations are correct, but on closer inspection neither
is.
This comparison describes the U.S./U.K. approach as a shareholder
market model. In it, two internal groups constitute and regulate
a corporation: managers and shareholders. Shareholders own
the corporation’s equity, the value of which fluctuates with the fortunes
of the corporation. Managers consist of both the daily operators
of the corporation (the officers) and those who oversee and
supervise those operations (the directors).
The key problem in U.S. and U.K. corporate governance is the
separation of ownership from control that results from the
shareholder-manager dichotomy. Two broad sets of mechanisms address
the issues raised by this problem. Monitoring mechanisms either
impose duties on managers or empower shareholders to take
action against them. Exit mechanisms include, most importantly, the
free transferability of ownership interests, which enables shareholders
to sell their stockand thus exit the corporation at will; this often
is called the Wall Street rule.
Monitoring and exit mechanisms reinforce the financial and laGoing
Global 173
bor markets, and vice versa. Shareholders can oust inferior managements
because a market for managing and controlling corporations
exists. The free transferability of ownership interests—an exit mechanism—
has contributed to the development of deep, liquid, and active
(if not efficient) capital markets. Disclosure laws in the United
States, which promote the transparency of corporations’ performance,
have substantially aided these market forces.
Corporate transparency, coupled with the U.S./U.K. tradition of
at-will employment, also facilitates reasonably well-functioning labor
markets. For example, if managers perform poorly, corporate transparency
makes it more likely that shareholders will vote to oust them
and other corporations will not hire them readily.
At the same time, however, managers can contract and expand
the employee base to enhance performance. Of course, labor unions
often gain substantial power through collective bargaining agreements
which contract and federal labor laws protect. That power
does not derive, however, from externally imposed regulation but
instead is the product of voluntary arrangements.
Consumer product markets also contribute to the discipline of
corporate managerial performance by registering preferences which
eventually lead to corporate profits. Nonetheless, in the end, labor
markets are far from perfect, and it is not uncommon to see senior
executives earn staggering compensation despite mediocre or subpar
performance.
The great American pastime of litigation reinforces these monitoring
mechanisms. Shareholders are equipped with a vast arsenal
of legal claims, procedural devices, and legal and equitable remedies
to protect their interests. They benefit from a specialized group of
lawyers who not only bring direct, derivative, and class action suits
under both state and federal law but also identify and communicate
the bases for such actions and even finance them.
The rights of other constituencies in a U.S. corporation differ
from those of shareholders. Contracts set employee, supplier, creditor,
and customer rights. The primary rationale for this treatment
is that in bankruptcy, shareholders are last in line after the claims
of all the other groups are paid off. This means that when managers
act for the shareholders they indirectly protect the interests of all
those claimants.
The central finance characteristic of this market model is fragmented
ownership of equity securities in corporations. An underlying
cultural aspect of the fragmented ownership structure generates
an entrepreneurial spirit which encourages widespread participation
174 In Managers We Trust
in equity investment in terms of both those who demand it (startups
and expanding enterprises) and those who supply it (venture
capitalists and investors generally).
This ownership structure also rests on a cultural aversion to concentrations
of power. The best examples are the Sherman and Clayton
antitrust acts that shut down trusts such as Standard Oil in the
climate of Theodore Roosevelt’s trust-busting populism. Another is
the Glass-Steagall Act, the Depression-era law that segregated the
industry of investment banking from that of commercial banking.
The repeal of that act in 1999 may reflect a degree of change in U.S.
attitudes, though it at least equally likely reflects the globalization
of the world economy, in which power is greatly diffused already;
the governmental efforts waged against Microsoft under the antitrust
laws suggest that such concerns remain prevalent.
Contrast all this with the so-called bank/labor model used to describe
Japanese, German, and other Continental European corporate
systems. Instead of the shareholder market model’s fragmentation of
ownership, the central finance features of the bank/labor model are
ownership concentration and substantial investment intermediation.
Banks act as financial intermediaries by accepting individual deposits
and compiling them for investment in corporations. Only a
relatively small number of these investing entities exist. This concentration
of ownership and debt holdings reduces the pressure for
the development of actively functioning, deep, and liquid capital
markets. Moreover, nothing like the Glass-Steagall Act has prevented
the commercial and investment bankunity that mitigates this concentration
of investment ownership.
This centralization results in a small and powerful body of shareholders
and debt holders whose dual position requires few regulatory
governance mechanisms compared to the array of tools used to define
the rights of various interests in U.S./U.K. corporations. Because
a single bankacts as both primary shareholder and debt
holder, there is less pressure to choose between models that favor
either shareholders or other constituencies of the corporation.
Also, less need exists for regulating governance mechanisms because
of traditions that have put labor at the center of the governance
structure rather than as a participant with contractually defined
interests. European nations are deeply committed to worker
protection, as evidenced by wage-setting policies and laws that make
firing workers difficult (in contrast to U.S./U.K. at-will employment).
These sorts of forces also explain why the disparity in compensation
Going Global 175
levels between senior executives and ordinary laborers is relatively
narrower under the bank/labor model than it is under the market
model.
In terms of formal governance, the German and Dutch version
of this model formally elevates labor as a third key participant in the
leadership of a corporation. These corporations operate with worker
councils which management must consult on a variety of matters
concerning corporate policy. German corporations generally have a
two-tiered board system which consists of a management board and
a supervisory board.
The management board (Vorstand) manages the corporation, represents
it in third-party dealings, and submits regular reports to the
supervisory board. The supervisory board (Aufsichtsrat) appoints and
removes the members of the management board and oversees the
management of the corporation. Under German law, employeeelected
and shareholder-elected representatives are represented on
the supervisory board in equal shares. While it cannot make management
decisions, the supervisory board may determine that certain
actions or business measures contemplated by the management
board require its prior approval.
The German dual-board structure is based on the concept of
codetermination (Mitbestimmung). According to this view, because
labor and capital codetermine a corporation’s future, labor should
protect its interests from within the corporate governance system
through formal representation on the supervisory board rather than
through contract or governmental regulation. Banks, which occupy
the unique positions of debt holder and shareholder, constitute the
other half of the supervisory board. Consequently, the separation of
ownership from control, a defining characteristic of the shareholder
market model, is expressly absent in the bank/labor model.
In the bank/labor model, even sole shareholders may lack the
power to remove or replace management. This lackof power is especially
pronounced under the two-tiered board structure prevalent
in Germany and the Netherlands, in large part as a result of the
workcouncil regulations that have been adopted across Europe. The
European Union (EU) mandates that all members except the United
Kingdom require most of their corporations to establish procedures
for employee consultation and worker council formation.
Many Continental European countries have gone beyond the EU
mandates to require that virtually all corporations establish and
maintain worker councils. Management must consult with these
176 In Managers We Trust
councils on major corporate policies affecting labor interests, including
layoff proposals and in many cases potential changes of control.
Galvanizing this labor element in the corporate governance
model, the EU also requires that employment contracts follow business
assets when sold as a going concern so that a buyer of such
assets remains subject to those agreements by operation of law.
Compared to the European model, the Japanese variation deepens
the roles of both labor and lender banks in the governance structure.
As in Europe, banks tend to own the vast bulk of the debt and
equity of industrial companies. The distinguishing factual characteristic
is the Japanese production model that is called horizontal
coordination. Workers are generalists when it comes to the production
process and engage in a substantial amount of information sharing
and training throughout production. Limited specialization, however,
requires high corporate investment in labor markets to develop
the necessary human capital.
Japanese corporations thus face a higher riskof loss on investment
from worker defection than do European and American corporations.
However, workers face the risk of acquiring nontransportable,
firm-specific skills. Corporations and workers have
addressed these risks by developing a system of lifetime employment.
This policy provides workers with permanent job security and affords
corporations a concomitantly restricted labor market.
No binding contract guaranteed this mutual security system, and
so the Japanese model turned to corporate cross-ownership to provide
the necessary structural protections. Industrial corporations in
Japan own substantial percentages of the securities of other industrial
corporations. The resulting ownership concentration is even
more centralized than it is in the European model, and it causes a
commensurate dilution of capital market disciplining power.
ILLUSIONS OF DUTY
So much for these polar stories. Reality suggests far more overlap
and universal looseness across advanced economies in regard to the
real beneficiaries of managerial duties—an important point for investors
to understand.
Corporate social responsibility remains an important dimension
of U.S. corporate governance. Direct efforts to improve the lot of
nonshareholder constituencies supplement the simple argument that
Going Global 177
shareholder-based profit maximization helps all the other participants.
Scores of organizations promote this direct approach in response
to the needs of corporate constituencies on a variety of issues, including
affirmative action, child labor, downsizing, the environment,
fair wages, privacy, sexual harassment, and the balance between work
life and family life. These organizations operate through employee
training and assistance programs, mission statements, and social responsibility
audits.
Social responsibility has reached the large organizational level.
For example, Business for Social Responsibility, an organization
founded in 1992, currently has over 1,400 corporate members with
aggregate annual revenues exceeding $1 trillion and total employees
of nearly 5 million. It features household corporate names such as
AT&T, Coke, DuPont, Federal Express, Home Depot, Motorola, and
Polaroid. Significant numbers of mutual funds and other institutional
investors also have committed to investing only in socially
responsible enterprises. Some investors claim that investing this way
maximizes shareholder wealth.
Many corporations have followed suit and now emphasize their
social responsibility. There are well-known exemplars of the traditional
left such as Body Shop and Ben & Jerry’s (taken over by Unilever
in early 2000 with promises to expand the social responsibility
commitments of the global consumer products giant). There are also
some surprising followers, such as Philips-Van Heusen Corporation,
which is headed by CEO Bruce Klatsky, an adviser on U.S. trade policy
to the Bush and Reagan administrations. Hasbro, Reebok, and
Wal-Mart also are following this trend. This social emphasis is entirely
consistent with state laws, which mandate that directors act in the
best interests of the shareholders and the corporation as a whole.
German law takes more seriously the idea that the beneficiaries
of directors’ duties include corporate constituents other than shareholders,
yet Germany also forbids directors from acting contrary to
shareholder interests and indeed often requires them to act in the
“aggregated shareholder interest.” German corporate law—which is
fairly representative of European countries on these points—and
U.S. law therefore contemplate the protection of all corporate constituencies.
Both prescribe this protection by imposing on management
the fiduciary duties care and loyalty.
The duty of care requires the exercise of an informed business
judgment, which is taken to mean that directors must gather all the
178 In Managers We Trust
material information that is reasonably available to them. Informed
directors then must act prudently and reasonably in the discharge
of their duties. The liability of directors for breach of the duty of
care in most circumstances requires a finding by a court that the
directors were grossly negligent—quite a high standard that is akin
to driving while intoxicated. The duty of loyalty requires directors to
subordinate their personal interests to those of the corporation if a
conflict exists. Specific applications of this general duty vary among
economically-developed countries, but the variation is not much
more pronounced than are the nuanced differences between states
within the United States.
The differences are thus more subtle between U.S./U.K. and
Continental Europe director duties than is often recognized. The
varying prescriptions address the content of those duties rather than
their discrete beneficiaries. They are “vertical,” intended to preserve
and expand the size of the corporate pie rather than address how it
is sliced or allocated.
When the question is pie size, the interests of managers are pitted
against the interests of all the other constituencies, and so it is
not surprising that these vertical mechanisms differ little across the
borders of economically advanced countries. What is surprising is
that they also extend to situations where allocation is at stake, a
“horizontal” question that manifests itself most acutely when threats
to corporate control arise.
Most U.S. state laws impose either a heightened standard of duty
on directors facing hostile takeovers or a heightened standard of
judicial review of director conduct. The issue in either instance is
whether the directors have acted in the best interest of shareholders.
While these heightened standards do not exist in German law, which
only requires directors not to act contrary to the stockholders’ interest
and to show regard for the common interest, this does not
mean that the heightened U.S. standard separates the American
model from the Continental model.
Many states empower directors to consider the interests of nonshareholder
constituencies in numerous circumstances. For example,
although U.S. judges often remarkthat “shareholders come
first,” they simultaneously let directors consider the impact of corporate
decisions on constituencies other than shareholders, including
creditors, customers, employees, and sometimes as broad a group
as the general community.
Judges sometimes mesh mandatory rhetoric with discretionary
Going Global 179
reality even in extreme circumstances such as where managers fight
against a hostile takeover—one of the devices on the horizon in the
late 1960s that Ben Graham thought might operate as a disciplining
force on underperforming managers.5 For example, in the mid-1990s
the Delaware Supreme Court accepted the arguments of Time Inc.’s
directors, who resisted an unwanted takeover by Paramount, in part
on the ground that doing so was necessary to preserve the company’s
culture of journalistic integrity. Thus, despite even the most rigorous
judicial review of board actions, in takeover contexts, directors have
a great deal of latitude.
Takeover laws do not require any particular action, such as an
auction, or impose on directors any duty to ensure that shareholders
get the highest price. The unifying inquiry in virtually all these cases
is whether a threat to the corporation exists, not solely or even necessarily
whether the shareholders’ interests are in jeopardy.
For a dramatic example of what occurs under laws that look
beyond shareholder interests, consider the fight for corporate control
between AlliedSignal and AMP.6 AlliedSignal offered a 55% premium
over the market price of AMP, a company whose profitability
had seriously dropped. AMP shareholders overwhelmingly supported
AlliedSignal, and within a month of the offer 72% of AMP’s outstanding
shares were tendered into it. Shareholder supporters included
the family of the company’s founder, Robert Hixon, and many
institutional shareholders, which owned approximately 80% of the
stock, including the Teachers Insurance and Annuity Association–
College Retirement Equities Fund (TIAA-CREF).
Indeed, TIAA-CREF joined a shareholder group that sued AMP’s
board. That group tookthe extraordinary step of separately filing a
“friend-of-the-court” brief supporting AlliedSignal in direct litigation
between AlliedSignal and AMP. TIAA-CREF argued that AMP had
trampled on basic “principles of shareholder democracy.”
Despite this overwhelming shareholder support for AlliedSignal,
AMP’s management successfully erected a series of defensive barriers
to the bid. Management tookadvantage of Pennsylvania laws
requiring directors to act in the best interests not of the shareholders,
but of the corporation and permitting boards to act in what they
perceive to be the best interests of employees, lenders, communities,
and others. One extraordinary barrier AMP’s management raised
changed the terms of its “poison pill” so that it could not be eliminated
even by directors who held office before any of AlliedSignal’s
directors had joined.
180 In Managers We Trust
AMP sought and won an injunction prohibiting AlliedSignal’s
consent solicitation unless and until each proposed directorcandidate
affirmed that if elected, he or she was duty-bound under
Pennsylvania law to act in the best interests of the corporation as a
whole, not merely in the shareholders’ interest.
The court upheld AMP’s extraordinary actions against Allied-
Signal’s claim that AMP’s board had breached its fiduciary duties in
response to the AlliedSignal bid. In its opinion, the court repeatedly
emphasized a “stakeholder” standard, which appears to be at the
heart of Pennsylvania law, and used the following unequivocal terms:
“Directors may weigh the interests of the shareholders against the
interests of other constituencies.” They “may consider the effects
upon all groups affected, including shareholders, employees, suppliers,
customers and creditors.” They “shall not be required to regard
any corporate interest or group as dominant or controlling.”
These statements do not suggest a shareholder-primacy norm. A
less obvious point but one that is equally true is that these Pennsylvania
standards are not all that different in practice from those
of other U.S. states. They are also not all that different from German
law and may even capture the German sense of the common interest.
Consider both German-based Mannesmann’s battle against the
United Kingdom’s Vodaphone and the merger of Germany’s Daimler
Benz with the United States’s Chrysler. Although German law permits
directors to evaluate the interests of workers and lenders and
the so-called common interest, the law also required that the board
not act contrary to the best interests of shareholders—and both
boards did so, Mannesmann’s with a vengeance.
That kind of deference to shareholders may not illustrate shareholder
primacy, nor it it consistent with the usual rhetoric of the
bank/labor model. Accordingly, U.S. practice more closely resembles
European practice than it does U.S. rhetoric, and European practice
more closely resembles U.S. practice than it does European rhetoric;
managers in neither place are obligated to hold a thoroughgoing
owner orientation.
ONE WORLD TO COME
Trends in corporate practice worldwide suggest further harmonization,
and it is a mistake for investors to overlook them. These trends
spell the continued erasure of differences and a tendency to make
Going Global 181
owner orientation even less compulsory. If this is the case, the already
small population of true owner-orientated U.S. managers will
shrinkfurther . On the other hand, the number abroad may grow
larger.
Financial markets increasingly compete internationally, just as
product markets have done for decades. Investors (suppliers of capital)
now lookacross borders for additional investment opportunities,
while corporations and other organizations seekthe lowest-cost capital
from any market in the world. The isolation of capital markets
is disappearing, and head-to-head competition among financial markets
has ensued.
The EU integrates corporate finance and governance in many
respects. Most significantly, the adoption of a single currency will
harmonize competition through the sharing of productivity differentials—
the fruits of technological advancement and higher investment.
Business expense differentials, particularly wages, should
evaporate. The process is just beginning as countries adopt the euro
and ultimately abandon their local currencies.
Nearly as profound, new EU innovations are greatly diminishing
barriers to cross-border capital flows. A series of EU directives
compeled the abolition of foreign investment controls. Member
states enthusiastically responded to this call by relaxing their controls.
The remaining restrictions generally are limited to notification
requirements or to specified sectors that pose national security or
public health, safety, and welfare concerns. Many European countries
simply retained the authority to implement such controls if
necessary.
Accounting
A series of fundamental principles has harmonized accounting rules
within Europe. These principles include (1) a requirement of uniform
formats for financial statements, (2) common valuation principles,
including historical cost, accrual accounting, and the principle of
conservatism called prudence, (3) a general mandate that financial
statements show true and fair value, (4) an annual audit, (5) public
filings, and (6) consolidation principles. A trend toward unified accounting
reinforces the harmonization trends in finance and governance.
Similar moves have occurred in Japan. Japanese accounting rules
now require consolidation of all the accounts of a company’s controlled
affiliates. In the past, the absence of such a rule enabled
182 In Managers We Trust
companies to allocate the bad accounting news to affiliates, making
the parent company’s books look much better. New Japanese rules
also require listing real estate held for sale at its current market value
if that value has fallen more than 50% from the original cost. The
absence of this new rule fueled the Japanese speculative bubble of
the 1980s that cratered gradually throughout the 1990s (described in
Chapter 5).
Around the world, increasing numbers of non-U.S. and non-
English-language corporations are ahead of schedule in adopting international
accounting principles and reporting their results in the
English language. Nissan, for example, adopted consolidation accounting
principles in late 1999, six months ahead of schedule, and
issued related press releases about that period’s results in English,
an unimaginable act for a Japanese corporation just a decade ago
(even one that is partly French-owned).
When Nissan reported its annual financial results in mid-2000,
using international accounting principles, they showed staggering
losses of $6.3 billion. Contributing to those losses were recognition
of pension liabilities and the costs of plant closings and the assignment
of more realistic values to real estate and securities holdings.
Although a number of other substantive factors contributed to these
results, investors considering investment in non-U.S. companies
must understand that accounting principles elsewhere are not always
what they seem.
The United States is harmonizing its accounting principles with
those prevalent worldwide. In October 1996, Congress passed the
National Securities Markets Improvement Act of 1996, which requires
the SEC to report to Congress on progress in developing international
accounting standards. The SEC has worked with the International
Accounting Standards Committee (IASC) for nearly a
decade to promulgate a core set of accounting pronouncements. In
October 1997 the SEC published a report to Congress on the progress
of the IASC, and it joined organizations throughout the world
in supporting the IASC’s initiatives.
The finance ministers and central bankgovernors of the G7
countries proclaimed support for the IASC and encouraged it to
complete a proposed set of core principles promptly. Additionally,
the World Bankrequested the world’s “Big Five” international auditing
firms to insist that companies prepare their financial statements
in accordance with international accounting standards. Leading
voices from around the world, including Tony Blair, the United
Going Global 183
Kingdom’s prime minister, and Robert E. Rubin, then U.S. treasury
secretary, intoned that developing and implementing international
accounting standards is a key part of the emerging global financial
system.
The SEC argues that international accounting standards must
be comprehensive, produce comparability and transparency, provide
for full disclosure, and be amenable to rigorous interpretation and
application. Indeed, many view SEC Chairman Levitt’s broad-based
initiative to crackdown on earnings abuses by management in U.S.
corporations as a response to the increasing attractiveness of international
harmonization of accounting standards, which the SEC
wants the United States to lead rather than follow.
The future state of accounting is crucial to investors. As pliable
as accounting rules are in the United States, they remain a functional
way to measure business reality. Coupled with an auditing
culture that insists on the integrity of financial reporting, this system
adds unparalleled value to the investing enterprise. Investors looking
abroad should be aware of the differences and monitor improvements
worldwide as they pose both pitfalls and opportunities.
Governance
In Europe, periodic resistance flares up against unification efforts.
For example, 13 EU directives dealing with European company law,
as well as a proposal to create a European Corporation (Societas
Europaea) that would supplement but not substitute for the national
corporate form in individual states, were intended to promote regional
(if not global) harmonization. However, none of these measures
is currently among the EU’s highest priorities.
On a few occasions, particularly during early EU convergence
efforts, proposals for employee board representation derailed the
adoption of some integrated governance proposals. Much of this resistance
originated in the United Kingdom, which has for decades
debated whether its future will be served better by a U.S./U.K. alliance
or a Continental European EU alliance. Despite the obstacles
this uncertainty poses for EU harmony, the United Kingdom produced
domestic convergence by drawing on both models.
U.S. corporate governance originally drew upon and refined U.K.
traditions. Now the United Kingdom has in turn imported those
principles as refined. Its 1992 Cadbury Report on corporate governance
(renamed the Hampel Report in the final 1998 version) seeks
184 In Managers We Trust
to identify the “best practices” of global corporations. They tend to
borrow on U.S. technical innovations in corporate governance, including
some discussed in the next chapter.
The United Kingdom’s substantial role in Europe, coupled with
its linkto U.S. corporate governance, moved the Continental models
closer to the market model. The French experience provides a provocative
example. The stakeholder model and financial intermediation
historically characterized French corporate governance. At the
same time, a state-dominated industrial policy defined French capitalism,
producing firms of a smaller average size than those in other
capitalist countries and an industrial elite recruited not from within
industry but from outside it. This environment limits capital market
depth and monitoring capabilities.
Now the French model is following the trend toward globalization
and liberalism. The revisions make the French model more closely resemble
a market model, beginning with a loosening of the state’s grip
on industry through privatization efforts. Additionally, the number of
small shareholders is rapidly growing, and, following the United Kingdom,
technical governance reforms based on U.S. models have been
instituted widely. Moreover, audit and compensation committees are
forming in French corporate boards, minority shareholders are taking
on increasingly important roles, and information superior in both
quantity and quality is enhancing economic transparency.
Japan is similarly racing toward a shareholder-market model and
away from long-term employment commitments and horizontal coordination.
Increasingly, Japan has recognized that profit-maximizing
strategies actually are consistent with the protections its traditional
devices provide. More and more Japanese workers—particularly
younger workers—indicate that they do not intend to stay with one
employer for more than a few years at a time, let alone maintain
lifetime employment with a single firm.
U.S. corporate governance remains imperfect, as we’ll see in the
next few chapters. The principles on which it is based are sound,
but a lot can be learned from studying governance in other countries,
particularly as investors increasingly set their sites on companies
organized abroad and competing worldwide.
Mergers and Acquisitions
The Vodafone-Mannesmann fight rode a wave of American-style European
merger activity that erupted in early 1999 with major hostile
Going Global 185
takeover battles. In France, Banque Nationale de Paris launched a
$38 billion hostile bid to take over its two major French banking
rivals, Socie´ te´ Ge´ne´ rale and Paribas, after they had recently announced
their own plan to merge with each other. In Italy, Olivetti
launched a $60 billion hostile bid to acquire its major rival, Telecom
Italia, which in turn erected a series of substantial defensive tactics
designed to thwart the overture, including a white-knight alliance
with Germany’s Deutsche-Telecom.
In another cross-border battle, France’s LVMH Moe¨ t Hennessy
Louis Vuitton waged a protracted and intense battle to obtain control
of Gucci, an Italy-based but Netherlands-incorporated company
which also strenuously resisted the unwelcome overture. TOTALFINA
made a hostile bid for Elf Aquitaine in mid-1999, shaking up
the French industrial and governmental establishment. These kinds
of deals—in both their offensive and defensive modes—are reminiscent
of U.S.-style merger activity, which had been unprecedented in
Europe.
Scores of friendly global alliances have reinforced the spread of
market model behavior in Europe and Japan. Led by the merger of
Daimler and Chrysler, the worldwide auto industry consolidated
through cross-border deals once considered too intractable to
achieve. Industry capacity ranges up to approximately 70 million vehicles
annually while average annual demand generally peaks at 50
million, and only about 10 of the world’s 40 auto manufacturers are
profitable. Some results: Ford bought control of Mazda, Volkswagen
acquired the United Kingdom’s Rolls Royce, Renault bought Samsung
(Korea) and a third of Nissan, and Daimler-Chrysler bought a
third of Mitsubishi.
Many other industries stand on the brinkof similar global consolidation.
In the publishing industry, Germany’s Bertelsmann pursued
an acquiring and joint-venturing spree with other European and U.S.
counterparts; in apparel, after surviving its own battle to resist a takeover
by LVMH, Gucci tookover France’s Yves Saint Laurent; in finance,
Deutsche Bankbought Bankers Trust, UBS bought Paine
Webber, Credit Suisse bought Donaldson Lufkin Jenrette, Dresdner
bought Wasserstein Parella; British Petroleum bought Amoco; and
Nabisco and a U.S. buyout firm sought to buy Britain’s United Biscuits
only to be outflanked by a consortium of French, German, and
British buyers. These and scores of other proposals on the docket of
the EU merger panel have created unmatched uniformity of practices
and expectations in the corporate world.
186 In Managers We Trust
There are few ways in which a corporate board can destroy shareholder
value as dramatically as through mergers and acquisitions. As
globalization advances, more opportunities for deals arise. Some will
be desirable; many will not. Paying close attention to the activity in
this field is of great importance to investors and is addressed again
later in this part.
Capital Markets
The aggregate stockmark et capitalization of Europe is larger than
that of Nasdaq and over half that of the New YorkStock Exchange.
(Given Mr. Market, the aggregate market capitalizations can change
dramatically in short time periods, but as of early 2000, the amounts
were about $7 trillion, $4 trillion, and $11 trillion, respectively.)
The Frankfurt and London stock exchanges announced in July
1998 a plan to integrate their facilities and permit the trading of each
other’s listed securities on both exchanges. France, unhappy with its
exclusion, quickly gained admission to the Frankfurt-London alliance
(although as a 20% player, compared with 40% for each of the
founding exchanges). Soon after France announced its inclusion in
the emerging pan-European exchange, exchange officials in Milan,
Madrid, Amsterdam, and Brussels echoed a similar eagerness to participate
in the venture.
Although the European alliance had difficulty agreeing on a
common trading system, the group quickly elected to permit stock
trading between the various exchanges. While negotiators struggled,
the once-snubbed French Bourse tookadvantage of the delays by
signing itself up with exchange partners from Amsterdam and Brussels.
This troika’s single market—a full integration of these three
exchanges called Euronext—boasts listings with a combined market
capitalization equal to over a quarter of that of Europe as a whole.
As the Euronext group forged this deal, the London and Frankfurt
exchanges agreed on a merger. The two formed iX, standing for
International Exchanges, a market poised to integrate blue chips and
tech stocks from the two dominant European capitals and boasting
a total capitalization of over half of that of Europe as a whole. That
deal was interrupted when OM Gruppen, operator of the Stockholm
(Sweden) stockexchange, made a hostile bid to buy the London
Exchange. However the dust settles on this array of parties, these
historical deals will not end capital market integration in Europe,
Going Global 187
the pace of which races on despite the presence of a dozen or more
unintegrated exchanges on the continent.
The U.S. National Association of Securities Dealers (NASD)
launched its own Nasdaq Europe stockmark et, one that will have
strong links to the emerging continental hybrids. This signifies a
major step toward creating a 24-hour-a-day global stockmark et that
began with the NASD’s similar venture in creating Nasdaq Japan, a
joint effort with the SoftbankCorporation of Japan that is linked to
the Osaka Securities Exchange. All this will compel the convergence
of these markets in awesome ways, impacting finance, accounting,
disclosure, takeovers, governance, and ultimately what investors expect
and what managers deliver.
Evidence of integration is pervasive in securities listing and trading.
Foreign firms for years have pushed for global listing, most famously
achieved by Daimler-Benz’s listing on the NYSE beginning
in 1993. These crusades continue, with rising success. After the repeal
of Glass-Steagall, the Swiss bankUBS filed with the SEC to
seekan NYSE listing, chiefly to give it a U.S.-listed stock to pay for
new acquisitions of U.S. financial services firms. This started with
its acquisition, a couple of months later, of PaineWebber.
SAP, a 25-year-old German software firm, was listed on the
NYSE in early August 1998, ten years to the day after its initial public
offering on the Frankfurt stock exchange. SAP is famous for generating
“U.S.-style growth” and “U.S.-style rewards.” SAP executives
characterized its listing on the NYSE as evidence that SAP had “outgrown”
the Frankfurt stock market and evolved into a transnational
company combining features of a variety of governance models.
Clear-cut signs of the conglomeration of international securities
trading include the creation of the International Securities Exchange
(ISE) for options trading. An on-line brokerage firm, E*Trade, and
a group of broker-dealers led by Adirondack Trading Partners invested
nearly $80 million to establish this all-electronic options
exchange. The founders touted their ability to slash transaction costs
while simultaneously conducting staggering sums of electronic
trades which transcend geographic boundaries.
Investors should not ignore the shape of capital markets. How
trades are made, by whom, at what cost, and over what time periods
significantly affect price volatility and have an impact on market
efficiency. Equally important, exchange rules often dictate accounting
requirements, and so the ease of international listings can impair
the integrity of financial reporting.
188 In Managers We Trust
The Last Frontier: Information
A practical barrier to cross-border deals has been yielding. It concerns
the nature and amount of available information regarding a
counterparty. In market model countries such as the United States
and the United Kingdom, a wealth of information is available concerning
the targets organized therein. These countries tend to operate
systems of public recordation for real as well as intellectual
property. Well-developed securities and mergers and acquisitions
(M&A) industries strengthen such an information culture.
Buyers and sellers in M&A transactions understand the need for
information to allow proper valuations and the need for contractual
protection to preserve confidentiality. Sellers customarily meet these
needs by executing confidentiality agreements early in the exploration
process and providing the buyer with substantial proprietary
data before discussing agreements any further.
The culture in European and Asian countries contrasts remarkably
with that of the U.S./U.K. market model. Access to property
records is limited, and information is more jealously guarded. Sellers
are reluctant to share information with a potential buyer who can
walkaway from a deal if she doesn’t like what she sees; confidentiality
agreements that protect such a seller in the United States and
the United Kingdom simply don’t do the trick. That may be sensible,
since a less well-developed system of legal enforcement for such
agreements justifies a seller’s apprehension about a buyer’s confidentiality.
Cultural disparities became acute in the Vodafone-Mannesmann
battle. Mannesmann sued Vodaphone’s adviser, Goldman Sachs, in
a U.K. court, trying to prevent it from advising Vodaphone on the
grounds that Goldman had previously represented Mannesmann and
possessed confidential information about it. The British court dismissed
the lawsuit after a brief hearing and in a short time, basically
telling Mannesmann that its claim was frivolous.
Substantively, the type of information understood as relevant also
varies between the models. In the market model and especially in
the United States, disclosing potential environmental or retiree liabilities
is a time-honored practice. Other countries have only recently
developed environmental regulation. Also, other countries traditionally
rely more heavily on public social security systems,
removing private plans from center stage (even in countries such as
Germany, where such liabilities are often substantial and unfunded).
Going Global 189
For investors, U.S. corporations disclose far more than do those
in Europe or Japan. U.S. federal and state law, as well as stock
exchange rules and general market pressures and expectations in the
United States, result in corporations disclosing extraordinary
amounts and types of information. Other countries impose more
limited and far less effective disclosure requirements.
As global corporations as diverse as DaimlerChrysler and SAP
increasingly list shares on U.S. stockexchanges and stock exchanges
around the world, they will find themselves subject to U.S.-style disclosure
requirements as a matter of both regulatory mandate and
market expectations and demand. As the same group consummates
cross-border transactions requiring the disclosure and evaluation of
information, pressures toward uniform disclosure requirements will
emerge in a wide variety of settings. In fact, participants find that
U.S./U.K.-style information disclosure is consistent with existing
corporate traditions in most countries, most notably Germany. Accordingly,
broadening global corporate laws to require such disclosure
seems quite possible.
Public regulators have undertaken just such an effort. The SEC
is working with the International Organization of Securities Commissions
(IOSCO) to develop a set of international standards for
nonfinancial statement disclosure. These efforts are intended to facilitate
cross-border financing and listing by transnational companies
while holding them to a single global standard of disclosure. The
IOSCO issued new rules about certain kinds of cash transactions
and offerings and listings of common equity securities and is working
to extend them to tender and exchange offers, business combinations,
privatizations, and other affiliated deals.
High-quality information is essential for intelligent investing in
the modern global marketplace. Ignoring the garbage and disinformation
piling up on the Internet is becoming increasingly difficult
as more countries develop information-based corporate and investing
cultures and as more citizens of those countries learn the ropes of
the systems.
Two-Way Street
Not all these trends run one way, for the idea of shareholder primacy
in the United States was gradually but substantially eroded by the
dramatic reallocation of corporate value from shareholders to work190
In Managers We Trust
ers throughout the latter half of the twentieth century. In the past,
workers had no interest in a corporation other than a paycheck and
the right to quit (and be fired). Today corporations whose workers
have no interest except a paycheckare rare.
Workers have claims against their corporate employers ranging
from vacation and sickpay to paternity or maternity leave, safety and
antidiscrimination rights, health plans, severance claims, and retiree
benefits and pensions. All these claims cost substantial amounts of
money, value that in the old days was owned by the shareholders.
On top of all that, somewhat paradoxically, employees have become
shareholders of these corporations and, counter to the Japanese
trend, are actually staying with the same employer for longer periods
and expressing greater loyalty to their employers than they did in the
past.
U.S. regulators are taking pages from abroad in a bolder way. A
major example is the elimination of boundaries between investment
and commercial banking. These boundaries were relaxed in December
1996, when the Federal Reserve Board increased the amount of
investment banking income a commercial bank can earn from investment
banking subsidiaries from 10% to 25%. The so-called Section
20 subs ushered in this regulatory change, which contributed
substantially to the ensuing wave of commercial and investment
bankmergers and reversed a historical cause of ownership fragmentation.
The repeal of the Glass-Steagall Act in November 1999 has
further fueled such financial reunions.
The U.S. litigation system is not the envy of the world, and it
encourages large volumes of shareholder class action and derivative
lawsuits against management. In contrast, most legal systems put
substantial restrictions on such suits. Although it does not appear
that litigation will decline substantially in the United States, it is
clear that lawmakers want to curb litigation abuse. For example, the
Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995 substantially revised
the securities laws in an effort to distinguish frivolous claims from
meritorious ones.
This analysis forecasts the hybridization of corporate governance
models in terms of both constituency and finance characteristics.
No owner orientation is required by these models. Forces appear to
be pushing for convergence, and the emerging model will not require
an owner orientation either. Indeed, to the extent that there is anything
real to the European corporate governance rhetoric, converGoing
Global 191
gence will dilute rather than enhance any managerial mandate to
run U.S. corporations mainly for the benefit of shareholders. Detecting
an owner orientation in this global marketplace thus becomes
more important than ever.
Buffett tells us that the most valuable lesson he learned in investing
was realizing the importance of owner-oriented managers.
The value of this timeless lesson will increase geometrically in a
globalized world. Of course, Buffett emphasizes that while management
quality can dramatically affect returns on equity, it is never a
substitute for a good business within one’s circle of competence,
saying that “a good managerial record (measured by economic returns)
is far more a function of what business boat you get into than
it is of how effectively you row (though intelligence and effort help
considerably, of course, in any business, good or bad).”7 The remaining
chapters focus on identifying winning managers.
This page intentionally left blank.
193
C h a p t e r 1 2
RULES AND TRUST
An investor is going to entrust her wealth to someone else.
Shouldn’t the investor have a high degree of confidence in that
person’s ability and integrity? Of course. It is simple common sense,
but how to assess ability and integrity is a bit trickier.
Graham used the quantitative analysis of the sort described in
Part II as a proxy. If the numbers lookgood year after year and
provide a basis for thinking that they will continue to do so, that
may suggest that management is able.
Many other investors, including Warren Buffett in his early days,
learned hard lessons from paying too little attention to management
integrity. True, if a company’s numbers lookgood and are accurate,
its managers are probably able and trustworthy. If the numbers look
good but are misleading, management may be neither. As Buffett
reminds us, “In the long run, managements stressing accounting
appearances over economic substance usually achieve little of either.”
1
Therefore, integrity is an additional independent factor in investment
selection. Is there a sensible way to thinkabout managerial
integrity? Buffett says the key is to invest with managers you “like,
trust, and admire.” His test for whether an investment meets this
requirement is whether the managers are “men you would be pleased
to see your daughter marry.”2
Does this “son-in-law” standard help? It may only suggest avoiding
managers you would not be pleased to invite over for a Super
Bowl party, but this is a great deal more meaningful than it sounds.
THE FAMILY MANAGER
All business transactions depend on trust and always have. Contracts
help define and protect rights, but entering into one calls for some
expectation that the other party will do what he says he will do.
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
194 In Managers We Trust
Contracts also reduce the costs of doing business and investing by
enabling people to trade off future risks, but that works only if the
other person can be expected to live up to the deal.
Trust in business is deeply rooted in kinship, and so it is no
wonder that the son-in-law test makes sense. The link between the
son-in-law test for managers and business itself comports with the
broad history of business development. Most businesses start out as
family enterprises and then grow in size over decades or generations,
adding relatives to the management ranks (often even including
sons-in-law, as at Anheuser-Busch, the Washington Post Company,
and Mead, for example). In many cases, such growth leads families
to give up control and the business evolves into a modern corporation,
as occurred at Brown-Forman, DuPont, Eli Lilly, McGraw-Hill,
Nordstroms, and countless others.
The erstwhile family business as modern corporation no longer
has Dad or Granddad or Daughter at the helm but instead has a
cadre of professional managers, a diffusion of control, an institutionalized
organizational structure, and lines of reporting authority.
The upshot is a corporation characterized by a separation of ownership
from control—shareholders watching managers run the business.
Trust in the modern corporation should resonate with norms
and values associated with that family business.
It is rarely feasible for an individual investor to sit down and get
acquainted with the chief executive officers of most major corporations,
but all these chiefs write annual letters to shareholders and
author other addresses periodically as well. These communications
contain remarkable clues about trustworthiness. The manager’s own
words often reveal her character. (Chapter 14 pursues this point.)
What is it that you trust a manager to do? The answer to that
question comes from thinking of him as your manager, something
that is hardly ever done. People always speakof their broker, their
accountant, their lawyer, but they hardly ever speakof their manager.
Yet a corporate manager does just as much for your wealth as these
sidekicks do, or more.
What should your manager do? Run the business for your benefit,
as a shareholder, against the numerous and often conflicting
interests of other constituencies of the business. Here is another key
point that is often overlooked: The perspectives of investors and
managers often diverge. When they do, investor interests can be
disserved.
Rules and Trust 195
Managers raise funds for corporate enterprise from the investing
public in the form of equity capital or stocks. Investors are regarded
by managers either as partners in the enterprise or merely as consumers.
When seen as consumers, investors are deemed to have tastes
and preferences that are reflected in the prices at which managers
can sell them stocks and other securities. Most of these investors
have little or no say in how a business is operated or even who the
managers will be (other than through annual elections of directors).
Instead they are strangers to the corporation, strangers whose
interests are subordinated to those of the corporation as a whole. In
this type of corporation, for example, managers tend to consider the
tax effects of declaring a dividend or structuring an acquisition deal
on the corporation as a whole but not on the individual shareholders.
In contrast, the voices of individual investors matter more to
owner-oriented managers. Seeing them as partners in the business,
these managers treat investors as members of the enterprise rather
than as strangers to it. Electing directors remains the formal vehicle
for this voice, but a more solicitous view of owner interests is taken.
For example, these managers consider the tax effects of corporate
decisions such as dividends and deals on the investor rather than
on, or at least separately from, the corporation.
It is far easier for managers of family and other small and privately
held corporations to adopt this owner orientation. It is far
easier for managers of large publicly held corporations to adopt the
opposite view. The managers with whom intelligent investors should
entrust their wealth are those who adopt the investor’s perspective
no matter how large the corporation or how many shareholders it
has.
LOCAL GOVERNANCE
The reality of global corporate management means that boards and
managers can run a business for the benefit of many constituencies,
not solely shareholders. Laws permit managers to operate pretty
much wherever they want along the spectrum from a shareholder
orientation to a constituency orientation. One part of business analysis
is evaluating the degree to which management has an owner
orientation.
196 In Managers We Trust
Sources for determining that orientation abound, probably more
so in the United States but increasingly throughout the developed
world. In the United States, corporations disclose volumes of information
to shareholders and other interested people. Many corporations
go beyond legal requirements, producing substantial information
on their Web sites and Webcasting archives and you can get
plenty of high-quality and reliable information from publications by
reputable industry analysts such as Standard & Poor’s, Dun & Bradstreet,
and Robert Morris Associates as well as government agencies
such as the Federal Trade Commission. Use your imagination.
Sift through these materials in looking for managers who act like
stewards of shareholder capital. Use it to find the best managers,
those who think like owners in making business decisions and who
adopt an attitude of partnership, embracing shareholders as members
of the enterprise rather than as strangers to it, those you would
be happy to invite over for a Super Bowl party.
However, even owner-oriented managers sometimes have interests
that conflict with those of shareholders. Workto identify and
invest with those who make a habit of easing those conflicts and
nurturing managerial stewardship of owner funds, those who exhibit
Aristotelian ethical virtue.
It is not easy to detect governance indicators of an owner orientation
in place at a corporation any more than it is to detect the
financial or managerial performance or even value of a corporation
from its financial statements. However, as with that effort, it is worth
the work.
The difficulty and the possibility exist because the law requires
very little of corporate governance. Yes, federal securities laws impose
extensive disclosure obligations, though most of what they call
for probably would be produced voluntarily by good companies participating
in a vibrant market economy anyway. Yes, state laws impose
duties on directors and managers, but those duties are loose
and general. Some statutory rules or limits are imposed, but they
are either highly formal and therefore malleable or pretty meaningless
as a practical matter and can be altered in corporate by-laws or
charter documents.
Corporate governance as such is not necessary. Many advocates
of corporate governance argue for reforms directed toward compelling
an owner orientation, usually described as aligning management
and shareholder interests or enhancing board oversight of CEO performance.
If a company needs these mechanisms to create an owner
Rules and Trust 197
orientation, however, its valuation should be discounted proportionally.
Most corporate governance reforms fail to solve governance
problems, and some exacerbate them. Nevertheless, institutional investors
and other shareholder advocates have promulgated a variety
of policies about corporate governance, most of which are designed
to promote an owner orientation. But just as fads infect finance,
they gum up governance too.
Perhaps the most popular governance idea in the past couple of
decades has been the call for independent boards of directors. The
National Association of Corporate Directors (NACD) and many institutional
investors including CalPers and TIAA-CREF, urged that
corporate boards be composed of at least a majority of outside directors,
those without employment or other affiliation with the corporation.
The idea was that this would strengthen directorial spines
to keep management in check. Nearly all major companies fell into
line, with 90% of Fortune 1000 companies having a majority of independent
directors.
These arguments were made on the basis of intuition, however,
rather than analysis. It was as if there were little or no doubt that
managers needed to be kept in line and that director watchdogs
could do the trick. This premise has been exploded by several studies
showing that far from independent boards enhancing economic performance,
there is actually a negative correlation between the degree
of independence and financial results.3
This is not to say that having some or many independent directors
is never desirable (Buffett, for example, believes that most directors
should be outsiders),4 but there is no reason to give credit
ipso facto to a company just because it does this. The unanswered
commonsense questions are: (1) Who are these independent directors?
and (2) What value do they add to the boardroom? Independent
directors famous for international diplomacy or senatorial jobbery
may be far worse to have at the table than a chief financial officer
with extensive industry and managerial experience. A template that
calls for independence is not a virtue but a mirage.
The key is to choose directors for their business savvy, interest
in the job, and owner orientation. To be avoided are celebrity directors
and others who are chosen for nonfundamental reasons, such
as adding diversity or prominence to a board.
Another popular move some companies fell for was the push to
split the functions of the company’s CEO from those of its board
198 In Managers We Trust
chairman. This manifested the same rationale of independence prescriptions,
a need to checkthe boardroom power of the CEO. Only
about 5% of Fortune 1000 companies succumbed to this formula,
probably with good reason.
As an empirical matter, as with board independence, most evidence
shows that companies that split these functions do not perform
better than those which do not.5 As an abstract matter, it is
hard to justify giving a company governance credit for this separation
of function, for putting a watchdog on the CEO suggests as many reasons
to be suspicious of the CEO as reasons to trust him. For a company
whose CEO is not to be trusted, this may be a good step, but
it sounds more like probation than probity and is a strong warning
signal for investors to run from rather than embrace the business.
Only a fool, after all, thinks trust can be purchased or structured.
One aspect of this reform makes sense, however, and many companies
adopted a version of it by providing for a nonexecutive board
chair for critical functions such as CEO, board, and director evaluations.
After all, letting the CEO grade herself and her board does
pose a riskof self-delusion. An independent grader is in a better
position to evaluate performance objectively, and so some governance
credit is justified for a company that takes this step.
Director independence is frequently encouraged for some committees
and often required for audit committees. Audit committee
independence is consistent with the structure of U.S. audit practice
that requires an auditing firm to be independent of the company and
its management. Independence on compensation committees reflects
the logic of a nonexecutive overseer for key functions such as
CEO and board performance review.
However, the argument for requiring independence on other
committees, such as nominating, ethics, and governance, is the same
as that for independence overall. If a corporation needs those kinds
of things, it has problems anyway. The mere fact that a corporation
has various independent board committees does not guarantee that
problems arising from collusion or delusion will be absent or disappear.
Periodic and formal evaluations of the CEO and other directors
are often recommended and do seem sensible and worthy of praise.
To deserve credit, however, the CEO reviews should be conducted
outside the presence of the CEO, something that is not easily or
commonly done. A more general way to implement this practice is
to supplement such periodic reviews with regular director meetings
Rules and Trust 199
outside the CEO’s presence, a practice Buffett in particular champions.
This is creditworthy not so much under the logic of suspicion
of the CEO but as an independent checkon the CEO’s judgment.
Some gobbledygookabout improved board processes is commonly
bandied about. This is usually sheer nonsense or gloss. Requirements
such as swift flows of quality information, statements of
governance principles, and procedures for full and effective participation
of all directors seem like mere bafflegab. These practices
should simply be part of the normal operation of a well-governed
corporation. Giving credit for the articulation of these practices is
superfluous—like giving umpires extra credit for knowing the rules
of baseball.
Other common and strange prescriptions take pages from the
equally silly playbookof American politics. Term limits for directors?
Why should a good director be forbidden from continuing in his job
just because he’s done it for a specified period of time? Age limits?
Nearly 40% of Fortune 1000 companies adopted age limits in response
to urgings from governance poobahs such as CalPers.
But a company that forbids persons older than, say, 65 or 70 is
ordaining the exclusion of talent from its reach. One can applaud
JackBogle for stepping down as Vanguard’s chairman at the fund’s
mandated retirement age of 70, but is Vanguard really better off
without Jackor any other (old!) sagacious person with integrity? And
what should it matter—on its own terms—that 5 of the 18 members
of Disney’s board are in their seventies, if those people are savvy
business leaders who seekto promote the interests of Disney’s owners?
At the other end of the politically correct scale of corporate governance
is the goal of trying to add diversity of gender or race to the
board. Diversity itself is not a laudable business goal and is nothing
for which credit should be given to the leaders of a business organization.
It is just as out of place, silly, and off the markas deliberately
creating and maintaining a diversified portfolio of stocks. It
may turn out to be fine and dandy, but if so, that is a consequence
and not a cause of a more prudent disposition that focuses on fundamentals
rather than frames. It does not matter one way or the
other that GE’s board has two women and one blackperson on it
though it does matter that those people and GE’s other directors are
outstanding business thinkers with a strong owner orientation.
The problem with all these sorts of proposals is their universality.
What is good for GM may not be good for GE, and what is good for
200 In Managers We Trust
either of them may not be good for Procter & Gamble or eBay, Wrigley,
or Hershey. Each corporate situation justifies and calls for its
own governance structure and analysis. Broad credit can be given
only for governance moves that have some inherently defensible
logic, such as having the board review the CEO’s performance without
her being present and having independence on the audit committee.
Beyond that, these general principles are of little use. Indeed,
too much emphasis on them can be affirmatively misleading. You
can put all the governance bells and whistles you want on a board,
but if its CEO or other strong leaders lackintegrity , you can be sure
they will neither ring nor blow.
GENERAL GOVERNANCE
While one-size-fits-all recipes of corporate governance are inapt, a
few areas justify generalizations. The most important is that active
boards engaged with the companies they serve boost corporate performance.
That is plain common sense, though empirical studies
confirm the intuition.6
A key problem in all governance structures is the size of the
board. You do need a minimum number of directors to generate the
kind of thoughtful deliberateness that characterizes any effective
group of people. But above that number—which is probably as low
as six—the larger the board is, the less manageable it is. Lean is
mean in business, and there is no question that ideas and energy
move more quickly through leaner managerial structures, as Wal-
Mart proved to Sears and GE proved to Westinghouse. Smaller
boards often translate into leaner management teams down the
ranks.
A similar problem is the number of other boards on which individual
directors serve. The more duties a given director undertakes
in various companies, the less effective she is likely to be on each
one. A director’s concurrent experience on two boards may add value
to both. Former U.S. Senator Sam Nunn serves on the boards of a
half dozen public companies (including GE, Coke, and Texaco), for
example, and his workon one may benefit the needs of the others.
But how effective is a director who serves on a dozen boards at once?
Vernon Jordan serves on nearly that many and has been criticized
for doing so. It would be a rare person whose prominence and trustRules
and Trust 201
worthiness, not to mention access to the corridors of power, could
remain valuable to a company that shares her service with so many
others.
A final point all corporations should worry about is who is next
in line for the top spot. It may not be necessary for a company to
have a formal succession plan for its CEO, but it is important for
the board to give it some thought. The trouble is that even the best
laid plan can go awry and sometimes the most surprising and unplanned
succession can have terrific benefits. Succession is a matter
of judgment, and just because a board has thought hard about it,
that doesn’t mean its plan will work(more on this in the next chapter).
All these details of corporate governance provide clues about
managerial trustworthiness. A board filled with close personal
friends of the CEO who lacksolid business backgrounds is a red
flag of caution. A board that fails to review the chief’s performance
regularly may not be trustworthy either. Take another area of corporate
life: charitable giving. If most of the corporation’s charitable
contributions go to pet causes of the CEO, maybe you should wonder
whether he treats the corporation more as his than as yours.
Unique among major American corporations, Berkshire Hathaway
rejects managerial direction of discretionary charitable giving, putting
this power directly in the hands of shareholders.7
If these factors indicate high trustworthiness, lower your discount
rate on a good business; if they suggest moderate trustworthiness,
raise it upward. (If they suggest an antiowner orientation,
simply stay away.)
Amid the intense interest in corporate governance there generally
emerges the subtopic of corporate governance for Internet companies.
Some argue that the traditional templates of corporate governance
simply do not apply to new economy companies. It is hard
to see exactly why, but the argument seems to be that the speed of
industry change, the intensity of competition, the shortage of
technology-savvy managers, and the importance of stockoptions in
compensation packages mean that the new economy cannot abide
the old rules and ways.8
These arguments are silly. On their face, they state very little
difference in the problems of governing a new economy company
versus an old economy company. Change, competition, managerial
savvy, and incentive compensation matter in all businesses. A better
202 In Managers We Trust
argument would relate these different sorts of companies to their
respective average sizes. Smaller companies may need or warrant less
in the way of formal governance (such as board review of director
performance) than do larger companies. But that argument relates
to the dot-com governance debate only to the extent that dot-coms
are on average smaller than non-dot-coms, something that may or
may not be true and so is ultimately irrelevant.
The key issue for any kind of business also remains the same,
whether new economy, old economy, future economy, or whatever.
It is what constitutes good governance, and the answer varies with
company specifics, including potentially to which category a company
belongs. Just as a one-size-fits-all governance template is inappropriate
for the run of non-dot-com companies, it is inappropriate
for dot-coms.
In fairness to the advocates of new governance rules for new
economy companies, they were forced into this strange stance (that
dot-coms as a group were both alike and special) because governance
gurus had so whipsawed old economy companies into governance
uniformity that prevailing governance practices did not make sense
for many dot-coms (for the same reasons they never made sense for
many old economy companies).
It is therefore a colossal waste of time even to discuss whether
governance principles should be different. Of course they should,
but not because of anything special about dot-coms as such but
instead because every business organization is special.
YOUR VOICE ATT HE TABLE
Persuading boards to listen to shareholders is an ideal corporate governance
method, but legal and practical limits frustrate this simple
vehicle. Apathy and collective action problems limit the shareholders’
voice, but this explains only part of the problem.
Most state laws authorize corporations to establish procedures
governing shareholder proposals at annual or special meetings. The
SEC imposes additional rules.9 As a matter of practice, management
on average strongly prefers rules that enable it to omit shareholder
proposals from proxy statements.
Using the “shareholder proposal rule” has led to substantial policy
changes at many major corporations. For example, beginning in
Rules and Trust 203
the 1930s, this rule was used to enhance shareholder rights in areas
such as cumulative voting and dissemination of postmeeting reports.
Virtually anyone can satisfy the eligibility requirements for compelling
a corporation to include a shareholder proposal in the corporation’s
annual proxy statement. By law it is enough to own 1% or
$1,000 in market value of the corporation’s equity for one year, and
the costs of making proposals are borne by the company.
Shareholder proposals are often made by only nominal shareholders,
spearheaded by nonshareholder constituencies that harness
the shareholder proposal rule to effect social change. (This use exploded
in the 1970s, with the famous Campaign GM that led to the
integration of GM’s board of directors.) Social policy advocates use
it to promote things such as reporting requirements concerning the
environmental impact of corporate actions, race and sex discrimination,
and human rights activities. Sometimes these are in the interests
of shareholders, and sometimes they are not.
In the last few decades shareholders and other constituencies
have employed this device innumerable times. Although most campaigns
do not carry a majority vote, increasing numbers of proposals
win. But because everyone knows nominal shareholders can make
proposals, management can take lightly even proposals that win the
support of a majority of shareholders. Thus management often opts
not to implement a winning proposal. After all, if management believes
in the proposal, it will adopt it without waiting for a constituency
initiative or vote.
More important than the shareholder proposal rule is the possibility
of a corporate takeover. This can be effected either by proxy
contest or by tender offer. In a proxy contest, the more traditional
method of corporate takeover, a shareholder or group of shareholders
appeals to other shareholders to change control of the company by
electing new directors to the board. They argue their case in a proxy
statement delivered to all shareholders, and the incumbent group
presents its case in its own proxy statement. The shareholders vote,
and their voice is heard.
Before the late 1960s and early 1970s, Ben Graham lamented the
difficulty shareholders faced in changing poor management in this
way. (Graham knew firsthand about those difficulties, for he waged
a proxy contest to wrest control of a company earlier in his career.)10
But proxy contests became far easier to wage and more effective in
that time, signaling the dawn of the corporate governance movement
that tookfirm hold in the 1980s. As a consequence of the rise in
204 In Managers We Trust
proxy contests in the late 1960s and early 1970s, Graham said that
“boards of directors have probably become more alive than previously
to their fundamental duty to see that their company has a
satisfactory top management.”
The 1980s brought more sophisticated and better-funded takeover
tactics to corporate America, chiefly the tender offer, by which
shareholders simply exit a company with unsatisfactory management
and performance. The result has been the creation of a market for
control of corporations, a way to give real meaning to the shareholders’
voice. Thus, Graham’s plea made at the dawn of the corporate
governance era assumes greater value now: “that stockholders
consider with an open mind and with careful attention any proxy
material sent them by fellow stockholders who want to remedy an
obviously unsatisfactory management situation in the company.”11
205
C h a p t e r 1 3
DIRECTORS AT
WORK
An increasingly common lament sung across corporate America
is that directors are overworked. They are asked to do too much,
must satisfy too many competing interests, and so on. There is a
simple and sufficient solution to this condition. Directors should be
asked to do a short list of five things and do them well. The key jobs
entrusted to any board of directors are as follows:
• Selecting an effective chief executive
• Setting executive compensation
• Evaluating takeovers
• Allocating capital
• Promoting integrity in financial reporting
Effective performance of these jobs ultimately depends not so
much on governance mechanisms as on board trustworthiness. An
investor should pay attention to how well directors perform these
tasks as a way to gauge where along the continuum from owner
orientation to manager orientation they sit. A management-oriented
position is suggested by fat executive paychecks for a dismal performance.
A stakeholder-oriented position reveals itself in poor returns
on invested capital that keep unproductive plants operating in a bow
to labor pressure. An owner orientation is reflected by good performance,
reasonable executive pay, and the cultivation of productive
workers in productive jobs.
As a management orientation example, askyourself whose interests
were really going to be served by AMP’s resistance to Allied-
Signal’s bid discussed in Chapter 11? AMP’s shareholders objected,
and so they obviously thought their interests were being disserved,
and AMP’s plan to boost the company’s profitability included cutting
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
206 In Managers We Trust
the workforce by about 9%, or 4200 jobs, and closing ten factories.1
AMP’s board ultimately may have served the corporation’s interests
in concluding a deal with a friendly partner, but AMP’s CEO and
management undoubtedly pressured the board to resist what by all
accounts looked good for shareholders in favor of something that
looked bad for the workers.
The best way to tell where a company sits is to investigate the
way its directors tackle their key jobs. Focus on those jobs and decide
which boards do them well.
HAIL TO THE CHIEF
The CEO sets the tone at the top. The CEO’s historical performance
on matters such as compensation, acquisitions, and capital allocation
generally is the key question an investor should ask when judging
a CEO and deciding whether to entrust wealth to his or her
management. Special attention must be paid to selecting a CEO
because of his or her unique role in the organization.
Warren Buffett notes that standards for measuring a CEO’s performance
are either inadequate or easy to manipulate, and so a
CEO’s performance is harder to measure than that of most workers.
The CEO has no senior other than in theory the company’s board
of directors. That board is often handicapped in its performance
review, however, because of a lackof measurement standards and
because as meetings come and go, the relationship between the CEO
and the directors increasingly becomes congenial rather than supervisory.
Maintaining that supervisory attitude is critical. The board’s role
in reviewing the CEO’s performance is most acute precisely where
it can be most easily impaired: dealing with a mediocre manager. It
is easy for a board to get rid of a terrible manager; the hard case is
a so-so one. Recruiting the top talent and a roster of succession
candidates is a critical board function. Too often the importance of
this role is overlooked, as occurs when a board simply replaces an
outgoing CEO with the number two fellow at the company (which
happens about two-thirds of the time). This means that many boards
fail to evaluate changing organizational needs and variations in the
personal talents of the two at the top.2
Abdication of a board’s responsibility for CEO selection is most
clear when a board simply allows an incumbent CEO to handpick
Directors at Work 207
the successor. There is little reason to believe that even the most
outstanding CEO is as good as a top board at picking a new CEO.
The result is too often the need to oust the new CEO pretty early
in his or her tenure.
Still, boards must evaluate a CEO’s performance regularly and
out of the CEO’s presence, and evaluating that performance is harder
than it seems. Both short-term results and potential long-term
results must be assessed. If only short-term results mattered, many
managerial decisions would be much easier, particularly those relating
to businesses whose economic characteristics have eroded.
Recall again Al Dunlap’s aggressive and doomed plan to turn
around the ailing Sunbeam. The huge accounting scandal that followed
in its wake also suggests its inherent stupidity. Once it was
clear that Dunlap was a terrible manager, it was easy for the Sunbeam
board to throw him out, but before the fallout he looked at
worst mediocre and therefore harder to disagree with.
PAY
Plenty of evidence shows that the total level of executive compensation
in the United States is positively correlated with the level of
corporate performance. Some evidence even shows a positive correlation
between performance and the portion of total compensation
paid in stock.3
Even so, it is also obvious that some executives are paid substantially
more than they should be in light of their performance.
Accordingly, investors should pay close attention to potentially piratical
executive compensation.
Compensation Levels
This is not to say that it is desirable to have governance rules that
limit top executive compensation to some ratio of the pay of the
least compensated employee at a company. Indeed, Ben & Jerry’s
tried this during its early years of business life, capping its founder’s
and chief’s compensation at seven times that of the lowest-paid
worker. But once the company outgrew its founder’s managerial
skills, it was forced to go on the market to recruit top talent, and
that required a pay package way higher than that cap.4
208 In Managers We Trust
If the early Ben & Jerry’s policy showed bad judgment, some of
the pay packages seen lately show something far worse. The CEO
of NetworkAssociates (owner of the McAfee computer antivirus programs),
for example, got about $7 million in shares of McAfee.com
just ahead of its IPO even though the business of NetworkAssociates
performed poorly and McAfee itself was losing money.5
A key issue in the merger between Chrysler and Daimler-Benz
was the enormous difference between the two companies both in
the level of executive compensation and in the compensation ratios
of the highest-paid and lowest-paid employees. In 1997, for example,
Robert Eaton, Chrysler’s chairman of the board, received total compensation
of about $10 million, over 200 times the average worker’s
pay and nearly as much as the total compensation paid to all ten
members of Daimler-Benz’s management board combined. Daimler-
Benz’s chairman, Jurgen Schrempp, was paid about one-tenth as
much as Eaton, making his compensation approximately twenty
times that of the average Daimler-Benz worker.
Thus, a major question in the merger was the form that the
combined entity’s compensation structure should take. Schrempp
pointed out that the existing pay differences reflected cultural differences,
particularly the somewhat more egalitarian corporate culture
in Germany, as demonstrated by labor representation on supervisory
boards. He also predicted that the U.S. model would prove to
be the proper form for DaimlerChrysler and other transnational
companies, except that “the only way to make big pay packets socially
acceptable is by linking them closely to performance.”6
Schrempp’s statement mirrors the rhetoric of corporate America.
Given that the other differences in corporate governance between
Germany and the United States are more nuanced and subtle than
is generally understood, you have to wonder if this was Schrempp’s
main point when he said that DaimlerChrysler created “the first
German company with a North American culture.” Any doubt was
cleared up when Schrempp subsequently proselytized for Americanstyle
executive options at DaimlerChrysler’s April 2000 shareholder
meeting, something his German shareholders sensibly resisted.
Stock Options
A decade ago corporate governance mavens urged boards to pay
managers more in stockthan in cash to promote an alignment of
interests between managers and shareholders. The response was treDirectors
at Work 209
mendous, a bit like the apocryphal story of Lady Astor’s famous quip
on the Titanic: “I asked for ice, but this is ridiculous.”
What the governance gurus got was a proliferation of payment
not in stockthat was the functional equivalent of the forgone cash
but instead stockoptions with a value vastly exceeding what the cash
payment could reasonably have been. The explosion of option-based
compensation remains one of the most controversial subjects in corporate
governance history.
Some say that the widespread use of stockoptions in the United
States simply reflects the priority given to this alignment goal in the
United States and that its relative infrequency in Europe and elsewhere
reflects the absence or irrelevance of this goal. However, the
talkof alignment is more myth than truth and too often represents
an attempt to sanitize management compensation packages that conflict
with shareholder interests (not to mention labor interests).
Stock Option Myths
No evidence indicates that the prevailing structure of executive compensation
in the United States comes anywhere close to aligning
manager and shareholder interests. On the contrary, a great deal of
evidence demonstrates that the compensation structure is random.
Many corporations give their managers stockoptions which increase
in value simply through earnings retention, rather than because
of improved performance resulting from superior deployment
of capital. By retaining and reinvesting net income, managers can
report annual earnings increases without doing anything to improve
real returns on capital.
Buffett makes the point: “You can get the same result personally
while operating from your rocking chair. Just quadruple the capital
you commit to a savings account and you will quadruple your earnings.
You would hardly expect hosannas for that particular accomplishment.”
7
When that happens, stockoptions rob the corporation and its
shareholders of wealth and allocate the booty to the optionees. Indeed,
once granted, stockoptions are often irrevocable and unconditional
and benefit the grantees without regard to individual performance—
a form of instant robbery.
Even if stockoptions encourage optionees to thinkas shareholders
would, optionees are not exposed to the same downside risks
as shareholders are. If economic performance improves and the
210 In Managers We Trust
stockprice rises above the exercise price, the optionees will exercise
the option and share in the increase with shareholders. But if economic
performance is unfavorable and the stockprice remains below
the exercise price, optionees simply will not exercise the option.
Shareholders suffer from the corporation’s unfavorable performance,
but an option holder does not.
These awards also exacerbate the misalignment of interests between
corporate option holders (usually senior executives) and other
workers. The awards dramatically increase the compensation differential
between highly paid executives and ordinary laborers, a ratio
which is significantly higher in the United States than it is in Europe
and elsewhere. Accordingly, when stockoptions are used, they
should be spread throughout the employee base—as GE has done—
rather than limited to the top dogs.
Stock Option Costs
The direct cost to shareholders of stockoption compensation is the
dilution of their ownership interest. A common managerial response
to the dilution is to buy backoutstanding shares. The trouble with
that solution is that it devours corporate funds that might be more
profitably deployed.
Shocking indirect costs are accounting rules that fail to require
employee stockoptions to be recorded as an expense on the income
statement.8 This translates into earnings per share figures that overstate
actual earnings for companies with executive stockoptions outstanding.
Even the diluted earnings per share figure does not reflect
these costs.
Accordingly, you must adjust earnings figures for the cost of options.
Doing this is not easy, however, for not all information is necessarily
found in the financial statements. You need to examine the
footnotes for something called overhang, which is the percentage of
the company that outstanding stockoptions would represent if they
were exercised. The average percentage has mushroomed from under
10% a few years ago to nearly 15% now.
Still, the actual cost of options is not presented directly, though
there is some footnote disclosure about this. The real cost equals
the price at the time of exercise minus the amount the executive
pays (the exercise price). This is the truest measure of cost because
the company could have generated that much by selling the optioned
shares to others at the prevalent price instead of at the option price.
The cost of executive stockoptions is substantial, averaging
Directors at Work 211
about 5% of annual earnings among S&P 500 companies and in
some cases amounting to half of reported earnings, including at Yahoo!,
Polaroid, and Palm.9 In less dramatic but still striking examples,
if stockoptions were recorded as a cost, the 1999 earnings of
some major companies would be slashed: Cisco, 24%; Microsoft,
12%; IBM, 8%; and Oracle, 16%.10
These cost effects extend for many years, depending on the life
of the options. At many companies, options have a life of five years.
Increasingly, companies extend their lives to as long as 10 and 15
years.
Accountability
Legal rules are ill equipped to police executive compensation. The
general stance of U.S. courts is to evaluate compensation issues, if
at all, under a waste standard. This standard rarely upsets corporate
decisions. Waste requires pretty much the irrational trashing of corporate
assets in ways akin to dumping truckloads of cash into the
Hudson River. In the case of executive compensation, U.S. courts
are quite deferential to management indeed.
As for securities disclosure laws, the SEC requires substantial
and focused disclosure of top executive compensation in comparative
performance charts. Nevertheless, corporations continue to
structure executive compensation packages so that they don’t show
up in the bottom-line numbers. For example, after accounting standard
setters ruled that a reduction in the exercise price of a previously
issued option had to be recorded as an expense on the income
statement, many companies chose instead to extend the life of the
option.
Without effective legal or accounting regulations, the chief job
of policing executive compensation lies with the corporate board.
Board members must insist that executive compensation peg individual
contributions to corporate performance. Measuring executive
performance by business profitability is the most definitive yardstick
with regard to shareholder as well as labor interests. When measuring
performance, companies should reduce earnings by the capital
employed in the relevant business or by the earnings the firm retains.
Caveat
While Warren Buffett tends to share these criticisms of stockoption
compensation packages, he is careful to record the following caveat:
212 In Managers We Trust
Some managers whom I admire enormously—and whose operating
records are far better than mine—disagree with me regarding
fixed-price options. They have built corporate cultures
that work, and fixed-price options have been a tool that helped
them. By their leadership and example, and by the use of options
as incentives, these managers have taught their colleagues to
thinklik e owners. Such a culture is rare and when it exists
should perhaps be left intact—despite inefficiencies and inequities
that may infest the option program.11
Investors should lookfor boards that take the lead in policing
stockoption compensation, but beware—they are scarce.
DEALS
Just as the disease of random executive compensation must be
avoided by intelligent investors and trustworthy boards, so must the
costs of imprudent acquisition policies and defensive tactics.
Offensive
Offensive acquisition strategies require careful board attention because
of the strong possibility that even outstanding senior managers
possess individual interests that conflict with owner interests. Acquisitions
give CEOs enormous psychological benefits by expanding
their dominion and generating more action. Acquisitions driven by
these sorts of impulses come at shareholder expense.
Most acquisitions do not achieve gains in business value. A 1999
study by the global accounting firm KPMG concluded that “83% of
mergers [during the period 1996–1998, when trillions had been paid
in merger deals] failed to produce any benefits for shareholders and,
even more alarming, over half actually destroyed value.” That study
also found, based on interviews with managers involved in mergers,
that less than half did any postdeal review to test whether value was
added or subtracted!12
A governance problem exists because most acquisition attempts
do not come to the board for discussion until the process is substantially
under way and until after the CEO has invested substantial
personal capital in them. Rejecting an acquisition proposal after the
CEO invests substantial personal capital is often considered a rejection
of the CEO who presented the proposal to the board. This problem
is especially acute among CEOs who resent hearing bad news.
Directors at Work 213
Cascades of stupid acquisitions come pouring in, often drowning the
board’s better judgment.
These timing problems make it difficult to design a governance
mechanism that would alleviate this pressure on the board. The ego
problems are just as intractable, as another Buffettism suggests:
“While deals often fail in practice, they never fail in projections—if
the CEO is visibly panting over a prospective acquisition, subordinates
and consultants will supply the requisite projections to rationalize
any price.”13
Mattel, for example, is a worldwide leader in the design, manufacture,
and distribution of toys. In May 1999 it bought the Learning
Company, a producer of educational software for personal computers.
Mattel paid for the $3.8 billion purchase by using Mattel
stockat a time when the stockwas trading at about $26 a share
(down already from an average trading price over the prior year of
around $40). Mattel’s chair, Jill Barad, announced in July 1999 that
the Learning Company was contributing to Mattel’s overall operations
with “exceptionally strong growth” in revenues and margins and
said this “was one of the reasons this merger made so much sense
for Mattel.”14
Barad did not say how the computer software business related
to Mattel’s traditional products, such as Barbie dolls, Fisher-Price
toys, and Hot Wheels. But just three months later, in October
1999, Mattel announced that the Learning Company division’s revenues
had declined and it had lost money because of, among other
things, higher than expected product returns from customers and
write-offs of bad debts.15 Instead of earning $50 million that quarter
as Barad estimated, it lost over $100 million, and Mattel’s stock
plummeted to about $11 a share. Many analysts, at least in hindsight,
reported that these problems at the Learning Company were
not new and should have been uncovered and discounted before
Mattel bought it.
These analysts also thought that Mattel fit the description of a
company about to make a bad acquisition. If sales growth in your
core business is declining and you can’t seem to do anything about
it through product, marketing, or distribution improvements, one
impulse is to buy yourself some growth through an acquisition. Mattel’s
sales growth, incidentally, was declining in its core products
right before the Learning Company acquisition. So too, for that matter,
was the Learning Company’s. (Mattel’s board ousted Barad in
early 2000, awarding her an exorbitant severance package, and replaced
her with Kraft Foods CEO Robert Eckert.)
214 In Managers We Trust
Contrast Mattel’s story with the policies of Disney. Disney’s
philosophy is to make only acquisitions that are in a related or
complementary field that current management understands fully,
and at a fair price. In its most important acquisition, Capital Cities
ABC fit the bill. Disney’s long-time chairman, Michael Eisner, had
worked at ABC from 1966 through 1976 and had seen it grow from
a networkcritics called the “fourth of three” to first place in every
category.
After Capital Cities bought ABC in 1986, Tom Murphy and Dan
Burke catapulted it to yet new heights, and the combination with
Disney made sense. Walt Disney himself liked ABC as well. After
all, ABC helped finance Disneyland in 1955, and Walt brought ABC
to Hollywood when he began what is now The Wonderful World of
Disney. Disney’s Internet business benefited enormously from the
addition of ABC.com, ESPN.com, and a host of cable assets that
enable important growth opportunities.
Defensive
Takeover defenses are the flip side of offensive acquisition strategies.
Antitakeover devices such as the poison pill protect management’s
decision making by discouraging attempts to acquire the corporation
or remove incumbent directors (as AMP’s defense against Allied-
Signal attests). If some or a majority of stockholders deem a takeover
attempt to be in the corporation’s and their best interest and the
potential acquirer is willing to pay a premium over the prevailing
market price or intrinsic value of the corporation’s common stock,
antitakeover devices work against shareholders.
Disney’s acquisition philosophy is also illustrative on this side of
the table. Corporate raiders of the early 1980s sought to acquire
Disney and bust it up but Roy Disney would not let that happen.
He preserved Disney as a great American institution and facilitated
a recommitment to the fundamental businesses that had made it
great. Disney animation, for example, with Roy at the helm, reinvented
itself and surged with a long series of critically and popularly
acclaimed films. In doing so, Disney adopted the best takeover defense
strategy there is: an extraordinary business. (More on Disney
in the next chapter.)
To be sure, situations exist in which hostile offers are inadequate
and not in the interests of the corporation or any of its constituents.
Yet incumbent managers facing unwanted takeover talks naturally
Directors at Work 215
will resist the efforts of the acquiring firm whether or not their resistance
best serves the corporation. After all, in most cases their
jobs are at risk.
Within U.S. corporations—and probably increasingly within corporations
organized elsewhere—takeovers put unmatured stock options
at risk. Faced with this prospect, managers may employ mechanisms
designed to resist inferior bids in an effort to resist superior
bids. They thus may use a poison pill against a bid that is great for
shareholders when it should be used only to deter bids that are bad
for shareholders.
In these situations, boards must recognize that CEOs and their
troops are under fire, just as they are when a board challenges one
of their proposed offensive acquisitions.
In both situations boards should expect managers to adopt a
siege mentality which obscures honest thinking about what is in the
owners’ interests. In both offensive and defensive situations there is
no clear mechanism that can assure that boards will respond properly,
but boards must at least recognize what is happening psychologically
in these situations if they hope to respond effectively at all.
For investors, identifying directors with that capacity is key.
CAPITAL
A company generating substantial amounts of excess cash can deploy
it in one of four ways. It can reinvest in the business, repurchase its
own shares, distribute the cash in dividends to shareholders, and, as
was just noted, make acquisitions.
Aside from a few formal and manipulable limits, U.S. law gives
boards of directors unbridled discretion in the choice of these uses,
including declaring and paying dividends and making or not making
repurchases. Corporate charters rarely restrict dividend policies, although
a corporation’s loan and credit agreements sometimes do.
The policy of most U.S. boards is to pay regular quarterly cash
dividends at a stable or steadily increasing dollar amount. This pattern
is inconsistent with the reality that underlying business performance
is hardly ever that smooth. Earnings are almost always bumpy
(even if less bumpy than average stockprices).
Dividends tend to be way higher than they should be. Given the
importance of dividend policy in capital allocation decisions, certain
common reasons that boards use to justify their policies, such as
216 In Managers We Trust
signaling confidence and giving the appearance of reliability, are either
strange or disingenuous.
We should give credit to boards that use a more rigorous approach
for setting dividend policy, an ideal set forth by Warren Buffett.
The test distinguishes between restricted earnings, those which
must be reinvested in a business just to maintain its competitive
position, and unrestricted earnings, which should be retained only
when there is a reasonable prospect that for every dollar retained,
at least one dollar of market value will be created for shareholders;
otherwise, the dollar of earnings should be paid out.16 Microsoft follows
this policy pretty well, never having paid a dividend and generating
great returns on the reinvested capital.
Boards can justify retaining earnings under this test only if the
capital retained produces incremental earnings at least equal to the
return generally available to the shareholders. For companies that
can reinvest earnings in this manner, dividends should not be paid
and boards should ignore any negative signals this policy sends, such
as lackof confidence or unreliability (though they should pay attention
to the resulting tax advantages to shareholders).
The smartest thing a company can do with undervalued stockis
to buy it back. Obviously, if a stock is selling in the market at half
its intrinsic value, the company can buy $2 in value by paying $1 in
cash. You rarely find better uses of capital than that. Stockrepur -
chases usually give a stockholder a slight tax advantage. Dividends
on common stockare taxed as ordinary income at rates as high as
39.6%, whereas income generated by the repurchase of stockheld
longer than a year is treated as capital gains at rates no higher than
20%.
Stockbuyback s are not always what they seem. They reduce the
number of a company’s shares outstanding, thus increasing earnings
per share. The typical result is that investors buy more of that stock
and thus bid the price up, mistakenly believing that the repurchases
are a managerial signal that the company’s stockis underpriced. Often,
however, the repurchase program is a cognate of a stockissuance
program to offset shares issued upon the exercise of stockoptions.
The increased stockprice, after all, means increasing the value
of stockoptions on that stock. When a repurchase program and an
issuance program are run simultaneously, you should be more discriminating
in your judgment of what management is doing.
It is possible that this effect could lead management (with many
stockoptions at its feet) to prefer buybacks even if that were not
Directors at Work 217
the smartest way to allocate the company’s capital. Indeed, options
create incentives to borrow money for stockrepurchases that boost
earnings per share and return on equity. That poses a major risk, as
a smaller equity base in a crisis can push a company closer to bankruptcy,
severely damaging shareholder interests (as well as the interests
of others).
In contrast to the occasional wisdom of stockrepurchases is the
universal folly of stocksplits. Stocksplits have three consequences,
none of them beneficial to the stockholders. They increase transaction
costs by promoting high share turnover; they attract shareholders
with short-term, market-oriented views who unduly focus on
stockmark et prices; and, as a result of both of those effects, they
lead to prices that depart materially from intrinsic business value.
With no offsetting benefits, splitting a stockis nonsense. Nevertheless,
most companies do it, including GE, Microsoft, and Amazon.
com. Berkshire Hathaway is one of the handful that don’t. After
going public in mid-1997, Amazon.com split its stockthree times
from June 1998 to September 1999! GE split its stockonly nine times
in its hundred-plus-year history, though three of those splits occurred
in the last six years of the 1990s.
The only meritorious argument favoring stocksplits is that they
reduce the per share price of stockand thus enable a wider investor
group to participate. If no U.S. company in history had ever split its
stock, the per share price of some of the best companies would be
in the tens of thousands of dollars (as is the case at Berkshire Hathaway,
for example). That price level is prohibitive for many investors.
This argument does not justify the high frequency of stocksplits,
however, which are used to keep prices below a couple of hundred
dollars—an amount that is affordable by all investors.
CHECKING UP
As Chapter 10 showed, for accounting information to be valuable,
users must have justifiable confidence in its integrity. Forces that
jeopardize integrity are often intractable: Business innovation, evolution,
and complexity, coupled with the formal nature of accounting
rules inevitably create a substantial zone of managerial discretion in
financial reporting.
Integrity in financial reporting is promoted through internal control
systems and by external auditor certifications, both of which can
218 In Managers We Trust
constrain managerial discretion somewhat. For these mechanisms to
be effective, however, the board of directors must assure that both
internal controls and external audits do this.
Internal financial reporting controls are designed to assure that
transactions are executed in accordance with management policy
and are recorded properly in the accounting records (and to assure
that assets are deployed only in accordance with management policy).
They range from daily journal entries that are reviewed regularly
by others, to periodic taking of inventory, to procedures for review
of judgments concerning depreciation, to the articulation and review
of riskmanagement policies. Some of these tools are required by
federal securities laws.
Within a corporation, both the board of directors and the managers
play a role in defining, implementing, and evaluating internal
controls. In principle, however, the chief and ultimate responsibility
for internal controls rests with the board of directors, both as a matter
of common sense and as a matter of policy. Boards have a comparative
informational advantage and greater motivation to police
managerial opportunism than managers do. This obligation entails
supervising the design of internal control systems and supporting
their administration.
The critical importance of internal controls to the integrity of
financial reporting is evidenced by the requirement that outside auditors
review them in connection with annual audits of a company’s
financial statements. This audit is intended to obtain objective assurance
that the financial statements are relevant and reliable, based
on a general review of the financial statements and the underlying
day-to-day records and periodic summaries on which they are based.
The audit is a monitoring mechanism that lends credibility to
the financial statements. For that credibility to be meaningful, however,
the auditor must workclosely with members of the board of
directors, and both the auditor and those directors must act with
diligence, independence, and awareness. Several challenges are
posed for a board and its audit committee.
First, an audit conducted by an independent firm does not
change the fact that a company’s management prepares the financial
statements and is responsible for them. The audit is a review of those
statements. The audit does not entail a review of every financial
transaction in which the company engaged during the period covered
by the financial statements. That is a practical impossibility for any
auditor and even more so for any audit committee. Businesses enDirectors
at Work 219
gage in huge numbers of financial transactions during the course of
the typical financial period, usually one year. Instead, audits are conducted
on a “test basis” by reviewing a sample of the hundreds or
thousands of transactions of a variety of kinds engaged in by the firm
over time.
Second, with respect to the detection of fraud, neither the auditor
nor the audit committee is always in a position to root it out.
This is the case principally because it is impossible for the audit to
include an examination of every single transaction in which a company
engaged or in which management says it engaged.
Third, the auditor must be independent of the company, a requirement
imposed by the canons of professional responsibility of
the auditing profession; so too must the members of the audit committee,
a requirement of stockexchange rules endorsed by the SEC.
Audits lacking impartial and objective professional judgment fail to
promote financial reporting integrity. At best, they end up functioning
as merely another type of internal control.
Audits are harmful if they carry a false appearance of independent
certification that induces undue reliance. Also, since effective
independent audits include testing internal controls, the integrity of
those systems is undermined by a nonobjective and potentially biased
audit that diminishes rather than enhances overall integrity.
Audit firm independence is a hot topic. The big global auditing
firms have expanded their businesses beyond the traditional audit
function to include consulting and other practices that could in
some circumstances compromise their ability to contribute integrity
to financial reporting. These firms have merged, restructured, or
been acquired by other corporations. Their clients and business are
evolving into more sophisticated, technologically advanced, and
transnational operations.
The SEC established the Independence Standards Board (ISB)
to address auditor independence issues,17 but it remains a principal
responsibility of the board of directors and its audit committee to
assure an independent financial review. Those in charge are accountable
for adopting a diligent and alert mind-set that lets them rigorously
assess the company’s internal controls, the testing of its
reported accounts, and the likelihood that what they see accountingwise
is what really happened businesswise.
The audit committee is the one place where independent directors
are called for, but independence is not as essential as expertise
in accounting and/or auditing, as the new stockexchange rules now
220 In Managers We Trust
require. That is a crucial step (though by no means a sufficient one)
in giving assurance that, in the words of the traditional SEC standard,
“a reasonable investor, knowing all relevant facts and circumstances,
would perceive an auditor as having neither mutual nor
conflicting interests with its audit client and as exercising objective
and impartial judgment on all issues brought to the auditor’s attention.”
Only then are financial statements worth analyzing. Auditing is
an area over which the board of directors must take control and
provide leadership. Boards that consistently do this deserve credit.
Those which do not should be penalized—and they should be penalized
long before the outside auditor gets around to blowing the
whistle, as shareholders of Rite-Aid discovered to their chagrin and
loss in late 1999, when its outside auditors resigned from their audit
engagement on the grounds that they could no longer trust management
to tell them the truth!
Important as the auditor, audit committee, and board are in their
key jobs, there remains one person holding the torch for investors—
the CEO. Buffett says:
The term “earnings” has a precise ring to it. And when an earnings
figure is accompanied by an unqualified auditor’s certificate,
a naive reader might thinkit comparable in certitude to p,
calculated to dozens of decimal places.
In reality, however, earnings can be as pliable as putty when
a charlatan heads the company reporting them. Eventually truth
will surface, but in the meantime a lot of money can change
hands. Indeed, some important American fortunes have been
created by the monetization of accounting mirages.18
Avoiding charlatans is even more important than identifying excellent
boards, so let’s move on to the corner suite.
221
C h a p t e r 1 4
THE FIRESIDE CEO
The legendary investor Phil Fisher described his scuttlebutt approach
to investing as requiring diligent investigation of management.
He boldly interviewed a company’s customers, suppliers,
and employees about the managers and also spoke to management
directly. The Fisher method is followed today by venture capitalists
but is prohibitive for most average investors, who cannot get out and
visit those folks or even talk to them.
Some reasonable substitutes are available, though. You can listen
in on the investor conference calls held by most companies on a
quarterly basis and chaired by the CEO (the dial-in numbers for
these calls are available from the company and from most brokerage
firms). You can also attend the periodic “road shows” that companies
take through your locality; they are particularly worthwhile when the
CEO is in tow (which isn’t always the case) and you can attend
annual meetings to get a bird’s-eye view of the chief. These and other
events are often available on the Internet as Webcasts.
You can also read the voluminous material written about the
CEOs of most companies and by the CEOs themselves. At the top
of the reading list for insight into the character and business orientation
of a CEO is his annual letters to shareholders. Most of
these are public relations documents, ghostwritten, stylized, and full
of puffery. No one is fooled by messages written in the promotions
department, but among the glossy, photograph-laden, chart-strewn
marketing materials are a handful of letters actually written by the
CEO. Those are the letters worth reading.
MASTER SERVANTS
The seven basic characteristics most widely cited by venture capitalists
as important to lookfor in managers are integrity, achieve-
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
222 In Managers We Trust
ment, energy, intelligence, knowledge, leadership, and creativity.1
Which of these is the most important?
Obviously, you want to avoid entrusting your wealth to a brilliant
crookor a trustworthy idiot. An above-average IQ and these other
traits are certainly assets, but your CEO need not be in the top 10%
in the world on all these scales (who is?).
You might be tempted to follow the line of Fred Schwed in Where
Are the Customers’ Yachts? who joked that he’d prefer a smart criminal
to an honest bonehead because at least with a writ and a cop
he’d collect from the thief whereas all he’d get from the bonehead
was a pathetic apology. Don’t do this.
Buffett repeatedly emphasizes that the one characteristic that
belongs on a pedestal is integrity. This means a CEO who thinks of
your interests first, one who has what Buffett calls an owner orientation.
CEOs reveal the degree of their owner orientation in their letters,
as described by the rules Warren Buffett sets for himself when
he writes his annual letter to Berkshire Hathaway shareholders: “to
tell you the business facts that we would want to know if our positions
were reversed. We owe you no less. . . . TheCEOwhomisleads
others in public may eventually mislead himself in private.”2 Apply
that standard in evaluating whether a CEO deserves your trust.
Everyone knows that Warren Buffett is an enormously successful
investor, but not everyone is aware that he is also an enormously
successful and owner-oriented manager. On this score, Buffett is to
business management what Ted Williams was to baseball. Both are
in classes by themselves, Ted constantly hitting near .400 and Warren
constantly writing lucid and candid reports of his successes and
failures at Berkshire Hathaway (compiled into the book The Essays
of Warren Buffett: Lessons for Corporate America).
While Buffett is in a class by himself, there are many runnersup,
and searching for them by reading CEO letters is a valuable and
often entertaining investing exercise. This chapter looks at what is
revealed by the letters of three leaders who display not only honesty,
the key characteristic you should seek in a CEO, but also in various
degrees achievement, energy, intelligence, knowledge, leadership,
and creativity.
ACTION
Few CEOs have affected corporate America as GE’s JackWelch has.3
By word and action since taking the helm at General Electric in
The Fireside CEO 223
1979, Welch has redefined major aspects of business management.
In his widely followed annual letters to GE shareholders, Welch articulates
a creative set of core operating elements and explains how
their practical applications produce a new kind of company that exploits
the vast resources of a large organization with the passion and
hunger usually associated with smaller companies, all within a corporate
culture committed to cultivating the best practices.
GE is one of the largest companies in the world. Welch transformed
it from a widely diverse set of 350 businesses and major
product lines into what he calls an “integrated, diversified company.”
Welch determined that GE’s strength from diversity could be real
only if each business was number one or two in its particular market.
Through a policy of “fixing, selling, or closing” businesses that
weren’t, Welch led GE to occupy a leadership position in the dozen
businesses it now operates. Those businesses are integrated as an
overall company through a boundaryless culture united by a shared
thirst for better ideas to workfaster and reach higher.
GE shareholders benefited enormously from this culture of
boundaryless and integrated diversity, enjoying average annual returns
on equity exceeding 24% during Welch’s stewardship. Hundreds
of thousands of GE employees also benefited through an enhanced
system of internal rewards and recognition that encourages
involvement. A large number of GE alumni moved on to lead other
businesses, including Larry Bossidy, former CEO of AlliedSignal and
coauthor with Welch of a number of his letters.
Ideas generated or adapted at GE were celebrated among other
businesses and leaders, for the concept of boundarylessness is taken
so literally at GE that it shares its ideas the world over. As Welch
notes, a key GE value is to treat resource allocation as a dynamic
process: “Sometimes a business benefits as a net importer of dollars,
ideas and talent while at other times the same business will be
called upon to be a net exporter for the benefit of the Company as
a whole.”
Accolades for GE flowed during Welch’s stewardship. Fortune
magazine named GE its “Most Admired Company in America” in
1998 and 1999, and The Financial Times named it “the World’s Most
Respected Company” in those two years. Time magazine upped the
ante, calling GE “the Company of the Century,” and a 1999 Business
Week survey said that GE boasted the best board of directors. As
Welch said in his 1999 letter, Thomas Edison would be pleased with
the company he founded over a century ago.
Welch’s letters not only contain a firsthand account of the de224
In Managers We Trust
velopment of GE’s unique culture but also reflect Welch’s imagination,
energy, and vision. They are a concrete exposition of the
values that pervade GE’s culture, how those values are implemented,
their fruits, and the qualities of leadership that make it all possible—
a great resource for the sophisticated investor as well as the intelligent
manager.
The Core Operating Elements
Welch envisions an organization without boundaries. Artificial walls
dividing parts of the inside of an organization are to be destroyed.
The entire enterprise is a team, and responsibility is shared. A culture
without boundaries renders impossible excuses such as “not
invented here,” a common way to evade responsibility. In this culture,
Welch created “a vast laboratory whose principal product is new
ideas.” Ideas generated in one place are transported to others.
External boundaries are also exploded in this corporate culture.
Employees engage with broader communities through volunteer
work, and the company participates in outreach programs. GE engages
its various constituents as part of its daily life, learning how
better to serve customers as well as coventurers, distributors, and
others. GE is happy to learn from its own but equally happy to adapt
ideas created by others, including suppliers and competitors.
Boundaries retard development, stifle creativity, and complicate
operations. Destroying boundaries enabled GE to flourish amid
Welch’s three other core operating elements: speed, stretch, and simplification.
Speed thrives on change. Teamworkenhances speed, enabling
substantial increases in measures of performance straight across a
business. For example, by diminishing the cycle from order to remittance,
speed enhances inventory turnover. For a company GE’s
size, every single-digit improvement in its inventory turnover produces
over a billion dollars in free cash for investment.
Speed’s “fun and excitement” facilitates stretch, the idea of always
setting outsized goals. The stretch philosophy says that if you
thinkyou can increase inventory turnover by one point in the next
cycle, set your goal at increasing it by two points. A boundaryless
culture is the key to a successful stretch philosophy because it emphasizes
that “the quality of effort toward achieving the ‘impossible’
is the ultimate measure” of performance.
Stretch reverses much of conventional practice and incentive
The Fireside CEO 225
structures in business. At many businesses, managers set targets and
are evaluated on the basis of whether they meet them. The incentive
is to set modest targets. In a stretch setting managers are encouraged
to set extraordinarily ambitious goals and are then evaluated according
to how they did in one period compared to how they did in the
prior period. In short, “performance is measured against how the
world turned out to be—how well a business anticipated change and
dealt with it—rather than against some ‘plan’ or internal number
negotiated a year earlier.”
Speed and stretch are complemented by the final core operating
element of a boundaryless environment: simplification. Complexity,
whether in business organization charts, communications, or goal
setting, impairs speed and stretch and is foreign to a boundaryless
culture. Simplicity breeds self-confidence, which is conveyed
through direct plans and straightforward speech, setting “big, clear
targets.” The clarity arising from simplicity has another big virtue:
It enhances speed. As Welch says, “simple messages travel faster,
simpler designs reach the market faster, and the elimination of clutter
allows faster decision making.”
The Implementing Practices
GE implements its core operating elements of speed, stretch, and
simplification to realize the fruits of these elements. The key to producing
those fruits is the concept of integrated diversity. It is the
strength a company generates from being number one or number
two in all its businesses and drawing on the resources of each business
to sustain or enhance its position in others.
Two steps were necessary to achieve integrated diversity at GE.
The first was to keep only the businesses that were number one or
two in their particular markets. Each business needs to be strong in
its own right. Then the collection of businesses produces “a critical
mass of competitive advantage.” To exploit that competitive advantage
in turn requires delayering the management structure, which
Welch achieved by dismantling the multiple layers of management
that had clogged the company in the earlier era. Delayering enhanced
productivity, making the aggregate of the parts far more powerful
than their mere sum.
Through a strategy called “Work-Out,” Welch sought and got
input from everyone in the company (and some people outside it).
Long before Perot and Clinton repopularized the town meeting con226
In Managers We Trust
cept in American politics, GE practiced it, getting ideas from those
closest to the particular problem. This technique not only is most
likely to generate the best solutions, it also builds self-confidence
through participation and counters insecurity by discouraging turf
battles, parochialism, and other impediments to speed and stretch.
Apart from these practices within the boundaryless culture,
Welch instilled a sense of the right sorts of managers for a thriving
enterprise. Four types of managers are defined. The first two are
easy: Type I believes in GE’s values and delivers (and sticks around),
whereas type II does neither (and doesn’t last long). Type III is a
believer but an erratic deliverer and usually gets another chance.
Type IV is the trickiest: He or she delivers short-term results but
does not believe in GE’s values. Instead of living and breathing boundaryless
values and energizing and exciting people to new heights of
creativity and productivity, this manager controls, oppresses, intimidates,
and squeezes people. Welch solved the type IV case by elevating
shared values above short-term results, and so these types
don’t last long at GE either.
GE’s system of rewards and recognition glues these managerial
qualities to GE’s values by reinforcing its boundaryless and speed/
stretch culture. Under Welch’s stewardship at GE, the number of
employees eligible for stockoptions soared from 400 to nearly
30,000. Speakers at big company meetings are selected not by their
title or rankbut on the basis of “what people know that can be
shared, borrowed, and expanded on.”
Finally, GE’s “360 degree” management appraisal calls for managers
to be evaluated not only by their superiors but also by
the people who workunder and alongside them. This evaluation
focuses GE’s leaders “on finding and rewarding people who demonstrated
an ability to get every mind in the organization into the
relentless search for ideas.”
Fruits of the Culture
Concrete results of the core operating elements implemented
through a strategy of integrated diversity and Work-Out include
those generated at GE’s Crotonville Institute management school
and those originating on shop floors throughout the company. Best
practices has become a model emulated throughout the world and
is a hallmarkof Welch’s GE. Crotonville is a wellspring of thought
on management and business, producing great ideas for decades and
The Fireside CEO 227
sharing them not only with GE businesses but with businesspeople
the world over.
Welch notes that “the intellectual underpinning of Work-Out
consists of ideas like worker involvement, trust and empowerment—
shopworn and even platitudinous concepts.” Yet he goes on to say
that at GE, “the difference is that our whole organization is, in fact,
living them, every day.” GE wields these “soft concepts” as real competitive
weapons in victorious battles, not merely “inscribing them
on coffee mugs and T-shirts.”
Crotonville, as Welch describes it, combines the “thirst for learning
of academia with an action environment usually seen only in
small, hungry companies.” Animating GE’s culture of ideas is a mode
of thought linked to the core operating elements of speed and stretch
called bullet-train thinking. Originated by the CEO of Yokogawa, this
metaphor signifies that if you want to increase a train’s speed by 10
mph, tinker with its horsepower; if you want to double it, break out
of conventional thinking and goal setting.
The fruits of the learning culture reinforce the core operating
elements by producing additional mechanisms. Consider two big
ideas embraced at GE that also exhibit the speed and stretch philosophy.
Co-location, Welch says, is the “ultimate boundaryless behavior.”
As “unsophisticated as can be,” it means conducting all the
functions for a product in one room without walls. All project participants
are simultaneously involved, including at the design stages
people from manufacturing and marketing as well as suppliers and
customers. Quick response is a cycle-time reduction technique that
similarly erases barriers between functions for a product. With colocation,
it vastly reduces average inventory and proportionately bolsters
inventory turnover.
Other fruits of this learning culture taken from outside GE help
implement the core operating elements. Demand Flow Technology
was borrowed from the GE customer American Standard to multiply
inventory turnover and move toward GE’s goal noted in an earlier
chapter of zero working capital. Quick Market Intelligence (QMI), a
strategy adapted from Wal-Mart to get direct customer feedback
weekly, “employs out-of-the-box thinking and cross-functional teams
dedicated to removing obstacles to cost reduction.” The Toshibaoriginated
idea of Half Movement, another variation on the speedstretch
operating elements, envisions each product being produced
with half the parts and half the weight in half the time.
Six Sigma quality is perhaps the most famous concept Welch
228 In Managers We Trust
pioneered at GE. It means “the virtual elimination of defects from
every product, process and transaction [GE] engages in every day
around the globe.” It is not just a slogan but a measurement: It
means “fewer than 3.4 defects per million operations in a manufacturing
or service process.” That is nearly perfect quality when you
consider that average sigma quality in corporate America is around
3 or 4, at a cost of about 10 to 15% of corporate revenues, Welch
reports.
Led by experts on quality who, depending on their skill level in
Six Sigma thinking, are creatively called Master Black Belts, Black
Belts or Green Belts, the activity dissects every process to improve
key business concerns such as enhancing customer productivity and
reducing customer capital outlays while increasing the “quality,
speed and efficiency” of all GE operations.
Launched in 1995, Six Sigma quality spread “like wildfire”
throughout GE to generate substantial returns on the billion-plus
dollars invested in it. For example, Six Sigma contributed over $300
million to GE’s operating income in 1997, $750 million in 1998, and
about $2 billion in 1999, and the impact continues. Profit margins
at GE historically ran around 10%, but with Six Sigma they were
boosted to 15% to 17% and higher.
All this leads to what Welch hoped for all along: a new kind of
company that is a hybrid of typical large companies with vast resources
and typical small companies with insatiable appetites.Welch
denies that GE is a conglomerate in the usual sense of the word.
Welch’s model is very different. It calls for GE to reign only over
businesses where it is number one or number two, generate ideas
from those businesses, and spread them to the others, all in a culture
of energy, excitement, and creativity.
The learning culture created by Work-Out and boundarylessness
that fueled Six Sigma gains enabled GE to get into e-business far
more rapidly and with greater depth and breadth than pretty much
any company close to its size. GE generates billions in revenue from
its e-business, but Welch notes that the transformation it has
brought is more pervasive.
Tackling the question of why the Internet revolution began at
small start-ups rather than big resourceful companies such as GE,
Welch speculated that it was a mystery of the unknown. At GE,
however, it did not take long for people to overcome that e-fear
and digitize the entire company, a taskW elch says was way easier
than anyone at the company had ever imagined. E-business was
The Fireside CEO 229
made for GE, he says, telling us that the “E” in GE assumes a
whole new meaning in this learning culture that rides out all great
new ideas.
Leadership
Creating, implementing, and harvesting best practices from a boundaryless
culture built on speed, stretch, and simplification require
leadership. The cornerstone of successful leadership is recognizing
that people matter most in any organization. Welch repeatedly emphasizes
this characteristic, which is the essence of Work-Out, the
bedrockof best practices, and the sine qua non of superior management
teams.
Leaders must constantly be on guard. They must take reality
checks and face the results. They must avoid the pervasive temptation
to wish, hope, and temporize. Equally important, leaders must
encourage their troops to do the same. To ignite a mammoth company
like GE with the energy of a small company requires “passion,
hunger, appetite for change, customer focus, and, above all, the
speed to see reality more clearly and to act on it faster.” Doing all
this, Welch concludes, requires leaders to foster a culture in which
everything “comes backto people—their ideas, their motivation,
their passion to win.”
Effective leaders share the same values as their troops. GE’s
enormous size and diversity are bound together through common
values. These valves include excellence measured in terms of customer
satisfaction, acceptance of change as a constant force, candid
communication in all directions, and acceptance of the paradox of
managing such an organization, which is simultaneously a single
entity and a collection of many different businesses.
Driving all GE’s initiatives are what Welch calls a “a unique
brand of 21st century business leader—the GE ‘A’ player.” These are
leaders with “a vision and the ability to articulate that vision to the
team, so vividly and powerfully that it also becomes their vision.”
They embody GE’s “4Es” of leadership—Energy, Energize-ability,
Edge, and Execution. In other words they embody enormous personal
energy, the ability to energize others, “the instinct and the
courage to make tough calls decisively but with fairness and absolute
integrity,” and “the consistent ability to turn vision into results.” The
best A leaders, Welch concludes, are like the best coaches: They
insist on having only A players on the field.
230 In Managers We Trust
Welch developed a culture of creativity—one without the barnacles
of bureaucracy that retard progress—where it is possible to
blend the virtues of both large and small organizations. Boundarylessness
is a “behavior definer” that gets people together as teams
with speed and drive. Work-Out epitomizes a process designed to
generate and capture good ideas whatever their origin. This culture
and these processes characterize the type of company GE has become:
a company of action, just like its leader.
LIGHTS
The Walt Disney Company is no Mickey Mouse operation, and CEO
Mike Eisner knows it.4 Eisner has one of the most enviable jobs in
the world, but he makes it look easier than it is. Since 1984 he has
run Disney as if he himself were Walt Disney—the ultimate owner
orientation. The animation, the characters, the films, the broadcast
TV, and now publishing and bigger theme parks keep Eisner on his
toes at this multi-billion-dollar entertainment company.
In his letters to shareholders, Eisner summarizes his views on
management and strategies for growth through times of change and
economic adversity. Direct commentary on specific aspects of Disney’s
entertainment business—animation, characters, television,
Euro Disney, and the Internet—evinces qualities of trust as well as
creativity and leadership. Eisner discusses some of the special problems
a large, exquisitely public company such as Disney confronts
as a business operated in the limelight of public opinion.
The More Things Change . . .
Eisner sums up his whole philosophy of business as follows: “call
meetings about subjects that really matter—and show up.” Paralleling
the situation at Welch’s GE, the big meetings at Disney are the
“synergy meetings” that bring together the heads and top managers
of each division to share ideas so that the best of one division can
be transplanted to the others. Motivated by Disney’s general devotion
to synergy and all the participants’ desire to impress their colleagues
“with the breadth and creativity of their synergistic initiatives,”
participants prepare hard for these gatherings, with
tremendous results.
The synergy meetings reflect an overall strategy at Disney anThe
Fireside CEO 231
chored on four guiding lights. First and foremost is the goal of increasing
shareholder wealth while simultaneously discharging responsibility
to Disney’s employees and its communities in an ethical
manner. The second goal is “to increase productivity through superior
work,” emphasizing that setting “the highest standards drives the
highest results.” The third goal is to “concentrate on continuing to
lead creatively,” and the fourth is a “strategic direction of quality and
innovation.”
These anchoring qualities are necessary to exploit the opportunities
and confront the challenges posed by constant change.
“Change is the engine of growth and the muse of creativity,” Eisner
says. It’s what makes things happen in life and at Disney. Eisner
addresses technological change with special lucidity. Soothsayers
regularly announce the edge of technology as spelling doom for certain
industries, such as entertainment, in the face of advances such
as 500-channel television capability.
Eisner loves it, likening such predictions to those Walt faced
when TV first emerged and forecasters foretold the death of film.
Far from shutting down any aspects of Disney’s business, TV gave
Disney a new outlet for its products. For those who are creative and
driven, such technological and other changes mean opportunity, not
obsolescence.
Tough times must be dealt with when they come, of course, but
it is far better to deal with them before they come—in robust economic
times. Eisner thinks that way, and Disney’s business is organized
that way. Although Eisner no longer likes the term “recessionresistant”
as a description of Disney, the account he gives of its
ability and strategy to make headway in tough economic times makes
the label apt.
The roaring economic climate of the 1980s led many companies
(and individuals) down shortsighted and treacherous paths, but not
Disney. It stayed clear of overpaying for businesses; didn’t acquire
what it didn’t need; kept its balance sheet clean, strong, and financially
conservative; grew internally; preserved its franchise by nurturing
its core values; and avoided teaming up with others who could
detract from the Disney brand.
Opportunities present themselves, of course, and even a conservative
company must be ready to exploit them. The fall of communism
opened enormous new markets. Disney penetrated them
through Euro Disney and through television programming in former
Soviet bloc countries.
232 In Managers We Trust
Through adversity and opportunity, Eisner recounts how the
challenges he faces are not all that different from those Walt Disney
faced 50 or 60 years ago. The challenges listed in Disney’s annual
report of 1940 were eerily similar to its list in 1990: external world
crises such as war, studio expansion, film production expansion, foreign
currency fluctuations, and control over the cost of creative talent.
All these things remain, including, the pundits notwithstanding,
the riskof war, which is hardly expected far in advance by the investing
public.
Disney’s recession resistance comes from a combination of a
strong brand, financial conservatism, and a disciplined emphasis on
growth that concentrates mainly on internal expansion supplemented
with selective expansion through prudent acquisition. External
expansion is prudent when it is necessary to preserve access
to the means of entertainment delivery, especially to the home entertainment
environment. That often entails expansion through technological
advances, but Eisner cautions that he will not let Disney
invest in technology for its own sake.
Disney’s commitment must be to the content of the entertainment,
Eisner says, not its delivery mechanisms. He regards Marshall
McLuhan’s claim that “the medium is the message” as anachronistic,
maybe true when written but no longer the case in a world of proliferating
delivery systems—numerous broadcast networks, independent
television stations, and the advent and multiplication of home
video, satellite, and the Internet. “What has counted from the time
of Homer, Chaucer and Shakespeare to the present is the story and
the skill with which it is told, whatever the medium,” he observes.
Even so, Eisner aggressively led Disney to embrace the Internet.
Among Disney’s major assets are some of the most visited Web sites:
Disney.com for entertainment, ESPN.com for sports, and ABC.com
for news. By partnering first with Starwave, a leading technology
company, and then with Infoseek, one of the most popular Web
search engines, Disney also created the Go Network, an Internet
space that collects and offers content from all Disney units.
Magic and Mice
Eisner explains that many people in the early 1980s thought animation
was dead, a lost art. Roy Disney disagreed and proved that
when done properly, animation was magic. And as Eisner says,
“magic is the essence of Disney.” Disney’s success in renewing aniThe
Fireside CEO 233
mation was the product of a two-part strategy. First, it successfully
rereleased the great classics in old and new venues—in theaters and
then on the Disney Channel and on home video. Second, Disney
bolstered its motion picture animation organization. That effort was
a splash, producing such phenomenal productions as Who Framed
Roger Rabbit?, The Little Mermaid, Beauty and the Beast, Aladdin,
The Lion King, and Pocahantas. These efforts continued through the
1990s with Tarzan, a smash hit which weighs in as the second most
successful animated film Disney ever released.
These blockbusters tower alongside such brand-name Disney
characters as Mickey Mouse and help define Disney as a familyoriented
company. That enables it to avoid dependency on the hitor-
miss business orientation shackling many other studios. Filmmaking
is a high-risk industry: Millions can be invested in a film
with no assurance of any return. That is why most major movie
studios release a dozen or more films per year, betting that the hits
will offset the misses (a practice not unlike that of dot-com speculators
in the late 1990s and early 2000s).
Disney’s strategy for overcoming these industry conditions is to
concentrate on cost control and selectivity. Two applications follow.
First, Disney emphasizes its family-oriented brand identification.
This creates a special niche that largely liberates Disney from the
hit-or-miss strategy. Second, that emphasis also gives Disney an operating
edge in the live-action film (and television) business, allowing
successes such as Father of the Bride, The Hand That Rocks the
Cradle, and Sister Act (plus scores of others too numerous to mention,
but thinkof Toy Story, Armageddon, The Horse Whisperer, and
Good Will Hunting).
The television business is even tougher than the motion picture
business, but again, Disney leverages its animation strengths to overcome
industry challenges. The Disney Channel is a major vehicle
for animation and a major competitive advantage for Disney in the
television business, with subscriber increases generally outpacing
those at competitor channels. Even before it acquired ABC in 1995,
Disney placed numerous successful shows with the networks, including
Home Improvement, Golden Girls, and Empty Nest. It later
scored knockout points with the ABC hit Who Wants to Be a Millionaire?,
which Eisner says “transcended being a mere television
show and has entered into the culture.”
If magic is the essence of Disney, Mickey Mouse is its manifestation.
Mickey’s prominence leads Eisner to explore the intriguing
234 In Managers We Trust
question, “Which came first, Mickey Mouse or the Disney company?”
The answer is not easy. Of course the company came first as
a logical and chronological matter, but Mickey was the company’s
real launching pad. Eisner quotes Walt Disney as fondly repeating:
“Remember, this all started with a mouse.” And it continues with
that mouse, as Eisner describes how Disney pulled out all the stops
to stage a worldwide celebration of Mickey’s sixty-fifth birthday in
1992.
Among the toughest business challenges Eisner and Disney
faced in recent years was the development of Euro Disney. This ambitious
theme-park undertaking was years in the making. During
many of them, Eisner expressed high hopes and great optimism.
Then struggles ensued, delays slowed progress, and hopes were lowered.
But with tenacity bolstered by a long-term vision, Eisner and
Disney pulled through and Euro Disney opened with success. Eisner’s
candor in admitting trouble and accounting for his own errors
is a sign of trustworthiness that no investor should ignore.
Managing in the Spotlight
Euro Disney got a lot of press, but so do most activities of a company
that is a piece of American cultural history. This unyielding spotlight
poses special management problems that Eisner describes with great
understatement and felicity. Disney takes the lumps for its mistakes
but gets praise when it deserves to. Under Eisner’s stewardship Disney
regularly ranks among the best entertainment companies in the
world, one of the best-managed companies overall, and one of the
most profitable and financially stable entertainment companies. In
1991 Disney also joined the Dow, the only representative of the entertainment
industry in that barometer of American (and world) financial
health.
Eisner attributes these successes to his entire management team
as well as all Disney employees, whom he affectionately refers to as
the “cast of Disney.” The spirit Eisner conveys to the cast of this
family entertainment company resonates with civic virtue and
public-spiritedness. From generating research funding for AIDS at
the 20th Anniversary Celebration of Walt Disney World in 1991, to
furnishing financial sustenance to a downtown theater in Los Angeles
in 1997, to practicing sound environmental policies companywide,
Disney is long on public values. Disney is a major supporter
of education through an effort that dramatizes the importance of
The Fireside CEO 235
teachers in society and responded generously to the upheaval reflected
in the Los Angeles riots of 1992.
Eisner’s exorbitant stockoptions remain controversial and a
sticky issue (as was his decision to hire talent tsar Mike Ovitz, who
lasted at Disney for 14 months but cost the company several hundred
million dollars in severance payments). These options warrant careful
scrutiny in his case, as with all managers. Eisner makes no bones
about his pay level, arguing that his performance at Disney justifies
it. Whether you agree is a judgment call. Some investors could reasonably
adjust their valuation of Disney on the basis of both the
awards and Eisner’s defense of them; the question is what his account
tells you about whether you want to entrust your wealth to
him.
TRUST
The Coca-Cola Company remains one of the world’s premier corporations.
5 Three priorities guided Coke’s actions under its late
CEO, Roberto C. Goizueta: creating value, strengthening the company’s
trademarks, and focusing on the long term. These priorities
pervade and define Coke, a $150 billion operation when Goizueta
died in 1997, up from a $4 billion operation when he became CEO
a little more than a decade earlier. The lively pages of Goizueta’s
passionate and clear writings, some cowritten with his former righthand
man, Donald Keough, explain why.
Consider first a few of the benchmarks. In 1995 and 1996 Coca-
Cola led Fortune’s ranking of wealth creators. As of year end 1995
its market cap was $93 billion, an increase in shareowner wealth of
$38 billion over the prior year. As of year end 1996 that figure had
increased to $131 billion, adding another $38 billion. While in 1976
Coca-Cola was the twentieth best wealth creator among publicly
traded U.S.-based companies, by 1995 it was fourth and in 1996 it
was first.
In 1995 and 1996 the total return on Coca-Cola stockexceeded
40%, and during the preceding 15 years it produced an average compound
annual total return rate of 30% (counting reinvested dividends).
From 1980 through 1995 Coca-Cola’s share price grew at an
average annual compound rate of 24%, creating nearly $89 billion
in shareowner wealth, compared with increases of 12% in the Dow
and 11% in the S&P 500. The annualized total return from 1981
236 In Managers We Trust
through 1990, assuming reinvestment of dividends, was 37%, and
from 1986 through 1990, it was 34%.
Driving these spectacular results, Goizueta repeatedly emphasized,
was growth in unit case volume. From 1985 through 1995, unit
case volume outside North America grew at an average annual compound
rate of 8.2%, while within the United States it grew at an
average annual compound rate of 4.2% (compared with 2.7% industrywide).
In 1996 Coca-Cola set another record, with worldwide unit
case volume up 8% and selling 13.7 billion unit cases. Sales of the
Coca-Cola brand itself grew by nearly 450 million unit cases (a 6%
increase over 1995), while Sprite grew by more than 138 million unit
cases (up 13%, its third consecutive year of double-digit growth).
Owner Orientation and Long-Term Thinking
Adding fuel to this unstoppable engine was Goizueta’s business philosophy.
Goizueta saw himself as the steward of shareholder capital,
always tying Coke’s activities to shareholder values. He said that
“solid unit case volume growth is the foundation for generating economic
profit, which, experience teaches us, is the key to increasing
the value of [our shareowners’ investment].”
Under Goizueta, Coke focused on its core businesses and
adopted a long-term time horizon. Through disciplined and patient
attention to building the Coke brand for the long term, Goizueta
also created another trademarkat Coke: a company with an unquenchable
thirst for selling more product to more customers all
over the world.
Goizueta believed that “the best way to generate consistently
strong short-term results is to keep our attention riveted on the longterm.”
That long-term focus during the 1980s and 1990s meant building
step by step a “global business machine capable of sustaining
strong, profitable growth” over the decades to come.
Branding
At the foundation of that global business is the Coke brand. It “not
only has universal appeal and accessibility, but also meets the fundamental,
frequently recurring human need for refreshment.” To get
people to choose Coke to meet their daily liquid needs, building
The Fireside CEO 237
brand strength was the key. Brand strength was for Goizueta not
solely about delivering value to the marketplace, marketing research
results, or balance sheet impacts. Goizueta defined brand strength
in terms of its “ability to command a premium price in exchange for
the very real and obvious value it delivers in return.”
Managing brand strength need not be tricky, although enough
businesses have squeezed brand strength to the point where its
price-value relationship led to its rejection by the market. Coke did
not make that mistake under Goizueta’s leadership. Instead, it continually
sought to find ways to add brand strength by differentiating
the products, “making them unique and distinctive.” For many years
Coke used the AAA approach to its brand strength: availability, affordability,
and acceptability of its products. That strategy worked
well, but Goizueta moved to the next level in 1995, to the PPP approach:
pervasive penetration (rather than mere availability), priceto-
value ratios for customers (rather than mere affordability), and
preferred (to merely acceptable).
Financial Prudence
Another foundation of Coke’s enormous success was Goizueta’s
commitment to financial prudence, epitomized by his decision in
1994 to effect at Coke a “financial reformation.” Noting that Coke’s
historical financial prudence had ossified by the early 1980s—“effectively
trapping a live organism within the hard constrictions of its
own fossil shell”—and rejuvenated in the latter 1980s, Goizueta restated
that commitment.
Goizueta announced a new way of measuring Coke’s performance.
Economic profits (a version of what would later be called
economic value added), not just growth in revenues or earnings,
became the yardstick. Economic profit is “net operating profit after
taxes, less a charge for the average cost of capital employed to produce
that profit.”
Evaluating businesses with this measure led Coke to divest some
poorly performing operations and renewed the focus on the core
business of soft drinkconcentrate (with some holdings in bottlers
complemented by an economically profitable foods business).
Coke used debt sparingly to enhance shareholder returns and
effected share repurchases to enhance earnings per share. It lowered
its dividend payout ratio while increasing the annual dividend to free
238 In Managers We Trust
up cash for reinvestment at low cost. It reinvested those and other
funds to expand its global bottling networkto erect an extensive and
efficient business system. All this Goizueta explained with great clarity
to his fellow shareholders.
Infrastructure Fortification
Part of that investment helped finance improvements in its bottlers’
processing and distribution systems. Not only did those investments
bolster current and future product sales (and strengthen the Cokebottler
partnership), Coke could subsequently sell its interest in the
investment at an additional profit for its shareholders.
Goizueta called Coke’s investment in and development of an extensive
and efficient bottling and distribution system “infrastructure
fortification.” It entailed continued and deeper investments in the
system that bottles and distributes Coca-Cola products. A variety of
means were used to fortify the system, from encouraging bottlers to
reinvest to investing equity directly and supplying managerial expertise.
Through these practices, Coke expanded around the globe to
nearly two-hundred countries to create billions of new potential customers.
Between 1980 and 1994 the number of potential Coke customers
more than doubled. With sales volume growth as the key to
sustaining value growth, this shows why Coke’s average return on
capital was over triple the approximate cost of that capital.
Adding strength to Coke’s focus on the core brands in its global
business system was geographic diversification. Coke enjoys a
strong—maybe dominant—position in blue chip markets such as the
United States, Germany, and Japan. It is committed to dominating
new worlds of opportunity such as eastern Europe and Indonesia.
Add to that the “start-up” markets of China and India and you have
overall diversity through which to “use existing strengths to create
future strengths.” (That fortification is one of the reasons Coke prevailed
against the adversity of the Asian financial crisis of 1998.)
Resource Allocation
In Coke’s global business environment, Goizueta said, his primary
challenge was to optimally allocate resources generated in developed
markets to invest in less developed ones. The greatest growth potential
for Coke in the world, Goizueta told a group of students in 1995,
The Fireside CEO 239
was in southern California! Coke sold more cans and bottles of Coke
per capita in Hungary than in southern California, making the latter
the more “emerging” of the two markets.
Financial reformation, infrastructure fortification, and geographic
expansion were meant to create the “best machine possible.”
A complementary initiative would “equip that machine with a
uniquely powerful growth engine.” This was the consumer marketing
effort designed to drive world demand for the brand. It called for
Coke to market its products as distinctive—“different, better and
special”—relentlessly deepening brand power.
Goizueta ignored the varied views from the sidelines that ranged
from those who said Coke already was a premier consumer marketing
outfit and could do no more to those who said there were plenty
of other great companies that hold that title. Noting that the average
human body needs at least 64 ounces of liquid daily to survive, Goizueta
saw Coke as having a huge window of opportunity.
Goizueta sought to promote the brand everywhere in the world,
driving dramatic growth in already developed markets such as the
United States, Japan, and Europe. To deepen brand strength vertically—
that is, in existing strong markets as compared to horizontal
building in new ones—required exploiting Goizueta’s commitment
to product differentiation. Goizueta said that if the keys to selling
real estate are location, location, location, the “keys to selling consumer
products are differentiation, differentiation, differentiation.”
Many were astonished in 1996 when Coke did what they thought
was impossible: It surpassed the combined consumption of the two
leading teas in the United Kingdom and that of the leading bottled
water in France!
Learning Culture
These insights guided Coke instinctively for years. Goizueta set them
out in writing as part of an effort to create throughout the company
a “learning culture” in which these principles were institutionalized.
Like GE’s Welch, he sought to learn from every participant in Coke’s
business: consumers, customers, partners, competitors, and even unrelated
organizations. For example, another reality at Goizueta’s
Coke was his team’s ability to find opportunities others could not
see. His people search the world not to see where Coke already is
but to see where it is not.
Goizueta helped create another extraordinary reality: Coca-Cola
240 In Managers We Trust
adds value “to everyone who touches it.” Shareholders, bottlers,
Coke’s customers, and end consumers all benefit from Coke. Goizueta
emphasized particularly Coke’s relationships with its bottlers.
Throughout the world, a once-fragmented group of bottlers increasingly
consolidated on a country-by-country basis—in Japan, Germany,
and elsewhere—to gain substantial competitive advantages. As
for the customers, many restaurants must sell three hamburgers to
make the same profit they make from selling a large Coke. Coke
went out of its way to let its customers know this.
Conquering Economic Adversity
Concentrating on the long term by emphasizing short-term prudence
is how Coke and Goizueta conquered the economic adversity of the
early 1990s. Coke deployed its resources amid global economic malaise
to cope with the slowdown through strategic pricing and cost
controls. It deployed those resources to capitalize on those conditions
by making flexible marketing investments. In this two-front
campaign Goizueta never wavered from his conviction, shared by
Keough and Coke’s other top managers, that a hybrid perspective is
optimal: What distinguished Coke was its simultaneous “constancy
of purpose” and its “continuous discontentment with the immediate
present.”
That hybrid perspective was doubly valuable in facing adversity
and proved the adage that tough times make the strong stronger.
The aggressive investment in the long-term growth and value of the
business, in good times as well as in bad, is what’s behind Fortune
magazine’s regular ranking of Coke as one of the most admired companies
in America, especially for its long-term investment value.
Goizueta’s long-term orientation gave succor in bad times, as did
his unwillingness to waste energy on forecasting the economic future.
It is not possible to control external events such as “global
economic trends, currency fluctuations and devaluations, natural
disasters, political upheavals, social unrest, bad weather or schizophrenic
stockmark ets,” but Goizueta notes that he and every other
manager has complete control over his or her own behavior.
Managers cannot allow themselves to be distracted by the external
environment. What they can and should do is focus the management
team on what it can control: resource deployment to build
a foundation for future growth, whatever the current economic climate.
The future, in those terms, is in no way preordained but inThe
Fireside CEO 241
stead is “an infinite series of openings, of possibilities.” He emphasized
that what uncertainty calls for, especially in difficult economic
environments, is what the Greeks called practical intelligence. This
world view “forces adaptability and teaches constant preparedness.”
Pragmatism
Practical intelligence also “acknowledges that nothing quite succeeds
as planned” and that what is crucial is “pragmatic adaptability”
to what is new. And new always comes—change is inevitable. The
sharp business focus at Coke is what best prepared the company to
meet change. Indeed, as Goizueta suggested, few large companies
are as focused as Coke or as “tightly riveted” to a particular business
as Coke is to soft drinks.
Animating Goizueta’s letters was an overarching dominant
theme: The company’s shareholders own it. All other themes—building
brand strength through the AAAs or PPPs, differentiating the
brand as special and better, fiscal prudence, and focus—serve the
ultimate principle that the investors are the owners.
Success at Coke, Goizueta emphasized to all the troops, was
“creating value for the people who have entrusted their assets to us.”
That is the reason why the company (and any other business) exists.
All the other social benefits Coke or any other company generates
by “serving customers and consumers, creating jobs, positively impacting
society, supporting communities—happen only as long as we
fulfill our mission of creating value for [shareholders],” Goizueta
said.
Shortly before his death Goizueta quoted for his management
team the words of the German poet and playwright Goethe: “Whatever
you can do or dream you can, begin it. Boldness has genius,
power and magic in it. Begin it now.”
Goizueta believed that boldness sustains growth. He expressed
gratitude to all the participants in the Coke venture—associates,
customers, bottling partners, board members, and most of all, he
said, his fellow shareowners—for their trust and confidence in his
team’s ability to create value.
Well-earned trust indeed, and indispensable when markets, numbers,
and governance tell only part of the story in business analysis.
This page intentionally left blank.
243
CONCLUSION:
THE V CULTURE
Readers with an arbitrage orientation may regret that the exemplars
of great modern CEOs covered in the last chapter, apart
from Warren Buffett, consist of one who is dead, one who has announced
his retirement, and only one who is likely to reign for the
foreseeable future. Who’s next, and why not name them?
If I knew, I would not say. Not so much because I want to gain
a competitive edge. No, my reticence is precisely because of an insight
in this book: Judgment is the key, and my judgment will invariably
differ from yours. Our circles of competence are necessarily
different. Our interpretation of the past differs, and our prognosis
for the future must as well. It contradicts the whole point of this
bookfor me to tell you who I believe are the up-and-coming star
CEOs. My picks are irrelevant to your judgments.
Go backto the masters mentioned in Chapter 1 and you’ll see
that it was precisely their independence of thought, their utter and
profound common sense, which led to their remarkable success. I
condense these ideas and insights in the spirit of a teacher and professor,
not an investment adviser. I hope you’ll use these pages as a
foundation for picking stocks as a savvy, sophisticated investor (or,
failing that, picking advisers who share respect for the basic philosophy
of outstanding investors such as Graham and Buffett).
The basic philosophy of business analysis investing integrates
three branches: finance, accounting, and governance. Finance is
commonly defined as “the science of management of money and
other assets.” So much for this definition, if you agree that finance
is one part science and the other part art. Behavioral economics, a
field that draws on numerous disciplines, including psychology, statistics,
history, and sociology, may deserve to be called a social sci-
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
244 In Managers We Trust
ence. Its approach to finance is the most promising, for it recognizes
the first branch of intelligent investing: Graham’s foundational insight
that price and value are different things.
The meaning and measure of value are the second branch, pursuits
requiring a grasp of basic ideas from the world of accounting.
Accounting has long been known as the language of business, and
the discretion managers have in applying accounting principles requires
intelligent investors to become translators of that language.
When that discretion is abused, it is safer to side with those who
declare accounting a state of mind rather than an art or science.
Fluency in accounting gives you a huge investment edge, and even
conversational accounting will put you at the top of the investing
class.
Since market prices and accounting numbers are both fragile
grounds for firm and final investment decisions, the third branch is
managerial trustworthiness. Formal and overly general governance
principles don’t help very much here. What you need are people you
are happy to entrust your wealth with. Identifying them is all art.
In the stockmark et forest, lookfor these three branches. They
enable you to steer away from the Q culture and thrive in the V
culture, a value-oriented investing culture nurtured by Graham and
Buffett.
245
NOTES
Chapter 1
1. Benjamin Graham, The Intelligent Investor (1st ed. 1949; 4th rev. ed. Harper &
Row, 1973), 108.
2. Fred Schwed, Jr., Where Are the Customers’ Yachts? (1st ed. 1940; rev. ed. John
Wiley & Sons, 1995), 6–7.
3. The New York Stock Exchange Fact Book (New York, 1999), http://
www.nyse.com; Gretchen Morgenson, “Investing’s Longtime Best Bet Is Being
Trampled by the Bulls,” The New York Times, January 15, 2000.
4. Report of the Presidential TaskF orce on Market Mechanisms (the Brady Report),
1988.
5. Greg Ip, “Market on a High Wire,” The Wall Street Journal, January 18, 2000.
6. Burton G. Malkiel, A Random Walk Down Wall Street (1st ed. 1973; 7th rev.
ed. W. W. Norton, 1999), 57–61.
7. Warren E. Buffett and Lawrence A. Cunningham, The Essays of Warren Buffett:
Lessons for Corporate America (The Cunningham Group, 1997), 72.
8. Robert J. Shiller, Irrational Exuberance (Princeton University Press, 2000), 118–
132, catalogs and evaluates the 25 top bursts and busts on global stockexchanges
during one- and five-year periods from the 1960s through the 1990s.
9. Joseph de la Vega, Confusio´n de Confusiones (1st ed. 1688; rev. ed. John Wiley
& Sons, 1996), 159–165 (the selected quotation condenses original material
without indicating omissions).
10. Malkiel, Random Walk, 185.
11. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 63, 84. The price per share was $5.63, aggregating
$100 million, compared to a value of $400 to $500 million.
12. Graham, Intelligent Investor, 289 (footnote omitted).
Chapter 2
1. For additional analysis and sources, consult Lawrence A. Cunningham, “From
Random Walks to Chaotic Crashes: The Linear Genealogy of the Efficient
Capital Market Hypothesis,” The George Washington University Law Review,
vol. 62 (1994), on which this chapter is based.
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
246 Notes
2. Louis Bachelier, “Theory of Speculation,” reprinted in The Random Character
of Stock Market Prices, Paul H. Cootner, ed. (rev. ed. MIT Press, 1964).
3. Eugene F. Fama, “The Behavior of StockMark et Prices,” Journal of Business,
vol. 38 (1965).
4. Sidney S. Alexander, “Price Movements in Speculative Markets: Trends or Random
Walks?” Industry Management Review, May 1961.
5. Benjamin Graham, The Intelligent Investor (1st ed. 1949; 4th rev. ed. Harper &
Row, 1973), 133.
6. Paul A. Samuelson, “Proof That Properly Anticipated Prices Fluctuate Randomly,”
Industry Management Review, Spring 1965.
7. Milton Friedman, “The Methodology of Positive Economics,” in Essays in Positive
Economics (University of Chicago Press, 1953).
8. Andrew Lo and A. Craig MacKinlay, A Non-Random Walk Down Wall Street
(Princeton University Press, 1999).
9. Eugene A. Fama, “Efficient Capital Markets: II,” Journal of Finance, vol. 46
(1991).
10. James Tobin, “On the Efficiency of the Financial System,” Lloyds Bank Review,
July 1984.
11. William F. Sharpe, Portfolio Theory and Capital Markets (McGraw-Hill, 1970);
Kenneth J. Arrow, “RiskP erception in Psychology and Economics,” Economic
Inquiry, vol. 20 (1982).
12. Lawrence H. Summers, “Does the StockMark et Rationally Reflect Fundamental
Values?” Journal of Finance, vol. 41 (1986).
13. Fischer Black, “Noise,” Journal of Finance, vol. 41 (1986).
14. Andrei Shleifer, Inefficient Markets: An Introduction to Behavioral Finance (Oxford
University Press, 2000).
15. Harry M. Markowitz, Portfolio Diversification: Efficient Diversification of Investments
(John Wiley & Sons, 1959).
16. Sharpe, Portfolio Theory and Capital Markets.
17. Andrei Shleifer, “Do Demand Curves for Stocks Slope Down?” Journal of Finance,
vol. 41 (1986).
18. Francis Fukuyama, Trust: The Social Virtues and the Creation of Prosperity (Free
Press, 1995).
19. Graham, Intelligent Investor, 61, n. 2.
20. Lawrence A. Cunningham, ed., “Conversations from the Buffett Symposium,”
Cardozo Law Review, vol. 19 (Sept.–Nov. 1997), 812.
Chapter 3
1. For additional analysis and sources, consult Lawrence A. Cunningham, “From
Random Walks to Chaotic Crashes: The Linear Genealogy of the Efficient
Capital Market Hypothesis,” The George Washington University Law Review,
vol. 62 (1994), on which this chapter is based.
Notes 247
2. H. E. Hurst, “Long-Term Storage Capacities of Reservoirs,” Transactions of the
American Society of Civil Engineers, vol. 116 (1951).
3. Edgar E. Peters, Chaos and Order in the Capital Markets (John Wiley & Sons,
1991); Edgar E. Peters, Fractal Market Analysis: Applying Chaos Theory to Investment
and Economics (John Wiley & Sons, 1994).
4. Henri Poincare´ , Science and Method (1st ed. 1908; rev. ed. Dover Press, 1952).
5. Edward Lorenz, “Deterministic Nonperiodic Flow,” Journal of Atmospheric Sciences,
vol. 20 (1963); Edward Lorenz, Nonlinear Dynamical Economics and
Chaotic Motion (Springer-Verlag, 1989).
6. Alan Wolf, “Chaos in the Stadium,” Algorithm, April 1992.
7. These figures were prepared by Alan Wolf.
8. Alan Wolf, et al., “Determining Lyapunov Exponents from Time Series,” Physica,
vol. 16D (1985).
9. Benoit B. Mandelbrot, The Fractal Geometry of Nature (W. H. Freeman, 1988);
Benoit B. Mandelbrot, ed., Fractals and Scaling in Finance: Discontinuity, Concentration,
Risk (Springer-Verlag, 1997).
10. Andrei Shleifer, Inefficient Markets: An Introduction to Behavioral Finance (Oxford
University Press, 2000), 121–22.
11. John Y. Campbell and Robert J. Shiller, “The Dividend-Price Ratio and Expectations
of Future Dividends and Discount Factors,” Review of Financial Studies,
vol. 1 (1998); John Y. Campbell and John Ammer, “What Moves Stockand Bond
Markets: A Variance Decomposition for Long-Term Asset Returns,” Journal of
Finance, vol. 48 (1993).
12. Warren E. Buffett and Lawrence A. Cunningham, The Essays of Warren Buffett:
Lessons for Corporate America (The Cunningham Group, 1997), 72.
13. Warren E. Buffett, “The Superinvestors of Graham and Doddsville,” Hermes
(Columbia Business School), Fall 1984.
14. Benjamin Graham, The Intelligent Investor (1st. ed. 1949; rev. ed Harper & Row,
1973), 36–37.
15. Ibid.
Chapter 4
1. Alex Berenson, “On Hair-Trigger Wall Street, A StockPlunges on Fake News,”
The New York Times, August 26, 2000.
2. Susan E. Hurd and Jonathan M.Winer, “On-Line Securities Fraud Under Scrutiny,”
The New York Law Journal, February 22, 2000.
3. Professor Howard M. Friedman of the University of Toledo Law School furnished
testimony providing some of these examples before the Permanent Investigations
Subcommittee of the Senate Governmental Affairs Committee on
March 22, 1999.
4. SEC v. Francis Tribble &Sloane Fitzgerald, SEC Litigation Release No. 15959,
October 27, 1998.
248 Notes
5. SEC v. Remington-Hall Capital Corp. &Douglas T. Fonteno, SEC Litigation
Release No. 15943, October 22, 1998.
6. Alex Berenson, “Two Accused of Using E-Mail to Commit StockF raud,” The
New York Times, February 25, 2000.
7. Jeffrey Keegan, “Regulators Step Up Fight against Internet Fraud,” Investment
Dealers Digest, August 7, 1998.
8. Philip L. Carret, The Art of Speculation (1st ed. 1930; rev. ed. Fraser, 1984).
9. Edwin LeFe`vre, Reminiscences of a Stock Operator (1st ed. 1923; rev. ed. John
Wiley & Sons, 1994).
10. Benjamin Graham, The Intelligent Investor (1st ed. 1949; 4th rev. ed. Harper &
Row, 1973), 142.
11. Leslie Eaton, “Internet Investing: Spotlight on Risk,” International Herald Tribune,
December 6, 1996.
12. SEC v. Aziz-Golshani, No. 99–13139 (CBM) (Federal Central District of California,
December 15, 1999); Rebecca Buckman and Michael Schroeder, “Web
Postings Draw Charges of StockF raud,” The Wall Street Journal, December 16,
1999; Gretchen Morgenson, “Internet’s Role Is Implicated in StockF raud,” The
New York Times, December 16, 1999.
13. SEC Litigation Release No. 16399 (January 5, 2000) (reporting on SEC v. Yun
Soo Oh Park, Federal Northern District of Illinois, Case No. 00C 0049); Jennifer
Friedlin, “The SEC Files Civil Fraud Charges against Tokyo Joe,” The-
Street.com & NYTimes.com, January 2000; John C. Coffee, Jr., “Tokyo Joe and
the First Amendment,” The New York Law Journal, January 20, 2000.
14. “Net Damage: PairGain Hoax Revealed,” Investor Relations Business, April 26,
1999; Associated Press, “PairGain Worker Sentenced in Fraud Case,” The New
York Times, August 31, 1999.
15. Alex Berenson, “S.E.C. Reaches Settlement in Web-Based ‘Pump and Dump’
Case,” The New York Times, March 3, 2000; Michael Schroeder, “Georgetown
Students Draw Web Investors—and an SEC Bust,” The Wall Street Journal,
March 3, 2000.
16. William M. Bulkeley, “Presstek Suit Alleges Short Sellers Posted False Statements
On-Line,” The Wall Street Journal, September 18, 1997.
17. Gretchen Morgenson, “S.E.C. Says Teenager Had After-School Hobby: Online
StockF raud,” The New York Times, September 21, 2000.
18. Lawrence Harris, “Volatility, Portfolio Insurance, and the Role of Specialists
and Market Makers,” Cornell Law Review, vol. 74 (1989), provided part of the
foundation for the following discussion.
19. Michael Schroeder and Randall Smith, “Sweeping Changes in Market Structure
Sought: Major Firms Propose Central Order System and Single Regulator,”
The Wall Street Journal, February 29, 2000; Alex Berenson, “Top Wall St. Executives
Urge Trading Overhaul,” The New York Times, March 1, 2000.
20. Michael Schroeder, “NASD, NYSE Discussed Merging to Keep Up With Market
Changes,” The Wall Street Journal, March 3, 2000; Greg Ip and Randall
Notes 249
Smith, “Instinet, DatekRecently Held Merger Talks,” The Wall Street Journal,
March 3, 2000.
21. Thomas Kalinke, “Sleepless in New York: Evening Hours at the Exchange,”
Financial History, vol. 69 (Spring 2000).
22. Rebecca Buckman, “Heavy Losses: The Rise and Collapse of a Day Trader,”
The Wall Street Journal, February 28, 2000.
23. Senate Governmental Affairs Committee, Permanent Subcommittee on Investigations,
February 25, 2000; Bloomberg News, “Day Trading’s Risks and Pressures
Are Described to a Senate Panel,” The New York Times, February 25,
2000.
24. Gerald M. Loeb, The Battle for Investment Survival (1st ed. 1935; rev. ed. John
Wiley & Sons, 1996).
25. Warren E. Buffett and Lawrence A. Cunningham, The Essays of Warren Buffet:
Lessons for Corporate America (The Cunningham Group, 1997), 90.
26. Edward Wyatt, “Day Traders Are Formidable Market Force,” The New York
Times, April 14, 1999.
27. The Charles Schwab Corporation, 1999 Annual Report, 41–42; PatrickMc-
Geehan, “Profit Up at Citigroup, Merrill and Schwab,” The New York Times,
April 18, 2000.
28. PatrickMcGeehan, “The Unmutual Fund,” The New York Times, May 18, 2000.
Chapter 5
1. Benjamin Graham, The Intelligent Investor (1st ed. 1949; 4th rev. ed. Harper &
Row, 1973), 110.
2. Warren E. Buffett and Lawrence A. Cunningham, The Essays of Warren Buffett:
Lessons for Corporate America (The Cunningham Group, 1997), 120, 122, 134.
3. Ibid., 110.
4. John C. Bogle, Common Sense on Mutual Funds (John Wiley & Sons, 1999).
5. Gerald M. Loeb, The Battle for Investment Survival (1st ed. 1935; rev. ed. John
Wiley & Sons, 1996).
6. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 79; Graham, Intelligent Investor, 54, 282–
283.
7. Gretchen Morgenson, “Buying on Margin Becomes a Habit,” The New York
Times, March 24, 2000.
8. Gretchen Morgenson, “Stock-Trading Cheerleader Now Faces $45 Million
Debt,” The New York Times, April 19, 2000.
9. NickLeeson, Rogue Trader (Warner, 1997).
10. Graham, Intelligent Investor, 228–231.
11. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 57.
12. Charles T. Munger, “A Lesson on Elementary, Worldly Wisdom As It Relates
to Investment Management and Business,” Outstanding Investor Digest, vol. X
(May 5, 1995).
250 Notes
13. Edwin LeFe`vre, Reminiscences of a Stock Operator (1st ed. 1923; rev. ed. John
Wiley & Sons, 1994).
14. Graham, Intelligent Investor, 245.
15. Ibid., 124–125
16. Bill Spindle, “Been There? Euphoric ’80s in Japan Ended in Long Slide,” The
Wall Street Journal, January 18, 2000.
17. Steve Liesman and Jacob M. Schlesinger, “Blunted Spike: The Price of Oil Has
Doubled This Year; So, Where’s the Recession?” The Wall Street Journal, December
15, 1999; Joseph Kahn, “Surge in Oil Prices Is Raising Specter of Inflation
Spike,” The New York Times, February 21, 2000.
18. Graham, Intelligent Investor, 162.
19. Gretchen Morgenson, “Investing’s Longtime Best Bet Is Being Trampled by the
Bulls,” The New York Times, January 15, 2000.
Chapter 6
1. Donald Schwartz, late professor at the Georgetown University Law Center,
prepared the original version of this parable, rewritten for publication here and
previously appearing in others forms in Lawrence A. Cunningham, Introductory
Accounting and Finance for Lawyers (West Group 2d ed., 1999) and Lewis D.
Solomon, et al., Corporations Law and Policy (West Group 4th ed., 1998).
2. Carol Loomis, “Mr. Buffett on the StockMark et,” Fortune, November 22, 1999.
3. Charles T. Munger, author of “A Lesson on Elementary, Worldly Wisdom As It
Relates to Investment Management and Business,” Outstanding Investor Digest,
vol. X (May 5, 1995), furnished this example.
4. Warren E. Buffett and Lawrence A. Cunningham, The Essays of Warren Buffett:
Lessons for Corporate America (The Cunningham Group, 1997), 71.
Chapter 7
1. Benjamin Graham, The Intelligent Investor (1st ed. 1949; 4th rev. ed. Harper &
Row, 1973), 63.
2. Warren E. Buffett and Lawrence A. Cunningham, The Essays of Warren Buffett:
Lessons for Corporate America (The Cunningham Group, 1997), 92–93.
3. Benjamin Graham, The Interpretation of Financial Statements (1st ed. 1937; rev.
ed. Harper Business, 1998), 77.
4. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 208.
5. Ibid., 91–92.
6. Adrian J. Slywotzky and David J. Morrison, authors of Profit Patterns (Times
Business, 1999), identify and discuss the patterns described in the accompanying
text.
7. Bill Miller, “Amazon.com’s Allure,” Barron’s, November 15, 1999.
8. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 96–97.
Notes 251
9. Graham, Intelligent Investor, 286.
10. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 99.
11. The psychology literature calls the resistance bias a “principle of conservatism”
and the pattern-seeking bias a “representativeness heuristic.” Both labels seem
not only unwieldy but imprecise when adapted for thinking about investor behavior.
Nevertheless, investment theorists cling to these terms in arguing that
these cognitive biases play a role in explaining market inefficiencies. For an
example, consider Andrei Shleifer, Inefficient Markets: An Introduction to Behavioral
Finance (Oxford University Press, 2000).
12. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 87.
13. Ibid., 53.
Chapter 8
1. Leopold A. Bernstein and John J. Wild, Analysis of Financial Statements (5th
ed. McGraw-Hill, 2000), 102–03.
2. Benjamin Graham, The Interpretation of Financial Statements (1st ed. 1937; rev.
ed. Harper Business, 1998), 32.
3. For more, consult ibid. or Lawrence A. Cunningham, Introductory Accounting
and Finance for Lawyers (2nd ed. West Group, 1999), on which this and the
next chapter draw (the title is intended to show that it is for the nonaccountant;
it is not exclusively for lawyers).
Chapter 9
1. Benjamin Graham, The Intelligent Investor (1st ed. 1949; 4th rev. ed. Harper &
Row, 1973), 277.
2. Warren E. Buffett and Lawrence A. Cunningham, The Essays of Warren Buffett:
Lessons for Corporate America (The Cunningham Group, 1997), 101. Note also
Subrata N. Chakravarty, “Three Little Words,” Forbes, April 6, 1998.
3. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 187.
4. The per share figures throughout this chapter do not take into account any
stocksplits occurring in 2000 or beyond.
5. Graham, Intelligent Investor, 14–15.
6. Michael Metz and David Kerdell, “Graham and Dodd Revisited,” Portfolio Strategy
(CIBC Oppenheimer, December 11, 1998).
7. Benjamin Graham, The Interpretation of Financial Statements (1st ed. 1937; rev.
ed. Harper Business, 1998), 15, 23.
8. Ibid., 49.
9. Ibid., 48–49.
10. Philip L. Carret, The Art of Speculation (1st ed. 1930; rev. ed. Fraser, 1984).
11. Graham, Intelligent Investor, 277–282.
252 Notes
12. John Burr Williams, The Theory of Investment Value (1st ed. 1938; rev. ed. Fraser,
1997).
13. Robert Shiller, Irrational Exuberance (Princeton University Press, 2000) (noting
the studies referred to and reporting on others done directly that show
slightly lower expected returns), 52–55; Graham, Intelligent Investor, 122.
14. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 85.
15. Stern Stewart, the firm that trademarked the term “economic value added,”
publishes volumes of material on the concept, including G. Bennett Stewart
III, “EVA : Fact and Fantasy,” Journal of Applied Corporate Finance, vol. 7
(1994).
16. The Coca-Cola Company defines “economic value added” in a glossary in its
annual report as year-to-year growth in after-tax operating income in excess of
a varying estimated charge for average operating capital employed.
17. Graham, Interpretation, 75–76.
Chapter 10
1. David Burgstahler and Ilia Dichev, “Earnings Management to Avoid Earnings
Decreases and Losses,” Journal of Accounting and Economics, vol. 24 (1997).
2. Michael Schroeder, “SEC to Adopt Disclosure Rules for Companies,” The Wall
Street Journal, December 16, 1999.
3. New York Stock Exchange Listed Company Manual, Section 303.01, Audit Committees
(available from http://www.nyse.com/listed). Big accounting firms used
these rules and recommendations to formulate statements of audit committee
standards. For example, see PriceWaterhouseCoopers, Audit Committees: Best
Practices for Protecting Shareholder Interests (1999); KMPG, Shaping the Audit
Committee Agenda (1999).
4. Graham’s lampooning appears in Warren E. Buffett and Lawrence A. Cunningham,
The Essays of Warren Buffett: Lessons For Corporate America (The
Cunningham Group, 1997), 159–65. Briloff’s workincludes More Debits Than
Credits (Harper & Row, 1976) and Unaccountable Accounting (Harper & Row,
1972).
5. Some of these charade discussions are adapted from Lawrence A. Cunningham,
Introductory Accounting and Finance for Lawyers (2nd ed. West Group, 1999).
6. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 193.
7. Benjamin Graham, The Intelligent Investor (1st ed. 1949; 4th rev. ed. Harper &
Row, 1973), 167.
Chapter 11
1. Benjamin Graham, The Intelligent Investor (1st ed. 1949; 4th rev. ed. Harper &
Row, 1973), 155.
2. Ibid., 286.
3. Warren E. Buffett and Lawrence A. Cunningham, The Essays of Warren Buffett:
Notes 253
Lessons for Corporate America (The Cunningham Group, 1997), 147.
4. For additional analysis and sources, consult Lawrence A. Cunningham, “Commonalities
and Prescriptions in the Vertical Dimension of Global Corporate
Governance,” Cornell Law Review, vol. 84 (1999), on which this and the following
chapters draw.
5. Graham, Intelligent Investor, 270.
6. AMP, Inc. v. Allied-Signal, Inc., 1998 US District LEXIS 15617 (Federal Eastern
District of Pennsylvania, October 8, 1998), reversed on other grounds by the
Federal Third Circuit Court of Appeals, 168 Federal Reporter 3d 649 (January
20, 1999).
7. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 47.
Chapter 12
1. Warren E. Buffett and Lawrence A. Cunningham, The Essays of Warren Buffett:
Lessons for Corporate America (The Cunningham Group, 1997), 138.
2. Ibid., 86–87, 96.
3. Roberta Romano, “Corporate Law and Corporate Governance,” Industrial and
Corporate Change, vol. 5 (1996); Sanjai Bhagat and Bernard Black, “The Uncertain
Relationship between Board Composition and Firm Performance,” Business
Lawyer, vol. 54 (1999).
4. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 40.
5. James A. Brickley, Jeffrey L. Coles, and Gregg Jarrell, “Leadership Structure:
Separating the CEO and Chairman of the Board,” Journal of Corporate Finance,
vol. 3 (1997).
6. Ira M. Millstein and Paul W. MacAvoy, “The Active Board of Directors and
Performance of the Large Publicly Traded Corporation,” Columbia University
Law Review, vol. 98 (1998).
7. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 47–54.
8. Investors Responsibility Research Center (press release), “Investors, CEOs,
Split on Best Governance Practices for Dot-Com Companies,” January 26,
2000.
9. SEC Rule 14a-8 under the Federal Securities Exchange Act of 1934.
10. Benjamin Graham, The Memoirs of the Dean ofWall Street (McGraw-Hill, 1996;
posthumous publication, Seymour Chatman, ed.), 201–212. The company was
Northern Pipeline, and the year was 1928 (Graham was 34 years old). Ibid.,
320.
11. Benjamin Graham, The Intelligent Investor (1st ed. 1949; 4th rev. ed. Harper
and Row, 1973), 270.
Chapter 13
1. Joseph Kahn, “AMP Rejects Allied Signal’s Takeover Bid of $10 Billion,” The
New York Times, August 22, 1998.
254 Notes
2. John A. Byrnes, “The Blame When the Boss Fails,” Business Week, December
27, 1999.
3. Consult Kevin Murphy, “Corporate Performance and Managerial Remuneration:
An Empirical Analysis,” Journal of Accounting and Economics, vol. 7
(1985), and Hamid Mehran, “Executive Compensation Structure, Ownership,
and Firm Performance,” Journal of Financial Economics, vol. 38 (1995).
4. Ben & Jerry’s Homemade, Inc., 1992 Annual Report (5:1 ratio raised in 1990 to
7:1); Ben & Jerry’s Homemade, Inc., 1998 Annual Report (16:1 ratio at its “historical
high” and would be higher if “the present value of unexercised stock
options were included”).
5. Lee Gomes, “McAfee.com to Make Long-Awaited IPO,” The Wall Street Journal,
December 2, 1999.
6. Haig Simonian and Nikki Tait, “U.S. Executives Earn Much More,” The Financial
Times (London), August 3, 1998.
7. Warren E. Buffett and Lawrence A. Cunningham, The Essays of Warren Buffett:
Lessons for Corporate America (The Cunningham Group, 1997), 54–55.
8. “Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation,” Statement of Financial Accounting
Standards No. 123 (Financial Accounting Standards Board, 1995).
9. Gretchen Morgenson, “Investors May Now Eye Costs of StockOptions,” The
New York Times, August 29, 2000 (reporting studies performed by Pat Mc-
Connell of Bear Stearns); Manitou Investment Management Ltd., The Long
View: The Amazing Stock Option Bubble (October 1999) (reporting studies performed
by the British research firm Smithers and the U.S. investment banking
firm Sanford Bernstein).
10. David Leonhardt, “In the Options Age, Rising Pay (and Risk): Will Today’s
Huge Rewards Devour Tomorrow’s Earnings?” The New York Times, April 2,
2000.
11. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 58.
12. Reuters, “Study Says Mergers Often Don’t Aid Investors,” The New York Times,
December 1, 1999.
13. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 143.
14. Mattell, Inc., SEC Form 8-K (filed July 22, 1999).
15. Mattell, Inc., SEC Form 8-K (filed October 22, 1999).
16. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 123–127.
17. Beginning in 1999, the author helped direct a project on firm structures for the
Independence Standards Board, and his views expressed here do not necessarily
represent those of that project or of the board.
18. Buffett and Cunningham, Essays, 168.
Chapter 14
1. David Gladstone, Venture Capital Handbook (Prentice-Hall, 1988), 101–104.
2. Warren E. Buffett and Lawrence A. Cunningham, The Essays of Warren
Buffett: Lessons for Corporate America (The Cunningham Group, 1997), 36
Notes 255
(this is one of Berkshire Hathaway’s famous “Owner Related Business Principles”).
3. This discussion draws on the annual letters of John F. (Jack) Welch to General
Electric Co. shareholders from 1985 through 2000. Some of them were coauthored
with other GE executives.
4. This discussion draws on the annual letters of Michael D. (Mike) Eisner to
Walt Disney Co. shareholders from 1988 through 2000.
5. This discussion draws on the annual letters of Roberto C. Goizueta to Coca-
Cola Co. shareholders from 1985 through 1996, plus an article enclosed with
one of them by Mr. Goizveta called “The Emerging Post-Conglomerate Era:
Changing the Shape of Corporate America,” Leaders, April–June 1989.
This page intentionally left blank.
257
COMPANY INDEX
AdirondackT rading Partners, 187
Alabama National, 106
AlliedSignal, 179–180, 205–206, 214, 223
Amazon.com, 115–116, 120–122, 124–128, 130–
131, 133–136, 139, 141–142, 147–148, 217
America Online (AOL), 55–56, 164
American Broadcasting Corporation (ABC),
114, 214, 232, 233
American Home Products, 106
American Institute of Certified Public Accountants
(AICPA), 155–156
American Standard, 227
Amoco, 185
AMP, 179–180, 205–206, 214
Anheuser-Busch, 106, 194
Applied Materials, 105
AT&T, 106, 177
Bang & Olufsen, 108
Bankof Boston, 163
Bankers Trust, 185
Banque Nationale de Paris, 185
Barings, 79–80
Barnes & Noble, 109, 113, 130
Ben & Jerry’s, 177, 207–208
Berkshire Hathaway, 11, 12–13, 14, 55, 71, 117,
150, 201, 217, 222
Bertelsmann, 185
BlackHills, 106
Bloomberg News, 53, 57
BMW, 106
Body Shop, 177
Boeing, 106, 108
Border’s, 109
British Petroleum, 185
Brown-Forman, 194
Business for Social Responsibility, 177
CalPers, 197, 199
Campbell’s Soup, 112
Capital Cities, 214
Carnival, 107
Cendant Corporation, 153, 166–167
Central Broadcasting System (CBS), 53
Charles Schwab, 66
Chicago Bulls, 65
Chrysler, 180, 185, 189, 208
Cirrus Logic, 55
Cisco, 84, 211
Clorox, 112
Coca-Cola Company, 84, 106–107, 108, 113–
114, 127, 136, 150, 177, 200, 235–241
Colgate-Palmolive, 107
Compaq, 112
ConEd, 106
Credit Suisse, 185
CUC International, 166
CVS, 106
Daimler Benz, 180, 185, 187, 189, 208
Dell Computer, 59, 60–61, 108, 112
Deutsche Bank, 185
Deutsche-Telecom, 185
Disney, 113–114, 135, 137, 199, 214, 230–235
Donaldson Lufkin Jenrette, 185
Dow Chemical, 106
Dow Jones, 53
Dresdner, 185
Dun & Bradstreet, 196
DuPont, 84, 99, 106, 177, 194
E-America Dot.com (satire), 157–160
eBay, 200
Elf Aquitaine, 185
Eli Lilly, 106, 194
Emulex, 53–54, 58
Enron, 106
ESPN, 114, 214, 232
E*Trade, 187
Euronext, 186
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
258 Company Index
Evening Exchange, 62
Exxon-Mobil, 106, 146
Fabri-Centers, 164–165
Federal Express, 106, 177
Federal Reserve Board, 8, 190
Financial Accounting Standards Board
(FASB), 156
First Oaks, 106
Folio, 66
Food and Drug Administration, U.S. (FDA),
52
Ford, 112, 185
Freerealtime, 57
French Bourse, 17, 186
Gap, 106
General Electric (GE), 99, 108, 113, 114–116,
121–130, 133–136, 139–142, 147–148, 199–
200, 210, 217, 222–230, 239
General Motors (GM), 199–200, 203
Gillette, 107
Goldman Sachs, 188
Gucci, 107, 185
Hasbro, 108, 177
Heineken, 106
He`rmes International, 106
Hershey’s, 106, 200
HFS Inc., 166
Home Depot, 106, 177
Honeywell, 108
Hoover, 112
IBM, 112, 211
Instinet, 62
Intel, 107
International Accounting Standards Committee
(IASC), 182
International Organization of Securities
Commissions (IOSCO), 189
International Securities Exchange, 187
Island, 62
iX (International Exchanges), 186–187
JoAnn Fabrics, 165
John Deere, 106
Johnson & Johnson, 75
Johnson Controls, 107, 108
Kenneth Cole, 107
Kimberly-Clark, 107
KPMG, 212
Kraft Foods, 213
Learning Company, 213
Leasco, 153
London StockExchange, 7
Longleaf Partner Funds, 11
Lucent, 106
LVMH Moe¨ t Hennessy Louis Vuitton, 185
McDonald’s, 106, 120
McGraw-Hill, 194
Mannesmann, 180, 184–185, 188
Marketwatch.com, 53
Mattel, 108, 213–214
Mazda, 185
MCI, 106
Mead, 107, 194
Mercury Finance, 163–164
Microsoft, 114–116, 121–130, 133–136, 141, 147–
148, 174, 211, 216, 217
MicroStrategy, 153, 166
Mitsubishi, 185
Motley Fool, 54
Motorola, 177
Nabisco, 113, 185
Nasdaq, 5–7, 54, 59, 62, 67, 87, 186, 187
National Association of Corporate Directors
(NACD), 197
National Association of Securities Dealers
(NASD), 187
National Broadcasting Corporation (NBC),
114
National Student Marketing, 153, 164
NEI Webworld, 56–58
Nestle´ , 106
NetworkAssociates, 208
New YorkStockExchange (NYSE), 3–4, 5,
7, 59, 62, 78, 186, 187
Nike, 107
Nissan, 182, 185
Nordstroms, 194
Olivetti, 185
Om Gruppen, 186
Omnigene Diagnostics, 56
Company Index 259
Oracle, 211
Osaka Securities Exchange, 187
PaineWebber, 185, 187
PairGain Technologies, 57
Palm, 211
Papa John’s Pizza, 75
Paramount, 179
Paribas, 185
Pearson, 162–163
Penguin, 162–163
Penn Central, 153
Pepsi, 84, 107, 127
Perdue, 112
Pfizer, 106
Philips-Van Heusen Corporation, 177
Polaroid, 177, 211
Polo Ralph Lauren, 107
Procter & Gamble, 74–75, 85, 105, 108, 113,
200
Putnam Berkley, 163
Quigley Corporation, 55
Raging Bull, 54, 57
Ralph Lauren, 107
Reebok, 177
Renault, 185
Rite-Aid, 220
Robert Morris Associates, 196
Rolls Royce, 185
Saks Fifth Avenue, 109
Salomon Brothers, 163
Samsung, 185
Santa Fe Institute, 36–37
SAP, 187, 189
Sears, 200
Securities and Exchange Commission
(SEC), 3–4, 11, 54, 56–59, 61, 67, 105,
155–156, 165, 182–183, 187, 189, 202,
211, 219–220
Sequoia Fund, 11
Silicon Investor, 54
Socie´te´ Ge´nerale, 185
SoftbankCorporation, 187
Sony, 106
Sotheby’s, 116
South Sea Company, 9–10
Standard & Poor’s, 196
Standard Oil, 174
Starbucks, 108
Steinway, 107
Sunbeam, 153, 165, 166, 207
Supreme Court, U.S., 52
Teacher’s Insurance Annuity Associate-
College Retirement Equities Fund
(TIAA-CREF), 179, 197
Telecom Italia, 185
Texaco, 106, 200
Tiffany’s, 106
Time Inc., 179
Tokyo Stock Exchange, 7
Toshiba, 227
TOTAL-FINA, 185
Toys-‘‘R’’-Us, 108
TrackData Corporation, 79
Tweedy Browne, 11
UBS, 185
Unilever, 177
United Biscuits, 185
United Technologies, 99
U.S. Steel Corporation, 157
Value Line Investment Survey, 11
Vanguard, 11, 199
Vodafone, 180, 184–185, 188
Volkswagen, 185
Wal-Mart, 108, 177, 200, 227
Walgreen’s, 106
Walt Disney Company, 113–114, 135, 137, 199,
214, 230–235
Washington Post Company, 13, 194
Wasserstein Parella, 185
Westinghouse, 200
Wilshire, 106
Windsor Fund, 11, 14
Wrigley, 200
Xerox, 113
Yahoo!, 54, 55, 57, 211
Yokogawa, 227
Yves Saint Laurent, 185
260
NAME INDEX
Alexander, Sidney, 21
Ammer, John, 49
Aristotle, 49
Arrow, Kenneth, 26
Astor, Lady, 208–209
Bachelier, Louis, 17–18, 22
Baker, James, 8
Barad, Jill, 213
Baruch, Bernard, 11
Bass, Thomas, 37
Berra, Yogi, 82
Black, Fischer, 26
Blair, Tony, 182–183
Bogle, Jack, 13, 199
Boorstein, Daniel, 119
Bossidy, Larry, 223
Brett, George, 64
Briloff, Abraham, 156–157
Brown, Robert, 18
Buffett, Warren, 4, 9, 11, 12–14, 27, 48, 49,
55, 65, 71, 73, 76, 81, 87, 88, 100, 102,
103, 109, 111, 117, 118, 134, 137, 145, 150,
167, 171, 172, 191, 193, 197, 198–199,
206, 209, 211–212, 216, 220, 222, 243
Burgstahler, David, 154
Burke, Dan, 214
Campbell, John, 49
Carew, Rod, 64
Carret, Phil, 13, 14, 56, 143
Clinton, Bill, 225–226
Cowles, Alfred, 18
Cuniff, Richard, 11
de la Vega, Joseph, 10
Dichev, Ilia, 154
Disney, Roy, 214, 232
Disney, Walt, 214, 230, 231, 232, 234
Dunlap, Al, 165, 207
Eaton, Robert, 208
Eckert, Robert, 213
Edison, Thomas, 223
Einstein, Albert, 18, 22, 32, 46
Eisner, Michael, 214, 230–235
Fama, Eugene, 20, 21, 25, 27–28
Farmer, Doyne, 37
Fisher, Phil, 13, 221
Franklin, Ben, 118
Friedman, Milton, 23, 87–88
Fukuyama, Francis, 31
Gabelli, Mario, 11
Gates, Bill, 115
Gleick, James, 36–37
Goethe, G. W. F., 241
Goizueta, Roberto, 113–114, 150, 235–241
Graham, Benjamin, 4–5, 11, 13–14, 22, 32,
33, 49, 56, 69, 70–71, 73, 76, 80–82,
86, 87, 109, 111, 117, 121, 134, 137, 143–
144, 145, 150–151, 156–157, 167, 171, 179,
193, 203–204, 243–244
Hackworth, Michael, 55
Hawkins, Mason, 11
Hertz, Barry, 79
Hixon, Robert, 179
Hurst, H. E., 35–36
Jordan, Michael, 65
Jordan, Vernon, 200
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
Name Index 261
Kendall, Maurice, 18
Keough, Donald, 235
Keynes, John Maynard, 11, 13, 25, 26, 87–88
Klatsky, Bruce, 177
Knapp, Tom, 11
Leeson, Nick, 79–80
Lefe`vre, Edwin, 56, 82
Levitt, Arthur, 67, 153–154, 155–157, 161,
166, 183
Lo, Andrew, 25
Loeb, Gerald, 11, 13, 14, 65, 75
Loomis, Carol, 102
Lorenz, Edward, 37–38
Lyapunov, Aleksandr, 43–44
Lynch, Peter, 13, 14, 65
MacKinley, A. Craig, 25
McLuhan, Marshall, 232
Malkiel, Burton, 12
Mandelbrot, Benoit, 45
Markowitz, Harry, 28, 29
Munger, Charlie, 11, 14, 32, 49, 134, 150
Murphy, Tom, 214
Neff, John, 11, 14
Newton, Isaac, 37
Nixon, Richard, 13
Nunn, Sam, 200
Ovitz, Mike, 235
Pacioli, Luca, 153
Packard, Norman, 37
Park, Yun Soo Oh (Toyko Joe), 57–58
Perdue, Frank, 112
Perot, Ross, 225–226
Peters, Edgar, 36, 44–46
Poincare´ , Henri, 37
Price, Michael, 13
Price, T. Rowe, 13
Ricketts, Howard T., 4
Roosevelt, Theodore, 174
Ruane, William, 11
Rubin, Robert E., 182–183
Samuelson, Paul, 18, 22
Savage, Leonard, 18
Schafer, David, 11
Schrempp, Jurgen, 208
Schwed, Fred, 5, 222
Shakespeare, William, 12
Sharpe, William F., 26, 28, 29
Shiller, Robert, 48–49
Shleifer, Andrei, 48
Smith, Adam, 31
Soros, George, 13, 15
Stein, Herb, 9
Summers, Lawrence, 48
Templeton, John, 11
Tobin, James, 25–26
Tokyo Joe, 57–58
Welch, Jack, 114–115, 125, 222–230, 239
Williams, John Burr, 144, 146
Williams, Ted, 64, 222
Working, Holbrook, 18
262
SUBJECT INDEX
AAA approach, at Coca-Cola, 237, 241
Accountability, 211
Accounting:
auditing and, 217–220
globalization and, 181–183, 219
internal financial controls, 218
for mergers and acquisitions, 154–155
Accounting goodwill, 137, 154
Accounting trickery, 52, 153–167
examples of aggressive accounting, 161–
167
perennial techniques, 153–157
satire of, 157–161
Accounts receivable turnover, 125–126
Acid test ratio, 122–123
Analyst effect, 11
Annual reports, 105–106
Anomaly effects, 10–11, 21
Arbitrage, 27, 79–80
Ask, 59–60
Asset allocation, 76–77
At-will employment, 173
Auditing, 217–220
Balance sheet, 134–138
Bargain hunting, 137
Behavioral finance, 47–49
Beta, 29–32
Bid, 59–60
Bid-askspread, 60, 61
Big bath accounting, 154
Board of directors (see Corporate governance)
Bookvalue, 92–93, 134–138, 147
Boundarylessness, at General Electric, 223,
224, 226, 228, 229, 230
Branded products, 112, 136, 236–237
British South Sea bubble, 9–10
Brownian motion, 18
Bullet-train thinking, 227
Bulletin boards, 54, 56–57
Business climate, 85–86
Business value, 70–75
(See also Valuation)
Business volatility, 31–32
Butterfly effect, 37–38, 47
Capital allocation, 215–217
Capital asset pricing model (CAPM), 29–32,
34, 72
Capital markets, globalization and, 186–
187
Capitalization of earnings method of valuation,
95–96, 98, 99, 133, 138–142
Capitalization rate, 140
Care, duty of, 177–178
Cash-burn, 83, 159–160
Cash flow, in discounted cash flow method
of valuation, 96–98, 99, 133, 144–
145
Chaos (Gleick), 36–37
Chaos theory, 31, 36–46
butterfly effect and, 37–38, 47
fractals and, 44–46
hockey puck problem and, 38, 47
Lyapunov exponents and, 43–44
origins of, 37–38
phase portraits and, 38–43
pricing discontinuity and, 46–47
pricing persistency in, 46–47
time-series data and, 38–43, 45
Chartists, 24
Chat rooms, 54, 56–57
Chief executive officers (CEOs):
Michael Eisner, 230–235
Roberto Goizueta, 235–241
JackW elch, 222–230
key characteristics of, 221–222
selection of, 206–207
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
Subject Index 263
Circle of competence, 105–118
decision making and, 116–118
full circle, 114–116
initial, 106–109
nurtured, 109–114
Circuit breakers, 3–4
Co-location, at General Electric, 227
Commercial banking, 174, 187, 190
Commodities, 112
Compensation:
determining levels of, 207–208
stockoptions in, 208–212, 216–217
Compounding, 100–102
Confirmation bias, 118
Corporate governance, 172–176, 183–184
board independence, 198–199
capital allocation, 215–217
CEO selection, 206–207
compensation and, 207–212
globalization and, 172–176, 183–184
integrity of financial reporting, 217–
220
involvement in other boards, 200–201
orientation of board, 195–200
reforms in, 197
shareholder primacy and, 180, 189–190,
194
shareholder proposals and, 202–204
size of board, 200
son-in-law standard, 193–195
succession and, 201, 206–207
takeover evaluation, 212–215
(See also Chief executive officers; Managerial
integrity and ability)
Corporate social responsibility, 176–179
Correlation tests, 19–20
Cost of debt, 145
Cost of equity, 145
Cost of goods sold (COGS), 125
Crash of 1929, 8, 84
Crash of 1987, 7–8, 46, 48, 67, 72
Credit sales, 126
Currency reporting, 160
Current ratio, 121–122
Day trading, 4, 47, 70
margin trading and, 79
trader volatility and, 63–64, 66
Debt-to-equity ratio, 123–124
Decimal pricing, 62
Decision making, 116–118
Delinkage, 71
Demand Flow Technology, at General Electric,
227
Depreciation, 93, 96, 98, 99, 131
Derivative securities, 8
(See also Stockoptions)
Diluted earnings, 138
Directors (see Corporate governance)
Discount brokers, 61
Discounted cash flow method of valuation,
96–98, 99, 133, 144–145
Discounting, 97–98
Diversification, 15, 75–76
asset allocation and, 76–77
income allocation and, 77–78
and modern portfolio theory, 29
Dividend discount method of valuation, 144–
145
Dividend policy, 215–216
Dividend reinvestment plans (DRIPs), 74–
75
Dutch tulip bulb mania, 9, 10
Duty of care, 177–178
Duty of loyalty, 178
E-commerce (see Internet)
Economic goodwill, 136–137
Economic value added, 149–151
Efficient market theory (EMT), 4, 7–49
anomaly effects and, 10–11, 21
behavioral finance and, 47–49
capital asset pricing model and, 29–32,
34, 72
challenges to, 47–49
chaos theory and, 36–46
‘‘lucky monkey’’ viewpoint and, 12–13
market bubbles and, 8–10
as misleading, 72
modern portfolio theory and, 28–29, 64,
72
noise theory and, 25–28, 33–34
perfect market and, 22–23
professional investors and, 11, 12–15
random walkmodel and, 12–13, 17–
22
three forms of efficiency, 23–25, 26
volatility and, 51–67
Electronic computer networks (ECNs), 60–
63
EMT (see Efficient market theory)
Essays of Warren Buffett, The (Buffett), 171,
222
Euclidean geometry, 44–46
264 Subject Index
European Union (EU):
corporate governance and, 175–176, 183
integration of finance and governance,
181
(See also names of specific countries)
Expenses, matching revenues with, 93–94
Filter technique, 21
Financial alchemy, 81–86
Financial leverage index, 130
401(k) accounts, 76, 77
Fractals, 44–46
France, mergers and acquisitions, 185
Fraud detection, 219
Free rider strategy, 73, 76
Fundamental analysis, 70–75
Fundamental efficiency, 26
Germany:
corporate governance and, 175
globalization and, 187
information and, 188, 189
mergers and acquisitions and, 180, 185
social responsibility and, 177
Glass-Steagall Act, 174, 187, 190
Globalization, 52, 113, 171–191
accounting and, 181–183, 219
capital markets and, 186–187
corporate governance and, 172–176, 183–
184
information and, 188–189
mergers and acquisitions, 178–180, 184–
186
orientation of board, 195–200
shareholder primacy and, 172–176, 180,
189–190
social responsibility and, 176–179
Goodwill, 136–137, 154
Greater fool theory, 69
H exponent, 35–36
Half Movement, at General Electric, 227
Hedge funds, 15
Hoaxes, 53–58
Hockey puck problem, 38, 47
Holding period, 87
Hostile takeovers, 178–180, 184–186, 214–215
Implied cap rate, 149
Income allocation, 77–78
Index funds, 73–74, 99
Individual retirement accounts (IRAs), 76,
77
Inflation, in valuation process, 103, 136
Information volatility, 51–59
negative, 52–59
positive, 52
Informational efficiency, 26
Infrastructure fortification, at Coca-Cola,
238
Initial public offerings (IPOs), 8–9
Inside tips, 56
Insider effect, 11
Integrated diversity, at General Electric,
223, 225, 226
Intelligent Investor, The (Graham), 22, 134
Interest rates:
risk-free, 102, 141, 142
in valuation process, 102
Internet, 8–9
and Disney, 232
and General Electric, 228–229
rise of, 113
Webcasting, 54
Interpretation of Financial Statements, The
(Graham), 121
Intrinsic time, 46–47
Inventory turnover, 124–125
Investment banking, 174, 187, 190
Italy, mergers and acquisitions, 185
January effect, 11
Japan:
accounting and, 181–182
corporate governance and, 176, 184
globalization and, 185, 187
information and, 189
stockmark et bubble, 9, 84
Joseph effect, 46–47
Lake Woebegon syndrome, 117
Learning culture:
at Coca-Cola, 239–240
at General Electric, 227, 228
Leverage, 123–124, 129, 130
Limit cycle attractors, 43
Linear testing, 33–36
Liquidation value, 135–136
Liquidity ratio, 122–123
Long-term approach, 86–88
Loyalty, duty of, 178
Lyapunov exponents (LEs), 43–44
Subject Index 265
Macroeconomic factors, 100, 103
Management discussion and analysis, 105–
106, 119
Managerial integrity and ability, 171–191
accounting and, 181–183
capital markets and, 186–187
corporate governance and, 172–176, 183–
184
information and, 188–189
key components of, 221–222
mergers and acquisitions and, 178–180,
184–186, 214–216
shareholder primacy and, 172–176, 180,
189–190
social responsibility and, 176–179
(See also Chief executive officers)
Margin trading, 78–79, 80
Market bubbles, 8–10, 81–86
Market capitalization, 8–9
Market cycle, 69, 72
Market efficiency, 64
Market makers, transaction volatility and,
59–63
Market share, 83–84, 159
Market volatility, 5–8, 34
Matching expenses and revenues, 93–94
Materiality principle, 155, 160
Mergers and acquisitions:
accounting for, 154–155
defensive tactics in, 214–215
hostile takeovers, 178–180, 184–186, 214–
215
offensive tactics in, 212–214
Modern portfolio theory (MPT), 28–29, 64,
72
Momentum traders, 5, 21–22
Month effect, 11
Mutual funds, 99, 177
National Securities Markets Improvements
Act of 1996, 182
Negative information volatility, 52–59
accounting trickery and, 52, 153–167
pump-and-dump schemes, 56–58
rumor-based ‘‘news’’ and, 53–58
share repurchases and, 52, 216–217
Neoclassical economic model, 31
Net current assets, 137
Netherlands:
corporate governance and, 175
mergers and acquisitions, 185
News cycle, 53
Nile River Dam project, 35
Noah effect, 46–47
Noise theory, 25–28, 33–34
Non-Random Walk Down Wall Street, A (Lo
and MacKinlay), 25
Nonlinear systems, 31, 33–36
On-line brokers, 61
Opportunity cost, 77
Options, 79–81, 208–212, 216–217
Order flow, 60
Overconfidence, 117, 118
Owner orientation (see Shareholder primacy)
Pattern seeking, 118
Perfect markets, 22–23
Phase portraits, 38–43
Phynance, 36–46
Point cycle attractors, 43
Ponzi schemes, 55
PPP approach, at Coca-Cola, 237, 241
Practical intelligence, at Coca-Cola, 241
Predictors, The (Bass), 37
Present value, 97–98
Price/bookratio, 147
Price/earnings (P/E) ratio, 95–96, 148–149
Price/sales ratio, 147–148
Pricing discontinuity, 46–47
Pricing persistency, 46–47
Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of
1995, 190
Privatization, 184
Profit margin, 95, 126–128
Proxy contests, 203–204
Pump-and-dump schemes, 56–58
Q fever, 4–5
Quality of income, 131
QuickMark et Intelligence (QMI), at General
Electric, 227
Quickratio, 122–123
Random Walk Down Wall Street, A (Malkiel),
12
Random walkmodel, 17–22, 31
correlation tests and, 19–20
described, 12–13
H exponent and, 35–36
perfect market and, 22–23
runs and, 20
266 Subject Index
Random walkmodel (Cont.):
trading rules and, 20–22
validity of, 24, 35
weakform efficiency and, 23–25
Rate of return, 95
Ratio analysis, 119–132
current ratio, 121–122
debt-to-equity ratio, 123–124
inventory turns, 124–125
price/bookratio, 147
price/earnings ratio, 95–96, 148–149
price/sales ratio, 147–148
profit margin, 95, 126–128
quickratio, 122–123
receivable turns, 125–126
return on assets, 129–131
return on equity, 128
return on investment, 128–129
working capital, 120–121
Rebalancing, trader volatility and, 63, 64–
65, 66
Receivables turnover, 125–126
Research-and-development (R&D) expenditures,
154–155
Reserve adjustments, 155, 158–159
Resistance, 118
Resource allocation, at Coca-Cola, 238–
239
Return:
capital asset pricing model and, 29–32
and modern portfolio theory, 28–29
Return on assets, 129–131
Return on equity, 128
Return on investment (ROI), 128–129
Revenue recognition, 155, 158
Revenues, matching expenses with, 93–94
Risk:
appetite for, 117
and modern portfolio theory, 28–29
riskaversion, 27
risk-free rate of interest, 102, 141, 142
Rule of 72s, 101–102
Rumors, 27, 53–58, 82
Runs, 20
Sales per employee, 131
Salvage value, 99
Saving via stocks, 65–66
Scalping, 57
Scrap value, 99
Sector rotation, 5, 21–22
Sell-offs, 4
Semistrong-form efficiency, 23–25, 26
Shareholder primacy:
at Coca-Cola, 236
corporate governance and, 172–176, 180,
189–190, 194
Shareholder proposal rule, 202–204
Simplification philosophy, at General Electric,
225, 229
Six Sigma quality, at General Electric, 227–
228
Smoothing techniques, 153
Social responsibility, 176–179
Son-in-law standard, 193–195
Spamming, 55–56
Specialists, transaction volatility and, 59–63
Speculation, 5, 73, 79–80
market bubbles and, 8–10, 81–86
(See also Day trading)
Speed philosophy, at General Electric, 224,
227, 229
Stochastic systems, 37
Stockmutual funds, 74, 77
Stockoptions, 208–212, 216–217
Stockrepurchases, 52, 216–217
Stocksplits, 217
Stretch philosophy, at General Electric, 224–
225, 227, 229
Strong-form efficiency, 23–25
Succession, 201, 206–207
Superiority, 117, 118
Synergy meetings, at Disney, 230–231
Systematic risk, 29
Takeovers, 178–180, 184–186, 214–215
Taxes:
impact on investments, 102–103
interest deductions on debt, 8
on mutual funds versus individual
stocks, 74
Three-body problem, 37
360 degree management appraisal, 226
Ticks:
market price, 5
Q fever and, 4–5
Time-series data, 19–20, 38–43, 45
Time value of money, 99, 100–102
Tips, 27
Trader volatility, 63–66
day trading and, 63–64, 66
rebalancing and, 63, 64–65, 66
saving via stocks and, 65–66
Trading rules, 20–22
Subject Index 267
Transaction volatility, 59–63
Tulip bulb mania, 9, 10
24-hour trading, 62
Typhus, 4
United Kingdom:
accounting and, 182–183
corporate governance and, 172–176, 183–
184
information and, 188–189
Unsystematic risk, 29
Valuation, 70–75, 83, 91–103
assets in, 134–138
bookvalue in, 134–138
capitalization of earnings method, 95–
96, 98, 99, 133, 138–142
circle of competence and, 105–118
compounding in, 100–102
discounted cash flow method, 96–98,
99, 133, 144–145
inflation in, 103, 136
interest rates in, 102
Valuation (Cont.):
margin of safety and, 134, 142–144
market circularity and, 146–149
ratio analysis in, 119–132, 147–149
taxes and, 102–103
Value Line effect, 11
Vividness bias, 118
Volatility, 51–67
business, 31–32
information, 51–59
market, 5–8, 34
prognosis for market and, 66–67
trader, 63–66
transaction, 59–63
Wall Street rule, 172
Watergate, 13
Weakform efficiency, 23–25
Webcasting, 54
Weekend effect, 11
Where Are the Customers’ Yachts? (Schwed),
5, 222
Work-Out, at General Electric, 225–227,
228, 229, 230
Working capital, 120–121
ABOUT THE AUTHOR
Lawrence A. Cunningham is professor of law at the Benjamin N.
Cardozo Law School of Yeshiva University in New YorkCity and
director of The Samuel and Ronnie Heyman Center on Corporate
Governance at Cardozo, where he has taught since 1992. From 1988
to 1992, he was an associate with Cravath, Swaine & Moore, where
he practiced corporate and securities law. Professor Cunningham
has written numerous books and dozens of articles on accounting,
business, finance, investing, and related policy matters, including an
internationally acclaimed collection of Warren Buffett’s letters to
Berkshire Hathaway shareholders, The Essays of Warren Buffet: Lessons
for Corporate America, and the widely used textbook Introductory
Accounting and Finance for Lawyers. Professor Cunningham has
taught and lectured widely, in the United States and abroad, at
schools and business organizations of all kinds. He has served as a
consultant to corporate boards of directors, law and accounting
firms, and regulatory and standard-setting bodies. He has been featured
in Forbes and Money, and on CNN and The Motley Fool Radio
Show, and has appeared on or been quoted in scores of other broadcast
and print media. Professor Cunningham is a magna cum laude
graduate of Cardozo and earned his B.A. in economics from the
University of Delaware. He was born and raised in Wilmington, Delaware,
and now resides in New YorkCity with his wife, JoAnna Cunningham.
Professor Cunningham is an investor and may hold securities
of some of the companies discussed in this book
Copyright 2001 The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Click Here for Terms of Use
‘‘This timely bookchallenges investors to move away from the recentlypopular
‘Q Culture’ of speculation to the ‘V Culture’ of value investing,
based on business analysis that focuses on the basics of finance, accounting,
and governance. The author reminds us that, ‘earnings and cash
flows are what give a business value’—the eternal message of long-run
success in equity investing. It is the critical linkin the investment chain,
and Larry Cunningham’s bookforges it with heat, power, and persuasiveness.’’
JackBogle, Founder and Former Chairman,
The Vanguard Group
‘‘Larry Cunningham masterfully tackles critical subjects at the heart of
today’s markets. A much-needed work on a unique style of investing, this
bookputs the ABCs of common sense valuation back into the business of
investing. This is the place to lookfor insight and guidance in the age of
volatile markets and colliding ideas.’’
Alan C. (‘‘Ace’’) Greenberg, Chairman, Bear Stearns
‘‘Anyone desiring to be a successful investor should read this excellent
bookpresenting the important investing principles of Graham, Buffett,
Fisher, and others in a most insightful and understandable manner.’’
David J. (‘‘Sandy’’) Gottesman, Chairman, First Manhattan
‘‘Remarkably timely. For stock players who realize they played the greatest
fool in the Internet stockgame, Cunningham offers a tool for rehabilitation:
a guide to thoughtful investing. For earnest investors, he shows how
to live profitably with the moodiness of Mr. Market.’’
David Henry, Associate Editor, Finance, Business Week
‘‘While the stockmark et does not always behave rationally, Larry Cunningham’s
well-articulated and insightful views as to value investing are a
refreshing reminder that, just as night follows day, a return to the principles
at the core of Cunningham’s commonsense approach to investing is
inevitable.’’
Samuel J. Heyman, Chairman of the Board and CEO,
GAF Corporation
‘‘Puzzled by acronyms, buzz words, the pop investing concepts? Cunningham
explains then debunks them. He gets down to the fundamentals that
investors must know about companies in order to choose reliable winners
in the stockmark et.’’
Janet Lowe, Author, Benjamin Graham on
Value Investing and Warren Buffett Speaks
Comments
Post a Comment